RENT A CENTER INC
S-4, 1998-10-16
EQUIPMENT RENTAL & LEASING, NEC
Previous: REALTY INCOME CORP, 424B2, 1998-10-16
Next: SHELTER PROPERTIES VI LIMITED PARTNERSHIP, 8-K, 1998-10-16



<PAGE>   1
 
    As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 16, 1998
                                                   Registration No. 333-[      ]
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             Washington, D.C. 20549
                                    FORM S-4
            REGISTRATION STATEMENT UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                              RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
                              RENT-A-CENTER, INC.
                                COLORTYME, INC.
           (Exact name of co-registrants as specified in its charter)
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                <C>                                <C>
             DELAWARE                             7359                            48-1024367
             DELAWARE                             7359                            48-0959188
              TEXAS                               6794                            75-2651408
 (State or other jurisdiction of      (Primary standard industrial             (I.R.S. Employer
  incorporation or organization)      classification code number)            Identification No.)
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                <C>                                <C>
       RENT-A-CENTER, INC.                RENTERS CHOICE, INC.                 COLORTYME, INC.
      8200 EAST THORN DRIVE         13800 MONTFORT DRIVE, SUITE 300     1231 GREENWAY DRIVE, SUITE 900
      WICHITA, KANSAS 67226               DALLAS, TEXAS 75240                IRVING, TEXAS 75038
          (316) 636-7368                     (972) 701-0489                     (972) 751-1711
</TABLE>
 
    (Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code
               of each Registrant's principal executive offices)
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                 <C>
                 J. ERNEST TALLEY
 CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD AND CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER                    With Copies To:
               RENTERS CHOICE, INC.                               THOMAS W. HUGHES, ESQ.
          13800 MONTFORT DRIVE, SUITE 300                         BRUCE A. CHEATHAM, ESQ.
                DALLAS, TEXAS 75240                           WINSTEAD SECHREST & MINICK P.C.
                  (972) 701-0489                                  5400 RENAISSANCE TOWER
 (Name, address, including zip code, and telephone                    1201 ELM STREET
                      number,                                    DALLAS, TEXAS 75270-2199
    including area code, of Agent for service)                        (214) 745-5400
</TABLE>
 
     APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF PROPOSED SALE TO THE PUBLIC: As soon as
practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement.
     If the securities being registered on this Form are being offered in
connection with the formation of a holding company and there is compliance with
General Instruction G, check the following box.  [ ]
     If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering
pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and
list the Securities Act registration number of the earlier effective
registration number for the same offering.  [ ]
     If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d)
under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier, effective registration statement
for the same offering.  [ ]
                        CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
       TITLE OF EACH NOTE OF             AMOUNT TO BE       PROPOSED OFFERING   PROPOSED AGGREGATE        AMOUNT OF
    SECURITIES TO BE REGISTERED           REGISTERED        PRICE PER NOTE(1)    OFFERING PRICE(1)    REGISTRATION FEE
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                   <C>                  <C>                  <C>                  <C>
11% Senior Subordinated Notes due
  2008..............................     $175,000,000             100%             $175,000,000          $51,625.00
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Guarantees of Senior Subordinated
  Notes(2)..........................          --                   --                   --                   (3)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
 
(1) In accordance with Rule 457(f)(2), the registration fee is calculated based
    on the book value, which has been computed as of October 13, 1998, of the
    outstanding 11% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 of Renters Choice, Inc.
    to be canceled in the exchange transaction hereunder.
(2) Rent-A-Center, Inc. and ColorTyme, Inc., each a direct, wholly owned
    subsidiary of the Registrant, have each guaranteed the Notes being
    registered pursuant hereto.
(3) Pursuant to Rule 457(n), no separate fee is payable with respect to the
    guarantees of the Notes being registered.
 
     THE REGISTRANTS HEREBY AMEND THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR
DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANTS
SHALL FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS REGISTRATION
STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(a) OF
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933 OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL BECOME
EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(a),
MAY DETERMINE.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>   2
 
                             PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS
 
                                     [LOGO]
 
                              RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
                                     Issuer
 
                              RENT-A-CENTER, INC.
                                COLORTYME, INC.
                                   Guarantors
 
                               Offer to Exchange
                     11% Senior Subordinated Notes Due 2008
           For All Outstanding 11% Senior Subordinated Notes Due 2008
 
THE EXCHANGE NOTES --
 
- - Identical in all material respects to the Old Notes, except for certain
  transfer restrictions, registration rights and liquidated damages provisions
  relating to the Old Notes
 
- - Interest accrues from the date of issuance at the rate of 11% per annum,
  payable semi-annually in arrears on each February 15 and August 15, commencing
  February 15, 1999
 
- - Unsecured and subordinated to all existing and future Senior Indebtedness
 
- - Rank without preference with all future Senior Subordinated Indebtedness and
  as senior to all future Subordinated Obligations
 
- - Fully and unconditionally guaranteed on an unsecured, senior subordinated
  basis by Rent-A-Center, Inc. and ColorTyme, Inc.
 
THE EXCHANGE OFFER --
 
- - For all of the Old Notes
 
- - Expires at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on [                ], 1998
 
- - Subject to customary conditions
 
CONSIDER CAREFULLY THE RISK FACTORS BEGINNING ON PAGE 25 OF THIS PROSPECTUS.
 
You should rely only on the information contained in this Prospectus or that we
have referred you to. We have not authorized anyone to provide you with
information that is different. We are not offering to sell or asking you to buy
anything other than the Exchange Notes. We are not offering to sell or asking
you to buy anything in any jurisdiction where doing so would be against the law.
 
NEITHER THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION NOR ANY STATE SECURITIES
COMMISSION HAS APPROVED THE EXCHANGE NOTES NOR DETERMINED THAT THIS PROSPECTUS
IS ACCURATE OR COMPLETE. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL
OFFENSE.
 
Subject to completion, dated October 16, 1998
 
THE INFORMATION IN THIS PROSPECTUS IS NOT COMPLETE AND MAY BE CHANGED. WE MAY
NOT SELL THESE SECURITIES UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT FILED WITH THE
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION IS EFFECTIVE. THIS PROSPECTUS IS NOT AN OFFER
TO SELL THESE SECURITIES AND IT IS NOT SOLICITING AN OFFER TO BUY THESE
SECURITIES IN ANY STATE WHERE THE OFFER OR SALE IS NOT PERMITTED.
<PAGE>   3
 
                             AVAILABLE INFORMATION
 
We have filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC") a
registration statement on Form S-4 (the "Registration Statement") with respect
to the 11% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Exchange Notes"). This
Prospectus, which is a part of the Registration Statement, omits certain
information included in the Registration Statement. Information omitted from
this Prospectus, but contained in the Registration Statement, may be inspected
and copied at the SEC's Public Reference Room at Room 1024, 450 Fifth Street,
N.W., Judiciary Plaza, Washington, D.C. 20549. You may obtain information on the
operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. You
may also obtain information about the Company from the following regional
offices of the SEC: Northwestern Atrium Center, 500 West Madison Street, Suite
1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661; and 7 World Trade Center, 13th Floor, New York,
New York 10048. Copies of such material can be obtained by mail from the Public
Reference Section of the SEC at 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Judiciary Plaza,
Washington, D.C. 20549 at prescribed rates. You may obtain our electronic
filings filed through the SEC's Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis and
Retrieval system ("EDGAR") through the SEC's home page on the Internet at
http://www.sec.gov.
 
We file annual, quarterly, and special reports, proxy statements, and other
information with the SEC. In the event that we are no longer required to do so,
we have agreed to file with the SEC (unless the SEC will not accept such a
filing) and provide to the Trustee and the holders of Notes annual reports and
the information, documents and other reports otherwise required pursuant to
Sections 13 and 15(d) of the Exchange Act. For additional information, please
refer to the section entitled "Description of the Notes and
Guarantees -- Certain Covenants -- Reporting Requirements" located elsewhere in
this Prospectus.
 
                           FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
 
The statements, other than statements of historical facts included in this
Prospectus, including statements set forth under the "Summary," "Risk Factors,"
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations," and "Business" regarding the Company's future financial position,
business strategy, budgets, projected costs and plans and objectives of
management for future operations, are forward-looking statements. In addition,
forward-looking statements generally can be identified by the use of
forward-looking terminology such as "may," "will," "expect," "intend,"
"estimate," "anticipate" or "believe" or the negative thereof or variations
thereon or similar terminology. Although we believe that the expectations
reflected in such forward-looking statements will prove to have been correct, we
can give no assurance that such expectations will prove to have been correct.
You are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking
statements, which speak only as of the date of this Prospectus. Except as
required by law, we are not obligated to publicly release any revisions to these
forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances after the date of
this Prospectus or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events. Important
factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from our
expectations (the "Cautionary Statements") are disclosed under "Risk Factors"
and elsewhere in this Prospectus including in conjunction with some of the
forward-looking statements included in this Prospectus. All subsequent written
and oral forward-looking statements attributable to the Company, or persons
acting on its behalf, are expressly qualified in their entirety by the
Cautionary Statements.
 
                                        3
<PAGE>   4
 
                               PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
 
This summary highlights some information from this Prospectus, but does not
contain all material features of the Exchange Offer. Please read the detailed
information and consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto
appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus. Except as otherwise required by the
context, references in this Prospectus to "we," "us," "RCI," "Issuer," or the
"Company" refer to (i) after August 5, 1998, the combined business of Renters
Choice, Inc. ("Renters Choice") and its subsidiary, ColorTyme, Inc.
("ColorTyme") and Rent-A-Center, Inc. (formerly known as Thorn Americas, Inc.)
and its subsidiaries ("Rent-A-Center" or "RAC") and (ii) prior to and including
August 5, 1998, the businesses of Renters Choice and ColorTyme. The term
"Guarantors" refers to ColorTyme and Rent-A-Center, both wholly owned
subsidiaries of Renters Choice. The term "Old Notes" refers to the 11% Senior
Subordinated Notes due 2008 that were issued on August 18, 1998. The term
"Exchange Notes" refers to the 11% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008. The term
"Notes" refers to the Old Notes and the Exchange Notes collectively. The term
"you" refers to prospective investors in the Exchange Notes.
 
                                  THE COMPANY
 
We are the largest operator in the U.S. Rent-to-Own ("RTO") industry with
approximately 25% market share of RTO stores. We currently operate 2,126
company-owned stores and franchise 307 stores in the United States and Puerto
Rico. Our stores offer home electronics, appliances and furniture and
accessories under flexible rental purchase agreements that allow our customers
to obtain ownership of the merchandise at the conclusion of an agreed upon
rental period.
 
                                  RTO INDUSTRY
 
Overview. According to the Association of Progressive Rental Organizations, the
RTO industry generated approximately $4.1 billion in revenue during 1996 through
the rental of roughly 5.8 million products to approximately 3.0 million
households. We estimate the RTO target market is greater than 20 million
households, principally comprised of households with annual income from $15,000
to $50,000. The RTO industry appeals to a wide variety of consumers by allowing
them to obtain merchandise that they might otherwise be (i) unable to purchase
due to insufficient cash resources or a lack of access to credit, or (ii)
unwilling to purchase due to a temporary, short-term need or desire to rent. The
RTO industry provides consumers with
 
- - a means of obtaining merchandise without the burden of incurring debt or
  qualifying for credit,
 
- - the ability to return merchandise at any time without future obligations,
 
- - flexible payment terms,
 
- - delivery, repair and pick-up service, typically at no incremental charge, and
 
- - the potential for merchandise ownership after a predetermined number of
  payments.
                                        4
<PAGE>   5
 
The types of products rented by RTO customers include furniture and accessories
(34.9% of total units rented), electronics (31.1%), appliances (22.4%), and
other items including jewelry, pagers and personal computers (11.6%). We
estimate that the RTO industry is comprised of approximately 8,300 stores.
Although the five largest RTO companies operate approximately 38.5% of the
industry's store base, the industry is highly fragmented as the majority of RTO
competitors operate fewer than 20 stores. Our industry has experienced
significant consolidation since 1993, when the five largest RTO companies
operated approximately 26.6% of the industry's store base. The RTO industry is
experiencing consolidation primarily because larger, multi-unit operators have
significant competitive advantages compared to their smaller competitors. Larger
operators enjoy greater purchasing power, which enables them to offer more
competitively priced merchandise, and are able to operate more efficiently than
smaller operators in areas such as management information systems, advertising
and purchasing. Many smaller competitors lack the managerial resources necessary
to operate larger RTO operations efficiently across multiple locations. We
believe that these factors will continue to promote the trend toward
consolidation and present an opportunity for well-capitalized operators to
acquire additional stores on favorable terms.
 
RTO Transaction. In general, customers enter into weekly or monthly rental
purchase agreements, which renew automatically upon receipt of each payment.
Rental payments are made each week in advance, generally in cash. RTO companies
retain ownership of rental merchandise during the term of the rental purchase
agreement. Ownership of the merchandise typically transfers to the customer if
the customer has continuously renewed the rental purchase agreement for a
specified period of time or exercises a specified early purchase option. On
average, however, customers satisfy the ownership requirements less than 25% of
the time for items rented for the first time. We typically rent a product four
to six times over a 24 month period, with the average time on rent to each
customer lasting approximately four months. Virtually all rental items are
ultimately rented to ownership in subsequent rental transactions. The RTO
transaction bears an important distinction to a traditional retail transaction:
RTO companies do not lend to customers or bear the associated credit risk
because customers make all payments in advance. As a result, balance sheets of
RTO companies have very few accounts receivable.
                                        5
<PAGE>   6
 
                               BUSINESS STRENGTHS
 
Over the past several years, we have experienced significant increases in sales
and operating income through acquisitions and internal growth. During this
period, we focused on achieving a position as a market-leading and profitable
operator of RTO locations. As a result, we believe that we benefit from the
following competitive advantages:
 
- - Industry Leader. We are the largest competitor in the RTO industry (based on
  store count) with market share of approximately 25%. We currently operate
  2,126 company-owned stores and franchise 307 stores (including the largest RTO
  franchisor, ColorTyme) in the United States and Puerto Rico. Our stores
  operate under various brand names including Renters Choice and Rent-A-Center,
  the most widely recognized name in the RTO industry. As the only nationwide
  RTO competitor, we benefit from:
 
     - greater visibility among consumers,
 
     - geographic diversity,
 
     - increased opportunities to expand into contiguous markets,
 
     - certain efficiencies in areas such as advertising, purchasing and human
       resources, and
 
     - the ability to leverage our corporate overhead over a larger store base.
 
- - Consistent Revenue and Strong Cash Flow. Our loyal customer base, as well as
  our resilience to economic cycles, enables us to generate stable revenue.
  Historically, we have not experienced a meaningful correlation between
  economic conditions (as measured by GDP growth) and same store revenue growth.
  Consistently stable revenue and strong margins (combined with low levels of
  maintenance capital expenditures) provide resources that can be used to fund
  our growth strategy.
 
- - Superior Customer Service. We believe that providing superior customer service
  is a key element for our long-term success. We achieve a high level of
  customer satisfaction by providing:
 
     - appealing store environments,
 
     - premium quality, durable merchandise,
 
     - personal customer service, and
 
     - experienced, well-trained store personnel.
 
  We believe our high level of customer satisfaction allows us to maximize the
  number and length of rental agreements per store, leading to customer
  referrals and repeat business.
 
- - Premium Quality Product Offerings. We distinguish ourselves from our
  competitors by purchasing, marketing, and renting premium name brand products
  from manufacturers such as Sony, JVC and Magnavox for home electronics;
  La-Z-Boy, Sealy and Ashley for home furnishings and accessories; and
  Whirlpool, General Electric and Kenmore for appliances. In addition to
  satisfying customer demand, premium products reduce service
                                        6
<PAGE>   7
 
  costs through increased reliability. We have developed strong relationships
  with our key vendors, enabling cost effective direct-to-store distribution.
 
- - Ability to Successfully Integrate Acquisitions. Since 1993, we have acquired
  2,090 stores, giving us extensive experience in the integration of diverse RTO
  operations. Our management information systems facilitate acquisition
  integration by providing our management team with operating and financial
  information about each store location and region and every rental purchase
  transaction. As a result of our ability to implement our business practices,
  operating performance of the integrated stores has improved significantly. For
  example, in 1997 store operating margins (before field administration and
  corporate overhead) for all of our stores was 23.9%, while our 325 mature
  stores (in our system for at least two years) generated store operating
  margins of 26.8%. Our mature stores primarily consist of acquired stores.
 
- - Experienced and Committed Management Team. Our senior management team has an
  average of 17 years of RTO experience. J. Ernest Talley, our Chairman and
  Chief Executive Officer, is generally credited with founding the RTO industry
  in the early 1960's. Our management team has a significant personal economic
  interest in our performance, as evidenced by the fact that:
 
     - the senior management group collectively owns approximately 26.2% of the
       common stock of the Company on a fully diluted basis, and
 
     - store, regional and senior manager compensation is tied directly to store
       revenue and/or operating profit and such bonuses account for up to 30% of
       all compensation.
 
  We believe that the de-centralized, entrepreneurial spirit of our field
  management, together with the guidance provided by senior management, will
  continue to be a key factor in our efforts to maximize revenue, improve
  margins and expand our store base.
                                        7
<PAGE>   8
 
                              RECENT DEVELOPMENTS
 
Rent-A-Center Acquisition. On August 5, 1998, we acquired Rent-A-Center pursuant
to an agreement with Thorn plc dated June 16, 1998, for approximately $900
million in cash (including the repayment of certain debt of Rent-A-Center),
subject to adjustment. Prior to this acquisition, Rent-A-Center was the largest
RTO competitor with 1,404 company-owned stores and 65 franchised stores in 49
states and the District of Columbia. Rent-A-Center operated stores under three
brand names, "Rent-A-Center," "Remco" and "U-Can-Rent." Rent-A-Center operated
1,158 stores under the Rent-A-Center brand, the most widely recognized store
name in the RTO industry.
 
We financed the acquisition of Rent-A-Center through certain financing
arrangements, consisting of a senior credit facility and a senior subordinated
facility. We also issued a total of $260 million in preferred stock to certain
affiliates of Apollo Management IV, L.P. ("Apollo") and to an affiliate of Bear,
Stearns & Co. Inc. to assist in the funding of the Rent-A-Center acquisition, to
repurchase $25 million of the Company's common stock and to repay our prior
credit facility. Following the acquisition of Rent-A-Center, we issued the Old
Notes to repay the senior subordinated facility. In connection with the
acquisition of Rent-A-Center, we assumed certain of Rent-A-Center's ongoing
litigation, including an adverse New Jersey state court judgment currently on
appeal. For additional information, please read the sections entitled "Risk
Factors -- Legal Proceedings" and "Business -- Legal Proceedings" located
elsewhere in this Prospectus. We are currently in the process of integrating the
stores acquired in the Rent-A-Center acquisition and we believe that we will
realize over $30 million in net annual cash cost savings upon completion of our
integration plan.
 
We are well underway in our assimilation of the Rent-A-Center stores. During the
first two months following the acquisition of Rent-A-Center, we have begun to
implement the initiatives of our integration plan. Specifically, we have reduced
the Wichita corporate staff from 560 to approximately 400 people and have
planned and organized the physical shutdown of the Wichita facility and the move
to Dallas of the Rent-A-Center corporate headquarters during the fourth quarter
of 1998. Additionally, we decided to convert the Rent-A-Center store management
information systems to our current system (High Touch) and will complete the
conversion of all of the Rent-A-Center stores during the fourth quarter of 1998.
We have also decided to eliminate the current Rent-A-Center product distribution
network and replace it with our system of drop shipments to our stores by our
vendors. We expect to close the Rent-A-Center warehouses during the fourth
quarter of 1998 and to utilize all remaining excess inventory in the normal
rental process in our stores during the first two quarters of 1999. We decided
to retain the Rent-A-Center product repair network and to utilize it to provide
product repair services to our customers in the Renters Choice stores, as well
as the Rent-A-Center stores. In September 1998, we purchased 41 Rent-A-Center
franchised stores and are currently converting them to Company owned and
operated stores. Finally, we decided to operate all of our stores under the
Rent-A-Center trade name and will have all Renters Choice, Remco and U-Can-Rent
stores converted to the Rent-A-Center trade name by the first quarter of 1999.
With the actions described above well underway, our original assumption of a
transition period of up to 12 months for integrating the Rent-A-Center stores is
progressing as planned and should be completed on schedule.
                                        8
<PAGE>   9
 
Central Rents Acquisition. In May 1998, we acquired substantially all of the
assets of Central Rents, Inc., for approximately $100 million. Central Rents
operated 176 stores located primarily in California, the Southwest, Midwest and
South. This acquisition expanded our presence in a region of the country, the
Southwest, which we strategically targeted for expansion. We expect to generate
an additional $2.6 million in annual general and administrative cost savings as
a result of this acquisition. These cost savings will be derived primarily from
the elimination of duplicative corporate and administrative functions. In
addition to these general and administrative cost reductions, we anticipate that
we will gradually bring the store operating performance of Central Rents in line
with our own store margins within 24-30 months.
 
We are well underway in our assimilation of the 176-store Central Rents chain.
During the first 30 days following this acquisition, we converted all of the
Central Rents stores to our management information system and began implementing
our human resource, purchasing and advertising programs, as well as other
processes that are essential in our system. Our immediate focus in these stores
is to improve operations and continue to build strength in store management
personnel.
                                        9
<PAGE>   10
 
                               BUSINESS STRATEGY
 
- - Integrate Rent-A-Center. We have developed a comprehensive program for the
  integration of the Rent-A-Center stores, which, as described above, is
  currently in process and which we expect to complete within 18-24 months. We
  believe we will realize over $30 million in net annual cash cost savings upon
  completion of the integration plan, primarily as a result of eliminating:
 
     - duplicative general and administrative expenses, and
 
     - Rent-A-Center's nationwide distribution network including seven
       distribution centers.
 
  Additional benefits and margin improvements are expected to be realized over
  time as we undertake initiatives to enhance the operations of the
  Rent-A-Center stores.
 
- - Continue to Enhance Store Operations. Our management endeavors to improve
  store performance through strategies intended to produce gains in operating
  efficiency and profitability. We believe we will achieve gains in revenues and
  operating margins in our stores by:
 
     - using focused advertising to increase store traffic,
 
     - expanding the offering of upscale, higher margin products (such as Sony
       wide screen televisions, La-Z-Boy recliners and JVC stereo systems) to
       increase the number of product rentals,
 
     - employing strict store-level cost control, and
 
     - closely monitoring each store's performance through the use of our
       management information system to ensure each store's adherence to
       established operating guidelines.
 
- - Pursue Strategic Expansion. Our management team has gained significant
  experience in the acquisition and integration of other RTO operators and
  believes the fragmented nature of the RTO industry will result in ongoing
  growth opportunities for us. Once our Rent-A-Center integration plan is
  substantially in place, we will again focus on strategic acquisition
  opportunities and new store development. We typically target underperforming
  and undercapitalized chains of RTO stores. These acquired stores benefit from
  our management expertise, administrative network, improved product mix,
  sophisticated management information system and purchasing power of the larger
  organization while strengthening their local market position. In addition, we
  have access to an expanding number of franchise locations, which we have the
  right of first refusal to purchase. We plan to continue opening new stores in
  our existing and new markets, and will focus our new market penetration in
  adjacent areas or regions which are underserved by the RTO industry. In
  evaluating a new market, we review demographic statistics, cost of advertising
  and the number and nature of competitors.
                                       10
<PAGE>   11
 
                               THE EXCHANGE OFFER
 
Exchange Notes...............   The forms and terms of the Exchange Notes are
                                identical in all material respects to the terms
                                of the Old Notes for which they may be exchanged
                                pursuant to the Exchange Offer, except for
                                certain transfer restrictions, registration
                                rights and liquidated damages provisions
                                relating to the Old Notes described elsewhere in
                                this Prospectus under "Description of the Notes
                                and Guarantees" and "Old Notes Exchange and
                                Registration Rights Agreement."
 
The Exchange Offer...........   We are offering to exchange up to $175,000,000
                                aggregate principal amount of the Exchange Notes
                                for up to $175,000,000 aggregate principal
                                amount of Old Notes. Old Notes may be exchanged
                                only in integral multiples of $1,000.
 
Expiration Date; Withdrawal
of Tender....................   Unless we extend the Exchange Offer, it will
                                expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on
                                [               ], 1998. We will not extend this
                                time period to a date later than
                                [               ], 1998. You may withdraw any
                                Old Notes you tender pursuant to the Exchange
                                Offer at any time prior to [               ],
                                1998. We will return, as promptly as practicable
                                after the expiration or termination of the
                                Exchange Offer, any Old Notes not accepted for
                                exchange for any reason without expense to you.
 
Certain Conditions to the
  Exchange Offer.............   The Exchange Offer is subject to customary
                                conditions, which may be waived by us.
 
Procedures for Tendering Old
  Notes......................   If you wish to accept the Exchange Offer, you
                                must complete, sign and date the Letter of
                                Transmittal in accordance with the instructions,
                                and deliver the Letter of Transmittal, along
                                with the Old Notes and any other required
                                documentation, to the Exchange Agent. By
                                executing the Letter of Transmittal, you will
                                represent to us that, among other things:
 
                                - any Exchange Notes you receive will be
                                  acquired in the ordinary course of your
                                  business,
 
                                - you have no arrangement with any person to
                                  participate in the distribution of the
                                  Exchange Notes, and
 
                                - you are not an "affiliate," as defined in Rule
                                  405 of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended,
                                  of the
                                       11
<PAGE>   12
 
                                Company or, if you are an affiliate, you will
                                comply with the registration and prospectus
                                delivery requirements of the Securities Act to
                                the extent applicable.
 
                                If you hold your Old Notes through the
                                Depository Trust Corporation ("DTC") and wish to
                                participate in the Exchange Offer, you may do so
                                through DTC's Automated Tender Offer Program
                                ("ATOP"). By participating in the Exchange
                                Offer, you will agree to be bound by the Letter
                                of Transmittal as though you had executed such
                                Letter of Transmittal.
 
Interest on the New Notes....   Interest on the Exchange Notes:
 
                                - accrues from the date of issuance at the rate
                                  of 11% per annum, and
 
                                - is payable semi-annually in arrears on each
                                  February 15 and August 15, commencing on
                                  February 15, 1999.
 
                                On February 15, 1999, holders of the Exchange
                                Notes will also receive an amount equal to the
                                accrued interest on the Old Notes. Interest on
                                the Old Notes accepted for exchange will stop
                                accruing upon the issuance the Exchange Notes.
 
Special Procedures for
  Beneficial Owners..........   If you are a beneficial owner whose Old Notes
                                are registered in the name of a broker, dealer,
                                commercial bank, trust company or other nominee
                                and wish to tender such Old Notes in the
                                Exchange Offer, please contact the registered
                                holder as soon as possible and instruct them to
                                tender on your behalf and comply with our
                                instructions set forth elsewhere in this
                                Prospectus.
 
Guaranteed Delivery
  Procedure..................   If you wish to tender your Old Notes, you may,
                                in certain instances, do so according to the
                                guaranteed delivery procedures set forth
                                elsewhere in this Prospectus under "The Exchange
                                Offer -- Guaranteed Delivery Procedures."
 
Registration Rights
  Agreement..................   We sold the Old Notes and the related Guarantees
                                to the Initial Purchasers in a transaction
                                exempt from the registration requirements of the
                                Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on August
                                18, 1998. At that time, the Company and the
                                Initial Purchasers entered into a Registration
                                Rights Agreement which grants the holders of the
                                Old Notes certain exchange and registration
                                       12
<PAGE>   13
 
                                rights. This Exchange Offer satisfies those
                                rights, which terminate upon consummation of the
                                Exchange Offer. You will not be entitled to any
                                exchange or registration rights with respect to
                                the Exchange Notes.
 
Certain Federal Tax
  Considerations.............   With respect to the exchange of the Old Notes
                                for the Exchange Notes:
 
                                - the exchange should not constitute a taxable
                                  exchange for U.S. federal income tax purposes,
 
                                - you should not recognize gain or loss upon
                                  receipt of the Exchange Notes,
 
                                - you must include interest in gross income to
                                  the same extent as the Old Notes, and
 
                                - you should be able to tack the holding period
                                  of the Exchange Notes to the holding period of
                                  the Old Notes.
 
Use of Proceeds..............   We will not receive any proceeds from the
                                exchange of Notes pursuant to the Exchange
                                Offer.
 
Exchange Agent...............   We have appointed IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust
                                Company as the Exchange Agent for the Exchange
                                Offer. The address and telephone number of the
                                Exchange Agent are IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust
                                Company, P. O. Box 84, Bowling Green Station,
                                New York, New York 10274-0084, telephone (212)
                                858-2103.
                                       13
<PAGE>   14
 
                       TERMS OF THE NOTES AND GUARANTEES
 
The form and terms of the Exchange Notes are substantially the same as the form
and terms of the Old Notes, except that the Exchange Notes are registered under
the Securities Act. As a result, the Exchange Notes will not bear legends
restricting their transfer and will not contain the registration rights and
liquidated damages provisions contained in the Old Notes.
 
Issuer.......................   Renters Choice, Inc.
 
Guarantors...................   Rent-A-Center, Inc. and ColorTyme, Inc.
 
Securities Offered...........   $175,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 11%
                                Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008.
 
Maturity.....................   August 15, 2008
 
Interest Payment Dates.......   February 15 and August 15 of each year,
                                commencing February 15, 1999.
 
Sinking Fund.................   None.
 
Optional Redemption..........   Except as described below and under "Change of
                                Control," we may not redeem the Notes prior to
                                August 15, 2003. After August 15, 2003, we may
                                redeem any amount of the Notes at any time at
                                the respective redemption prices, together with
                                accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date
                                of redemption. In addition, at any time prior to
                                August 15, 2001, we may redeem up to 33.33% of
                                the original aggregate principal amount of the
                                Notes with the cash proceeds of one or more
                                Equity Offerings (as defined) at a redemption
                                price equal to 111% of the principal amount to
                                be redeemed, together with accrued and unpaid
                                interest, if any, to the date of redemption, as
                                long as at least 66.67% of the original
                                aggregate principal amount of the Notes remain
                                outstanding after such redemption.
 
Change of Control............   Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control (as
                                defined), the holders of the Notes have the
                                right to require us to repurchase the Notes at a
                                price equal to 101% of the original aggregate
                                principal amount, together with accrued and
                                unpaid interest, if any, to the date of
                                repurchase.
 
Ranking......................   The Notes will be unsecured and will be
                                subordinated to all existing and future Senior
                                Indebtedness of the Company. The Notes will rank
                                without preference with all existing and future
                                Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of the Company
                                and will rank senior to all existing and future
                                Subordinated Obligations of the Company.
                                       14
<PAGE>   15
 
Guarantees...................   The guarantees are general unsecured obligations
                                of the Subsidiary Guarantors and are
                                subordinated in right of payment to all existing
                                and future Guarantor Senior Indebtedness.
 
Restrictive Covenants........   The Indenture under which the Exchange Notes
                                will be issued and the Old Notes were issued
                                limits:
 
                                - the incurrence of additional indebtedness by
                                  us and our subsidiaries,
 
                                - the payment of dividends on, and redemption
                                  of, our capital stock and our subsidiaries'
                                  capital stock and the redemption of our and
                                  our subsidiaries' subordinated obligations,
 
                                - investments,
 
                                - sales of assets and subsidiary stock,
 
                                - transactions with affiliates,
 
                                - sale and leaseback transactions, and
 
                                - liens.
 
                                In addition, the Indenture limits our ability to
                                engage in consolidations, mergers and transfers
                                of substantially all of our assets and also
                                contains certain restrictions on distributions
                                from our subsidiaries. All of these limitations
                                and prohibitions are subject to a number of
                                important qualifications and exceptions.
 
Absence of a Public Market
for the Exchange Notes.......   In general, you may freely transfer the Exchange
                                Notes. However, there are exceptions to this
                                general statement. Further, the Exchange Notes
                                will be new securities for which there will not
                                initially be a market. As a result, the
                                development or liquidity of any market for the
                                Exchange Notes may not occur. The Initial
                                Purchasers have advised us that they currently
                                intend to make a market in the Exchange Notes.
                                However, you should be aware that the Initial
                                Purchasers are not obligated to do so. In the
                                event such a market may develop, the Initial
                                Purchasers may discontinue it at any time
                                without notice. We do not intend to apply for a
                                listing of the Exchange Notes on any securities
                                exchange or on any automated dealer quotation
                                system.
                                       15
<PAGE>   16
 
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
You should consider carefully the information set forth under the caption "Risk
Factors" beginning on page 25 and all the other information set forth in this
Prospectus before deciding whether to participate in the Exchange Offer.
                                       16
<PAGE>   17
 
                           SUMMARY UNAUDITED COMBINED
                            PRO FORMA FINANCIAL DATA
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
Our unaudited pro forma combined financial information presented here gives
effect to the acquisition of Rent-A-Center and the offering of the Old Notes as
if such transactions were consummated on June 30, 1998, in the case of the
Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Balance Sheet, and as if such transactions and the
acquisition of Central Rents were consummated on January 1, 1997, in the case of
Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Statements of Operations for the year ended
December 31, 1997 and the six months ended June 30, 1998. The Unaudited Pro
Forma Combined Statement of Operations for the year ended December 31, 1997
includes the historical information of Rent-A-Center for the year ended March
31, 1998, which was its fiscal year end. The acquisition of Rent-A-Center was
completed on August 5, 1998, and the acquisition of Central Rents was completed
on May 28, 1998. These transactions and the related adjustments are described in
the accompanying notes. In our opinion, all adjustments have been made that are
necessary to present fairly the pro forma data.
 
The following unaudited pro forma combined financial information is presented
for illustrative purposes only, does not purport to be indicative of our
financial position or results of operations as of the date of this Prospectus,
or as of or for any other future date, and is not necessarily indicative of what
our actual financial position or results of operations would have been had the
foregoing transactions been consummated on such dates. In addition, it does not
give effect to (i) any transactions other than the foregoing transactions and
those described in the accompanying Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Combined
Financial Information, or (ii) the Company's, Rent-A-Center's or Central Rents'
results of operations since June 30, 1998. Although the following unaudited pro
forma combined financial information gives effect to expected annual net savings
from the elimination of duplicate general and administrative and field expenses
as a result of the aforementioned acquisitions, it does not give effect to
additional annual net savings expected to be achieved following consummation of
these acquisitions (described in Note (3) to the Unaudited Pro Forma Combined
Statement of Operations for the year ended December 31, 1997). Actual amounts
could differ from those presented.
 
The following unaudited pro forma combined financial information is based upon
the historical financial statements of the Company, Rent-A-Center, and Central
Rents, and should be read in conjunction with such historical financial
statements, the related notes, and the Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Combined
Financial Information. In the preparation of the unaudited pro forma combined
financial information, we have generally assumed that the historical value of
Rent-A-Center's assets and liabilities approximates the fair value thereof,
except as described in the Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial
Information, since an independent valuation has not been completed. We will be
required to determine the fair value of Rent-A-Center's assets and liabilities
as of August 5, 1998. Although such determination of fair value is not presently
expected to result in values that are materially greater or less than the values
assumed in the preparation of the following unaudited pro forma combined
financial information, there can be no assurance to that effect.
                                       17
<PAGE>   18
 
          SUMMARY UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENTS OF OPERATION
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 COMBINED PRO FORMA
                                                              -------------------------
                                                                             SIX MONTHS
                                                               YEAR ENDED      ENDED
                                                              DECEMBER 31,    JUNE 30,
                                                                  1997          1998
                                                              ------------   ----------
                                                               (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS,
                                                               EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                                           <C>            <C>
STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS DATA:
Revenue.....................................................   $1,314,712    $  686,022
Operating expenses
  Direct store expenses
    Depreciation of rental merchandise......................      328,000       168,911
    Other(1)................................................      715,457       372,452
                                                               ----------    ----------
                                                                1,043,457       541,363
  Franchise cost of merchandise sold........................       35,841        16,386
  General and administrative expenses.......................       52,512        30,401
  Nonrecurring charges(2)...................................        6,600         5,600
  Amortization of intangibles(3)............................       24,174        12,445
                                                               ----------    ----------
        Total operating expenses............................    1,162,584       606,195
                                                               ----------    ----------
        Operating profit....................................      152,128        79,827
Interest expense............................................       85,821        42,876
Interest income.............................................         (392)         (238)
                                                               ----------    ----------
        Earnings before income taxes........................       66,699        37,189
Income tax expense..........................................       33,191        18,132
                                                               ----------    ----------
        Net earnings........................................       33,508        19,057
Preferred dividends.........................................        9,888         4,898
                                                               ----------    ----------
        Earnings allocable to common stockholders...........   $   23,620    $   14,159
                                                               ==========    ==========
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
Basic earnings per share(4).................................   $      .99    $      .59
                                                               ==========    ==========
Diluted earnings per share(4)...............................   $      .98    $      .57
                                                               ==========    ==========
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges(5).......................          1.6x          1.7x
                                                               ==========    ==========
BALANCE SHEET DATA (END OF PERIOD):
Cash and cash equivalents...................................                 $   50,918
Rental merchandise, net.....................................                    452,114
Total assets................................................                  1,433,355
Total debt..................................................                    895,735
Redeemable convertible preferred stock(6)...................                    260,000
Total stockholders' equity..................................                    145,343
OPERATING DATA:
Number of stores (end of period)............................        2,065         2,087
Revenue data:
  Store
    Rentals and fees........................................   $1,204,971    $  628,770
    Merchandise sales.......................................       65,289        36,505
    Other...................................................          793           281
  Franchise
    Merchandise sales.......................................       37,385        17,061
    Royalty income and fees.................................        6,274         3,405
                                                               ----------    ----------
        Total revenue.......................................   $1,314,712    $  686,022
                                                               ==========    ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                       18
<PAGE>   19
 
- -------------------------
 
(1) Represents cost of merchandise sold and salaries and other expenses.
 
(2) Represents (i) approximately $12.3 million of restructuring charges relating
    to certain of Rent-A-Center's discontinued Non-RTO Business such as credit
    retailing and check cashing, the closing of certain non-performing RTO
    stores, and the reorganization of certain administrative support functions
    and (ii) approximately $2.1 million related primarily to Rent-A-Center's
    writedown of cellular phone inventory.
 
(3) This amount is subject to adjustment for the final resolution of certain
    litigation, including Robinson v. Thorn Americas, Inc. which is currently on
    appeal in New Jersey. In the event we are unsuccessful on the appeal,
    intangibles will be increased for any damages required to be paid.
 
(4) Weighted average common shares outstanding for both basic and diluted
    earnings per share were decreased by 990,099 to give pro forma effect of the
    repurchase of $25 million of our common stock at $25.25 per share from our
    Chief Executive Officer. The assumed conversion of the redeemable
    convertible preferred stock would have had an anti-dilutive effect on
    diluted earnings per share for the year ended December 31, 1997, and
    therefore has been excluded from the computation thereof. For the six months
    ended June 30, 1998, the conversion of the redeemable convertible preferred
    stock is dilutive; therefore, the weighted average common shares outstanding
    for diluted earnings per share were increased by 9,350,957 to reflect the
    conversion of the redeemable preferred stock to our common stock at a
    conversion price of $27.935 per share, and preferred dividends of $4,898
    were added to earnings allocable to common stockholders when computing
    diluted earnings per share.
 
(5) In calculating the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings consist of
    income before income taxes plus fixed charges (excluding capitalized
    interest). Fixed charges consist of interest expense (which includes
    amortization of deferred financing costs) whether expensed or capitalized
    and one-fourth of rental expense, deemed representative of that portion of
    rental expense estimated to be attributable to interest.
 
(6) Represents the total of the Apollo and Bear Stearns redeemable convertible
    preferred stock investments.
                                       19
<PAGE>   20
 
                              RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
 
                       SUMMARY HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA
 
Our summary historical financial data as of and for each of the five years in
the period ended December 31, 1997, have been derived from our consolidated
financial statements which have been audited and reported upon by Grant Thornton
LLP. Our summary historical financial data as of and for the six months ended
June 30, 1997 and 1998 have been derived from our unaudited consolidated
financial statements which were prepared on the same basis as our audited
financial statements and include, in the opinion of our management, all
adjustments necessary to present fairly the information presented for such
interim periods. Please read this information in conjunction with our audited
consolidated financial statements and notes thereto included herein,
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations," and other financial information included elsewhere in this
Prospectus. Because of our significant growth from acquisitions, the historical
results of operations, the period-to-period comparisons of such results and
certain financial data may not be comparable, meaningful or indicative of future
results.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                             YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,                     JUNE 30,
                                --------------------------------------------------   -------------------
                                1993(1)   1994(1)     1995       1996       1997       1997       1998
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                                         (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                             <C>       <C>       <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
STATEMENTS OF EARNINGS DATA:
Total revenue.................  $53,212   $74,385   $133,289   $237,965   $331,541   $155,389   $193,546
Direct store expenses
  Depreciation of rental
    merchandise...............   11,626    15,614     29,640     42,978     57,223     27,510     33,839
  Other store expenses........   29,576    40,701     74,966    124,934    173,823     82,751    103,588
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                 41,202    56,315    104,606    167,912    231,046    110,261    137,427
Franchise operating
  expense(2)..................       --        --         --     24,010     35,841     14,726     16,386
General and administrative
  expenses....................    2,151     2,809      5,766     10,111     13,304      6,773      7,194
Amortization of intangibles...    5,304     6,022      3,109      4,891      5,412      2,649      3,271
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
        Total operating
          expenses............   48,657    65,146    113,481    206,924    285,603    134,409    164,278
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
        Operating profit......    4,555     9,239     19,808     31,041     45,938     20,980     29,268
Interest expense..............    1,817     2,160      2,202        606      2,194      1,021      1,555
Interest income...............       --        --       (890)      (667)      (304)      (432)      (238)
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
        Earnings before income
          taxes...............    2,738     7,079     18,496     31,102     44,048     20,391     27,951
Income tax expense............      937     1,600      7,784     13,076     18,170      8,622     11,566
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
        Net earnings..........  $ 1,801   $ 5,479   $ 10,712   $ 18,026   $ 25,878   $ 11,769   $ 16,385
                                =======   =======   ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
Basic earnings per share......                      $    .52   $    .73   $   1.04   $    .47   $    .66
                                                    ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
Diluted earnings per share....                      $    .52   $    .72   $   1.03   $    .47   $    .65
                                                    ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
</TABLE>
 
                                       20
<PAGE>   21
 
                              RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
                     SUMMARY HISTORICAL DATA -- (CONTINUED)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                             YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,                     JUNE 30,
                                --------------------------------------------------   -------------------
                                1993(1)   1994(1)     1995       1996       1997       1997       1998
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                                         (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                             <C>       <C>       <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
Depreciation and
  amortization(3).............  $ 6,164   $ 7,207   $  5,239   $  8,571   $ 11,013   $  5,158   $  6,547
Capital expenditures(4).......    1,489     1,715      3,473      8,187     10,446      4,755      5,758
Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges(5)..................      2.1x      3.2x       5.1x       7.9x       6.7x       6.6x       6.7x
BALANCE SHEET DATA (END OF
  PERIOD):
Cash and cash equivalents.....  $ 1,359   $ 1,441   $ 35,321   $  5,920   $  4,744   $  6,446   $ 23,347
Rental merchandise, net.......   20,672    28,096     64,240     95,110    112,759    110,260    148,432
        Total assets..........   34,813    36,959    147,294    174,467    208,868    205,330    335,838
Total debt....................   27,592    23,383     40,850     18,993     27,172     39,086    128,235
Total stockholders' equity....    4,168     9,286     96,484    125,503    152,753    137,676    170,343
OPERATING DATA:
Number of stores (end of
  period).....................      112       114        325        423        504        503        717
Average annual revenue per
  store(6)....................  $   591   $   653   $    626   $    608   $    610   $    604   $    653
Comparable store revenue
  growth(7)...................     11.1%     10.8%      18.1%       3.8%       8.1%       8.9%       9.3%
REVENUES:
  Store revenue
    Rentals and fees..........  $51,162   $70,590   $126,264   $198,486   $275,344   $130,150   $163,443
    Merchandise sales.........    1,678     3,470      6,383     10,604     14,125      7,457     10,513
    Other.....................      372       325        642        687        679        339         28
Franchise revenue
  Merchandise sales...........       --        --         --     25,229     37,385     15,461     17,061
  Royalty income and fees.....       --        --         --      2,959      4,008      1,982      2,248
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
        Total revenue.........  $53,212   $74,385   $133,289   $237,965   $331,541   $155,389   $193,546
                                =======   =======   ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
</TABLE>
 
                                       21
<PAGE>   22
 
            NOTES TO SUMMARY FINANCIAL DATA OF RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
 
(1) In each of the periods presented ending prior to January 1, 1995, we
    operated as an S corporation under Subchapter S of the Internal Revenue Code
    and comparable provisions of certain state tax laws. Accordingly, prior to
    January 1, 1995, we were not subject to federal income taxation. Earnings
    per share are not provided for periods prior to January 1, 1995, because
    operating results for those periods are not comparable.
 
(2) Prior to our acquisition of ColorTyme in May 1996, we conducted no franchise
    operations. Therefore, we presented franchise operation financial
    information for periods beginning with the year ended December 31, 1996.
 
(3) This amount excludes depreciation of rental merchandise.
 
(4) We exclude purchase of rental merchandise.
 
(5) In calculating the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings consist of
    income before income taxes plus fixed charges (excluding capitalized
    interest). Fixed charges consist of interest expense (which includes
    amortization of deferred financing costs) whether expensed or capitalized
    and one-fourth of rental expense, which we deem representative of that
    portion of rental expense estimated to be attributable to interest.
 
(6) We annualized the revenues for the six months ended June 30, 1997 and 1998.
 
(7) Comparable store revenue growth for each period presented includes revenues
    only of stores open throughout the full period and the comparable prior
    period.
                                       22
<PAGE>   23
 
                              RENT-A-CENTER, INC.
 
                       SUMMARY HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA
 
The summary historical financial data for Rent-A-Center as of and for each of
the three years in the period ended March 31, 1998, have been derived from
Rent-A-Center's audited consolidated financial statements. The summary
historical financial data for Rent-A-Center as of and for the three months ended
June 30, 1997 and 1998 have been derived from Rent-A-Center's unaudited
consolidated financial statements which were prepared on the same basis as
Rent-A-Center's audited financial statements and include, in the opinion of
Rent-A-Center's management, all adjustments necessary to present fairly the
information presented for such interim periods. Please read this information in
conjunction with the consolidated financial statements of Rent-A-Center and
notes thereto included herein, "Management's Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Conditions and Results of Operations of Rent-A-Center," and the other
financial information included elsewhere in this Prospectus.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                         YEARS ENDED MARCH 31,                  JUNE 30,
                                  ------------------------------------   -----------------------
                                     1996         1997         1998         1997         1998
                                  ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
                                                      (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                               <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>
STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
  DATA:(1)
 
Total revenue...................  $  897,927   $  926,871   $  904,004   $  225,641   $  235,421
 
Cost of sales...................      43,345       39,793       45,574        8,524       12,503
 
Depreciation and amortization
 
  Rental merchandise............     257,383      260,433      244,572       62,852       62,886
 
  Other.........................      52,236       59,085       56,869       14,598       14,532
 
Salaries, wages and fringe
  benefits......................     255,768      272,242      279,796       68,488       72,960
 
Other operating expenses........     202,577      233,015      207,460       50,654       52,653
 
Nonrecurring charges(2).........      12,600           --       14,392           --           --
                                  ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
 
         Total operating
           expenses.............     823,909      864,568      848,663      205,116      215,534
                                  ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
 
         Operating profit.......      74,018       62,303       55,341       20,525       19,887
 
Interest expense, net...........      80,207       52,651       46,184       10,825       11,191
 
Other (income) expense..........         101         (254)         (88)         (81)          72
                                  ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
         Earnings (loss) before
           income taxes.........      (6,290)       9,906        9,245        9,781        8,624
 
Income tax expense..............       6,771       13,880        7,760        5,950        5,344
                                  ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
 
         Net earnings (loss)....  $  (13,061)  $   (3,974)  $    1,485   $    3,831   $    3,280
                                  ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========
 
RTO FINANCIAL DATA:(3)
 
Depreciation and
  amortization(4)...............  $   52,236   $   59,085   $   56,869   $   14,598   $   14,532
 
Capital expenditures(5).........      44,642       32,306       38,077        6,574       16,887
 
BALANCE SHEET DATA (END OF
  PERIOD):
 
Cash and cash equivalents.......  $   19,225   $   26,077   $   23,755   $   37,399   $   27,486
 
Rental merchandise, net.........     304,164      276,012      292,965      268,564      303,682
 
         Total assets...........   1,242,211    1,108,280    1,079,109    1,086,784    1,085,796
 
         Total debt.............   1,042,729      714,235      714,223      714,827      714,663
 
         Total stockholder's
           equity...............      88,529      239,026      236,483      242,857      239,763
 
RTO OPERATING DATA:
 
Number of stores (end of
  period).......................       1,306        1,367        1,384        1,392        1,404
 
Average annual revenue per
  store(6)......................  $      744   $      694   $      639   $      652   $      674
Revenues:
 
  Store revenue
 
    Rentals and fees............  $  827,935   $  864,256   $  831,025   $  212,448   $  219,720
 
    Merchandise sales...........      64,628       60,249       46,337       12,611       15,141
 
  Franchise royalty income......       5,364        2,366        2,266          582          560
                                  ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
 
         Total RTO revenue......  $  897,927   $  926,871   $  879,628   $  225,641   $  235,421
                                  ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                       23
<PAGE>   24
 
          NOTES TO SUMMARY HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA OF RENT-A-CENTER
 
(1) As part of the acquisition of Rent-A-Center, we acquired several Non-RTO
    Businesses including used automobile retailing, credit retailing and check
    cashing businesses which began generating revenues in fiscal 1998. We sold
    AdvantEDGE Auto, Inc. in August 1998 for $4.0 million and intend to
    discontinue the operations of the remaining Non-RTO Businesses. For the
    fiscal year ended 1998, the Non-RTO Businesses generated revenue of $20.2
    million and a net loss before income taxes of $5.2 million.
 
(2) Nonrecurring charges in 1996 relate to the consolidation of corporate and
    field offices and reductions in the number of employees. In 1998,
    nonrecurring charges represents (i) approximately $12.3 million in charges
    related to discontinued Non-RTO Businesses, closure of certain nonperforming
    RTO stores and reorganized administrative support functions, and (ii)
    approximately $2.1 million related primarily to Rent-A-Center's writedown of
    cellular phone inventory.
 
(3) We combined the RTO Financial Data from the historical financial results of
    Rent-A-Center with appropriate adjustments to eliminate the effect of
    Non-RTO Businesses.
 
(4) We excluded depreciation of rental merchandise.
 
(5) We excluded purchases of rental merchandise.
 
(6) Our revenues for the three months ended June 30, 1997 and 1998 have been
    annualized.
                                       24
<PAGE>   25
 
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
You should carefully consider the information below in addition to everything
else we have told you in this Prospectus in evaluating whether or not you should
participate in the Exchange Offer.
 
RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH THE ACQUISITION OF RENT-A-CENTER
 
Expected Benefits of Combined Business May Not Be Achieved. We believe the
combination of Renters Choice and Rent-A-Center will be of significant benefit
to Renters Choice and its stockholders. However, you should be aware that these
benefits may not be realized if combining Renters Choice's business and
Rent-A-Center's business cannot be accomplished in an efficient and effective
manner. This combination will require, among other things, the integration of
management philosophies and personnel, arrangements with third party vendors,
standardization of training programs, realization of operating efficiencies, and
effective coordination of sales and marketing and financial reporting efforts.
Additionally, you should be aware that acquisitions in general are subject to a
number of special risks, including adverse short-term effects on our reported
operating results, diversion of management's attention, and unanticipated
problems or legal liabilities. Although we have a history of successful
acquisitions, we cannot assure you that this acquisition and the integration of
Rent-A-Center's operations into Renters Choice's will be successful or
accomplished efficiently. You should be aware that if we fail to integrate
Rent-A-Center's operations successfully with Renters Choice's, the Company could
be affected, both materially and adversely. You should also carefully consider
the information we have set forth in the "Business" section later in this
Prospectus.
 
Increased Size of Company. Although we have successfully acquired many
businesses since our initial public offering, we have never been this large of a
company. Our operations more than doubled with the purchase of Rent-A-Center.
Our future operations depend largely upon our ability to manage this sizeable
and growing business profitably. We believe, with the implementation of our
management philosophy, that we can accomplish this task. However, we cannot
guarantee to you that we will. If we fail to manage the size and the growth of
our business, a material adverse effect could result.
 
SIGNIFICANT LEVERAGE; ABILITY TO SERVICE INDEBTEDNESS
 
Because of the acquisition of Rent-A-Center, we have a significant amount of
debt outstanding. You should be aware that this significant amount of debt could
have important consequences to you as a holder of the Notes. Below we have
identified for you many, but not all, of the consequences resulting from this
significant amount of debt that we now owe.
 
- - We may be unable to obtain additional financing for working capital, capital
  expenditures, acquisitions and general corporate purposes.
 
- - A significant portion of our cash flow from operations must be dedicated to
  the repayment of the indebtedness, thereby reducing the amount of cash we have
  available for other purposes.
 
- - We may be disadvantaged as compared to our competitors as a result of the
  significant amount of debt we now owe.
 
                                       25
<PAGE>   26
 
- - Our ability to adjust to changing market conditions and our ability to
  withstand competition may be hampered by the amount of debt we now owe. It may
  also make us more vulnerable in a downturned market.
 
You should be aware that our ability to repay or refinance our current debt
depends on our successful financial and operating performance. Our ability to
meet our payment obligations may depend on our ability to successfully implement
our business strategy. Unfortunately, we cannot assure you that we will be
successful in implementing our strategy or in realizing our anticipated
financial results. You should also be aware that our financial and operational
performance depends upon a number of factors, many of which are beyond our
control. These factors include:
 
- - the current economic and competitive conditions in the RTO industry,
 
- - any operating difficulties, operating costs or pricing pressures we may
  experience,
 
- - the passage of legislation or other regulatory developments that affects us
  adversely, and
 
- - any delays in implementing any strategic projects we may have.
 
In the event that we are unable to repay our current debt, we may be forced to
reduce or delay expansion, sell some of our assets, obtain additional equity
capital or refinance or restructure our debt. We cannot assure you that our cash
flow and capital resources will be sufficient to repay any indebtedness we may
incur in the future, or that we will be successful in obtaining alternative
financing. You should also read the information we have included under the
captions "Description of Other Indebtedness," "Description of the Notes and
Guarantees," and "Business -- Business Strategy" later in this Prospectus.
 
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
 
The RTO industry is the subject of class action litigation involving claims that
RTO contracts are in fact disguised installment sales contracts or involve
undisclosed excessive interest charges. We are involved in such litigation in
five states: New Jersey, Pennsylvania (with respect to RTO contracts entered
into prior to Pennsylvania's enactment of an RTO statute), Wisconsin, New York
and Minnesota.
 
We are involved in three class actions in New Jersey, one of which (Robinson v.
Thorn Americas, Inc.) was originally filed against Rent-A-Center. In Robinson v.
Thorn Americas, Inc., a New Jersey state court entered a judgment against
Rent-A-Center and ordered Rent-A-Center to pay the class of plaintiffs an amount
in excess of $140 million which will increase until this litigation is resolved.
Rent-A-Center posted a $163 million supersedeas bond, which amount was derived
from an accounting by the plaintiffs of the projected amount of judgment
liability as of April 1999. Rent-A-Center is appealing the Robinson decision.
The other two other class actions in New Jersey are entitled Gallagher v. Crown
Leasing Corporation and Handy Boykin v. Renters Choice, Inc. In these cases, the
plaintiffs allege we (or, in the Gallagher case, Renters Choice as the successor
to Crown) violated the New Jersey Consumer Fraud Act and the New Jersey Retail
Installment Sales Act. The claims arising from the Boykin and Gallagher cases
are similar to the claims made against our subsidiary Rent-A-Center in Robinson
v. Thorn Americas, Inc. Claims have also been made that Rent-A-Center violated
RTO statutes in certain
 
                                       26
<PAGE>   27
 
other states. We intend to vigorously defend ourselves in all pending or
asserted actions against us. You should read the sections entitled
"-- Government Regulation," "Business -- Government Regulation" and
"Business -- Legal Proceedings" located later in this Prospectus for additional
information.
 
A class action entitled Fogie v. Thorn Americas, Inc. has been filed in
Minnesota alleging Rent-A-Center's RTO contracts violated Minnesota's Consumer
Credit Sales Act and the Minnesota General Usury Statute. Furthermore, a class
action entitled Colon v. Thorn Americas, Inc. has been filed in New York State
court, alleging that Rent-A-Center has a duty to disclose "effective interest"
under New York consumer protection laws and seek damages for Rent-A-Center's
failure to do so. An adverse ruling in any of these cases could have a material
adverse effect on the Company. You should read the sections entitled
"-- Government Regulation," "Business -- Government Regulation" and
"Business -- Legal Proceedings" located later in this Prospectus for additional
information.
 
Rent-A-Center was also named in a class action in Wisconsin entitled Burney v.
Thorn Americas, Inc. In Burney v. Thorn Americas, Inc., a plaintiff filed a
class action in Wisconsin state court alleging Rent-A-Center violated the
Wisconsin Consumer Act. This matter was settled in principle for approximately
$16.25 million. A claim was also filed against Rent-A-Center alleging
discrimination against its African-American employees. This matter was settled
in principle for approximately $6.75 million.
 
GOVERNMENT REGULATION
 
As is the case with most businesses, we are subject to certain governmental
regulations, specifically with respect to RTO transactions. There are currently
45 states that have passed laws regulating rental purchase transactions and
another state that has a retail installment sales statute that excludes RTO
transactions from its coverage if certain criteria are met. These laws generally
require certain contractual and advertising disclosures. They also provide
varying levels of substantive consumer protection, such as requiring a grace
period for late fees and contract reinstatement rights in the event the rental
purchase agreement is terminated. The rental purchase laws of nine states limit
the total amount of rentals that may be charged over the life of a rental
purchase agreement. Certain states also effectively regulate rental purchase
transactions under other consumer protection statutes. You should also be aware
that we are currently subject to outstanding judgments and other litigation
alleging that we, or our subsidiaries, have violated some of these statutory
provisions. You should also read the information under the captions "-- Legal
Proceedings" above and "Business -- Legal Proceedings" later in this Prospectus
for a more complete discussion of these matters.
 
Although there is no comprehensive federal legislation regulating
rental-purchase transactions, we cannot assure you that such legislation will
not be enacted in the future. From time to time, legislation has been introduced
in Congress seeking to regulate our business. In the event that legislation
having a negative impact on our business is adopted, you should be aware that it
could have a material adverse impact on us. In addition, we cannot assure you
that the various legislators in the states where we currently do business will
not adopt new legislation or amend existing legislation that negatively affects
us. You should also read the section entitled "Business -- Government
Regulation" appearing later in this Prospectus for additional discussions
related to this matter.
 
                                       27
<PAGE>   28
 
DEPENDENCE UPON KEY PERSONNEL
 
As a holder of the Notes, you have no right to participate in the Company's
management. The Company's continued success is highly dependent upon the
personal efforts and abilities of our senior management, including J. Ernest
Talley, our Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, Mark E. Speese,
our President and Chief Operating Officer, and L. Dowell Arnette, our Executive
Vice President. We do not have employment contracts with any of these officers
and the loss of any one of them could impact the Company in a negative way.
Please also read the "Management" section later in this Prospectus for
additional information.
 
CONTROL BY PRINCIPAL STOCKHOLDERS
 
You should be aware that a total of approximately 42.0% of the Company's voting
stock on a fully diluted basis is controlled by Messrs. Talley, Speese and by
Apollo. As a result, in the event they act together, they have the ability to
exercise practical control over the outcome of actions requiring the approval of
our stockholders, including potential acquisitions, elections of the Company's
Board of Directors and sales or changes in control of the Company. You should
read the section entitled "Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and
Management" later in this Prospectus for additional information.
 
RELIANCE ON INFORMATION SYSTEMS
 
As is common with large organizations, we rely extensively on our information
systems to manage our operations. As a result, we regularly invest in various
upgrades to our systems in order to achieve optimum performance compared to the
costs involved. We are currently implementing our information systems in the
stores we acquired in the Rent-A-Center acquisition and expect this process to
be completed by early December 1998. However, you should be aware that any
difficulties or delays that we may experience in implementing our system in the
acquired stores, or any other disruption with respect to our information
systems, could negatively impact our financial and operating results. Please
read the sections entitled "-- Year 2000" next and "Business -- Management
Information Systems" later in this Prospectus for additional information.
 
YEAR 2000
 
Year 2000 issues exist when dates are recorded in computers using two digits
(rather than four) and are then used for arithmetic operations, comparisons or
sorting. A two-digit recording may recognize a date using "00" as 1900 rather
than 2000, which could cause our computer systems to perform inaccurate
computations. We have received confirmation from our management information
systems vendors that our system is Year 2000 compliant. You should be aware that
Year 2000 issues relate not only to our systems, but also to those used by our
suppliers. We anticipate that system replacements and modifications will resolve
any Year 2000 issues that may exist with our suppliers or their suppliers.
However, we cannot guarantee to you that such replacements or modifications will
be completed successfully or on time and, as a result, any failure to complete
such modifications on time could materially affect our financial and operating
results in a negative way. Please read the section entitled
"Business -- Management Information Systems" later in this Prospectus for
additional information.
 
                                       28
<PAGE>   29
 
RESTRICTIVE DEBT COVENANTS
 
The Indenture and our Senior Credit Facilities (as defined below) impose
significant operating and financial restrictions on us and our subsidiaries.
These restrictions may significantly limit or prohibit us from engaging in
certain transactions, including the following:
 
     - borrowing additional money,
 
     - paying dividends or other distributions to our stockholders,
 
     - making certain investments,
 
     - creating certain liens on our assets,
 
     - selling certain assets currently held by us,
 
     - entering into transactions with any of our affiliates, and
 
     - engaging in certain mergers or consolidations involving the Company.
 
The senior credit facilities we entered into in financing the Rent-A-Center
acquisition (the "Senior Credit Facilities") impose significant restrictive
covenants and require the Company and certain of its subsidiaries to maintain
specified financial ratios and satisfy certain financial tests. Our ability to
meet these financial ratios and tests may be affected by events beyond our
control and, as a result, we cannot guarantee to you that we will be able to
meet such tests. In addition, the restrictions contained in the Senior Credit
Facilities could limit our ability to obtain future financing, make needed
capital expenditures, withstand a future downturn in our business or in the
economy or otherwise conduct necessary corporate activities. Our failure to
comply with the restrictions in the Indenture and the Senior Credit Facilities
could lead to a default under the terms of those documents. In the event of such
a default, the applicable lender could declare all amounts borrowed and all
amounts due under other instruments that contain certain provisions for
cross-acceleration or cross-default due and payable, including all interest that
is accrued and unpaid. In addition, the lenders under such agreements could
terminate their commitments to lend to us. If that does occur, we cannot assure
you that we would be able to make the necessary payments to the lenders and we
cannot give you any assurance that we would be able to find additional
alternative financing. Even if we could obtain additional alternative financing,
we cannot assure you that it would be on terms that are favorable or acceptable
to the Company.
 
You should also be aware that the existing indebtedness under the Senior Credit
Facilities is secured by substantially all of our and our subsidiaries' assets.
Should a default or acceleration of such indebtedness occur, the holders of such
indebtedness could seize these assets securing the indebtedness and sell the
assets to satisfy all or a part of what is owed. The Senior Credit Facilities
also contain provisions prohibiting the modification of the Exchange Notes
(subject to certain exceptions favorable to the lenders under the Senior Credit
Facilities) and that limit our ability to refinance the Exchange Notes without
the consent of such lenders. Please refer to the sections in this Prospectus
entitled "Description of the Notes and Guarantees -- Certain Covenants," and
"Description of Other Indebtedness" later in this Prospectus for additional
information.
 
                                       29
<PAGE>   30
 
COMPETITION
 
We operate in a highly competitive industry. Competition is based primarily on
store location, product selection and availability, customer service and rental
rates and terms. Several of our competitors operate on a regional basis and some
may, in the future, have significantly greater financial and operating resources
and name recognition than us. We also face competition from sources outside the
RTO industry, such as department stores, discount stores and rental stores
offering short-term rent-to-rent arrangements. Because barriers to entry in the
RTO industry are relatively low, additional competition may arise from new
sources. As a result of these competitive conditions, we may not be able to
sustain past levels of revenue or continue our recent revenue growth or
profitability. Please refer to the section entitled "Business -- Competition"
later in this Prospectus for additional information.
 
FRAUDULENT TRANSFER CONSIDERATIONS
 
The incurrence of indebtedness by the Company, such as the Notes (and the
related incurrence by the Subsidiary Guarantors of the Subsidiary Guarantees),
may be subject to review under federal bankruptcy law or relevant state
fraudulent conveyance or transfer laws if a bankruptcy case or lawsuit is
commenced by or on behalf of unpaid creditors of the Company or a Subsidiary
Guarantor. Under these laws, if, in such a case, a court were to find that, at
the time the Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor incurred indebtedness
(including indebtedness under the Notes and the Subsidiary Guarantees) (i) the
Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor incurred such indebtedness with the intent
of hindering, delaying or defrauding current or future creditors, or (ii)(a) the
Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor received less than reasonably equivalent
value or fair consideration for incurring such indebtedness, and (b) the Company
or such Subsidiary Guarantor (1) was insolvent or was rendered insolvent by
reason of any of the transactions, (2) was engaged, or about to engage, in a
business or transaction for which its assets constituted unreasonably small
capital, (3) intended to incur, or believed that it would incur, debts beyond
its ability to pay as such debts matured (as all of the foregoing terms are
defined in or interpreted under the relevant fraudulent transfer or conveyance
statutes), or (4) was a defendant in an action for money damages, or had a
judgment for money damages docketed against it (if, in either case, after final
judgment the judgment is unsatisfied), then such court could avoid or
subordinate the amounts owing under the Notes and/or the Subsidiary Guarantees
to presently existing and future indebtedness of the Company or such Subsidiary
Guarantor, as the case may be, and take other actions detrimental to the holders
of the Notes.
 
The measure of insolvency for purposes of the foregoing considerations will vary
depending upon the law of the jurisdiction that is being applied in any such
proceeding. Generally, however, the Company or a Subsidiary Guarantor would be
considered insolvent if, at the time it incurred the indebtedness, either (i)
the sum of its debts (including contingent liabilities) is greater than its
assets, at a fair valuation, or (ii) the present fair salable value of its
assets is less than the amount required to pay the probable liability on its
total existing debts and liabilities (including contingent liabilities) as they
become absolute and matured. We cannot give any assurance as to what standards a
court would use to determine whether the Company or a Subsidiary Guarantor was
solvent at the relevant
 
                                       30
<PAGE>   31
 
time, or whether, whatever standard was used, the Notes would not be avoided or
further subordinated on another of the grounds set forth above.
 
We believe that at the time we incurred the indebtedness constituting the Notes
and the Subsidiary Guarantees, we (i) were (a) not insolvent nor rendered
insolvent as a result, (b) in possession of sufficient capital to run our
businesses effectively, and (c) incurring debts within our ability to pay them
as they become due, and (ii) had sufficient assets to satisfy any probable money
judgment against us in any pending action. In reaching the foregoing
conclusions, we have relied upon our analyses of internal cash flow projections
and estimated values of our assets and liabilities. At the time we entered into
our financing, Valuation Research Corporation rendered an opinion to such
effect. We cannot assure you, however, that a court passing on the same
questions would reach the same conclusions.
 
ABSENCE OF PUBLIC MARKET
 
Currently, there is no public market for the Exchange Notes or the Old Notes. We
do not intend to apply for listing of the Notes on any securities exchange or on
any automated dealer quotation system. Although the Initial Purchasers have
informed the Company that they intend to make a market in the Notes, they are
not obligated to do so and may discontinue any such market at any time without
notice. In addition, such market making activity may be limited during this
Exchange Offer or the effectiveness of a shelf registration statement in lieu
thereof. As a result, we can make no assurances to you as to the development or
liquidity of any market for the Notes, your ability to sell the Notes, or the
price at which you may be able to sell the Notes. Future trading prices of the
Notes will depend on many factors, including among other things, prevailing
interest rates, the Company's operating results and the market for similar
securities. Historically, the market for securities similar to the Notes,
including non-investment grade debt, has been subject to disruptions that have
caused substantial volatility in the prices of such securities. We cannot assure
you that, if a market develops, it will not be subject to similar disruptions.
 
PROCEDURES FOR TENDER OF OLD NOTES
 
The Exchange Notes will be issued in exchange for the Old Notes only after
timely receipt by the Exchange Agent of such Old Notes, a properly completed and
duly executed Letter of Transmittal and all other required documentation. If you
desire to tender such Old Notes in exchange for Exchange Notes, you should allow
sufficient time to ensure timely delivery. Neither the Exchange Agent nor we are
under any duty to give you notification of defects or irregularities with
respect to tenders of Old Notes for exchange. Old Notes that are not tendered or
are tendered but not accepted will, following the consummation of the Exchange
Offer, continue to be subject to the existing transfer restrictions. In
addition, if you tender the Old Notes in the Exchange Offer for the purpose of
participating in a distribution of the Exchange Notes, you will be required to
comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the
Securities Act in connection with any resale transaction. For additional
information, please refer to the sections entitled "The Exchange Offer" and
"Plan of Distribution" later in this Prospectus.
 
                                       31
<PAGE>   32
 
CONSEQUENCES OF FAILURE TO EXCHANGE OLD NOTES
 
We have not registered the Old Notes under the Securities Act. As a result, the
Old Notes are subject to substantial transfer restrictions. Old Notes that are
not tendered in exchange for Exchange Notes or are tendered but not accepted
will, following consummation of the Exchange Offer, continue to be subject to
the existing transfer restrictions. We do not currently anticipate that we will
register the Old Notes under the Securities Act. To the extent that Old Notes
are tendered and accepted in the Exchange Offer, the trading market for
untendered and tendered but unaccepted Old Notes could be adversely affected due
to the limited amount, or "float," of the Old Notes that are expected to remain
outstanding following the Exchange Offer. Generally, a lower "float" of a
security could result in less demand to purchase such security and, as a result,
could result in lower prices for such security. For the same reason, to the
extent that a large amount of Old Notes are not tendered or are tendered and not
accepted in the Exchange Offer, the trading market for the Exchange Notes could
be adversely affected. For additional information, please refer to the sections
entitled "The Exchange Offer" and "Plan of Distribution" later in this
Prospectus.
 
                     USE OF PROCEEDS OF THE EXCHANGE NOTES
 
This Exchange Offer is intended to satisfy obligations of the Company under the
Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement dated as of August 15, 1998 (the
"Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement") by and between the Company and
Chase Securities Inc., Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc., NationsBanc Montgomery
Securities LLC, and Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation, as initial
purchasers (each, an "Initial Purchaser," and, collectively, the "Initial
Purchasers"). The Company will not receive any proceeds from the issuance of the
Exchange Notes offered hereby. In consideration for issuing the Exchange Notes
as contemplated in this Prospectus, the Company will receive, in exchange, Old
Notes in like principal amount. The form and terms of the Exchange Notes are
identical in all material respects to the form and terms of the Old Notes except
as otherwise described herein under "The Exchange Offer -- Terms of the Exchange
Offer." The Old Notes surrendered in exchange for the Exchange Notes will be
retired and canceled and cannot be reissued. Accordingly, issuance of the
Exchange Notes will not result in any increase in the outstanding debt of the
Company.
 
                                       32
<PAGE>   33
 
                                 CAPITALIZATION
 
The following table sets forth (i) the unaudited capitalization of the Company
as of June 30, 1998, (ii) such unaudited capitalization to give pro forma effect
to the acquisition of Rent-A-Center, and (iii) such unaudited capitalization to
give pro forma effect to the acquisition of Rent-A-Center and the offering of
the Old Notes (the "Offering"). The information set forth below should be read
in conjunction with the "Summary Historical Financial Data of the Company" and
the notes thereto, "Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information," "Selected
Historical Financial Data of the Company," and notes thereto, "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and
the consolidated financial statements of the Company and the notes thereto
included elsewhere in this Prospectus.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        AS OF JUNE 30, 1998
                                              ----------------------------------------
                                                                      ACQUISITIONS AND
                                                       ACQUISITIONS       OFFERING
                                                         COMBINED       COMBINED PRO
                                              ACTUAL    PRO FORMA          FORMA
                                              ------   ------------   ----------------
                                                       (DOLLARS IN MILLIONS)
<S>                                           <C>      <C>            <C>
Prior Credit Facility.......................  $127.5     $     --         $     --
Senior Revolving Credit Facility(1).........      --           --               --
Letter of Credit/Multidraw Facility(2)......      --           --               --
Senior Term Loan A(3).......................      --        120.0            120.0
Senior Term Loan B(4).......................      --        270.0            270.0
Senior Term Loan C(5).......................      --        330.0            330.0
Other debt outstanding......................     0.7          0.7              0.7
Senior Subordinated Facility(6).............      --        175.0               --
Senior Subordinated Notes Due 2008(6).......      --           --            175.0
                                              ------     --------         --------
          Total debt........................   128.2        895.7            895.7
Convertible Preferred Stock(7)..............      --        260.0            260.0
Stockholders' equity........................   170.3        145.3            145.3
                                              ------     --------         --------
          Total capitalization..............  $298.5     $1,301.0         $1,301.0
                                              ======     ========         ========
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
(1) The Senior Revolving Credit Facility provides for borrowings of up to $120.0
    million.
 
(2) The Letter of Credit/Multidraw Facility was initially used to post a letter
    of credit in the amount of $122.25 million to support a $163 million bond
    relating to certain New Jersey litigation. See "Business -- Legal
    Proceedings." Once the Letter of Credit has been terminated, the Company may
    borrow up to $85 million until 2004.
 
(3) Senior Term Loan A is a 6.0 year facility in an aggregate principal amount
    of $120 million.
 
(4) Senior Term Loan B is a 7.5 year facility in an aggregate principal amount
    of $270 million.
 
(5) Senior Term Loan C is a 8.5 year facility in an aggregate principal amount
    of $330 million.
 
(6) The proceeds from the sale of the Old Notes and available cash were used to
    repay $175 million outstanding under the Senior Subordinated Facility.
 
(7) In connection with financing a portion of the acquisition of Rent-A-Center,
    Apollo purchased $250 million, and an affiliate of Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc.
    purchased $10 million, of the Company's Convertible Preferred Stock.
    Dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock are payable quarterly at an
    annual rate of 3.75% (subject to reduction based on the Company's stock
    price performance) in cash or in-kind at the Company's option (subject to
    restrictions under the Senior Credit Facilities and the Notes). The
    Convertible Preferred Stock is convertible into approximately 27.8% of the
    Company's common stock on a fully diluted basis. See "Description of Capital
    Stock -- Preferred Stock."
 
                                       33
<PAGE>   34
 
                               THE EXCHANGE OFFER
 
PURPOSE AND EFFECT OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER
 
Pursuant to the Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement, the Company has
agreed to file a registration statement with respect to an offer to exchange the
Old Notes for senior subordinated debt securities of the Company with terms
substantially identical to the Old Notes (except that the Exchange Notes will
not contain terms with respect to transfer restrictions, registration rights and
liquidated damages) on or prior to 60 days after the Issue Date and to use its
reasonable best efforts to cause such registration statement to become effective
under the Securities Act within 150 days after the Issue Date. The Old Notes
were issued on August 18, 1998 (the "Issue Date"). In the event that applicable
interpretations of the staff of the SEC do not permit the Company to effect the
Exchange Offer as contemplated thereby, or if certain holders of the Old Notes
notify the Company that they are not eligible to participate in, or would not
receive freely tradeable Exchange Notes in exchange for tendered Old Notes
pursuant to, the Exchange Offer, the Company will use its reasonable best
efforts to cause to become effective a shelf registration statement (the "Shelf
Registration Statement") with respect to the resale of the Old Notes and to keep
the Shelf Registration Statement effective until two years after the Issue Date.
In the event that the Company is not in compliance with certain obligations
under the Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement, the Company will be
obligated to pay liquidated damages to holders of the Old Notes. See "Old Notes
Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement."
 
Each holder of the Old Notes that wishes to exchange such Old Notes for Exchange
Notes in the Exchange Offer will be required to make certain representations,
including representations that (i) any Exchange Notes to be received by it will
be acquired in the ordinary course of its business, (ii) it has no arrangement
with any person to participate in the distribution of the Exchange Notes, and
(iii) it is not an "affiliate," as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act, of
the Company or if it is an affiliate, that it will comply with the registration
and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act to the extent
applicable.
 
RESALE OF EXCHANGE NOTES
 
Based on interpretations by the staff of the SEC set forth in no-action letters
issued to third-parties, the Company believes that, except as described below,
Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange for Old Notes
may be offered for resale, resold and otherwise transferred by any holder
thereof (other than a holder which is an "affiliate" of the Company within the
meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities Act) without compliance with the
registration and prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act, provided
that such Exchange Notes are acquired in the ordinary course of such holder's
business and such holder does not intend to participate and has no arrangement
or understanding with any person to participate in the distribution of such
Exchange Notes. Any holder who tenders in the Exchange Offer with the intention
or for the purpose of participating in a distribution of the Exchange Notes
cannot rely on such interpretation by the staff of the SEC and must comply with
the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act in
connection with a secondary resale transaction. Unless an exemption from
registration is otherwise available, any such
 
                                       34
<PAGE>   35
 
resale transaction should be covered by an effective registration statement
containing the selling security holder's information required by Item 507 of
Regulation S-K under the Securities Act. This Prospectus may be used for an
offer to resell, resale or other retransfer of Exchange Notes only as
specifically set forth herein. Only broker-dealers who acquired the Old Notes as
a result of market-making activities or other trading activities may participate
in the Exchange Offer. Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its
own account in exchange for Old Notes, where such Old Notes were acquired by
such broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or other trading
activities, must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection
with any resale of such Exchange Notes. See "Plan of Distribution."
 
TERMS OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER
 
Upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Prospectus and in
the Letter of Transmittal, the Company will accept for exchange any and all Old
Notes properly tendered and not withdrawn prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City
time, on [             , 199 ] ( the "Expiration Date"). The Company will issue
$1,000 principal amount of Exchange Notes in exchange for each $1,000 principal
amount of outstanding Old Notes surrendered pursuant to the Exchange Offer. Old
Notes may be tendered only in integral multiples of $1,000.
 
The form and terms of the Exchange Notes will be the same as the form and terms
of the Old Notes except that the Exchange Notes will be registered under the
Securities Act and hence will not bear legends restricting the transfer thereof.
The Exchange Notes will evidence the same debt as the Old Notes. The Exchange
Notes will be issued under and entitled to the benefits of the Indenture, which
also authorized the issuance of the Old Notes, such that both series will be
treated as a single class of debt securities under the Indenture. See
"Description of the Notes and Guarantees -- General."
 
The Exchange Offer is not conditioned upon any minimum aggregate principal
amount of Old Notes being tendered for exchange.
 
As of the date of this Prospectus, $175.0 million aggregate principal amount of
the Old Notes are outstanding. This Prospectus, together with the Letter of
Transmittal, is being sent to all registered holders of Old Notes. There will be
no fixed record date for determining registered holders of Old Notes entitled to
participate in the Exchange Offer.
 
The Company intends to conduct the Exchange Offer in accordance with the
provisions of the Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement and the applicable
requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange
Act"), and the rules and regulations of the SEC thereunder. Old Notes which are
not tendered for exchange in the Exchange Offer will remain outstanding and
continue to accrue interest and will be entitled to the rights and benefits such
holders have under the Indenture and the Exchange and Registration Rights
Agreement.
 
The Company shall be deemed to have accepted for exchange properly tendered
Notes when, as and if the Company shall have given oral or written notice
thereof to the Exchange Agent and complied with the provisions of Section 1 of
the Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement. The Exchange Agent will act as
agent for the tendering holders for the purposes of receiving the Exchange Notes
from the Company. The
 
                                       35
<PAGE>   36
 
Company expressly reserves the right to amend or terminate the Exchange Offer,
and not to accept for exchange any Old Notes not accepted for exchange, upon the
occurrence of any of the conditions specified below under "-- Certain Conditions
to the Exchange Offer."
 
Holders who tender Old Notes in the Exchange Offer will not be required to pay
brokerage commissions or fees or, subject to the instructions in the Letter of
Transmittal, transfer taxes with respect to the exchange of Old Notes pursuant
to the Exchange Offer. The Company will pay all charges and expenses, other than
certain applicable taxes described below, in connection with the Exchange Offer.
See "-- Fees and Expenses."
 
EXPIRATION DATE; EXTENSIONS; AMENDMENTS
 
The term "Expiration Date" shall mean 5:00 p.m., New York City time on
[               , 199 ,] unless the Company, in its sole discretion, extends the
Exchange Offer, in which case the term "Expiration Date" shall mean the latest
date and time to which the Exchange Offer is extended.
 
In order to extend the Exchange Offer, the Company will notify the Exchange
Agent of any extension by oral or written notice and will mail to the registered
holders of Old Notes an announcement thereof, each prior to 9:00 a.m., New York
City time, on the next business day after the Expiration Date.
 
The Company reserves the right, in its sole discretion, (i) to delay accepting
any Old Notes for exchange, to extend the Exchange Offer or to terminate the
Exchange Offer if any of the conditions set forth below under "-- Certain
Conditions to the Exchange Offer" shall not have been satisfied, by giving oral
or written notice of such delay, extension or termination to the Exchange Agent
or (ii) to amend the terms of the Exchange Offer in any manner. Any such delay
in acceptance, extension, termination or amendment will be followed as promptly
as practicable by oral or written notice thereof to the registered holders of
Old Notes. If the Exchange Offer is amended in a manner determined by the
Company to constitute a material change, the Company will promptly disclose such
amendment by means of a prospectus supplement that will be distributed to the
registered holders, and the Company will extend the Exchange Offer, depending
upon the significance of the amendment and the manner of disclosure to the
registered holders, if the Exchange Offer would otherwise expire during such
period.
 
Without limiting the manner in which we may choose to make a public announcement
of any delay, extension, amendment or termination of the Exchange Offer, we have
no obligation to publish, advertise or otherwise communicate any such public
announcement, other than by making a timely release to an appropriate news
agency.
 
If we extend the period of time during which the Exchange Offer is open, or if
it is delayed in accepting for exchange of, or in issuing and exchanging the
Exchange Notes for, any Old Notes, or is unable to accept for exchange of, or
issue Exchange Notes for, any Old Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer for any
reason, then, without prejudice to our rights under the Exchange Offer, the
Exchange Agent may, on our behalf, retain all Old Notes tendered, and such Old
Notes may not be withdrawn except as otherwise provided below in "-- Withdrawal
of Tenders." The right to delay acceptance for exchange of, or the issuance and
the exchange of the Exchange Notes for, any Old Notes is subject
 
                                       36
<PAGE>   37
 
to applicable law, including Rule 14e-1(c) under the Exchange Act, which
requires that we pay the consideration offered or return the Old Notes deposited
by or on behalf of the holders thereof promptly after termination or withdrawal
of the Exchange Offer.
 
INTEREST ON THE EXCHANGE NOTES
 
The Exchange Notes will bear interest at a rate of 11% per annum, payable
semi-annually, on February 15 and August 15 of each year, commencing on February
15, 1999. Holders of Exchange Notes will receive interest on February 15, 1999
from the date of initial issuance of the Exchange Notes, plus an amount equal to
the accrued interest on the Old Notes. Interest on the Old Notes accepted for
exchange will cease to accrue upon issuance of the Exchange Notes.
 
CERTAIN CONDITIONS TO THE EXCHANGE OFFER
 
Notwithstanding any other term of the Exchange Offer, the Company will not be
required to accept for exchange, or exchange any Exchange Notes for, any Old
Notes, and may terminate the Exchange Offer as provided herein before the
acceptance of any Old Notes for exchange, if:
 
     (a) any action or proceeding is instituted or threatened in any court or by
         or before any governmental agency with respect to the Exchange Offer
         which, in the Company's reasonable judgment, might materially impair
         the ability of the Company to proceed with the Exchange Offer; or
 
     (b) any law, statute, rule or regulation is proposed, adopted or enacted,
         or any existing law, statute, rule or regulation is interpreted by the
         staff of the SEC, which, in the Company's reasonable judgment, might
         materially impair the ability of the Company to proceed with the
         Exchange Offer; or
 
     (c) any governmental approval has not been obtained, which approval the
         Company shall, in its reasonable discretion, deem necessary for the
         consummation of the Exchange Offer as contemplated hereby.
 
The Company expressly reserves the right, at any time or from time to time, to
extend the period of time during which the Exchange Offer is open, and thereby
delay acceptance for exchange of any Old Notes, by giving oral or written notice
of such extension to the holders thereof. During any such extensions, all Old
Notes previously tendered will remain subject to the Exchange Offer and may be
accepted for exchange by the Company. Any Old Notes not accepted for exchange
for any reason will be returned without expense to the tendering holder thereof
as promptly as practicable after the expiration or termination of the Exchange
Offer.
 
The Company expressly reserves the right to amend or terminate the Exchange
Offer, and not to accept for exchange any Old Notes not accepted for exchange,
upon the occurrence of any of the conditions of the Exchange Offer specified
above under "-- Certain Conditions to the Exchange Offer." The Company will give
oral or written notice of any extension, amendment, non-acceptance or
termination to the holders of the Old Notes as promptly as practicable, such
notice in the case of any extension to be issued no later than
 
                                       37
<PAGE>   38
 
9:00 a.m., New York City time, on the next business day after the previously
scheduled Expiration Date.
 
The foregoing conditions are for the sole benefit of the Company and may be
asserted by the Company regardless of the circumstances giving rise to any such
condition or may be waived by the Company in whole or in part at any time and
from time to time in its sole discretion. The failure by the Company at any time
to exercise any of the foregoing rights shall not be deemed a waiver of any such
right and each such right shall be deemed an ongoing right which may be asserted
at any time and from time to time.
 
In addition, the Company will not accept for exchange any Old Notes tendered,
and no Exchange Notes will be issued in exchange for any such Old Notes, if at
such time any stop order shall be threatened or in effect with respect to the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus constitutes a part or the
qualification of the Indenture under the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 (the
"TIA").
 
PROCEDURES FOR TENDERING
 
Subject to the terms and conditions hereof and the Letter of Transmittal, only a
holder of Old Notes may tender such Old Notes in the Exchange Offer. To tender
in the Exchange Offer, a holder must complete, sign and date the Letter of
Transmittal, or facsimile thereof, have the signature thereon guaranteed if
required by the Letter of Transmittal, and mail or otherwise deliver such Letter
of Transmittal or such facsimile to the Exchange Agent prior to 5:00 p.m., New
York City time, on the Expiration Date or, in the alternative, comply with DTC's
ATOP procedures described below. In addition, either (i) Old Notes must be
received by the Exchange Agent along with the Letter of Transmittal, or (ii) a
timely confirmation of book-entry transfer (a "Book-Entry Confirmation") of such
Old Notes, if such procedure is available, into the Exchange Agent's account at
DTC (the "Book-Entry Transfer Facility") pursuant to the procedure for
book-entry transfer described below or properly transmitted Agent's Message (as
defined below) must be received by the Exchange Agent prior to the Expiration
Date, or (iii) the holder must comply with the guaranteed delivery procedures
described below. To be tendered effectively, the Letter of Transmittal and other
required documents must be received by the Exchange Agent at the address set
forth below under "-- Exchange Agent" prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on
the Expiration Date.
 
The tender by a holder which is not withdrawn prior to the Expiration Date will
constitute an agreement between such holder and the Company in accordance with
the terms and subject to the conditions set forth herein and in the Letter of
Transmittal.
 
THE METHOD OF DELIVERY OF OLD NOTES, THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL AND ALL OTHER
REQUIRED DOCUMENTS TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT IS AT THE ELECTION AND RISK OF THE
HOLDER. INSTEAD OF DELIVERY BY MAIL, IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT HOLDERS USE AN
OVERNIGHT OR HAND DELIVERY SERVICE. IN ALL CASES, SUFFICIENT TIME SHOULD BE
ALLOWED TO ASSURE DELIVERY TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT BEFORE THE EXPIRATION DATE. NO
LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL OR OLD NOTES SHOULD BE SENT TO THE COMPANY. HOLDERS MAY
REQUEST THEIR RESPECTIVE BROKERS, DEALERS, COMMERCIAL BANKS,
 
                                       38
<PAGE>   39
 
TRUST COMPANIES OR OTHER NOMINEES TO EFFECT THE ABOVE TRANSACTIONS FOR SUCH
HOLDERS.
 
Any beneficial owner whose Old Notes are registered in the name of a broker,
dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee and who wishes to tender
should contact the registered holder promptly and instruct such registered
holder of Old Notes to tender on such beneficial owner's behalf. If such
beneficial owner wishes to tender on such owner's own behalf, such owner must,
prior to completing and executing the Letter of Transmittal and delivering such
owner's Old Notes, either make appropriate arrangements to register ownership of
the Old Notes in such owner's name or obtain a properly completed bond power
from the registered holder of Old Notes. The transfer of registered ownership
may take considerable time and may not be able to be completed prior to the
Expiration Date.
 
Signatures on a Letter of Transmittal or a notice of withdrawal described below,
as the case may be, must be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution (as defined
below) unless the Old Notes tendered pursuant thereto are tendered (i) by a
registered holder who has not completed the box entitled "Special Issuance
Instructions" or "Special Delivery Instructions" on the Letter of Transmittal or
(ii) for the account of an Eligible Institution. In the event that signatures on
a Letter of Transmittal or a notice of withdrawal, as the case may be, are
required to be guaranteed, such guarantor must be a member firm of a registered
national securities exchange or of the National Association of Securities
Dealers, Inc., a commercial bank or trust company having an office or
correspondent in the United States or an "eligible guarantor institution" within
the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15 under the Exchange Act which is a member of one of
the recognized signature guarantee programs identified in the Letter of
Transmittal (an "Eligible Institution").
 
If the Letter of Transmittal is signed by a person other than the registered
holder of any Old Notes listed therein, such Old Notes must be endorsed or
accompanied by a properly completed bond power, signed by such registered holder
as such registered holder's name appears on such Old Notes with the signature
thereon guaranteed by an Eligible Institution.
 
If the Letter of Transmittal or any Old Notes or bond powers are signed by
trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact, officers of
corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, such
persons should so indicate when signing, and unless waived by the Company,
provide evidence satisfactory to the Company of their authority to so act must
be submitted with the Letter of Transmittal.
 
The Exchange Agent and DTC have confirmed that any financial institution that is
a participant in DTC's system may utilize DTC's ATOP to tender. Accordingly,
participants in DTC's ATOP may, in lieu of physically completing and signing the
Letter of Transmittal and delivering it to the Exchange Agent, electronically
transmit their acceptance of the Exchange Offer by causing DTC to transfer the
Old Notes to the Exchange Agent in accordance with DTC's ATOP procedures for
transfer. DTC will then send an Agent's Message to the Exchange Agent.
 
The term "Agent's Message" means a message transmitted by DTC received by the
Exchange Agent and forming part of the Book-Entry Confirmation, which states
that DTC has received an express acknowledgment from a participant in DTC's ATOP
that is tendering Old Notes which are the subject of such book entry
confirmation, that such
 
                                       39
<PAGE>   40
 
participant has received and agrees to be bound by the terms of the Letter of
Transmittal (or, in the case of an Agent's Message relating to guaranteed
delivery, that such participant has received and agrees to be bound by the
applicable Notice of Guaranteed Delivery), and that the agreement may be
enforced against such participant.
 
All questions as to the validity, form, eligibility (including time of receipt),
acceptance of tendered Old Notes and withdrawal of tendered Old Notes will be
determined by the Company in its sole discretion, which determination will be
final and binding. The Company reserves the absolute right to reject any and all
Old Notes not properly tendered or any Old Notes the Company's acceptance of
which would, in the opinion of counsel for the Company, be unlawful. The Company
also reserves the right to waive any defects, irregularities or conditions of
tender as to particular Old Notes. The Company's interpretation of the terms and
conditions of the Exchange Offer (including the instructions in the Letter of
Transmittal) will be final and binding on all parties. Unless waived, any
defects or irregularities in connection with tenders of Old Notes must be cured
within such time as the Company shall determine. Although the Company intends to
notify holders of defects or irregularities with respect to tenders of Old
Notes, neither the Company, the Exchange Agent nor any other person shall incur
any liability for failure to give such notification. Tenders of Old Notes will
not be deemed to have been made until such defects or irregularities have been
cured or waived. Any Old Notes received by the Exchange Agent that are not
properly tendered and as to which the defects or irregularities have not been
cured or waived will be returned by the Exchange Agent to the tendering holder,
unless otherwise provided in the Letter of Transmittal, as soon as practicable
following the Expiration Date.
 
In all cases, issuance of Exchange Notes for Old Notes that are accepted for
exchange pursuant to the Exchange Offer will be made only after timely receipt
by the Exchange Agent of Old Notes or a timely Book-Entry Confirmation of such
Old Notes into the Exchange Agent's account at the Book-Entry Transfer Facility,
a properly completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal and all other
required documents. If any tendered Old Notes are not accepted for exchange for
any reason set forth in the terms and conditions of the Exchange Offer or if Old
Notes are submitted for a greater principal amount than the holder desires to
exchange, such unaccepted or non-exchanged Old Notes will be returned without
expense to the tendering holder thereof (or, in the case of Old Notes tendered
by book-entry transfer into the Exchange Agent's account at the Book-Entry
Transfer Facility pursuant to the book-entry transfer procedures described
below, such non-exchanged Notes will be credited to an account maintained with
such Book-Entry Transfer Facility) as promptly as practicable after the
expiration or termination of the Exchange Offer.
 
BOOK-ENTRY TRANSFER
 
The Exchange Agent will make a request to establish an account with respect to
the Old Notes at the Book-Entry Transfer Facility for purposes of the Exchange
Offer within two business days after the date of this Prospectus, and any
financial institution that is a participant in the Book-Entry Transfer
Facility's system may make book-entry delivery of Old Notes by causing the
Book-Entry Transfer Facility to transfer such Old Notes into the Exchange
Agent's account at the Book-Entry Transfer Facility in accordance with such
Book-Entry Transfer Facility's procedures for transfer. However, although
delivery of
 
                                       40
<PAGE>   41
 
Notes may be effected through book-entry transfer at the Book-Entry Transfer
Facility, the Letter of Transmittal or facsimile thereof, with any required
signature guarantees and any other required documents, must, in any case, be
transmitted to and received by the Exchange Agent at the address set forth below
under "-- Exchange Agent" on or prior to the Expiration Date or, if the
guaranteed delivery procedures described below are to be complied with, within
the time period provided under such procedures. Delivery of documents to the
Book-Entry Transfer Facility does not constitute delivery to the Exchange Agent.
 
GUARANTEED DELIVERY PROCEDURES
 
Holders who wish to tender their Old Notes and (i) whose Old Notes are not
immediately available, or (ii) who cannot deliver their Old Notes, the Letter of
Transmittal or any other required documents to the Exchange Agent prior to the
Expiration Date, may effect a tender if:
 
     (a) The tender is made through an Eligible Institution;
 
     (b) Prior to the Expiration Date, the Exchange Agent receives from such
         Eligible Institution a properly completed and duly executed Notice of
         Guaranteed Delivery (by facsimile transmission, mail or hand delivery)
         setting forth the name and address of the holder, the registered
         number(s) of such Old Notes and the principal amount of Old Notes
         tendered, stating that the tender is being made thereby and
         guaranteeing that, within three (3) New York Stock Exchange trading
         days after the Expiration Date, the Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile
         thereof) together with the Old Notes or a Book-Entry Confirmation, as
         the case may be, and any other documents required by the Letter of
         Transmittal will be deposited by the Eligible Institution with the
         Exchange Agent; and
 
     (c) Such properly completed and executed Letter of Transmittal (or
         facsimile thereof), or properly transmitted Agent's Message as well as
         all tendered Old Notes in proper form for transfer or a Book-Entry
         Confirmation, as the case may be, and all other documents required by
         the Letter of Transmittal, are received by the Exchange Agent within
         three (3) New York Stock Exchange trading days after the Expiration
         Date.
 
Upon request to the Exchange Agent, a Notice of Guaranteed Delivery will be sent
to holders who wish to tender their Old Notes according to the guaranteed
delivery procedures set forth above.
 
WITHDRAWAL OF TENDERS
 
Except as otherwise provided herein, tenders of Old Notes may be withdrawn at
any time prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date.
 
For a withdrawal to be effective, (i) a written notice of withdrawal must be
received by the Exchange Agent at one of the addresses set forth below
under "-- Exchange Agent" or (ii) holders must comply with the appropriate
procedures of DTC's ATOP system. Any such notice of withdrawal must specify the
name of the person having tendered the Old Notes to be withdrawn, identify the
Old Notes to be withdrawn (including the principal
 
                                       41
<PAGE>   42
 
amount of such Old Notes), and (where certificates for Old Notes have been
transmitted) specify the name in which such Old Notes were registered, if
different from that of the withdrawing holder. If certificates for Old Notes
have been delivered or otherwise identified to the Exchange Agent, then, prior
to the release of such certificates, the withdrawing holder must also submit the
serial numbers of the particular certificates to be withdrawn and a signed
notice of withdrawal with signatures guaranteed by an Eligible Institution
unless such holder is an Eligible Institution. If Old Notes have been tendered
pursuant to the procedure for book-entry transfer described above, any notice of
withdrawal must specify the name and number of the account at the Book-Entry
Transfer Facility to be credited with the withdrawn Old Notes and otherwise
comply with the procedures of such facility. All questions as to the validity,
form and eligibility (including time of receipt) of such notices will be
determined by the Company, whose determination shall be final and binding on all
parties. Any Old Notes so withdrawn will be deemed not to have been validly
tendered for exchange for purposes of the Exchange Offer. Any Old Notes which
have been tendered for exchange but which are not exchanged for any reason will
be returned to the holder thereof without cost to such holder (or, in the case
of Old Notes tendered by book-entry transfer into the Exchange Agent's account
at the Book-Entry Transfer Facility pursuant to the book-entry transfer
procedures described above, such Old Notes will be credited to an account
maintained with such Book-Entry Transfer Facility for the Old Notes) as soon as
practicable after withdrawal, rejection of tender or termination of the Exchange
Offer. Properly withdrawn Old Notes may be retendered by following one of the
procedures described under "-- Procedures for Tendering" above at any time on or
prior to the Expiration Date.
 
EXCHANGE AGENT
 
IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust Company has been appointed as Exchange Agent for the
Exchange Offer. Questions and requests for assistance, requests for additional
copies of this Prospectus or the Letter of Transmittal and requests for Notice
of Guaranteed Delivery should be directed to the Exchange Agent addressed as
follows:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                 <C>
 By Registered or Certified Mail
     or by Overnight Courier:                    By Hand:
IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust Company   IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust Company
           P. O. Box 84                      One State Street
      Bowling Green Station              New York, New York 10004
  New York, New York 10274-0084        Attn: Securities Processing
 Attn: Reorganization Operations                 Window,
               Dept                       Subcellar One, (SC-1)
</TABLE>
 
                                 By Facsimile:
 
                                 (212) 858-2611
           (To confirm facsimile transmissions, call: (212) 858-2103)
 
FEES AND EXPENSES
 
The expenses of soliciting tenders will be borne by the Company. The principal
solicitation is being made by mail. However, additional solicitation may be made
by telegraph, telephone or in person by officers and regular employees of the
Company and its affiliates.
 
                                       42
<PAGE>   43
 
The Company has not retained any dealer-manager in connection with the Exchange
Offer and will not make any payments to broker-dealers or others soliciting
acceptances of the Exchange Offer. The Company, however, will pay the Exchange
Agent reasonable and customary fees for its services and will reimburse it for
its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses in connection therewith.
 
The cash expenses to be incurred in connection with the Exchange Offer will be
paid by the Company and are estimated in the aggregate to be approximately
$300,000. Such expenses include registration fees, fees and expenses of the
Exchange Agent and Trustee, accounting and legal fees and printing costs, and
related fees and expenses.
 
TRANSFER TAXES
 
The Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the exchange of
the Old Notes for Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. If, however,
certificates representing Old Notes for principal amounts not tendered or
accepted for exchange are to be delivered to, or are to be issued in the name
of, any person other than the registered holder of Notes tendered, or if
tendered Notes are registered in the name of any person other than the person
signing the Letter of Transmittal, or if a transfer tax is imposed for any
reason other than the exchange of Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, then the
amount of any such transfer taxes (whether imposed on the registered holder or
any other persons) will be payable by the tendering holder. If satisfactory
evidence of payment of such taxes or exemption therefrom is not submitted with
the Letter of Transmittal, the amount of such transfer taxes will be billed
directly to such tendering holder.
 
CONSEQUENCES OF FAILURE TO EXCHANGE
 
Holders of Old Notes who do not exchange their Old Notes for Exchange Notes
pursuant to the Exchange Offer will continue to be subject to the restrictions
on transfer of such Old Notes, as set forth (i) in the legend thereon as a
consequence of the issuance of the Old Notes pursuant to the exemptions from, or
in transactions not subject to, the registration requirements of the Securities
Act and applicable state securities laws, and (ii) otherwise set forth in the
Offering Memorandum dated August 13, 1998, distributed in connection with the
Offering. In general, the Old Notes may not be offered or sold, unless
registered under the Securities Act, except pursuant to an exemption from, or in
a transaction not subject to, the Securities Act and applicable state securities
laws. The Company does not currently anticipate that it will register the Old
Notes under the Securities Act. Based on interpretations by the staff of the
SEC, Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be offered for
resale, resold or otherwise transferred by holders thereof (other than any such
holder which is an "affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405
under the Securities Act) without compliance with the registration and
prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act, provided that such
Exchange Notes are acquired in the ordinary course of such holders' business and
such holders have no arrangement or understanding with respect to the
distribution of the Exchange Notes to be acquired pursuant to the Exchange
Offer. Any holder who tenders in the Exchange Offer for the purpose of
participating in a distribution of the Exchange Notes (i) could not rely on the
applicable interpretations of the staff of the SEC, and (ii) must comply with
the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act in
connection with a secondary resale transaction. In addition, to comply
 
                                       43
<PAGE>   44
 
with the securities laws of certain jurisdictions, if applicable, the Exchange
Notes may not be offered or sold unless they have been registered or such
securities laws have been complied with. The Company has agreed, pursuant to the
Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement and subject to certain specified
limitations therein, to register or qualify the Exchange Notes for offer or sale
under the securities or blue sky laws of such jurisdictions as any holder of the
Exchange Notes may request in writing.
 
                                       44
<PAGE>   45
 
               UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
The following unaudited pro forma combined financial information of the Company
gives effect to the acquisition of Rent-A-Center and the Offering as if such
transactions were consummated on June 30, 1998, in the case of the Unaudited Pro
Forma Combined Balance Sheet, and as if such transactions and the acquisition of
Central Rents were consummated on January 1, 1997, in the case of Unaudited Pro
Forma Combined Statements of Operations for the year ended December 31, 1997 and
the six months ended June 30, 1998. The Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Statement
of Operations for the year ended December 31, 1997 includes Rent-A-Center
historical information for the year ended March 31, 1998, its fiscal year end.
The acquisition of Rent-A-Center was completed on August 5, 1998 and the
acquisition of Central Rents was completed on May 28, 1998. The aforementioned
transactions and the related adjustments are described in the accompanying
notes. In the opinion of management, all adjustments have been made that are
necessary to present fairly the pro forma data.
 
The following unaudited pro forma combined financial information is presented
for illustrative purposes only, does not purport to be indicative of the
Company's financial position or results of operations as of the date hereof, or
as of or for any other future date, and is not necessarily indicative of what
the Company's actual financial position or results of operations would have been
had the foregoing transactions been consummated on such dates, nor does it give
effect to (i) any transactions other than the foregoing transactions and those
described in the accompanying Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial
Information or (ii) the Company's, Rent-A-Center's, or Central Rents' results of
operations since June 30, 1998. Although the following unaudited pro forma
combined financial information gives effect to expected annual net savings from
the elimination of duplicate general and administrative and field expenses as a
result of the aforementioned acquisitions, it does not give effect to additional
annual net savings expected to be achieved following consummation of the
acquisition of Rent-A-Center and the acquisition of Central Rents (described in
Note (3) to the Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Statement of Operations for the
year ended December 31, 1997). Actual amounts could differ from those presented.
 
The following unaudited pro forma combined financial information is based upon
the historical financial statements of the Company, Rent-A-Center, and Central
Rents, and should be read in conjunction with such historical financial
statements, the related notes, and the Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Combined
Financial Information. In the preparation of the unaudited pro forma combined
financial information, it has been generally assumed that the historical value
of Rent-A-Center's assets and liabilities approximates the fair value thereof,
except as described in the Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial
Information, because an independent valuation has not been completed. The
Company will be required to determine the fair value of Rent-A-Center's assets
and liabilities as of the closing date of the acquisition of Rent-A-Center.
Although such determination of fair value is not presently expected to result in
values that are materially greater or less than the values assumed in the
preparation of the following unaudited pro forma combined financial information,
there can be no assurance with respect thereof.
 
                                       45
<PAGE>   46
 
                   UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED BALANCE SHEET
                                 JUNE 30, 1998
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        RAC
                             RCI          RAC        PRO FORMA     ACQUISITION    OFFERING      PRO FORMA
                          HISTORICAL   HISTORICAL   ADJUSTMENTS     PRO FORMA    ADJUSTMENTS     COMBINED
                          ----------   ----------   -----------    -----------   -----------    ----------
                                                       (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                       <C>          <C>          <C>            <C>           <C>            <C>
ASSETS
Cash and cash
  equivalents...........   $ 23,347    $   27,486    $  5,835(1)   $   56,668      $(5,750)(5)  $   50,918
Accounts receivable.....      1,799        23,024        (702)(2)      24,121           --          24,121
Rental merchandise,
  net...................    148,432       303,682          --         452,114           --         452,114
Merchandise and auto
  inventory.............         --        43,068          --          43,068           --          43,068
Prepaids and other
  assets................      2,440         8,555      19,465(3)       30,460        5,750(5)       36,210
Property assets, net....     21,479       130,152          --         151,631           --         151,631
Deferred income taxes...      6,479        21,113      26,376(2)       53,968           --          53,968
Intangible assets,
  net...................    131,862       528,716     (39,253)(2)     621,325           --         621,325
                           --------    ----------    --------      ----------      -------      ----------
          Total
             assets.....   $335,838    $1,085,796    $ 11,721      $1,433,355      $    --      $1,433,355
                           ========    ==========    ========      ==========      =======      ==========
 
LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
Accounts payable........   $ 14,193    $   41,334    $     --      $   55,527      $    --      $   55,527
Accrued liabilities.....     23,067        90,036     (36,353)(2)      76,750           --          76,750
Debt....................    128,235            --     767,500(1)      895,735           --         895,735
Loans from Thorn plc....         --       714,663    (714,663)(2)          --           --              --
                           --------    ----------    --------      ----------      -------      ----------
          Total
          liabilities...    165,495       846,033      16,484       1,028,012           --       1,028,012
Redeemable convertible
  preferred stock.......         --            --     260,000(1)      260,000           --         260,000
Stockholders' equity....    170,343       239,763    (264,763)(4)     145,343           --         145,343
                           --------    ----------    --------      ----------      -------      ----------
          Total
             liabilities
             and
           stockholders'
             equity.....   $335,838    $1,085,796    $ 11,721      $1,433,355      $    --      $1,433,355
                           ========    ==========    ========      ==========      =======      ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                       46
<PAGE>   47
 
              NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED BALANCE SHEET
                                 JUNE 30, 1998
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
(1) Adjustment to record the debt and equity required to finance the acquisition
    of Rent-A-Center and the repurchase of common stock and use of related
    proceeds:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                       <C>
Sources:
  Senior Term Loan A....................................  $  120,000
  Senior Term Loan B....................................     270,000
  Senior Term Loan C....................................     330,000
  Senior Subordinated Credit Facility...................     175,000
  Redeemable convertible preferred stock................     260,000
                                                          ----------
          Total sources.................................  $1,155,000
                                                          ==========
Uses:
  Purchase price of the acquisition of Rent-A-Center....  $  900,000(a)
  Estimated purchase price adjustment per agreement.....      17,600(a)
  Retirement of existing Renters Choice Debt............     127,500
  Repurchase of Renters Choice common stock.............      25,000(b)
  Transition and integration costs related to the
     acquisition of Rent-A-Center.......................      45,000(a)
  Fees and expenses.....................................      34,065(a)
  Cash and cash equivalents.............................       5,835
                                                          ----------
          Total uses....................................  $1,155,000
                                                          ==========
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
     (a) Pro Forma adjustment reflected in Note (2) below. Fees and expenses are
         also reflected in Note (3).
 
     (b) Pro Forma adjustment reflected in Note (4) below.
 
                                       47
<PAGE>   48
       NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED BALANCE SHEET -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
(2) The aggregate purchase price assumed to be paid by Renters Choice and the
    related purchase accounting for the acquisition of Rent-A-Center is as
    follows:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                              <C>           <C>
Aggregate purchase price
  Purchase price per agreement.................                $900,000
  Estimated purchase price adjustment per
     agreement.................................                  17,600
  Estimated legal, accounting and other
     advisory fees.............................                  14,600
  Restructuring charge related to the
     acquisition of Rent-A-Center..............                  45,000(a)
                                                               --------
                                                               $977,200
                                                               ========
Allocation of purchase price
  Aggregate purchase price.....................                $977,200
  Less net book value of assets acquired.......                 239,763
                                                               --------
                                                                737,437
  Less adjustments to record assets and
     liabilities acquired at fair market value
     Existing goodwill.........................  $(479,517)
     Other intangible assets...................    (48,067)(b)
     Existing loans from Thorn plc forgiven....    714,663
     Existing Accounts receivable -- affiliated
       companies forgiven......................       (702)
     Accrued liabilities.......................     36,353(c)
     Deferred income taxes.....................     26,376(d)   249,106
                                                 ---------     --------
  Excess cost over fair market value of
     tangible net assets acquired..............                $488,331(e)
                                                               ========
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
     (a) Reflects estimated transition and integration costs to be incurred in
         connection with the acquisition of Rent-A-Center in accordance with
         EITF 95-3 "Recognition of Liabilities in Connection with a Purchase
         Business Combination"
 
<TABLE>
    <S>                                                         <C>
    Severance payments and other compensation to employees....  $24,500
    Lease termination and store conversion costs..............   20,500
                                                                -------
              Total...........................................  $45,000
                                                                =======
</TABLE>
 
     (b) Elimination of other assets such as territory rights and deferred
         software costs as a result of the acquisition of Rent-A-Center.
 
                                       48
<PAGE>   49
       NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED BALANCE SHEET -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
     (c) Elimination of the $34,500 legal reserve for pending class action
         litigation indemnified by seller and the elimination of $1,853 of
         accrued incentive payments to employees which are being assumed by
         seller.
 
     (d) Deferred tax asset related to the temporary differences between
         financial statement carrying amounts and tax basis of assets and
         liabilities acquired, as adjusted, at an assumed income tax rate of 40%
         for the years in which those differences are expected to be recovered
         or settled.
 
     (e) Rent-A-Center has not accrued a liability for the Robinson v. Thorn
         Americas, Inc. litigation in which a New Jersey state court has entered
         a judgment against Rent-A-Center and has ordered Rent-A-Center to pay
         the class of plaintiffs an amount in excess of $140 million.
         Rent-A-Center has posted a $163 million supersedeas bond, which amount
         was derived from an accounting by the plaintiffs of the projected
         amount of judgment liability as of April 1999. Renters Choice intends
         to vigorously defend any actions still pending at the time of the
         consummation of the acquisition of Rent-A-Center and, accordingly, in
         its preliminary purchase accounting, Renters Choice has also not
         recorded an estimated liability related to this case. This will be
         treated as a preacquisition contingency by Renters Choice. In the event
         that Renters Choice is unsuccessful under the appeal, excess cost over
         fair market value of tangible net assets will be increased by any
         damages required to be paid.
 
(3) Represents debt issuance costs associated with the acquisition of
    Rent-A-Center.
 
(4) Reflects the following:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                           <C>
Elimination of equity.......................................  $(239,763)
Repurchase of Renters Choice common stock...................    (25,000)
                                                              ---------
          Total.............................................  $(264,763)
                                                              =========
</TABLE>
 
(5) Adjustment to reflect the costs of the Offering.
 
                                       49
<PAGE>   50
 
              UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                          YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                RAC PRO FORMA
                                                                                                 ADJUSTMENTS
                                RCI AND                         RCI AND                   --------------------------
                                CENTRAL      CENTRAL RENTS   CENTRAL RENTS                ELIMINATION
                                 RENTS         PRO FORMA       PRO FORMA        RAC         NON-RTO
                             HISTORICAL(1)    ADJUSTMENTS      COMBINED      HISTORICAL   BUSINESSES     ACQUISITION
                             -------------   -------------   -------------   ----------   -----------    -----------
                                                  (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                          <C>             <C>             <C>             <C>          <C>            <C>
Revenues
  Store
    Rentals and fees........   $373,926        $     --        $373,926       $839,026     $ (3,779)(2)   $  (4,202)(3)
    Merchandise sales.......     18,972              --          18,972         62,712      (16,395)(2)          --
    Other...................        793              --             793             --           --              --
  Franchise
    Merchandise sales.......     37,385              --          37,385             --           --              --
    Royalty income and
      fees..................      4,008              --           4,008          2,266           --              --
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
        Total revenues......    435,084              --         435,084        904,004      (20,174)         (4,202)
Operating expenses
  Direct store expenses
    Depreciation of rental
      merchandise...........     87,630              --          87,630        244,572           --          (4,202)(3)
    Cost of merchandise
      sold..................     14,885              --          14,885         45,574      (14,853)(2)          --
    Salaries and other
      expenses..............    162,458        57,884(4)        220,342             --           --         449,509(3)
  Franchise cost of
    merchandise sold........     35,841              --          35,841             --           --              --
  General and administrative
    expenses................     77,559         (60,484)(4)      17,075        513,481      (10,535)(2)    (467,509)(3)
  Indemnified litigation
    expenses................         --              --              --          6,600           --          (6,600)(5)
  Nonrecurring
    charges(14).............         --              --              --         14,392       (7,792)(2)          --
  Amortization of
    intangibles.............      6,957           939(6)          7,896         24,044           --          (7,766)(6)
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
        Total operating
          expenses..........    385,330          (1,661)        383,669        848,663      (33,180)        (36,568)
        Operating profit....     49,754           1,661          51,415         55,341       13,006          32,366
Interest expense............     10,043            (752)(7)       9,291         46,184           --          30,865(8)
Interest income and other...       (304)             --            (304)           (88)          --              --
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
        Earnings before
          income taxes......     40,015           2,413          42,428          9,245       13,006           1,501
Income tax expense..........     17,044             965(10)      18,009          7,760           --           7,214(11)
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
        Net earnings........     22,971           1,448          24,419          1,485       13,006          (5,713)
Preferred dividends.........         --              --              --             --           --           9,888(13)
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
        Earnings allocable
          to common
          stockholders......   $ 22,971        $  1,448        $ 24,419       $  1,485     $ 13,006       $ (15,601)
                               ========        ========        ========       ========     ========       =========
Basic earnings per
  share(15):
  Earnings per share........                                   $   1.02
                                                               ========
  Weighted average common
    shares outstanding......                                     23,854
                                                               ========
Diluted earnings per
  share(15):
  Earnings per share........                                   $   1.01
                                                               ========
  Weighted average common
    and common equivalent
    shares outstanding......                                     24,204
                                                               ========
Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges(16)...............                                        3.6x
                                                               ========
 
<CAPTION>
 
                              ACQUISITIONS    OFFERING      PRO FORMA
                               PRO FORMA     ADJUSTMENTS     COMBINED
                              ------------   -----------    ----------
<S>                           <C>            <C>            <C>
Revenues
  Store
    Rentals and fees........   $1,204,971       $  --       $1,204,971
    Merchandise sales.......       65,289          --           65,289
    Other...................          793          --              793
  Franchise
    Merchandise sales.......       37,385          --           37,385
    Royalty income and
      fees..................        6,274          --            6,274
                               ----------       -----       ----------
        Total revenues......    1,314,712          --        1,314,712
Operating expenses
  Direct store expenses
    Depreciation of rental
      merchandise...........      328,000          --          328,000
    Cost of merchandise
      sold..................       45,606          --           45,606
    Salaries and other
      expenses..............      669,851          --          669,851
  Franchise cost of
    merchandise sold........       35,841          --           35,841
  General and administrative
    expenses................       52,512          --           52,512
  Indemnified litigation
    expenses................           --          --               --
  Nonrecurring
    charges(14).............        6,600          --            6,600
  Amortization of
    intangibles.............       24,174          --           24,174
                               ----------       -----       ----------
        Total operating
          expenses..........    1,162,584          --        1,162,584
        Operating profit....      152,128          --          152,128
Interest expense............       86,340        (519)(9)       85,821
Interest income and other...         (392)         --             (392)
                               ----------       -----       ----------
        Earnings before
          income taxes......       66,180         519           66,699
Income tax expense..........       32,983         208(12)       33,191
                               ----------       -----       ----------
        Net earnings........       33,197         311           33,508
Preferred dividends.........        9,888          --            9,888
                               ----------       -----       ----------
        Earnings allocable
          to common
          stockholders......   $   23,309       $ 311       $   23,620
                               ==========       =====       ==========
Basic earnings per
  share(15):
  Earnings per share........   $      .98                   $      .99
                               ==========                   ==========
  Weighted average common
    shares outstanding......       23,854                       23,854
                               ==========                   ==========
Diluted earnings per
  share(15):
  Earnings per share........   $      .96                   $      .98
                               ==========                   ==========
  Weighted average common
    and common equivalent
    shares outstanding......       24,204                       24,204
                               ==========                   ==========
Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges(16)...............          1.6x                         1.6x
                               ==========                   ==========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Statement of Operations
 
                                       50
<PAGE>   51
 
         NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                          YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
(1) The following historical combined statement of operations of Renters Choice
    and Central Rents for the year ended December 31, 1997 has been derived from
    the audited financial statements of the respective entities:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                RCI AND
                                                             CENTRAL RENTS
                                                  CENTRAL     HISTORICAL
                                         RCI       RENTS       COMBINED
                                       --------   --------   -------------
<S>                                    <C>        <C>        <C>
Revenues
  Store
     Rentals and fees................  $275,344   $ 98,582     $373,926
     Merchandise sales...............    14,125      4,847       18,972
     Other...........................       679        114          793
  Franchise
     Merchandise sales...............    37,385         --       37,385
     Royalty income and fees.........     4,008         --        4,008
                                       --------   --------     --------
          Total revenues.............   331,541    103,543      435,084
Operating expenses
  Store expenses
     Depreciation of rental
       merchandise...................    57,223     30,407       87,630
     Cost of merchandise sold........    11,365      3,520       14,885
     Salaries and other expenses.....   162,458         --      162,458
  Franchise cost of merchandise
     sold............................    35,841         --       35,841
  General and administrative
     expenses........................    13,304     64,255       77,559
  Amortization of intangibles........     5,412      1,545        6,957
                                       --------   --------     --------
          Total operating expenses...   285,603     99,727      385,330
          Operating profit...........    45,938      3,816       49,754
Interest expense.....................     2,194      7,849       10,043
Interest income......................      (304)        --         (304)
                                       --------   --------     --------
          Earnings (loss) before
             income taxes............    44,048     (4,033)      40,015
Income tax expense (benefit).........    18,170     (1,126)      17,044
                                       --------   --------     --------
          Net earnings (loss)........  $ 25,878   $ (2,907)    $ 22,971
                                       ========   ========     ========
Basic earnings per share:
  Earnings per share.................  $   1.04
                                       ========
  Weighted average common shares
     outstanding.....................    24,844
                                       ========
Earnings per share:
  Earnings per share.................  $   1.03
                                       ========
  Weighted average common shares
     outstanding.....................    25,194
                                       ========
</TABLE>
 
(2) Reflects the elimination of Rent-A-Center's Non-RTO Businesses (including
    nonrecurring charges of $7,792 as discussed in Note (14), including used
    automobiles retailing, credit retailing and check cashing businesses, which
    had combined revenue of $20.2 million.
 
                                       51
<PAGE>   52
         NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                  YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 -- (CONTINUED)
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              INCREASE (DECREASE)
(3)                           ---------------------------------------------------
                                            STORE
                                           EXPENSES
                              RENTALS    DEPRECIATION   SALARIES    GENERAL AND
                              AND FEES    OF RENTAL       AND      ADMINISTRATIVE
                              REVENUE    MERCHANDISE     OTHER        EXPENSES
                              --------   ------------   --------   --------------
<S>                           <C>        <C>            <C>        <C>
Reclassification of
  Rent-A-Center store
  expenses to conform with
  RCI's presentation........  $    --      $    --      $457,807     $(457,807)
Reclassification
  Rent-A-Center volume and
  cash discounts from
  purchases to conform with
  RCI's presentation........   (4,202)      (4,202)           --            --
Reclassification of
  Rent-A-Center advertising
  rebates as a reduction in
  store expenses to conform
  with RCI's presentation...       --           --        (5,798)        5,798
Elimination of income
  related to a rebate of
  management fees from Thorn
  plc.......................       --           --            --         2,900
                              -------      -------      --------     ---------
          Total.............   (4,202)      (4,202)      452,009      (449,109)
Elimination of duplicate
  corporate overhead and
  regional management
  expenses: (a)
  Corporate overhead
     Salaries and
       benefits.............       --           --            --       (17,400)
     Administrative
       expenses.............       --           --            --        (1,000)
  Regional management
     expenses...............       --           --        (2,500)           --
                              -------      -------      --------     ---------
          Total.............       --           --        (2,500)      (18,400)
                              -------      -------      --------     ---------
                              $(4,202)     $(4,202)     $449,509     $(467,509)
                              =======      =======      ========     =========
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
     (a) In addition to cost savings of $20.9 million from the acquisition of
         Rent-A-Center and $2.6 million from the acquisition of Central Rents,
         the Company is planning to implement certain other initiatives which
         are expected to generate an additional $9.9 million of annual cost
         savings. These include making changes to Rent-A-Center's product
         distribution network and utilizing Rent-A-Center's service and repair
         network which would result in estimated annual savings of $22.3 million
         and $4.6 million, respectively. In addition, the Company is considering
         other initiatives to increase Rent-A-Center's store efficiencies and
 
                                       52
<PAGE>   53
         NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                  YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 -- (CONTINUED)
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
         operating profit. These changes would result in estimated additional
         expenditures of approximately $17.0 million. Therefore, management
         believes it will achieve $30.8 million of total cost savings for the
         acquisition of Rent-A-Center, of which $20.9 million is included in
         Operating Income and $9.9 million of which reflects the net effect of
         these other initiatives.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             INCREASE (DECREASE)
(4)                                                       -------------------------
                                                           STORE
                                                          EXPENSES
                                                          SALARIES    GENERAL AND
                                                            AND      ADMINISTRATIVE
                                                           OTHER        EXPENSES
                                                          --------   --------------
<S>                                                       <C>        <C>
     Reclassification of Central Rents other store
       expenses to conform with RCI's presentation......  $57,684       $(57,684)
       Elimination of duplicate corporate overhead and
          additional field expenses as a result of the
          Central Rents acquisition.....................      200         (2,800)
                                                          -------       --------
                                                          $57,884       $(60,484)
                                                          =======       ========
</TABLE>
 
(5) Elimination of litigation expense relating to Minnesota and Pennsylvania
    class action litigation indemnified by seller as part of the acquisition of
    Rent-A-Center.
 
(6) Reversal of historical intangible amortization and recording the pro forma
    intangible amortization required as a result of the Central Rents and
    Rent-A-Center acquisitions, using estimated useful lives of 5 years for the
    noncompete agreement (Central Rents), and 30 years for excess costs over
    fair market value of net assets acquired:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     CENTRAL
                                                      RENTS       RAC
                                                     -------   ---------
<S>                                                  <C>       <C>
Reversal of historical intangible amortization.....  $(1,545)  $(24,044)
Pro forma intangible amortization..................    2,484     16,278
                                                     -------   --------
                                                     $   939   $ (7,766)
                                                     =======   ========
</TABLE>
 
(7) Change in interest expense as a result of borrowings on the existing
    revolving credit agreement used to finance the Central Acquisition:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                           <C>
Borrowings of $101.4 million at 7% on the existing revolving
  credit agreement used to finance the Central
  Acquisition...............................................  $ 7,097
Elimination of historical interest expense for Central
  Rents.....................................................   (7,849)
                                                              -------
                                                              $  (752)
                                                              =======
</TABLE>
 
                                       53
<PAGE>   54
         NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                  YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 -- (CONTINUED)
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
(8) Net adjustment to interest expense as a result of the issuance of debt to
    complete the acquisition of Rent-A-Center:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                           <C>
Senior Credit Facilities:
  $120 million Term Loan A at an annual interest rate of
     7.95%..................................................  $  9,540
  $270 million Term Loan B at an annual interest rate of
     8.20%..................................................    22,140
  $330 million Term Loan C at an annual interest rate of
     8.45%..................................................    27,885
  Annual commitment fee of 0.50% applied to the $120 million
     unused balance of the Revolving Credit Facility........       600
  Annual 2.50% fee applied to the Letter of Credit
     Facility...............................................     3,056
$175 million Senior Subordinated Facility at an annual
  interest rate of 11.625%..................................    20,344
                                                              --------
Cash interest expense.......................................    83,565
Amortization of deferred financing costs(a).................     2,628
                                                              --------
Pro forma interest expense for the acquisitions.............    86,193
Interest expense relating to existing Renters Choice debt
  not refinanced............................................       147
                                                              --------
Pre-Offering pro forma interest expense.....................    86,340
Less: Renters Choice and Central Rents pro forma combined
  interest expense plus Rent-A-Center historical interest
  expense...................................................   (55,475)
                                                              --------
Pre-Offering net interest expense adjustment................  $ 30,865
                                                              ========
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
     (a) Deferred financing costs are amortized over the term of the related
         debt (ten years for the Senior Subordinated Facility, six years for the
         Term Loan A, seven and one-half years for Term Loan B, eight and
         one-half years for Term Loan C, and six years for both the Revolving
         Credit and Letter of Credit Facilities).
 
        A change of 0.125% in the assumed interest rates would result in a $1.1
        million change in pro forma interest expense for the year.
 
(9) Net adjustments to interest expense as a result of the Offering:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                           <C>
Issuance of Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 -- $175,000
  at 11.0%..................................................  $ 19,250
Amortization of related deferred financing costs............       575
Repayment of Senior Subordinated Facility -- $175,000 at
  11.625%...................................................   (20,344)
                                                              --------
                                                              $   (519)
                                                              ========
</TABLE>
 
(10) Income tax expense adjustment related to the effects of the Central Rents
     pro forma adjustments at a 40% effective tax rate.
 
                                       54
<PAGE>   55
         NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                  YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 -- (CONTINUED)
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
(11) Income tax expense adjustment related to the effects of the pro forma
     adjustments based upon an assumed composite income tax rate of 40% applied
     to combined pro forma earnings before income taxes, adjusted for
     nondeductible goodwill amortization of $16.3 million related to the
     acquisition of Rent-A-Center.
 
(12) Income tax expense adjustment related to the effects of the Offering
     adjustments, at a 40% effective tax rate.
 
(13) In-kind dividends at 3.75% per annum on the $260 million of redeemable
     convertible preferred stock issued to finance a portion of the acquisition
     of Rent-A-Center. For the first five years subsequent to issuance, Renters
     Choice has the option to pay the quarterly dividends in cash or in-kind
     with the issuance of additional redeemable convertible preferred stock.
     RCI's ability to pay the dividends in cash will be subject to restrictions
     under the Senior Credit Facilities and Senior Subordinated Notes. Dividends
     reflected herein are assumed to be paid in-kind with the issuance of
     additional redeemable convertible preferred stock.
 
(14) Nonrecurring charges relate to Rent-A-Center's discontinued Non-RTO
     Businesses, the closing of certain non-performing RTO stores, and
     reorganization of certain administrative support functions aggregating
     approximately $12.3 million and approximately $2.1 million related
     primarily to Rent-A-Center's writedown of cellular phone inventory.
 
(15) Weighted average common shares outstanding for both basic and diluted
     earnings per share were decreased by 990,099 to give pro forma effect of
     the repurchase of $25 million of Renters Choice common stock at $25.25 per
     share from RCI's Chief Executive Officer. The assumed conversion of the
     redeemable convertible preferred stock would have had an anti-dilutive
     effect on diluted earnings per share for the year ended December 31, 1997,
     and therefore has been excluded from the computation thereof.
 
(16) In calculating the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings consist of
     income before income taxes plus fixed charges (excluding capitalized
     interest). Fixed charges consist of interest expense (which includes
     amortization of deferred financing costs) whether expensed or capitalized
     and one-fourth of rental expense, deemed representative of that portion of
     rental expense estimated to be attributable to interest.
 
                                       55
<PAGE>   56
 
              UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                         SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1998
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                RAC PRO FORMA
                                                                                                 ADJUSTMENTS
                                RCI AND                         RCI AND                   --------------------------
                                CENTRAL      CENTRAL RENTS   CENTRAL RENTS                ELIMINATION
                                 RENTS         PRO FORMA       PRO FORMA        RAC         NON-RTO
                             HISTORICAL(1)    ADJUSTMENTS      COMBINED      HISTORICAL   BUSINESSES     ACQUISITION
                             -------------   -------------   -------------   ----------   -----------    -----------
                                                  (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                          <C>             <C>             <C>             <C>          <C>            <C>
Revenues
  Store
    Rentals and fees........   $202,136        $     --        $202,136       $431,879     $ (3,847)(2)   $  (1,398)(3)
    Merchandise sales.......     12,767              --          12,767         37,035      (13,297)(2)          --
    Other...................        281              --             281             --           --              --
 
  Franchise
    Merchandise sales.......     17,061              --          17,061             --           --              --
    Royalty income and
      fees..................      2,248              --           2,248          1,157           --              --
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
 
        Total revenues......    234,493              --         234,493        470,071      (17,144)         (1,398)
 
Operating expenses
  Direct store expenses
    Depreciation of rental
      merchandise...........     45,261              --          45,261        125,048           --          (1,398)(3)
    Cost of merchandise
      sold..................     10,275              --          10,275         28,636      (13,043)(2)          --
    Salaries and other
      expenses..............     95,287          24,598(4)      119,885             --           --         226,699(3)
Franchise cost of
  merchandise sold..........     16,386              --          16,386             --           --              --
General and administrative
  expenses..................     35,039         (25,681)(4)       9,358        261,906       (6,614)(2)    (234,249)(3)
Indemnified litigation
  expenses..................         --              --              --          5,600           --          (5,600)(5)
Nonrecurring charges(14)....         --              --              --         10,877       (5,277)(2)          --
Amortization of
  intangibles...............      3,378             928(6)        4,306         11,823           --          (3,684)(6)
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
        Total operating
          expenses..........    205,626            (155)        205,471        443,890      (24,934)        (18,232)
        Operating profit....     28,867             155          29,022         26,181        7,790          16,834
Interest expense............      9,677          (5,216)(7)       4,461         26,485           --          12,189(8)
Interest income and other...       (238)             --            (238)            --           --              --
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
        Earnings before
          income taxes......     19,428           5,371          24,799           (304)       7,790           4,645
Income tax expense..........      8,327           2,148(10)      10,475            664           --           6,889(11)
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
        Net earnings
          (loss)............     11,101           3,223          14,324           (968)       7,790          (2,244)
Preferred dividends.........         --              --              --             --           --           4,898(13)
                               --------        --------        --------       --------     --------       ---------
 
        Earnings (loss)
          allocable to
          common
          stockholders......   $ 11,101        $  3,223        $ 14,324       $   (968)    $  7,790       $  (7,142)
                               ========        ========        ========       ========     ========       =========
 
Basic earnings per
  share(15):
  Earnings per share........                                   $    .60
                                                               ========
  Weighted average common
    shares outstanding......                                     23,964
                                                               ========
 
Diluted earnings per
  share(15):
  Earnings per share........                                   $    .59
                                                               ========
  Weighted average common
    and common equivalent
    shares outstanding......                                     24,212
                                                               ========
Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges(16)...............                                        3.9x
                                                               ========
 
<CAPTION>
 
                              ACQUISITIONS     OFFERING     PRO FORMA
                               PRO FORMA      ADJUSTMENTS   COMBINED
                              ------------    -----------   ---------
<S>                           <C>             <C>           <C>
Revenues
  Store
    Rentals and fees........    $628,770         $  --      $628,770
    Merchandise sales.......      36,505            --        36,505
    Other...................         281            --           281
  Franchise
    Merchandise sales.......      17,061            --        17,061
    Royalty income and
      fees..................       3,405            --         3,405
                                --------         -----      --------
        Total revenues......     686,022            --       686,022
Operating expenses
  Direct store expenses
    Depreciation of rental
      merchandise...........     168,911            --       168,911
    Cost of merchandise
      sold..................      25,868            --        25,868
    Salaries and other
      expenses..............     346,584            --       346,584
Franchise cost of
  merchandise sold..........      16,386            --        16,386
General and administrative
  expenses..................      30,401            --        30,401
Indemnified litigation
  expenses..................          --            --            --
Nonrecurring charges(14)....       5,600            --         5,600
Amortization of
  intangibles...............      12,445            --        12,445
                                --------         -----      --------
        Total operating
          expenses..........     606,195            --       606,195
        Operating profit....      79,827            --        79,827
Interest expense............      43,135          (259)(9)    42,876
Interest income and other...        (238)           --          (238)
                                --------         -----      --------
        Earnings before
          income taxes......      36,930           259        37,189
Income tax expense..........      18,028           104(12)    18,132
                                --------         -----      --------
        Net earnings
          (loss)............      18,902           155        19,057
Preferred dividends.........       4,898            --         4,898
                                --------         -----      --------
        Earnings (loss)
          allocable to
          common
          stockholders......    $ 14,004         $ 155      $ 14,159
                                ========         =====      ========
Basic earnings per
  share(15):
  Earnings per share........    $    .58                    $    .59
                                ========                    ========
  Weighted average common
    shares outstanding......      23,964                      23,964
                                ========                    ========
Diluted earnings per
  share(15):
  Earnings per share........    $    .56                    $    .57
                                ========                    ========
  Weighted average common
    and common equivalent
    shares outstanding......      33,563                      33,563
                                ========                    ========
Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges(16)...............         1.7x                        1.7x
                                ========                    ========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying notes to Unaudited Pro Forma combined Statement of Operations
 
                                       56
<PAGE>   57
 
         NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                         SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1998
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
(1) The following historical combined statement of operations of Renters Choice
    and Central Rents for the six months ended June 30, 1998 has been derived
    from the unaudited financial statements of the respective entities:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            RCI AND
                                                                         CENTRAL RENTS
                                                              CENTRAL     HISTORICAL
                                                     RCI      RENTS(A)     COMBINED
                                                   --------   --------   -------------
    <S>                                            <C>        <C>        <C>
    Revenues
      Store
         Rentals and fees........................  $163,443   $38,693      $202,136
         Merchandise sales.......................    10,513     2,254        12,767
         Other...................................       281        --           281
      Franchise
         Merchandise sales.......................    17,061        --        17,061
         Royalty income and fees.................     2,248        --         2,248
                                                   --------   -------      --------
              Total revenues.....................   193,546    40,947       234,493
    Operating expenses
      Store expenses
         Depreciation of rental merchandise......    33,839    11,422        45,261
         Cost of merchandise sold................     8,301     1,974        10,275
         Salaries and other expenses.............    95,287        --        95,287
      Franchise cost of merchandise sold.........    16,386        --        16,386
      General and administrative expenses........     7,194    27,845        35,039
      Amortization of intangibles................     3,271       107         3,378
                                                   --------   -------      --------
              Total operating expenses...........   164,278    41,348       205,626
              Operating profit (loss)............    29,268      (401)       28,867
    Interest expense.............................     1,555     8,122         9,677
    Interest income..............................      (238)       --          (238)
                                                   --------   -------      --------
              Earnings (loss) before income
                taxes............................    27,951    (8,523)       19,428
    Income tax expense (benefit).................    11,566    (3,239)        8,327
                                                   --------   -------      --------
              Net earnings (loss)................  $ 16,385   $(5,284)     $ 11,101
                                                   ========   =======      ========
    Basic earnings per share:
      Earnings per share.........................  $    .66
                                                   ========
      Weighted average common shares
         outstanding.............................    24,954
                                                   ========
    Diluted earnings per share:
      Earnings per share.........................  $    .65
                                                   ========
      Weighted average common shares
         outstanding.............................    25,202
                                                   ========
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
     (a) The Central Rents information above reflects their operations for the
         period (January 1, 1998 through May 28, 1998) prior to the acquisition
         by Renters Choice.
 
                                       57
<PAGE>   58
                NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT
                          OF OPERATIONS -- (CONTINUED)
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
(2) Reflects the elimination of Rent-A-Center's Non-RTO Businesses (including
    nonrecurring charges of $5,277 as discussed in Note (14)), including used
    automobiles retailing, credit retailing and check cashing businesses, which
    had combined revenue of $17.1 million.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     INCREASE (DECREASE)
                                     ----------------------------------------------------
                                                                 STORE
                                     RENTALS    DEPRECIATION   EXPENSES     GENERAL AND
                                     AND FEES    OF RENTAL     SALARIES    ADMINISTRATIVE
                                     REVENUE    MERCHANDISE    AND OTHER      EXPENSES
                                     --------   ------------   ---------   --------------
    <S>                              <C>        <C>            <C>         <C>
    Reclassification of
      Rent-A-Center store expenses
      to conform with RCI's
      presentation.................  $    --      $    --      $232,107      $(232,107)
    Reclassification Rent-A-Center
      volume and cash discounts
      from purchases to conform
      with RCI's presentation......   (1,398)      (1,398)           --             --
    Reclassification of
      Rent-A-Center advertising
      rebates as a reduction in
      store expenses to conform
      with RCI's presentation......       --           --        (4,158)         4,158
    Elimination of income related
      to a rebate of management
      fees from Thorn plc..........       --           --            --          2,900
                                     -------      -------      --------      ---------
              Total................   (1,398)      (1,398)      227,949       (225,049)
    Elimination of duplicate
      corporate overhead and
      regional management
      expenses:(a)
      Corporate overhead
         Salaries and benefits.....       --           --            --         (8,700)
         Administrative expenses...       --           --            --           (500)
      Regional management
         expenses..................       --           --        (1,250)            --
                                     -------      -------      --------      ---------
              Total................       --           --        (1,250)        (9,200)
                                     -------      -------      --------      ---------
                                     $(1,398)     $(1,398)     $226,699      $(234,249)
                                     =======      =======      ========      =========
</TABLE>
 
                                       58
<PAGE>   59
                NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT
                          OF OPERATIONS -- (CONTINUED)
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
(3) Represents six months of the annual cost savings described in Note (3)(a) to
    the Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Statement of Operations for the year ended
    December 31, 1997.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            INCREASE (DECREASE)
                            (4)                          --------------------------
                                                           STORE
                                                         EXPENSES     GENERAL AND
                                                         SALARIES    ADMINISTRATIVE
                                                         AND OTHER      EXPENSES
                                                         ---------   --------------
    <S>                                                  <C>         <C>
    Reclassification of Central Rents other store
      expenses to conform with RCI's presentation......   $24,514       $(24,514)
    Elimination of duplicate corporate overhead and
      additional field expenses as a result of the
      Central Rents acquisition........................        84         (1,167)
                                                          -------       --------
                                                          $24,598       $(25,681)
                                                          =======       ========
</TABLE>
 
(5) Elimination of litigation expense relating to Minnesota and Pennsylvania
    class action litigation indemnified by seller as part of the acquisition of
    Rent-A-Center.
 
(6) Reversal of historical intangible amortization and recording of the pro
    forma intangible amortization required as a result of the acquisition of
    Central Rents and the acquisition of Rent-A-Center, using estimated useful
    lives of 5 years for the noncompete agreement (Central Rents), and 30 years
    for excess costs over fair market value of net assets acquired:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              CENTRAL
                                                               RENTS     THORN
                                                              -------   --------
    <S>                                                       <C>       <C>
    Reversal of historical intangible amortization recorded
      by respective entities................................  $ (107)   $(11,823)
    Reversal of historical intangible amortization relating
      to the acquisition of Central Rents recorded by
      Renters Choice from the acquisition date through June
      30, 1998..............................................    (207)         --
    Pro forma intangible amortization for six months........   1,242       8,139
                                                              ------    --------
                                                              $  928    $ (3,684)
                                                              ======    ========
</TABLE>
 
                                       59
<PAGE>   60
                NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT
                          OF OPERATIONS -- (CONTINUED)
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
<TABLE>
<S>  <C>                                                           <C>
(7)  Change in interest expense for six months as a result of
       borrowings on the existing revolving credit agreement used
       to finance the acquisition of Central Rents:
                                                                   $ 3,548
     Borrowings of $101.4 million at 7%, for six months, on the
       existing revolving credit agreement used to finance the
       acquisition of Central Rents..............................
                                                                    (8,122)
     Elimination of historical interest expense for Central
       Rents.....................................................
                                                                      (642)
     Elimination of historical interest expense recorded by
       Renters Choice from the acquisition date through June 30,
       1998, relating to the financing of Central Acquisition....
                                                                   -------
                                                                   $(5,216)
                                                                   =======
</TABLE>
 
(8) Net adjustment to interest expense for six months as a result of the
    issuance of debt to complete the acquisition of Rent-A-Center:
 
<TABLE>
    <S>                                                           <C>
    Senior Credit Facilities:
      $120 million Term Loan A at an annual interest rate of
         7.95%..................................................  $  4,770
      $270 million Term Loan B at an annual interest rate of
         8.20%..................................................    11,070
      $330 million Term Loan C at an annual interest rate of
         8.45%..................................................    13,943
      Annual commitment fee of 0.50% applied to the $120 million
         unused balance of the Revolving Credit Facility........       300
      Annual 2.50% fee applied to the Letter of Credit
         Facility...............................................     1,528
    $175 million Senior Subordinated Facility at an annual
      interest rate of 11.625%..................................    10,172
                                                                  --------
    Cash interest expense.......................................    41,783
    Amortization of deferred financing costs(a).................     1,314
                                                                  --------
    Pro forma interest expense for the acquisitions.............    43,097
    Interest expense relating to existing Renters Choice debt
      not refinanced............................................        38
                                                                  --------
    Pre-Offering pro forma interest expense.....................    43,135
    Less: Renters Choice and Central Rents pro forma combined
      interest expense plus Rent-A-Center historical interest
      expense...................................................   (30,946)
                                                                  --------
    Pre-Offering net interest expense adjustment................  $ 12,189
                                                                  ========
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
     (a) Deferred financing costs are amortized over the term of the related
         debt (ten years for the Senior Subordinated Facility, six years for the
         Term Loan A, seven and one-half years for Term Loan B, eight and
         one-half years for Term Loan C, and six years for both the Revolving
         Credit and Letter of Credit Facilities).
 
     A change of 0.125% in the assumed interest rates would result in a $.6
     million change in pro forma interest expense for the six months ended June
     30, 1998.
 
                                       60
<PAGE>   61
                NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT
                          OF OPERATIONS -- (CONTINUED)
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
(9) Net adjustments to interest expense for six months as a result of the
    Offering:
 
<TABLE>
    <S>                                                           <C>
    Issuance of Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 -- $175,000
      at 11.0%..................................................  $  9,625
    Amortization of related deferred financing costs............       288
    Repayment of Senior Subordinated Facility -- $175,000 at
      11.625%...................................................   (10,172)
                                                                  --------
                                                                  $   (259)
                                                                  ========
</TABLE>
 
(10) Income tax expense adjustment related to the effects of the Central Rents
     pro forma adjustments at a 40% effective tax rate.
 
(11) Income tax expense adjustment related to the effects of the pro forma
     adjustments based upon an assumed composite income tax rate of 40% applied
     to combined pro forma earnings before income taxes, adjusted for
     nondeductible goodwill amortization of $8.1 million related to the
     acquisition of Rent-A-Center.
 
(12) Income tax expense adjustment related to the effects of the Offering
     adjustments, at a 40% effective tax rate.
 
(13) Six months of in-kind dividends at 3.75% per annum on the $260 million of
     redeemable convertible preferred stock issued to finance a portion of the
     acquisition of Rent-A-Center. For the first five years subsequent to
     issuance, Renters Choice has the option to pay the quarterly dividends in
     cash or in-kind with the issuance of additional redeemable convertible
     preferred stock. RCI's ability to pay the dividends in cash will be subject
     to restrictions under the Senior Credit Facilities and Senior Subordinated
     Notes. Dividends reflected herein are assumed to be paid in-kind with the
     issuance of additional redeemable convertible preferred stock.
 
(14) Nonrecurring charges relate to Rent-A-Center's discontinued Non-RTO
     Businesses, the closing of certain non-performing RTO stores, and
     reorganization of certain administrative support functions aggregating
     approximately $9.8 million and approximately $1.1 million related primarily
     to Rent-A-Center's writedown of cellular phone inventory.
 
(15) Weighted average common shares outstanding for both basic and diluted
     earnings per share were decreased by 990,099 to give pro forma effect of
     the repurchase of $25 million of Renters Choice common stock at $25.25 per
     share from RCI's Chief Executive Officer. Weighted average common shares
     outstanding for diluted earnings per share were increased by 9,350,957 to
     reflect the conversion of the redeemable convertible preferred stock to
     Renters Choice common stock at a conversion price of $27.935 per share. For
     the six months ended June 30, 1998, the conversion of the redeemable
     convertible preferred stock is dilutive; therefore, preferred dividends of
     $4,898 were added to earnings allocable to common stockholders when
     computing diluted earnings per share.
 
                                       61
<PAGE>   62
                NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED STATEMENT
                          OF OPERATIONS -- (CONTINUED)
                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
(16) In calculating the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings consist of
     income before income taxes plus fixed charges (excluding capitalized
     interest). Fixed charges consist of interest expense (which includes
     amortization of deferred financing costs) whether expensed or capitalized
     and one-fourth of rental expense, deemed representative of that portion of
     rental expense estimated to be attributable to interest.
 
                                       62
<PAGE>   63
 
                              RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
 
                       SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA
 
The selected historical financial data for the Company as of and for each of the
five years in the period ended December 31, 1997, have been derived from the
Company's consolidated financial statements which have been audited and reported
upon by Grant Thornton LLP. The selected historical financial data for the
Company as of and for the six months ended June 30, 1997 and 1998 have been
derived from the Company's unaudited consolidated financial statements which
were prepared on the same basis as the Company's audited financial statements
and include, in the opinion of the Company's management, all adjustments
necessary to present fairly the information presented for such interim periods.
This information should be read in conjunction with the Company's audited
consolidated financial statements and notes thereto included herein,
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations," and other financial information included elsewhere in this
Prospectus. Because of the significant growth of the Company from acquisitions,
the historical results of operations, its period-to-period comparisons of such
results and certain financial data may not be comparable, meaningful or
indicative of future results.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                             YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,                   JUNE 30, 1997
                                --------------------------------------------------   -------------------
                                1993(1)   1994(1)     1995       1996       1997       1997       1998
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                                        (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                             <C>       <C>       <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
STATEMENTS OF EARNINGS DATA:
Total revenue.................  $53,212   $74,385   $133,289   $237,965   $331,541   $155,389   $193,546
Direct store expenses
  Depreciation of rental
  merchandise.................   11,626    15,614     29,640     42,978     57,223     27,510     33,839
  Other store expenses........   29,576    40,701     74,966    124,934    173,823     82,751    103,588
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                 41,202    56,315    104,606    167,912    231,046    110,261    137,427
Franchise operating
  expense(2)..................       --        --         --     24,010     35,841     14,726     16,386
General and administrative
  expenses....................    2,151     2,809      5,766     10,111     13,304      6,773      7,194
Amortization of intangibles...    5,304     6,022      3,109      4,891      5,412      2,649      3,271
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
        Total operating
          expenses............   48,657    65,146    113,481    206,924    285,603    134,409    164,278
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
        Operating profit......    4,555     9,239     19,808     31,041     45,938     20,980     29,268
Interest expense..............    1,817     2,160      2,202        606      2,194      1,021      1,555
Interest income...............       --        --       (890)      (667)      (304)      (432)      (238)
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
  Earnings before income
    taxes.....................    2,738     7,079     18,496     31,102     44,048     20,391     27,951
Income tax expense............      937     1,600      7,784     13,076     18,170      8,622     11,566
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
        Net earnings..........  $ 1,801   $ 5,479   $ 10,712   $ 18,026   $ 25,878   $ 11,769   $ 16,385
                                                    ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
Basic earnings per share......                      $    .52   $    .73   $   1.04   $    .47   $    .66
                                                    ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
Diluted earnings per share....                      $    .52   $    .72   $   1.03   $    .47   $    .65
                                                    ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
Depreciation and
  amortization(3).............  $ 6,164   $ 7,207   $  5,239   $  8,571   $ 11,013   $  5,158   $  6,547
Capital expenditures(4).......    1,489     1,715      3,473      8,187     10,446      4,755      5,758
Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges(5)..................      2.1x      3.2x       5.1x       7.9x       6.7x       6.6x       6.7x
</TABLE>
 
                                       63
<PAGE>   64
                              RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
 
               SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA -- (CONTINUED)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                             YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,                   JUNE 30, 1997
                                --------------------------------------------------   -------------------
                                1993(1)   1994(1)     1995       1996       1997       1997       1998
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                                        (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                             <C>       <C>       <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA (END OF
  PERIOD):
Cash and cash equivalents.....  $ 1,359   $ 1,441   $ 35,321   $  5,920   $  4,744   $  6,446   $ 23,347
Rental merchandise, net.......   20,672    28,096     64,240     95,110    112,759    110,260    148,432
        Total assets..........   34,813    36,959    147,294    174,467    208,868    205,330    335,838
        Total debt............   27,592    23,383     40,850     18,993     27,172     39,086    128,235
        Total stockholders'
          equity..............    4,168     9,286     96,484    125,503    152,753    137,676    170,343
OPERATING DATA:
Number of stores (end of
  period).....................      112       114        325        423        504        491        683
Average annual revenue per
  store(6)....................  $   591   $   653   $    626   $    608   $    610   $    604   $    653
Comparable store revenue
  growth(7)...................     11.1%     10.8%      18.1%       3.8%       8.1%       8.9%       9.3%
Revenues:
  Store revenue
    Rentals and fees..........  $51,162   $70,590   $126,264   $198,486   $275,344   $130,150   $163,443
    Merchandise sales.........    1,678     3,470      6,383     10,604     14,125      7,457     10,513
    Other.....................      372       325        642        687        679        339         28
  Franchise revenue
    Merchandise sales.........       --        --         --     25,229     37,385     15,461     17,061
    Royalty income and fees...       --        --         --      2,959      4,008      1,982      2,248
                                -------   -------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
        Total revenue.........  $53,212   $74,385   $133,289   $237,965   $331,541   $155,389   $193,546
                                =======   =======   ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
</TABLE>
 
                                       64
<PAGE>   65
 
      NOTES TO SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA OF RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
 
(1) In each of the periods presented ending prior to January 1, 1995, we
    operated as an S corporation under Subchapter S of the Internal Revenue Code
    and comparable provisions of certain state tax laws. Accordingly, prior to
    January 1, 1995, we were not subject to federal income taxation. Earnings
    per share are not provided for periods prior to January 1, 1995, because
    operating results for those periods are not comparable.
 
(2) Prior to our acquisition of ColorTyme in May 1996, we conducted no franchise
    operations. Therefore, we presented franchise operation financial
    information for periods beginning with the year ended December 31, 1996.
 
(3) This amount excludes depreciation of rental merchandise.
 
(4) We exclude purchase of rental merchandise.
 
(5) In calculating the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings consist of
    income before income taxes plus fixed charges (excluding capitalized
    interest). Fixed charges consist of interest expense (which includes
    amortization of deferred financing costs) whether expensed or capitalized
    and one-fourth of rental expense, which we deem representative of that
    portion of rental expense estimated to be attributable to interest.
 
(6) We annualized the revenues for the six months ended June 30, 1997 and 1998.
 
(7) Comparable store revenue growth for each period presented includes revenues
    only of stores open throughout the full period and the comparable prior
    period.
 
                                       65
<PAGE>   66
 
                                RENT-A-CENTER, INC.
 
                         SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA
 
The selected historical financial data for Rent-A-Center as of and for each of
the three years in the period ended March 31, 1998, have been derived from
Rent-A-Center's audited consolidated financial statements. The summary
historical financial data for Rent-A-Center as of and for the three months ended
June 30, 1997 and 1998 have been derived from Rent-A-Center's unaudited
consolidated financial statements which were prepared on the same basis as
Rent-A-Center's audited financial statements and include, in the opinion of
Rent-A-Center's management, all adjustments necessary to present fairly the
information presented for such interim periods. This information should be read
in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements of Rent-A-Center and
notes thereto included herein, "Management's Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations," and the other financial
information included elsewhere in this Prospectus.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                      THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                    YEARS ENDED MARCH 31,                  JUNE 30,
                             ------------------------------------   -----------------------
                                1996         1997         1998         1997         1998
                             ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
                                                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>
STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
  DATA:(1)
Total revenue..............  $  897,927   $  926,871   $  904,004   $  225,641   $  235,421
Cost of sales..............      43,345       39,793       45,574        8,524       12,503
Depreciation and
  amortization
  Rental merchandise.......     257,383      260,433      244,572       62,852       62,886
  Other....................      52,236       59,085       56,869       14,598       14,532
Salaries, wages and fringe
  benefits.................     255,768      272,242      279,796       68,488       72,960
Other operating expenses...     202,577      233,015      207,460       50,654       52,653
Nonrecurring charges(2)....      12,600           --       14,392           --           --
                             ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
         Total operating
           expenses........     823,909      864,568      848,663      205,116      215,534
                             ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
         Operating
           profit..........      74,018       62,303       55,341       20,525       19,887
Interest expense, net......      80,207       52,651       46,184       10,825       11,191
Other (income) expense.....         101         (254)         (88)         (81)          72
                             ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
         Earnings (loss)
           before income
           taxes...........      (6,290)       9,906        9,245        9,781        8,624
Income tax expense.........       6,771       13,880        7,760        5,950        5,344
                             ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
Net earnings (loss)........  $  (13,061)  $   (3,974)  $    1,485   $    3,831   $    3,280
                             ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========
RTO FINANCIAL DATA:(3)
Depreciation and
  amortization(4)..........  $   52,236   $   59,085   $   56,869   $   14,598   $   14,532
Capital expenditures(5)....      44,642       32,306       38,077
</TABLE>
 
                                       66
<PAGE>   67
                              RENT-A-CENTER, INC.
 
               SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA -- (CONTINUED)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                      THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                    YEARS ENDED MARCH 31,                  JUNE 30,
                             ------------------------------------   -----------------------
                                1996         1997         1998         1997         1998
                             ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
                                                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA (END OF
  PERIOD):
Cash and cash
  equivalents..............  $   19,225   $   26,077   $   23,755   $   37,399   $   27,486
Rental merchandise, net....     304,164      276,012      292,965      268,564      303,682
Total assets...............   1,242,211    1,108,280    1,079,109    1,086,784    1,085,796
Total debt.................   1,042,729      714,235      714,223      714,827      714,663
Total stockholder's
  equity...................      88,529      239,026      236,483      242,857      239,763
RTO OPERATING DATA:
Number of stores (end of
  period)..................       1,306        1,367        1,384        1,392        1,404
Average annual revenue per
  store(6).................  $      744   $      694   $      639   $      652   $      674
Revenues:
  Store revenue
    Rentals and fees.......  $  827,935   $  864,256   $  831,025   $  212,448   $  219,720
    Merchandise sales......      64,628       60,249       46,337       12,611       15,141
  Franchise royalty
    income.................       5,364        2,366        2,266          582          560
                             ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
         Total RTO
           revenue.........  $  897,927   $  926,871   $  879,628   $  225,641   $  235,421
                             ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                       67
<PAGE>   68
 
          NOTES TO SELECTED HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA OF RENT-A-CENTER
 
(1) As part of the acquisition of Rent-A-Center, we acquired several Non-RTO
    Businesses including used automobile retailing, credit retailing and check
    cashing businesses which began generating revenues in fiscal 1998. We sold
    AdvantEDGE Auto, Inc. in August 1998 for $4.0 million and intend to
    discontinue the operations of the remaining Non-RTO Businesses. For the
    fiscal year ended 1998, the Non-RTO Businesses generated revenue of $20.2
    million and a net loss before income taxes of $5.2 million.
 
(2) Nonrecurring charges in 1996 relate to the consolidation of corporate and
    field offices and reductions in the number of employees. In 1998,
    nonrecurring charges represents (i) approximately $12.3 million in charges
    related to discontinued Non-RTO Businesses, closure of certain nonperforming
    RTO stores and reorganized administrative support functions, and (ii)
    approximately $2.1 million related primarily to Rent-A-Center's writedown of
    cellular phone inventory.
 
(3) We combined the RTO financial data from the historical financial results of
    Rent-A-Center with appropriate adjustments to eliminate the effect of
    Non-RTO Businesses.
 
(4) We excluded depreciation of rental merchandise.
 
(5) We excluded purchases of rental merchandise.
 
(6) Our revenues for the three months ended June 30, 1997 and 1998 have been
    annualized.
 
                                       68
<PAGE>   69
 
                      MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
                OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
The following discussion and analysis of the results of operations of each of
the Company and Rent-A-Center covers a period before the consummation of the
acquisition of Rent-A-Center, the issuance of the Preferred Stock and the
Offering. Accordingly, the discussion and analysis of such periods does not
reflect the significant impact the acquisition of Rent-A-Center, the issuance of
the Preferred Stock and the Offering will have on the Company. See "Risk
Factors," "Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial Information" and "-- Liquidity
and Capital Resources of the Company Following the Exchange Offer" for further
discussion relating to the impact on the Company. The following discussion
should be read in conjunction with "Selected Historical Financial
Information -- the Company," "Rent-A-Center, Inc. Selected Historical Financial
Information" and the Financial Statements, including the notes thereto,
incorporated by reference herein.
 
GENERAL
 
The Company is the largest operator in the United States RTO industry with
approximately 25% market share (based on store count). In June 1998, the Company
entered into an agreement to acquire Rent-A-Center, Inc. (f/k/a Thorn Americas,
Inc.) with Thorn plc, a UK-based company, to purchase Rent-A-Center, an indirect
wholly-owned subsidiary of Thorn plc (the "Rent-A-Center Acquisition"). Proceeds
from the Senior Credit Facilities, Senior Subordinated Facility and the sale of
the Convertible Preferred Stock were used to fund the Rent-A-Center Acquisition,
refinance the Company's pre-Acquisition indebtedness and repurchase $25 million
of the Company's common stock held by J. Ernest Talley. The Company's stores
offer home electronics, appliances, and furniture and accessories under flexible
rental purchase agreements that allow its customers to obtain ownership of the
merchandise at the conclusion of the agreed upon rental period.
 
The Company has developed a plan to integrate the operations of Rent-A-Center
with the Company's business practices. The main initiatives of this integration
plan are to (i) eliminate duplicative general and administrative expenses, (ii)
eliminate Rent-A-Center's distribution network, (iii) implement the Company's
management practices into Rent-A-Center's stores, (iv) increase the number of
higher margin products available for rent while eliminating lower margin
products, and (v) divest non-core assets. The Company believes its integration
plan will be fully implemented within 18-24 months and will yield net annual
cost savings of $30 million. In addition to the anticipated net cost savings
from its implementation plan, the Company anticipates additional improvement in
sales and profitability as a direct result of the investment the Company intends
to make in Rent-A-Center's stores.
 
As part of the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, the Company acquired the Non-RTO
Businesses which began generating revenues in fiscal 1998. The Company intends
to discontinue the operations of the Non-RTO Businesses. For the fiscal year
ended March 31, 1998, the Non-RTO Businesses generated revenue of $20.2 million
and a net loss before income taxes of $5.2 million. Subsequent to the
Rent-A-Center Acquisition, the Company sold all of the outstanding stock of
AdvantEDGE Auto, Inc. for approximately $4.0 million.
 
                                       69
<PAGE>   70
 
Since 1993, the Company's store count has grown from 27 to 2,126 through
acquisitions and new store openings. In May 1998, the Company completed the
acquisition of Central Rents, Inc. (the "Central Acquisition"), acquiring
substantially all of the assets of an underperforming RTO operator which
expanded the Company's presence in a region of the country, the Southwest, which
the Company had strategically targeted for expansion. The Company expects to
generate annual general and administrative cost savings as a result of the
Central Acquisition of $2.6 million. These cost savings will be derived
primarily from the closing of Central Rents' corporate headquarters and the
elimination of duplicative corporate and administrative functions. In addition
to these general and administrative cost reductions, the Company anticipates
that it will gradually bring the store operating performance of Central Rents in
line with its own store margins within 24-30 months.
 
The Company operates on a December 31 fiscal year end. Rent-A-Center's
historical results of operations, which were based upon a March 31 fiscal year
end, have not been restated to a December 31 year end for the purpose of any pro
forma financial presentation of the Company's historical operations.
 
COMPONENTS OF INCOME
 
Revenue. The Company collects nonrefundable rental payments and fees in advance,
generally on a weekly or monthly basis. This revenue is recognized when
collected. Rental purchase agreements generally include a discounted early
purchase option. Amounts received upon sales of merchandise pursuant to such
options, and upon the sale of used merchandise, are recognized as revenue when
the merchandise is sold.
 
Franchise Revenue. Revenue from the sale of rental equipment is recognized upon
shipment of the equipment to the franchisee. Franchise fee revenue is recognized
upon completion of substantially all services and satisfaction of all material
conditions required under the terms of the franchise agreement.
 
Depreciation of Rental Merchandise. Except for tax purposes, the Company
depreciates its rental merchandise using the income forecasting method. The
income forecasting method of depreciation does not consider salvage value and
does not allow the depreciation of rental merchandise during periods when it is
not generating rental revenue. For periods prior to 1996, the Company used the
income forecasting method to calculate depreciation of its rental merchandise
for tax purposes. However, in 1996, the Company began using the MACRS method of
depreciation using a five-year class life for its rental purchase merchandise.
In August 1997, the Internal Revenue Service issued a revenue ruling requiring
rental purchase companies to use MACRS, with a three year class life for all
purchases after August 5, 1997. The Company began application of the ruling for
all purchases effective August 5, 1997, and thereafter.
 
Cost of Merchandise Sold. Cost of merchandise sold represents the book value net
of accumulated depreciation of rental merchandise at time of sale.
 
Salaries and Other Expenses. Salaries and other expenses include all salaries
and wages paid to store level employees and regional management salaries, travel
and occupancy, including any related benefits and taxes, as well as all store
level general and administrative expenses and selling, advertising, occupancy,
nonrental depreciation and other operating expenses.
 
                                       70
<PAGE>   71
 
General and Administrative Expenses. General and administrative expenses include
all corporate overhead expenses related to the Company's headquarters such as
salaries, taxes and benefits, occupancy, administrative and other operating
expenses, as well as Regional Vice Presidents' salaries, travel and office
expenses.
 
                      RESULTS OF OPERATIONS -- THE COMPANY
 
The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, certain historical
Statement of Earnings data as a percentage of total revenue from stores and
total revenue from franchise operations.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  SIX MONTHS                             SIX MONTHS
                              YEARS ENDED            ENDED           YEARS ENDED            ENDED
                             DECEMBER 31,          JUNE 30,          DECEMBER 31,         JUNE 30,
                         ---------------------   -------------   --------------------   -------------
                         1995    1996    1997    1997    1998    1995   1996    1997    1997    1998
                         -----   -----   -----   -----   -----   ----   -----   -----   -----   -----
                              (COMPANY OWNED STORES ONLY)               (FRANCHISE OPERATIONS)
<S>                      <C>     <C>     <C>     <C>     <C>     <C>    <C>     <C>     <C>     <C>
Revenue
  Rentals and fees.....   94.7%   94.7%   94.9%   93.3%   93.8%   --%      --%     --%     --%     --%
  Merchandise Sales....    4.8     5.0     4.9     6.4     6.0    --     89.6    90.3    88.4    88.4
  Other/Royalties......    0.5     0.3     0.2     0.3     0.2    --     10.4     9.7    11.6    11.6
                         -----   -----   -----   -----   -----    --    -----   -----   -----   -----
                         100.0%  100.0%  100.0%  100.0%  100.0%   --%   100.0%  100.0%  100.0%  100.0%
                         =====   =====   =====   =====   =====    ==    =====   =====   =====   =====
Operating Expenses.....
Direct store
  expenses.............
Depreciation of rental
  merchandise..........   22.2%   20.5%   19.7%   19.8%   19.3%   --%      --%     --%     --%     --%
Cost of merchandise
  sold.................    3.8     3.9     3.9     4.6     4.8    --     85.0    86.6    84.7    84.9
Salaries and other
  expenses.............   52.5    55.6    56.0    56.0    54.8    --       --      --      --      --
                         -----   -----   -----   -----   -----    --    -----   -----   -----   -----
                          78.5    80.0    79.6    80.4    78.9    --     85.0    86.6    84.7    84.9
General and
  administrative
  expenses.............    4.3     3.8     3.8     3.7     3.3    --      7.7     5.3     7.8     7.2
Amortization of
  intangibles..........    2.3     2.3     1.7     2.0     1.8    --      0.6     1.0     1.5     0.9
                         -----   -----   -----   -----   -----    --    -----   -----   -----   -----
        Total operating
          expenses.....   85.1    86.1    85.1    86.1    84.0    --     93.3    92.9    94.0    93.0
                         -----   -----   -----   -----   -----    --    -----   -----   -----   -----
Operating profit.......   14.9    13.9    14.9    13.9    16.0    --      6.7     7.1     6.0     7.0
Interest expense/
  (income).............    1.0     0.1     0.8     0.7     0.9    --     (1.9)   (0.6)   (2.1)   (0.9)
                         -----   -----   -----   -----   -----    --    -----   -----   -----   -----
Earnings before income
  taxes................   13.9%   13.8%   14.1%   13.2%   15.1%   --%     8.6%    7.7%    8.1%    7.9%
                         =====   =====   =====   =====   =====    ==    =====   =====   =====   =====
</TABLE>
 
                                       71
<PAGE>   72
 
The Company has increased the number of stores owned from 27 at the beginning of
1993 to 2,126 at October 7, 1998. The following table shows the number of stores
opened, acquired and closed during 1993 through 1998.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   THE COMPANY
                        -----------------------------------------------------------------
                         BEGINNING
  FISCAL YEAR ENDED      OF PERIOD    NEW STORE      STORE        STORE     END OF PERIOD
     DECEMBER 31,       STORE COUNT   OPENINGS    ACQUISITIONS   CLOSINGS    STORE COUNT
  -----------------     -----------   ---------   ------------   --------   -------------
<S>                     <C>           <C>         <C>            <C>        <C>
1993..................       27           1             84          --            112
1994..................      112           2             --          --            114
1995..................      114           4            209          (2)           325
1996..................      325          13             94          (9)           423
1997..................      423          10             76          (5)           504
1998(1)...............      504           1          1,632         (11)         2,126
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
(1) Through October 7, 1998.
 
COMPARISON OF THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1998 AND 1997
 
Total revenue increased by $38.2 million, or 24.6%, to $193.5 million for 1998
from $155.4 million for 1997. The increase in total revenue was primarily
attributable to the inclusion of the 71 stores purchased (net of consolidation)
in 1997 as well as the Central Acquisition. Same store revenues increased by
$12.1 million, or 9.3% to $143.1 million for 1998 from $131.0 million in 1997.
Same store revenues represent those revenues earned in stores that were operated
by the Company for the entire six-month periods ending June 30, 1998 and 1997.
This improvement was primarily attributable to an increase in both the number of
items on rent and in revenue earned per item on rent.
 
Depreciation of rental merchandise increased by $6.3 million, or 23.0%, to $33.8
million for 1998 from $27.5 million for 1997. Depreciation of rental merchandise
expressed as a percent of total store rental and fee revenue decreased from
21.1% in 1997 to 20.7% in 1998. The decrease was primarily attributable to
higher rental rates on rental merchandise purchased after the 1995 acquisitions
and operational emphasis on increasing the rental life of inventory items.
 
Salaries and other expenses expressed as a percentage of total store revenue
decreased to 54.7% for 1998 from 55.9% for 1997. This decrease was attributable
to the increase in store revenues from the Central Acquisition, as well as the
same store base, and the Company has experienced some efficiencies in spreading
costs over a larger store base, in particular advertising costs and certain
service costs. General and administrative expenses expressed as a percent of
total revenue decreased from 4.4% in 1997 to 3.7% in 1998. This decrease was the
result of increased revenues from the 1997 acquisitions and the Central
Acquisition, allowing us to leverage our fixed and semi-fixed costs over the
larger revenue base.
 
Operating profit increased by $8.3 million, or 39.5%, to $29.3 million for 1998
from $21.0 million for 1997. This improvement was primarily attributable to an
increase in both the number of items on rent and in revenue earned per item on
rent, both in stores
 
                                       72
<PAGE>   73
 
acquired before 1995 and in stores acquired in the 1996 and 1997 acquisitions.
Net interest expense increased from $590,000 of interest expense in 1997 to $1.3
million of interest expense in 1998. The increased interest expense and debt
level relate primarily to the acquisition of Central Rents in May 1998. Net
earnings increased by $4.6 million, or 39.2%, to $16.4 million in 1998 from
$11.8 million in 1997. The improvement was a result of the increase in operating
profit described above.
 
COMPARISON OF THE THREE MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1998 AND 1997
 
Total revenue increased by $22.5 million, or 27.9%, to $103.3 million for 1998
from $80.8 million for 1997. The increase in total revenue was primarily
attributable to the inclusion of the 71 stores acquired in 1997 (net of
consolidation), as well as the Central Acquisition. Same store revenues
increased by 9.4%, from $70.2 million to $76.8 million. Same store revenues
represents those revenues earned in stores that were operated by the Company for
the entire three-month periods ending June 30, 1997 and 1998. This improvement
was primarily attributable to an increase in both the number of items on rent
and in revenue earned per item on rent.
 
Depreciation of rental merchandise increased by $3.9 million, or 27.3%, to $18.3
million for 1998 from $14.4 million for 1997. Depreciation of rental merchandise
expressed as a percent of total store rental and fee revenue decreased from
21.1% in 1997 to 20.8% in 1998. The decrease was primarily attributable to
higher rental rates on rental merchandise and operational emphasis on increasing
the rental life of inventory items.
 
Salaries and other expenses expressed as a percentage of total store revenue
decreased to 54.8% for 1998 from 55.8% for 1997 primarily as a result of
increased revenues in our 1996 acquisitions and 1997 acquisitions, as well as
the leveraging of our fixed and semi-fixed costs in these stores. General and
administrative expenses expressed as a percent of total revenue decreased from
4.5% in 1997 to 3.8% in 1998. This decrease was primarily the result of
increased revenues resulting from the Central Acquisition, allowing us to
leverage our fixed and semi-fixed costs over the larger revenue base.
 
Operating profit increased by $4.2 million, or 37.1% to $15.5 million for 1998
from $11.3 million for 1997. This improvement was attributable to the
efficiencies discussed above and the profit contribution from ColorTyme.
 
Net earnings increased by $2.2 million, or 34.2%, to $8.5 million in 1998 from
$6.3 million in 1997. The improvement was a result of the increase in operating
profit described above.
 
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
 
The Company's primary requirements for capital are the acquisition of existing
stores, the opening of new stores, the purchase of additional rental merchandise
and the replacement of rental merchandise which has been sold, charged-off or is
no longer suitable for rent. During the six months ended June 30, 1998, the
Company acquired 182 stores for an aggregate purchase price of $101.6 million,
all of which was paid in cash. The Company also opened 1 new store during the
first two quarters of 1998.
 
The Company purchased $54.0 million and $47.9 million of rental merchandise
during the six months ended June 30, 1998 and 1997, respectively.
 
                                       73
<PAGE>   74
 
For the six months ended June 30, 1998, cash provided by operating activities
increased by $12.3 million, from $11.0 million in 1997 to $23.3 million in 1998,
primarily due to increased net earnings and the timing of the payment of various
operating expenses. Cash used in investing activities increased by $76.0 million
from $31.0 million in 1997 to $107.0 million in 1998, principally related to the
greater number of stores acquired in 1998 as compared to the number of stores
acquired during the same period for 1997. Cash provided by financing activities
was $102.3 million for the six months ended June 30, 1998.
 
At June 30, 1998, the Company had in place a $140 million credit facility (the
"Prior Credit Facility") with a group of banks. Borrowings under the Prior
Credit Facility bore interest at a rate equal to the designated prime rate
(8 1/2% per annum at June 30, 1998) or 1.10% to 1.4% over LIBOR (5.625% at June
30, 1998) at the Company's option. At June 30, 1998, the average rate on
outstanding borrowings was 7.1%, and for the quarter the weighted average
interest rate under the Prior Credit Facility was 6.875%. Borrowings were
collateralized by a lien on substantially all of the assets of the Company. A
commitment fee equal to .20% to .30% of the unused portion of the term loan
facility was payable quarterly. The Prior Credit Facility included certain net
worth and fixed charge coverage requirements, as well as covenants which
restrict additional indebtedness and the disposition of assets not in the
ordinary course of business. On June 30, 1998, the outstanding borrowings under
this revolving credit agreement were $127.5 million.
 
As a result of the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, the Prior Credit Facility was
replaced by the $962 million Senior Secured Credit Facility and a $175 million
Senior Subordinated Credit Facility. The Company retired the Senior Subordinated
Credit Facility with the proceeds from the issuance of the Old Notes. The
Company believes that the Senior Credit Facility, the proceeds from the
Preferred Stock issuance, the Senior Subordinated Credit Facility (or the
proceeds from the Senior Subordinated Notes), along with its cash flows from
operations, will adequately fund the Company's operations and expansion plans
during 1998 and beyond.
 
During the next 18-24 months, the Company's central business strategy is to
successfully integrate the Rent-A-Center Acquisition and the Central Acquisition
into the Renters Choice system. Once completed, the Company intends to resume
its strategy to increase its store base and annual revenues and profits through
the opening of new stores, as well as opportunistic acquisitions. The Company
anticipates ample opportunities to increase its store base through its continued
participation in the industry consolidation and the possibility for increased
penetration and expansion of its existing customer base.
 
After the assimilation of the Rent-A-Center Acquisition and Central Acquisition,
the Company plans to accomplish its future growth through selective and
opportunistic acquisitions, with an increasing emphasis on new store
development. Typically, a newly opened rental store is profitable on a monthly
basis in the sixth to seventh month after its initial opening. Cumulatively, the
store will achieve break-even profitability in the twelfth to fifteenth month
after its initial opening. Total financing requirements of a typical new store
approximates $350,000, with roughly 80 to 85% of that amount related to the
purchase of rental merchandise inventory (both on-rent and idle). A newly opened
store will achieve results consistent with the Company's other mature stores
(stores that have been operating within the system for greater than two years)
by the end of its third year of operation. There can be no assurance that the
Company will be able to acquire any additional stores, or that any stores that
are acquired will be or will become profitable, nor
 
                                       74
<PAGE>   75
 
is there any assurance that the Company will open any new stores in the future,
or as to the number, location or profitability thereof.
 
COMPARISON OF YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996
 
Between January 1, 1997 and December 31, 1997 the Company acquired 76 stores
(five of which were subsequently consolidated with existing locations) in 18
separate transactions. The 1997 acquisitions were accounted for as purchases,
and accordingly, the operating results of the acquired operations have been
included in the results of operations of the Company since the respective dates
of acquisition. Primarily as a result of the 1997 Acquisitions, comparisons of
the Company's operating results for 1997 and 1996 may not be meaningful or
indicative of future results.
 
Revenues. Total revenue increased by $93.5 million, or 39.3%, to $331.5 million
for 1997 from $238.0 million for 1996. Store revenues increased $80.3 million,
or 38.3% to $290.1 million in 1997 from $209.8 million in 1996. The increase in
store revenue was primarily due to the inclusion of 76 stores acquired in 1997
and the full year impact of the 94 stores acquired in 1996. Store revenues also
increased as a result of the increase in same store revenue growth of 8.1%. Same
store revenues increased due to an increase in both the number of items on rent
and in revenue earned per item on rent. Franchise revenues increased $13.2
million, or 46.9% to $41.4 million from $28.2 million in 1996. This increase was
primarily due to the inclusion of the franchise operations for an entire year in
1997, compared to only eight months in 1996.
 
Depreciation of rental merchandise. Depreciation of rental merchandise increased
$14.2 million, or 33.0%, to $57.2 million for 1997 from $43.0 million for 1996.
Depreciation of rental merchandise as a percent of total store revenue decreased
to 19.7% for 1997 from 20.5% for 1996. The decrease in depreciation of rental
merchandise as a percent of revenue was primarily attributable to higher rental
rates on rental merchandise.
 
Salaries and other expenses. Salaries and other expenses as a percentage of
store revenue increased to 56.0% for 1997 from 55.6% for 1996. This increase was
primarily attributable to the increase in salaries for employees and other
expenses of the acquired stores immediately following the acquisitions.
Occupancy costs also increased as a percent of total store revenue due to the
relocation of certain stores acquired in 1996 and 1997 to locations that are
larger in square footage. Generally, revenue from these stores increased
gradually while the additional payroll and occupancy costs were incurred
immediately. The average square footage per store was approximately 4,150 at
December 31, 1996 as compared to 4,290 for 1997.
 
General and administrative expenses. General and administrative expenses
expressed as a percentage of total revenue decreased to 4.0% for 1997 from 4.2%
for 1996. Expressed as a percentage of store revenue only, general and
administrative expenses, exclusive of expenses relative to ColorTyme, were 3.8%
in both 1997 and 1996. Franchise general and administrative expenses as a
percentage of franchise revenue totaled 5.3% in 1997, down significantly from
7.7% in 1996. This decrease was primarily attributable to streamlining efforts
as overhead reductions were implemented in 1996 and 1997.
 
                                       75
<PAGE>   76
 
Operating profit. Operating profit increased by $14.9 million, or 48.1%, to
$45.9 million for 1997 from $31.0 million for 1996.
 
Net earnings. Net earnings increased by $7.9 million, or 43.9%, to $25.9 million
in 1997 from $18.0 million in 1996. The improvement was primarily attributable
to the increase in operating profit described above.
 
COMPARISON OF YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996 AND 1995
 
In May 1996, the Company completed the acquisition of ColorTyme, and between May
1996 and December 1996, the Company acquired a total of 94 additional stores.
The 1996 acquisitions were accounted for as purchases, and accordingly, the
operating results of the acquired operations have been included in the results
of operations of the Company since the respective dates of acquisition.
Primarily as a result of the 1996 Acquisitions on the Company's results of
operations, comparisons of the Company's operating results for 1996 and 1995 may
not be meaningful or indicative of future results.
 
Total revenues. Total revenue increased by $104.7 million, or 78.5%, to $238.0
million for 1996 from $133.3 million for 1995. Store revenues increased $76.5
million, 57.4% to $209.8 million in 1996 from $133.3 million in 1995. The
increase in store revenue was primarily due to the inclusion of stores acquired
in 1996 and the full year impact of the stores acquired in 1995. Store revenues
also increased as a result of the increase in same store revenue growth of 3.8%.
Some store revenues increased primarily due to an increase in both the number of
items on rent and in revenue per rental. Franchise revenue was $28.2 million in
1996.
 
Depreciation of rental merchandise. Depreciation of rental merchandise increased
by $13.4 million, or 45.3%, to $43.0 million for 1996 from $29.6 million for
1995. Depreciation of rental merchandise as a percent of total store revenue
decreased to 20.5% for 1996 from 22.2% for 1995. The decrease in depreciation of
rental merchandise as a percent of revenue was primarily attributable to higher
rental rates on rental merchandise.
 
Salaries and other expenses. Salaries and other expenses as a percentage of
store revenue increased to 55.6% for 1996 from 52.5% for 1995. This increase is
primarily attributable to the increase in salaries for employees and other
expenses of the acquired stores immediately following the acquisitions while
store revenue has increased gradually. Additionally, the Company increased its
advertising efforts during 1996 in the markets related to the stores acquired in
1996. Occupancy costs also increased as a percent of total store revenue due to
the relocation of certain stores acquired in 1996 to stores that are larger in
square footage. Revenue from these stores increased gradually while the
additional occupancy costs are incurred immediately. The average square footage
per store was approximately 3,800 at December 31, 1995 compared to 4,150 at
December 31, 1996.
 
General and administrative expenses. General and administrative expenses
expressed as a percentage of total revenue decreased to 4.2% for 1996 from 4.3%
for 1995. This relatively small decrease was primarily attributable to the
leveraging of corporate overhead expenses over a larger store and revenue base
offset by franchise general and administrative expenses incurred in 1996 for the
first year of operations. Franchise general and administrative expenses as a
percentage of franchise revenue totaled 7.7% in 1996. This increase was
 
                                       76
<PAGE>   77
 
offset by the decrease in corporate overhead for store operations in 1996, which
declined to 3.8% of store revenue in 1996 compared to 4.3% in 1995.
 
Operating profit. Operating profit increased by $11.2 million, or 56.6%, to
$31.0 million for 1996 from $19.8 million for 1995.
 
Net earnings. Net earnings increased by $7.3 million, or 68.2%, to $18.0 million
for 1996 from $10.7 million for 1995. The improvement was primarily attributable
to the increase in operating profit described above, as well as a reduction in
interest expense from 1995.
 
                     RESULTS OF OPERATIONS -- RENT-A-CENTER
 
The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, certain historical
Statement of Operations data as a percentage of total revenue.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    THREE MONTHS
                                         YEAR ENDED MARCH 31,      ENDED JUNE 30,
                                        -----------------------    --------------
                                        1996     1997     1998     1997     1998
                                        -----    -----    -----    -----    -----
<S>                                     <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>
Revenue
  RTO revenue.........................  100.0%   100.0%    97.3%    99.0%    96.6%
  Non-RTO revenue.....................     --       --      2.7      1.0      3.4
                                        -----    -----    -----    -----    -----
                                        100.0%   100.0%   100.0%   100.0%   100.0%
                                        =====    =====    =====    =====    =====
Operating Expenses
  Depreciation of rental
     merchandise......................   28.7%    28.1%    27.0%    27.9%    26.7%
  Amortization of intangibles.........    2.1      2.5      2.7      2.7      2.5
  Cost of merchandise sold............    4.8      4.3      5.0      3.8      5.3
  Salaries, wages and fringe
     benefits.........................   28.5     29.4     31.0     30.4     31.0
  Other...............................   26.3     29.0     26.8     26.1     26.1
  Restructuring charges...............    1.4       --      1.4       --       --
                                        -----    -----    -----    -----    -----
          Total operating expenses....   91.8     93.3     93.9     90.9     91.6
Operating profit......................    8.2      6.7      6.1      9.1      8.4
Interest expense/(income).............    8.9      5.6      5.1      4.8      4.7
                                        -----    -----    -----    -----    -----
Earnings (loss) before income taxes...   (0.7)%    1.1%     1.0%     4.3%     3.7%
                                        =====    =====    =====    =====    =====
</TABLE>
 
                                       77
<PAGE>   78
 
Rent-A-Center increased its owned stores from 1,006 at fiscal year end 1993 to
1,384 at fiscal year end 1998. The following table sets forth the number of
stores, opened, acquired and closed from 1994 through 1998.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       RAC
                         ----------------------------------------------------------------
      FISCAL YEAR        BEGINNING OF                                           END OF
         ENDED           PERIOD STORE   NEW STORE      STORE        STORE       PERIOD
       MARCH 31,            COUNT       OPENINGS    ACQUISITIONS   CLOSINGS   STORE COUNT
      -----------        ------------   ---------   ------------   --------   -----------
<S>                      <C>            <C>         <C>            <C>        <C>
1994...................     1,006          54            27          (10)        1,077
1995...................     1,077          32            12          (12)        1,109
1996...................     1,109          12           200          (15)        1,306
1997...................     1,306          19            64          (22)        1,367
1998...................     1,367          34            25          (42)        1,384(1)
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
(1) As of March 31, 1998, Rent-A-Center increased its store count by 25 to
    1,409, the number of stores acquired by Renters Choice pursuant to the
    acquisition of Rent-A-Center.
 
COMPARISON OF THREE MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1998 AND JUNE 30, 1997
 
Total revenue. Total revenues were $235.4 million for 1998 compared to $225.6
million for 1997, an increase of 4.3% or $9.8 million. The increase in revenues
was primarily attributable to an increase in the total rental agreements
outstanding, partially offset by a reduction in the average price charged per
rental agreement. The increase in the total rental agreements outstanding was
primarily the result of increases in the number of store locations, combined
with increases in agreements outstanding in existing stores resulting from
certain advertising promotions. Rent-A-Center ended the quarter ending June 30,
1998 with 1,404 store locations, up from 1,392 at June 30, 1997. The increase in
the number of stores since June 30, 1997 was partially offset by the impact of
the closing of 42 stores in the fourth quarter of fiscal 1998. The decrease in
the average price charged per rental agreement was principally due to a shift in
product mix toward less expensive items such as cellular phones and pagers, as
well as promotional pricing programs.
 
Depreciation of rental merchandise. Depreciation of rental merchandise was
approximately the same in terms of dollars for both periods, $62.9 million for
1998 and 1997. Depreciation of rental merchandise as a percent of revenues
decreased to 26.7% for 1998 and from 27.9% in 1997. This decrease is primarily
due to selected price increases in recent months on certain core products and an
increasing emphasis on overall gross margin management.
 
Salaries, wages and fringe benefits. Salaries, wages and fringe benefits
increased 6.6%, or $4.5 million, to $72.0 million for 1998 from $68.5 million
for 1997. This increase was primarily related to the increase in the number of
stores and rental agreements for fiscal 1998 as these salaries and wages were
largely consistent with the number of rental contracts and stores.
 
                                       78
<PAGE>   79
 
Other operating expenses. Other operating expenses increased 4.0%, or $2.0
million, to $52.7 million for 1998 from $50.7 million for 1997. The increase was
generally consistent with the revenue increase of 4.3% discussed above.
 
Net income. Net income decreased by $.5 million, to $3.3 million for 1998 from
$3.8 million in 1997.
 
COMPARISON OF FISCAL YEAR ENDED MARCH 31, 1998 AND FISCAL YEAR ENDED MARCH 31,
1997
 
Total revenue. Total revenues were $904.0 million for fiscal 1998 compared to
$926.9 million for fiscal 1997, a decrease of 2.5% or $22.9 million. Total RTO
revenues decreased by 5.1%, or $47.3 million, to $879.6 million for fiscal 1998
from $926.9 million for fiscal 1997. RTO revenues are comprised of two principal
components, rental revenues and other revenues. Rental revenues declined by
4.9%, or $37.8 million, from $764.0 million for fiscal 1997 to $726.2 million
for fiscal 1998. The decline in rental revenues is primarily attributable to a
reduction in the average price charged per rental agreement offset by an
increase in total rental agreements outstanding. The reduction in the average
price charged per rental agreement is principally due to a shift in product mix
toward less expensive items such as cellular phones and pagers, as well as a
promotional pricing program. The increase in the total rental agreements
outstanding is primarily the result of promotional activities and an increase in
the average number of stores open during the year. During the fiscal year,
Rent-A-Center acquired and opened a total of 59 stores, but this was offset by
the closing of 42 stores in the fourth quarter of fiscal 1998. Other revenues
decreased slightly to $153.4 million for fiscal 1998 versus $162.9 million for
fiscal 1997. This decrease was primarily attributable to decreased sales of used
merchandise for fiscal 1998 due to stronger business conditions and better idle
inventory management. This decrease was offset by increases in ancillary service
fees and revenues associated with the rental of merchandise to commercial
business. Ancillary services include the sale of product protection plans,
cellular phones and pager airtime. The introduction of the Value Club program by
Rent-A-Center for fiscal 1998, in particular, contributed positively to Other
Revenues. The Value Club program provides customers loss damage waiver
protection, extended service contracts, and other miscellaneous benefits such as
dental savings, grocery coupons, discounts on auto service, entertainment
discounts and emergency auto assistance. The balance of total revenues in 1998
of $24.4 million is due to Non-RTO Businesses ($20.2 million) including used car
retailing, credit retailing and check cashing kiosks and conforming adjustments
($4.2 million). Non-RTO Businesses had no revenues in 1997.
 
Depreciation of rental merchandise. Depreciation of rental merchandise decreased
by $15.8 million, or 6.1%, to $244.6 million for fiscal 1998 from $260.4 million
for fiscal 1997. Depreciation of rental merchandise as a percent of RTO revenues
decreased to 27.8% for 1998 and from 28.1% for 1997. This decrease was primarily
due to results from the change in product mix discussed above and a reduction in
the average quantity and cost of idle inventory held as available for rent in
the stores. This reduction in idle inventory was largely due to the
implementation of a new jewelry strategy in October 1997, which used alloy-based
prototypes rather than actual jewelry for display in the stores.
 
Salaries, wages and fringe benefits. Salaries, wages and fringe benefits
increased 2.8%, or $7.6 million, to $279.8 million for fiscal 1998 from $272.2
million for fiscal 1997. This
 
                                       79
<PAGE>   80
 
increase was primarily attributable to the increase in number of rental
agreements for fiscal 1998 as these salaries and wages are largely consistent
with the number of rental contracts.
 
Other operating expenses. Other operating expenses decreased 18.0%, or $25.9
million, to $117.6 million for fiscal 1998 from $143.5 million for fiscal 1997.
The decrease was primarily a result of the impact of the field reorganization
that occurred at the end of fiscal 1997. As part of the reorganization, field
divisional offices were closed and consolidated into the corporate office. In
addition, for fiscal 1998 Rent-A-Center eliminated store managers' meetings
resulting in savings of $2.0 million.
 
Restructuring charges. Restructuring charges were $12.3 million for fiscal 1998,
while fiscal 1997 had none. The restructuring charges related to the
discontinuation of certain new concepts, certain nonperforming rental purchase
stores and the reorganization of certain administrative support functions.
 
Operating income. Operating income decreased by $7.0 million, or 11.2%, to $55.3
million for fiscal 1998 from $62.3 million for fiscal 1997. This decrease was
primarily attributable to the reasons stated above.
 
Net income. Net income increased by $5.5 million, or 137.5%, to $1.5 million for
fiscal 1998 from a net loss of $4.0 million the fiscal 1997.
 
COMPARISON OF FISCAL YEAR ENDED MARCH 31, 1997 AND FISCAL YEAR ENDED MARCH 31,
1996
 
In August 1995, Rent-A-Center completed the U-Can-Rent acquisition, and in
January 1996, Rent-A-Center completed the Advantage, Inc. acquisition. The
financial results of these stores are included in Rent-A-Center's fiscal 1996
results from the dates of the respective acquisitions.
 
Total revenue. Total revenues were $926.9 million for fiscal 1997 compared to
$897.9 million for fiscal 1996, an increase of $28.9 million, or 3.2%. Non-RTO
Businesses had no revenues in 1997 and 1996. RTO revenues are comprised of two
principal components, rental revenue and other revenue. Rental revenue increased
2.7%, or $19.9 million, during fiscal 1997 to $764.0 million from $744.1 million
for fiscal 1996. The increase was primarily attributable to two acquisitions
made during fiscal 1996. The increase in rental revenue experienced in fiscal
1997 as a result of these acquisitions was offset by soft results experienced
by, Rent-A-Center overall., Rent-A-Center's net portfolio of agreements
outstanding during fiscal 1997 declined by 55,400 primarily due to a
disappointing holiday season. Other revenue increased 5.9%, or $9.1 million,
during fiscal 1997 to $162.9 million from $153.8 million for fiscal 1996. The
increase was primarily attributable to the impact of, Rent-A-Center's
acquisitions made during fiscal 1996, as discussed above, as well as the
increase in revenues associated with, Rent-A-Center's commercial rental
business, which commenced operation in August 1995. In addition, during fiscal
1997, Rent-A-Center experienced a substantial increase in customer participation
in its Value Club program which was introduced in fiscal 1996.
 
Restructuring charges. Restructuring charges were $12.6 million for fiscal 1996
while fiscal 1997 had none. The restructuring charges related to the
consolidation of offices and reductions in the number of employees. These
charges were primarily made up of employee separation costs.
 
                                       80
<PAGE>   81
 
Depreciation of rental merchandise. Depreciation of rental merchandise increased
by $3.1 million, or 1.2%, to $260.4 million for fiscal 1997 from $257.4 million
for fiscal 1996. Depreciation of rental merchandise as a percent of RTO revenues
decreased to 28.1% for fiscal 1997 from 28.7% for fiscal 1996. This increase was
primarily attributable to the result of the 1996 acquisitions and the associated
increase in rental merchandise held as available for rent in the stores.
 
Salaries, wages and fringe benefits. Salaries, wages and fringe benefits
increased 6.4% or $16.5 million, to $272.2 million for fiscal 1997 from $255.8
million for fiscal 1996. This increase was primarily attributable to the impact
of the 1996 acquisitions and a reduction in average revenue per store for fiscal
1997 compared to fiscal 1996.
 
Other operating expenses. Other operating expenses increased $27.2 million, or
23.4%, to $143.5 million for fiscal 1997 from $116.3 million for fiscal 1996.
 
Operating income. Operating income decreased by $11.7 million, or 15.8%, to
$62.3 million for fiscal 1997 from $74.0 million for fiscal 1996. This decrease
was primarily attributable to the reasons stated above.
 
Net loss. The net loss decreased by $9.1 million, or 69.5% to a loss of $4.0
million for fiscal 1997 from a loss of $13.1 million for fiscal 1996.
 
HISTORICAL LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES -- THE COMPANY
 
The Company's primary requirements for capital were the acquisition of existing
stores, the opening of new stores, the purchase of additional rental merchandise
and the replacement of rental merchandise which has been sold, charged-off or is
no longer suitable for rent. During the year ended December 31, 1997, the
Company acquired 71 stores (net of consolidation) for an aggregate purchase
price of $30.5 million, all of which was paid in cash. The Company purchased
rental merchandise in the amount of $85.9 million, $75.2 million and $44.5
million of rental merchandise during the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and
1995, respectively.
 
For 1997, cash provided by operating activities increased by $9.4 million from
$19.4 million in 1996 to $28.8 million in 1997, primarily due to the $7.9
million increase in net earnings. Cash used in investing activities increased by
$4.3 million from $36.3 million in 1996 to $40.6 million in 1997, primarily due
to additional cash paid pursuant to the 1997 acquisitions. Additionally, the
Company paid $2.3 million more in 1997 than 1996 for the purchase of property
assets. The increase was attributable primarily to relocating and improving
acquired stores. During 1997, cash provided by financing activities was $10.6
million, primarily from the Company's credit facility. During 1996, cash used in
financing activities was $12.5 million, which relates primarily to repayment of
debt to the Magic selling shareholders which was paid in full on January 2,
1996, offset by the net proceeds of the sale of the ColorTyme franchisee loan
portfolio.
 
In connection with the acquisition of Magic Rent-to-Own, monthly payments of
$33,333 were due under a consulting agreement through April 1, 2001, and monthly
payments of $125,000 were due under a noncompetition agreement from February
1996 through January 1998. Pursuant to the settlement of the DEF litigation in
January 1998, the Company was released from its obligations to make payments
under such consulting and noncompetition agreements, in exchange for a final
cash payment of $950,000.
 
                                       81
<PAGE>   82
 
In connection with the acquisition of Crown Leasing Corporation and certain of
its affiliates, monthly payments of $16,667 were made under a consulting
agreement that ended in October 1996, and in connection with the acquisition of
Magic Rent-to-Own, monthly payments in the aggregate amount of $32,500 each are
due under certain noncompetition agreements through August 2000.
 
HISTORICAL LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES -- RENT-A-CENTER
 
RAC's primary capital requirements were the acquisition of existing stores, the
opening of new stores, the purchase of additional rental merchandise and the
purchase of replacement rental merchandise.
 
Capital spent on the purchase of new rental merchandise in 1998 was $306.8
million compared to $289.5 million and $299.7 million in 1997 and 1996,
respectively. The cost of depreciation of rental merchandise was $244.6 million,
$260.4 million and $257.4 million in 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively.
 
In 1998, 1997 and 1996, Rent-A-Center acquired 25 new stores for cash
consideration of $7.6 million, 64 new stores for cash consideration of $21.1
million, and 200 new stores for cash consideration of $124.6 million,
respectively. Capital expenditures for property and equipment were $38.1
million, $32.3 million and $44.6 million in 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively.
Significant expenditures included (i) transportation equipment of $8.0 million,
$10.9 million and $19.3 million in 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively, (ii)
computer furniture and equipment of $5.5 million, $3.8 million and $8.8 million
in 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively, (iii) leasehold improvements to open new
stores and renovate and remodel existing stores of $12.1 million, $12.5 million
and $4.4 million in 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively, and (iv) store fixtures
and equipment of $11.5 million, $4.9 million and $4.2 million in 1998, 1997 and
1996, respectively, and (v) buildings of $7.3 million in 1996.
 
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES OF THE COMPANY FOLLOWING THE EXCHANGE OFFER
 
The Company's primary liquidity requirements are for debt service under the
Senior Credit Facilities, the Notes, other indebtedness outstanding, working
capital and capital expenditures. As of June 30, 1998, the Company's
consolidated indebtedness would have been approximately $895.7 million,
consisting primarily of $720.0 million of the Senior Credit Facilities
(excluding the unfunded Senior Revolving Credit Facility and outstanding letters
of credit under the Letter of Credit/Multidraw Facility), $175.0 million of the
Notes and $.7 million of other debt. In addition, the Company has raised $260
million through the sale of the Convertible Preferred Stock.
 
Capital expenditures are generally to maintain existing operations and for the
acquisition and opening of stores. The Company expects to spend approximately
$26.4 million in 1998 and $24.8 million in 1999 on capital expenditures, all of
which are to maintain existing operations. Furthermore, the Company purchases
new property and equipment in connection with a store acquisition or new store
opening. The Company does not expect to open or acquire any additional stores
other than franchised stores in 1998 or 1999.
 
                                       82
<PAGE>   83
 
In connection with the integration plan for Rent-A-Center, the Company expects
to incur $45.0 million of nonrecurring cash costs within 24 months following the
Rent-A-Center Acquisition.
 
Principal and interest payments under the Senior Credit Facilities and the Notes
will represent significant liquidity requirements for the Company. Under the
Term Loans, the Company will be required to make principal payments totaling
approximately $2.0 million in 1999, $14.0 million in 2000, $22.0 million in
2001, $26.0 million in 2002, and $30.0 million in 2003. Loans under the Senior
Credit Facilities will bear interest at floating rates based upon the interest
rate option selected by the Company. Under the terms of the Senior Credit
Facilities, the Company is required to purchase and maintain interest rate
protection with respect to 50% of the Term Loans for 3 years. During September
1998, the Company entered into a three-year interest rate swap for $250 million
and a five-year interest rate swap for $250 million. These swaps fixed the
interest rate plus the applicable spread for the applicable periods. The blended
interest rate for the swaps is 5.59%. See "Description of Other Indebtedness."
 
The Company believes that cash flow from operations together with amounts
available under the Revolving Credit Facility and Letter of Credit/Multidraw
Facility will be sufficient to fund its debt service requirements, working
capital needs, capital expenditures and litigation exposure. The Revolving
Credit Facility provides the Company with revolving loans in an aggregate
principal amount not exceeding $120.0 million and the Letter of Credit/Multidraw
Facility will provide the Company with an additional $122.25 million of
financing to support certain litigation assumed in connection with the
Rent-A-Center Acquisition. Once the letter of credit is terminated, the Letter
of Credit/ Multidraw Facility will convert to a $85 million term loan.
 
INFLATION
 
During the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, the cost of rental
merchandise, lease expense and salaries and wages have increased modestly. The
increases have not had a significant effect on the Company's results of
operations because the Company has been able to charge commensurately higher
rental rates for its merchandise.
 
                                       83
<PAGE>   84
 
QUARTERLY RESULTS -- THE COMPANY
 
The following table contains certain unaudited historical financial information
for the quarters indicated.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   1ST QUARTER   2ND QUARTER   3RD QUARTER   4TH QUARTER
                                   -----------   -----------   -----------   -----------
                                                  (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
Year ended December 31, 1997(1)
  Revenue........................    $74,587       $80,803       $83,864       $92,288
  Operating profit...............      9,639        11,341        11,766        13,192
Year ended December 31, 1996(2)
  Revenue........................    $49,002       $57,756       $60,025       $71,182
  Operating profit...............      6,344         7,558         7,957         9,183
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
(1) During 1997, 28 stores were purchased during the first quarter; 39 stores
    were purchased during the second quarter; and nine stores were purchased
    during the third quarter. Of the 76 stores acquired, five were subsequently
    consolidated with existing store locations. In addition, two stores were
    opened during the first quarter; two stores were opened during the second
    quarter; four stores were opened during the third quarter; and two stores
    were opened during the fourth quarter.
 
(2) During 1996, 11 stores were purchased during the second quarter, 12 stores
    were purchased during the third quarter, and 71 stores were purchased during
    the fourth quarter of 1996. In addition, three stores were opened in the
    second quarter, four stores were opened in the third quarter, and six stores
    were opened in the fourth quarter of 1996.
 
EFFECT OF NEW ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS
 
In 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued SFAS No. 130,
"Reporting Comprehensive Income." SFAS No. 130 addresses the manner in which
certain items included in stockholders equity are displayed in the financial
statements, but does not affect reported assets or net earnings. The Company
adopted SFAS No. 130 effective January 1, 1998.
 
In 1997, the FASB issued SFAS No. 131 "Disclosures about Segments of an
Enterprise and Related Information." See Note A to the consolidated financial
statements of Renters Choice, Inc. and Subsidiaries for further discussion.
 
In June 1998, the FASB issued SFAS No. 133, "Accounting for Derivative
Instruments and Hedging Activities" effective for fiscal years beginning after
June 15, 1998. The Company will account for the derivative transactions required
under the terms of the Senior Credit Facilities in accordance with SFAS No. 133.
 
                                       84
<PAGE>   85
 
                                    BUSINESS
 
THE COMPANY
 
The Company is the largest operator in the RTO industry with approximately 25%
market share (based on the number of stores). The Company operates 2,126
company-owned stores, and franchises 307 stores, in 50 states, Puerto Rico and
the District of Columbia. The Company's stores offer home electronics,
appliances, and furniture and accessories under flexible rental purchase
agreements that allow customers to obtain ownership of the merchandise at the
conclusion of an agreed upon rental period. The RTO industry appeals to a wide
variety of consumers by allowing them to obtain merchandise that they might
otherwise be (i) unable to purchase due to insufficient cash resources or a lack
of access to credit, or (ii) unwilling to purchase due to a temporary,
short-term need or desire to rent.
 
Rent-A-Center Acquisition. On August 5, 1998, we acquired Rent-A-Center pursuant
to an agreement with Thorn plc dated June 16, 1998, for approximately $900
million in cash (including the repayment of certain debt of Rent-A-Center),
subject to adjustment. Prior to this acquisition, Rent-A-Center was the largest
RTO competitor with 1,404 company-owned stores and 65 franchised stores in 49
states and the District of Columbia. Rent-A-Center operated stores under three
brand names, "Rent-A-Center," "Remco" and "U-Can-Rent." Rent-A-Center operated
1,158 stores under the Rent-A-Center brand, the most widely recognized store
name in the RTO industry.
 
We financed the acquisition of Rent-A-Center through certain financing
arrangements, consisting of a senior credit facility and a senior subordinated
facility. We also issued a total of $260 million in preferred stock to certain
affiliates of Apollo and to an affiliate of Bear Stearns to assist in the
funding of the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, to repurchase $25 million of the
Company's common stock and to repay our prior credit facility. Following the
acquisition of Rent-A-Center, we issued the Old Notes to repay the senior
subordinated facility. In connection with the acquisition of Rent-A-Center, we
assumed certain of Rent-A-Center's ongoing litigation, including an adverse New
Jersey state court judgment currently on appeal. In addition, Thorn plc has
agreed to indemnify and hold harmless the Company and Rent-A-Center from two
lawsuits and has deposited $40 million in escrow with respect to such claims and
other indemnification claims the Company may have against Thorn plc. For
additional information, please read the sections entitled "Risk Factors -- Legal
Proceedings" and "-- Legal Proceedings" located elsewhere in this Prospectus.
 
Prior to the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, the Company was the second largest
competitor in the RTO industry with 680 company-owned stores operating under the
"Renters Choice" brand name in 35 states and Puerto Rico. In addition, its
ColorTyme subsidiary was the largest RTO franchisor in the U.S. with 278
franchised stores in 37 states. The Company's management team has gained
extensive experience in integrating acquisitions and is headed by J. Ernest
Talley, the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of the Company, who is
generally credited with founding the RTO industry in the early 1960's. Since
1993, the Company's store count grew from 27 to 2,126 through acquisitions and
new store openings.
 
                                       85
<PAGE>   86
 
Prior to the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, Rent-A-Center was the largest RTO
competitor with 1,404 company-owned stores and 65 franchised stores in 49 states
and the District of Columbia. Rent-A-Center operated stores under three brand
names, "Rent-A-Center," "Remco" and "U-Can-Rent." Rent-A-Center was
Rent-A-Center's largest brand, with 1,158 stores, and is the most widely
recognized store name in the RTO industry. Founded in 1973 and purchased by
Thorn EMI plc in 1987, Rent-A-Center grew through both new store openings and
acquisitions from 1,006 stores at fiscal year-end 1993 to 1,404 stores through
June 30, 1998.
 
RTO INDUSTRY
 
Overview. According to APRO, an industry trade association, the RTO industry
generated approximately $4.1 billion in revenue during 1996 through the rental
of roughly 5.8 million products to approximately 3.0 million households. The
Company estimates the RTO target market is greater than 20 million households,
principally comprised of households with annual income from $15,000 to $50,000.
The types of products rented by RTO customers include: furniture and accessories
(34.9% of total units rented), electronics (31.1%), appliances (22.4%), and
other items including jewelry, pagers and personal computers (11.6%). Management
estimates that the RTO industry is comprised of approximately 8,300 stores.
Although the five largest RTO companies operate approximately 38.5% of the
industry's store base, the industry is highly fragmented as the majority of RTO
competitors operate fewer than 20 stores. The industry has experienced
significant consolidation since 1993, when the five largest RTO companies
operated approximately 26.6% of the industry's store base. The RTO industry is
experiencing consolidation primarily because larger, multi-unit operators have
significant competitive advantages compared to their smaller competitors. Larger
operators enjoy greater purchasing power, which enables them to offer more
competitively priced merchandise and are able to operate more efficiently than
smaller operators in areas such as management information systems, advertising
and purchasing. Many smaller competitors lack the managerial resources necessary
to operate larger RTO operations efficiently across multiple locations.
Management believes that these factors will continue to promote the trend toward
consolidation and present an opportunity for well-capitalized operators to
acquire additional stores on favorable terms.
 
RTO Transaction. The RTO industry provides consumers with: (i) a means of
obtaining merchandise without the burden of incurring debt or qualifying for
credit, (ii) the ability to return merchandise at any time without future
obligations, (iii) flexible payment terms, (iv) delivery, repair and pick-up
service typically at no incremental charge, and (v) the potential for
merchandise ownership after a predetermined number of payments. Customers enter
into weekly or monthly rental purchase agreements, which renew automatically
upon receipt of each payment. Rental payments are made each week in advance
generally in cash. RTO companies retain title to rental merchandise during the
term of the rental purchase agreement. Ownership of the merchandise typically
transfers to the customer if the customer has continuously renewed the rental
purchase agreement for a specified period of time or exercises a specified early
purchase option. On average, however, ownership requirements are met on less
than 25% of items being rented for the first time. Products are typically rented
four to six times over a 24 month period with the average time on rent to each
customer lasting approximately four months. Virtually all rental items are
ultimately rented to ownership in subsequent rental transactions. The RTO
transaction bears an important distinction to a traditional retail transaction:
RTO
 
                                       86
<PAGE>   87
 
companies do not lend to customers or bear the associated credit risk because
customers make all payments in advance. As a result, balance sheets of RTO
companies have very few accounts receivable.
 
BUSINESS STRENGTHS
 
Over the past several years, the Company experienced significant increases in
sales and operating income through acquisitions and internal growth. During this
period, the Company focused on achieving a position as a market-leading operator
of RTO locations. As a result, the Company believes that it benefits from the
following competitive advantages.
 
Industry Leader. The Company is the largest competitor in the RTO industry
(based on the number of stores) with market share of approximately 25%. The next
largest operator has a market share of less than 5.5%. The Company operates
2,126 company-owned stores, and franchises 307 stores (including the largest RTO
franchisor, ColorTyme) in 50 states, Puerto Rico and the District of Columbia.
The Company's stores operate under various brand names including Renters Choice
and Rent-A-Center, the most widely recognized name in the RTO industry. In 1997,
the Company and Rent-A-Center together served over 1 million customers. As the
only nationwide RTO competitor, the Company benefits from (i) greater visibility
among consumers, (ii) geographic diversity, (iii) increased opportunities to
expand into contiguous markets, (iv) certain efficiencies in areas such as
advertising, purchasing and human resources, and (v) the ability to leverage its
corporate overhead over a larger store base.
 
Consistent Revenue and Strong Cash Flow. The Company's loyal customer base, as
well as its resilience to economic cycles, enables it to generate stable
revenue. In 1997, repeat customers accounted for approximately 50% of the
Company's revenues. Historically, the Company has not experienced a meaningful
correlation between economic conditions (as measured by GDP growth) and same
store revenue growth. Through the successful integration of Rent-A-Center into
the Company's operating system, management expects to substantially increase the
profit margins and cash flows at the combined company. Consistently stable
revenue and strong margins (combined with low levels of maintenance capital
expenditures) provide resources that can be used to fund the Company's growth
strategy.
 
Superior Customer Service. Management believes that providing superior customer
service is a key element for its long-term success. The Company achieves a high
level of customer satisfaction by providing: (i) appealing store environments,
(ii) premium quality, durable merchandise, (iii) personal customer service, and
(iv) experienced, well-trained store personnel. The Company believes its high
level of customer satisfaction allows the Company to maximize the number and
length of rental agreements per store, leading to customer referrals and repeat
business.
 
Premium Quality Product Offerings. The Company distinguishes itself from its
competitors by purchasing, marketing, and renting premium name brand products
from manufacturers such as Sony, JVC and Magnavox for home electronics;
La-Z-Boy, Sealy and Ashley for home furnishings and accessories; and Whirlpool,
General Electric and Kenmore for appliances. In addition to satisfying customer
demand, premium products reduce service costs through increased reliability.
Furthermore, the Company has
 
                                       87
<PAGE>   88
 
developed strong relationships with its key vendors, enabling cost effective
direct-to-store distribution from its vendors.
 
Ability to Successfully Integrate Acquisitions. Since 1993, the Company acquired
2,090 stores, giving management extensive experience in the integration of
diverse RTO operations. The Company's information systems facilitate acquisition
integration by providing management with operating and financial information
about each store location and region and every rental purchase transaction. As a
result of management's ability to implement the Company's business practices,
operating performance of the integrated stores has improved significantly. For
example, in 1997, store operating margins (before field administration and
corporate overhead) for all of the Company's stores was 23.9%, while its 325
mature stores (in the Company's system for at least two years) generated store
operating margins of 26.8%. The Company's mature stores primarily consist of
acquired stores. The average store operating margin for Rent-A-Center's stores
for fiscal 1998 was 20.9%.
 
Experienced and Committed Management Team. The Company has a senior management
team with an average of 17 years of RTO experience. J. Ernest Talley, Chairman
and Chief Executive Officer of the Company, is generally credited with founding
the RTO industry in the early 1960's. The Company's management team has a
significant personal economic interest in the Company's performance: (i) the
senior management group collectively owns approximately 26.2% of the Company on
a fully-diluted basis, and (ii) store, regional and senior manager compensation
is tied directly to store revenue and/or operating profit and such bonuses
account for up to 30% of all compensation. The Company believes that the
de-centralized, entrepreneurial spirit of its field management, together with
the guidance provided by senior management, will continue to be a key factor in
the Company's efforts to maximize revenue, improve margins and expand the
Company's store base.
 
BUSINESS STRATEGY
 
The Company is focusing its strategic efforts on (i) the implementation of its
integration plan, (ii) continued efforts to improve store operations, and (iii)
the pursuit of strategic expansion once the integration plan is substantially in
place.
 
Implement the Integration Plan. The Company management has developed a
comprehensive program for the integration of Rent-A-Center, which it expects
will be completed within 18-24 months. The Company believes it will experience
over $30 million in net annual cash cost savings upon completion of the
integration plan, primarily as a result of eliminating (i) duplicative general
and administrative expenses, and (ii) Rent-A-Center's nationwide distribution
network including seven distribution centers. Additional benefit and margin
improvement is expected to be realized over time as management undertakes
initiatives to enhance operations in Rent-A-Center stores. These cost savings
represent less than 2.5% of the Company's latest twelve months revenues. In
addition, the Company is continuing the process of integrating Central Rents,
from which it expects to realize an additional $2.6 million of annual general
and administrative cost savings.
 
Continue to Enhance Store Operations. Management seeks to improve store
performance through strategies intended to produce gains in operating efficiency
and profitability. The Company believes it will achieve these gains in revenues
and operating margins in its
 
                                       88
<PAGE>   89
 
stores by: (i) using focused advertising to increase store traffic, (ii)
expanding the offering of upscale, higher margin products (such as Sony wide
screen televisions, La-Z-Boy recliners and JVC stereo systems) to increase the
number of product rentals, (iii) employing strict store-level cost control, and
(iv) closely monitoring each store's performance through the use of its
management information system to ensure each store's adherence to established
operating guidelines.
 
Pursue Strategic Expansion. Management has gained significant experience in the
acquisition and integration of other RTO operators and believes the fragmented
nature of the RTO industry will result in ongoing growth opportunities. Once the
integration plan is substantially in place, the Company will again focus on
strategic acquisition opportunities and new store development. The Company
typically targets underperforming and undercapitalized chains of RTO stores. The
acquired stores benefit from the administrative network, improved product mix,
sophisticated management information system and purchasing power of the larger
organization while strengthening their local market position. In addition, the
Company has access to an expanding number of franchise locations, which it has
the right of first refusal to purchase. The Company believes the RTO market is
significantly under-penetrated and plans to continue opening new stores in
current and new markets. The Company will focus its new market penetration in
adjacent areas or regions which are underserved by the RTO industry. In
evaluating a new market, the Company reviews demographic statistics, cost of
advertising and the number and nature of competitors.
 
                                       89
<PAGE>   90
 
STORES
 
Store sizes range from approximately 1,500 to 8,200 square feet, and average
approximately 3,600 square feet. Approximately 80% of each store's space is
generally used for showroom space and 20% for offices and storage space. The
Company operates approximately 2,126 Company-owned stores and 307 franchised
stores in 50 states, Puerto Rico and the District of Columbia, as illustrated by
the following table:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                         NUMBER OF STORES                              NUMBER OF STORES
                        -------------------                           -------------------
                        COMPANY                                       COMPANY
       LOCATION          OWNED    FRANCHISE          LOCATION          OWNED    FRANCHISE
       --------         -------   ---------          --------         -------   ---------
<S>                     <C>       <C>         <C>                     <C>       <C>
Alabama...............     46        --       Nebraska..............       4        --
Alaska................      1        --       Nevada................      16         4
Arizona...............     54        10       New Hampshire.........      15         2
Arkansas..............     23         2       New Jersey............      40         9
California............    119         8       New Mexico............      10        10
Colorado..............     26         2       New York..............     100        19
Connecticut...........     17         6       North Carolina........      95         9
Delaware..............     15         1       North Dakota..........       1        --
District of
  Columbia............      4        --       Ohio..................     128         9
Florida...............    135         8       Oklahoma..............      37        13
Georgia...............     95         4       Oregon................       6         4
Hawaii................     11         1       Pennsylvania..........      76         6
Idaho.................      1         1       Puerto Rico...........      17        --
Illinois..............    115        --       Rhode Island..........       7         3
Indiana...............     75        17       South Carolina........      28         1
Iowa..................     19        --       South Dakota..........       2        --
Kansas................     28        17       Tennessee.............      78         8
Kentucky..............     40         6       Texas.................     225        58
Louisiana.............     35         4       Utah..................      16         1
Maine.................     --        13       Vermont...............       6        --
Maryland..............     46         6       Virginia..............      39        --
Massachusetts.........     40        11       Washington............      27         3
Michigan..............     95        14       West Virginia.........      14         1
Minnesota.............      7        --       Wisconsin.............      29         2
Mississippi...........     12         4       Wyoming...............       1        --
                                                                       -----       ---
Missouri..............     49         7
Montana...............      1         3       Total.................   2,126       307
                                                                       =====       ===
</TABLE>
 
                                       90
<PAGE>   91
 
The Company has increased its owned stores from 27 at the beginning of 1993 to
2,126 at October 7, 1998 (including the acquisition of 1,409 Rent-A-Center
stores). The following table shows the number of stores opened, acquired and
closed during 1993 through 1998.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         THE COMPANY
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                       END OF
        FISCAL YEARS           BEGINNING OF      NEW                                   PERIOD
            ENDED                 PERIOD        STORE        STORE          STORE      STORE
        DECEMBER 31,           STORE COUNT    OPENINGS    ACQUISITIONS   CLOSINGS(1)   COUNT
        ------------           ------------   --------    ------------   -----------   ------
<S>                            <C>            <C>         <C>            <C>           <C>
1993.........................       27            1             84            --         112
1994.........................      112            2             --            --         114
1995.........................      114            4            209            (2)        325
1996.........................      325           13             94            (9)        423
1997.........................      423           10             76            (5)        504
1998(2)......................      504            1          1,632           (11)      2,126
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
(1) Historically the Company has only closed stores in connection with acquiring
    stores.
 
(2) Through October 7, 1998.
 
The Company focuses on expansion by making acquisitions and opening new stores.
With respect to store acquisitions, the Company typically targets
underperforming and undercapitalized chains of RTO stores. The acquired stores
benefit from the management expertise, administrative network, improved product
mix, sophisticated management information system and purchasing power of the
larger organization allowing them to strengthen their local market position. In
addition, the Company's information systems facilitate acquisition integration
by providing management with access to operating and financial information about
any store location or region in which the Company operates and generates
management reports on a daily, weekly, month-to-date and year-to-date basis for
each store and every rental purchase transaction.
 
Store leases typically range from three to five years and contain one to two
renewal options. Before a new site is selected, management reviews demographic
information regarding the median income, housing and other factors that affect
the buying patterns for potential rental purchase customers primarily within a
five mile radius for urban locations and up to 30 miles for rural locations of a
potential site. Store locations are selected based upon management's analysis of
such demographic information, location of competitors, customer traffic for the
site, accessibility and cost. Stores are typically located in or near low to
middle income neighborhoods, usually in strip shopping centers which contain a
large anchor tenant and other suitable tenants. The Company estimates that the
average investment with respect to opening a new store is approximately $350,000
of which rental merchandise comprises approximately 80% of the investment. The
remaining investment consists of leasehold improvements, furnishings and
fixtures, computer equipment, store signs and start-up costs. Newly opened
stores generally become profitable after approximately six months. The Company
does not intend to open new store locations until the plan for the integration
of Rent-A-Center is substantially in place. Management believes that suitable
store space is generally available for lease and that the Company would be able
to relocate any of its stores without significant difficulty should it be unable
to renew a particular lease. Management also expects that additional space will
be readily available at competitive rates in the event the Company desires to
open new stores.
 
                                       91
<PAGE>   92
 
PRODUCT SELECTION
 
The Company's stores offer merchandise from three basic product categories: home
electronics, appliances and furniture and accessories. Management's policy is to
ensure that its stores maintain sufficient inventory to provide a wide variety
of high quality merchandise to its customers and emphasizes products from a core
group of brand-name manufacturers. Choices of merchandise reflect management's
belief that customers want to rent the same quality of merchandise that is
available from more traditional retailers and that customers are willing to pay
for value and quality. In addition, by focusing on its manufacturers' premium
quality products, the Company seeks to avoid frequent service problems
associated with inferior products. During 1997, home electronic products
accounted for approximately 46%, appliances for 24% and furniture and
accessories for 30% of the Company's store revenue. Management believes the
effect of this product mix and its focus on "higher end" products results in its
favorable profit margin relative to its competitors.
 
The general product mix in the Company's stores is determined by senior
management, based on an analysis of customer rental patterns and the
introduction of new products on a test basis. Individual store managers are
responsible for determining the particular product selection for their store
from the list of products approved by senior management. Customers may request
either new merchandise or previously rented merchandise. Previously rented
merchandise is offered at the same weekly or monthly rental rate as is offered
for new merchandise, but with an opportunity to obtain ownership of the
merchandise after fewer rental payments. In order to achieve gross margins
consistent with its mature stores, the Company standardizes inventory in each of
its acquired stores.
 
On average, Rent-A-Center's stores offer approximately 1,000 SKUs, as compared
to approximately 100 SKUs offered by the Renters Choice stores. This greater
number of product offerings is achieved in part through the use of an in-store
catalog. Merchandise is offered from the same three basic product categories:
home electronics (40.7% of total Rent-A-Center sales), appliances (16.6%) and
furniture and accessories (27.5%), as well as computers, pagers, cellular phones
and jewelry (15.2%). Historically, the Company has elected not to rent certain
of these merchandise categories, such as pagers, cellular phones and jewelry.
Management believes these products do not produce enough volume to justify their
relatively lower margins. Moreover, with pagers and cellular phones, revenue is
generated primarily from the sale of air time (which is not a part of the
Company's business) rather than from the rental of the hardware. As part of the
integration process, the Company intends to standardize the inventory in each of
the Rent-A-Center stores.
 
Home Electronics. Home electronic products offered by the Company's stores
include televisions, video cassette recorders and stereos. The Company offers
home electronics merchandise from top brand manufacturers such as Magnavox,
Sony, JVC and Technics. The Company's weekly rental prices in this product
category currently range from approximately $9.99 to $45.99 per item.
 
Appliances. The Company rents major appliances manufactured by Whirlpool,
General Electric and Kenmore, including refrigerators, washing machines, dryers,
microwave ovens, freezers and ranges. The Company's weekly rental prices in this
product category currently range from approximately $9.99 to $29.99 per item.
 
                                       92
<PAGE>   93
 
Furniture and Accessories. The Company offers a variety of furniture products,
including dining room, living room and bedroom furniture featuring a number of
styles, materials and colors. Showroom displays enable customers to visualize
how the product will look in their homes and provide a showcase for accessories.
The Company offers furniture made by Ashley, England-Corsair, La-Z-Boy and other
top brand manufacturers. The Company's weekly rental prices in this product
category currently range from approximately $5.99 to $35.99. Accessories such as
pictures, plants, lamps and tables are typically rented as part of a package of
items to furnish a complete room. Rental rates for accessories vary widely and
are often determined based upon the rental rates of the other items in the
package.
 
Computers. Rent-A-Center began the rental of computers in 1993 and the Company
is considering adding computers to its product offering. As new generations of
computers become available, Rent-A-Center reduced the rental rates and/or rental
terms on older models. This makes the computers affordable to a customer base
that would otherwise be unwilling or unable to afford the higher rates for the
new units. Store associates receive training in marketing personal computers.
Major computer brands in this category include Packard Bell and Epson. Weekly
rental rates for computers range from $34.99 to $39.99.
 
PURCHASING AND DISTRIBUTION
 
Specific purchasing decisions for the Company's stores are made by store
managers, subject to review by headquarters management. Other than the
warehouses previously utilized by Rent-A-Center, the Company does not maintain
any warehouse space. All merchandise is shipped by vendors directly to each
store, typically within two to six days for electronics and appliances and one
to two weeks for furniture, where it is held for rental. The Company purchases
the majority of its merchandise directly from manufacturers. The Company's
largest suppliers include Magnavox and Whirlpool, which accounted for
approximately 21.7% and 21.6%, respectively, of merchandise purchased for the
Company's stores in 1997. No other supplier accounted for more than 10% of
merchandise purchased by the Company during such period. The Company generally
does not enter into written contracts with its suppliers. Although the Company
currently expects to continue relationships with its existing suppliers,
management believes there are numerous sources of products available to the
Company, and does not believe that the success of the Company's operations is
dependent on any one or more of its present suppliers.
 
In contrast to the Company's strategy of direct-to-store delivery, Rent-A-Center
previously maintained a nationwide network of seven distribution centers. These
distribution centers consisted of warehouses, all of which were leased, ranging
in size from 87,000 to 215,000 square feet (averaging approximately 135,000
square feet) and had the capacity to distribute to an average of approximately
300 stores each. Rent-A-Center utilized a fleet of 171 trucks to distribute its
products through its distribution system, delivering merchandise to its stores
once a week in the holiday season and once every two weeks in the off-peak
season. Expenses incurred to operate this distribution network were $23.5
million for the fiscal year ended March 31, 1998. The Company is in the process
of closing down 's distribution system as part of the integration process.
 
                                       93
<PAGE>   94
 
THE RENTAL PROCESS
 
Marketing. The Company uses advertising to introduce and reinforce the benefits
of its rental-purchase program to existing and potential customers as well as to
make such customers aware of new products and special promotions. The Company's
advertisements emphasize such features as product and brand name selection,
prompt delivery and the absence of any initial deposit, credit investigation or
long-term obligation. The Company focuses on direct mail advertising, and to a
lesser extent television, radio and secondary print advertising. Direct mail is
used extensively because it allows the Company to target specific zip codes near
its stores and those areas where potential customers reside. On average, the
Company distributes approximately 8 million color flyers per month by direct
mail. As a percentage of store revenues, the Company spent 4.7% ($13.7 million)
in its most recent fiscal year on advertising. As the Company acquires or opens
new stores in its existing market areas, it realizes certain efficiencies by
listing all stores in the same market-wide advertisement.
 
Rental-Purchase Agreement. In general, the Company and Rent-A-Center utilized
substantially similar rental purchase agreements and screening processes. The
Company retains title to the merchandise during the term of the rental purchase
agreement. The term required for ownership of new products on initial rental is
12 to 36 months depending on the product category. The contract also provides
the customer with an early purchase option. On average, however, ownership
requirements are met on less than 25% of items being rented for the first time.
During 1997, the average actual term of the Company's rental purchase agreements
was approximately 4.3 months. Actual rental periods vary based on the type of
merchandise rented: consumer electronics products have an average actual rental
period of 3.8 months, while appliances and furniture are generally rented for
longer periods with an average actual rental period of 5.2 and 4.6 months,
respectively.
 
The Company strives to make the rental-purchase transaction as simple and as
accessible as possible for the customer. An agreement is intended to be
straightforward and understandable and includes the total amount required to be
paid for ownership of the merchandise, as well as all other required
disclosures. If a customer elects to continue to rent the merchandise, the
customer pays the next period's rental. If a customer elects to terminate an
agreement, the Company will pick up the merchandise or the merchandise will be
returned by the customer and in either case, will be held by the Company for re-
rental. A customer may purchase a rented product at any time for a price based
on a predetermined formula.
 
Approval Process. Although the Company does not conduct a formal credit review,
the Company's order approval process provides a mechanism for qualifying a
customer. This process is designed to verify a customer's financial ability to
meet weekly or monthly payments and to ensure store personnel will be able to
locate the merchandise should the customer's account become past due. The
Company's qualification process consists of obtaining the customer's name,
address, landlord or mortgage holder, source of income and personal references.
Information is verified over the telephone by store personnel contacting the
personal references and other sources. Generally, the Company will verify
employment and residence status. Since merchandise is rented rather than
purchased, the Company focuses on a customer's credibility, not the customer's
credit history. If a customer does not pay promptly, the RTO merchandise is
simply returned or picked up. The approval process is designed to be completed
within an hour.
 
                                       94
<PAGE>   95
 
Product Delivery. The Company offers same day or 24-hour delivery and
installation of its merchandise at no additional cost to the customer. While
providing value to the customers, delivery of the merchandise provides the
Company with further confirmation of the information provided in the customer's
rental order and better inventory control. As an additional service to the
customer, the Company provides free pick-up should the customer wish to
terminate the rental agreement.
 
Repair. Through the network of 22 service centers previously utilized by
Rent-A-Center and acquired pursuant to the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, the
Company also provides any required service or repair of merchandise without
additional charge, except for damage in excess of normal wear and tear. If the
product cannot be repaired at the customer's residence, the Company provides a
temporary replacement while the product is being repaired. The customer is fully
liable for damage, loss or destruction of the merchandise, unless the customer
purchases an optional loss/damage waiver. Most of the products offered by the
Company are covered by a manufacturer's warranty for varying periods, which,
subject to the terms of the warranty, is transferred to the customer in the
event that the customer obtains ownership.
 
Collections. Management believes that good collections practices are critical to
the Company's success in the RTO industry. Management believes its strict and
disciplined approach to collections results in increased collected revenue and
ultimately enhances its long term relationships with its customers. Once a
customer accepts delivery of merchandise, the next priority is to encourage the
customer to continue renting the merchandise while making all payments in a
timely manner. The goal is to treat each customer with respect and dignity.
Store managers use a computerized management information system to track cash
collections on a daily basis. Most rental-purchase payments are made on or near
the due date, with little or no collection efforts by the Company and are made
in cash and in person. Having customers deliver payments in person affords the
Company an opportunity to further develop its customer relationships and market
additional merchandise. On average, 93.5% of all the Company's accounts are
collected within seven days of their respective due dates.
 
In the event a customer fails to make a rental payment when due, store
management will attempt to contact the customer to obtain payment and reinstate
the contract or will terminate the account and arrange to regain possession of
the merchandise. The Company attempts to recover the rental items by the seventh
to tenth day following termination or default of a rental purchase agreement.
Depending on state regulatory requirements, the Company charges for the
reinstatement of terminated accounts or collects a delinquent account fee. It
also collects loss/damage waiver fees from customers desiring such product
protection in the case of theft and certain natural disasters. Such fees are
standard in the industry and may be subject to government-specified limits. See
"-- Government Regulation." The Company's policy is to charge-off accounts
within 90 days of becoming past due. The Company's charge-offs due to lost or
stolen merchandise, expressed as a percentage of store revenues, were
approximately 2.1% in 1997, as compared to approximately 2.3% in 1996.
Rent-A-Center's charge-offs were approximately 2.3% in 1997, as compared to
approximately 2.4% in 1996. These percentages compare to an industry average of
2.9% in 1997 for chains of 20 stores or more.
 
                                       95
<PAGE>   96
 
STORE OPERATIONS
 
The Company employs a decentralized management organization, delegating
significant responsibility to its store and field managers and emphasizing
results-oriented compensation directly tied to store profitability and/or growth
in store revenue. A typical mature store has a store manager, an assistant
manager, and two or three account executives. Each store is responsible for its
operations including customer relations, credit management, delivery and pickup
of merchandise, inventory management, staffing and certain marketing efforts.
Account executives make deliveries, monitor accounts, secure timely rental
payments and pick up rental merchandise, as necessary.
 
The Company's philosophy is to treat store managers as "owners" of their stores.
At the end of each year, store managers prepare projections for the upcoming
year that must be approved by executive officers and senior management. Each
month actual results are compared to projected results, and managers must be
able to explain significant discrepancies. Because up to 30% of the compensation
of the managers of mature stores is based on profitability, store managers are
attentive to their store's financial statements and play an active role in the
analysis of store performance.
 
The latitude granted to the Company's store managers is a key to manager
accountability. Unless inventory units not rented within the last 90 days exceed
acceptable levels, no approval by the Company's senior management is required to
order merchandise from the Company's approved vendor list. The Company has idle
inventory standards that are closely monitored and designed to provide for
adequate display merchandise without building up excess inventory. All of these
factors help keep store inventory as low as possible while maintaining
sufficient quantities for store displays and customer deliveries.
 
As part of the integration process, the Company is currently reallocating its
existing resources to add the assistant manager position in the Rent-A-Center
stores. Management believes the assistant manager is a critical position in
increasing store depth as it adds additional support for the store manager and
develops management backup. In addition, starting pay for entry level positions
in the Company's stores is greater than in Rent-A-Center stores. In addition,
the Company intends to transition the salaries of Rent-A-Center's entry level
employees to those of the Company as it believes the higher wages allow it to
attract and retain stronger, more efficient employees.
 
REGIONAL MANAGEMENT
 
Each store manager reports to a market manager who typically oversees seven to
nine stores. Market managers are primarily responsible for monitoring individual
store performance and inventory levels within their respective regions. The
Company's approximately 265 market managers, in turn, report to 41 regional
directors, who monitor the operations of approximately six regions, and, through
the market managers, individual store performance. The regional directors report
to the Company's senior management and together, the regional directors and
senior management direct and coordinate purchasing, financial planning and
controls, employee training, personnel matters and new store site selection.
Despite the Company's decentralized structure, senior management closely
monitors operations by examining store-level performance on a daily basis
through the Company's management information system and frequent on-site
reviews. As part of the integration process, the Company is in the process of
reorganizing Rent-A-Center's field
 
                                       96
<PAGE>   97
 
reporting structure and aligning its compensation plans to conform to the
structure employed by the Company. Up to 30% of all market manager compensation
at the Company is tied directly to store revenue and/or operating profit.
 
RECRUITMENT, RETENTION AND TRAINING
 
The Company places great importance on recruiting and training quality personnel
and believes that its managers are among the best in the industry. As part of
its recruiting process, each prospective store employee is administered an
examination to determine his or her managerial abilities. In order to attract
and retain quality personnel, the Company generally pays its entry level
employees more than the industry average and provides competitive benefits
packages. In order to become a store manager, a candidate must have experience
working in the Company system and be selected by regional and senior management
and complete the management training program. In order to be promoted to
regional manager, a candidate must have previously served as a store manager.
 
The Company conducts an annual managers' meeting at a central location attended
by store managers, regional managers, regional vice presidents and executive
management. At such sessions, prior performance is critiqued, operating
procedures are reviewed and revised, new merchandise is showcased and managers
receive classroom training in the areas of financial management, product
information, inventory management, customer service, credit management and other
areas of store operations.
 
MANAGEMENT INFORMATION SYSTEMS
 
Utilizing the Company's management information system, executive management,
regional managers and store managers can closely monitor the productivity of
stores under their supervision as compared to prescribed guidelines. This system
provides the Company's management with access to operating and financial
information about each store location and region, and generates management
reports on a daily, weekly, month-to-date and year-to-date basis for each unit
of merchandise and every rental purchase transaction. The reports for all stores
are reviewed daily by senior management and any irregularities are addressed the
following business day. Each store is equipped with a computer system that
tracks individual components of revenue, each item in idle and rented inventory,
total items on rent, delinquent accounts and other account information. In
addition, the Company's computer system maintains all standard agreements, which
are printed off the system on an as-needed basis at each store. All documents
including standard agreements, sales material and collection material have been
pre-formatted. The Company has only four employees in its management information
system department as it outsources the maintenance and software development to
an outside vendor.
 
COMPETITION
 
The RTO industry is highly competitive. The Company is the largest RTO operator
with 2,126 stores as well as the largest franchisor with 307 stores. The five
largest industry participants account for only 38.5% of the approximately 8,300
RTO stores in the United States. The Company's stores will compete with other
RTO businesses, as well as with rental stores that do not offer their customers
a purchase option. With respect to customers desiring to purchase merchandise
for cash or on credit, the Company will also compete
 
                                       97
<PAGE>   98
 
with department stores and discount stores. Competition is based primarily on
store location, product selection and availability, customer service and rental
rates and terms.
 
FRANCHISE OPERATIONS
 
ColorTyme is the largest nationwide RTO franchisor with 284 stores in 37 states.
In addition, Rent-A-Center has 23 franchise stores.
 
All ColorTyme franchised stores use ColorTyme's trade names, service marks,
trademarks, logos, emblems and indicia of origin and operate under distinctive
operating procedures and standards specified by ColorTyme. ColorTyme's primary
source of revenue is the sale of rental equipment to its franchisees, who, in
turn, offer the equipment to the general public for rent or purchase under a RTO
program. As franchisor, ColorTyme receives royalties of 2.3% to 4.0% of the
franchisees' rental income and, generally, an initial fee of $7,500 per location
for existing franchisees and up to $25,000 per location for new franchisees.
 
ColorTyme has established a national advertising fund (the "Fund") for the
franchised stores, whereby ColorTyme has the right to collect up to 3% of the
monthly gross rental payments and sales from each franchisee to be contributed
to the Fund. Currently, ColorTyme has set the monthly franchisee contribution at
$250 per store per month. ColorTyme directs the advertising programs of the
Fund, generally consisting of advertising in print, television and radio.
Furthermore, the franchisees are required to expend 3% of their monthly gross
rental payments and sales on local advertising.
 
RAC has 23 franchised locations operating under the Rent-A-Center name. As
franchisor, Rent-A-Center receives royalties of up to 3% of gross receipts and a
fee of $25,000 per location. Additionally, franchisees can purchase merchandise
through Rent-A-Center with no mark-up. Rent-A-Center franchisees pay
substantially the same amount for advertising as the ColorTyme stores.
 
EMPLOYEES
 
As of September 30, 1998, the Company had approximately 11,795 employees, of
whom approximately 427 were assigned to the Company's headquarters and the
remainder of whom were directly involved in the management and operation of the
Company's stores. As of the same date, ColorTyme had approximately 18 employees,
all of which were employed full-time. None of the Company's employees are
covered by a collective bargaining agreement.
 
PROPERTIES
 
The Company. The Company leases space for all of its retail stores, as well as
its corporate and regional offices, under operating leases. Most of these leases
are for terms of 3 to 5 years and contain renewal options for an additional one
or two terms at rental rates adjusted according to agreed upon formulas. The
Company's headquarters are currently located at 13800 Montfort Drive, Dallas,
Texas, and consist of approximately 19,450 square feet. The Company has entered
into a new lease located at 5700 Tennyson Parkway, Plano, Texas (the "New
Headquarters"). The New Headquarters consist of approximately 82,274 square feet
and will be the home office for all of the Company's
 
                                       98
<PAGE>   99
 
operations beginning in November 1998. The Company intends to dispose of the
former headquarters of Rent-A-Center located in Wichita, Kansas.
 
ColorTyme. ColorTyme's headquarters are located at 1231 Greenway Drive in
Irving, Texas, and consist of approximately 9,600 square feet. It is anticipated
that ColorTyme will relocate to the New Headquarters in January 1999.
 
GOVERNMENT REGULATION
 
State Regulation
 
There are currently 45 states that have legislation regulating rental purchase
transactions. With some variations in individual states, most state legislation
requires the lessor to make prescribed disclosures to customers about the rental
purchase agreement and transaction, and provides time periods during which
customers may reinstate agreements. Some state rental purchase laws prescribe
grace periods for nonpayment, prohibit or limit certain types of collection or
other practices, and limit certain fees that may be charged. Nine states limit
the total rental payments that can be charged. Such limitations, however, do not
become applicable in general unless the total rental payments required under
agreements exceed 2 times to 2.4 times of the "disclosed cash price" or the
retail value.
 
Minnesota and, more recently, Wisconsin and New Jersey have had lower court
decisions which treat rental purchase transactions as credit sales subject to
consumer lending restrictions. In response, the Company has developed and
utilizes rent-to-rent agreements similar to RTO agreements in both Wisconsin and
Minnesota.
 
Three other states (Alaska, Montana and North Carolina), Puerto Rico and the
District of Columbia have no rental purchase legislation. However, the retail
installment sales statute in North Carolina recognizes that rental purchase
transactions which provide for more than a nominal purchase price at the end of
the agreed rental period are not credit sales under such statute. The Company
operates 23 stores in the remaining jurisdictions which have no rental purchase
legislation.
 
There can be no assurance that new or revised rental purchase laws will not be
enacted or, if enacted, that such laws would not have a material adverse effect
on the Company. See "Risk Factors -- Government Regulation."
 
Federal Legislation
 
No comprehensive federal legislation has been enacted regulating or otherwise
impacting the rental-purchase transaction. From time to time, legislation has
been introduced in Congress that would regulate the rental-purchase transaction,
including legislation that would subject the rental-purchase transaction to
interest rate, finance charge and fee limitations, as well as the Federal Truth
in Lending Act. Any such federal legislation, if enacted, could have a material
adverse effect on the Company. See "Risk Factors -- Government Regulation."
 
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
 
From time to time, the Company, along with its subsidiaries, is party to various
legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. The majority of
the material
 
                                       99
<PAGE>   100
 
proceedings involve claims that may be generally characterized into one of two
categories, recharacterization claims and statutory compliance claims.
Recharacterization claims generally involve claims (i) in states that do not
have RTO legislation, (ii) that RTO transactions are disguised installment sales
in violation of applicable state installment statutes and (iii) that allege
greater damages. Statutory compliance claims generally involve claims (i) in
states that have RTO legislation, (ii) that the operator failed to comply with
applicable state rental purchase statutes (e.g., notices and late fees) and
(iii) that allege lesser damages. Except as described below, the Company is not
currently a party to any material litigation.
 
The following litigation matters were acquired from Rent-A-Center pursuant to
the Rent-A-Center Acquisition. In connection with accounting for the
Rent-A-Center Acquisition, the Company made appropriate purchase accounting
adjustments for liabilities associated with outstanding litigation.
 
Robinson v. Thorn Americas, Inc. The plaintiffs filed this class action on April
19, 1994 in state court in New Jersey. The class consists of all residents of
New Jersey who are or have been parties to Rent-A-Center RTO contracts since
April 19, 1988. During this period, Rent-A-Center operated approximately 23
stores in New Jersey. The plaintiffs' claims are for alleged violations of the
New Jersey Retail Installment Sales Act and the New Jersey Consumer Fraud Act,
usury, unlawful contractual penalty and conversion. On January 5, 1998, the
court entered a judgment against Rent-A-Center and ordered Rent-A-Center to pay
the plaintiffs the amount equal to (i) all reinstatement fees collected by
Rent-A-Center since April 29, 1988 and (ii) 40% of all rental revenue collected
by Rent-A-Center from the plaintiffs from April 29, 1988, trebled. Later, the
court added an incentive award to the class representative, the inclusion of
attorneys' fees, and granted plaintiff's counsel 25% of the amount to be
distributed to the class. The judgment is secured by a supersedeas bond posted
by Rent-A-Center in the amount of $163 million, which amount was derived from an
accounting by plaintiffs of the projected amount of the judgment liability
through April 1999. Rent-A-Center filed its notice of appeal on January 26, 1998
and filed its appellate brief on May 5, 1998. The Company is vigorously
defending this action. However, there can be no assurance that the Company will
be successful on appeal.
 
Burney v. Thorn Americas, Inc. The plaintiffs originally filed a class action in
federal court in Wisconsin alleging Rent-A-Center's RTO contracts violated the
Wisconsin Consumer Act and federal RICO and truth-in-lending statutes. The court
first granted the plaintiffs' motion for summary judgment as to liability. The
court then withdrew that decision and dismissed the action for lack of federal
subject matter jurisdiction once the plaintiffs withdrew their truth-in-lending
claims. The plaintiffs' refiled the action on February 28, 1997 in state court
in Wisconsin, and the court granted plaintiffs' motion for class certification
on July 7, 1998. The class is comprised of the persons who were party to RTO
contracts with Rent-A-Center in Wisconsin after October 19, 1988 and who have
paid RAC an amount equal to or greater than the value of the merchandise. During
this period, Rent-A-Center operated approximately 23 stores in Wisconsin. (The
plaintiffs have asserted that the value of the merchandise for class
certification purposes is 60% of the amount required to obtain ownership.) This
limitation on the members of the class distinguishes Burney from Robinson. We
are currently in settlement negotiations with respect to this matter.
 
                                       100
<PAGE>   101
 
Colon v. Thorn Americas, Inc. The plaintiffs filed this class action in November
1997 in New York state court. Rent-A-Center removed the case to the U.S.
District Court for the Southern District of New York. Plaintiffs filed a motion
to remand, which was granted. The plaintiffs acknowledge that RTO transactions
in New York are subject to the provisions of New York's Rental Purchase Statute
but contend the Rental Purchase Statute does not provide Rent-A-Center immunity
from suit for other statutory violations. Plaintiffs allege Rent-A-Center has a
duty to disclose "effective interest" under New York consumer protection laws,
and seek damages for Rent-A-Center's failure to do so. This suit also alleges
violations relating to late fees, harassment, undisclosed charges, and the ease
of use and accuracy of its payment records. No damages theory was specified in
the complaint. The proposed class includes all New York residents who were party
to Rent-A-Center RTO contracts from November 26, 1991 through November 26, 1997.
The Company is vigorously defending this action and on September 24, 1998, filed
motions to deny class certification and dismiss the complaint. However, there
can be no assurance that such motions will be granted or that Rent-A-Center will
be found not to have any liability.
 
Anslono v. Thorn Americas, Inc. This is a putative class action filed in
Massachusetts state court on January 6, 1998. Plaintiffs acknowledge that RTO
contracts constitute "consumer leases" under Massachusetts' RTO statute, but
contend that Rent-A-Center failed to comply with certain statutory provisions
and Rent-A-Center failed to provide certain disclosures. Plaintiffs seek actual
and statutory damages and an injunction to prohibit Rent-A-Center from engaging
in the acts complained of. The proposed class includes all Massachusetts
residents who were parties to Rent-A-Center RTO contracts in the four-year
period prior to the January 6, 1998 filing. The Company is vigorously defending
this action. However, there can be no assurance that Rent-A-Center will be found
not to have any liability.
 
Allen v. Thorn Americas, Inc. The plaintiffs filed August 15, 1997 a putative
nationwide class action suit in federal court in Missouri, alleging that
Rent-A-Center has discriminated against African-Americans in its hiring,
compensation, promotional and termination policies. The Company has settled this
matter in principle for approximately $6.75 million.
 
Cooks v. Thorn Americas, Inc. The plaintiff filed a putative class action in
Texas state court in 1993, alleging violations of Texas' usury statute,
Deceptive Trade Practices Act and Insurance Code. This case has been dormant
since 1994. The Company intends to vigorously defend its subsidiary in this
action should it once again become active. However, there can be no assurance
that Rent-A-Center will be found not to have any liability.
 
In connection with the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, Thorn plc agreed to indemnify
and hold harmless the Company and Rent-A-Center from the following two lawsuits
and deposited $40 million in escrow in respect of these two lawsuits and other
indemnification claims that the Company may have against Thorn plc.
 
Fogie v. Thorn Americas, Inc. The plaintiffs filed this class action on December
4, 1991 in Minnesota. The class consists of residents of Minnesota who entered
rental purchase contracts with Rent-A-Center from August 1, 1990 through
November 30, 1996. The plaintiffs alleged that Rent-A-Center's RTO contracts
violated Minnesota's Consumer Credit Sales Act and the Minnesota General Usury
Statute. On April 15, 1998, the court
 
                                       101
<PAGE>   102
 
entered a final judgment against Rent-A-Center and ordered it to pay
approximately $30 million to the plaintiffs. Under certain provisions of the
judgment, Rent-A-Center may receive certain credits against the judgment. On May
15, 1998, Rent-A-Center filed a notice of appeal from the damages finding only.
 
Willis v. Thorn Americas, Inc. The Willis action consolidated three separate but
related actions, the first of which was filed in 1994, that cover the period
from December 22, 1988 to September 9, 1996. The plaintiffs alleged that prior
to Pennsylvania's enactment of RTO legislation, Rent-A-Center's RTO contracts
were actual installment sales contracts in violation of Pennsylvania law.
Rent-A-Center entered into a settlement agreement with the plaintiffs whereby
Rent-A-Center agreed to pay $9,350,000. On July 8, 1998, the court approved the
settlement.
 
The following litigation matters against the Company are also pending:
 
Gallagher v. Crown Leasing Corporation. On January 3, 1996, Renters Choice was
served with a class action complaint adding it as a defendant in this action
originally filed in April 1994 against Crown and certain of its affiliates in
state court in New Jersey. The class consists of all New Jersey residents who
entered into RTO contracts with Crown between April 25, 1988 and April 20, 1995.
During this period, Crown operated approximately 5 stores in New Jersey. The
lawsuit alleges, among other things, that under certain RTO contracts entered
into between the plaintiff class and Crown, some of which were purportedly
acquired by Renters Choice pursuant to the acquisition of Crown and certain of
its affiliates (the "Crown Acquisition"), the defendants failed to make the
necessary disclosures and charged the plaintiffs fees and expenses that violated
the New Jersey Consumer Fraud Act and the New Jersey Retail Installment Sales
Act. The plaintiffs seek damages including, among other things, a refund of all
excessive fees and/or interest charged or collected by the defendants in
violation of such acts, state usury laws and other related statutes and treble
damages, as applicable. Pursuant to the Asset Purchase Agreement entered into
between Crown, its controlling shareholder and Renters Choice in connection with
the Crown Acquisition, Renters Choice did not contractually assume any
liabilities pertaining to Crown's RTO contracts for the period prior to the
acquisition of Crown. The plaintiffs have obtained class certification and a
summary judgment against Crown on the liability issues. Subsequent to these
decisions by the New Jersey state court, Crown filed for protection from its
creditors under Chapter 11 of the federal bankruptcy laws. The bankruptcy court
has allowed the lawsuit to proceed in New Jersey, where the state court recently
granted summary judgment on the plaintiff's damages formula against Crown. The
plaintiffs calculated actual damages for purposes of their summary judgment
motion at approximately $7.6 million. The court ruled that the plaintiffs are
entitled to three times actual damages. However, the state court's ruling
requires certain minor adjustments pursuant to an accounting. Although the
plaintiffs were unsuccessful in their attempt to certify a class against Renters
Choice, the plaintiffs have attempted to assert a theory of successor liability
against Renters Choice. Management believes there is no basis for a claim of
successor liability against Renters Choice. The Company will take appropriate
steps to defend the successor liability issues at trial. Due to the
uncertainties associated with any litigation, the ultimate outcome of this
matter cannot presently be determined.
 
                                       102
<PAGE>   103
 
Michelle Newhouse v. Renters Choice, Inc./Handy Boykin v. Renters Choice,
Inc. On November 26, 1997 a class action complaint was filed against the Company
by Michelle Newhouse in New Jersey state court alleging, among other things,
that under certain RTO contracts entered into between the plaintiffs and the
Company, the Company failed to make the necessary disclosures and charged the
plaintiffs fees and expenses that violated the New Jersey Consumer Fraud Act and
the New Jersey Installment Sales Act. The claims arising from this action are
similar to the claims made in Robinson v. Thorn Americas, Inc. and Gallagher v.
Crown Leasing Corporation. The proposed class consists of all residents of New
Jersey who are or have been parties to contracts to RTO merchandise from the
Company within the past six years. During this period, the Company operated
approximately 17 stores in New Jersey.
 
The Company removed the case to federal court on January 21, 1998, and was then
advised by the plaintiffs' attorney that Michelle Newhouse no longer wished to
serve as class representative. A motion to voluntarily dismiss the Newhouse case
filed by the plaintiffs' attorney was granted shortly thereafter. However, on
May 1, 1998, a new class action complaint against the Company made by Handy
Boykin was filed by the plaintiffs' attorney in the Newhouse matter in New
Jersey state court alleging the same causes of action with the same proposed
class as that of the Newhouse matter. This new filing essentially constitutes a
replacement of the named plaintiff in the Newhouse matter with a new named
plaintiff, Handy Boykin. Management anticipated such a replacement and intends
to defend this matter vigorously. The Company removed the Boykin case to federal
court, where Boykin's motion to remand to New Jersey state court is now pending.
No motion for class certification has been made; however, due to the
uncertainties associated with any litigation, the ultimate outcome of this
matter cannot presently be determined. An adverse decision in this case could
have a material effect on the Company.
 
                                       103
<PAGE>   104
 
                                   MANAGEMENT
 
DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS
 
The following table sets forth certain information with respect to the executive
officers and directors of the Company:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
              NAME                AGE               POSITION
              ----                ---               --------
<S>                               <C>   <C>
J. Ernest Talley................  63    Chairman of the Board of
                                        Directors and Chief Executive
                                        Officer
Mark E. Speese..................  41    President, Chief Operating
                                        Officer and Director
Danny Z. Wilbanks...............  42    Senior Vice President -- Finance
                                        and Chief Financial Officer
L. Dowell Arnette...............  51    Executive Vice President
Joseph V. Mariner, Jr...........  78    Director
J.V. Lentell....................  60    Director
Rex W. Thompson.................  48    Director
Laurence M. Berg................  32    Director
Peter P. Copses.................  40    Director
</TABLE>
 
J. Ernest Talley. Mr. Talley has served as Chairman of the Board of Directors of
the Company since May 1989 and Chief Executive Officer since November 1994. Mr.
Talley operated an RTO business from 1963 to 1974 in Wichita, Kansas, which he
sold to Remco (later acquired by Rent-A-Center and acquired as part of the
Rent-A-Center Acquisition) in 1974. From 1974 to 1988, he was involved in the
commercial real estate business in Dallas, Texas. Mr. Talley co-founded Talley
Lease to Own, Inc. with his son, Michael C. Talley, in 1987 and served as a
director and Chief Executive Officer of that company from 1988 until its merger
with Renters Choice on January 1, 1995.
 
Mark E. Speese. Mr. Speese has served as President and a director of Renters
Choice since 1990, and as Chief Operating Officer since November 1994. From the
Company's inception in 1986 until 1990, Mr. Speese served as a Vice President
responsible for the Company's New Jersey operations. Prior to joining Renters
Choice, Mr. Speese was a regional manager for Rent-A-Center from 1979 to 1986.
 
Danny Z. Wilbanks. Mr. Wilbanks was appointed Senior Vice President -- Finance
and Chief Financial Officer of Renters Choice in April 1997. From January 1995
to April 1997, Mr. Wilbanks served as President and Chief Executive Officer of
Trans Texas Capital, L.L.C., a rental purchase company, the assets of which were
acquired by Renters Choice in February 1997. Between August 1993 and January
1995, Mr. Wilbanks was a self-employed consultant in the RTO industry. From
January 1986 to August 1993, Mr. Wilbanks, who is a certified public accountant,
served as Chief Financial Officer of Remco.
 
L. Dowell Arnette. Mr. Arnette has served as an Executive Vice President of
Renters Choice since September 1996. From May 1995 to September 1996, Mr.
Arnette served as Senior Vice President of Renters Choice. From November 1994 to
May 1995, he served as
 
                                       104
<PAGE>   105
 
Regional Vice President of Renters Choice. From 1993 to November 1994, he served
as a regional manager of Renters Choice responsible for the southeastern region.
From 1975 until 1993, Mr. Arnette was an Executive Vice President of DEF
Investments, Inc. ("DEF"), an operator of RTO stores. The Company acquired
substantially all of the assets of DEF and its subsidiaries in April 1993. Mr.
Arnette is the brother of Joe T. Arnette, Vice President -- Training & Personnel
of Renters Choice.
 
Joseph V. Mariner, Jr. Mr. Mariner has served as a director of Renters Choice
since February 1995. Until his retirement in 1978, Mr. Mariner served as
Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer of Hydrometals,
Inc., a large conglomerate with subsidiaries engaged in the manufacture of
retail plumbing supplies, nonpowered hand tools and electronic components. Mr.
Mariner currently serves as a director of Temtex Industries, Inc., a
manufacturer of energy efficient fireplaces and gas logs, Peerless Mfg. Co., a
manufacturer of heavy oil and gas filtration equipment and Dyson Kissner Moran
Corp., a New York based private investment company engaged in acquiring and
operating a multitude of manufacturing companies with additional holdings in
real estate.
 
J.V. Lentell. Mr. Lentell has served as a director of Renters Choice since
February 1995. Mr. Lentell was employed by Kansas State Bank & Trust Co.,
Wichita, Kansas, from 1966 through July 1993, serving as Chairman of the Board
from 1981 through July 1993. Since July 1993, he has served as a director and
Vice Chairman of the Board of Directors of Intrust Bank, N.A., successor by
merger to Kansas State Bank & Trust Co.
 
Rex W. Thompson. Mr. Thompson has served as a director of Renters Choice since
February 1995. Since 1988, Mr. Thompson has served as a Professor of Finance at
the Edwin L. Cox School of Business, Southern Methodist University, Dallas,
Texas, where he is the Collins Professor of Finance. Mr. Thompson previously
served as department chair, and as an associate professor at the University of
British Columbia and the Wharton School of Business.
 
Laurence M. Berg. Mr. Berg was appointed a director of Renters Choice on August
5, 1998. Mr. Berg has been associated since 1992 and a principal since 1995 with
Apollo Advisors, L.P., which together with its affiliates, acts as managing
general partner of Apollo Investment Fund, L.P., AIF II, L.P., Apollo Investment
Fund III, L.P., and Apollo Investment Fund IV, L.P. Mr. Berg is also a director
of Paragon Health Network, Inc., Continental Graphics Holdings, Inc., CWT
Specialty Stores, Inc. and Communications Corp. of America. Mr. Berg serves as
one of Apollo's designees on the Company's Board.
 
Peter P. Copses. Mr. Copses was appointed a director of Renters Choice on August
5, 1998. Mr. Copses has been a principal since 1990 of Apollo Advisors, L.P.,
which, together with its affiliates, acts as managing general partner of Apollo
Investment Fund, L.P., AIF II, L.P., Apollo Investment Fund III, L.P. and Apollo
Investment Fund IV, L.P. Mr. Copses is also a director of Paragon Health
Network, Inc., Dominick Supermarkets, Inc., and Zale Corporation. Mr. Copses
serves as one of Apollo's designees on the Company's Board.
 
                                       105
<PAGE>   106
 
TERM AND COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS
 
The Company's Board of Directors is divided into three separate classes (Class
I, Class II and Class III), with one class of directors elected at each annual
meeting to serve a three year term. Each director elected serves in such
capacity until the next annual meeting of the stockholders of Renters Choice
were that class re-elected or until their successors are duly elected and
qualified. Directors that are not employees of Renters Choice (the "Outside
Directors") each receive $3,000 for each meeting of the Board of Directors that
they attend and $1,000 for attending a meeting of a committee of the Board of
Directors. Automatic annual awards of fully-vested options to purchase 3,000
shares of common stock at the market price on the date of grant are made to each
Outside Director on the first business day of each year. Each of the Company's
directors is reimbursed for any expenses incurred by such director in connection
with such director's attendance at a meeting of the Board of Directors, or
committee thereof. Directors receive no other compensation from Renters Choice
for serving on the Board of Directors.
 
COMMITTEES OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
 
The Board of Directors has appointed (i) a Compensation Committee which consists
of Messrs. Thompson, Lentell and Mariner, (ii) an Audit Committee comprising
Messrs. Mariner, Lentell and Thompson and (iii) a Finance Committee comprising
Messrs. Talley, Lentell and Copses. Either Mr. Copses or Mr. Berg will serve on
the Compensation Committee and the Audit Committee.
 
COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION
 
J.V. Lentell, a director of the Company, serves as Vice Chairman of the Board of
Directors of Intrust Bank, N.A., one of the Company's lenders. Intrust Bank,
N.A. was an $18,000,000 participant in the Prior Credit Facility and is a
$20,000,000 participant in the Senior Credit Facilities. The Prior Credit
Facility was replaced by the Senior Credit Facilities. In addition, Intrust
Bank, N.A. serves as trustee of Company's 401(k) plan.
 
No executive officer of the Company served as a member of the compensation or
similar committee or Board of Directors of any other entity of which an
executive officer served on the Compensation Committee or Board of Directors of
the Company.
 
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY AND INDEMNIFICATION
 
As permitted by the Delaware General Corporation Law, the Company has adopted
provisions in its Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws which provide for the
indemnification of directors and officers of the Company to the fullest extent
permitted by applicable law. These provisions, among other things, indemnify
each of the Company's directors for certain expenses (including attorneys'
fees), judgments, fines and settlement amounts incurred by such director in any
action or proceeding, including any action by or in the right of the Company, on
account of such director's service as a director of the Company. In addition,
the Company maintains a customary directors' and officers' liability insurance
policy covering its directors and officers. The Company believes that these
indemnification provisions are necessary to attract and retain qualified persons
as directors.
 
                                       106
<PAGE>   107
 
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
 
The following table summarizes the compensation for fiscal 1997, 1996 and 1995
for the Company's Chief Executive Officer and each of its four other most highly
compensated executive officers in fiscal 1997 (the Chief Executive Officer and
such other officers, collectively, the "Named Executive Officers"):
 
                           SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           ANNUAL            LONG-TERM
                                       COMPENSATION(1)      COMPENSATION
                                    ---------------------   ------------
                                                             SECURITIES     ALL OTHER
                                                             UNDERLYING    COMPENSATION
NAME AND PRINCIPAL POSITION         SALARY($)    BONUS($)    OPTIONS(#)        ($)
- ---------------------------         ---------    --------   ------------   ------------
<S>                          <C>    <C>          <C>        <C>            <C>
J. Ernest Talley...........  1997   $250,000     $    --           --          --
  Chairman of the Board and  1996    240,000          --           --          --
     Chief Executive
       Officer               1995    240,000          --           --          --
Mark E. Speese.............  1997   $170,000     $21,000           --          --
  President and Chief        1996    160,000      16,000           --          --
     Operating Officer       1995    150,000      10,000           --          --
Mitchell E. Fadel(2).......  1997   $210,000     $96,000       10,000(3)       --
  President -- ColorTyme,
     Inc.                    1996    105,000(2)   96,000           --          --
                             1995         --          --           --          --
L. Dowell Arnette..........  1997   $160,000     $25,000           --          --
  Executive Vice President   1996    150,000      16,000           --          --
                             1995    132,000      23,000       15,000(4)       --
Dana F. Goble..............  1997   $120,000     $14,000        5,000(5)       --
  Senior Vice President      1996     82,000      22,000           --          --
                             1995     60,000      12,000       15,000(6)       --
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
(1) The Named Executive Officers did not receive any annual compensation not
    properly categorized as salary or bonus, except for certain perquisites or
    other benefits the aggregate cost of which did not exceed the lesser of
    $50,000 or 10% of the total of annual salary and bonus for each such
    officer.
 
(2) Mr. Fadel is President of ColorTyme, which was acquired by the Company in
    May 1996. The amount presented for 1996 reflects the portion of his $210,000
    annual salary received in 1996.
 
(3) These amounts represent options to purchase the Company's Common Stock that
    were granted to Mr. Fadel in July 1996 and were outstanding as of December
    31, 1996 (the "1996 Options"). Effective January 2, 1997, the 1996 Options
    were canceled and Mr. Fadel was granted 10,000 new options (the "New
    Options") to replace the 1996 Options. The New Options vest at 25% per year,
    beginning January 2, 1998.
 
(4) In May 1995, Mr. Arnette was granted 15,000 options to purchase the
    Company's Common Stock on a one-for-one basis, pursuant to the Company's
    Long-Term Incentive Plan. The options vest over four years and expire 10
    years from the date of the grant.
 
(5) In January 1997, Mr. Goble was granted 5,000 options to purchase the
    Company's Common Stock on a one-for-one basis, pursuant to the Company's
    Long-Term Incentive Plan. The options vest over four years and expire 10
    years from the date of the grant.
 
(6) In May 1995, Mr. Goble was granted 15,000 options to purchase the Company's
    Common Stock on a one-for-one basis, pursuant to the Company's Long-Term
    Incentive Plan. The options vest over four years and expire 10 years from
    the date of the grant.
 
                                       107
<PAGE>   108
 
OPTIONS GRANTED IN LAST FISCAL YEAR
 
The following table sets forth information concerning options granted during
fiscal 1997 to each of the Named Executive Officers. To date, no such options
have been exercised.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        POTENTIAL REALIZABLE
                                                                          VALUE AT ASSUMED
                       NUMBER OF      % OF                               ANNUAL STOCK PRICE
                       SECURITIES     TOTAL                               APPRECIATION FOR
                       UNDERLYING    GRANTED                               OPTION TERM(1)
                        OPTIONS     IN FISCAL   EXERCISE   EXPIRATION   --------------------
        NAME           GRANTED(2)     1997      PRICE(3)      DATE         5%         10%
        ----           ----------   ---------   --------   ----------   --------   ---------
<S>                    <C>          <C>         <C>        <C>          <C>        <C>
J. Ernest Talley.....         0          0          N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A
Mark E. Speese.......         0          0          N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A
Mitchell E. Fadel....    10,000(4)    1.16%      $14.38      1/2/07      90,450     229,217
L. Dowell Arnette....         0          0          N/A         N/A         N/A         N/A
Dana F. Goble........     5,000       0.58%      $14.38      1/2/07      45,225     114,609
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
(1) These amounts represent certain assumed rates of appreciation only. Actual
    gains, if any, on stock option exercises are dependent on the future
    performance of the Company's Common Stock and overall market conditions.
    There can be no assurance that the amounts reflected in this table will be
    achieved.
 
(2) Options are exercisable at 25% per year, beginning one year from the date of
    grant.
 
(3) The exercise price was fixed at the date of the grant and represented the
    fair market value per share of common stock on such date.
 
(4) These amounts represent the 1996 Options that were granted to Mr. Fadel in
    July 1996 and were outstanding as of December 31, 1996. Effective January 2,
    1997, the 1996 Options were canceled and Mr. Fadel was granted 10,000 new
    options to replace the 1996 Options. The New Options vest at 25% per year,
    beginning January 2, 1998, have an exercise price of $14.38 per share and
    expire on January 2, 2007.
 
EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS
 
The Company entered into an employment agreement with Danny Z. Wilbanks dated
March 28, 1997, pursuant to which Mr. Wilbanks became the Senior Vice
President -- Finance and Chief Financial Officer of the Company effective April
1, 1997. The employment agreement provides for Mr. Wilbanks' employment by the
Company for a two-year period commencing April 1, 1997, subject to earlier
termination by the Company or Mr. Wilbanks at any time for any reason, and for
an annual salary of $140,000 for the first year, with annual increases
thereafter as authorized by the Company's Board of Directors. The Company and
Mr. Wilbanks also entered into a stock option agreement pursuant to which Mr.
Wilbanks received an option to purchase 60,000 shares of the Company's Common
Stock, par value $0.01 per share, under the Company's Long-Term Incentive Plan,
at an exercise price of $14.00 per share. Of the 60,000 options granted, 20,000
are currently exercisable, with the remaining options vesting over the remaining
four-year period through the year 2002 on each anniversary date of the
agreement.
 
The Company does not have employment agreements with any other executive
officers or other members of management.
 
                                       108
<PAGE>   109
 
LONG-TERM INCENTIVE AND OTHER PLANS FOR EMPLOYEES
 
Long-Term Incentive Plan. Under the Company's Amended and Restated 1994 Renters
Choice, Inc. Long-Term Incentive Plan (the "Long-Term Incentive Plan")
designated officers, employees and directors of the Company are eligible to
receive awards in the form of stock options, stock appreciation rights,
restricted stock grants and cash awards. An aggregate of 4,500,000 shares of
Common Stock is currently reserved for issuance under the Long-Term Incentive
Plan, subject to adjustment in the event of a stock split, stock dividend or
other change in the Common Stock or the capital structure of the Company.
 
401(k) Savings Plan. The Company maintains a defined contribution plan (the
"401(k) Plan") whereby after one year of service substantially all employees of
the Company may defer a portion of their current salary, on a pre-tax basis, to
the 401(k) Plan. The Company may make discretionary matching contributions to
the 401(k) Plan in an amount equal to a certain percentage of each participant's
salary reduction contribution for the plan year. The Company may also make a
discretionary profit sharing contribution to the 401(k) Plan that is allocated
to the participants based on a formula defined by the 401(k) Plan. Matching
contributions made by the Company for the plan year ended December 31, 1997 were
twenty-five cents (25c) for every one dollar ($1.00) contributed through the
first four percent (4%) of employee compensation. Discretionary contributions
made by the Company for the plan year ended December 31, 1997 were $61,824. The
trustee of the 401(k) Plan is Intrust Bank, N.A.
 
                                       109
<PAGE>   110
 
                             SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF
                    CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT
 
The following table sets forth certain information regarding the beneficial
ownership of the voting securities of the Company as of September 18, 1998, by
(i) each person who is known to the Company to be the beneficial owner of more
than 5% or more of the outstanding voting securities of the Company, (ii) each
director of the Company, (iii) each Named Executive Officer, and (iv) all
executive officers and directors of the company as a group. Unless otherwise
indicated, the persons named below have the sole power to vote and dispose of
the shares of voting securities beneficially owned by them, subject to community
property laws, where applicable.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  SHARES OF SERIES A
                                         SHARES OF COMMON STOCK    PREFERRED STOCK
                                           BENEFICIALLY OWNED     BENEFICIALLY OWNED
                                         ----------------------   ------------------
          NAME AND ADDRESS OF                          PERCENT              PERCENT
           BENEFICIAL OWNER               NUMBER       OF CLASS   NUMBER    OF CLASS
          -------------------            ---------     --------   -------   --------
<S>                                      <C>           <C>        <C>       <C>
J. Ernest Talley(1)....................  4,903,166(2)   20.38%         --       --
Mark E. Speese(1)......................  2,288,432       9.51%         --       --
Montgomery Asset Management, LLC(3)....  1,553,600(4)    6.46%         --       --
L. Dowell Arnette......................    416,164(5)    1.73%         --       --
Mitchell E. Fadel......................     87,023(6)       *          --       --
Dana F. Goble..........................     21,563(7)       *          --       --
J.V. Lentell...........................     13,000(8)       *          --       --
Rex W. Thompson........................     12,000(8)       *          --       --
Joseph V. Mariner, Jr..................      5,842          *          --       --
Lawrence M. Berg(9)....................          0          *          --       --
Peter P. Copses(9).....................          0          *          --       --
Apollo(10).............................  5,004,152      17.23%    139,791    100.0%
All officers and directors as a group
  (21 total)...........................  7,827,073      32.40%    139,791    100.0%
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
  *  Less than 1%.
 
 (1) The address of J. Ernest Talley and Mark E. Speese is 13800 Montfort Drive,
     Suite 300, Dallas, Texas 75240.
 
 (2) Does not include an aggregate of 326,184 shares owned by two of Mr.
     Talley's children, as to which Mr. Talley disclaims beneficial ownership.
 
 (3) The address of Montgomery Asset Management, LLC is 101 California Street,
     San Francisco, California 94111.
 
 (4) As of September 15, 1998.
 
 (5) Includes 11,250 shares issuable pursuant to options granted under the
     Long-Term Incentive Plan, all of which are currently exercisable.
 
 (6) Includes 2,500 shares issuable pursuant to options granted under the
     Long-Term Incentive Plan, all of which are currently exercisable.
 
 (7) Includes 12,500 shares issuable pursuant to options granted under the
     Long-Term Incentive Plan, all of which are currently exercisable.
 
 (8) These shares are issuable pursuant to options granted under the Long-Term
     Incentive Plan, all of which are currently exercisable.
 
 (9) Messrs. Berg and Copses are each principals and officers of certain
     affiliates of Apollo. Accordingly, each of Messrs. Berg and Copses may be
     deemed to beneficially own shares owned by Apollo. Messrs. Berg and Copses
     disclaim beneficial ownership with respect to any such shares owned by
     Apollo.
 
(10) The address of Apollo is 1999 Avenue of the Stars, Suite 1900, Los Angeles,
     California 90067. The 5,004,152 shares of Common Stock represent the shares
     of Common Stock into which the Series A Preferred Stock is convertible
     (which is equal to the number of votes it will be entitled to cast at the
     Special Meeting). Apollo owns 134,414 shares of the Series A Preferred
     Stock and 115,586 shares of the Series B Preferred Stock, which represents
     in excess of 96% of each of the outstanding shares of the Series A
     Preferred Stock and Series B Preferred Stock. Apollo also has the right to
     vote RCAC's 5,377 shares of Series A Preferred Stock. Apollo disclaims any
     beneficial ownership in these 5,377 shares other than its right to vote
     these shares. The Series B Preferred Stock is not entitled to vote.
 
                                       110
<PAGE>   111
 
                      CERTAIN TRANSACTIONS OF THE COMPANY
 
CERTAIN BUSINESS RELATIONSHIPS
 
J.V. Lentell, a director of the Company, serves as Vice Chairman of the Board of
Directors of Intrust Bank, N.A., one of the Company's lenders. Intrust Bank,
N.A. was an $18.0 million participant in the Company's prior credit facility and
is a $20.0 million participant in the Senior Credit Facilities. This credit
facility was replaced by the Senior Credit Facilities. In addition, Intrust
Bank, N.A. serves as trustee of the Company's 401(k) plan.
 
Mitchell E. Fadel, President of ColorTyme, owns approximately 13.5% of each of
Portland II RAC, Inc. ("Portland") and Wilson Enterprises of Maine, Inc.
("Wilson"), both of which are franchisees of Rent-A-Center. As of October 13,
1998, Portland and Wilson collectively were indebted to Rent-A-Center for
approximately $31,000.
 
On August 5, 1998, Apollo purchased $250 million of the Company's Preferred
Stock. Pursuant to the Stock Purchase Agreement the Company entered into with
Apollo, Apollo is entitled to designate two individuals on the Company's Board.
Messrs. Berg and Copses currently serve as Apollo's designees on the Company's
Board.
 
ACQUISITION OF TRANS TEXAS CAPITAL, L.L.C.
 
In February 1997, the Company acquired fourteen stores in Texas from Trans Texas
Capital, L.L.C. ("Trans Texas") for approximately $7.3 million in cash (the
"Trans Texas Acquisition"). Danny Z. Wilbanks, Senior Vice President -- Finance
and Chief Financial Officer of the Company was the managing member of Trans
Texas. At the time of the Trans Texas Acquisition, Mr. Wilbanks was not an
executive officer of the Company.
 
REPURCHASE OF $25 MILLION OF THE COMPANY'S COMMON STOCK
 
On August 18, 1998, the Company repurchased 990,099 shares of the Company's
common stock for $25 million from J. Ernest Talley, the Company's Chairman of
the Board and Chief Executive Officer. The repurchase of Mr. Talley's stock was
approved by the Board of Directors of the Company on August 5, 1998. The price
was determined by a pricing committee made up of Joseph V. Mariner, Jr., J. V.
Lentell and Rex W. Thompson (and approved by the Board of Directors of the
Company, with Mr. Talley abstaining). The pricing committee met on August 17,
1998, after the close of the markets, and Mr. Talley's shares were repurchased
at the price of $25.25 per share, the closing price of the Company's common
stock on August 17, 1998.
 
                                       111
<PAGE>   112
 
                          DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
 
The following description of the capital stock of the Company and certain
provisions of the Company's Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation
(the "Certificate of Incorporation") and the Company's Amended and Restated
By-Laws (the "By-Laws") is a summary and is qualified in its entirety by the
provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws, copies of which have
been filed as exhibits to the Company's filings, from time to time, with the
SEC.
 
As of September 18, 1998, the authorized capital stock of the Company consisted
of (i) 50,000,000 shares of Common Stock, par value $.01 per share, of which
24,055,209 shares were outstanding, and (ii) 5,000,000 shares of Preferred
Stock, par value $.01 per share, of which 260,000 shares were outstanding.
 
COMMON STOCK
 
As of September 18, 1998, there were 24,055,209 shares of Common Stock
outstanding held by approximately 75 record holders. The holders of Common Stock
are entitled to one vote per share on all matters submitted to a vote of the
stockholders. Cumulative voting of shares of Common Stock is prohibited. The
holders of Common Stock are entitled to receive ratably such dividends, if any,
as may be declared from time to time by the Board of Directors out of assets
legally available therefor, subject to the payment of any preferential dividends
and the setting aside of sinking funds or redemption accounts, if any, with
respect to any Preferred Stock that from time to time may be outstanding. In the
event of liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company, the holders of
Common Stock are entitled to share ratably in all assets remaining after payment
of liabilities, subject to prior distribution rights of the holders of any
outstanding Preferred Stock. The holders of Common Stock have no preemptive or
conversion rights or other subscription rights, and there are no redemption or
sinking fund provisions applicable to the Common Stock. All of the outstanding
shares of Common Stock are fully paid and nonassessable, and all of the shares
of Common Stock offered hereby, when issued, will be fully paid and
nonassessable.
 
PREFERRED STOCK
 
The Board of Directors of the Company, without further action by the
stockholders, is authorized to issue up to 5,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock
(the "Preferred Stock") in one or more series and to fix and determine as to any
series any and all of the relative rights and preferences of shares in such
series, including, without limitation, preferences, limitations or relative
rights with respect to redemption rights, conversion rights, voting rights,
dividend rights and preferences on liquidation.
 
Convertible Preferred Stock
 
To finance a portion of the cost of the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, the Company
issued to Apollo 250,000 shares of Convertible Preferred Stock at $1,000 per
share, resulting in aggregate proceeds to the Company of $250 million. In
addition, the Company issued to an affiliate of Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. ("Bear
Stearns") 10,000 shares of Convertible Preferred Stock at $1,000 per share
contemporaneously with the Offering, resulting in
 
                                       112
<PAGE>   113
 
aggregate proceeds to the Company of $10 million. The terms of the Convertible
Preferred Stock are summarized below.
 
Series A and Series B Preferred Stock. The Company issued to Apollo 134,414
shares of Series A Preferred Stock ("Series A Preferred Stock") and 115,586
shares of Series B Preferred Stock ("Series B Preferred Stock" and, together
with the Series A Preferred Stock, the "Convertible Preferred Stock"). The
Company issued to Bear Stearns 5,377 shares of Series A Preferred Stock and
4,623 of Series B Preferred Stock. Series B Preferred Stock is convertible into
Series A Preferred Stock if the stockholders of the Company approve such
conversion (the "Conversion") in accordance with the following schedule and
terms: if the stockholders approve the Conversion on or before December 3, 1998,
then each outstanding share of Series B Preferred Stock shall be automatically
converted into one fully-paid and non-assessable share of Series A Preferred
Stock; if the stockholders approve the Conversion during the period commencing
on December 4, 1998 and continuing up to and including January 2, 1999, then
each outstanding share shall be automatically converted into 1.15 fully-paid and
non-assessable shares of Series A Preferred Stock; and, if the stockholders
shall approve the Conversion on or after January 3, 1999, then each outstanding
share of Series B Preferred Stock shall be convertible into 1.2 fully-paid and
non-assessable shares of Series A Preferred Stock at the sole option and
discretion of each holder of Series B Preferred Stock.
 
Liquidation Preference. The Series A Preferred Stock has a liquidation
preference of $1,000 per share, plus all accrued and unpaid dividends. The
Series B Preferred Stock has a liquidation preference equal to the product of
(i) $1,050 per share of Series B Preferred Stock, plus all accrued and unpaid
dividends and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the number equal to the
current market price as of the relevant liquidation date, and the denominator of
which is the number equal to the average stock price for the fifteen trading
days prior to August 5, 1998 (adjusted for stock splits, reorganizations,
recapitalization of similar events); provided, however, in no case shall the
liquidation preference for Series B Preferred Stock be an amount less than the
number in subparagraph (i) immediately above. No distributions may be made to
holders of common stock of the Company until the holders of the Convertible
Preferred Stock have received the liquidation preference.
 
Dividends. Holders of Series A Preferred Stock are entitled to receive quarterly
dividends at the rate of $37.50 per annum per share of Series A Preferred Stock.
Holders of Series B Preferred Stock are initially entitled to receive quarterly
dividends at the rate of $37.50 per annum per share of Series B Preferred Stock;
provided, however, on and after the earlier of the date of the stockholders'
meeting to approve the Conversion or December 4, 1998, holders of Series B
Preferred Stock will be entitled to receive quarterly dividends at the rate of
$70.00 per annum per share of Series B Preferred Stock. For the first five
years, dividends on the Convertible Preferred Stock may be paid, at the option
of the Company, in cash or in additional Convertible Preferred Stock. With
respect to the Series A Preferred Stock only, for the four quarters beginning
the ninth quarter following August 5, 1998, no dividend shall be paid or accrued
on any share of Series A Preferred Stock for any quarter in which the average
stock price for the fifteen consecutive trading days immediately preceding the
payment date is equal to or greater than two times the Conversion Price (as
defined below). Also with respect to Series A Preferred Stock only, for each
quarter beginning the thirteenth quarter following August 5, 1998, no dividend
shall be paid or accrued on any share of Series A Preferred Stock in any quarter
in which
 
                                       113
<PAGE>   114
 
the average stock price for the fifteen consecutive trading days immediately
preceding the payment date is equal to or greater than the Conversion Price
accumulated forward to the payment date at a compound annual growth rate of 25%
per annum, compounded quarterly.
 
Conversion Price. Holders of Series A Preferred Stock may convert their shares
of Series A Preferred Stock at any time into shares of the Company's voting
common stock at a price equal to $27.935 per share (the "Conversion Price"). The
Series B Preferred Stock shall initially not be convertible into any other class
or series of stock of the Company (except with respect to the Conversion to
Series A Preferred Stock as set forth above). After the earlier of December 4,
1998 or the date of the first stockholders' meeting after August 5, 1998,
holders of the Series B Preferred Stock may convert their shares of Series B
Preferred Stock into shares of the Company's non-voting common stock. The number
of shares of non-voting common stock issuable upon conversion for each share of
Series B Preferred Stock shall be determined by dividing (i) the number of
shares of common stock issuable as if the Series B Preferred Stock had been
first converted into Series A Preferred Stock by (ii)(A) 1.00, in the event the
shares of Series B are converted during the period commencing on December 4,
1998 and continuing up to and including January 2, 1999 or (B) .75, in the event
the shares of Series B Preferred Stock are converted on or after January 3,
1999. If it is determined that the Company cannot issue non-voting common stock
upon a conversion election by a holder of Series B Preferred Stock, such holder
shall be entitled to receive common stock in lieu of non-voting common stock.
 
Optional Redemption. The Series A Preferred Stock is not redeemable for four
years; thereafter, the Company may redeem all but one share of the Series A
Preferred Stock at any time at 105% of the liquidation preference plus accrued
and unpaid dividends. Apollo may reserve from redemption one share of Series A
Preferred Stock until such time as it and its Permitted Transferees (as defined
in the Certificate of Designations, Preferences and Relative Rights and
Limitations of Series A Preferred Stock of Renters Choice, Inc.) shall own less
than 33 1/3% of the Shares (as defined immediately below) initially issued to
Apollo. "Shares" is defined as shares of the common stock (voting and
non-voting), the Series A Preferred Stock and the Series B Preferred Stock, and
the preceding percentage shall be calculated as if each of the Shares had been
exchanged or converted into shares of common stock immediately prior to the
calculation regardless of the existence of any restrictions on such exchange or
conversion. The Series B Preferred Stock is not redeemable by the Company.
 
Mandatory Redemption. Holders of Convertible Preferred Stock have the right to
require the Company to redeem the Convertible Preferred Stock on the earliest of
a change of control, the date upon which the Company's common stock is not
listed for trading on a United States national securities exchange or the Nasdaq
National Market System or the eleventh anniversary of the issuance of the
Convertible Preferred Stock at a price equal to the liquidation preference of
the Convertible Preferred Stock.
 
Board Representation. Holders of Series A Preferred Stock are entitled to two
seats on the Company's Board of Directors.
 
                                       114
<PAGE>   115
 
Voting Rights. Holders of Series A Preferred Stock are entitled to vote on all
matters presented to the holders of the Company's common stock. The number of
votes per share of Series A Preferred Stock shall be equal to the number of
votes associated with the underlying voting common stock into which such Series
A Preferred Stock is convertible.
 
CERTAIN ANTI-TAKEOVER MATTERS
 
The Company's Amended and Restated By-Laws establish advance notice procedures
with regard to stockholder proposals relating to the nomination of candidates
for election as directors to be brought before meetings of stockholders of the
Company. These procedures provide that notice of such stockholder proposals must
be timely given in writing to the Secretary of the Company prior to the meeting
at which action is to be taken. Generally, to be timely, notice must be received
at the principal executive offices of the Company not less than 90 days prior to
the anniversary date of the immediately preceding annual meeting of
stockholders. Such notice must also contain certain information specified in the
Company's Amended and Restated By-Laws.
 
There are currently 5,000,000 authorized shares of Preferred Stock, of which
260,000 shares were outstanding as of September 18, 1998. The existence of
authorized but unissued Preferred Stock may enable the Board of Directors to
render more difficult or to discourage an attempt to obtain control of the
Company by means of a merger, tender offer, proxy consent or otherwise. For
example, if in the due exercise of its fiduciary obligations, the Board of
Directors were to determine that a takeover proposal is not in the Company's
best interests, the Board of Directors could cause shares of Preferred Stock to
be issued without stockholder approval in one or more private offerings or other
transactions that might dilute the voting or other rights of the proposed
acquirer or insurgent stockholder or stockholder group or create a substantial
voting block in institutional or other hands that might undertake to support the
position of the incumbent Board of Directors. In this regard, the Amended and
Restated Certificate of Incorporation grants the Board of Directors broad power
to establish the rights and preferences of authorized and unissued Preferred
Stock. The issuance of shares of Preferred Stock pursuant to the Board of
Directors' authority described above could decrease the amount of earnings and
assets available for distribution to holders of Common Stock and adversely
affect the rights and powers, including voting rights, of such holders and may
have the effect of delaying, deterring or preventing a change in control of the
Company. The Board of Directors does not currently intend to seek stockholder
approval prior to any issuance of Preferred Stock, unless otherwise required by
law.
 
The Company is a Delaware corporation and is subject to Section 203 of the
Delaware General Corporation Law (the "DGCL"). In general, subject to certain
exceptions, Section 203 prohibits a Delaware corporation from engaging in a
"business combination" with an "interested stockholder" for a period of three
years following the date that such stockholder became an interested stockholder,
unless (i) prior to such date the board of directors of the corporation approved
either the business combination or the transaction which resulted in the
stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, or (ii) upon consummation of the
transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested
stockholder, the interested stockholder owned at least 85% of the voting stock
of the corporation outstanding at the time the transaction commenced (excluding
for purposes of determining the number of shares outstanding those shares owned
by (x) persons who are
 
                                       115
<PAGE>   116
 
directors and also officers and (y) employee stock plans in which employee
participants do not have the right to determine confidentially whether shares
held subject to the plan will be tendered in a tender or exchange offer), or
(iii) on or subsequent to such date the business combination is approved by the
board of directors and authorized at an annual or special meeting of
stockholders, and not by written consent, by the affirmative vote of at least
66 2/3% of the outstanding voting stock which is not owned by the interested
stockholder. Section 203 defines a "business combination" to include certain
mergers, consolidations, asset sales and stock issuances and certain other
transactions resulting in a financial benefit to an "interested stockholder." In
addition, Section 203 defines an "interested stockholder" to include any entity
or person beneficially owning 15% or more of the outstanding voting stock of the
corporation and any entity or person affiliated with such an entity or person.
 
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY
 
The DGCL allows a Delaware corporation to limit a director's personal liability
for monetary damages for breaches of certain fiduciary duties owed to the
corporation and its stockholders. The Amended and Restated Certificate of
Incorporation contains a provision that limits the liability of its directors
for monetary damages for any breach of fiduciary duty as a director to the
maximum extent permitted by the DGCL. This provision, however, does not
eliminate a director's liability (i) for any breach of the director's duty of
loyalty to the Company or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or omissions not in
good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of
law, (iii) for a transaction from which the director derived an improper
personal benefit, or (iv) in respect of certain unlawful dividend payments or
stock purchases or redemptions. The inclusion of this provision in the Amended
and Restated Certificate of Incorporation may reduce the likelihood of
derivative litigation against directors and may discourage or deter stockholders
or management from bringing a lawsuit against directors for breaches of their
fiduciary duties, even though such an action, if successful, might otherwise
have benefited the Company and its stockholders. This provision does not prevent
the Company or its stockholders from seeking injunctive relief or other
equitable remedies against its directors under applicable state law, although
there can be no assurance that such remedies, if sought, would be obtained.
 
TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR
 
The transfer agent and registrar for the Common Stock and the Preferred Stock is
ChaseMellon Shareholder Services, L.L.C.
 
                                       116
<PAGE>   117
 
                       DESCRIPTION OF OTHER INDEBTEDNESS
 
The description set forth below does not purport to be complete and is subject
to, and qualified in its entirety by reference to, all of the provisions
(including all of the definitions therein of terms not defined in this
Prospectus) of certain agreements setting forth the principal terms and
conditions of the Company's Senior Credit Facility which is available upon
request from the Company.
 
SENIOR SECURED CREDIT FACILITY
 
To assist in financing the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, the Company obtained
$962.3 million in senior secured credit facilities, for which The Chase
Manhattan Bank serves as Administrative Agent. Chase Securities Inc. acted as
Arranger. Comerica Bank serves as Documentation Agent. NationsBank, N.A. serves
as Syndication Agent. The Senior Credit Facilities consist of the following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     LIBOR
SENIOR FACILITIES                             AMOUNT     TENOR     SPREAD(1)
- -----------------                             ------   ---------   ---------
                                                  (DOLLARS IN MILLIONS)
<S>                                           <C>      <C>         <C>
Senior Revolving Credit Facility............  $120.0   6.0 years    225 bps
Letter of Credit/Multidraw Facility(2)......  122.3    6.0 years    225 bps
Senior Term Loan A Facility.................  120.0    6.0 years    225 bps
Senior Term Loan B Facility.................  270.0    7.5 years    250 bps
Senior Term Loan C Facility.................  330.0    8.5 years    275 bps
                                              ------
          Total Facilities..................  $962.3
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
(1) Pricing subject to a leverage-based pricing grid.
 
(2) The Letter of Credit/Multidraw Facility are included in funded debt for
    purposes of calculating covenants and the pricing grid.
 
The $120.0 million 6.0 year Revolving Credit Facility will be made available to
the Company for working capital and general corporate purposes, including
acquisitions. The $122.3 million 6.0 year Letter of Credit/Multidraw Facility
has been initially used to post a letter of credit to support a $163 million
bond relating to certain New Jersey litigation. Once the Letter of Credit has
been terminated, the Company will be permitted to borrow up to $85 million under
the multidraw term loan facility. The $720.0 million in Term Loan Facilities,
comprised of a $120.0 million 6.0 year Tranche A facility, a $270.0 million 7.5
year Tranche B facility, and a $330.0 million 8.5 year Tranche C facility, was
drawn at the closing of the Rent-A-Center Acquisition to fund the Company's
purchase of Rent-A-Center's stock, refinance existing debt held by the Company
and to pay certain other costs associated with the Rent-A-Center Acquisition.
 
The Senior Credit Facilities are secured by a perfected first priority security
interest in substantially all of the Company's tangible and intangible assets
including, without limitation, intellectual property, real property, and the
capital stock of the Company's direct and indirect subsidiaries. The Senior
Credit Facilities are unconditionally guaranteed by each of the Company's direct
and indirect domestic subsidiaries. In addition, the Senior Credit Facilities
will be subject to several financial covenants, including (i) a maximum leverage
ratio, (ii) a minimum interest coverage ratio, and (iii) a minimum fixed charge
coverage ratio.
 
                                       117
<PAGE>   118
 
                    DESCRIPTION OF THE NOTES AND GUARANTEES
 
GENERAL
 
The Exchange Notes will be issued, and the Old Notes were issued, under the
Indenture among the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and IBJ Schroder Bank &
Trust Company, as trustee (the "Trustee"), a copy of which has been filed as an
exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus is a part.
 
The following summary of certain provisions of the Indenture and the Notes does
not purport to be complete and is subject to, and is qualified in its entirety
by reference to, all the provisions of the Indenture, including the definitions
of certain terms therein and those terms made a part thereof by the TIA.
Capitalized terms defined in "-- Certain Definitions" below are used in this
"Description of the Notes and Guarantees" as so defined. For purposes of this
Section, any reference to a "Holder" means a Holder of the Notes.
 
The Notes are unsecured obligations of the Company ranking subordinate in right
of payment to all Senior Indebtedness of the Company. The Notes are fully and
unconditionally guaranteed on an unsecured senior subordinated basis by the
Company's existing and future Restricted Subsidiaries.
 
MATURITY, INTEREST AND PRINCIPAL
 
The Notes are limited to $175 million aggregate principal amount and will mature
on August 15, 2008. Each Note will bear interest at 11% per annum from the date
of issuance, or from the most recent date to which interest has been paid or
provided for, payable semiannually in cash and in arrears to Holders of record
at the close of business on the February 1 or August 1 immediately preceding the
interest payment date on February 15 and August 15 of each year, commencing
February 15, 1999.
 
Interest is computed on the basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve 30-day
months. Principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes is payable, and
the Notes may be exchanged or transferred, at the office or agency of the
Company in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York (which initially shall
be the principal corporate trust office of the Trustee, at One State Street, New
York, New York), except that, at the option of the Company, payment of interest
may be made by check mailed to the addresses of the Holders of the Notes as such
addresses appear in the Note Register. Any Old Notes that remain outstanding
after the completion of the Exchange Offer, together with the Exchange Notes
issued in connection with the Exchange Offer, will be treated as a single class
of securities under the Indenture. See "The Exchange Offer" and "Old Notes
Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement."
 
The Notes will be issued only in fully registered form, without coupons, in
denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples thereof. No service charge will
be made for any registration of transfer or exchange of Notes, but the Company
may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any transfer tax or other
similar governmental charge payable in connection therewith.
 
                                       118
<PAGE>   119
 
OPTIONAL REDEMPTION
 
The Notes are redeemable, at the Company's option, in whole or in part, at any
time and from time to time on and after August 15, 2003 and prior to maturity,
upon not less than 30 nor more than 90 days' prior notice mailed by first-class
mail to each Holder's registered address, at the following redemption prices
(expressed as a percentage of principal amount), plus accrued interest, if any,
to the redemption date (subject to the right of Holders of record on the
relevant record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment
date), if redeemed during the 12-month period commencing on August 15 of the
years set forth below:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              REDEMPTION
                   PERIOD                       PRICE
                   ------                     ----------
<S>                                           <C>
2003........................................   105.500%
2004........................................   103.667%
2005........................................   101.833%
2006 and thereafter.........................   100.000%
</TABLE>
 
In addition, at any time and from time to time prior to August 15, 2001, the
Company may redeem in the aggregate up to 33.33% of the original aggregate
principal amount of the Notes with the proceeds of one or more Equity Offerings
by the Company at a redemption price (expressed as a percentage of principal
amount thereof) of 111% plus accrued interest, if any, to the redemption date
(subject to the right of Holders of record on the relevant record date to
receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date); provided, however,
that at least 66.67% of the original aggregate principal amount of the Notes
must remain outstanding after each such redemption and that any such redemption
occurs within 90 days following the closing of any such Equity Offering.
 
SELECTION AND NOTICE OF REDEMPTION
 
In the event that less than all of the Notes are to be redeemed at any time
pursuant to an optional redemption, selection of the Notes for redemption will
be made by the Trustee on a pro rata basis, by lot or by such method as the
Trustee shall deem fair and appropriate; provided that no Notes of a principal
amount or principal amount at maturity, as the case may be, of $1,000 or less
shall be redeemed in part. Notice of redemption shall be mailed by first-class
mail at least 30 but not more than 90 days before the redemption date to each
Holder of Notes to be redeemed at its registered address. If any Note is to be
redeemed in part only, the notice of redemption that relates to such Note shall
state the portion of the principal amount or principal amount at maturity, as
the case may be, thereof to be redeemed. A new Note in a principal amount equal
to the unredeemed portion thereof will be issued in the name of the holder
thereof upon cancellation of the original Note. On and after the redemption
date, interest will cease to accrue on Notes or portions thereof called for
redemption as long as the Company has deposited with the paying agent for the
Notes funds in satisfaction of the applicable redemption price pursuant to the
Indenture.
 
                                       119
<PAGE>   120
 
RANKING
 
The indebtedness evidenced by the Notes (i) is unsecured Senior Subordinated
Indebtedness of the Company, (ii) is subordinated in right of payment, as set
forth in the Indenture, to the payment when due of all existing and future
Senior Indebtedness of the Company, including the Company's Obligations under
the Senior Credit Facility, (iii) ranks pari passu in right of payment with all
existing and future Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of the Company and (iv) is
senior in right of payment to all existing and future Subordinated Obligations
of the Company. The Notes are also effectively subordinated to any Secured
Indebtedness of the Company and its Subsidiaries to the extent of the value of
the assets securing such Indebtedness. However, payment from the money or the
proceeds of U.S. Government Obligations held in any defeasance trust described
under "-- Defeasance" below is not subordinated to any Senior Indebtedness or
subject to the restrictions described herein.
 
At June 30, 1998, after giving effect to the Transactions and the application of
the proceeds therefrom as described herein under "Use of Proceeds," the
outstanding Senior Indebtedness of the Company would have been approximately
$720.0 million (excluding the unfunded Senior Revolving Credit Facility and
outstanding letters of credit under the Letter of Credit/Multidraw Facility).
Although the Indenture contains limitations on the amount of additional
Indebtedness which the Company may Incur, under certain circumstances the amount
of such Indebtedness could be substantial and, in any case, such Indebtedness
may be Senior Indebtedness. See "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on
Indebtedness" below.
 
Only Indebtedness of the Company that is Senior Indebtedness will rank senior to
the Notes in accordance with the provisions of the Indenture. The Notes will in
all respects rank pari passu with all other Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of
the Company. The Company has agreed in the Indenture that it will not Incur,
directly or indirectly, any Indebtedness that is subordinate or junior in
ranking in any respect to Senior Indebtedness unless such Indebtedness is Senior
Subordinated Indebtedness or is expressly subordinated in right of payment to
Senior Subordinated Indebtedness. Unsecured Indebtedness is not deemed to be
subordinate or junior to Secured Indebtedness merely because it is unsecured.
 
The Company may not pay principal of, premium (if any) or interest on, the Notes
or make any deposit pursuant to the provisions described under "Defeasance"
below and may not otherwise purchase, redeem or otherwise retire any Notes
(collectively, "pay the Notes") if (i) any Senior Indebtedness is not paid when
due in cash or Cash Equivalents or (ii) any other default on Senior Indebtedness
occurs and the maturity of such Senior Indebtedness is accelerated in accordance
with its terms unless, in either case, (x) the default has been cured or waived
and any such acceleration has been rescinded in writing or (y) such Senior
Indebtedness has been paid in full in cash or Cash Equivalents. However, the
Company may pay the Notes without regard to the foregoing if the Company and the
Trustee receive written notice approving such payment from the Representative of
the Designated Senior Indebtedness with respect to which either of the events
set forth in clause (i) or (ii) of the immediately preceding sentence has
occurred and is continuing.
 
                                       120
<PAGE>   121
 
In addition, during the continuance of any default (other than a default
described in clause (i) or (ii) of the first sentence of the immediately
preceding paragraph) with respect to any Designated Senior Indebtedness pursuant
to which the maturity thereof may be accelerated immediately without further
notice (except such notice as may be required to effect such acceleration) or
the expiration of any applicable grace periods, the Company may not pay the
Notes for a period (a "Payment Blockage Period") commencing upon the receipt by
the Trustee (with a copy to the Company) of written notice (a "Blockage Notice")
of such default from the Representative of the Designated Senior Indebtedness
specifying an election to effect a Payment Blockage Period and ending on the
date 179 days thereafter (or earlier if such Payment Blockage Period is
terminated (i) by written notice to the Trustee and the Company from the Person
or Persons who gave such Blockage Notice, (ii) because such Designated Senior
Indebtedness has been discharged or repaid in full or (iii) because the default
giving rise to such Blockage Notice is no longer continuing). Notwithstanding
the provisions described in the immediately preceding sentence (but subject to
the provisions contained in the first sentence of the immediately preceding
paragraph), unless the holders of such Designated Senior Indebtedness or the
Representative of such holders have accelerated the maturity of such Designated
Senior Indebtedness, the Company may resume payments on the Notes after the end
of such Payment Blockage Period. Not more than one Blockage Notice may be given
in any consecutive 360-day period, irrespective of the number of defaults with
respect to Designated Senior Indebtedness during such period. However, if any
Blockage Notice within such 360-day period is given by or on behalf of any
holders of Designated Senior Indebtedness other than Bank Indebtedness, a
Representative of Bank Indebtedness may give another Blockage Notice within such
period. In no event, however, may the total number of days during which any
Payment Blockage Period or Periods is in effect exceed 179 days in the aggregate
during any 360 consecutive day period.
 
Upon any payment or distribution of the assets of the Company upon a total or
partial liquidation or dissolution or reorganization of or similar proceeding
relating to the Company or its property, or in a bankruptcy, insolvency,
receivership or similar proceeding relating to the Company or its property, the
holders of Senior Indebtedness will be entitled to receive payment in full of
the Senior Indebtedness before the Noteholders are entitled to receive any
payment and until the Senior Indebtedness is paid in full, any payment or
distribution to which Noteholders would be entitled but for the subordination
provisions of the Indenture will be made to holders of the Senior Indebtedness
as their interests may appear. If a distribution is made to Noteholders that due
to the subordination provisions should not have been made to them, such
Noteholders are required to hold it in trust for the holders of Senior
Indebtedness and pay it over to them as their interests may appear.
 
If payment of the Notes is accelerated because of an Event of Default, the
Company or the Trustee shall promptly notify the holders of the Designated
Senior Indebtedness or the Representative of such holders of the acceleration.
The Company may not pay the Notes until five Business Days after such holders or
the Representative of the Designated Senior Indebtedness receive notice of such
acceleration and, thereafter, may pay the Notes only if the subordination
provisions of the Indenture otherwise permit payment at that time.
 
By reason of such subordination provisions contained in the Indenture, in the
event of insolvency, creditors of the Company who are holders of Senior
Indebtedness may recover more, ratably, than the Noteholders.
 
                                       121
<PAGE>   122
 
GUARANTEES
 
Each Subsidiary Guarantor will unconditionally guarantee, jointly and severally,
to each holder and the Trustee, on an unsecured, senior subordinated basis, the
full and prompt payment of principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the
Notes, and of all other obligations under the Indenture.
 
The indebtedness evidenced by each Subsidiary Guarantee (including the payment
of principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes and other
obligations with respect to the Notes) will be subordinated to all Guarantor
Senior Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor on the same basis as the Notes
are subordinated to Senior Indebtedness of the Company. Each Subsidiary
Guarantee will in all respects rank pari passu with all other Senior
Subordinated Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor. In addition, a
Subsidiary Guarantor may not incur any Indebtedness if such Indebtedness is
subordinate or junior in ranking in any respect to any Guarantor Senior
Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor unless such Indebtedness is Guarantor
Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor or is expressly
subordinated in right of payment to Guarantor Senior Subordinated Indebtedness
of such Subsidiary Guarantor. As of June 30, 1998, on a pro forma basis after
giving effect to the Transactions, there would have been no Guarantor Senior
Indebtedness of Subsidiary Guarantors other than the Guarantees of the Senior
Credit Facility. See "Description of Other Indebtedness." Although the Indenture
contains limitations on the amount of additional Indebtedness that the Company's
Restricted Subsidiaries may incur, under certain circumstances the amount of
such Indebtedness could be substantial and, in any case, such Indebtedness may
be Guarantor Senior Indebtedness. See "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on
Indebtedness" and "-- Ranking."
 
The obligations of each Subsidiary Guarantor is limited to the maximum amount as
will, after giving effect to all other contingent and fixed liabilities of such
Subsidiary Guarantor (including without limitation, any Guarantees under the
Senior Credit Facility) and after giving effect to any collections from or
payments made by or on behalf of any other Subsidiary Guarantor in respect of
the obligations of such other Subsidiary Guarantor under its Subsidiary
Guarantee or pursuant to its contribution obligations under the Indenture,
result in the obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor under its Subsidiary
Guarantee not constituting a fraudulent conveyance or fraudulent transfer under
federal or state law.
 
Each Subsidiary Guarantor may consolidate with or merge into or sell its assets
to the Company or another Wholly-Owned Subsidiary Guarantor without limitation.
Each Subsidiary Guarantor may consolidate with or merge into or sell all or
substantially all its assets to a corporation, partnership, trust, limited
partnership, limited liability company or other similar entity other than the
Company or a Wholly Owned-Subsidiary Guarantor (whether or not affiliated with
the Subsidiary Guarantor); provided, that (i) any sale or disposition of a
Subsidiary Guarantor (by merger, consolidation, the sale of its Capital Stock or
the sale of all or substantially all of its assets) to a Person (whether or not
an Affiliate of the Subsidiary Guarantor) other than the Company or a
Wholly-Owned Subsidiary Guarantor, must comply with the Indenture (including the
covenant described under "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on Sales of
Assets"), and (ii) such Subsidiary Guarantor will be deemed released from all of
its obligations under the Indenture and its Subsidiary Guarantee and such
Subsidiary Guarantee will terminate; provided, however,
 
                                       122
<PAGE>   123
 
that any such termination will occur only to the extent that all obligations of
such Subsidiary Guarantor under the Senior Credit Facility and all of its
Guarantees of, and under all of its pledges of assets or other security
interests which secure, any other Indebtedness of the Company will also
terminate upon such release, sale or disposition.
 
CHANGE OF CONTROL
 
Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control (as defined below), each Holder will
have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or any part of such
Holder's Notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the principal amount
thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of repurchase
(subject to the right of Holders of record on the relevant record date to
receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date); provided, however,
that notwithstanding the occurrence of a Change of Control, the Company shall
not be obligated to purchase the Notes pursuant to this covenant in the event
that it has exercised its right to redeem all of the Notes as described under
"-- Optional Redemption." "Change of Control" means (i) any "Person" (as such
term is used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Exchange Act), other than one or
more Permitted Holders, is or becomes the beneficial owner (as defined in Rules
13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act, except that a Person shall be deemed to
have "beneficial ownership" of all shares that any such Person has the right to
acquire within one year), directly or indirectly, of more than 50% of the Voting
Stock of the Company or a Successor Company (as defined below) (including,
without limitation, through a merger or consolidation or purchase of Voting
Stock of the Company); provided that the Permitted Holders do not have the right
or ability by voting power, contract or otherwise to elect or designate for
election a majority of the Board of Directors; (ii) during any period of two
consecutive years, individuals who at the beginning of such period constituted
the Board of Directors (together with any new directors whose election by such
Board of Directors or whose nomination for election by the shareholders of the
Company was approved by a vote of a majority of the directors of the Company
then still in office who were either directors at the beginning of such period
or whose election or nomination for election was previously so approved) cease
for any reason to constitute a majority of the Board of Directors then in
office; (iii) the sale, lease, transfer, conveyance or other disposition (other
than by way of merger or consolidation), in one or a series of related
transactions, of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company and its
Restricted Subsidiaries taken as a whole to any Person or group of related
Persons (a "Group") (as such term is used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the
Exchange Act) other than a Permitted Holder; or (iv) the adoption of a plan
relating to the liquidation or dissolution of the Company.
 
Unless the Company has exercised its right to redeem all the Notes as described
under "-- Optional Redemption," the Company shall within 30 days following any
Change of Control (or at the Company's option, prior to such Change of Control
but after the public announcement thereof) mail a notice to each Holder with a
copy to the Trustee stating: (1) that a Change of Control has occurred or will
occur and that such Holder has (or upon such occurrence will have) the right to
require the Company to purchase such Holder's Notes at a purchase price in cash
equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest,
if any, to the date of purchase (subject to the right of Holders of record on a
record date to receive interest on the relevant interest payment date); (2) the
circumstances and relevant facts and financial information regarding such
 
                                       123
<PAGE>   124
 
Change of Control; (3) the date of purchase (which shall be no earlier than 30
days nor later than 90 days from the date such notice is mailed); (4) the
instructions determined by the Company, consistent with this covenant, that a
Holder must follow in order to have its Notes purchased; and (5) that, if such
offer is made prior to such Change of Control, payment is conditioned on the
occurrence of such Change of Control.
 
The Company will comply, to the extent applicable, with the requirements of
Section 14(e) of the Exchange Act and any other securities laws or regulations
in connection with the repurchase of Notes pursuant to this covenant. To the
extent that the provisions of any securities laws or regulations conflict with
provisions of this covenant, the Company will comply with the applicable
securities laws and regulations and will not be deemed to have breached its
obligations under this paragraph by virtue thereof.
 
The Change of Control purchase feature is a result of negotiations between the
Company and the Initial Purchasers. The Company has no present plans to engage
in a transaction involving a Change of Control, although it is possible that the
Company would decide to do so in the future. Subject to the limitations
discussed below, the Company could, in the future, enter into certain
transactions, including acquisitions, refinancings or recapitalizations, that
would not constitute a Change of Control under the Indenture, but that could
increase the amount of indebtedness outstanding at such time or otherwise affect
the Company's capital structure or credit ratings.
 
The occurrence of a Change of Control would constitute a default under the
Senior Credit Agreement. Future Senior Indebtedness of the Company may contain
prohibitions of certain events which would constitute a Change of Control or
require such Senior Indebtedness to be repurchased upon a Change of Control.
Moreover, the exercise by the Holders of their right to require the Company to
repurchase the Notes could cause a default under such Senior Indebtedness, even
if the Change of Control itself does not, due to the financial effect of such
repurchase on the Company. Finally, the Company's ability to pay cash to the
Holders upon a repurchase may be limited by the Company's then existing
financial resources. There can be no assurance that sufficient funds will be
available when necessary to make any required repurchases.
 
The Change of Control provisions described above may deter certain mergers,
tender offers and other takeover attempts involving the Company by increasing
the capital required to effectuate such transactions. The definition of "Change
of Control" includes a disposition of all or substantially all of the property
and assets of the Company and its Subsidiaries. With respect to the disposition
of property or assets, the phrase "all or substantially all" as used in the
Indentures varies according to the facts and circumstances of the subject
transaction, has no clearly established meaning under New York law and is
subject to judicial interpretation. Accordingly, in certain circumstances there
may be a degree of uncertainty in ascertaining whether a particular transaction
would involve a disposition of "all or substantially all" of the property or
assets of a Person, and therefore it may be unclear as to whether a Change of
Control has occurred and whether the Company is required to make an offer to
repurchase the Notes as described above.
 
                                       124
<PAGE>   125
 
CERTAIN COVENANTS
 
The Indenture contains covenants including, among others, the following:
 
Limitation on Indebtedness. (a) The Company shall not, and shall not permit any
Restricted Subsidiary to, Incur any Indebtedness; provided, however, that the
Company and any Restricted Subsidiary which is a Subsidiary Guarantor may Incur
Indebtedness if on the date of the Incurrence of such Indebtedness the
Consolidated Coverage Ratio would be greater than (i) 2.25 to 1.00 if such
Indebtedness is Incurred on or prior to the second anniversary of the Issue Date
and (ii) 2.50 to 1.00 if such Indebtedness is Incurred thereafter.
 
(b) Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraph (a), the Company and its Restricted
Subsidiaries may Incur the following Indebtedness: (i) Indebtedness Incurred
pursuant to the Senior Credit Facility (or any refinancing thereof) in a maximum
principal amount not to exceed $962.25 million; (ii) the Subsidiary Guarantees
and Guarantees of Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to paragraph (a) or clause (i)
of this paragraph (b); (iii) Indebtedness (A) of the Company to any Restricted
Subsidiary and (B) of any Wholly Owned Subsidiary to the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary; provided, however, that any subsequent issuance or
transfer of any Capital Stock or any other event that results in any such Wholly
Owned Subsidiary ceasing to be a Wholly Owned Subsidiary or any other subsequent
transfer of any such Indebtedness (except to the Company or a Wholly Owned
Subsidiary) will be deemed, in each case, an Incurrence of Indebtedness by the
Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be, in the amount that
remains outstanding following such issuance or transfer of such securities; (iv)
Indebtedness represented by the Notes, any Indebtedness (other than the
Indebtedness described in clauses (i), (ii) or (iii) above) outstanding on the
date of the Indenture and any Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred in respect of
any Indebtedness described in this clause (iv) or paragraph(a); (v) Indebtedness
of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary in the form of Capitalized Lease
Obligations, Purchase Money Obligations or Attributable Debt, and any
Refinancing Indebtedness with respect thereto, in an aggregate amount not in
excess of 2.5% of Consolidated Tangible Assets at any one time outstanding; (vi)
Indebtedness under Hedging Obligations; provided, however, that such Hedging
Obligations are entered into for bona fide hedging purposes of the Company or
any Restricted Subsidiary and are in the ordinary course of business or are
required by the Senior Credit Facility; (vii) Indebtedness evidenced by letters
of credit assumed in the Transactions or issued in the ordinary course of
business of the Company to secure workers' compensation and other insurance
coverages; (viii) Guarantees of the Company in respect of Indebtedness of
franchisees not to exceed $50 million at any one time outstanding; and (ix)
Indebtedness (which may comprise Bank Indebtedness) in an aggregate principal
amount at any one time outstanding not in excess of $25 million.
 
(c) Notwithstanding the foregoing, neither the Company nor any Restricted
Subsidiary shall Incur any Indebtedness pursuant to the foregoing paragraph (b)
that permits Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of Indebtedness constituting
Subordinated Obligations if the proceeds of such Refinancing Indebtedness are
used, directly or indirectly, to Refinance such Subordinated Obligations, unless
such Refinancing Indebtedness will be subordinated to the Notes at least to the
same extent as such Subordinated Obligations. No Subsidiary Guarantor will incur
any Indebtedness pursuant to the foregoing paragraph (b) that permits
Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of Indebtedness constituting
 
                                       125
<PAGE>   126
 
Guarantor Subordinated Obligations if the proceeds of such Refinancing
Indebtedness are used, directly or indirectly, to Refinance such Guarantor
Subordinated Obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor unless such Refinancing
Indebtedness will be subordinated to the obligations of such Subsidiary
Guarantor under its Subsidiary Guarantee to at least the same extent as such
Guarantor Subordinated Obligations.
 
(d) For purposes of determining compliance with, and the outstanding principal
amount of any particular Indebtedness incurred pursuant to and in compliance
with, this covenant, (i) in the event that Indebtedness meets the criteria of
more than one of the types of Indebtedness described in paragraph (b) above, the
Company, in its sole discretion, shall classify such item of Indebtedness and
only be required to include the amount and type of such Indebtedness in one of
such clauses; and (ii) the amount of Indebtedness issued at a price that is less
than the principal amount thereof shall be equal to the amount of the liability
in respect thereof determined in accordance with GAAP.
 
(e) The Company will not permit any Unrestricted Subsidiary to incur any
Indebtedness other than Non-Recourse Debt; provided, however, if any such
Indebtedness ceases to be Non-Recourse Debt, such event shall be deemed to
constitute an incurrence of Indebtedness by the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary.
 
Limitation on Layering. The Company shall not incur any Indebtedness that is
expressly subordinate in right of payment to any Senior Indebtedness unless such
Indebtedness is Senior Subordinated Indebtedness or is contractually
subordinated in right of payment to Senior Subordinated Indebtedness. No
Subsidiary Guarantor will incur any Indebtedness that is expressly subordinate
in right of payment to any Guarantor Senior Indebtedness of such Subsidiary
Guarantor unless such Indebtedness is Guarantor Senior Subordinated Indebtedness
of such Subsidiary Guarantor or is contractually subordinated in right of
payment to Guarantor Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of such Subsidiary
Guarantor. Unsecured indebtedness is not deemed to be subordinate or junior to
Secured Indebtedness merely because it is unsecured, and Indebtedness that is
not guaranteed by a particular person is not deemed to be subordinate or junior
to Indebtedness that is so guaranteed merely because it is not so guaranteed.
 
Limitation on Restricted Payments. (a) The Company shall not, and shall not
permit any Restricted Subsidiary, directly or indirectly, to (i) declare or pay
any dividend or make any distribution on or in respect of its Capital Stock
(including any payment in connection with any merger or consolidation involving
the Company) except (1) dividends or distributions payable solely in its Capital
Stock (other than Disqualified Stock) and (2) dividends or distributions payable
to the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary (and, if such Restricted Subsidiary
is not a Wholly Owned Subsidiary, to its other shareholders on no more than a
pro rata basis, measured by value), (ii) purchase, redeem, retire or otherwise
acquire for value any Capital Stock of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
held by Persons other than the Company or another Restricted Subsidiary, (iii)
purchase, repurchase, redeem, defease or otherwise acquire or retire for value,
prior to scheduled maturity, scheduled repayment or scheduled sinking fund
payment, any Subordinated Obligations (other than the purchase, repurchase,
redemption or other acquisition of Subordinated Obligations in anticipation of
satisfying a sinking fund obligation, principal installment or final maturity,
in each case due within one year of the date of acquisition) or (iv) make any
Investment (other than a Permitted Investment) in any Person (any such dividend,
distribution, purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance,
 
                                       126
<PAGE>   127
 
other acquisition, retirement or Investment being herein referred to as a
"Restricted Payment") if at the time the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary
makes such Restricted Payment: (1) a Default shall have occurred and be
continuing (or would result therefrom); (2) the Company could not incur at least
an additional $1.00 of Indebtedness under paragraph (a) of the covenant
described under "-- Limitation on Indebtedness;" or (3) the aggregate amount of
such Restricted Payment and all other Restricted Payments (the amount so
expended, if other than in cash, to be determined in good faith by the Company's
Board of Directors, whose determination shall be conclusive and evidenced by a
resolution of the Company's Board of Directors) declared or made subsequent to
the date of the Indenture would exceed the sum of: (A) 50% of the Consolidated
Net Income accrued during the period (treated as one accounting period) from the
end of the most recent fiscal quarter ending prior to the Issue Date to the end
of the most recent fiscal quarter ending prior to the date of such Restricted
Payment for which consolidated financial statements of the Company are available
(or, in case such Consolidated Net Income shall be a deficit, minus 100% of such
deficit); (B) the aggregate Net Cash Proceeds received by the Company from the
issuance or sale of its Capital Stock (other than Disqualified Stock) subsequent
to the Issue Date (other than an issuance or sale to a Restricted Subsidiary of
the Company, provided that in the event such issuance or sale is to an employee
stock ownership plan or other trust established by the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries for the benefit of their employees, to the extent the purchase by
such plan or trust is financed by Indebtedness of such plan or trust and for
which the Company is liable as a guarantor or otherwise, such aggregate amount
of Net Cash Proceeds shall be limited to the aggregate amount of principal
payments made by such plan or trust with respect to such Indebtedness); and (C)
in the case of the disposition or repayment of any Investment constituting a
Restricted Payment (without duplication of any amount deducted in calculating
the amount of Investments at any time outstanding included in the amount of
Restricted Payments), an amount equal to the lesser of (x) the return of capital
or similar repayment with respect to such Investment and (y) the initial amount
of such Investment, in either case, less the cost of the disposition of such
Investment.
 
(b) The provisions of the foregoing paragraph (a) will not prohibit: (i) any
purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance, retirement or other acquisition of
Capital Stock of the Company or Subordinated Obligations made by exchange
(including any such exchange pursuant to the exercise of a conversion right or
privilege in connection with which cash is paid in lieu of the issuance of
fractional shares) for, or out of the proceeds of the substantially concurrent
sale of, Capital Stock of the Company (other than Disqualified Stock and other
than Capital Stock issued or sold to a Subsidiary or an employee stock ownership
plan or other trust established by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries);
provided, however, that (A) such purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance,
retirement or other acquisition shall be excluded in subsequent calculations of
the amount of Restricted Payments and (B) the Net Cash Proceeds or reduction of
Indebtedness from such sale shall be excluded in calculations under clause (B)
and (C) of paragraph (a); (ii) any purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance,
retirement or other acquisition of Subordinated Obligations made by exchange
for, or out of the proceeds of the substantially concurrent sale of,
Subordinated Obligations of the Company that is permitted to be Incurred
pursuant to the covenant described under "-- Limitation on Indebtedness;"
provided, however, that such purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance,
retirement or other acquisition shall be excluded in subsequent calculations of
the amount of Restricted Payments; (iii) any purchase, redemption, repurchase,
defeasance, retirement or other
 
                                       127
<PAGE>   128
 
acquisition of Subordinated Obligations from Net Available Cash to the extent
permitted by the covenant described under "-- Limitation on Sales of Assets;"
provided, however, that such purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance,
retirement or other acquisition shall be excluded in subsequent calculations of
the amount of Restricted Payments; (iv) dividends paid within 60 days after the
date of declaration thereof if at such date of declaration such dividend would
have complied with paragraph (a); provided, however, that such dividend shall be
included in subsequent calculations of the amount of Restricted Payments; (v)
any purchase or redemption of any shares of Capital Stock of the Company from
employees of the Company and its Subsidiaries pursuant to the repurchase
provisions under employee stock option or stock purchase agreements or other
agreements to compensate management employees in an aggregate amount after the
date of the Indenture not in excess of $2.5 million in any fiscal year, plus any
unused amounts under this clause (v) from prior fiscal years; provided, however,
that such purchases or redemptions shall be excluded in subsequent calculations
of the amount of Restricted Payments; or (vi) the repurchase of the Company's
common stock in an aggregate amount not to exceed the amount by which the
proceeds from the issuance of the Convertible Preferred Stock exceeds $235
million; provided, however, the aggregate amount of repurchases made pursuant to
this clause (vi) shall not exceed $25 million.
 
Designation of Unrestricted Subsidiaries. The Board of Directors of the Company
may designate any Restricted Subsidiary to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary if such
designation would not cause a default. For purposes of making such
determination, all outstanding Investments by the Company and its Restricted
Subsidiaries (except to the extent repaid in cash) in the Subsidiary so
designated will be deemed to be Restricted Payments at the time of such
designation and will reduce the amount available for Restricted Payments under
clause (3) of paragraph (a) of the covenant "-- Limitation on Restricted
Payments." All such outstanding Investments will be deemed to constitute
Investments in an amount equal to the greater of the fair market value or the
book value of such Subsidiary at the time of such designation. Such designation
will only be permitted if such Restricted Payment would be permitted at such
time and if such Restricted Subsidiary otherwise meets the definition of an
Unrestricted Subsidiary.
 
Limitation on Restrictions on Distributions from Restricted Subsidiaries. The
Company will not, and will not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to, create or
otherwise cause or permit to exist or become effective any consensual
encumbrance or restriction on the ability of any Restricted Subsidiary to (i)
pay dividends or make any other distributions on its Capital Stock or pay any
Indebtedness or other obligations owed to the Company, (ii) make any loans or
advances to the Company or (iii) transfer any of its property or assets to the
Company, except (1) any encumbrance or restriction pursuant to an agreement in
effect at or entered into on the date of the Indentures (including, without
limitation, the Senior Credit Facility); (2) any encumbrance or restriction with
respect to a Restricted Subsidiary (x) pursuant to an agreement relating to any
Indebtedness Incurred by a Restricted Subsidiary prior to the date on which such
Restricted Subsidiary was acquired by the Company, or of another Person that is
assumed by the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary in connection with the
acquisition of assets from, or merger or consolidation with, such Person (other
than Indebtedness Incurred as consideration in, or to provide all or any portion
of the funds or credit support utilized to consummate, the transaction or series
of related transactions pursuant to which such Restricted Subsidiary became a
Restricted Subsidiary or was acquired by the Company, or such acquisition of
 
                                       128
<PAGE>   129
 
assets, merger or consolidation) and outstanding on the date of such
acquisition, merger or consolidation or (y) pursuant to any agreement (not
relating to any Indebtedness) in existence when a Person becomes a Subsidiary of
the Company or when such agreement is acquired by the Company or any Subsidiary
thereof, that is not created in contemplation of such Person becoming such a
Subsidiary or such acquisition (for purposes of this clause (2), if another
Person is the Successor Company, any Subsidiary or agreement thereof shall be
deemed acquired or assumed, as the case may be, by the Company when such Person
becomes the Successor Company); (3) any encumbrance or restriction with respect
to a Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to an agreement (a "Refinancing Agreement")
effecting a refinancing of Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to, or that otherwise
extends, renews, refinances or replaces, an agreement referred to in clause (1)
or (2)of this covenant or this clause (3) or contained in any amendment to an
agreement referred to in clause (1) or (2) of this covenant or this clause (3)
(an "Initial Agreement") or contained in any amendment to an Initial Agreement;
provided, however, that the encumbrances and restrictions contained in any such
Refinancing Agreement or amendment are no less favorable to the Holders of the
Notes taken as a whole than encumbrances and restrictions contained in the
Initial Agreement or Agreements to which such Refinancing Agreement or amendment
relates; (4) any encumbrance or restriction (A) that restricts in a customary
manner the subletting, assignment or transfer of any property or asset that is
subject to a lease, license or similar contract, or the assignment or transfer
of any lease, license or other contract, (B) by virtue of any transfer of,
agreement to transfer, option or right with respect to, or Lien on, any property
or assets of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary not otherwise prohibited
by the Indenture, (C) contained in mortgages, pledges or other security
agreements securing Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary to the extent such
encumbrance or restrictions restrict the transfer of the property subject to
such mortgages, pledges or other security agreements or (D) pursuant to
customary provisions restricting dispositions of real property interests set
forth in any reciprocal easement agreements of the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary; (5) any restriction with respect to a Restricted Subsidiary (or any
of its property or assets) imposed pursuant to an agreement entered into for the
direct or indirect sale or disposition of all or substantially all the Capital
Stock or assets of such Restricted Subsidiary (or the property or assets that
are subject to such restriction) pending the closing of such sale or
disposition; and (6) any encumbrance or restriction on the transfer of property
or assets required by any regulatory authority having jurisdiction over the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary or any of their businesses.
 
Limitation on Sales of Assets. (a) The Company will not, and will not permit any
Restricted Subsidiary to, make any Asset Disposition unless (i) the Company or
such Restricted Subsidiary receives consideration (including by way of relief
from, or by any other Person assuming sole responsibility for, any liabilities,
contingent or otherwise) at the time of such Asset Disposition at least equal to
the fair market value of the shares and assets subject to such Asset Disposition
as such fair market value shall be determined in good faith by the Board of
Directors, whose determination shall be conclusive (including as to the value of
all non-cash consideration), (ii) at least 75% of the consideration therefor
(excluding, in the case of an Asset Disposition of assets, any consideration by
way of relief from, or by any other person assuming responsibility for, any
liabilities, contingent or otherwise, which are not Indebtedness) received by
the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary is in the form of cash, (iii) an
amount equal to 100% of the Net Available Cash from such Asset Disposition is
applied by the Company (or such Restricted
 
                                       129
<PAGE>   130
 
Subsidiary, as the case may be) (A) first, to the extent the Company elects (or
is required by the terms of any Senior Indebtedness or Indebtedness (other than
Preferred Stock) of a Restricted Subsidiary), to prepay, repay or purchase
Senior Indebtedness or such Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary (in each
case other than Indebtedness owed to the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary of
the Company) within 365 days after the date of such Asset Disposition; (B)
second, to the extent of the balance of Net Available Cash after application in
accordance with clause (A), to the extent the Company or such Restricted
Subsidiary elects, to reinvest in Additional Assets (including by means of an
Investment in Additional Assets by a Restricted Subsidiary with Net Available
Cash received by the Company or another Restricted Subsidiary) within 365 days
from the date of such Asset Disposition or, if such reinvestment in Additional
Assets is a project authorized by the Board of Directors that will take longer
than 365 days to complete, the period of time necessary to complete such
project; (C) third, to the extent of the balance of such Net Available Cash
after application in accordance with clauses (A) and (B) (such balance, the
"Excess Proceeds"), to make an offer to purchase Notes at a price in cash equal
to 100% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if
any, to the purchase date, and (to the extent required by the terms thereof) any
other Senior Subordinated Indebtedness pursuant and subject to the conditions of
the agreements governing such other Indebtedness at a purchase price of 100% of
the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest to the purchase
date and (D) fourth, to the extent of the balance of such Excess Proceeds after
application in accordance with clauses (A), (B) and (C) above, to fund (to the
extent consistent with any other applicable provision of the Indentures) any
general corporate purpose (including the repayment of Subordinated Obligations);
provided, however, that in connection with any prepayment, repayment or purchase
of Indebtedness pursuant to clause (A) or (C) above, the Company or such
Restricted Subsidiary will retire such Indebtedness and will cause the related
loan commitment (if any) to be permanently reduced in an amount equal to the
principal amount so prepaid, repaid or purchased. Notwithstanding the foregoing
provisions of this covenant, the Company and the Restricted Subsidiaries shall
not be required to apply any Net Available Cash in accordance with this covenant
except to the extent that the aggregate Net Available Cash from all Asset
Dispositions that is not applied in accordance with this covenant exceeds $10.0
million.
 
To the extent that the aggregate principal amount of the Notes and other Senior
Subordinated Indebtedness tendered pursuant to an offer to purchase made in
accordance with clause (C) above exceeds the amount of Excess Proceeds, the
Trustee shall select the Notes and Senior Subordinated Indebtedness to be
purchased on a pro rata basis, based on the aggregate principal amount thereof
surrendered in such offer to purchase. Upon completion of such offer to
purchase, the amount of Excess Proceeds shall be reset to zero.
 
For the purposes of this covenant, the following are deemed to be cash: (v) Cash
Equivalents, (w) the assumption of Indebtedness of the Company (other than
Disqualified Stock of the Company) or any Restricted Subsidiary and the release
of the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary from all liability on such
Indebtedness in connection with such Asset Disposition, (x) Indebtedness of any
Restricted Subsidiary that is no longer a Restricted Subsidiary as a result of
such Asset Disposition, to the extent that the Company and each other Restricted
Subsidiary is released from any Guarantee of such Indebtedness in connection
with such Asset Disposition, (y) securities received by the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary from the transferee that are promptly converted by the
Company or
 
                                       130
<PAGE>   131
 
such Restricted Subsidiary into cash, and (z) consideration consisting of
Indebtedness of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary.
 
(b) The Company will comply, to the extent applicable, with the requirements of
Section 14(e) of the Exchange Act and any other securities laws or regulations
in connection with the repurchase of Notes pursuant to this covenant. To the
extent that the provisions of any securities laws or regulations conflict with
provisions of this covenant, the Company will comply with the applicable
securities laws and regulations and will not be deemed to have breached its
obligations under this covenant by virtue thereof.
 
Limitation on Transactions with Affiliates. (a) The Company will not, and will
not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, enter into or
conduct any transaction or series of transactions (including the purchase, sale,
lease or exchange of any property or the rendering of any service with any
Affiliate of the Company (an "Affiliate Transaction") on terms (i) that taken as
a whole are less favorable to the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the
case may be, than those that could be obtained at the time of such transaction
in arm's-length dealings with a Person who is not such an Affiliate and (ii)
that, in the event such Affiliate Transaction involves an aggregate amount in
excess of $10.0 million, are not in writing and have not been approved by a
majority of the members of the Board of Directors having no material personal
financial interest in such Affiliate Transaction or, in the event there are no
such members, as to which the Company has not obtained a Fairness Opinion (as
hereinafter defined). In addition, any transaction involving aggregate payments
or other transfers by the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries in excess of
$20.0 million will also require an opinion (a "Fairness Opinion") from an
independent investment banking firm or appraiser, as appropriate, of national
prominence, to the effect that the terms of such transaction are fair to the
Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be, from a financial
point of view.
 
(b) The provisions of the foregoing paragraph (a) shall not prohibit (i) any
Restricted Payment permitted by the covenant described under "-- Limitation on
Restricted Payments," or any Permitted Investment, (ii) the performance of the
Company's or Restricted Subsidiary's obligations under any employment contract,
collective bargaining agreement, agreement for the provision of services,
employee benefit plan, related trust agreement or any other similar arrangement
heretofore or hereafter entered into in the ordinary course of business, (iii)
payment of compensation, performance of indemnification or contribution
obligations, or any issuance, grant or award of stock, options or other
securities, to employees, officers or directors in the ordinary course of
business, (iv) any transaction between the Company and a Restricted Subsidiary
or between Restricted Subsidiaries, (v) the Transactions and the incurrence and
payment of all fees and expenses payable in connection therewith as described in
or contemplated by the Prospectus, (vi) any other transaction arising out of
agreements in existence on the Issue Date, and (vii) transactions with suppliers
or other purchasers or sellers of goods or services, in each case in the
ordinary course of business and on terms no less favorable to the Company or the
Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be, than those that could be obtained at
such time in arm's length dealings with a Person which is not an Affiliate.
 
Limitation on the Sale or Issuance of Preferred Stock of Restricted
Subsidiaries. The Company shall not sell any shares of Preferred Stock of a
Restricted Subsidiary, and shall
 
                                       131
<PAGE>   132
 
not permit any Restricted Subsidiary, directly or indirectly, to issue or sell
any shares of its Preferred Stock to any Person (other than to the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary).
 
Limitation on Liens. The Company shall not, and shall not permit any Restricted
Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, create or permit to exist any Lien (other
than Permitted Liens) on any of its property or assets (including Capital
Stock), whether owned on the date of the Indenture or thereafter acquired,
securing any Indebtedness that is not Senior Indebtedness (the "Initial Lien"),
unless contemporaneously therewith effective provision is made to secure the
obligations due under the Indenture and the Notes or, in respect of Liens on any
Restricted Subsidiary's property or assets, equally and ratably with such
obligation for so long as such obligation is secured by such Initial Lien. Any
such Lien thereby created in favor of the Notes will be automatically and
unconditionally released and discharged upon (i) the release and discharge of
the Initial Lien to which it relates, or (ii) any sale, exchange or transfer to
any Person not an Affiliate of the Company of the property or assets secured by
such Initial Lien, or of all of the Capital Stock held by the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary in, or all or substantially all the assets of, any
Restricted Subsidiary creating such Lien.
 
Reporting Requirements. As long as any of the Notes are outstanding, the Company
will file with the SEC (unless the SEC will not accept such a filing) the annual
reports, quarterly reports and other documents required to be filed with the SEC
pursuant to Sections 13 and 15 of the Exchange Act, whether or not the Company
is then obligated to file reports pursuant to such sections. The Company will be
required to file with the Trustee and provide to each holder of Notes within 15
days after filing with the SEC (or if any such filing is not permitted under the
Exchange Act, 15 days after the Company would have been required to make such
filing) copies of such reports and documents.
 
Future Subsidiary Guarantors. After the Issue Date, the Company will cause each
Restricted Subsidiary created or acquired by the Company to execute and deliver
to the Trustee a Subsidiary Guarantee pursuant to which such Restricted
Subsidiary will unconditionally Guarantee, on a joint and several basis, the
full and prompt payment of the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on
the Notes on a senior unsecured basis.
 
Limitation on Sale/Leaseback Transactions. The Company will not, and will not
permit any Restricted Subsidiary to, enter into any Sale/Leaseback Transaction
with respect to any property unless: (i) the Company or such Restricted
Subsidiary would be entitled to Incur Indebtedness in an amount equal to the
Attributable Debt with respect to such Sale/Leaseback Transaction pursuant to
the covenant described under "Limitation on Indebtedness;" (ii) the net proceeds
received by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such
Sale/Leaseback Transaction are at least equal to the fair value (as determined
by the Board of Directors) of such property; and (iii) the transfer of such
property as permitted by, and the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary applies
the proceeds of such transaction in compliance with, the covenant described
under "Limitation on Sales of Assets."
 
MERGER AND CONSOLIDATION
 
The Company will not, in a single transaction or a series of related
transactions, consolidate with or merge with or into, or convey, transfer or
lease all or substantially all its assets to, any Person, unless: (i) the
resulting, surviving or transferee Person (the
 
                                       132
<PAGE>   133
 
"Successor Company") will be a Person organized and existing under the laws of
the United States of America, any State thereof or the District of Columbia and
the Successor Company (if not the Company) will expressly assume, by an
indenture supplemental to the Indenture, executed and delivered to the Trustee,
in form satisfactory to the Trustee, all the obligations of the Company under
the Notes and the Indenture; (ii) immediately before and after giving effect to
such transaction or series of transactions no Default or Event of Default
exists; (iii) the Company or the Successor Company (if the Company is not the
continuing obligor under the Indenture) will, at the time of such transaction or
series of transactions and after giving proforma effect thereto as if such
transaction or series of transactions had occurred at the beginning of the
applicable four-quarter period, be permitted to Incur at least an additional
$1.00 of Indebtedness pursuant to paragraph (a) of "-- Limitation on
Indebtedness;" and (iv) the Company will have delivered to the Trustee an
Officer's Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each to the effect that such
consolidation, merger or transfer and such supplemental indenture (if any)
comply with the Indenture, provided that (x) in giving such opinion such counsel
may rely on such Officer's Certificate as to any matters of fact (including
without limitation as to compliance with the foregoing clauses (ii)and (iii)),
and (y) no Opinion of Counsel will be required for a consolidation, merger or
transfer described in the last paragraph of this covenant.
 
The Successor Company will succeed to, and be substituted for, and may exercise
every right and power of, the Company under the Indenture, and thereafter the
predecessor Company shall be relieved of all obligations and covenants under the
Indenture, except that, in the case of a conveyance, transfer or lease of all or
substantially all its assets, the predecessor Company will not be released from
the obligation to pay the principal of and interest on the Notes.
 
Notwithstanding the foregoing clauses (ii) and (iii), (1) any Restricted
Subsidiary may consolidate with, merge into or transfer all or part of its
properties and assets to the Company and (2) the Company may merge with an
Affiliate incorporated or organized for the purpose of reincorporating or
reorganizing the Company in another jurisdiction to realize tax or other
benefits.
 
DEFAULTS
 
An Event of Default is defined under the Indenture as (i) a default in any
payment of interest on any Note when due (whether or not such payment is
prohibited by the provisions described under "-- Ranking" above), continued for
30 days, (ii) a default in the payment of principal of any Note when due at its
Stated Maturity, upon optional redemption, upon required repurchase, upon
declaration or otherwise, whether or not such payment is prohibited by the
provisions described under "-- Ranking" above, (iii) the failure by the Company
to comply with its obligations under the covenant described under "-- Merger and
Consolidation" above, (iv) the failure by the Company to comply for 30 days
after written notice with any of its obligations under the covenants described
under "-- Change of Control" or "-- Certain Covenants" above (in each case,
other than a failure to purchase Notes), (v) the failure by the Company to
comply for 60 days after notice with its other agreements contained in the Notes
or the Indenture, (vi) the failure by the Company or any Significant Subsidiary
to pay any Indebtedness within any applicable grace period after final maturity
or the acceleration of any such Indebtedness by
 
                                       133
<PAGE>   134
 
the holders thereof because of a default if the total amount of such
Indebtedness unpaid or accelerated exceeds $25 million (the "cross acceleration
provision"), (vii) certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of
the Company or a Significant Subsidiary (the "bankruptcy provisions"), (viii)
the rendering of any judgment or decree for the payment of money in an amount
(net of any insurance or indemnity payments actually received in respect thereof
prior to or within 90 days from the entry thereof, or to be received in respect
thereof in the event any appeal thereof shall be unsuccessful) in excess of $25
million against the Company or a Significant Subsidiary that is not discharged,
bonded or insured by a third Person if (A) an enforcement proceeding thereon is
commenced or (B) such judgment or decree remains outstanding for a period of 90
days following such judgment or decree and is not discharged, waived or stayed
(the "judgment default provision") or (ix) the failure of any Guarantee of the
Notes by a Subsidiary Guarantor to be in full force and effect (except as
contemplated by the terms thereof or of the Indenture) or the denial or
disaffirmation in writing by any such Subsidiary Guarantor of its obligations
under the Indenture or any such Guarantee if such Default continues for 10 days.
 
The foregoing will constitute Events of Default whatever the reason for any such
Event of Default and whether it is voluntary or involuntary or is effected by
operation of law or pursuant to any judgment, decree or order of any court or
any order, rule or regulation of any administrative or governmental body.
 
However, a Default under clause (iv) or (v) will not constitute an Event of
Default until the applicable Trustee or the Holders of at least 25% of the
aggregate principal amount of the outstanding applicable Notes notify the
Company of the Default and the Company does not cure such Default within the
time specified in clauses (iv) and (v) hereof after receipt of such notice.
 
If an Event of Default (other than a Default relating to certain events of
bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of the Company) occurs and is
continuing, the Trustee by notice to the Company, or the Holders of at least a
majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes, by notice to the Company
and the Trustee, may declare the principal of and accrued but unpaid interest on
all of such Notes to be due and payable. Upon such a declaration, such principal
and interest will be due and payable immediately. If an Event of Default
relating to certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of the
Company occurs and is continuing, the principal of and interest on all the Notes
will become immediately due and payable without any declaration or other act on
the part of the Trustee or any Holder. Under certain circumstances, the Holders
of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes may rescind any such
acceleration with respect to the Notes and its consequences.
 
Subject to the provisions of the Indenture relating to the duties of the
Trustee, in case an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee will
be under no obligation to exercise any of the rights or powers under the
Indenture at the request or direction of any of the Holders unless such Holders
have offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity or security against any loss,
liability or expense. Except to enforce the right to receive payment of
principal, premium (if any) or interest when due, no Holder may pursue any
remedy with respect to the Indenture or the Notes unless (i) such Holder has
previously given the Trustee notice that an Event of Default is continuing, (ii)
Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the outstanding Notes have
requested the Trustee to pursue
 
                                       134
<PAGE>   135
 
the remedy, (iii) such Holders have offered the Trustee reasonable security or
indemnity against any loss, liability or expense, (iv) the Trustee has not
complied with such request within 60 days after the receipt of the request and
the offer of security or indemnity and (v) the Holders of a majority in
principal amount of the applicable Notes have not given the Trustee a direction
inconsistent with such request within such 60-day period. Subject to certain
restrictions, the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes
outstanding are given the right to direct the time, method and place of
conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or of
exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee. The Trustee, however,
may refuse to follow any direction that conflicts with law or the Indenture or
that the Trustee determines is unduly prejudicial to the rights of any other
Holder or that would involve the Trustee in personal liability. Prior to taking
any action under the Indenture, the Trustee will be entitled to indemnification
satisfactory to it in its sole discretion against all losses and expenses caused
by taking or not taking such action.
 
The Indenture provides that if a Default occurs and is continuing and is known
to the Trustee, the Trustee must mail to each Holder notice of the Default
within 90 days after it occurs. Except in the case of a Default in the payment
of principal of, premium (if any) or interest on any Note, the Trustee may
withhold notice if and so long as a committee of its Trust Officers in good
faith determines that withholding notice is in the interests of the Noteholders.
In addition, the Company is required to deliver to the Trustee, within 120 days
after the end of each fiscal year, a certificate indicating whether the signers
thereof know of any Default that occurred during the previous year. The Company
also is required to deliver to the Trustee, within 30 days after the occurrence
thereof, written notice of any event which would constitute certain Defaults,
their status and what action the Company is taking or proposes to take in
respect thereof.
 
AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS
 
Subject to certain exceptions, the Indenture may be amended with the consent of
the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding and
any past default or compliance with any provisions may be waived with the
consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then
outstanding. However, without the consent of each Holder, no amendment may,
among other things, (i) reduce the principal amount of Notes whose Holders must
consent to an amendment, (ii) reduce the rate of or extend the time for payment
of interest on any Note, (iii) reduce the principal amount of or extend the
Stated Maturity of any Note, (iv) reduce the premium payable upon the redemption
of any Note or change the time at which any Note may be redeemed as described
under "-- Optional Redemption" above, (v) make any Note payable in money other
than that stated in the Note, (vi) make any change to the subordination
provisions of the Indenture that adversely affects the rights of any Holder,
(vii) impair the right of any Holder to receive payment of principal of and
interest on such Holder's Notes on or after the due dates therefor or to
institute suit for the enforcement of any payment on or with respect to such
Holder's Notes, or (viii) make any change in the amendment provisions which
require each Holder's consent or in the waiver provisions.
 
Without the consent of any Holder, the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and
the Trustee may amend the Indenture to cure any ambiguity, omission, defect or
inconsistency, to provide for the assumption by a successor corporation of the
obligations of the Company
 
                                       135
<PAGE>   136
 
under the Indenture, to provide for uncertificated Notes in addition to or in
place of certificated Notes (provided, however, that the uncertificated Notes
are issued in registered form for purposes of Section 163(f) of the Code, or in
a manner such that the uncertificated Notes are described in Section
163(f)(2)(B) of the Code), to add Guarantees with respect to the Notes, to
secure the Notes, to add to the covenants of the Company for the benefit of the
Noteholders or to surrender any right or power conferred upon the Company, to
make any change that does not adversely affect the rights of any Holder, or to
comply with any requirement of the SEC in connection with the qualification of
the Indenture under the TIA. However, no amendment may be made to the
subordination provisions of the Indenture that adversely affects the rights of
any holder of Senior Indebtedness then outstanding unless the holders of such
Senior Indebtedness (or any group or representative thereof authorized to give a
consent) consent to such change.
 
The consent of the Noteholders is not necessary under the Indenture to approve
the particular form of any proposed amendment. It is sufficient if such consent
approves the substance of the proposed amendment. After an amendment under the
Indenture becomes effective, the Company is required to mail to the applicable
Noteholders a notice briefly describing such amendment. However, the failure to
give such notice to all such Noteholders, or any defect therein, will not impair
or affect the validity of the amendment.
 
DEFEASANCE
 
The Company at any time may terminate all its obligations under the Notes and
the Indenture ("legal defeasance"), except for certain obligations, including
those respecting the defeasance trust and obligations to register the transfer
or exchange of the Notes, to replace mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes
and to maintain a registrar and paying agent in respect of the Notes. The
Company at any time may terminate its obligations under the covenants described
under "-- Certain Covenants," the operation of the cross acceleration provision,
the bankruptcy provisions with respect to Subsidiaries and the judgment default
provision described under "-- Defaults" above and the limitations contained in
clauses (iii) and (iv) under "-- Merger and Consolidation" above ("covenant
defeasance").
 
The Company may exercise its legal defeasance option notwithstanding its prior
exercise of its covenant defeasance option. If the Company exercises its legal
defeasance option, payment of the Notes may not be accelerated because of an
Event of Default with respect thereto. If the Company exercises its covenant
defeasance option, payment of the Notes may not be accelerated because of an
Event of Default specified in clause (iv), (vi), (vii), (but only with respect
to certain bankruptcy events of a Significant Subsidiary), (viii) or (ix) under
"-- Defaults" above or because of the failure of the Company to comply with
clause (iii) or (iv) under "-- Merger and Consolidation" above.
 
Either defeasance option may be exercised prior to any redemption date or to the
maturity date for the Notes. In order to exercise either defeasance option, the
Company must irrevocably deposit in trust (the "defeasance trust") with the
Trustee money or U.S. Government Obligations, or a combination thereof, for the
payment of principal of, and premium (if any) and interest on, the applicable
Notes to redemption or maturity, as the case may be, and must comply with
certain other conditions, including delivery to the Trustee of an Opinion of
Counsel to the effect that Holders of the Notes will not recognize income, gain
or loss for Federal income tax purposes as a result of such deposit
 
                                       136
<PAGE>   137
 
and defeasance and will be subject to Federal income tax in the same amount and
in the same manner and at the same times as would have been the case if such
deposit and defeasance had not occurred (and, in the case of legal defeasance
only, such Opinion of Counsel must be based on a ruling of the Internal Revenue
Service or other change in applicable Federal income tax law since the date of
the Indenture).
 
CONCERNING THE TRUSTEE
 
IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust Company serves as the Trustee for the Notes. The
Trustee has been appointed by the Company as Registrar and Paying Agent with
regard to the Notes.
 
GOVERNING LAW
 
The Indenture provides that it and the Notes will be governed by, and construed
in accordance with, the laws of the State of New York without giving effect to
applicable principles of conflicts of law to the extent that the application of
the law of another jurisdiction would be required thereby.
 
CERTAIN DEFINITIONS
 
"Additional Assets" means (i) any property or assets (other than Indebtedness
and Capital Stock) to be used by the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary in a
Related Business; (ii) the Capital Stock of a Person that becomes a Restricted
Subsidiary as a result of the acquisition of such Capital Stock by the Company
or another Restricted Subsidiary; (iii) Capital Stock of any Person that at such
time is a Restricted Subsidiary, acquired from a third party; provided, however,
that, in the case of clauses (ii) and (iii), such Restricted Subsidiary is
primarily engaged in a Related Business; or (iv) Capital Stock of any Person
which is primarily engaged in a Related Business; provided, however, for
purposes of the covenant described under "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on
Sales of Assets," the aggregate amount of Net Available Cash permitted to be
invested pursuant to this clause (iv) shall not exceed at any one time
outstanding 5% of Consolidated Tangible Assets.
 
"Affiliate" of any specified Person means any other Person, directly or
indirectly, controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common
control with such specified Person. For the purposes of this definition,
"control" when used with respect to any Person means the power to direct the
management and policies of such Person, directly or indirectly, whether through
the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise; and the terms
"controlling" and "controlled" have meanings correlative to the foregoing. The
Chase Manhattan Bank and its Affiliates shall not be deemed an Affiliate of the
Company.
 
"Apollo" means Apollo Management IV, L.P. and its Affiliates or any entity
controlled thereby or any of the partners thereof.
 
"Asset Disposition" means any sale, lease, transfer or other disposition of
shares of Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary (other than directors'
qualifying shares), property or other assets (each referred to for the purposes
of this definition as a "disposition") by the Company or any of its Restricted
Subsidiaries (including any disposition by means of a
 
                                       137
<PAGE>   138
 
merger, consolidation or similar transaction) other than (i) a disposition by a
Restricted Subsidiary to the Company or by the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary to a Restricted Subsidiary, (ii) a disposition of inventory,
equipment, obsolete assets or surplus personal property in the ordinary course
of business, (iii) the sale of Temporary Cash Investments or Cash Equivalents in
the ordinary course of business, (iv) a transaction or a series of related
transactions in which either (x) the fair market value of the assets disposed
of, in the aggregate, does not exceed 2.5% of the Consolidated Tangible Assets
of the Company or (y) the EBITDA related to such assets does not, in the
aggregate, exceed 2.5% of the Company's EBITDA, (v) the sale or discount (with
or without recourse, and on commercially reasonable terms) of accounts
receivable or notes receivable arising in the ordinary course of business, or
the conversion or exchange of accounts receivable for notes receivable, (vi) the
licensing of intellectual property in the ordinary course of business, (vii) an
RTO Facility Swap, (viii) for purposes of the covenant described under
"-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on Sales of Assets" only, a disposition
subject to the covenant described under "-- Certain Covenants  -- Limitation on
Restricted Payments," or (ix) a disposition of property or assets that is
governed by the provisions described under "-- Merger and Consolidation."
 
"Attributable Debt" in respect of a Sale/Leaseback Transaction means, as at the
time of determination, the present value (discounted at the interest rate
assumed in making calculations in accordance with FAS 13) of the total
obligations of the lessee for rental payments during the remaining term of the
lease included in such Sale/Leaseback Transaction (including any period for
which such lease has been extended).
 
"Average Life" means, as of the date of determination, with respect to any
Indebtedness or Preferred Stock, the quotient obtained by dividing (i) the sum
of the products of the numbers of years from the date of determination to the
dates of each successive scheduled principal payment of such Indebtedness or
redemption or similar payment with respect to such Indebtedness or Preferred
Stock multiplied by the amount of such payment by (ii) the sum of all such
payments.
 
"Bank Indebtedness" means any and all amounts, whether outstanding on the Issue
Date or thereafter incurred, payable under or in respect of the Senior Credit
Facility, including, without limitation, principal, premium (if any), interest
(including interest accruing on or after the filing of any petition in
bankruptcy or for reorganization relating to the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary whether or not a claim for postfiling interest is allowed in such
proceedings), fees, charges, expenses, reimbursement obligations, guarantees,
other monetary obligations of any nature and all other amounts payable
thereunder or in respect thereof.
 
"Board of Directors" means the Board of Directors of the Company or any
committee thereof duly authorized to act on behalf of such Board.
 
"Business Day" means a day other than a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which
commercial banking institutions are authorized or required by law to close in
New York City.
 
"Capital Stock" of any Person means any and all shares, interests, rights to
purchase, warrants, options, participations or other equivalents of or interests
in (however designated) equity of such Person, including any Preferred Stock,
but excluding any debt securities convertible into such equity.
 
                                       138
<PAGE>   139
 
"Capitalized Lease Obligations" means an obligation that is required to be
classified and accounted for as a capitalized lease for financial reporting
purposes in accordance with GAAP, and the amount of Indebtedness represented by
such obligation shall be the capitalized amount of such obligation determined in
accordance with GAAP; and the Stated Maturity thereof shall be the date of the
last payment of rent or any other amount due under such lease.
 
"Cash Equivalents" means any of the following: (a) securities issued or fully
guaranteed or insured by the United States Government or any agency or
instrumentality thereof, (b) time deposits, certificates of deposit or bankers'
acceptances of (i) any lender under the Senior Credit Agreement or (ii) any
commercial bank having capital and surplus in excess of $500,000,000 and the
commercial paper of the holding company of which is rated at least "A-2" or the
equivalent thereof by S&P or at least "P-2" or the equivalent thereof by Moody's
(or if at such time neither is issuing ratings, then a comparable rating of
another nationally recognized rating agency), (c) commercial paper rated at
least "A1" or the equivalent thereof by S&P or at least "P-1" or the equivalent
thereof by Moody's (or if at such time neither is issuing ratings, then a
comparable rating of another nationally recognized rating agency), (d)
investments in money market funds complying with the risk limiting conditions of
Rule 2a-7 or any successor rule of the SEC under the Investment Company Act, (e)
repurchase obligations of any commercial bank satisfying the requirements of
clause (b) of this definition, having a term of not more than 30 days, with
respect to securities issued or fully guaranteed or insured by the United States
government, (f) securities with maturities of one year or less from the date of
acquisition issued or fully guaranteed by any state, commonwealth or territory
of the United States, by any political subdivision or taxing authority of any
such state, commonwealth or territory or by any foreign government, the
securities of which state, commonwealth, territory, political subdivision,
taxing authority or foreign government (as the case may be) are rated at least
"A" by S&P or "A" by Moody's and (g) securities with maturities of six months or
less from the date of acquisition backed by standby letters of credit issued by
any commercial bank satisfying the requirements of clause (b) of this
definition.
 
"Central Acquisition" means the Company's acquisition of substantially all of
the assets of Central Rents, Inc.
 
"Chase" means The Chase Manhattan Bank.
 
"Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.
 
"Company" means Renters Choice, Inc. after giving effect to the Rent-A-Center
Acquisition.
 
"Consolidated Coverage Ratio" as of any date of determination means the ratio of
(i) the aggregate amount of EBITDA of the Company and its Restricted
Subsidiaries for the period of the most recent four consecutive fiscal quarters
ending prior to the date of such determination for which consolidated financial
statements of the Company are available to (ii) Consolidated Interest Expense
for such four fiscal quarters (in each of clauses (i) and (ii), determined, for
each fiscal quarter (or portion thereof) of the four fiscal quarters ending
prior to the Issue Date, on a pro forma basis to give effect to the Central
Acquisition and the Transactions (including the anticipated disposition of any
non-rent-to-own businesses under contract for sale or held for sale following
the Issue Date) as if they had occurred at the beginning of such four-quarter
period); provided,
 
                                       139
<PAGE>   140
 
however, that: (1) if the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary (x) has Incurred
any Indebtedness since the beginning of such period that remains outstanding on
such date of determination or if the transaction giving rise to the need to
calculate the Consolidated Coverage Ratio is an Incurrence of Indebtedness,
EBITDA and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated
after giving effect on a pro forma basis to such Indebtedness as if such
Indebtedness had been Incurred on the first day of such period (except that in
making such computation, the amount of Indebtedness under any revolving credit
facility outstanding on the date of such calculation shall be computed based on
(A) the average daily balance of such Indebtedness during such four fiscal
quarters or such shorter period for which such facility was outstanding or (B)
if such facility was created after the end of such four fiscal quarters, the
average daily balance of such Indebtedness during the period from the date of
creation of such facility to the date of such calculation) and the discharge of
any other Indebtedness repaid, repurchased, defeased or otherwise discharged
with the proceeds of such new Indebtedness as if such discharge had occurred on
the first day of such period, or (y) has repaid, repurchased, defeased or
otherwise discharged any Indebtedness since the beginning of the period that is
no longer outstanding on such date of determination, or if the transaction
giving rise to the need to calculate the Consolidated Coverage Ratio involves a
discharge of Indebtedness (in each case other than Indebtedness Incurred under
any revolving credit facility unless such Indebtedness has been permanently
repaid), EBITDA and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be
calculated after giving effect on a pro forma basis to such discharge of such
Indebtedness, including with the proceeds of such new Indebtedness, as if such
discharge had occurred on the first day of such period; (2) if since the
beginning of such period the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary shall have
made any Asset Disposition of any company or any business or any group of
assets, the EBITDA for such period shall be reduced by an amount equal to the
EBITDA (if positive) directly attributable to the assets that are the subject of
such Asset Disposition for such period or increased by an amount equal to the
EBITDA (if negative) directly attributable thereto for such period and
Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be reduced by an amount
equal to the Consolidated Interest Expense directly attributable to any
Indebtedness of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary repaid, repurchased,
defeased or otherwise discharged with respect to the Company and its continuing
Restricted Subsidiaries in connection with such Asset Disposition for such
period (and, if the Capital Stock of any Restricted Subsidiary is sold, the
Consolidated Interest Expense for such period directly attributable to the
Indebtedness of such Restricted Subsidiary to the extent the Company and its
continuing Restricted Subsidiaries are no longer liable for such Indebtedness
after such sale); (3) if since the beginning of such period the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary (by merger or otherwise) shall have made an Investment in
any Person that thereby becomes a Restricted Subsidiary, or otherwise acquired
any company or any business or any group of assets, including any such
acquisition of assets occurring in connection with a transaction causing a
calculation to be made hereunder, EBITDA and Consolidated Interest Expense for
such period shall be calculated after giving pro forma effect thereto (including
the Incurrence of any Indebtedness and including the pro forma expenses and cost
reductions calculated on a basis consistent with Regulation S-X of the
Securities Act) as if such Investment or acquisition occurred on the first day
of such period; and (4) if since the beginning of such period any Person (that
subsequently became a Restricted Subsidiary or was merged with or into the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary since the beginning of such period) shall
have made any Asset
 
                                       140
<PAGE>   141
 
Disposition or any Investment or acquisition of assets that would have required
an adjustment pursuant to clause (2) or (3) above if made by the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary during such period, EBITDA and Consolidated Interest
Expense for such period shall be calculated after giving pro forma effect
thereto as if such Asset Disposition, Investment or acquisition of assets
occurred on the first day of such period.
 
For purposes of this definition, whenever pro forma effect is to be given to an
Asset Disposition, Investment or acquisition of assets, or any transaction
governed by the provisions described under "-- Merger and Consolidation," or the
amount of income or earnings relating thereto and the amount of Consolidated
Interest Expense associated with any Indebtedness Incurred or repaid,
repurchased, defeased or otherwise discharged in connection therewith, the pro
forma calculations in respect thereof shall be as determined in good faith by a
responsible financial or accounting officer of the Company, based on reasonable
assumptions. If any Indebtedness bears a floating rate of interest and is being
given pro forma effect, the interest expense on such Indebtedness shall be
calculated at a fixed rate as if the rate in effect on the date of determination
had been the applicable rate for the entire period (taking into account any
Interest Rate Agreement applicable to such Indebtedness if such Interest Rate
Agreement has a remaining term as at the date of determination in excess of 12
months). If any Indebtedness bears, at the option of the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary, a fixed or floating rate of interest and is being given pro forma
effect, the interest expense on such Indebtedness shall be computed by applying,
at the option of the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, either a fixed or
floating rate. If any Indebtedness which is being given pro forma effect was
Incurred under a revolving credit facility, the interest expense on such
Indebtedness shall be computed based upon the average daily balance of such
Indebtedness during the applicable period.
 
"Consolidated Interest Expense" means, as to any Person, for any period, the
total consolidated interest expense of such Person and its Subsidiaries
determined in accordance with GAAP, minus, to the extent included in such
interest expense, amortization or write-off of financing costs plus, to the
extent incurred by such Person and its Subsidiaries in such period but not
included in such interest expense, without duplication, (i) interest expense
attributable to Capitalized Lease Obligations and the interest component of rent
expense associated with Attributable Debt in respect of the relevant lease
giving rise thereto, determined as if such lease were a capitalized lease, in
accordance with GAAP, (ii) amortization of debt discount, (iii) interest in
respect of Indebtedness of any other Person that has been Guaranteed by such
Person or any Subsidiary, but only to the extent that such interest is actually
paid by such Person or any Restricted Subsidiary, (iv) non-cash interest
expense, (v) net costs associated with Hedging Obligations, (vi) the product of
(A) mandatory Preferred Stock cash dividends in respect of all Preferred Stock
of Subsidiaries of such Person and Disqualified Stock of such Person held by
Persons other than such Person or a Subsidiary multiplied by (B) a fraction, the
numerator of which is one and the denominator of which is one minus the then
current combined federal, state and local statutory tax rate of such Person,
expressed as a decimal, in each case, determined on a consolidated basis in
accordance with GAAP; and (vii) the cash contributions to any employee stock
ownership plan or similar trust to the extent such contributions are used by
such plan or trust to pay interest to any Person (other than the referent Person
or any Subsidiary thereof) in connection with Indebtedness Incurred by such plan
or trust; provided, however, that as to the Company, there shall be excluded
therefrom any such interest expense of any Unrestricted Subsidiary to the extent
the
 
                                       141
<PAGE>   142
 
related Indebtedness is not Guaranteed or paid by the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary. For purposes of the foregoing, gross interest expense shall be
determined after giving effect to any net payments made or received by such
Person and its Subsidiaries with respect to Interest Rate Agreements.
 
"Consolidated Net Income" means, as to any Person, for any period, the
consolidated net income (loss) of such Person and its Subsidiaries before
preferred stock dividends, determined in accordance with GAAP; provided,
however, that there shall not be included in such Consolidated Net Income: (i)
any net income (loss) of any Person if such Person is not (as to the Company) a
Restricted Subsidiary and (as to any other Person) an unconsolidated Person,
except that (A) subject to the limitations contained in clause (iv) below, the
referent Person's equity in the net income of any such Person for such period
shall be included in such Consolidated Net Income up to the aggregate amount of
cash actually distributed by such Person during such period to the referent
Person or a Subsidiary as a dividend or other distribution (subject, in the case
of a dividend or other distribution to a Subsidiary, to the limitations
contained in clause (iii) below) and (B) the net loss of such Person shall be
included to the extent of the aggregate Investment of the referent Person or any
of its Subsidiaries in such Person; (ii) any net income (loss) of any Person
acquired in a pooling of interests transaction for any period prior to the date
of such acquisition; (iii) any net income (loss) of any Restricted Subsidiary
(as to the Company) or of any Subsidiary (as to any other Person) if such
Subsidiary is subject to restrictions, directly or indirectly, on the payment of
dividends or the making of distributions by such Subsidiary, directly or
indirectly, to the Company, except that (A) subject to the limitations contained
in (iv) below, such Person's equity in the net income of any such Subsidiary for
such period shall be included in Consolidated Net Income up to the aggregate
amount of cash that could have been distributed by such Subsidiary during such
period to such Person or another Subsidiary as a dividend (subject, in the case
of a dividend that could have been made to another Restricted Subsidiary, to the
limitation contained in this clause) and (B) the net loss of such Subsidiary
shall be included in determining Consolidated Net Income; (iv) any charges for
costs and expenses associated with the Transactions; (v) any extraordinary gain
or loss; and (vi) the cumulative effect of a change in accounting principles.
 
"Consolidated Tangible Assets" means, as of any date of determination, the total
assets, less goodwill and other intangibles (other than patents, trademarks,
copyrights, licenses and other intellectual property), shown on the balance
sheet of the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries as of the most recent date
for which such a balance sheet is available, determined on a consolidated basis
in accordance with GAAP less all write-ups (other than write-ups in connection
with acquisitions) subsequent to the date of the Indenture in the book value of
any asset (except any such intangible assets) owned by the Company or any of its
Restricted Subsidiaries.
 
"Consolidation" means the consolidation of the accounts of each of the
Restricted Subsidiaries with those of the Company in accordance with GAAP;
provided, however, that "Consolidation" will not include consolidation of the
accounts of any Unrestricted Subsidiary, but the interest of the Company in any
Unrestricted Subsidiary will be accounted for as an investment. The term
"Consolidated" has a correlative meaning.
 
"Convertible Preferred Stock" means (i) the convertible preferred stock of the
Company issued to Apollo, resulting in gross proceeds to the Company of $250
million, and (ii) the
 
                                       142
<PAGE>   143
 
convertible preferred stock of the Company which will be issued to an Affiliate
of Bear, Stearns & Co. concurrently with the issuance of the Old Notes,
resulting in gross proceeds to the Company of $10 million.
 
"Currency Agreement" means in respect of a Person any foreign exchange contract,
currency swap agreement or other similar agreement or arrangement (including
derivative agreements or arrangements) as to which such Person is a party or a
beneficiary.
 
"Default" means any event or condition that is, or after notice or passage of
time or both would be, an Event of Default.
 
"Designated Senior Indebtedness" means (i) the Bank Indebtedness and (ii) any
other Senior Indebtedness which, at the date of determination, has an aggregate
principal amount of, or under which, at the date of determination, the holders
thereof are committed to lend up to, at least $25.0 million and is specifically
designated by the Company in the instrument evidencing or governing such Senior
Indebtedness as "Designated Senior Indebtedness" for purposes of the Indentures.
 
"Disqualified Stock" means, with respect to any Person, any Capital Stock
(excluding the Convertible Preferred Stock) that by its terms (or by the terms
of any security into which it is convertible or for which it is exchangeable or
exercisable) or upon the happening of any event (i) matures or is mandatorily
redeemable pursuant to a sinking fund obligation or otherwise, (ii) is
convertible or exchangeable for Indebtedness or Disqualified Stock or (iii) is
redeemable at the option of the holder thereof, in whole or in part, in the case
of clauses (i), (ii) and (iii), on or prior to the 91st day after the Stated
Maturity of the Notes.
 
"EBITDA" means, as to any Person, for any period, the Consolidated Net Income
for such period, plus the following to the extent included in calculating such
Consolidated Net Income: (i) income tax expense, (ii) Consolidated Interest
Expense, (iii) depreciation expense (other than depreciation expense relating to
rental merchandise), (iv) amortization expense and (v) other non-cash charges or
non-cash losses, and minus any gain (but not loss) realized upon the sale or
other disposition of any asset of the Company or its Restricted Subsidiaries
(including pursuant to any Sale/Leaseback Transaction) that is not sold or
otherwise disposed of in the ordinary course of business.
 
"Equity Offering" means a primary public or private offering or sale of common
stock of the Company, the proceeds of which shall be at least $25.0 million.
 
"Exchange Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
 
"GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of
America as in effect on the Issue Date (for purposes of the definitions of the
terms "Consolidated Coverage Ratio," "Consolidated Interest Expense,"
"Consolidated Net Income" and "EBITDA," all defined terms in the Indenture to
the extent used in or relating to any of the foregoing definitions, and all
ratios and computations based on any of the foregoing definitions) and as in
effect from time to time (for all other purposes of the Indenture), including
those set forth in the opinions and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles
Board of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements
and pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board or in such other
statements by such other entity as approved by a significant segment of the
accounting profession. All
 
                                       143
<PAGE>   144
 
ratios and computations based on GAAP contained in the Indenture shall be
computed in conformity with GAAP.
 
"Guarantee" means any obligation, contingent or otherwise, of any Person
directly or indirectly guaranteeing any Indebtedness or other nonfinancial
obligation of any other Person, including any such obligation, direct or
indirect, contingent or otherwise, of such Person (i) to purchase or pay (or
advance or supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such Indebtedness or
such other obligation of such other Person (whether arising by virtue of
partnership arrangements, or by agreement to keep-well, to purchase assets,
goods, securities or services, to take-or-pay, or to maintain financial
statement conditions or otherwise) or (ii) entered into for purposes of assuring
in any other manner the obligee of such Indebtedness or other obligation of the
payment thereof or to protect such obligee against loss in respect thereof (in
whole or in part); provided, however, that the term "Guarantee" shall not
include endorsements for collection or deposit in the ordinary course of
business. The term "Guarantee" used as a verb has a correlative meaning.
 
"Guarantor Senior Indebtedness" means, with respect to a Subsidiary Guarantor,
the following obligations, whether outstanding on the date of the Indenture or
thereafter issued, without duplication: (i) any Guarantee of the Senior Credit
Facility by such Subsidiary Guarantor and all other Guarantees by such
Subsidiary Guarantor of Senior Indebtedness of the Company or Guarantor
Indebtedness for any other Subsidiary Guarantor; and (ii) all obligations
consisting of the principal of and premium, if any, and accrued and unpaid
interest (including interest accruing on or after the filling of any petition in
bankruptcy or for reorganization relating to the Subsidiary Guarantor regardless
of whether post filing interest is allowed in such proceeding) on, and fees and
other amounts owing in respect of, all other Indebtedness of the Subsidiary
Guarantor, unless, in the instrument creating or evidencing the same or pursuant
to which the same is outstanding, it is expressly provided that the obligations
in respect of such Indebtedness are not senior in right of payment to the
obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor under the Subsidiary Guarantee;
provided, however, that Guarantor Senior Indebtedness will not include (1) any
obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor to another Subsidiary Guarantor or any
other Affiliate of the Subsidiary Guarantor or any such Affiliate's
Subsidiaries, (2) any liability for Federal, state, local, foreign or other
taxes owed or owing by such Subsidiary Guarantor, (3) any accounts payable or
other liability to trade creditors arising in the ordinary course of business
(including Guarantees thereof or instruments evidencing such liabilities) or
other current liabilities (other than current liabilities which constitute Bank
Indebtedness or the current portion of any long-term Indebtedness which would
constitute Senior Indebtedness but for the operation of this clause (3), (4) any
Indebtedness, Guarantee or obligation of such Subsidiary Guarantor that is
expressly subordinate or junior to any other Indebtedness, Guarantee or
obligation of such Subsidiary Guarantor, including any Guarantor Senior
Subordinated Indebtedness and Guarantor Subordinated Obligations of such
Subsidiary Guarantor (5) Indebtedness which is represented by redeemable Capital
Stock or (6) that portion of any Indebtedness that is incurred in violation of
the Indenture. If any Designated Senior Indebtedness is disallowed, avoided or
subordinated pursuant to the provisions of Section 548 of Title 11 of the United
States Code or any applicable state fraudulent conveyance law, such Designated
Senior Indebtedness nevertheless will constitute Senior Indebtedness.
 
                                       144
<PAGE>   145
 
"Guarantor Senior Subordinated Indebtedness" means with respect to a Subsidiary
Guarantor, the obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor under the Subsidiary
Guarantee and any other Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor (whether
outstanding on the Issue Date or thereafter incurred) that specifically provides
that such Indebtedness is to rank pari passu in right of payment with the
obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor under the Subsidiary Guarantee and is
not expressly subordinated by its terms in right of payment to any Indebtedness
of such Subsidiary Guarantor which is not Guarantor Senior Indebtedness of such
Subsidiary Guarantor.
 
"Guarantor Subordinated Obligation" means, with respect to a Subsidiary
Guarantor, any Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor (whether outstanding on
the Issue Date or thereafter incurred) which is expressly subordinate in right
of payment to the obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor under its Subsidiary
Guarantee pursuant to a written agreement.
 
"Hedging Obligations" of any Person means the obligations of such Person
pursuant to any Interest Rate Agreement or Currency Agreement.
 
"Holder" or "Noteholder" means the Person in whose name a Note is registered in
the Register.
 
"Incur" means issue, assume, enter into any Guarantee of, incur or otherwise
become liable for; provided, however, that any Indebtedness or Capital Stock of
a Person existing at the time such Person becomes a Subsidiary (whether by
merger, consolidation, acquisition or otherwise) shall be deemed to be Incurred
by such Subsidiary at the time it becomes a Subsidiary. Any Indebtedness issued
at a discount (including Indebtedness on which interest is payable through the
issuance of additional Indebtedness) shall be deemed incurred at the time of
original issuance of the Indebtedness at the initial accreted amount thereof.
 
"Indebtedness" means, with respect to any Person on any date of determination
(without duplication): (i) the principal of Indebtedness of such Person for
borrowed money, (ii) the principal of obligations of such Person evidenced by
bonds, debentures, notes or other similar instruments, (iii) all reimbursement
obligations of such Person, including reimbursement obligations in respect of
letters of credit or other similar instruments (the amount of such obligations
being equal at any time to the aggregate then undrawn and unexpired amount of
such letters of credit or other instruments plus the aggregate amount of
drawings thereunder that have not then been reimbursed), (iv) all obligations of
such Person to pay the deferred and unpaid purchase price of property or
services (except Trade Payables), which purchase price is due more than one year
after the date of placing such property in final service or taking final
delivery and title thereto or the completion of such services, (v) all
Capitalized Lease Obligations and Attributable Debt of such Person, (vi) the
redemption, repayment or other repurchase amount of such Person with respect to
any Disqualified Stock or (if such Person is a Subsidiary of the Company) any
Preferred Stock of such Subsidiary, but excluding, in each case, any accrued
dividends (the amount of such obligation to be equal at any time to the maximum
fixed involuntary redemption, repayment or repurchase price for such Capital
Stock, or if such Capital Stock has no fixed price, to the involuntary
redemption, repayment or repurchase price therefor calculated in accordance with
the terms thereof as if then redeemed, repaid or repurchased, and if such price
is based upon or measured by the fair market value of such
 
                                       145
<PAGE>   146
 
Capital Stock, such fair market value shall be as determined in good faith by
the Board of Directors or the board of directors of the issuer of such Capital
Stock), (vii) all Indebtedness of other Persons secured by a Lien on any asset
of such Person, whether or not such Indebtedness is assumed by such Person;
provided, however, that the amount of Indebtedness of such Person shall be the
lesser of (A) the fair market value of such asset at such date of determination
and (B) the amount of such Indebtedness of such other Persons, (viii) all
Indebtedness of other Persons to the extent Guaranteed by such Person, and (ix)
to the extent not otherwise included in this definition, net Hedging Obligations
of such Person (such obligations to be equal at any time to the termination
value of such agreement or arrangement giving rise to such Hedging Obligation
that would be payable by such Person at such time).
 
The amount of Indebtedness of any Person at any date shall be determined as set
forth above or otherwise provided in the Indenture, or otherwise in accordance
with GAAP.
 
"Interest Rate Agreement" means with respect to any Person any interest rate
protection agreement, interest rate future agreement, interest rate option
agreement, interest rate swap agreement, interest rate cap agreement, interest
rate collar agreement, interest rate hedge agreement or other similar agreement
or arrangement (including derivative agreements or arrangements) as to which
such Person is party or a beneficiary; provided, however, any such agreements
entered into in connection with the Notes shall not be included.
 
"Investment" in any Person by any other Person means any direct or indirect
advance, loan or other extension of credit (other than to customers, directors,
officers or employees of any Person in the ordinary course of business) or
capital contribution to (by means of any transfer of cash or other property to
others or any payment for property or services for the account or use of
others), or any purchase or acquisition of Capital Stock, Indebtedness or other
similar instruments issued by, such Person. If the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary of the Company sells or otherwise disposes of any Capital Stock of
any direct or indirect Restricted Subsidiary of the Company such that, after
giving effect to any such sale or disposition, such entity is no longer a
Subsidiary of the Company, the Company shall be deemed to have made an
Investment on the date of any such sale or disposition equal to the fair market
value of the Capital Stock of such Subsidiary not sold or disposed of.
 
"Issue Date" means the date on which the Old Notes were originally issued
(August 18, 1998).
 
"Lien" means any mortgage, pledge, security interest, encumbrance, lien or
charge of any kind (including any conditional sale or other title retention
agreement or lease in the nature thereof).
 
"Moody's" means Moody's Investors Service, Inc., and its successors.
 
"Net Available Cash" from an Asset Disposition means cash payments received
(including any cash payments received by way of deferred payment of principal
pursuant to a note or installment receivable or otherwise, but only as and when
received, but excluding any other consideration received in the form of
assumption by the acquiring person of Indebtedness or other obligations relating
to the properties or assets that are the subject of such Asset Disposition or
received in any other noncash form) therefrom, in each case net of (i) all
legal, title and recording tax expenses, commissions and other fees and expenses
incurred
 
                                       146
<PAGE>   147
 
(including, without limitation, fees and expenses of legal counsel, accountants
and financial advisors), and all Federal, state, provincial, foreign and local
taxes required to be paid or accrued as a liability under GAAP, as a consequence
of such Asset Disposition, (ii) all payments made on any Indebtedness that is
secured by any assets subject to such Asset Disposition, in accordance with the
terms of any Lien upon such assets, or that must by its terms, or in order to
obtain a necessary consent to such Asset Disposition, or by applicable law be
repaid out of the proceeds from such Asset Disposition, (iii) all distributions
and other payments required to be made to minority interest holders in
Subsidiaries or joint ventures as a result of such Asset Disposition or to any
other Person (other than the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary) owning a
beneficial interest in the assets disposed of in such Asset Disposition and (iv)
appropriate amounts to be provided by the seller as a reserve, in accordance
with GAAP, against any liabilities associated with the assets disposed of in
such Asset Disposition and retained by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
after such Asset Disposition.
 
"Net Cash Proceeds" means, with respect to any issuance or sale of any
securities of the Company or any Subsidiary by the Company or any Subsidiary, or
any capital contribution, the cash proceeds of such issuance, sale or
contribution net of attorneys' fees, accountants' fees, underwriters' or
placement agents' fees, discounts or commissions and brokerage, consultant and
other fees actually incurred in connection with such issuance, sale or
contribution and net of taxes paid or payable as a result thereof.
 
"Non-Recourse Debt" means Indebtedness (i) as to which neither the Company nor
any Restricted Subsidiary (a) provides any Guarantee or credit support of any
kind (including any undertaking, Guarantee, indemnity, agreement or instrument
that would constitute Indebtedness) or (b) is directly or indirectly liable (as
a guarantor or otherwise) and (ii) no default with respect to which (including
any rights that the holders thereof may have to take enforcement action against
an Unrestricted Subsidiary) would permit (upon notice, lapse of time or both)
any holder of any other Indebtedness of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
to declare a default under such other Indebtedness or cause the payment thereof
to be accelerated or payable prior to its stated maturity.
 
"Officer" means the Chief Executive Officer, President, Chief Financial Officer,
any Vice President, Controller, Secretary or Treasurer of the Company.
 
"Officer's Certificate" means a certificate signed by one Officer.
 
"Opinion of Counsel" means a written opinion from legal counsel who is
acceptable to the Trustee. The counsel may be an employee of or counsel to the
Company or the Trustee.
 
"Permitted Holders" means Apollo, J. Ernest Talley and Mark E. Speese, their
respective Affiliates and successors or assigns and any Person acting in the
capacity of an underwriter in connection with a public or private offering of
the Company's Capital Stock.
 
"Permitted Investment" means an Investment by the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary in any of the following: (i) a Restricted Subsidiary, the Company or
a Person that will, upon the making of such Investment, become a Restricted
Subsidiary; (ii) another Person if as a result of such Investment such other
Person is merged or consolidated with or into, or transfers or conveys all or
substantially all its assets to, the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary; (iii)
Temporary Cash Investments or Cash Equivalents; (iv) receivables owing to the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary, if created or acquired in the ordinary
course of business and payable or dischargeable in
 
                                       147
<PAGE>   148
 
accordance with customary trade terms; provided, however, that such trade terms
may include such concessionary trade terms as the Company or any such Restricted
Subsidiary deems reasonable under the circumstances; (v) securities or other
Investments received as consideration in connection with RTO Facility Swaps or
in sales or other dispositions of property or assets made in compliance with the
covenant described under "Certain Covenants -- Limitation on Sales of Assets;"
(vi) securities or other Investments received in settlement of debts created in
the ordinary course of business and owing to the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary, or as a result of foreclosure, perfection or enforcement of any
Lien, or in satisfaction of judgments, including in connection with any
bankruptcy proceeding or other reorganization of another Person; (vii)
Investments in existence or made pursuant to legally binding written commitments
in existence on the Issue Date; (viii) Currency Agreements, Interest Rate
Agreements and related Hedging Obligations, which obligations are Incurred in
compliance with the covenant described under "-- Certain
Covenants -- Limitations on Indebtedness;" (ix) pledges or deposits (A) with
respect to leases or utilities provided to third parties in the ordinary course
of business or (B) otherwise described in the definition of "Permitted Liens;"
(x) Investments in a Related Business in an amount not to exceed $10 million in
the aggregate; and (xi) other Investments in an aggregate amount not to exceed
the sum of $10 million and the aggregate non-cash net proceeds received by the
Company from the issue or sale of its Capital Stock (other than Disqualified
Stock) subsequent to the Issue Date (other than non-cash proceeds from an
issuance or sale of such Capital Stock to a Subsidiary of the Company or an
employee stock ownership plan or similar trust); provided, however, that the
value of such non-cash net proceeds shall be as conclusively determined by the
Board of Directors in good faith, except that in the event the value of any
non-cash net proceeds shall be $25 million or more, the value shall be as
determined in writing by an independent investment banking firm of nationally
recognized standing.
 
"Permitted Liens" means: (i) Liens for taxes, assessments or other governmental
charges not yet delinquent or the nonpayment of which in the aggregate would not
be reasonably expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company and its
Restricted Subsidiaries, or that are being contested in good faith and by
appropriate proceedings if adequate reserves with respect thereto are maintained
on the books of the Company or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, in
accordance with GAAP; (ii) carriers', warehousemen's, mechanics', landlords',
materialmen's, repairmen's or other like Liens arising in the ordinary course of
business in respect of obligations that are not overdue for a period of more
than 60 days or that are bonded or that are being contested in good faith and by
appropriate proceedings; (iii) pledges, deposits or liens in connection with
workers' compensation, unemployment insurance and other social security
legislation and/or similar legislation or other insurance-related obligations
(including, without limitation, pledges or deposits securing liability to
insurance carriers under insurance or self-insurance arrangements); (iv)
pledges, deposits or Liens to secure the performance of bids, tenders, trade,
government or other contracts (other than for borrowed money), obligations for
or under or in respect of utilities, leases, licenses, statutory obligations,
surety, judgment and appeal bonds, performance bonds and other obligations of a
like nature incurred in the ordinary course of business; (v) easements
(including reciprocal easement agreements), rights-of-way, building, zoning and
similar restrictions, utility agreements, covenants, reservations, restrictions,
encroachments, changes, and other similar encumbrances or title defects
incurred, or leases or subleases granted to others, in the ordinary course of
business, which do not in the aggregate materially interfere with the ordinary
conduct of
 
                                       148
<PAGE>   149
 
the business of the Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole; (vi) Liens
existing on, or provided for under written arrangements existing on, the Issue
Date, or (in the case of any such Liens securing Indebtedness of the Company or
any of its Subsidiaries existing or arising under written arrangements existing
on the Issue Date) securing any Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of such
Indebtedness so long as the Lien securing such Refinancing Indebtedness is
limited to all or part of the same property or assets (plus improvements,
accessions, proceeds or dividends or distributions in respect thereof) that
secured (or under such written arrangements could secure) the original
Indebtedness; (vii) Liens securing Hedging Obligations incurred in compliance
with the covenant described under "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on
Indebtedness;" (viii) Liens arising out of judgments, decrees, orders or awards
in respect of which the Company shall in good faith be prosecuting an appeal or
proceedings for review which appeal or proceedings shall not have been finally
terminated, or the period within which such appeal or proceedings may be
initiated shall not have expired; (ix) Liens securing (A) Indebtedness incurred
in compliance with clause (b)(i), (b)(ii) or (b)(v) of the covenant described
under "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on Indebtedness," or clause (b)(iv)
thereof (other than Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred in respect of Indebtedness
described in paragraph (a) thereof) or (B) Bank Indebtedness; (x) Liens on
properties or assets of the Company securing Senior Indebtedness; (xi) Liens
existing on property or assets of a Person at the time such Person becomes a
Subsidiary of the Company (or at the time the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary
acquires such property or assets); provided, however, that such Liens are not
created in connection with, or in contemplation of, such other Person becoming
such a Subsidiary (or such acquisition of such property or assets), and that
such Liens are limited to all or part of the same property or assets (plus
improvements, accessions, proceeds or dividends or distributions in respect
thereof) that secured (or, under the written arrangements under which such Liens
arose, could secure) the obligations to which such Liens relate; (xii) Liens on
Capital Stock of an Unrestricted Subsidiary that secure Indebtedness or other
obligations of such Unrestricted Subsidiary; (xiii) Liens securing the Notes;
and (xiv) Liens securing Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred in respect of any
Indebtedness secured by, or securing any refinancing, refunding, extension,
renewal or replacement (in whole or in part) of any other obligation secured by,
any other Permitted Liens, provided that any such new Lien is limited to all or
part of the same property or assets (plus improvements, accessions, proceeds or
dividends or distributions in respect thereof) that secured (or, under the
written arrangements under which the original Lien arose, could secure) the
obligations to which such Liens relate.
 
"Person" means any individual, corporation, partnership, joint venture,
association, joint-stock company, limited liability company, trust,
unincorporated organization, government or any agency or political subdivision
thereof or any other entity.
 
"Preferred Stock" as applied to the Capital Stock of any corporation means
Capital Stock of any class or classes (however designated) that is preferred as
to the payment of dividends, or as to the distribution of assets upon any
voluntary or involuntary liquidation or dissolution of such corporation, over
shares of Capital Stock of any other class of such corporation.
 
"Purchase Money Obligations" means any Indebtedness of the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary incurred to finance the acquisition, construction or
capital improvement of any
 
                                       149
<PAGE>   150
 
property or business (including Indebtedness incurred within 90 days following
such acquisition or construction), including Indebtedness of a Person existing
at the time such Person becomes a Restricted Subsidiary or assumed by the
Company or a Restricted Subsidiary in connection with the acquisition of assets
from such Person; provided, however, that any Lien on such Indebtedness shall
not extend to any property other than the property so acquired or constructed.
 
"Refinancing Indebtedness" means Indebtedness that is Incurred to refund,
refinance, replace, renew, repay or extend (including pursuant to any defeasance
or discharge mechanism) (collectively, "refinances," and "refinanced" shall have
a correlative meaning) any Indebtedness existing on the date of the Indenture or
Incurred in compliance with the Indenture (including Indebtedness of the Company
that refinances Indebtedness of any Restricted Subsidiary (to the extent
permitted in the Indenture) and Indebtedness of any Restricted Subsidiary that
refinances Indebtedness of another Restricted Subsidiary) including Indebtedness
that refinances Refinancing Indebtedness; provided, however, that (i) the
Refinancing Indebtedness has a Stated Maturity no earlier than the Stated
Maturity of the Indebtedness being refinanced, (ii) the Refinancing Indebtedness
has an Average Life at the time such Refinancing Indebtedness is Incurred that
is equal to or greater than the Average Life of the Indebtedness being
refinanced and (iii) such Refinancing Indebtedness is Incurred in an aggregate
principal amount (or if issued with original issue discount, an aggregate issue
price) that is equal to or less than the aggregate principal amount (or if
issued with original issue discount, the aggregate accreted value) then
outstanding of the Indebtedness being refinanced, plus fees, underwriting
discounts, premiums and other costs and expenses incurred in connection with
such Refinancing Indebtedness; provided further, however, that Refinancing
Indebtedness shall not include (x) Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary that
refinances Indebtedness of the Company or (y) Indebtedness of the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary that refinances Indebtedness of an Unrestricted
Subsidiary.
 
"Related Business" means those businesses, other than the car rental business,
in which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is engaged on the date of the
Indenture or that are reasonably related or incidental thereto.
 
"Rent-A-Center Acquisition" means the acquisition of Rent-A-Center by the
Company.
 
"Representative" means the trustee, agent or representative (if any) for an
issue of Senior Indebtedness.
 
"Restricted Subsidiary" means Rent-A-Center, Inc. and ColorTyme, Inc.
 
"Revolving Credit Facility" means the revolving credit facility under the Senior
Credit Facility (which may include any swing line or letter of credit facility
or subfacility thereunder).
 
"RTO Facility" means any facility through which the Company or any of its
Restricted Subsidiaries conducts the business of renting merchandise to its
customers and any facility through which a franchise of the Company or any of
its Subsidiaries conducts the business of renting merchandise to customers.
 
"RTO Facility Swap" means an exchange of assets (including Capital Stock of a
Subsidiary or the Company) of substantially equivalent fair market value, as
conclusively
 
                                       150
<PAGE>   151
 
determined in good faith by the Board of Directors, by the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary for one or more RTO Facilities or for cash, Capital Stock,
Indebtedness or other securities of any Person owning or operating one or more
RTO Facilities and primarily engaged in a Related Business; provided, however,
that any Net Cash Proceeds received by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
in connection with any such transaction must be applied in accordance with the
covenant described under "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on Sale of Assets."
 
"Sale/Leaseback Transaction" means an arrangement relating to property now owned
or hereafter acquired by the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary whereby the
Company or such Restricted Subsidiary transfers such property to a Person and
the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary leases it from such Person, other than
leases (x) between the Company and a Restricted Subsidiary or (y) required to be
classified and accounted for as capitalized leases for financial reporting
purposes in accordance with GAAP.
 
"SEC" means the Securities and Exchange Commission.
 
"Secured Indebtedness" means any Indebtedness of the Company secured by a Lien.
 
"Senior Credit Agreement" means the credit agreement dated as of August 5, 1998,
among the Company, the banks and other financial institutions party thereto from
time to time, Comerica, N.A. as the documentation agent, NationsBank, N.A. as
syndication agent and Chase, as administrative agent, as such agreement may be
assumed by any successor in interest, and as such agreement may be amended,
supplemented, waived or otherwise modified from time to time, or refunded,
refinanced, restructured, replaced, renewed, repaid, increased or extended from
time to time (whether in whole or in part, whether with the original agent and
lenders or other agents and lenders or otherwise, and whether provided under the
original Senior Credit Agreement or otherwise).
 
"Senior Credit Facility" means the collective reference to the Senior Credit
Agreement, any Loan Documents (as defined therein), any notes and letters of
credit issued pursuant thereto and any guarantee and collateral agreement,
patent and trademark security agreement, mortgages, letter of credit
applications and other security agreements and collateral documents, and other
instruments and documents, executed and delivered pursuant to or in connection
with any of the foregoing, in each case as the same may be amended,
supplemented, waived or otherwise modified from time to time, or refunded,
refinanced, restructured, replaced, renewed, repaid, increased or extended from
time to time (whether in whole or in part, whether with the original agent and
lenders or other agents and lenders or otherwise, and whether provided under the
original Senior Credit Agreement or otherwise). Without limiting the generality
of the foregoing, the term "Senior Credit Facility" shall include any agreement
(i) changing the maturity of any Indebtedness incurred thereunder or
contemplated thereby, (ii) adding Subsidiaries of the Company as additional
borrowers or guarantors thereunder, (iii) increasing the amount of Indebtedness
incurred thereunder or available to be borrowed thereunder or (iv) otherwise
altering the terms and conditions thereof.
 
"Senior Indebtedness" means the following obligations, whether outstanding on
the date of the Indenture or thereafter issued, without duplication: (i) all
obligations consisting of Bank Indebtedness; and (ii) all obligations consisting
of the principal of and premium, if any, and accrued and unpaid interest
(including interest accruing on or after the filing of any petition in
bankruptcy or for reorganization relating to the Company regardless of
 
                                       151
<PAGE>   152
 
whether postfiling interest is allowed in such proceeding) on, and fees and
other amounts owing in respect of, all other Indebtedness of the Company,
unless, in the instrument creating or evidencing the same or pursuant to which
the same is outstanding, it is provided that the obligations in respect of such
Indebtedness are not superior in right of payment to the Notes; provided,
however, that Senior Indebtedness shall not include (1) any obligation of the
Company to any Subsidiary or any other Affiliate of the Company, or any such
Affiliate's Subsidiaries, (2) any liability for Federal, state, foreign, local
or other taxes owed or owing by the Company, (3) any accounts payable or other
liability to trade creditors arising in the ordinary course of business
(including Guarantees thereof or instruments evidencing such liabilities) or
other current liabilities (other than current liabilities which constitute Bank
Indebtedness or the current portion of any long-term Indebtedness which would
constitute Senior Indebtedness but for the operation of this clause (3)), (4)
any Indebtedness, Guarantee or obligations of the Company that is expressly
subordinate or junior to any other Indebtedness, Guarantee or obligation of the
Company, (5) Indebtedness which is represented by redeemable Capital Stock or
(6) that portion of any Indebtedness that is incurred in violation of the
Indentures. If any Designated Senior Indebtedness is disallowed, avoided or
subordinated pursuant to the provisions of Section 548 of Title 11 of the United
States Code or any applicable state fraudulent conveyance law, such Designated
Senior Indebtedness nevertheless will constitute Senior Indebtedness.
 
"Senior Subordinated Indebtedness" means the Notes and any other Indebtedness of
the Company that (i) specifically provides that such Indebtedness is to rank
pari passu with the Notes or is otherwise entitled Senior Subordinated
Indebtedness and (ii) is not subordinated by its terms to any Indebtedness or
other obligation of the Company that is not Senior Indebtedness.
 
"Significant Subsidiary" means (i) each Subsidiary that for the most recent
fiscal year of such Subsidiary had consolidated revenues greater than $10.0
million or as at the end of such fiscal year had assets or liabilities greater
than $10.0 million and (ii) any group of Subsidiaries that, taken together,
would constitute a Significant Subsidiary.
 
"S&P" means Standard & Poor's Ratings Service, a division of The McGraw-Hill
Companies, Inc., and its successors.
 
"Stated Maturity" means, with respect to any security, the date specified in
such security as the fixed date on which the payment of principal of such
security is due and payable, including pursuant to any mandatory redemption
provision (but excluding any provision providing for the repurchase of such
security at the option of the holder thereof upon the happening of any
contingency beyond the control of the issuer unless such contingency has
occurred).
 
"Subordinated Obligation" means any Indebtedness of the Company (whether
outstanding on the date of the Indenture or thereafter Incurred) which is
subordinate or junior in right of payment to the Notes pursuant to a written
agreement.
 
"Subsidiary" of any Person means any corporation, association, partnership or
other business entity of which more than 50% of the total voting power of shares
of Capital Stock or other interests (including partnership interests) entitled
(without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of
directors, managers or trustees
 
                                       152
<PAGE>   153
 
thereof is at the time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by (i) such
Person or (ii) one or more Subsidiaries of such Person.
 
"Subsidiary Guarantee" means, individually, any Guarantee of payment of the
Notes by a Subsidiary Guarantor pursuant to the terms of the Indenture, and,
collectively, all such Guarantees. Each such Subsidiary Guarantee will be in the
form prescribed in the Indenture.
 
"Subsidiary Guarantor" means (i) Rent-A-Center, Inc. and ColorTyme, Inc. and
(ii) any Restricted Subsidiary created or acquired by the Company after the
Issue Date.
 
"Successor Company" shall have the meaning assigned thereto in clause (i) under
"-- Merger and Consolidation."
 
"Temporary Cash Investments" means any of the following: (i) any investment in
direct obligations (x) of the United States of America or any agency thereof or
obligations Guaranteed by the United States of America or any agency thereof or
(y) of any foreign country recognized by the United States of America rated at
least "A" by S&P or "A1" by Moody's, (ii) investments in time deposit accounts,
certificates of deposit and money market deposits maturing within 180 days of
the date of acquisition thereof issued by a bank or trust company that is
organized under the laws of the United States of America, any state thereof or
any foreign country recognized by the United States of America having capital
and surplus aggregating in excess of $250 million (or the foreign currency
equivalent thereof) and whose long-term debt is rated "A" by S&P or "A-1" by
Moody's, (iii) repurchase obligations with a term of not more than 180 days for
underlying securities of the types described in clause (i) or (ii) above entered
into with a bank meeting the qualifications described in clause (ii) above, (iv)
Investments in commercial paper, maturing not more than 180 days after the date
of acquisition, issued by a corporation (other than an Affiliate of the Company)
organized and in existence under the laws of the United States of America or any
foreign country recognized by the United States of America with a rating at the
time as of which any Investment therein is made of "P-1" (or higher) according
to Moody's or "A-1" (or higher) according to S&P, (v) Investments in securities
with maturities of six months or less from the date of acquisition issued or
fully guaranteed by any state, commonwealth or territory of the United States of
America, or by any political subdivision or taxing authority thereof, and rated
at least "A" by S&P or "A" by Moody's, (vi) any money market deposit accounts
issued or offered by a domestic commercial bank or a commercial bank organized
and located in a country recognized by the United States of America, in each
case, having capital and surplus in excess of $250 million (or the foreign
currency equivalent thereof), or investments in money market funds complying
with the risk limiting conditions of Rule 2a-7 (or any short-term successor
rule) of the SEC, under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, and
(vii) similar short-term investments approved by the Board of Directors in the
ordinary course of business.
 
"Term Loan Facility" means the term loan facilities provided under the Senior
Credit Facility.
 
"TIA" means the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 (15 U.S.C. sec.sec.77aaa-77bbbb) as
in effect on the date of the Indenture.
 
                                       153
<PAGE>   154
 
"Trade Payables" means, with respect to any Person, any accounts payable or any
indebtedness or monetary obligation to trade creditors created, assumed or
Guaranteed by such Person arising in the ordinary course of business in
connection with the acquisition of goods or services.
 
"Transactions," means collectively the Rent-A-Center Acquisition, the offering
of the Notes, the initial borrowings under the Senior Credit Facility, and all
other transactions relating to the Rent-A-Center Acquisition or the financing
thereof.
 
"Trustee" means the party named as such in the Indenture until a successor
replaces it and, thereafter, means the successor.
 
"Trust Officer" means the Chairman of the Board, the President or any other
officer or assistant officer of the Trustee assigned by the Trustee to
administer its corporate trust matters.
 
"Unrestricted Subsidiary" means (i) any Subsidiary of the Company that at the
time of determination shall be designated an Unrestricted Subsidiary by the
Board of Directors in the manner provided below and (ii) any Subsidiary of an
Unrestricted Subsidiary. The Board of Directors may designate any Subsidiary of
the Company (including any newly acquired or newly formed Subsidiary of the
Company) to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary unless such Subsidiary or any of its
Subsidiaries owns any Capital Stock or Indebtedness of, or owns or holds any
Lien on any property of, the Company or any other Subsidiary of the Company that
is not a Subsidiary of the Subsidiary to be so designated; provided, however,
that either (A) the Subsidiary to be so designated has total consolidated assets
of $10,000 or less or (B) if such Subsidiary has consolidated assets greater
than $10,000, then such designation would be permitted under "-- Certain
Covenants -- Limitation on Restricted Payments." The Board of Directors may
designate any Unrestricted Subsidiary to be a Restricted Subsidiary; provided,
however, that immediately after giving effect to such designation (x) the
Company could incur at least $1.00 of additional Indebtedness under paragraph
(a) in the covenant described under "-- Certain Covenants -- Limitation on
Indebtedness" and (y) no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be
continuing. Any such designation by the Board of Directors shall be evidenced to
the Trustee by promptly filing with the Trustee a copy of the resolution of the
Company's Board of Directors giving effect to such designation and an Officers'
Certificate certifying that such designation complied with the foregoing
provisions.
 
"Voting Stock" of an entity means all classes of Capital Stock of such entity
then outstanding and normally entitled to vote in the election of directors or
all interests in such entity with the ability to control the management or
actions of such entity.
 
"Wholly Owned Subsidiary" means a Restricted Subsidiary of the Company all the
Capital Stock of which (other than directors' qualifying shares) is owned by the
Company or another Wholly Owned Subsidiary.
 
CERTAIN BOOK-ENTRY PROCEDURES FOR THE GLOBAL NOTES
 
Except as set forth below, the Exchange Notes will be represented by one
permanent global registered note in global form, without interest coupons (the
"Global Note"). The Global Note will be deposited with, or on behalf of, The
Depository Trust Company ("DTC") and registered in the name of Cede & Co., as
nominee of DTC, or will remain
 
                                       154
<PAGE>   155
 
in the custody of the Trustee pursuant to the FAST Balance Certificate Agreement
between DTC and the Trustee.
 
The descriptions of the operations and procedures of DTC, Euroclear and Cedel
set forth below are provided solely as a matter of convenience. These operations
and procedures are solely within the control of the respective settlement
systems and are subject to change by them from time to time. Neither the Company
nor the Initial Purchasers takes any responsibility for these operations or
procedures, and investors are urged to contact the relevant system or its
participants directly to discuss these matters.
 
DTC has advised the Company that it is (i) a limited purpose trust company
organized under the laws of the State of New York, (ii) a "banking organization"
within the meaning of the New York Banking Law, (iii) a member of the Federal
Reserve System, (iv) a "clearing corporation" within the meaning of the Uniform
Commercial Code, as amended, and (v) a "clearing agency" registered pursuant to
Section 17A of the Exchange Act. DTC was created to hold securities for its
participants (collectively, the "Participants") and facilitates the clearance
and settlement of securities transactions between Participants through
electronic book-entry changes to the accounts of its Participants, thereby
eliminating the need for physical transfer and delivery of certificates. DTC's
Participants include securities brokers and dealers (including the Initial
Purchasers), banks and trust companies, clearing corporations and certain other
organizations. Indirect access to DTC's system is also available to other
entities such as banks, brokers, dealers and trust companies (collectively, the
"Indirect Participants") that clear through or maintain a custodial relationship
with a Participant, either directly or indirectly. Investors who are not
Participants may beneficially own securities held by or on behalf of DTC only
through Participants or Indirect Participants.
 
The Company expects that pursuant to procedures established by DTC (i) upon
deposit of each Global Note, DTC will credit the accounts of Participants
designated by the Initial Purchasers with an interest in the Global Note and
(ii) ownership of the Notes will be shown on, and the transfer of ownership
thereof will be effected only through, records maintained by DTC (with respect
to the interests of Participants) and the records of Participants and the
Indirect Participants (with respect to the interests of persons other than
Participants).
 
The laws of some jurisdictions may require that certain purchasers of securities
take physical delivery of such securities in definitive form. Accordingly, the
ability to transfer interests in the Notes represented by a Global Note to such
persons may be limited. In addition, because DTC can act only on behalf of its
Participants, who in turn act on behalf of persons who hold interests through
Participants, the ability of a person having an interest in Notes represented by
a Global Note to pledge or transfer such interest to persons or entities that do
not participate in DTC's system, or to otherwise take actions in respect of such
interest, may be affected by the lack of a physical definitive security in
respect of such interest.
 
So long as DTC or its nominee is the registered owner of a Global Note, DTC or
such nominee, as the case may be, will be considered the sole owner or holder of
the Notes represented by the Global Note for all purposes under the Indenture.
Except as provided below, owners of beneficial interests in a Global Note will
not be entitled to have Notes represented by such Global Note registered in
their names, will not receive or be entitled
 
                                       155
<PAGE>   156
 
to receive physical delivery of Certificated Notes, and will not be considered
the owners or holders thereof under the Indenture for any purpose, including
with respect to the giving of any direction, instruction or approval to the
Trustee thereunder. Accordingly, each holder owning a beneficial interest in a
Global Note must rely on the procedures of DTC and, if such holder is not a
Participant or an Indirect Participant, on the procedures of the Participant
through which such holder owns its interest, to exercise any rights of a holder
of Notes under the Indenture or such Global Note. The Company understands that
under existing industry practice, in the event that the Company requests any
action of holders of Notes, or a holder that is an owner of a beneficial
interest in a Global Note desires to take any action that DTC, as the holder of
such Global Note, is entitled to take, DTC would authorize the Participants to
take such action and the Participants would authorize holders owning through
such Participants to take such action or would otherwise act upon the
instruction of such holders. Neither the Company nor the Trustee will have any
responsibility or liability for any aspect of the records relating to or
payments made on account of Notes by DTC, or for maintaining, supervising or
reviewing any records of DTC relating to such Notes.
 
Payments with respect to the principal of, and premium, if any, Liquidated
Damages, if any, and interest on, any Notes represented by a Global Note
registered in the name of DTC or its nominee on the applicable record date will
be payable by the Trustee to or at the direction of DTC or its nominee in its
capacity as the registered holder of the Global Note representing such Notes
under the Indenture. Under the terms of the Indenture, the Company and the
Trustee may treat the persons in whose names the Notes, including the Global
Notes, are registered as the owners thereof for the purpose of receiving payment
thereon and for any and all other purposes whatsoever. Accordingly, neither the
Company nor the Trustee has or will have any responsibility or liability for the
payment of such amounts to owners of beneficial interests in a Global Note
(including principal, premium, if any, Liquidated Damages, if any, and
interest). Payments by the Participants and the Indirect Participants to the
owners of beneficial interests in a Global Note will be governed by standing
instructions and customary industry practice and will be the responsibility of
the Participants or the Indirect Participants and DTC.
 
Transfers between Participants in DTC will be effected in accordance with DTC's
procedures, and will be settled in same-day funds. Transfers between
participants in Euroclear or Cedel will be effected in the ordinary way in
accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.
 
Subject to compliance with the transfer restrictions applicable to the Notes,
cross-market transfers between the Participants in DTC, on the one hand, and
Euroclear or Cedel participants, on the other hand, will be effected through DTC
in accordance with DTC's rules on behalf of Euroclear or Cedel, as the case may
be, by its respective depositary; however, such cross-market transactions will
require delivery of instructions to Euroclear or Cedel, as the case may be, by
the counter party in such system in accordance with the rules and procedures and
within the established deadlines (Brussels time) of such system. Euroclear or
Cedel, as the case may be, will, if the transaction meets its settlement
requirements, deliver instructions to its respective depositary to take action
to effect final settlement on its behalf by delivering or receiving interests in
the relevant Global Notes in DTC, and making or receiving payment in accordance
with normal procedures for same-
 
                                       156
<PAGE>   157
 
day funds settlement applicable to DTC. Euroclear participants and Cedel
participants may not deliver instructions directly to the depositaries for
Euroclear or Cedel.
 
Because of time zone differences, the securities account of a Euroclear or Cedel
participant purchasing an interest in a Global Note from a Participant in DTC
will be credited, and any such crediting will be reported to the relevant
Euroclear or Cedel participant, during the securities settlement processing day
(which must be a business day for Euroclear and Cedel) immediately following the
settlement date of DTC. Cash received in Euroclear or Cedel as a result of sales
of interest in a Global Security by or through a Euroclear or Cedel participant
to a Participant in DTC will be received with value on the settlement date of
DTC but will be available in the relevant Euroclear or Cedel cash account only
as of the business day for Euroclear or Cedel following DTC's settlement date.
 
Although DTC, Euroclear and Cedel have agreed to the foregoing procedures to
facilitate transfers of interests in the Global Notes among participants in DTC,
Euroclear and Cedel, they are under no obligation to perform or to continue to
perform such procedures, and such procedures may be discontinued at any time.
Neither the Company nor the Trustee will have any responsibility for the
performance by DTC, Euroclear or Cedel or their respective participants or
indirect participants of their respective obligations under the rules and
procedures governing their operations.
 
CERTIFICATED NOTES
 
If (i) the Company notifies the Trustee in writing that DTC is no longer willing
or able to act as a depositary or DTC ceases to be registered as a clearing
agency under the Exchange Act and a successor depositary is not appointed within
90 days of such notice or cessation, (ii) the Company, at its option, notifies
the Trustee in writing that it elects to cause the issuance of Notes in
definitive form under the Indenture or (iii) upon the occurrence of certain
other events as provided in the Indenture, then, upon surrender by DTC of the
Global Notes, Certificated Notes will be issued to each person that DTC
identifies as the beneficial owner of the Notes represented by the Global Notes.
Upon any such issuance, the Trustee is required to register such Certificated
Notes in the name of such person or persons (or the nominee of any thereof) and
cause the same to be delivered thereto.
 
Neither the Company nor the Trustee shall be liable for any delay by DTC or any
Participant or Indirect Participant in identifying the beneficial owners of the
related Notes and each such person may conclusively rely on, and shall be
protected in relying on, instructions from DTC for all purposes (including with
respect to the registration and delivery, and the respective principal amounts,
of the Notes to be issued).
 
                                       157
<PAGE>   158
 
              OLD NOTES EXCHANGE AND REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT
 
The Company and the Initial Purchasers entered into the Exchange and
Registration Rights Agreement on August 18, 1998. Pursuant to the Exchange and
Registration Rights Agreement, the Company agreed to (i) file with the SEC on or
prior to 60 days after the Issue Date a registration statement (the "Exchange
Offer Registration Statement"), relating to the Exchange Offer for the Old Notes
under the Securities Act and (ii) use its reasonable efforts to cause the
Exchange Offer Registration Statement to be declared effective under the
Securities Act within 150 days after the Issue Date. As soon as practicable
after the effectiveness of the Exchange Offer Registration Statement, the
Company will offer to the holders of Transfer Restricted Securities (as defined
below), who are not prohibited by any law or policy of the SEC from
participating in the Exchange Offer, the opportunity to exchange their Transfer
Restricted Securities for an issue of the Exchange Notes which are identical in
all material respects to the Old Notes (except that the Exchange Notes will not
contain terms with respect to transfer restrictions) and that would be
registered under the Securities Act. The Company will keep the Exchange Offer
open for not less than 30 days (or longer, if required by applicable law) after
the date on which notice of the Exchange Offer is mailed to the holders of the
Notes.
 
If (i) because of any change in law or applicable interpretations thereof by the
staff of the SEC, the Company is not permitted to effect the Exchange Offer as
contemplated hereby; (ii) any Old Notes validly tendered pursuant to the
Exchange Offer are not exchanged for Exchange Notes within 180 days after the
Issue Date; (iii) any Initial Purchaser so requests with respect to Old Notes
not eligible to be exchanged for Exchange Notes in the Exchange Offer; (iv) any
applicable law or interpretations do not permit any Holder of Old Notes to
participate in the Exchange Offer; (v) any Holder of Old Notes that participates
in the Exchange Offer does not receive freely transferable Exchange Notes in
exchange for tendered Old Notes; or (vi) the Company so elects, then the Company
will file with the SEC the Shelf Registration Statement to cover resales of
Transfer Restricted Securities by such Holders who satisfy certain conditions
relating to the provision of information in connection with the Shelf
Registration Statement. For purposes of the foregoing, "Transfer Restricted
Securities" means each Old Note until (i) the date on which such Old Note has
been exchanged for a freely transferable Exchange Note in the Exchange Offer;
(ii) the date on which such Old Note has been effectively registered under the
Securities Act and disposed of in accordance with the Shelf Registration
Statement, or (iii) the date on which such Old Note is distributed to the public
pursuant to Rule 144 under the Securities Act or is salable pursuant to Rule
144(k) under the Securities Act.
 
The Company will use its reasonable efforts to have the Exchange Offer
Registration Statement or, if applicable, the Shelf Registration Statement
declared effective by the SEC as promptly as practicable after the filing
thereof. Unless the Exchange Offer would not be permitted by a policy of the
SEC, the Company will commence the Exchange Offer and use its reasonable efforts
to consummate the Exchange Offer as promptly as practicable, but in any event
prior to 180 days after the Issue Date. If necessary, the Company will use its
commercially reasonable efforts to keep the Shelf Registration Statement
effective for a period of two years after the Issue Date.
 
                                       158
<PAGE>   159
 
If (i) the applicable Exchange Offer Registration Statement or, if applicable,
the Shelf Registration Statement, is not filed with the SEC on or prior to 60
days after the Issue Date; (ii) the applicable Exchange Offer Registration
Statement or, if applicable, the Shelf Registration Statement, is not declared
effective within 150 days after the Issue Date; (iii) the Exchange Offer is not
consummated on or prior to 180 days after the Issue Date; or (iv) the Shelf
Registration Statement is filed and declared effective within 150 days after the
Issue Date but shall thereafter cease to be effective (at any time that the
Company is obligated to maintain the effectiveness thereof) without being
succeeded within 45 days by an additional Registration Statement filed and
declared effective (each such event referred to in clauses (i) through (iv), a
"Registration Default"), the Company will be obligated to pay liquidated damages
to each Holder of Transfer Restricted Securities, during the period of one or
more such Registration Defaults, in an amount equal to $0.192 per week per
$1,000 principal amount of the Notes constituting Transfer Restricted Securities
held by such Holder until the applicable Registration Statement is filed, the
Exchange Offer Registration Statement is declared effective and the Exchange
Offer is consummated or the Shelf Registration Statement is declared effective
or again becomes effective, as the case may be. All accrued liquidated damages
shall be paid to Holders in the same manner as interest payments on the Notes on
semi-annual payment dates which correspond to interest payment dates for the
Notes. The accrual of liquidated damages will cease on the day on which all
Registration Defaults are cured.
 
The Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement also provides that the Company
shall (i) make available for a period of 180 days after the consummation of the
Exchange Offer a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act to
any broker-dealer for use in connection with any resale of any such Exchange
Notes and (ii) pay all expenses incident to the Exchange Offer (including the
expense of one counsel to the Holders of the Notes) and will indemnify certain
Holders of the Notes (including any broker-dealer) against certain liabilities,
including liabilities under the Securities Act. A broker-dealer that delivers
such a prospectus to purchasers in connection with such resales will be subject
to certain of the civil liability provisions under the Securities Act and will
be bound by the provisions of the Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement
(including certain indemnification rights and obligations).
 
Each Holder of Old Notes who wishes to exchange such Old Notes for Exchange
Notes in the Exchange Offer will be required to make certain representations,
including representations that (i) any Exchange Notes to be received by it will
be acquired in the ordinary course of its business; (ii) it has no arrangement
or understanding with any person to participate in the distribution of the
Exchange Notes; and (iii) it is not an "affiliate" (as defined in Rule 405 under
the Securities Act) of the Company, or if it is an affiliate, that it will
comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the
Securities Act to the extent applicable.
 
If the Holder is not a broker-dealer, it will be required to represent that it
is not engaged in, and does not intend to engage in, the distribution of the
Exchange Notes. If the Holder is a broker-dealer that will receive Exchange
Notes for its own account in exchange for Notes that were acquired as a result
of market-making activities or other trading activities (an "Exchanging
Dealer"), it will be required to acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus
in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes.
 
                                       159
<PAGE>   160
 
Holders of the Old Notes will be required to make certain representations to the
Company (as described above) in order to participate in the Exchange Offer and
will be required to deliver information to be used in connection with the Shelf
Registration Statement and benefit from the provisions regarding liquidated
damages set forth in the preceding paragraphs. A Holder who sells Old Notes
pursuant to the Shelf Registration Statement generally will be required to be
named as a selling securityholder in the related prospectus and to deliver a
prospectus to purchasers, will be subject to certain of the civil liability
provisions under the Securities Act in connection with such sales and will be
bound by the provisions of the Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement which
are applicable to such a Holder (including certain indemnification obligations).
 
For so long as the Old Notes are outstanding, the Company will continue to
provide to Holders of the Old Notes and to prospective purchasers of the Old
Notes the information required by Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Act.
 
The foregoing description of the Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement is a
summary only, does not purport to be complete and is qualified in its entirety
by reference to all provisions of the Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement
which is filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this
Prospectus is a part.
 
                                       160
<PAGE>   161
 
                             CERTAIN U. S. FEDERAL
                            INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES
 
GENERAL
 
The following is a summary of certain U. S. federal income tax consequences
associated with the exchange of Old Notes for Exchange Notes pursuant to the
Exchange Offer, and does not purport to be a complete analysis of all potential
tax effects. This summary is based upon the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
amended (the "Code"), existing and proposed regulations thereunder, published
rulings and court decisions, all as in effect and existing on the date hereof
and all of which are subject to change at any time, which change may be
retroactive. This summary is not binding on the Internal Revenue Service or on
the courts, and no ruling will be requested from the Internal Revenue Service on
any issues described below. There can be no assurance that the Internal Revenue
Service will not take a different position concerning the matters discussed
below.
 
This summary applies only to those persons who are the initial holders of Old
Notes, who acquired Old Notes for cash and who hold Old Notes as capital assets,
and assumes that the Old Notes were not issued with "original issue discount,"
as defined in the Code. It does not address the tax consequences to taxpayers
who are subject to special rules (such as financial institutions, tax-exempt
organizations, insurance companies and persons who are not "U.S. Holders"), or
the effect of any applicable U.S. federal estate and gift tax laws or state,
local or foreign tax laws. For purposes of this summary, a "U.S. Holder" means a
beneficial owner of a Note who purchased the Notes pursuant to the Offering that
is for U.S. federal income tax purposes (i) a citizen or resident of the United
States; (ii) a corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in
or under the laws of the United States or any political subdivision thereof;
(iii) an estate the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income taxation
regardless of its source; or (iv) a trust if (A) a court within the United
States is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of the
trust and (B) one or more U.S. fiduciaries have the authority to control all
substantial decisions of the trust.
 
EXCHANGE OFFER
 
The exchange of Old Notes for Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer
should not constitute a taxable exchange for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
Accordingly, a U.S. Holder should not recognize gain or loss upon the receipt of
Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, and a U.S. Holder should be
required to include interest on the Exchange Notes in gross income in the manner
and to the extent interest income was includible under the Old Notes. A U.S.
Holder's holding period for the Exchange Notes should include the holding period
of the Old Notes exchanged therefor, and such holder's adjusted basis in the
Exchange Notes should be the same as the basis of the Old Notes exchanged
therefor immediately before the exchange.
 
THE FOREGOING DISCUSSION IS INCLUDED HEREIN FOR GENERAL INFORMATION ONLY.
ACCORDINGLY, EACH HOLDER SHOULD CONSULT WITH ITS OWN TAX ADVISORS CONCERNING THE
TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER WITH RESPECT TO ITS PARTICULAR SITUATION,
INCLUDING THE APPLICATION AND EFFECT OF STATE, LOCAL AND FOREIGN INCOME AND
OTHER TAX LAWS.
 
                                       161
<PAGE>   162
 
                              PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION
 
Based on interpretations by the SEC set forth in no-action letters issued to
third parties, the Company believes that Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the
Exchange Offer in exchange for the Old Notes may be offered for resale, resold
and otherwise transferred by holders thereof (other than any holder which is (i)
an "affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405 under the
Securities Act, (ii) a broker-dealer who acquired Notes directly from the
Company or (iii) broker-dealers who acquired Notes as a result of market-making
or other trading activities) without compliance with the registration and
prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act provided that such Exchange
Notes are acquired in the ordinary course of such holders' business, and such
holders are not engaged in, and do not intend to engage in, and have no
arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, a distribution
of such Exchange Notes; provided that broker-dealers ("Participating
Broker-Dealers") receiving Exchange Notes in the Exchange Offer will be subject
to a prospectus delivery requirement with respect to resales of such Exchange
Notes. To date, the SEC has taken the position that Participating Broker-
Dealers may fulfill their prospectus delivery requirements with respect to
transactions involving an exchange of securities such as the exchange pursuant
to the Exchange Offer (other than a resale of an unsold allotment from the sale
of the Old Notes to the Initial Purchasers) with the Prospectus contained in the
Exchange Offer Registration Statement. Pursuant to the Exchange and Registration
Rights Agreement, the Company has agreed to permit Participating Broker-Dealers
to use this Prospectus in connection with the resale of such Exchange Notes. The
Company has agreed that, for a period of 180 days after the Expiration Date, it
will make this Prospectus, and any amendment or supplement to this Prospectus,
available to any broker-dealer that requests such documents in the Letter of
Transmittal.
 
Each holder of the Old Notes who wishes to exchange its Old Notes for Exchange
Notes in the Exchange Offer will be required to make certain representations to
the Company as set forth in "The Exchange Offer -- Purpose and Effect of the
Exchange Offer."
 
Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account pursuant to
the Exchange Offer must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in
connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. This Prospectus, as it may be
amended or supplemented from time to time, may be used by a broker-dealer in
connection with resales of Exchange Notes received in exchange for Old Notes
where such Old Notes were acquired as a result of market-making activities or
other trading activities. The Company has agreed that, for a period of 180 days
after the consummation of the Exchange Offer, it will use its commercially
reasonable efforts to make this prospectus, as amended or supplemented,
available to any broker-dealer for use in connection with any such resale. In
addition, until [                 , 199 ,] all dealers effecting transactions in
the Exchange Notes may be required to deliver a prospectus.
 
The Company will not receive any proceeds from any sale of Exchange Notes by
broker-dealers. Exchange Notes received by broker-dealers for their own account
pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be sold from time to time in one or more
transactions in the over-the-counter market, in negotiated transactions, through
the writing of options on the Exchange Notes or a combination of such methods of
resale, at market prices prevailing at the time of resale, at prices related to
such prevailing market prices or at negotiated prices. Any such resale may be
made directly to purchasers or to or through brokers or dealers
 
                                       162
<PAGE>   163
 
who may receive compensation in the form of commissions or concessions from any
such broker-dealer or the purchasers of any such Exchange Notes. Any
broker-dealer that resells Exchange Notes that were received by it for its own
account pursuant to the Exchange Offer and any broker or dealer that
participates in a distribution of such Exchange Notes may be deemed to be an
"underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act and any profit on any
such resale of Exchange Notes and any commission or concessions received by any
such persons may be deemed to be underwriting compensation under the Securities
Act. The Letter of Transmittal states that, by acknowledging that it will
deliver and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to
admit that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act.
 
For a period of 90 days after the consummation of the Exchange Offer, the
Company will promptly send additional copies of this Prospectus and any
amendment or supplement to this Prospectus to any broker-dealer that requests
such documents in the Letter of Transmittal. The Company has agreed to pay all
expenses incident to the Exchange Offer (including the expenses of one counsel
for the Holders of the Notes) other than commissions or concessions of any
broker-dealers and will indemnify the Holders of the Securities (including any
broker-dealers) against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the
Securities Act.
 
                                    EXPERTS
 
The audited financial statements of the Company included in this Prospectus for
the years ended December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 have been audited by Grant
Thornton LLP, independent certified public accountants, as stated in their
reports included herein.
 
The consolidated financial statements of THORN Americas, Inc. and subsidiaries
at March 31, 1998 and 1997, and for each of the three years in the period ended
March 31, 1998, appearing in this Prospectus and Registration Statement have
been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent auditors, as set forth in their
report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon
such report given upon the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and
auditing.
 
The audited financial statements of Central Rents included in this Prospectus
for the years ended December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1994 have been audited by Arthur
Andersen LLP, independent public accountants, as stated in their reports
included herein.
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
 
The validity of the Exchange Notes offered hereby will be passed upon for the
Company by Winstead Sechrest & Minick P.C., Dallas, Texas.
 
                                       163
<PAGE>   164
 
                         INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               PAGE
                                                               ----
<S>                                                            <C>
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND
  SUBSIDIARIES
  Report of Independent Certified Public Accountants........    F-2
  Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1996 and
     1997 and June 30, 1998 (unaudited).....................    F-3
  Consolidated Statements of Earnings for the years ended
     December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 and the six month
     periods ended June 30, 1997 and 1998 (unaudited).......    F-4
  Consolidated Statement of Stockholder's Equity for the
     years ended December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 and the
     six month period ended June 30, 1998 (unaudited).......    F-5
  Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended
     December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 and the six month
     periods ended June 30, 1997 and 1998 (unaudited).......    F-6
  Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements................    F-8
 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND
  SUBSIDIARIES
  Report of Independent Auditors............................   F-25
  Consolidated Balance Sheets as of March 31, 1997 and 1998
     and June 30, 1998 (unaudited)..........................   F-26
  Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended
     March 31, 1996, 1997 and 1998 and the three month
     periods ended June 30, 1997 and 1998 (unaudited).......   F-28
  Consolidated Statement of Stockholder's Equity for the
     years ended March 31, 1996, 1997 and 1998 and the three
     month period ended June 30, 1998 (unaudited)...........   F-29
  Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended
     March 31, 1996, 1997 and 1998 and the three month
     periods ended June 30, 1997 and 1998 (unaudited).......   F-30
  Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements................   F-32
 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
  Report of Independent Public Accountants..................   F-44
  Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1996 and 1997 and March
     31, 1998 (unaudited)...................................   F-45
  Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31,
     1995, 1996 and 1997 and the three month periods ended
     March 31, 1997 and 1998 (unaudited)....................   F-46
  Statement of Stockholders' Equity for the years ended
     December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 and the three month
     period ended March 31, 1998 (unaudited)................   F-47
  Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31,
     1995, 1996 and 1997 and the three month periods ended
     March 31, 1997 and 1998 (unaudited)....................   F-48
  Notes to Financial Statements.............................   F-49
</TABLE>
 
                                       F-1
<PAGE>   165
 
               REPORT OF INDEPENDENT CERTIFIED PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
To the Board of Directors and Shareholders
Renters Choice, Inc.
 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Renters Choice,
Inc. and Subsidiary as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, and the related
consolidated statements of earnings, stockholders' equity, and cash flows for
each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997. These financial
statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on
our audits.
 
We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in
all material respects, the consolidated financial position of Renters Choice,
Inc. and Subsidiary as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, and the consolidated
results of their operations and their consolidated cash flows for each of the
three years in the period ended December 31, 1997, in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles.
 
GRANT THORNTON LLP
 
Dallas, Texas
February 12, 1998
 
                                       F-2
<PAGE>   166
 
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   DECEMBER 31,
                                                -------------------    JUNE 30,
                                                  1996       1997        1998
                                                --------   --------   -----------
                                                                      (UNAUDITED)
                                                    (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                                             <C>        <C>        <C>
ASSETS
Cash and cash equivalents.....................  $  5,920   $  4,744    $ 23,347
Rental merchandise, net
  On rent.....................................    71,620     89,007     116,659
  Held for rent...............................    23,490     23,752      31,773
Accounts receivable -- trade..................     3,021      2,839       1,799
Prepaid expenses and other assets.............     4,369      3,164       2,440
Property assets, net..........................    12,716     17,700      21,479
Deferred income taxes.........................     6,138      6,479       6,479
Intangible assets, net........................    47,193     61,183     131,862
                                                --------   --------    --------
                                                $174,467   $208,868    $335,838
                                                ========   ========    ========
LIABILITIES
  Revolving credit agreement..................  $ 14,435   $ 26,280    $127,500
  Accounts payable -- trade...................    17,047     11,935      14,193
  Accrued liabilities.........................    12,924     17,008      23,067
  Other debt..................................     4,558        892         735
                                                --------   --------    --------
                                                  48,964     56,115     165,495
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES.................        --         --          --
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
  Preferred stock, $.01 par value; 5,000,000
     shares authorized; none issued...........        --         --          --
  Common stock, $.01 par value; 50,000,000
     shares authorized; 24,904,721 and
     24,791,085 shares issued and outstanding
     in 1997 and 1996, respectively...........       248        249         250
  Additional paid-in capital..................    98,010     99,381     100,585
  Retained earnings...........................    27,245     53,123      69,508
                                                --------   --------    --------
                                                 125,503    152,753     170,343
                                                --------   --------    --------
                                                $174,467   $208,868    $335,838
                                                ========   ========    ========
</TABLE>
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                       F-3
<PAGE>   167
 
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF EARNINGS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                                  YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,            JUNE 30
                                               ------------------------------   -------------------
                                                 1995       1996       1997       1997       1998
                                               --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                                                                    (UNAUDITED)
                                                 (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                            <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Revenue
  Store
     Rentals and fees........................  $126,264   $198,486   $275,344   $130,150   $163,443
     Merchandise sales.......................     6,383     10,604     14,125      7,457     10,513
     Other...................................       642        687        679        339        281
  Franchise
     Merchandise sales.......................        --     25,229     37,385     15,461     17,061
     Royalty income and fees.................        --      2,959      4,008      1,982      2,248
                                               --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                                133,289    237,965    331,541    155,389    193,546
Operating expenses
  Direct store expenses
     Depreciation of rental merchandise......    29,640     42,978     57,223     27,510     33,839
     Cost of merchandise sold................     4,954      8,357     11,365      5,607      8,301
     Salaries and other expenses.............    70,012    116,577    162,458     77,144     95,287
  Franchise operating expense
     Cost of merchandise sales...............        --     24,010     35,841     14,726     16,386
                                               --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                                104,606    191,922    266,887    124,987    153,813
  General and administrative expenses........     5,766     10,111     13,304      6,773      7,194
  Amortization of intangibles................     3,109      4,891      5,412      2,649      3,271
                                               --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
          Total operating expenses...........   113,481    206,924    285,603    134,409    164,278
                                               --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
          Operating profit...................    19,808     31,041     45,938     20,980     29,268
Interest expense.............................     2,202        606      2,194      1,021      1,555
Interest income..............................      (890)      (667)      (304)      (432)      (238)
                                               --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
          Earnings before income taxes.......    18,496     31,102     44,048     20,391     27,951
Income tax expense...........................     7,784     13,076     18,170      8,622     11,566
                                               --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
          NET EARNINGS.......................  $ 10,712   $ 18,026   $ 25,878   $ 11,769   $ 16,385
                                               ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
Basic earnings per share.....................  $   0.52   $   0.73   $   1.04   $   0.47   $   0.66
                                               ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
Diluted earnings per share...................  $   0.52   $   0.72   $   1.03   $   0.47   $   0.65
                                               ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
</TABLE>
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                       F-4
<PAGE>   168
 
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                 CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     FOR THE THREE YEARS IN THE PERIOD ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997
                                                                 AND SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1998
                                               ----------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               RENTERS CHOICE, INC.                            UNAMORTIZED
                                                   COMMON STOCK        ADDITIONAL                 VALUE
                                               --------------------     PAID-IN     RETAINED    OF STOCK
                                                SHARES      AMOUNT      CAPITAL     EARNINGS      AWARD       TOTAL
                                               --------    --------    ----------   --------   -----------   --------
                                                                     (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                                            <C>         <C>         <C>          <C>        <C>           <C>
Balance at January 1, 1995...................  4,300..       $ 43       $    116    $ 9,126       $  --      $  9,285
  Net earnings...............................       --         --             --     10,712          --        10,712
  Dividends paid.............................       --         --             --     (1,493)         --        (1,493)
  Contribution of undistributed S corporation
    earnings.................................       --         --          9,126     (9,126)         --            --
  Initial public offering of common stock....    2,587         26         23,370         --          --        23,396
  Issuance of common stock under stock option
    plan.....................................        1         --             10         --          --            10
  Three-for-two common stock split effected
    in the form of a dividend................    3,444         34            (34)        --          --            --
  Two-for-one common stock split effected in
    the form of a dividend...................   10,333        103           (103)        --          --            --
  Stock award................................       63          1            960         --        (961)           --
  Amortization of stock award................       --         --             --         --          63            63
  Public offering of common stock............    3,650         37         54,474         --          --        54,511
                                                ------       ----       --------    -------       -----      --------
Balance at December 31, 1995.................   24,378        244         87,919      9,219        (898)       96,484
  Net earnings...............................       --         --             --     18,026          --        18,026
  Amortization of stock award................       --         --             --         --         322           322
  Termination of stock award.................      (37)        --           (576)        --         576            --
  Exercise of stock options..................      107          1            695         --          --           696
  Tax benefits related to exercise of stock
    options..................................       --         --            460         --          --           460
  Acquisition of ColorTyme, Inc..............      343          3          9,512         --          --         9,515
                                                ------       ----       --------    -------       -----      --------
Balance at December 31, 1996.................   24,791        248         98,010     27,245          --       125,503
  Net earnings...............................       --         --             --     25,878          --        25,878
  Exercise of stock options..................      114          1            950         --          --           951
  Tax benefits related to exercise of stock
    options..................................       --         --            421         --          --           421
                                                ------       ----       --------    -------       -----      --------
Balance at December 31, 1997.................   24,905        249         99,381     53,123          --       152,753
  Net earnings...............................       --         --             --     16,385          --        16,385
  Exercise of stock options..................      116          1          1,204         --          --         1,205
                                                ------       ----       --------    -------       -----      --------
Balance at June 30, 1998 (Unaudited).........   25,021       $250       $100,585    $69,508       $  --      $170,343
                                                ======       ====       ========    =======       =====      ========
</TABLE>
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                       F-5
<PAGE>   169
 
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                                 YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,            JUNE 30,
                                              ------------------------------   --------------------
                                                1995       1996       1997       1997       1998
                                              --------   --------   --------   --------   ---------
                                                                                   (UNAUDITED)
                                                            (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                                           <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Cash flows from operating activities
  Net earnings..............................  $ 10,712   $ 18,026   $ 25,878   $ 11,769   $  16,385
  Adjustments to reconcile net earnings to
    net cash provided by operating
    activities
    Depreciation of rental merchandise......    29,640     42,978     57,223     27,510      33,839
    Depreciation of property assets.........     2,130      3,680      5,601      2,509       3,276
    Amortization of intangibles.............     3,109      4,891      5,412      2,649       3,271
    Deferred income taxes...................     1,406      4,961       (341)        --          --
    Other...................................       (91)        24         --         (5)         --
  Changes in operating assets and
    liabilities, net of effects of
    acquisitions
    Rental merchandise......................   (39,220)   (64,927)   (64,346)   (35,682)    (43,549)
    Accounts receivable -- trade............        --       (602)       182      1,325       1,040
    Prepaid expenses and other assets.......    (2,636)       524      1,252        242         728
    Accounts payable -- trade...............       (28)    10,745     (5,112)    (5,056)      2,258
    Accrued liabilities.....................       183       (939)     3,033      5,737       6,059
                                              --------   --------   --------   --------   ---------
         Net cash provided by operating
           activities.......................     5,205     19,361     28,782     10,998      23,307
Cash flows from investing activities
  Purchase of property assets...............    (3,473)    (8,187)   (10,446)    (4,755)     (5,758)
  Proceeds from sale of property assets.....       414        303        376        129         408
  Acquisitions of businesses................   (21,680)   (28,367)   (30,491)   (26,349)   (101,616)
                                              --------   --------   --------   --------   ---------
         Net cash used in investing
           activities.......................   (24,739)   (36,251)   (40,561)   (30,975)   (106,966)
Cash flows from financing activities
  Proceeds from public stock offerings......    77,907         --         --         --          --
  Exercise of stock options.................        10        696        951        410       1,205
  Distributions to stockholders.............    (1,493)        --         --         --          --
  Proceeds from debt........................    33,083     37,733     80,656     48,132     162,222
  Repayments of debt........................   (49,843)   (72,278)   (71,004)   (28,039)    (61,165)
  Repayments of note payable to
    stockholder.............................    (6,250)        --         --         --          --
  Sale of notes receivable..................        --     21,338         --         --          --
                                              --------   --------   --------   --------   ---------
         Net cash provided by (used in)
           financing activities.............    53,414    (12,511)    10,603     20,503     102,262
                                              --------   --------   --------   --------   ---------
         NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND
           CASH EQUIVALENTS.................    33,880    (29,401)    (1,176)       526      18,603
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of
  year......................................     1,441     35,321      5,920      5,920       4,744
                                              --------   --------   --------   --------   ---------
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year....  $ 35,321   $  5,920   $  4,744   $  6,446   $  23,347
                                              ========   ========   ========   ========   =========
</TABLE>
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                       F-6
<PAGE>   170
 
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
               CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS -- CONTINUED
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                      YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,        JUNE 30,
                                      -------------------------   -----------------
                                       1995     1996     1997      1997      1998
                                      ------   ------   -------   -------   -------
                                                                     (UNAUDITED)
                                                (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                                   <C>      <C>      <C>       <C>       <C>
SUPPLEMENTAL CASH FLOW INFORMATION
Cash paid during the year for:
  Interest..........................  $1,711   $  929   $ 1,962   $1,021    $  955
  Income taxes......................  $7,764   $8,426   $13,983   $5,128    $9,470
</TABLE>
 
SUPPLEMENTAL SCHEDULE OF NON-CASH INVESTING ACTIVITIES
 
In conjunction with the businesses acquired, liabilities were assumed as
follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               SIX MONTHS ENDED
                               YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31,            JULY 30,
                            ------------------------------   --------------------
                              1995       1996       1997       1997       1998
                            --------   --------   --------   --------   ---------
                                                                 (UNAUDITED)
                                          (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
 
<S>                         <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Fair value of assets
  acquired................  $ 68,285   $ 57,223   $ 30,491   $ 26,349   $ 101,616
Stock and options
  issued..................        --     (9,515)        --         --          --
Cash paid.................   (21,680)   (28,367)   (30,491)   (26,349)   (101,616)
                            --------   --------   --------   --------   ---------
          Liabilities
             assumed......  $ 46,605   $ 19,341   $     --   $     --   $      --
                            ========   ========   ========   ========   =========
</TABLE>
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                       F-7
<PAGE>   171
 
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
NOTE A -- SUMMARY OF ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND NATURE OF OPERATIONS
 
A summary of the significant accounting policies consistently applied in the
preparation of the accompanying consolidated financial statements follows.
 
Principles of Consolidation and Nature of Operations
 
The accompanying financial statements include the accounts of Renters Choice,
Inc. (Renters Choice) and its franchise subsidiaries ColorTyme, Inc. (ColorTyme)
(collectively, the Company). All significant intercompany accounts and
transactions have been eliminated. Renters Choice leases household durable goods
to customers on a rent-to-own basis. At December 31, 1997, the Company operated
504 stores which were located throughout the United States and the Commonwealth
of Puerto Rico (sixteen stores).
 
ColorTyme is a nationwide franchisor of television, stereo and furniture rental
centers. ColorTyme's primary source of revenues is the sale of rental equipment
to its franchisees, who, in turn, offer the equipment to the general public for
rent or purchase under a rent-to-own program. The balance of ColorTyme's
revenues are generated primarily from royalties based on the franchisee's
monthly gross revenues. At December 31, 1997, there were approximately 262
franchised rental centers operating in 37 states.
 
Segment Disclosures
 
In June 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of
Financial Accounting Standard No. 131, "Disclosures about Segments of an
Enterprise and Related Information" (SFAS 131). SFAS 131 establishes standards
for the way that public business enterprises report information about operating
segments in annual financial statements and requires that those enterprises
report selected information about operating segments in interim financial
reports. It also establishes standards for related disclosures about products
and services, geographic areas, and major customers. The Company adopted SFAS
131 in 1998. The Company's only segments which require separate disclosure under
the reporting guidelines of SFAS 131 are its rent-to-own and franchise
operations.
 
Rental Merchandise
 
Rental merchandise is carried at the lower of cost or net realizable value.
Depreciation is provided using the income forecasting method which is intended
to match as closely as practicable the recognition of depreciation expense with
the consumption of the rental merchandise. The consumption of rental merchandise
occurs during periods of rental and directly coincides with the receipt of
rental revenue over the rental-purchase agreement period, generally 18 to 24
months. Under the income forecasting method, merchandise held for rent is not
depreciated, and merchandise on rent is depreciated in the proportion of rents
received to total rents provided in the rental contract, which is an activity
based method similar to the units of production method.
 
                                       F-8
<PAGE>   172
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE A -- SUMMARY OF ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND NATURE OF OPERATIONS -- (CONTINUED)
Cash Equivalents
 
For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash equivalents include all highly liquid
investments with an original maturity of three months or less.
 
Rental Revenue and Fees
 
Merchandise is rented to customers pursuant to rental-purchase agreements which
provide for weekly or monthly rental terms with nonrefundable rental payments.
Generally, the customer has the right to acquire title either through a purchase
option or through payment of all required rentals. Rental revenue and fees are
recognized over the rental term. No revenue is accrued because the customer can
cancel the rental contract at any time and the Company cannot enforce collection
for nonpayment of rents. A provision is made for estimated losses of rental
merchandise damaged or not returned by customers.
 
ColorTyme's revenue from the sale of rental equipment is recognized upon
shipment of the equipment to the franchisee.
 
Property Assets and Related Depreciation
 
Furniture, equipment and vehicles are stated at cost. Depreciation is provided
over the estimated useful lives of the respective assets (generally five years)
by the straight-line method. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the term
of the applicable leases by the straight-line method.
 
Intangible Assets and Amortization
 
Intangible assets are stated at cost less accumulated amortization calculated by
the straight-line method.
 
Accounting for Impairment of Long-Lived Assets
 
The Company evaluates long-lived assets used for impairment whenever events or
changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amounts may not be
recoverable. Impairment is recognized when the carrying amounts of such assets
cannot be recovered by the undiscounted net cash flows they will generate.
 
Income Taxes
 
Effective January 1, 1995, the Company terminated its S corporation status and
became a C corporation and, therefore, is subject to Federal income taxes. The
Company provides deferred taxes for temporary differences between the tax and
financial reporting bases of assets and liabilities at the rate expected to be
in effect when taxes become payable.
 
                                       F-9
<PAGE>   173
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE A -- SUMMARY OF ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND NATURE OF OPERATIONS -- (CONTINUED)
Earnings Per Share and Stock Splits
 
Effective for the fourth quarter of 1997, the Company adopted Statement of
Financial Accounting Standard No. 128, "Earnings Per Share" (SFAS 128), which
requires the computation of basic and diluted earnings per share. The provisions
of SFAS 128 have been applied retroactively to all periods presented herein.
Basic earnings per share are based upon the weighted average number of common
shares outstanding during each period presented. Diluted earnings per share are
based upon the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the
period, plus the assumed exercise of stock options at the beginning of the year.
 
In June 1995, the Company effected a 3-for-2 split of its common stock through
the distribution of one-half additional share of common stock as a dividend with
respect to each outstanding share of common stock.
 
On September 11, 1995, the Board of Directors approved a 2-for-1 stock split, to
be effected as a 100% stock dividend for shareholders of record as of September
29, 1995.
 
All share and per share data has been retroactively restated to reflect these
transactions.
 
Advertising Costs
 
Costs incurred for producing and communicating advertising are expensed when
incurred. Advertising expense was $6.4 million, $10.6 million and $13.7 million
in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively; and $6.7 million (unaudited) and $7.9
million (unaudited) for the six months ended June 30, 1997 and 1998,
respectively.
 
Stock-Based Compensation
 
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 (SFAS 123), "Accounting for
Stock-Based Compensation," encourages, but does not require companies to record
compensation cost for stock-based employee compensation plans at fair value. The
Company has chosen to account for stock-based compensation using the intrinsic
value method prescribed in Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25 (APB 25),
"Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees," and related Interpretations.
Accordingly, compensation cost for stock options is measured as the excess, if
any, of the quoted market price of the Company's stock at the date of the grant
over the amount an employee must pay to acquire that stock.
 
Use of Estimates
 
In preparing financial statements in conformity with generally accepted
accounting principles, management is required to make estimates and assumptions
that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of
contingent assets and
 
                                      F-10
<PAGE>   174
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE A -- SUMMARY OF ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND NATURE OF OPERATIONS -- (CONTINUED)
liabilities at the date of the financial statements and revenues during the
reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
Interim Financial Statements
 
In the opinion of management, the unaudited interim financial statements as of
June 30, 1998 and for the six months ended June 30, 1997 and 1998 include all
adjustments, consisting only of those of a normal recurring nature, necessary to
present fairly the Company's financial position as of June 30, 1998 and the
results of its operations and cash flows for the six months periods ended June
30, 1997 and 1998. The results of operations for the six months ended June 30,
1998 are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for the full
year.
 
Comprehensive Income
 
Effective January 1, 1998, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting
Standard No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive Income". This Statement establishes
standards for reporting and display of comprehensive income and its components.
The only component of comprehensive income for the three years in the period
ended December 31, 1997 and the six month periods ended June 30, 1997 and 1998,
was net earnings as reported in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings.
 
Reclassifications
 
Certain reclassifications have been made to conform to the 1997 presentation.
 
NOTE B -- ACQUISITIONS
 
On May 28, 1998, the Company completed its acquisition of the assets of 176
Central Rents, Inc. stores for approximately $100 million (Unaudited).
 
During 1997, the Company acquired the assets of 76 stores in eighteen separate
transactions for approximately $30.5 million in cash.
 
On May 15, 1996 the Company acquired all the outstanding common stock of
ColorTyme for $14.5 million, including acquisition costs, comprised of cash of
$4.7 million and 343,175 shares of the Company's common stock and 314,000
options for the Company's common stock valued at $3.0 million.
 
Immediately following the purchase of ColorTyme by the Company, ColorTyme sold
its loan portfolio (with certain recourse provisions) to a third party for
approximately $21.7 million. No gain or loss was recognized on the sale.
ColorTyme simultaneously paid off notes payable owed to a finance company of
approximately $13.2 million.
 
                                      F-11
<PAGE>   175
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE B -- ACQUISITIONS -- (CONTINUED)
The Company acquired the assets of an additional ninety-four stores in
twenty-three transactions during 1996, for approximately $25.6 million in cash
and $1.8 million in notes.
 
In April 1995, the Company acquired 72 stores from Crown Leasing Corporation and
certain of its affiliates (Crown) for a cash purchase price of approximately
$20.6 million.
 
In September 1995, the Company completed the acquisition of 135 rent-to-own
stores through the purchase of the common stock of Pro Rental, doing business as
Magic Rent-to-Own and Kelway Rent-to-Own. The total purchase price was
approximately $38.4 million, which was paid in cash and notes.
 
All acquisitions have been accounted for as purchases and the operating results
of the acquired stores have been included in the financial statements of the
Company since their acquisition.
 
The following unaudited pro forma information combines the results of operations
as if the acquisitions had been consummated as of the beginning of the period in
which the acquisition occurred, and as of the beginning of the immediately
preceding period, after including the impact of adjustments for amortization of
intangibles and interest expense on acquisition borrowings:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                     YEARS ENDED            SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                    DECEMBER 31,                JUNE 30,
                               -----------------------   -----------------------
                                  1996         1997         1997         1998
                               ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------
                               (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                            <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>
Revenue......................   $291,555     $339,809     $216,344     $234,493
Net earnings.................   $ 18,833     $ 25,866     $ 12,019     $ 14,772
Basic earnings per common
  share......................   $   0.76     $   1.04     $    .48     $    .59
Diluted earnings per common
  share......................   $   0.75     $   1.03     $    .48     $    .59
</TABLE>
 
The pro forma financial information is presented for informational purposes only
and is not necessarily indicative of operating results that would have occurred
had the acquisition been consummated as of the above dates, nor are they
necessarily indicative of future operating results.
 
Unaudited Acquisition Subsequent to June 30, 1998
 
On August 5, 1998, the Company acquired all of the outstanding common stock of
THORN Americas, Inc. (1404 company-owned stores) for approximately $900 million
in cash. The acquisition was financed via $720 million in variable rate senior
debt maturing in 6 to 8 1/2 years, $175 million of 11% senior subordinated debt
maturing in 11 years, and $235 million of redeemable, convertible preferred
stock.
 
                                      F-12
<PAGE>   176
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE C -- RENTAL MERCHANDISE
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           DECEMBER 31,
                                        -------------------    JUNE 30,
                                          1996       1997        1998
                                        --------   --------   -----------
                                                              (UNAUDITED)
                                            (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                                     <C>        <C>        <C>
On rent
  Cost................................  $109,663   $142,408    $177,334
  Less accumulated depreciation.......    38,043     53,401      60,675
                                        --------   --------    --------
                                        $ 71,620   $ 89,007    $116,659
                                        ========   ========    ========
Held for rent
  Cost................................  $ 27,805   $ 29,975    $ 38,742
  Less accumulated depreciation.......     4,315      6,223       6,969
                                        --------   --------    --------
                                        $ 23,490   $ 23,752    $ 31,773
                                        ========   ========    ========
</TABLE>
 
NOTE D -- PROPERTY ASSETS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            DECEMBER 31,
                                         ------------------    JUNE 30,
                                          1996       1997        1998
                                         -------   --------   -----------
                                                              (UNAUDITED)
                                            (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                                      <C>       <C>        <C>
Furniture and equipment................  $ 9,259   $ 13,115    $ 14,930
Delivery vehicles......................    2,711      2,608       2,413
Leasehold improvements.................    8,542     14,499      18,954
Construction in progress...............      236        547         443
                                         -------   --------    --------
                                          20,748     30,769      36,740
Accumulated depreciation...............   (8,032)   (13,069)    (15,261)
                                         -------   --------    --------
                                         $12,716   $ 17,700    $ 21,479
                                         =======   ========    ========
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-13
<PAGE>   177
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE E -- INTANGIBLE ASSETS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              DECEMBER 31,
                             AMORTIZATION   -----------------    JUNE 30,
                                PERIOD       1996      1997        1998
                             ------------   -------   -------   -----------
                                                                (UNAUDITED)
                                               (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                          <C>            <C>       <C>       <C>
Customer rental
  agreements...............  18 months      $ 2,537   $ 1,773    $  1,853
Noncompete agreements......  2-5 years        2,892     3,652       4,402
Consulting agreement.......  4 years          2,918        --          --
Franchise network..........  10 years         3,000     3,000       3,000
Goodwill...................  20 years        43,933    61,228     132,444
                                            -------   -------    --------
                                             55,280    69,653     141,699
Less accumulated
  amortization.............                   8,087     8,470       9,837
                                            -------   -------    --------
                                            $47,193   $61,183    $131,862
                                            =======   =======    ========
</TABLE>
 
Customer rental agreements represent the projected cash flows less servicing
costs from open customer contracts of acquired stores at acquisition date and
are amortized over the average stated term of the customer contract, 18 months.
Noncompete agreements and the consulting agreement are amortized over the life
of the respective agreements.
 
NOTE F -- REVOLVING CREDIT AGREEMENT
 
On November 27, 1996, the Company entered into a $90 million three-year
revolving credit agreement with a group of banks. Borrowings under the facility
bear interest at a rate equal to a designated prime rate (8.50% at December 31,
1997) or 1.10% to 1.65% over LIBOR (5.75% at December 31, 1997) at the Company's
option. Borrowings are collateralized by a lien on substantially all of the
Company's assets. A commitment fee equal to .30% to .50% of the unused portion
of the term loan facility is payable quarterly. The weighted average interest
rate under this facility was 6.7% and 7.0% for the years ended December 31, 1996
and 1997, respectively. The credit facility includes certain net worth and fixed
charge coverage requirements, as well as covenants which restrict additional
indebtedness and the disposition of assets not in the ordinary course of
business. At December 31, 1997, the Company has $64.5 million available under
the agreement.
 
                                      F-14
<PAGE>   178
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE G -- ACCRUED LIABILITIES
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            DECEMBER 31,
                                          -----------------    JUNE 30,
                                           1996      1997        1998
                                          -------   -------   -----------
                                                              (UNAUDITED)
                                             (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                                       <C>       <C>       <C>
Taxes other than income.................  $ 2,872   $ 3,700     $ 5,335
Income taxes payable....................       --     1,762       3,793
Accrued litigation costs................    4,114     4,038       3,347
Accrued insurance costs.................    1,859     3,033       3,586
Accrued compensation and other..........    4,079     4,475       7,006
                                          -------   -------     -------
                                          $12,924   $17,008     $23,067
                                          =======   =======     =======
</TABLE>
 
NOTE H -- OTHER DEBT
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                             DECEMBER 31,
                                             -------------    JUNE 30,
                                              1996    1997      1998
                                             ------   ----   -----------
                                                             (UNAUDITED)
                                              (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                                          <C>      <C>    <C>
Obligation payable under noncompete
  agreement, due in 24 monthly installments
  of $125 commencing April 1, 1996, with
  interest imputed at 5.32%................  $1,826   $ --      $ --
Obligation payable under consulting
  agreement, in 96 monthly installments of
  $33.3 commencing May 1, 1993, with
  interest imputed at 5.32%................   1,545     --        --
Obligations under noncompete agreements,
  due in 60 monthly installments of $32.5
  commencing September 1, 1995 with
  interest imputed at 8.75%................   1,187    892       735
                                             ------   ----      ----
                                             $4,558   $892      $735
                                             ======   ====      ====
</TABLE>
 
The following are scheduled maturities of debt at December 31, 1997
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
YEAR ENDING
DECEMBER 31,
- ------------
<S>          <C>                                                 <C>
    1998.......................................................  $289
    1999.......................................................   351
    2000.......................................................   252
                                                                 ----
                                                                 $892
                                                                 ====
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-15
<PAGE>   179
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE I -- INCOME TAXES
 
The components of the income tax provision are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                              --------------------------
                                               1995     1996      1997
                                              ------   -------   -------
                                              (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS)
<S>                                           <C>      <C>       <C>
Current
  Federal...................................  $3,837   $ 5,262   $15,028
  State.....................................   1,227     1,297     1,911
  Foreign...................................   1,314     1,556     1,572
                                              ------   -------   -------
          Total current.....................   6,378     8,115    18,511
                                              ------   -------   -------
Deferred
  Federal...................................   1,238     3,866      (351)
  State.....................................     168     1,095        10
                                              ------   -------   -------
          Total deferred....................   1,406     4,961      (341)
                                              ------   -------   -------
          Total.............................  $7,784   $13,076   $18,170
                                              ======   =======   =======
</TABLE>
 
The income tax provision reconciled to the tax computed at the statutory Federal
rate is:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          YEAR ENDED
                                                         DECEMBER 31,
                                                      ------------------
                                                      1995   1996   1997
                                                      ----   ----   ----
<S>                                                   <C>    <C>    <C>
Tax at statutory rate...............................  34.0%  34.0%  35.0%
State income taxes, net of federal benefit..........   4.9    5.1    4.6
Effect of foreign operations, net of foreign tax
  credits...........................................   1.0    0.5    0.4
Goodwill amortization...............................   0.7    1.8    1.1
Other, net..........................................   1.5    0.6    0.2
                                                      ----   ----   ----
          Total.....................................  42.1%  42.0%  41.3%
                                                      ====   ====   ====
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-16
<PAGE>   180
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
[CAPTION]
<TABLE>
<S>                                                   <C>    <C>    <C>
NOTE I -- INCOME TAXES -- (CONTINUED)
                                                       DECEMBER
                                                          31,
                                                      -----------
                                                      1996   1997
                                                      ----   ----
<S>                                                   <C>    <C>    <C>
Deferred tax assets
  Net operating loss carryforwards
     Federal........................................  $4,595 $4,202
     State..........................................  3,103  2,614
  Accrued expenses..................................  1,957  4,267
  Intangible assets.................................   835   1,079
  Property assets...................................   166    783
  Alternative minimum tax carryforward..............   463    463
  Other.............................................   676    124
                                                      ----   ----
                                                      11,795 13,532
  Less valuation allowance..........................  3,418  2,930
                                                      ----   ----
                                                      8,377  10,602
  Deferred tax liability
  Rental merchandise................................  2,239  4,123
                                                      ----   ----
          Net deferred tax asset....................  $6,138 $6,479
                                                      ====   ====
</TABLE>
 
The Company has Federal net operating loss carryforwards of approximately $10.8
million at December 31, 1997 which were acquired in connection with purchased
companies. The use of Federal carryforwards which expire between 2005 and 2010
are limited to approximately $3.5 million per year. Because of uncertainties
with respect to allocation of future taxable income to the various states, a
valuation allowance has been provided against these carryforwards. If utilized,
the tax benefit will reduce goodwill.
 
                                      F-17
<PAGE>   181
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE J -- COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
The Company leases its office and store facilities and certain delivery
vehicles. Rental expense was $9.4 million, $15.7 million and $22.0 million for
1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively; and $10.4 million (unaudited) and $13.5
million (unaudited) for the six months ended June 30, 1997 and 1998,
respectively. Future minimum rental payments under operating leases with
remaining noncancellable lease terms in excess of one year at December 31, 1997
are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
YEAR ENDING
DECEMBER 31,                                                  (IN THOUSANDS
- ------------                                                   OF DOLLARS)
<S>          <C>                                              <C>
1998.....................................................        $15,026
1999.....................................................         12,592
2000.....................................................          9,699
2001.....................................................          6,797
2002.....................................................          2,833
Thereafter...............................................          1,235
                                                                 -------
                                                                 $48,182
                                                                 =======
</TABLE>
 
The Company has agreed to indemnify its original stockholders against any
additional income tax liabilities incurred by them attributable to the Company's
operations during taxable periods in which the Company was an S Corporation.
 
The Company is one of the defendants in a class action lawsuit which alleges
that certain rent-to-own contracts entered into between Crown and the plaintiffs
included fees and expenses that violated the New Jersey Consumer Fraud Act and
the New Jersey Retail Installment Sales Act. The plaintiffs have obtained
summary judgment against Crown, reserving damages for trial. Crown and its
controlling shareholders have agreed to indemnify the Company against any losses
it may incur relating to the litigation under the terms of the Asset Purchase
Agreement between Crown and the Company. Although the Company believes it has
taken appropriate steps to defend itself, the ultimate outcome of this lawsuit
cannot presently be determined.
 
At December 31, 1997, the Company was a defendant in another class action
lawsuit in New Jersey alleging violations of the New Jersey Consumer Fraud Act,
Retail Installment Sales Act and usury laws, among other things. The litigation
sought treble the amount of damages, if any, incurred by the plaintiff class,
punitive damages, interest, attorneys fees and certain injunctive relief. The
Company removed the case to federal court on January 21, 1998, and was then
advised by the plaintiffs' attorney that the plaintiff no longer wished to serve
as class representative. Papers were filed seeking in January 1998 seeking court
approval for the withdrawal of the complaint. Management believes that it is
probable that plaintiffs' attorney will file a similar complaint on behalf of a
new class representative. The ultimate outcome of this lawsuit cannot presently
be determined.
 
                                      F-18
<PAGE>   182
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE J -- COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES -- (CONTINUED)
The Company is also involved in various other legal proceedings, claims and
litigation arising in the ordinary course of business. Although occasional
adverse decisions or settlements may occur, the Company believes that the final
disposition of such matters will not have a material adverse effect on the
financial position or results of operations of the Company.
 
NOTE K -- STOCK BASED COMPENSATION
 
In November 1994, the Company established a long-term incentive plan (the Plan)
for the benefit of certain key employees and directors. Under the plan, up to
2,000,000 shares of the Company's shares are reserved for issuance under stock
options, stock appreciation rights or restricted stock grants. Options granted
to employees under the plan become exercisable over a period of one to five
years from the date of grant and may be exercised up to a maximum of 10 years
from date of grant. Options granted to directors are exercisable immediately. In
1995, the Company granted a stock award to an employee for 62,500 shares of
common stock subject to forfeiture on termination of employment in certain
circumstances. At the date of grant, the fair value of such shares was $960,938.
Compensation charged to earnings was $63,000 and $320,000 in 1995 and 1996,
respectively. Upon termination of employment in 1996, 37,500 shares were
forfeitured in a negotiated settlement with the Company. There have been no
grants of stock appreciation rights and all options had been granted with fixed
prices. At December 31, 1997, there were 443,125 shares reserved for issuance
under the Plan.
 
The Company has adopted only the disclosure provisions of SFAS 123 for employee
stock options and continues to apply APB 25 for stock options granted under the
Plan. Accordingly, compensation cost for stock options is measured as the
excess, if any, of the quoted market price of the Company's stock at the date of
grant over the amount an employee must pay to acquire the stock. Compensation
costs for all other stock-based compensation is accounted for under SFAS 123. If
the Company had elected to recognize compensation expense based upon the fair
value at the grant date for options under the Plan consistent with the
methodology prescribed by SFAS 123, the Company's 1997, 1996
 
                                      F-19
<PAGE>   183
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE K -- STOCK BASED COMPENSATION -- (CONTINUED)
and 1995 net earnings and earnings per share would be reduced to the pro forma
amounts indicated as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  1995      1996      1997
                                                 -------   -------   -------
                                                  (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS,
                                                   EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                              <C>       <C>       <C>
Net earnings
  As reported..................................  $10,712   $18,026   $25,878
  Pro forma....................................  $10,494   $16,469   $23,967
Basic earnings per common share
  As reported..................................  $  0.52   $  0.73   $  1.04
  Pro forma....................................  $  0.51   $  0.67   $  0.96
Diluted earnings per common share
  As reported..................................  $  0.52   $  0.72   $  1.03
  Pro forma....................................  $  0.51   $  0.66   $  0.95
</TABLE>
 
The fair value of these options was estimated at the date of grant using the
Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted-average
assumptions: expected volatility of 50 percent; risk-free interest rates ranging
from 5.75 to 6.92 percent; no dividend yield; and expected lives of seven years.
 
                                      F-20
<PAGE>   184
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE K -- STOCK BASED COMPENSATION -- (CONTINUED)
Additional information with respect to options outstanding under the Plan at
December 31, 1997, and changes for each of the three years in the period then
ended was as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                  1995                   1996                   1997
                          --------------------   --------------------   --------------------
                                      WEIGHTED               WEIGHTED               WEIGHTED
                                      AVERAGE                AVERAGE                AVERAGE
                                      EXERCISE               EXERCISE               EXERCISE
                           SHARES      PRICE      SHARES      PRICE      SHARES      PRICE
                          ---------   --------   ---------   --------   ---------   --------
<S>                       <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>
Outstanding at beginning
  of year...............         --    $  --       906,000    $ 7.10    1,142,050    $15.74
Granted.................  1,204,500     8.75       695,000     22.22      859,000     16.54
Exercised...............     (3,000)    3.34      (109,700)     7.45     (113,925)     8.39
Forfeited...............   (295,500)    8.00      (349,250)    13.81     (562,875)    17.13
                          ---------              ---------              ---------
Outstanding at end of
  year..................    906,000    $9.02     1,142,050    $15.74    1,324,250    $16.39
                          =========              =========              =========
Options exercisable at
  end of year...........     24,000    $3.34       127,800    $ 9.64      282,375    $14.53
Weighted average fair
  value per share of
  options granted during
  1995, 1996 and 1997,
  all of which were
  granted at market.....               $5.25                  $13.35                 $ 9.93
</TABLE>
 
Information about stock options outstanding at December 31, 1997 is summarized
as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     OPTIONS OUTSTANDING
                                      -------------------------------------------------
                                                    WEIGHTED AVERAGE
                                        NUMBER         REMAINING       WEIGHTED AVERAGE
     RANGE OF EXERCISE PRICES         OUTSTANDING   CONTRACTUAL LIFE    EXERCISE PRICE
     ------------------------         -----------   ----------------   ----------------
<S>                                   <C>           <C>                <C>
$3.34 to $6.67.....................      293,625       7.35 years           $ 6.47
$6.68 to $18.50....................      523,125       8.76 years           $14.70
$18.51 to $26.75...................      507,500       9.05 years           $23.88
                                       ---------
                                       1,324,250
                                       =========
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-21
<PAGE>   185
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE K -- STOCK BASED COMPENSATION -- (CONTINUED)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           OPTIONS EXERCISABLE
                                                      ------------------------------
                                                        NUMBER      WEIGHTED AVERAGE
             RANGE OF EXERCISE PRICES                 EXERCISABLE    EXERCISE PRICE
             ------------------------                 -----------   ----------------
<S>                                                   <C>           <C>
$3.34 to $6.67.....................................      94,125          $ 6.03
$6.68 to $18.50....................................     126,000          $14.83
$18.51 to $26.75...................................      62,250          $26.75
                                                        -------
                                                        282,375
                                                        =======
</TABLE>
 
NOTE L -- FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
 
The Company's financial instruments include cash and cash equivalents and debt.
For variable rate debt that reprices frequently and entails no significant
change in credit risk, fair values are based on the carrying values. The fair
values of other debt is estimated based on discounted cash flow analysis using
interest rates currently offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers of
similar credit quality. The carrying amount of cash and cash equivalents and
debt approximates fair value at December 31, 1996 and 1997, and June 30, 1998
(unaudited).
 
NOTE M -- EARNINGS PER SHARE
 
Summarized basic and diluted earnings per common share were calculated as
follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                             YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                             -----------------------------
                                               NET               PER SHARE
                                             EARNINGS   SHARES    AMOUNT
                                             --------   ------   ---------
                                                 (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT
                                                    PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                          <C>        <C>      <C>
Basic earnings per common share............  $10,712    20,583     $0.52
Effect of dilutive stock options...........       --       211
                                             -------    ------
Diluted earnings per common share..........  $10,712    20,794     $0.52
                                             =======    ======
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                             YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996
                                             -----------------------------
                                               NET               PER SHARE
                                             EARNINGS   SHARES    AMOUNT
                                             --------   ------   ---------
<S>                                          <C>        <C>      <C>
Basic earnings per common share............  $18,026    24,656     $0.73
Effect of dilutive stock options...........       --       409
                                             -------    ------
Diluted earnings per common share..........  $18,026    25,065     $0.72
                                             =======    ======
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-22
<PAGE>   186
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE M -- EARNINGS PER SHARE -- (CONTINUED)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                             YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997
                                             -----------------------------
                                               NET               PER SHARE
                                             EARNINGS   SHARES    AMOUNT
                                             --------   ------   ---------
<S>                                          <C>        <C>      <C>
Basic earnings per common share............  $25,878    24,844     $1.04
Effect of dilutive stock options...........       --       350
                                             -------    ------
Diluted earnings per common share..........  $25,878    25,194     $1.03
                                             =======    ======
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1997
                                             --------------------------------
                                                NET                PER SHARE
                                             EARNINGS    SHARES      AMOUNT
                                             ---------   -------   ----------
<S>                                          <C>         <C>       <C>
Basic earnings per common share............   $11,769    24,805      $0.47
Effect of dilutive stock options...........        --       287
                                              -------    ------
Diluted earnings per common share..........   $11,769    25,092      $0.47
                                              =======    ======
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 1998
                                             --------------------------------
                                                NET                PER SHARE
                                             EARNINGS    SHARES      AMOUNT
                                             ---------   -------   ----------
<S>                                          <C>         <C>       <C>
Basic earnings per common share............   $16,385    24,954      $0.66
Effect of dilutive stock options...........        --       248
                                              -------    ------
Diluted earnings per common share..........   $16,385    25,202      $0.65
                                              =======    ======
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-23
<PAGE>   187
                     RENTERS CHOICE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE N -- UNAUDITED QUARTERLY DATA
 
Summarized quarterly financial data for 1997 and 1996 is as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                     1ST QUARTER   2ND QUARTER   3RD QUARTER   4TH QUARTER
                                     -----------   -----------   -----------   -----------
                                       (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                  <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
Year ended December 31, 1996
  Revenue..........................    $49,002       $57,756       $60,025       $71,182
  Operating profit.................      6,344         7,558         7,957         9,183
  Net earnings.....................      3,617         4,369         4,729         5,311
  Basic earnings per share.........       0.15          0.18          0.19          0.21
  Diluted earnings per share.......    $  0.15       $  0.17       $  0.19       $  0.21
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                     1ST QUARTER   2ND QUARTER   3RD QUARTER   4TH QUARTER
                                     -----------   -----------   -----------   -----------
                                       (IN THOUSANDS OF DOLLARS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                  <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
Year ended December 31, 1997
  Revenue..........................    $74,587       $80,803       $83,864       $92,288
  Operating profit.................      9,639        11,341        11,766        13,192
  Net earnings.....................      5,412         6,357         6,724         7,385
  Basic earnings per share.........       0.22          0.25          0.27          0.30
  Diluted earnings per share.......    $  0.22       $  0.25       $  0.27       $  0.29
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-24
<PAGE>   188
 
                         REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS
 
The Board of Directors
THORN Americas, Inc.
 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of THORN Americas,
Inc. and subsidiaries as of March 31, 1997 and 1998, and the related
consolidated statements of operations, stockholder's equity and cash flows for
each of the three years in the period ended March 31, 1998. These consolidated
financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial
statements based on our audits.
 
We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are
free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis,
evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial
statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and
significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall
consolidated financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits
provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present
fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of THORN
Americas, Inc. and subsidiaries at March 31, 1997 and 1998, and the consolidated
results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in
the period ended March 31, 1998, in conformity with generally accepted
accounting principles.
 
                                                ERNST & YOUNG LLP
 
April 24, 1998
except for Note 14, as to which
the date is June 25, 1998
Wichita, Kansas
 
                                      F-25
<PAGE>   189
 
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    MARCH 31
                                             -----------------------     JUNE 30
                                                1997         1998         1998
                                             ----------   ----------   -----------
                                                                       (UNAUDITED)
                                                    (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS,
                                                     EXCEPT SHARE AMOUNTS)
<S>                                          <C>          <C>          <C>
Cash.......................................  $   26,077   $   23,755   $   27,486
Accounts receivable -- other...............      10,339       26,937       22,322
Accounts receivable -- affiliated
  companies, net...........................      62,101       15,024          702
Prepaid expenses...........................       9,169        8,114        8,555
Deferred income taxes......................      21,209       21,113       21,113
Merchandise and auto inventory.............      38,231       39,443       43,068
Rental merchandise, at cost................     509,183      521,482      539,539
Less accumulated depreciation..............     233,171      228,517      235,857
                                             ----------   ----------   ----------
          Net rental merchandise...........     276,012      292,965      303,682
Property and equipment, at cost
  Land and building........................      19,810       22,855       22,971
  Furniture and equipment..................      84,083       95,594       98,189
  Transportation and equipment.............      86,140       87,494       87,851
  Leasehold improvements...................      59,206       63,593       73,616
                                             ----------   ----------   ----------
                                                249,239      269,536      282,627
  Less accumulated depreciation and
     amortization..........................     130,736      146,016      152,475
                                             ----------   ----------   ----------
          Net property and equipment.......     118,503      123,520      130,152
  Goodwill, less accumulated
     amortization..........................     499,471      479,636      479,517
Other assets, less accumulated
  amortization.............................      47,168       48,602       49,199
                                             $1,108,280   $1,079,109   $1,085,796
                                             ==========   ==========   ==========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying notes.
 
                                      F-26
<PAGE>   190
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    MARCH 31
                                             -----------------------     JUNE 30
                                                1997         1998         1998
                                             ----------   ----------   -----------
                                                                       (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                          <C>          <C>          <C>
Liabilities and Stockholder's Equity
Accounts payable...........................  $   62,222   $   31,717   $    1,334
Accrued expenses:
  Salaries, wages and fringe benefits......      31,523       32,492       31,305
  Other....................................      18,948        9,047        9,495
Other liabilities..........................      40,776       52,986       47,383
Accrued incentives.........................       1,550        2,161        1,853
Long term loans from affiliates............     714,235      714,223      714,663
                                             ----------   ----------   ----------
          Total liabilities................     869,254      842,626      846,033
                                             ----------   ----------   ----------
Stockholder's equity:
  Common stock of $1 par value; 1,000
     shares authorized, issued and
     outstanding...........................           1            1            1
  Additional paid-in capital...............     334,681      334,681      334,681
  Retained deficit.........................     (95,656)     (98,199)     (94,919)
                                             ----------   ----------   ----------
          Total stockholder's equity.......     239,026      236,483      239,763
                                             ----------   ----------   ----------
                                             $1,108,280   $1,079,109   $1,085,796
                                             ==========   ==========   ==========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying notes.
 
                                      F-27
<PAGE>   191
 
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 THREE MONTHS
                                  YEARS ENDED MARCH 31           ENDED JUNE 30
                             ------------------------------   -------------------
                               1996       1997       1998       1997       1998
                             --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                                                                  (UNAUDITED)
                                            (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                          <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Revenues:
  Rental revenues and
     fees..................  $819,452   $850,773   $819,949   $208,444   $214,514
  Sale of merchandise and
     autos.................    64,628     60,249     62,712     12,611     15,141
  Franchise income.........     5,364      2,366      2,266        582        560
  Other income.............     8,483     13,483     19,077      4,004      5,206
                             --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
          Total revenues...   897,927    926,871    904,004    225,641    235,421
                             --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
Costs and operating
  expenses:
  Cost of sales............    43,345     39,793     45,574      8,524     12,503
  Depreciation and
     amortization:
     Rental merchandise....   257,383    260,433    244,572     62,852     62,886
     Goodwill..............    19,097     23,164     24,044      6,014      5,884
     Other.................    33,139     35,921     32,825      8,584      8,648
  Salaries, wages and
     fringe benefits.......   255,768    272,242    279,796     68,488     72,960
  Advertising..............    33,895     30,284     30,320      8,059      8,188
  Property costs...........    52,393     59,244     61,643     15,054     14,886
  Other operating
     expenses..............   116,289    143,487    117,597     27,541     29,579
  Restructuring charges....    12,600         --     12,292         --         --
                             --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
          Total costs and
             operating
             expenses......   823,909    864,568    848,663    205,116    215,534
                             --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
          Operating
             income........    74,018     62,303     55,341     20,525     19,887
                             --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
Other (income) expense:
  Interest:
     Related parties,
       net.................    79,692     53,078     45,961     10,888     11,271
     Other interest, net...       515       (427)       223        (63)       (80)
  Other....................       101       (254)       (88)       (81)        72
                             --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
                               80,308     52,397     46,096     10,744     11,263
                             --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
          Income (loss)
             before income
             taxes.........    (6,290)     9,906      9,245      9,781      8,624
  Income taxes.............     6,771     13,880      7,760      5,950      5,344
                             --------   --------   --------   --------   --------
          Net income
             (loss)........  $(13,061)  $ (3,974)  $  1,485   $  3,831   $  3,280
                             ========   ========   ========   ========   ========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying notes.
 
                                      F-28
<PAGE>   192
 
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY
               FOR THE YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                               TOTAL
                                           ADDITIONAL PAID-IN   RETAINED   STOCKHOLDER'S
                            COMMON STOCK        CAPITAL         DEFICIT       EQUITY
                            ------------   ------------------   --------   -------------
                                               (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                         <C>            <C>                  <C>        <C>
Balance at March 31, 1995
  As previously
     reported.............       $1             $180,210        $(75,636)    $104,575
  Adjustment for
     reorganization/
     demerger.............       --                   --          (2,985)      (2,985)
                                 --             --------        --------     --------
  Adjusted balance........        1              180,210         (78,621)     101,590
  Net loss................       --                   --         (13,061)     (13,061)
                                 --             --------        --------     --------
Balance at March 31,
  1996....................        1              180,210         (91,682)      88,529
  Net loss................       --                   --          (3,974)      (3,974)
  Capital contributed by
     Parent...............       --              154,471              --      154,471
                                 --             --------        --------     --------
Balance at March 31,
  1997....................        1              334,681         (95,656)     239,026
  Net income..............       --                   --           1,485        1,485
  Advance to
     unconsolidated New
     Zealand division.....       --                   --          (4,028)      (4,028)
                                 --             --------        --------     --------
Balance at March 31,
  1998....................        1              334,681         (98,199)     236,483
  Net income
     (unaudited)..........       --                   --           3,280        3,280
                                 --             --------        --------     --------
Balance at June 30, 1998
  (unaudited).............       $1             $334,681        $(94,919)    $239,763
                                 ==             ========        ========     ========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
                                      F-29
<PAGE>   193
 
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   THREE MONTHS
                                                  YEARS ENDED MARCH 31             ENDED JUNE 30
                                            ---------------------------------   -------------------
                                              1996        1997        1998        1997       1998
                                            ---------   ---------   ---------   --------   --------
                                                                                    (UNAUDITED)
                                                            (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>        <C>
Cash flows from operating activities:
  Net income (loss).......................  $ (13,061)  $  (3,974)  $   1,485   $  3,831   $  3,280
  Adjustments to reconcile net income
    (loss) to net cash provided by
    operating activities:
    Rental merchandise losses.............      9,463      11,152      10,126      1,054      2,656
    Depreciation and amortization.........    309,619     319,518     301,441     77,450     77,418
    Interest added to principal balance,
      loan from affiliates................     88,891      34,468          --         --         --
    Deferred income taxes.................     (5,341)    (10,277)         96         --         --
    Restructuring charges.................      7,814          --       6,851         --         --
    Changes in operating assets and
      liabilities net of effects from
      business combinations:
      Accounts receivable -- other........       (407)     (3,930)    (16,598)     8,297      4,615
      Accounts receivable -- affiliated
        companies.........................     21,826         480        (480)        --         --
      Prepaid expenses....................     (3,697)      1,604       1,055        316       (441)
      Merchandise and auto inventory......     (6,622)     (9,443)     (1,212)     7,682     (3,625)
      Accounts payable....................     12,748      11,112     (30,505)   (22,860)     9,617
      Accrued expenses, other liabilities
        and accrued incentives............      4,968      32,954      (3,100)    (3,059)    (6,650)
                                            ---------   ---------   ---------   --------   --------
        Net cash provided by operating
          activities......................    426,201     383,664     269,159     72,711     86,870
Cash flows from investing activities:
  Proceeds from sale of rental
    merchandise...........................     43,858      50,998      39,474      9,441      8,040
  Net funds received from affiliated
    company...............................     17,427     141,672      47,557        914     14,322
  Advance to unconsolidated New Zealand
    division..............................         --          --      (4,028)        --         --
  Acquisition of rental merchandise.......   (299,704)   (289,483)   (306,792)   (64,506)   (83,320)
  Acquisition of property and equipment...    (44,642)    (32,306)    (38,077)    (5,630)   (15,454)
  Acquisition of rental companies, net of
    cash acquired.........................   (124,577)    (21,073)     (7,626)    (1,448)    (4,040)
  Decrease in undistributed IRB funds.....      2,250          --          --         --         --
Purchase of Minority Interest.............         --          --          --         --     (3,000)
  Other...................................    (10,330)    (10,658)     (1,977)      (752)      (127)
                                            ---------   ---------   ---------   --------   --------
        Net cash used by investing
          activities......................  $(415,718)  $(160,850)  $(271,469)  $(61,981)  $(83,579)
</TABLE>
 
Continued on following page.
 
                                      F-30
<PAGE>   194
 
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS, CONTINUED
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                      THREE MONTHS
                                        YEARS ENDED MARCH 31,        ENDED JUNE 30,
                                    -----------------------------   -----------------
                                     1996       1997       1998      1997      1998
                                    -------   ---------   -------   -------   -------
                                                                       (UNAUDITED)
                                                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                 <C>       <C>         <C>       <C>       <C>
Cash flows from financing
  activities:
  Advances from parent............  $    --   $      --   $    --   $   592   $   440
  Repayment of bond obligations...   (1,740)     (7,322)       --        --        --
  Repayments of loan from
     parent.......................       --    (208,640)      (12)       --        --
                                    -------   ---------   -------   -------   -------
          Net cash used by
            financing
            activities............   (1,740)   (215,962)      (12)      592       440
                                    -------   ---------   -------   -------   -------
Net increase (decrease) in cash...    8,743       6,852    (2,322)   11,322     3,731
Cash at beginning of year.........   10,482      19,225    26,077    26,077    23,755
                                    -------   ---------   -------   -------   -------
Cash at end of year...............  $19,225   $  26,077   $23,755   $37,399   $27,486
                                    =======   =========   =======   =======   =======
 
Supplemental disclosure of cash
  flow information
 
Cash paid during the year for:
  Interest........................  $ 4,862   $  30,431   $48,709   $11,476   $11,502
  Income taxes....................    4,295      17,102    23,991     9,265       252
</TABLE>
 
Supplemental schedule of noncash financing activities
 
During fiscal 1997, as part of the demerger transaction, the Company received a
capital contribution of $154,471 related to a reduction of affiliated
indebtedness.
 
Disclosure of accounting policies
 
For purposes of the statement of cash flows, the Company considers cash and cash
equivalents to include currency on hand, demand deposits and short-term
investments with a maturity of three months or less with banks or other
financial institutions.
 
                                      F-31
<PAGE>   195
 
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
                         MARCH 31, 1996, 1997 AND 1998
        (INFORMATION AS OF JUNE 30, 1998 AND FOR THE THREE-MONTH PERIODS
                   ENDED JUNE 30, 1997 AND 1998 IS UNAUDITED)
 
1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
Organization and Principles of Consolidated Financial Statements
 
Prior to April 1996, THORN Americas, Inc. (TA) was a wholly-owned subsidiary of
THORN EMI North America Holdings, Inc. (TEMINAH) and TEMINAH was an indirectly
wholly-owned subsidiary of THORN EMI plc., a United Kingdom limited liability
company. Effective August 19, 1996, the demerger and reorganization of the THORN
EMI group was completed and the rental, rental-purchase and related businesses
of THORN EMI group were transferred to THORN plc. (THORN), a newly formed United
Kingdom limited liability company. As a result of this demerger and
reorganization, TA became a wholly owned subsidiary of THORN International BV,
(hereinafter referred to as the "Parent"). The Parent is an indirectly
wholly-owned subsidiary of THORN. The consolidated financial statements include
the accounts of THORN Americas, Inc. and its wholly-owned subsidiaries, except
for the net assets and operations of its New Zealand division, which had net
assets at March 31, 1997 and 1998 of $7,608 and $10,242, respectively,
hereinafter referred to collectively as the Company. All significant
intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.
 
THORN Americas, Inc., dba Rent-A-Center, Remco America, Inc. (Remco), U-Can
Rent, and THORN Services International (TSI) operate approximately 1,400
rent-to-own stores throughout the United States. Rent-A-Center, Remco and U-Can
Rent principally rent consumer electronics, appliances and furniture on a short
or long term basis. Ownership of the merchandise may be transferred to the
consumer when rented on a long term basis, usually 6 to 30 months. TSI services
the rental merchandise and provides warehouse and merchandise distribution
services to the Rent-A-Center, Remco and U-Can Rent stores.
 
During fiscal 1998, the Company began testing a used auto sales business, under
the tradename AdvantEDGE Quality Cars. This proposition offers a retail
transaction on the sale of used autos with installment financing available
through the Company.
 
Certain reclassifications have been made in the 1996 and 1997 consolidated
financial statements to conform with the 1998 format.
 
Use of Estimates
 
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted
accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that
affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes.
Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
                                      F-32
<PAGE>   196
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
Merchandise and Auto Inventory
 
Merchandise inventory consists primarily of rental merchandise which is
temporarily stored in distribution centers awaiting assignment to a store.
Rental merchandise inventory is stated at average cost. In fiscal 1998,
merchandise and auto inventory also includes inventory associated with the
Company's auto business. Auto inventory is stated at actual cost.
 
Rental Merchandise, Related Rental Revenues and Depreciation
 
Rental merchandise is rented to customers pursuant to rental agreements which
generally provide for either weekly or monthly rental terms, with rental
payments collected in advance. The rental agreements may be terminated at any
time by the customers, and if terminated, the rental merchandise is returned to
the Company. Rental revenue is recognized as collected.
 
Merchandise rented to customers or available for rent is classified in the
consolidated balance sheets as rental merchandise and is being depreciated on a
straight-line basis over various periods ranging from 6 to 30 months (a majority
of rental merchandise is depreciated over 18 to 24 month periods).
 
Depreciation and Amortization
 
Depreciation of furniture and equipment, transportation equipment and buildings
is computed on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives of the
assets. Leasehold improvements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the
term of the related leases.
 
Goodwill
 
Goodwill represents the excess of cost over the fair value of the net assets of
businesses acquired and is amortized on the straight-line method over periods
ranging from 2 to 40 years. Accumulated amortization of goodwill was $149,210
and $173,254 at March 31, 1997 and 1998, respectively.
 
Other Assets
 
Other assets consist of territory rights, covenants not to compete, deferred
software costs, and other tangible and intangible amounts. Other assets, which
are amortizable, are amortized using the straight-line method over periods
ranging from 3 to 25 years. Accumulated amortization of these assets was $14,797
and $17,091 at March 31, 1997 and 1998, respectively.
 
                                      F-33
<PAGE>   197
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
Sale of Merchandise and Autos
 
Sale of merchandise and autos consists primarily of sales of used rental
merchandise, including proceeds from early payoffs of rental purchase contracts,
and automobile sales in connection with the Company's auto business which opened
in fiscal 1998.
 
Accounting for Impairment of Long-Lived Assets
 
The Company evaluates long-lived assets for impairment whenever events or
changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amounts may not be
recoverable. Impairment is recognized when the carrying amounts of such assets
cannot be recovered by the undiscounted future net cash flows likely to be
generated.
 
Advertising Costs
 
Costs incurred for communicating and producing advertising are expensed the
first time the advertising occurs. During fiscal 1996, 1997 and 1998,
advertising expense was $33,895, $30,284 and $30,320, respectively.
 
Stock-based Compensation
 
The Company participates in stock option and share rights plans sponsored by
THORN that provide for the granting of stock options (Thorn Share Option Plan)
to exempt level employees and share rights (Share Appreciation Rights Plan) to
certain key executives of the Company. The stock options and share rights, which
are associated with THORN stock, are typically issued annually and vest over a
three year period, subject to certain performance criteria. Statement of
Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 (SFAS 123), "Accounting for Stock-based
Compensation," encourages, but does not require companies to record compensation
cost for stock-based employee compensation plans at fair value. The Company
applies APB Opinion 25 "Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees" in accounting
for stock options.
 
Concentration of Credit Risk
 
The Company's financial instruments that were exposed to concentrations of
credit risk consist primarily of cash. The Company places its funds into high
credit quality financial institutions and, at times, such funds may be in excess
of the Federal Depository insurance limit.
 
Unaudited Interim Financial Data
 
The interim financial data at June 30, 1998, and for the three-month periods
ended June 30, 1997 and 1998, included herein, are unaudited and, in the opinion
of management, reflect all adjustments (consisting of only normal recurring
adjustments)
 
                                      F-34
<PAGE>   198
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
necessary for a fair presentation of financial position and the results of
operations and cash flows for such interim periods.
 
2. ACQUISITIONS AND MERGERS
 
The Company maintains an ongoing program to acquire selected rental operations.
During fiscal 1998, the Company acquired in purchase transactions eight rental
operations for an aggregate $7,626 net of cash acquired, of which $4,209 was
accounted for as goodwill. During fiscal 1997, the Company acquired in purchase
transactions twelve rental operations for an aggregate $21,073 net of cash
acquired, of which $15,292 was accounted for as goodwill. During fiscal 1996,
the Company acquired in purchase transactions seven rental operations for an
aggregate $124,577 net of cash acquired, of which $85,363 was accounted for as
goodwill. The operations of the stores are included in the Company's
consolidated financial statements beginning on the date of acquisition. The
Company is continuing to consider the acquisition of additional rental
operations.
 
On August 19, 1996 the demerger of the THORN EMI group was completed and the
rental, rental-purchase and related businesses of the THORN EMI group were
transferred to THORN plc. This resulted in, among other things, the Company
acquiring 100 percent of the common stock of Remco Americas, Inc. in exchange
for the Company's twelve percent investment interest in the common stock of an
affiliated company, Thorn EMI North America, Inc. (TENA). The Company's
investment in TENA was accounted for under the cost method of accounting and had
a net book carrying value of $50,000. The affiliates from which this common
stock and these net assets were purchased were under the common control of the
Company's indirect parent at the time of the transaction and accordingly, the
assets and liabilities were recorded at their historical cost in a manner
similar to that of a pooling of interest. The accompanying financial statements
include the accounts and operations of these affiliates as if they were a part
of the Company at the beginning of fiscal 1996.
 
3. LOANS FROM AFFILIATES
 
Prior to the demerger, the Company had entered into a loan agreement with
TEMINAH which required the Company to pay to TEMINAH $2,129,280 on July 2, 2004.
This amount consisted of principal plus interest compounded at ten percent (10%)
per year. As a part of the demerger transaction the Company and an affiliated
company, Thorn Finance, plc. (TFP), refinanced the loan agreement, requiring the
Company to pay TFP $710,818 together with all accrued and unpaid interest on the
unpaid balance on July 2, 2010. In connection with this refinancing the Company
paid $200,000 on the original note. In addition, $50,000 of this note was
forgiven by TEMINAH and recorded as a contribution of capital in the
accompanying statement of stockholders' equity.
 
During fiscal 1998, interest accrues at a variable rate equal to 120% of the
"Applicable Federal Rate" (AFR), designated as "Compounding Monthly," for debt
instruments with
                                      F-35
<PAGE>   199
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
3. LOANS FROM AFFILIATES -- (CONTINUED)
a maturity of less than three years (6.3% at March 31, 1998). During fiscal
1997, the interest rate was equal to fifty (50) basis points above the AFR
(6.18% at March 31, 1997). The terms of the agreement allow the Company to
prepay the note in part or in full, without premium or penalty. The balance on
the note payable to TFP, at March 31, 1997 and 1998 was $714,235 and $714,223,
respectively.
 
4. ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE -- AFFILIATED COMPANIES
 
Accounts receivable from affiliated companies includes income taxes payable to
Parent of $480 at March 31, 1997 (see Note 9). These balances are not subject to
interest. The Company has short term loans receivable outstanding from TFP
totaling $65,000 and $15,000 as of March 31, 1997 and 1998, respectively. Other
intercompany receivables/ (payables) with affiliated companies totaled $(2,419)
and $24 as of March 31, 1997 and 1998, respectively. The year-end net receivable
balances are not subject to specified settlement terms.
 
Prior to the demerger transaction, advances to or from affiliated companies were
made as working capital was available or needed. The Company received interest
at 125% of the monthly applicable federal rate on the deposited funds. After the
demerger transaction the Company continues to earn interest on its excess cash
invested with THORN at rates commensurate with short term interest rates
available in major U.S. banking markets.
 
5. COMMITMENTS
 
The Company leases its store and distribution facilities. Management expects, in
the normal course of business, that leases which expire will be renewed or
replaced by other leases. At March 31, 1998, the approximate future annual
minimum rental payments required under these noncancelable operating leases were
as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
1999.................................................   $39,886
2000.................................................    28,625
2001.................................................    14,344
2002.................................................     6,114
2003.................................................     2,475
Thereafter...........................................     2,327
                                                        -------
          Total minimum payments required............   $93,771
                                                        =======
</TABLE>
 
Rent expense under noncancelable operating leases for fiscal 1996, 1997, and
1998 was approximately $41,197, $45,973 and $47,590, respectively.
 
                                      F-36
<PAGE>   200
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
6. INCENTIVE PLANS
 
The Company has long-term incentive plans for key executives. Payments are
contingent upon the Company meeting long-term financial objectives based upon
three-year operating cycles. Expense associated with such plans during fiscal
1996, 1997 and 1998 totaled $440, $797 and $1,072, respectively. The expected
obligations under these plans at March 31, 1997 and 1998 were $1,550 and $2,161,
respectively.
 
7. SAVINGS PLANS
 
The Company has a trusteed savings plan for the benefit of eligible employees.
The plan provides for the participants to make voluntary contributions to the
plan ranging from 1% to 20% of their gross compensation which is matched by the
Company at a rate each year as determined by the Company's Board of Directors.
The Company may, at its sole discretion, match 100% of the amount contributed by
the participant up to 4% of the employee's annual gross compensation.
 
Effective January 1, 1998, the Company offered a nonqualified saving plan (NSP)
for certain designated employees who are within a select group of key management
or highly compensated employees. Employees eligible to participate in the NSP
may elect to defer up to a maximum of 80% of their salary and up to a maximum of
100% of incentive bonuses. The Company will make a matching deferred
contribution of up to 15% of the employee's contribution, not to exceed $15 per
employee per plan year.
 
During fiscal 1996, 1997, and 1998 the expense related to these plans, net of
forfeitures, amounted to $3,554, $3,359 and $3,295, respectively.
 
8. STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS
 
In fiscal 1997, the Company adopted the disclosure-only provisions of SFAS 123.
SFAS 123 encourages entities to adopt a fair value-based method of accounting
for employee stock compensation plans, but allows companies to continue to
account for those plans using the accounting proscribed by APB 25. The Company
has elected to account for stock based compensation using APB 25, while making
the required pro forma disclosures of net earnings as if the fair value-based
method had been applied.
 
Accordingly, no compensation expense has been recorded for the stock option or
share rights plans. Had the compensation cost for stock based compensation plans
been determined using the fair value method of accounting consistent with SFAS
123, there would have been no significant effect on the Company's net income.
The Black-Scholes option-pricing model was used to determine the fair value on
the date of grant for the stock options and share rights. As of March 31, 1998
there were awards for 9,961,904 shares outstanding.
 
SFAS 123 requires certain disclosures to be made about the pricing model
assumptions used, exercisable options, option activity, weighted average price
per option and option
 
                                      F-37
<PAGE>   201
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
8. STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS -- (CONTINUED)
exercise price range for each income statement period. Since the stock option
and share rights activity relates only to THORN's stockholders' equity, this
information is not presented for the Company.
 
9. INCOME TAXES
 
Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences
between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting
purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes.
 
Significant components of the provision for income taxes attributable to
continuing operations are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              1996       1997      1998
                                             -------   --------   ------
<S>                                          <C>       <C>        <C>
Current:
Federal....................................  $ 8,576   $ 17,487   $7,050
State......................................    3,536      6,670      614
                                             -------   --------   ------
          Total current....................   12,112     24,157    7,664
                                             -------   --------   ------
Deferred:
Federal....................................   (4,384)    (7,998)    (532)
State......................................     (957)    (2,279)     628
                                             -------   --------   ------
          Total deferred...................   (5,341)   (10,277)      96
                                             -------   --------   ------
                                             $ 6,771   $ 13,880   $7,760
                                             =======   ========   ======
</TABLE>
 
Prior to the demerger, the Company filed a consolidated federal tax return with
TEMINAH and calculated its tax provision in accordance with TEMINAH's tax
allocation policy, which provides for calculations on a stand-alone basis with
any tax liability or benefit recorded as a payable to or receivable from
TEMINAH. Post-demerger, the Company files a consolidated federal tax return with
its U.S. subsidiaries and calculates its tax liability based upon income for the
applicable periods. During fiscal 1997 in connection with the demerger, TEMINAH
forgave $8,721 in tax liability owed to them from the Company. This reduction in
liability was treated as a capital contribution by TEMINAH and recorded as an
increase in paid-in capital by the Company.
 
                                      F-38
<PAGE>   202
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
9. INCOME TAXES -- (CONTINUED)
The income tax provision differed from the amount computed by applying the U.S.
federal income tax rate of 35% for fiscal 1997 and 1998 to income before income
taxes as a result of the following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              1996      1997      1998
                                             -------   -------   -------
<S>                                          <C>       <C>       <C>
Computed "expected" tax expense............  $(2,202)  $ 3,466   $ 3,236
Increase (reduction) in income taxes
  resulting from:
Amortization of non-deductible goodwill....    5,336     6,149     6,123
State and local income tax, net of federal
  income tax benefit.......................    2,298     4,336       807
Reduction of valuation allowance...........       --        --    (1,400)
Other, net.................................    1,339       (71)   (1,006)
                                             -------   -------   -------
                                             $ 6,771   $13,880   $ 7,760
                                             =======   =======   =======
</TABLE>
 
Significant components of the Company's deferred tax assets and liabilities are
as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           1997      1998
                                                          -------   -------
<S>                                                       <C>       <C>
Deferred tax assets:
  Reserves for contingencies and restructuring..........  $10,836   $19,704
  Reserves for self-insurance and accrued liabilities...    9,997    11,378
  Alternative minimum tax credit carryforward...........       --     6,674
  Property and equipment................................    5,146    10,377
  Other.................................................    4,324     5,520
                                                          -------   -------
          Total deferred tax assets.....................   30,303    53,653
Deferred tax liabilities:
  Rental assets.........................................  $ 4,875   $26,811
  Other.................................................    4,219     5,729
                                                          -------   -------
          Total deferred tax liabilities................    9,094    32,540
                                                          -------   -------
          Net deferred tax assets.......................  $21,209   $21,113
                                                          =======   =======
</TABLE>
 
The alternative minimum tax credit carryforward has no expiration date.
 
10. CONTINGENCIES
 
The Company is a defendant in a number of class or alleged class action cases
relating to Rent-A-Center's rental-purchase or rent-to-rent agreements as
detailed below. Each claim is being adjudicated in the context of the relevant
state law which is different in each
 
                                      F-39
<PAGE>   203
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
10. CONTINGENCIES -- (CONTINUED)
state. The first five cases referred to below, which seek to recharacterize the
transaction from a lease to a credit sale, were filed prior to 1995. Of the
remaining four cases, two, filed in late 1997 and early 1998, seek to challenge
compliance with the relevant rental-purchase statutes. The remaining two cases,
filed in early 1998, seek to challenge the reinstatement fee and in addition,
one of the cases alleges that the Liability Damage Waiver (LDW) charge is
excessive.
 
The Company is a defendant in a class action alleging that Rent-A-Center's
rental-purchase agreements are credit sales and do not comply with the
requirements of the Minnesota Consumer Protection Statutes and Usury Law.
Summary judgment was entered as to liability and was affirmed by the U.S. Eighth
Circuit Court of Appeals. The District Court found that the remedy available to
the class members would be full recovery of all amounts paid for customers who
returned their property and recovery of only the alleged interest for those
customers who did not return their property.
 
Final Judgment as to damages was issued April 15, 1998, in the amount of $29,898
plus interest, although the court is considering the plaintiffs' request for an
additional $1,630. The Company will appeal such award of damages and will be
required to post a bond in connection therewith. The Company no longer offers
its rental-purchase transaction in this state.
 
The Company and five of its present or former officers are defendants in a
Pennsylvania alleged class action resulting from the consolidation of two
existing proposed class actions. A third class action lawsuit in Pennsylvania
has been stayed pending the outcome of the consolidated action and is
incorporated into the settlement relating to that consolidated action. The
consolidated action alleges that Rent-A-Center's rental agreements violate the
Pennsylvania Goods and Services Installment Sales Act and the federal Racketeer
Influenced and Corrupt Organization Act (RICO). A motion for a nationwide class
certification has been denied by the court with the provision that plaintiffs
may attempt to amend their complaint. A settlement in the amount of $9,350 has
been reached with the plaintiffs. A final hearing to obtain the Court's approval
was held June 17, 1998, and the Court approved the settlement July 8, 1998.
 
The class action filed in 1994 in Federal Court in Wisconsin was dismissed for
lack of jurisdiction on October 20, 1997. The plaintiffs have re-filed the case
in a Wisconsin state court. The new complaint alleges that Rent-A-Center's
rental purchase agreements should be deemed consumer credit sales under the
Wisconsin Consumer Act, violated Wisconsin's Usury law and violated the
Wisconsin Deceptive Practices Act. The Court entered an order July 7, 1998
granting the plaintiff's motion for class certification and denying the
Company's motion for partial summary judgment. A pre-trial conference is
scheduled August 26, 1998. The Company will defend the new claim vigorously.
 
The Company is a defendant in a class action alleging that Rent-A-Center's
rental-purchase agreements are credit sales and do not comply with the
requirements of
 
                                      F-40
<PAGE>   204
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
10. CONTINGENCIES -- (CONTINUED)
the New Jersey Retail Installment Sales Act and violate the New Jersey Consumer
Fraud Act and Usury law. In January 1997, summary judgment was granted in favor
of the plaintiffs in this case as to violation of the Retail Installment Sales
Act and the Consumer Fraud Act; the Court denied the plaintiff's motion on the
usury count. However, in September 1997, the Court granted the plaintiff's
motion for summary judgment on damages for breach of the Retail Installment
Sales Act and the Consumer Fraud Act, adopting the plaintiff's formula of 40% of
all rental payments, being the time differential interest equivalent, plus
reinstatement fees. This amount was trebled pursuant to the Consumer Fraud Act.
Judgment has now been entered for an amount of $100,000 subject to further
accounting. Initially, a bond was posted for this amount, and pursuant to
further accounting was increased by $63,000 to cover potential damages through
April, 1999. The injunction to prevent Rent-A-Center from continuing to trade
has been stayed pending the appeal. The Company is appealing this decision to
the New Jersey Court of Appeals and intends to pursue all further legal
proceedings as appropriate.
 
The Company is a defendant in a class action alleging that Rent-A-Center
violated the Texas Usury Law, the Texas Insurance Law and the Texas Deceptive
and Unfair Trade Practices Act. Texas law presently provides that rental
purchase agreements are not credit sales. There have been no developments in
this case since 1994 and damages are unspecified.
 
The following information relates to those claims not seeking
recharacterization:
 
The Company is a defendant in an alleged class action in New York. The case has
been removed to Federal Court. The complaint alleges that Rent-A-Center engaged
in deceptive or unfair acts in contravention of the New York Personal Property
Law (the Rent-to-Own Program Law), as well as provisions of the General Business
Law relating to consumer protection for deceptive acts and practices and false
advertising. The plaintiffs seek both compensatory and punitive damages.
 
The Company is a defendant in an alleged class action filed in Massachusetts.
This claim alleges that Rent-A-Center's transactions and advertising failed to
comply with the Massachusetts rental purchase statute and are deceptive under
the Massachusetts Consumer Protection Act. The plaintiffs seek both compensatory
and punitive damages.
 
The Company is a defendant in two alleged class actions filed in the State of
Alabama which were filed in January and March, 1998. These claims allege that
Rent-A-Center's reinstatement fee constitutes an illegal penalty and that
charging such fee constitutes breach of contract. A second claim was added to
the second class action alleging the LDW charge is excessive. The plaintiffs
seek compensatory damages only.
 
The claims described above, where not concluded, are being vigorously defended.
However, management believes that a loss will be incurred in some of the cases
and although a specific amount cannot be estimated due to an inability to
reasonably estimate potential losses and potential appellate decisions reversing
in whole or in part outstanding lower
 
                                      F-41
<PAGE>   205
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
10. CONTINGENCIES -- (CONTINUED)
court judgments, the Company has accrued $34,500 in the accompanying financial
statements. If the courts in these actions were to hold that the Company's
rental or rental-purchase transactions constitute credit sales, the Company
would seek to adapt its agreements, where this has not already occurred, so that
they would not be so treated under relevant state laws. Management believes that
a final unfavorable outcome in any one of these actions, except for that in
Texas, would not have a material adverse effect on the Company's ongoing
business. There can be no assurance, however, that final unfavorable outcomes in
any of these actions would not have a material effect on the Company's financial
condition or results of operations in the year of final adjudication.
 
The Company is a defendant in an action filed in the Federal District Court in
Missouri alleging a policy of racial discrimination against a nationwide class
of African-Americans who applied for employment, are currently employed or were
formerly employed. The Company denies the allegations and will vigorously oppose
certification of a nationwide class. Attempts to certify a nationwide class in a
racial discrimination case filed in the Federal District Court in Kansas were
dismissed last year.
 
The Company's management is not aware of any additional legal or arbitration
proceedings pending or threatened against the Company which may have any
liability significantly in excess of provisions in the accounts.
 
11. FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
 
The fair values of the Company's financial instruments at March 31, 1998 are as
follows:
 
Loans from affiliated company: It was not practicable to estimate the fair value
of the Company's loans from its affiliates because no quoted market prices exist
for these unique instruments and there is no intent by management to retire the
debts.
 
12. OFF-BALANCE SHEET RISK
 
Letters of credit are issued by the Company during the ordinary course of
business through banks as required by certain vendor contracts. As of March 31,
1997 and 1998, the Company had outstanding irrevocable stand-by letters of
credit for $27,336 and $66,842, respectively.
 
Subsequent to March 31, 1998, the Company secured a bond in the amount of
$32,786 and canceled its previously outstanding stand-by letter of credit in the
amount of $4,000, in connection with a class action lawsuit in Minnesota (see
Note 10). The Company and THORN are both guarantors of the bond.
 
The Company has secured a bond in the amount of $100,000 in connection with a
class action lawsuit in New Jersey (See Note 10). The Company and THORN are both
guarantors of the bond.
 
                                      F-42
<PAGE>   206
                     THORN AMERICAS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
12. OFF-BALANCE SHEET RISK -- (CONTINUED)
The Company has a $20,000 unused line of credit with a financial institution.
 
13. RESTRUCTURING CHARGES
 
During fiscal 1998, the Company discontinued its new concept tests related to
its credit retail and check-cashing businesses, closed certain nonperforming
rental purchase stores and reorganized certain administrative support functions
resulting in a charge to operating income of $12,292. Such restructuring charges
include asset valuation reductions of approximately $3,750, future rent
obligations of approximately $2,250, employee severance costs of approximately
$5,250 and other costs of approximately $1,042. As of March 31, 1998, $6,851 of
total restructuring charges remained in accrued liabilities.
 
During 1996, the Company recorded restructuring charges of $12,600 related to
consolidation of offices and reductions in the number of employees. These
charges were primarily made up of the expected costs of employee separations.
There was no remaining liability at March 31, 1998.
 
14. MERGER TRANSACTION
 
On June 17, 1998 THORN announced that it has entered into an agreement to sell
the Company to Renters Choice, Inc., a publicly held rent-to-own company for
approximately $900,000 subject to shareholder and Federal Trade Commission
approval. A closing date for the transaction has not yet been determined.
 
15. SUBSEQUENT EVENT (UNAUDITED)
 
In August 1998, subsequent to its change of control, the Company reached a
tentative settlement with the plaintiffs in Wisconsin, in the amount of $16.25
million. Such amount is not accrued in the June 30, 1998 financial statements.
 
                                      F-43
<PAGE>   207
 
                    REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
To The Board of Directors of
Central Rents, Inc.
 
We have audited the accompanying balance sheets of Central Rents, Inc. (a
Delaware corporation) as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, and the related
statements of operations, stockholders' equity (deficit) and cash flows for the
years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995. These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
 
We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in
all material respects, the financial position of Central Rents, Inc. as of
December 31, 1997 and 1996, and the results of its operations and its cash flows
for the years ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995 in conformity with
generally accepted accounting principles.
 
ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
 
Los Angeles, California
March 19, 1998
 
                                      F-44
<PAGE>   208
 
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
                                 BALANCE SHEETS
             DECEMBER 31, 1996, 1997 AND MARCH 31, 1998 (UNAUDITED)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 DECEMBER 31,
                                                              -------------------    MARCH 31,
                                                                1996       1997        1998
                                                              --------   --------   -----------
                                                                                    (UNAUDITED)
                                                                    (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS
                                                                   EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                                           <C>        <C>        <C>
ASSETS
Cash and Cash Equivalents...................................  $ 12,808   $  5,739    $ 11,526
Receivables and Prepaid Expenses............................     2,348      2,396       2,016
Due from Related Parties....................................        --        115          --
Income Tax Receivable -- Related Party......................     1,871         --          --
Rental Merchandise, at cost.................................    66,289     68,205      63,344
  Less -- Accumulated depreciation..........................   (31,908)   (31,461)    (31,621)
                                                              --------   --------    --------
                                                                34,381     36,744      31,723
Property and Equipment, at cost
  Leasehold improvements....................................     3,355      4,905       5,880
  Furniture and equipment...................................     2,037      2,981       4,256
  Vehicles..................................................       134         73          57
                                                              --------   --------    --------
                                                                 5,526      7,959      10,193
  Less -- Accumulated depreciation..........................    (2,834)    (4,127)     (6,622)
                                                              --------   --------    --------
                                                                 2,692      3,832       3,571
Deferred Financing Costs, net...............................     1,957      1,603       1,535
Noncompete Agreement, net...................................     1,275         --          --
Excess of Cost over Net Assets Acquired, net................     6,861      6,611       6,549
Deferred Income Taxes.......................................     8,156     10,595      11,045
Other Assets................................................       114        125         131
                                                              --------   --------    --------
        Total Assets........................................  $ 72,463   $ 67,760    $ 68,096
                                                              ========   ========    ========
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT)
Liabilities:
Accounts Payable............................................  $  5,332   $  4,688    $  2,715
Accrued Expenses............................................     5,682      6,058       7,380
Due to Related Parties......................................       237         --          --
Income Tax Payable -- Related Party.........................        --        434         249
Accrued Interest............................................       322        322       2,253
Long-term Notes.............................................    58,094     58,368      58,437
                                                              --------   --------    --------
        Total liabilities...................................    69,667     69,870      71,034
                                                              --------   --------    --------
Commitments and Contingencies...............................        --         --          --
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT):
  Preferred stock, $.01 par value, 100 shares authorized; no
    shares issued...........................................        --         --          --
  Common stock, $.01 par value, 2,000,000 shares authorized;
    551,045, 617,045 and 617,045 shares issued and
    outstanding in 1996, 1997 and 1998 (unaudited),
    respectively............................................         6          7           7
  Additional paid-in capital................................    22,944     22,944      22,944
  Retained deficit..........................................   (20,154)   (25,061)    (25,889)
                                                              --------   --------    --------
        Total stockholders' equity (deficit)................     2,796     (2,110)     (2,938)
                                                              --------   --------    --------
        Total liabilities and stockholders' equity
        (deficit)...........................................  $ 72,463   $ 67,760    $ 68,096
                                                              ========   ========    ========
</TABLE>
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-45
<PAGE>   209
 
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
                            STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
              FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1996 AND 1997
          AND FOR THE UNAUDITED PERIODS ENDED MARCH 31, 1997 AND 1998
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       DECEMBER 31,                MARCH 31,
                               -----------------------------   ------------------
                                 1995       1996      1997       1997      1998
                               --------   --------   -------   --------   -------
                                                                  (UNAUDITED)
                                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                            <C>        <C>        <C>       <C>        <C>
Revenues:
  Rental revenues............  $112,243   $103,382   $98,582   $ 23,528   $21,935
  Sales of merchandise.......     5,736      5,243     4,847      1,146     1,484
  Other revenue..............        65        152       114      2,062     1,782
                               --------   --------   -------   --------   -------
                                118,044    108,777   103,543     26,736    25,201
                               --------   --------   -------   --------   -------
Costs and Expenses:
  Selling, general and
     administrative..........    61,991     61,475    62,544     15,682    15,196
  Cost of merchandise sold...     3,658      3,852     3,520      1,098     1,058
  Depreciation and
     amortization
     Rental merchandise......    36,694     32,045    30,407      7,660     7,664
     Property and
       equipment.............     1,541      1,538     1,711        367       517
                               --------   --------   -------   --------   -------
                                103,884     98,910    98,182     24,807    24,435
                               --------   --------   -------   --------   -------
Income before interest, taxes
  and amortization of
  intangibles................    14,160      9,867     5,361      1,929       766
Amortization of
  intangibles................    19,601      5,192     1,545        818        65
                               --------   --------   -------   --------   -------
Income (loss) from
  operations.................    (5,441)     4,675     3,816      1,111       701
Interest expense, net........    (7,464)    (7,555)   (7,849)    (1,914)   (1,979)
                               --------   --------   -------   --------   -------
Loss before income tax
  benefit....................   (12,905)    (2,880)   (4,033)      (803)   (1,278)
Income tax benefit...........     3,750      1,040     1,126        289       450
                               --------   --------   -------   --------   -------
          Net loss...........  $ (9,155)  $ (1,840)  $(2,907)  $   (514)  $  (828)
                               ========   ========   =======   ========   =======
Per share data:
Basic net loss per common
  share......................  $ (16.89)  $  (3.34)  $ (4.79)  $  (0.89)  $ (1.34)
                               ========   ========   =======   ========   =======
Diluted net loss per common
  share......................  $ (16.89)  $  (3.34)  $ (4.79)  $  (0.89)  $ (1.34)
                               ========   ========   =======   ========   =======
Weighted average common
  shares outstanding.........   541,985    551,045   606,557    575,000   617,045
                               ========   ========   =======   ========   =======
</TABLE>
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-46
<PAGE>   210
 
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
                  STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT)
            FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1996 AND 1997 AND
                FOR THE PERIOD ENDED MARCH 31, 1998 (UNAUDITED)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   COMMON STOCK
                                -------------------             RETAINED
                                                      PAID-IN   EARNINGS
                                SHARES    PAR VALUE   CAPITAL   (DEFICIT)    TOTAL
                                -------   ---------   -------   ---------   -------
                                     (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
<S>                             <C>       <C>         <C>       <C>         <C>
BALANCE, December 31, 1994....  534,000      $ 5      $22,195   $ (9,159)   $13,041
  Issuance of common stock....   17,045        1          749         --        750
  Net loss for the year ended
     December 31, 1995........       --       --           --     (9,155)    (9,155)
                                -------      ---      -------   --------    -------
BALANCE, December 31,
  1995........................  551,045        6       22,944    (18,314)     4,636
  Net loss for the year ended
     December 31, 1996........       --       --           --     (1,840)    (1,840)
                                -------      ---      -------   --------    -------
BALANCE, December 31, 1996....  551,045        6       22,944    (20,154)     2,796
                                -------      ---      -------   --------    -------
  Dividends paid..............       --                    --     (2,000)    (2,000)
  Exercise of stock
     warrants.................   66,000        1           --         --          1
  Net loss for the year ended
     December 31, 1997........       --       --           --     (2,907)    (2,907)
                                -------      ---      -------   --------    -------
BALANCE, December 31, 1997....  617,045        7       22,944    (25,061)    (2,110)
                                -------      ---      -------   --------    -------
  Net loss for the unaudited
     period ended March 31,
     1998.....................       --       --           --       (828)      (828)
                                -------      ---      -------   --------    -------
BALANCE, March 31, 1998
  (unaudited).................  617,045      $ 7      $22,944   $(25,889)   $(2,938)
                                =======      ===      =======   ========    =======
</TABLE>
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-47
<PAGE>   211
 
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
                            STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
              FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1996 AND 1997
          AND FOR THE UNAUDITED PERIODS ENDED MARCH 31, 1997 AND 1998
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         DECEMBER 31,                MARCH 31,
                                                ------------------------------   -----------------
                                                  1995       1996       1997      1997      1998
                                                --------   --------   --------   -------   -------
                                                                                    (UNAUDITED)
                                                              (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                             <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>       <C>
Cash flows from operating activities:
  Net loss....................................  $ (9,155)  $ (1,840)  $ (2,907)  $  (514)  $  (828)
  Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net
    cash (used) provided by operating
    activities:
    Depreciation of rental merchandise........    36,694     32,045     30,407     7,660     7,664
    Depreciation of property and equipment....     1,541      1,538      1,711       367       517
    Deferred income tax benefit...............    (3,950)       (26)    (1,286)     (289)     (450)
    Amortization of intangibles...............    19,601      5,192      1,545       818        65
    Amortization of debt discount.............       274        274        274        68        69
    Amortization of deferred financing
      costs...................................       316        330        163        83        68
    Changes in operating assets and
      liabilities, net of the effect of
      businesses acquired:
      Decrease (increase) in receivables,
         prepaid expenses and other assets....       742       (354)       (59)      608       371
      Decrease (increase) in due from related
         parties..............................        --         --       (115)       --       115
      Decrease (increase) in income tax
         receivable -- related party..........    (1,050)      (821)     1,871        (2)       --
      Increase in rental merchandise,
         (purchases and retirement), net......   (41,095)   (31,561)   (32,865)   (6,900)   (2,643)
      Decrease in deferred financing costs....        --         --        191        --        --
      Increase (decrease) in accounts
         payable..............................     1,677     (4,891)      (644)   (2,813)   (1,973)
      Increase (decrease) in accrued
         expenses.............................      (856)      (494)       377       266     1,322
      Increase in accrued interest............        --         --         --     1,931     1,931
      (Decrease) increase in due to related
         parties..............................      (136)      (523)      (237)      116      (185)
      Decrease in income taxes payable --
         related party........................        --         --       (715)       --        --
      Increase in income taxes payable........        --        419         --        --        --
                                                --------   --------   --------   -------   -------
         Net cash (used) provided by operating
           activities.........................     4,603       (712)    (2,289)    1,399     6,043
                                                --------   --------   --------   -------   -------
Cash flows from investing activities:
  Proceeds from store sales...................       515         --         95        --        --
  Purchase of property and equipment..........    (2,114)    (1,032)    (2,851)   (1,094)     (256)
  Purchase of rental agreements and stores....    (1,110)        --        (24)      (24)       --
  Purchase of RTO and WBC, net of cash
    acquired..................................    (3,669)        --         --        --        --
                                                --------   --------   --------   -------   -------
         Net cash (used) provided by investing
           activities.........................    (6,378)    (1,032)    (2,780)   (1,118)     (256)
                                                --------   --------   --------   -------   -------
Cash flows from financing activities:
  Dividends paid..............................        --         --     (2,000)   (2,000)       --
  Proceeds from issuance of common stock......       750         --         --        --        --
  Debt issuance costs.........................      (176)        --         --        --        --
                                                --------   --------   --------   -------   -------
Net cash (used) provided by financing
  activities..................................       574         --     (2,000)   (2,000)       --
                                                --------   --------   --------   -------   -------
Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents.....    (1,201)    (1,744)    (7,069)   (1,719)    5,787
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of
  year........................................    15,753     14,552     12,808    12,808     5,739
                                                --------   --------   --------   -------   -------
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year........  $ 14,552   $ 12,808   $  5,739   $11,089   $11,526
                                                ========   ========   ========   =======   =======
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF CASH FLOW
  INFORMATION:
Cash paid during the period for:
  Income taxes................................  $  1,271   $  1,190   $    160   $    22   $     3
  Interest....................................  $  7,725   $  7,852   $  7,784   $   430   $   436
</TABLE>
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
 
                                      F-48
<PAGE>   212
 
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
1. HISTORY AND BUSINESS ACTIVITY
 
Central Rents, Inc. (the "Company") was incorporated in the State of Delaware on
March 17, 1994 to acquire RTO Enterprises, Inc. ("RTO") and WBC Holdings, Inc.
("WBC"). The Company is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Central Rents Holding, Inc.
which is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Banner Holdings, Inc. ("Banner"), its
ultimate parent company. All activity of the Company prior to the acquisition of
RTO and WBC ("Acquisition") related to its formation, including an infusion of
$20,000,000 of cash equity in exchange for the issuance of 534,000 shares of
common stock. On April 28, 1995, RTO and WBC were merged into the Company
pursuant to a statutory merger effected in accordance with the provisions of the
Delaware General Corporation Laws.
 
The Company's predecessors have been engaged in the rental-purchase industry
since 1968. As of December 31, 1997, the Company operated 175 rental-purchase
stores in 20 states throughout the United States. The stores rent a broad range
of consumer products, including electronics, major appliances, jewelry and
furniture.
 
2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
Rental Merchandise, Depreciation and Revenue Recognition
 
Rental merchandise is rented by customers through rental-purchase agreements
providing for weekly or monthly payments. The agreements automatically renew
with each payment. Rent is collected in advance at the beginning of each rental
period, is nonrefundable and is recognized as revenue when collected. Ownership
of the rental items passes to the customer when the customer makes the requisite
number of rental payments stipulated by the agreement, generally 12 to 30
monthly payments. In the accompanying statements of operations, sales of
merchandise primarily includes cash received for outright sales of previously
rented merchandise and final rental payments immediately preceding the passage
of title to the respective customers. Cost of merchandise sold represents the
undepreciated cost of merchandise on the date of sale.
 
Rental merchandise is recorded at cost. The Company has determined that the
estimated useful lives of its rental merchandise averaged approximately 22
months and such period is used for depreciation purposes.
 
Property and Equipment
 
Property and equipment, including leasehold improvements, are recorded at cost.
Additions, improvements and renewals which significantly add to the asset value
or extend the life of the asset are capitalized. Expenditures for maintenance
and repairs are expensed as such costs are incurred.
 
                                      F-49
<PAGE>   213
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
The Company uses the straight-line method for recording depreciation. The
estimated useful lives used in computing depreciation for financial reporting
purposes are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                     <C>
Leasehold improvements...............................   Life of lease
Furniture and equipment..............................       3-7 years
Vehicles.............................................         3 years
</TABLE>
 
Deferred Financing Costs
 
Deferred financing costs represent debt issuance costs and are amortized using
the interest method over the term of the long-term notes. As of December 31,
1996 and 1997 and as of the unaudited period ending March 31, 1998, accumulated
amortization amounted to $817,000, $980,000 and $1,047,000, respectively.
 
Advertising
 
The Company generally expenses production cost of print and television
advertisements as of the first date the advertisements takes place unless they
are expected to benefit future periods. Advertising expenses included in
selling, general and administrative expenses were $5,394,000 in 1995, $5,822,000
in 1996, $6,668,000 in 1997, and $1,570,000 and $1,204,000 for unaudited periods
ending March 31, 1997 and 1998, respectively.
 
Noncompete Agreement
 
In connection with the Acquisition, one of the sellers entered into a noncompete
agreement with the Company. The noncompete agreement was amortized over its
contractual life of 3 years. Amortization of the noncompete agreement was 50% in
year one, 35% in year two and 15% in year three. As of December 31, 1996 and
1997, and as of the unaudited period ending March 31, 1998, accumulated
amortization amounted to $18,725,000, $20,000,000 and $20,000,000, respectively.
The agreement was fully amortized at June 30, 1997.
 
Excess of Cost Over Net Assets Acquired
 
The excess of cost over net assets acquired, which relates to the acquisition of
RTO and WBC and other stores in 1995, is being amortized on a straight-line
basis over a period of 30 years. The purchase price is subject to change upon
the resolution of certain issues with the seller. The Company periodically
reviews the excess of cost over net assets acquired to assess recoverability.
Impairment would be recognized in operating results if a permanent diminution in
value were to occur. At year end, 1995, the Company specifically reviewed the
excess of cost over net assets acquired related to its California operations.
The Company undertook such a review in light of much lower operating results
experienced by these operations, due in a large part to the new California
legislation regulating rental-purchase transactions which became effective on
January 1, 1995 (the "California
 
                                      F-50
<PAGE>   214
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
Legislation"). The California Legislation limited the Company's ability to
collect certain types of fees. Based upon the then current economic environment
and future outlook, the Company determined that approximately $3.0 million of
excess of cost over net assets acquired related to its California operations had
been impaired and therefore such amount was charged-off as of December 31, 1995.
As of December 31, 1996 and 1997 and as of the unaudited period ending March 31,
1998, accumulated amortization amounted to $3,712,000, $3,960,000 and
$4,022,000, respectively.
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
The Company invests excess cash from operations in short-term investment grade
commercial paper and repurchase agreements. The Company considers all highly
liquid debt instruments purchased with an original maturity date of three months
or less to be cash equivalents.
 
Concentration of Credit Risk
 
The Company places its temporary cash and cash investments with high quality
financial institutions. Management monitors the financial creditworthiness of
these financial institutions. At times, such investments may be in excess of
insured limits.
 
Long-term Notes
 
The fair value of the Company's long-term notes is estimated as required by
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 107, "Disclosures about Fair
Value of Financial Instruments". The fair value is based on the quoted market
prices for the same or similar issues. Management believes that the fair value
of its long-term notes approximates the carrying value as of December 31, 1996
and 1997 and as of the unaudited period ending March 31, 1998.
 
Income Taxes
 
The Company accounts for income taxes in accordance with Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards No. 109, "Accounting for Income Taxes" ("SFAS 109"). SFAS
109 requires the use of the liability method of accounting for income taxes.
Deferred taxes are determined based on the difference between the financial
statement and tax basis of assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates in
effect.
 
The Company and Banner have entered into a tax sharing agreement which provides,
among other things, for the sharing of federal consolidated and state combined
income tax liabilities and refunds. Under the tax sharing agreement, payments
and refunds will be calculated by the Company on a separate company basis. The
Company will repay Banner $434,000 due to limitations that apply to loss
carryovers on a separate company basis due to a change in the method used in
allocating the tax liabilities in the prior years. The
 
                                      F-51
<PAGE>   215
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
Company recorded an income tax benefit in 1995, 1996 and 1997 of $3,750,000,
$1,040,000 and $1,126,000, respectively, and income taxes receivable from Banner
of $1,871,000 at December 31, 1996 and income taxes payable to Banner of
$434,000 at December 31, 1997.
 
Earnings Per Share
 
Earnings per common share is computed using the weighted average number of
shares outstanding and dilutive common stock equivalents (options and warrants).
No common stock equivalents were used in the computation as the impact would be
anti-dilutive.
 
The Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards No. 128, "Earnings Per Share" ("SFAS 128"), Statement of
Financial Accounting Standards No. 130 "Reporting Comprehensive Income" ("SFAS
130") and Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 131 "Disclosures about
Segments of Enterprise and Related Information" ("SFAS 131") in fiscal year
1997. The Company adopted SFAS 128 in 1997 and will adopt SFAS 130 and 131 in
1998. The Company does not expect that the adoption of SFAS 130 and SFAS 131
will have a material effect on its financial position or its results of
operations for the year ended December 31, 1998.
 
                                      F-52
<PAGE>   216
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
As described above, the Company reports earnings per share according to the
provisions of SFAS 128. The following table presents a reconciliation of basic
earnings per share and diluted earnings per share. The denominator of diluted
earnings per share includes the effect of dilutive common stock equivalents.
There were no potentially dilutive securities that were outstanding at December
31, 1997 and as of the unaudited period ended March 31, 1998.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            BASIC EARNINGS    DILUTED EARNINGS
                                               PER SHARE          PER SHARE
                                            ---------------   -----------------
                                            (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS EXCEPT SHARE
                                                    AND PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                         <C>               <C>
For the Year Ended December 31, 1995
  Numerator -- net loss...................     $ (9,155)          $ (9,155)
  Denominator -- weighted average shares
     outstanding..........................      541,985            541,985
  Loss per share..........................     $ (16.89)          $ (16.89)
For the Year Ended December 31, 1996
  Numerator -- net loss...................     $ (1,840)          $ (1,840)
  Denominator -- weighted average shares
     outstanding..........................      551,045            551,045
  Loss per share..........................     $  (3.34)          $  (3.34)
For the Year Ended December 31, 1997
  Numerator -- net loss...................     $ (2,907)          $ (2,907)
  Denominator -- weighted average shares
     outstanding..........................      606,557            606,557
  Loss per share..........................     $  (4.79)          $  (4.79)
For the Period Ended March 31, 1997
  (Unaudited)
  Numerator -- net loss...................     $   (514)          $   (514)
  Denominator -- weighted average shares
     outstanding..........................      575,000            575,000
  Loss per share..........................     $  (0.89)          $  (0.89)
For the Period Ended March 31, 1998
  (Unaudited)
  Numerator -- net loss...................     $   (828)          $   (828)
  Denominator -- weighted average shares
     outstanding..........................      617,045            617,045
  Loss per share..........................     $  (1.34)          $  (1.34)
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-53
<PAGE>   217
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
 
Balance Sheet Presentation
 
The Company's balance sheet is presented on a non-classified basis consistent
with industry practice.
 
Use of Estimates
 
The process of preparing financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles requires the use of estimates and assumptions
regarding certain types of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses. Such
estimates primarily relate to unsettled transactions and events as of the date
of the financial statements. Accordingly, upon settlement, actual results may
differ from estimated amounts, generally not by material amounts. Management
believes that these estimates and assumptions provide a reasonable basis for the
fair presentation of the Company's financial position and results of operations.
 
Included in the accompanying balance sheet is a deferred tax asset of $10.6
million as of December 31, 1997 and $11.1 million as of the unaudited period
ended March 31,1998. Management believes it is more likely than not that it will
realize the net deferred tax assets. The Company expects to realize this
recorded deferred tax asset through the potential disposition of all or a part
of the assets of the Company some time in the future, or through taking the
Company public providing for additional capital for growth and expansion.
 
Reclassifications
 
Certain reclassifications have been made to previously reported amounts to
conform to the current year presentation.
 
3. LONG-TERM NOTES
 
The Company funded the purchase price for the stock and notes of RTO and WBC
from the proceeds of an offering of Units (the "Offering"), consisting of
$60,000,000 principal amount of Senior Notes and Warrants to purchase 60,000
shares of common stock of the Company. The long-term notes were issued at a
price equal to 96.3% of the aggregate principal amount. Of the total proceeds,
$57,389,000 was allocated to Notes and $2,200,000 was allocated to the issuance
of Warrants. On or before February 28, 1997, all Warrant holders exercised their
option to convert the Warrants into the Company's common stock.
 
On September 28, 1994, the Company's Registration Statement under the Securities
Act relating to the issuance by the Company of $60,000,000 principal amount of
12 7/8% Series B Senior Notes due 2003 (the "New Notes") in exchange for the
outstanding Notes (the "Exchange Offer") was declared effective by the
Securities and Exchange Commission. Upon its effectiveness, the Company
commenced the Exchange Offer,
 
                                      F-54
<PAGE>   218
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
3. LONG-TERM NOTES -- (CONTINUED)
pursuant to which all of the outstanding Notes were tendered and exchanged on or
prior to October 28, 1994. The terms of the New Notes and the Notes are
identical in all material respects, except for certain transfer restrictions and
registration rights relating to the Notes.
 
The New Notes bear interest at the rate of 12 7/8% per annum payable
semi-annually on December 15 and June 15, commencing December 15, 1994. On or
after June 15, 1999, the New Notes will be redeemable at the option of the
Company, in whole or in part, at the redemption prices as defined plus accrued
and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.
 
In connection with the issuance of the Notes, the Company executed an indenture
dated June 3, 1994 (the "Indenture"). The Indenture contains certain covenants
that, among other things, limit the ability of the Company and its subsidiaries
to incur additional Indebtedness (as defined), pay dividends in excess of $2.0
million or make certain other Restricted Payments (as defined), enter into
certain transactions with affiliates, sell assets or enter into certain mergers
and consolidations. In addition, under certain circumstances, the Company is
required to offer to purchase the long-term notes at a price equal to 100% of
the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the
date of purchase, with proceeds from certain asset sales (as defined). Interest
expense on the New Notes amounted to $7,725,000 in 1995, 1996 and 1997 and
$2,067,000 for the unaudited period ended March 31, 1997 and 1998.
 
On May 10, 1997, the Company canceled a revolving line of credit agreement with
Wells Fargo Bank (the "Line of Credit") which was entered into on May 9, 1995.
The Line of Credit was subject to an annual commitment fee payable to the bank
on a quarterly basis of 0.5% of the unused borrowings.
 
4. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
Leases
 
The Company has various operating leases, which generally have an initial lease
term of 18 to 60 months. The operating leases are for office facilities, store
locations, rental of vehicles, office equipment and various other assets.
Generally leases for store locations contain renewal options for periods up to
six years. Rental expenses related to these leases during 1995, 1996 and 1997
and for the unaudited periods ending March 31, 1997 and 1998 amounted to
$7,667,000, $6,755,000, $7,545,000, $1,809,000 and $2,174,000,
 
                                      F-55
<PAGE>   219
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
4. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES -- (CONTINUED)
respectively. The future minimum annual rental commitments under operating
leases which have initial noncancelable lease terms in excess of one year are as
follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
           YEAR ENDING
          DECEMBER 31,              VEHICLES    REAL ESTATE      TOTAL
- ---------------------------------  ----------   -----------   -----------
<S>                                <C>          <C>           <C>
1998.............................  $2,236,000   $ 5,911,000   $ 8,147,000
1999.............................   1,604,000     3,969,000     5,573,000
2000.............................   1,208,000     3,047,000     4,255,000
2001.............................     313,000     1,595,000     1,908,000
2002.............................       1,000     1,046,000     1,047,000
Thereafter.......................          --       360,000       360,000
                                   ----------   -----------   -----------
                                   $5,362,000   $15,928,000   $21,290,000
                                   ==========   ===========   ===========
</TABLE>
 
Litigation
 
The Company is a party to legal proceedings arising in the normal course of
business. Based on consultation with legal counsel and on the facts currently
available, it is management's opinion that the ultimate resolution of these
matters will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial
position or results of operations.
 
Letters of Credit
 
The Company utilizes standby letters of credit to satisfy property and vehicle
insurance security deposit requirements. These letters of credit are irrevocable
and have one-year renewable terms. Outstanding standby letters of credit as of
December 31, 1996 and 1997 were $200,000 and $862,000, respectively, and
$1,162,000 as of the unaudited period ended March 31, 1998.
 
                                      F-56
<PAGE>   220
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
5. INCOME TAXES
 
The benefit for income taxes is comprised of the following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                     1995          1996          1997
                                  -----------   -----------   -----------
<S>                               <C>           <C>           <C>
Current:
  Federal.......................  $    36,000   $(1,061,000)  $        --
  State and local...............      164,000        47,000       160,000
                                  -----------   -----------   -----------
                                      200,000    (1,014,000)      160,000
                                  -----------   -----------   -----------
Deferred:
  Federal.......................   (3,150,000)      (20,000)     (660,000)
  State and local...............     (800,000)       (6,000)     (626,000)
                                  -----------   -----------   -----------
                                   (3,950,000)      (26,000)   (1,286,000)
                                  -----------   -----------   -----------
          Total tax benefit.....  $(3,750,000)  $(1,040,000)  $(1,126,000)
                                  ===========   ===========   ===========
</TABLE>
 
The benefit for income taxes differs from the amount obtained by applying the
federal statutory income tax rate to the loss before income taxes as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 1995     1996     1997
                                                 -----    -----    -----
<S>                                              <C>      <C>      <C>
Expected provision (benefit) for federal income
  taxes........................................  (35.0)%  (35.0)%  (35.0)%
State taxes -- net of federal deduction........    (.1)    (5.2)    (7.8)
Nondeductible and other items..................    6.1      4.1     14.9
                                                 -----    -----    -----
                                                 (29.0)%  (36.1)%  (27.9)%
                                                 =====    =====    =====
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-57
<PAGE>   221
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
5. INCOME TAXES -- (CONTINUED)
The primary components of temporary differences which give rise to deferred
taxes at December 31, 1997 and 1996 are:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   1996         1997
                                                ----------   -----------
<S>                                             <C>          <C>
Deferred Tax Assets:
  Depreciation of fixed assets................  $1,331,000   $ 1,082,000
  Reserves and other accrued expenses.........   1,585,000     1,542,000
  Noncompete agreement amortization...........   6,200,000     6,411,000
  Operating loss carry forward................          --     3,901,000
  Other.......................................     304,000       573,000
                                                ----------   -----------
          Total deferred tax assets...........   9,420,000    13,509,000
Deferred Tax Liabilities:
  Rental merchandise..........................    (601,000)     (648,000)
  State income tax............................    (474,000)     (755,000)
  Other.......................................    (189,000)   (1,511,000)
                                                ----------   -----------
          Net deferred tax assets.............  $8,156,000   $10,595,000
                                                ==========   ===========
</TABLE>
 
The Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") has examined certain of the Company's
former subsidiaries. In connection with the Acquisition, the sellers entered
into an agreement to indemnify the Company for income tax liabilities of RTO and
WBC attributable to pre-acquisition tax periods. The results of these audits did
not have a material adverse effect on the financial position of the Company.
 
The IRS published a revenue ruling in July 1995 providing that the Modified
Accelerated Cost Recovery System ("MACRS") is the appropriate depreciation
method for rental purchase merchandise. The Company has used the income forecast
method of depreciation for tax accounting, and management believes that this
method has been widely used throughout the rental-purchase industry prior to the
publication of this revenue ruling. The Company received permission from the IRS
and converted to the MACRS method of depreciation for tax accounting purposes
only, effective January 1, 1996. This change in tax accounting method will
require the Company to increase taxable income in future years in order to
recapture depreciation deductions previously claimed on the Company's tax
returns taken under the income forecast method of depreciation in advance of the
time at which such deductions may have been allowable under the MACRS
depreciation method. Management believes that the adoption of MACRS will not
significantly impact the Company's financial position and results of operations.
 
The Company provides taxes on a separate company basis pursuant to its tax
sharing agreement. Management believes it is more likely than not that it will
realize the net deferred tax assets and accordingly no valuation allowance has
been provided. This conclusion is based on the expectation of future taxable
income relating to the potential
 
                                      F-58
<PAGE>   222
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
5. INCOME TAXES -- (CONTINUED)
disposition of all or a part of the assets of the Company or through taking the
Company public providing for additional capital for growth and expansion. If the
Company is unable to generate sufficient taxable income through operating
results or dispositions and alternative strategies are not viable, then the
establishment of a valuation allowance may be necessary.
 
The Company has federal net operating loss carryforwards of approximately
$10,400,000 of which $1,288,000 expires in 2010, $2,295,000 expires in 2011 and
$6,817,000 expires in 2012. At December 31, 1997, the Company has state net
operating loss carryforwards of approximately $4,070,000 which expire at various
times and various amounts through the year 2012.
 
6. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
 
The Company has entered into an Administrative Services Agreement (the
"Administrative Services Agreement") with Banner pursuant to which Banner or one
of the other Banner subsidiaries, other than the Company, provides purchasing,
advertising, accounting, insurance, health and other benefits, real estate,
management information systems, and other services to the Company. The Company
is required to reimburse Banner for its allocable share of direct and overhead
costs determined on the basis of the Company's percentage utilization of the
applicable services contemplated by the Administrative Services Agreement. The
Administrative Services Agreement had an initial term of two years beginning
June 3, 1994 and will be automatically extended for up to eight successive
one-year terms after the end of the initial term unless the Company gives at
least 30 days prior notice at the end of the then current term that the
Administrative Services Agreement will terminate. As long as Banner or any other
Banner subsidiary beneficially owns more than 50% of the voting stock of the
Company, the Administrative Services Agreement shall not be terminable by Banner
or any other Banner subsidiary as a result of any breach of the Administrative
Services Agreement by the Company. During 1995, 1996 and 1997, and during the
unaudited periods ending March 31, 1997 and 1998, the Company purchased
$1,927,000, $640,000, $883,000, $0 and $201,000, respectively, of merchandise
from Banner's Central Electric, a wholly owned subsidiary of Banner. The Company
has not incurred any material common costs or expenses to be allocated during
1995, 1996 and 1997 and during the unaudited periods ending March 31, 1997 and
1998 in connection with the Administrative Services Agreement.
 
                                      F-59
<PAGE>   223
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
6. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS -- (CONTINUED)
The receivable from (payable to) related parties as of December 31, 1996 and
1997 and for the unaudited period ended March 31, 1998 are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                DECEMBER 31,
                                           ----------------------    MARCH 31,
                                              1996        1997         1998
                                           ----------   ---------   -----------
                                                                    (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                        <C>          <C>         <C>
Banner Holdings..........................  $2,371,000   $(434,000)   $(200,000)
Banner Central Electric..................    (656,000)    178,000       14,000
G. M. Cypres & Co. ......................     (61,000)    (63,000)     (63,000)
Banner Central Electric Properties.......     (20,000)         --           --
                                           ----------   ---------    ---------
                                           $1,634,000   $(319,000)   $(249,000)
                                           ==========   =========    =========
</TABLE>
 
The Company and G. M. Cypres & Co., a related party through common ownership,
entered into an agreement (the "Consulting Agreement") pursuant to which G. M.
Cypres & Co. or its designee provides consulting, investment banking or similar
services to the Company in consideration for the payment of certain fees and
expenses, including an annual management fee (the "Management Fee"). Under the
terms of the Indenture, the fees and expenses payable under the Consulting
Agreement must be reasonable and customary, and the Management Fee shall not
exceed $375,000 per year. Management Fees charged under the terms of the
Consulting Agreement totaled $375,000 for the years ended December 31, 1995,
1996 and 1997 and $93,750 for the unaudited periods ending March 31, 1997 and
1998.
 
Effective January 1, 1995, the Company entered into a triple net lease agreement
with BCE Properties II, Inc., a related party of the Company through common
ownership, for office space at the Company's corporate headquarters. The lease
provides, among other things, for monthly rent of $10,000 through December 31,
2005. Rent expense under the terms of the lease totaled $120,000 for the years
ended December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 and $30,000 for the unaudited periods
ending March 31, 1997 and 1998.
 
Management believes that all related party transactions were consummated on
terms comparable to terms that could have been negotiated with third parties.
 
7. RETIREMENT SAVINGS PLAN
 
As of December 31, 1995 the Company terminated a 401(k) defined contribution
plan covering substantially all employees of one of the Company's subsidiaries.
The Company matched the first 6% of eligible compensation contributed by the
participants at a rate of 25%. During 1995, the Company contributed $49,000 to
the plan.
 
The Company established a new 401(k) defined contribution plan in October 1997.
The Company did not match employee contributions and had no other expenses
related to the plan.
 
                                      F-60
<PAGE>   224
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
8. STORE SALES AND CLOSINGS
 
During 1995, the Company purchased rental agreements from two competitors and
transferred the agreements to existing stores, purchased two stores, closed one
store and sold six stores that were not located within the Company's targeted
geographic markets.
 
During 1996, the Company opened one new store and closed three stores and
transferred the agreements of the closed stores into other operating stores in
the area.
 
During 1997, the Company opened 13 new stores, sold the assets of one store,
closed two stores and transferred their agreements into other operating stores
in the area.
 
During the unaudited period ending March 31, 1998, the Company opened one new
store.
 
9. STOCK TRANSACTIONS
 
Issuance of Common Stock
 
On July 14, 1995 an outside institutional investor purchased 17,045 shares of
common stock of the Company at a price of $44.00 per share for an aggregate
purchase price of $750,000. The shares were issued pursuant to the terms of a
letter agreement which places certain restrictions on the purchaser's ability to
transfer the issued shares of stock.
 
As of February 28, 1997 all Warrant holders exercised their option to convert
the Warrants into the Company's common stock. 66,000 shares of stock were issued
for the Warrants at an exercise price of $.01 per share; 60,000 relating to the
initial offering and an additional 6,000 issued to the initial purchaser of the
Notes.
 
Stock Options
 
In 1994 the Board of Directors adopted a Stock Option Plan (the "1994 Plan"), to
grant to certain key employees of the Company options to purchase shares of the
common stock of the Company at fair market value. A percentage of the options
vest on each year provided that the Company meets or exceeds certain financial
performance standards during such year. If those standards are not attained in
such year, that portion of the option that would have vested may vest in the
year the Company does meet those standards. Management believes that those
standards will be attained in future years, before the options expire in the
year 2004, and therefore there is a potential that the options will be
exercisable. The stock options granted pursuant to the 1994 Plan cannot exceed
15% of the fully diluted shares of common stock of the Company. As of December
31, 1996 and 1997 and for the unaudited period ending March 31, 1998, there were
90,000 shares of common stock reserved for the 1994 Plan.
 
                                      F-61
<PAGE>   225
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
9. STOCK TRANSACTIONS -- (CONTINUED)
The following table summarizes stock option activity:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 EXERCISE
                                                                  PRICE
                                                        STOCK      PER
                                                       OPTIONS    SHARE
                                                       -------   --------
<S>                                                    <C>       <C>
Outstanding at December 31, 1995.....................   24,000    $37.45
  Granted............................................   17,000     37.45
  Expired or canceled................................  (11,000)    37.45
  Exercised..........................................       --
                                                       -------
Outstanding at December 31, 1996.....................   30,000     37.45
  Granted............................................       --     37.45
  Expired or canceled................................  (18,000)    37.45
  Exercised..........................................       --
                                                       -------
Outstanding at December 31, 1997 and for the
  unaudited period ending March 31, 1998.............   12,000     37.45
                                                       =======
Options exercisable at December 31, 1997 and for the
  unaudited period ending March 31, 1998.............       --
                                                       =======
</TABLE>
 
In October 1995, the Financial Accounting Standard Board issued Statement of
Financial Accounting Standards No. 123, "Accounting for Stock-Based
Compensation" ("SFAS 123"). SFAS 123 defines a fair value based method of
accounting for employee stock compensation plans, but allows for the
continuation of the intrinsic value based method of accounting to measure
compensation cost prescribed by Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25
"Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees" ("APB 25"). For companies electing
not to change their accounting, SFAS 123 requires pro-forma disclosures of
earnings and earnings per share as if the change in accounting provision of SFAS
123 has been adopted.
 
The Company has elected to continue to utilize the accounting method prescribed
by APB 25, under which no compensation cost has been recognized, and adopt the
disclosure requirements of SFAS 123. As a result, SFAS 123 has no effect on the
financial condition or results of operations of the Company at December 31, 1996
and 1997 and for the unaudited period ending March 31, 1998.
 
                                      F-62
<PAGE>   226
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
9. STOCK TRANSACTIONS -- (CONTINUED)
Had compensation cost for this plan been determined consistent with SFAS 123,
the Company's net income and earnings per share would have been reduced to the
following pro-forma amounts.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  DECEMBER 31,                       MARCH 31,
                                     ---------------------------------------   ---------------------
                                        1995          1996          1997         1997        1998
                                     -----------   -----------   -----------   ---------   ---------
                                                                                    (UNAUDITED)
<S>                    <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>         <C>
Net loss.............  As Reported   $(9,155,000)  $(1,840,000)  $(2,907,000)  $(514,000)  $(828,000)
                         Pro Forma   $(9,198,000)  $(1,889,000)  $(2,929,000)  $(536,000)  $(850,000)
Basic EPS............  As Reported   $    (16.89)  $     (3.34)  $     (4.79)  $   (0.89)  $   (1.34)
                         Pro Forma   $    (16.97)  $     (3.43)  $     (4.83)  $   (0.93)  $   (1.38)
Diluted EPS..........  As Reported   $    (16.89)  $     (3.34)  $     (4.79)  $   (0.89)  $   (1.34)
                         Pro Forma   $    (16.97)  $     (3.43)  $     (4.83)  $   (0.93)  $   (1.38)
</TABLE>
 
The fair value of each option grant is estimated on the date of grant using an
option pricing model with the following weighted-average assumptions used for
grants: dividend yield of 0.0%, volatility of 0.0%, risk-free interest rate of
6.5% and expected lives of 5 years.
 
On January 7, 1997 the Company declared a cash dividend on its common stock to
be paid to the holders of record of the Company's common stock as of February
28, 1997 payable on March 5, 1997.
 
Dividends
 
On March 5, 1997, the Company paid a total cash dividend of $2.0 million to the
holders of its common stock at $3.24 per share.
 
10. QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           INCOME                 BASIC      DILUTED
                               TOTAL        FROM        NET     NET LOSS    NET LOSS
                              REVENUES   OPERATIONS    LOSS     PER SHARE   PER SHARE
                              --------   ----------   -------   ---------   ---------
<S>                           <C>        <C>          <C>       <C>         <C>
December 31, 1996...........  $26,142      $  924     $  (533)   $ (.97)     $ (.97)
September 30, 1996..........  $26,468      $1,418     $  (320)   $ (.58)     $ (.58)
June 30, 1996...............  $27,767      $1,331     $  (369)   $ (.67)     $ (.67)
March 31, 1996..............  $28,400      $1,002     $  (618)   $(1.12)     $(1.12)
December 31, 1996...........  $25,029      $1,113     $  (826)   $(1.36)     $(1.36)
September 30, 1997..........  $25,409      $  170     $(1,191)   $(1.93)     $(1.93)
June 30, 1997...............  $26,394      $1,422     $  (376)   $ (.61)     $ (.61)
March 31, 1997..............  $26,736      $1,111     $  (514)   $ (.89)     $ (.89)
March 31, 1998..............  $25,201      $  701     $  (828)   $(1.34)     $(1.34)
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-63
<PAGE>   227
                              CENTRAL RENTS, INC.
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
11. SUBSEQUENT EVENT
 
The Company entered into an Asset Purchase Agreement dated May 1, 1998 with
Renters Choice, Inc. ("Renters"), Central Rents Holding, Inc. and Banner
pursuant to which substantially all of the assets of the Company will be sold to
Renters for approximately $102,400,000. Completion of the transaction occurred
on May 28, 1998 after obtaining necessary regulatory approvals and certain third
party approvals and various other closing conditions.
 
                                      F-64
<PAGE>   228
 
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
 
     NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS
PROSPECTUS, AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT
BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY THE COMPANY. THIS PROSPECTUS DOES
NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR A SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY ANY
SECURITIES OTHER THAN THE SECURITIES TO WHICH IT RELATES OR ANY OFFER TO SELL OR
THE SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY SUCH SECURITIES IN ANY CIRCUMSTANCES IN
WHICH SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS UNLAWFUL. NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF THIS
PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL, UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES, CREATE
ANY IMPLICATION THAT THERE HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE AFFAIRS OF THE COMPANY
SINCE THE DATE HEREOF OR THAT THE INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS CORRECT AS OF
ANY TIME SUBSEQUENT TO ITS DATE.
 
                           -------------------------
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                        PAGE
                                        ----
<S>                                     <C>
Available Information................     3
Forward-Looking Statements...........     3
Prospectus Summary...................     4
Risk Factors.........................    25
Use of Proceeds of the Exchange
  Notes..............................    32
Capitalization.......................    33
The Exchange Offer...................    34
Unaudited Pro Forma Combined
  Financial Information..............    45
Renters Choice, Inc. Selected
  Historical Financial Data..........    63
Rent-A-Center, Inc. Selected
  Historical Financial Data..........    66
Management's Discussion and Analysis
  of Financial Condition and Results
  of Operations......................    69
Business.............................    85
Management...........................   104
Security Ownership of Certain
  Beneficial Owners and Management...   110
Certain Transactions of the
  Company............................   111
Description of Capital Stock.........   112
Description of Other Indebtedness....   117
Description of the Notes and
  Guarantees.........................   118
Old Notes Exchange and Registration
  Rights Agreement...................   158
Certain U.S. Federal Income Tax
  Consequences.......................   161
Plan of Distribution.................   162
Experts..............................   163
Legal Matters........................   163
Index to Financial Statements........   F-1
</TABLE>
 
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
                              RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
                              RENT-A-CENTER, INC.
                                COLORTYME, INC.
                               OFFER TO EXCHANGE
                                   11% SENIOR
                               SUBORDINATED NOTES
                                    DUE 2008
                              FOR ALL OUTSTANDING
                         11% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES
                                    DUE 2008
                       ---------------------------------
                                   PROSPECTUS
                       ---------------------------------
                                            , 1998
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>   229
 
                                    PART II
 
                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
 
ITEM 20. INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS.
 
Delaware General Corporation Law
 
Section 145(a) of the DGCL provides that a corporation may indemnify any person
who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened,
pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal,
administrative or investigative (other than an action by or in the right of the
corporation) by reason of the fact that he is or was a director, officer,
employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the
corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation,
partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise against expenses
(including attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement
actually and reasonably incurred by him in connection with such action, suit or
proceeding if he acted in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to
be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and, with respect
to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe his
conduct was unlawful.
 
Section 145(b) of the DGCL provides that a corporation may indemnify any person
who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened,
pending or completed action or suit by or in the right of the corporation to
procure a judgment in its favor by reason of the fact that he is or was a
director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint
venture, trust or other enterprise against expenses (including attorneys' fees)
actually and reasonably incurred by him in connection with the defense or
settlement of such action or suit if he acted in good faith and in a manner he
reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the
corporation and except that no indemnification shall be made in respect of any
claim, issue or matter as to which such person shall have been adjudged to be
liable to the corporation unless and only to the extent that the Court of
Chancery or the court in which such action or suit was brought shall determine
upon application that, despite the adjudication of liability but in view of all
the circumstances of the case, such person is fairly and reasonably entitled to
indemnity for such expenses which the Court of Chancery or such other court
shall deem proper.
 
Section 145(c) of the DGCL provides that to the extent that a director, officer,
employee or agent of a corporation has been successful on the merits or
otherwise in defense of any action, suit or proceeding referred to in
subsections (a) and (b) of Section 145, or in defense of any claim, issue or
matter therein, he shall be indemnified against expenses (including attorneys'
fees) actually and reasonably incurred by him in connection therewith.
 
Section 145(d) of the DGCL provides that any indemnification under subsections
(a) and (b) of Section 145 (unless ordered by a court) shall be made by the
corporation only as authorized in the specific case upon a determination that
indemnification of the director, officer, employee or agent is proper in the
circumstances because he has met the applicable standard of conduct set forth in
subsections (a) and (b) of Section 145. Such determination shall be made (1) by
the board of directors by a majority vote of a quorum consisting of directors
who were not parties to such action, suit or proceeding, or (2) if
 
                                      II-1
<PAGE>   230
 
such a quorum is not obtainable, or, even if obtainable, if a quorum of
disinterested directors so directs, by independent legal counsel in a written
opinion, or (3) by the stockholders.
 
Section 145(e) of the DGCL provides that expenses (including attorneys' fees)
incurred by an officer or director in defending any civil, criminal,
administrative or investigative action, suit or proceeding may be paid by the
corporation in advance of the final disposition of such action, suit or
proceeding upon receipt of an undertaking by or on behalf of such director or
officer to repay such amount if it shall ultimately be determined that he is not
entitled to be indemnified by the corporation as authorized in Section 145. Such
expenses (including attorneys' fees) incurred by other employees and agents may
be so paid upon such terms and conditions, if any, as the board of directors
deems appropriate.
 
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation
 
The Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company provides
that a director of the Company shall not be personally liable to the Company or
its stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a
director, except for liability (i) for any breach of the director's duty of
loyalty to the company or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or occasions not in
good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of
law, (iii) in respect of certain unlawful dividend payments or stock purchases
or redemptions or (iv) for any transaction from which the director derived an
improper personal benefit. If the DGCL is amended to authorize the further
elimination or limitation of the liability of directors, then the liability of a
director of the Company, in addition to the limitation on personal liability
provided in the Amended and Restated Certificate of incorporation, will be
limited to the fullest extent permitted by the DGCL, as amended. Further, any
repeal or modification of such provision of the Amended and restated Certificate
of Incorporation by the stockholders of the Company will be prospective only,
and will not adversely affect any limitation on the personal liability of a
director of the Company arising from an act or omission occurring prior to the
time of such repeal or modification.
 
Amended and Restated Bylaws
 
The Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Company provide that each person who at
any time is or was a director of the Company, and is threatened to be or is made
a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding,
whether civil, criminal, administrative, arbitrative or investigative (a
"Proceeding"), by reason of the fact that such person is or was a director of
the company, or is or was serving at the request of the Company as a director,
officer, partner, venturer, proprietor, member, employee, trustee, agent or
similar functionary of another domestic or foreign corporation, partnership,
joint venture, sole proprietorship, trust, employee benefit plan or other
for-profit or non-profit enterprise, whether the basis of a Proceeding is
alleged action in such person's official capacity or in another capacity while
holding such office, shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Company to
the fullest extent authorized by the DGCL or any other applicable law as may
from time to time be in effect (but, in the case of any such amendment or
enactment, only to the extent that such amendment or statute permits the Company
to provide broader indemnification rights than such law prior to such amendment
 
                                      II-2
<PAGE>   231
 
or enactment permitted the Company to provide), against all expense, liability
and loss (including, without limitation, court costs and attorneys' fees,
judgments, fines, excise taxes or penalties, and amounts paid or to be paid in
settlement) actually and reasonably incurred or suffered by such person in
connection with a Proceeding, so long as a majority of a quorum of disinterested
directors, the stockholders or legal counsel through a written opinion
determines that such person acted in good faith and in a manner he reasonably
believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the Company, and in
the case of a criminal Proceeding, such person had no reasonable cause to
believe his conduct was unlawful. Such indemnification shall continue as to a
person who has ceased to serve in the capacity which initially entitled such
person to indemnity thereunder and shall inure to the benefit of his or her
heirs, executors and administrators. The Amended and Restated Bylaws also
contain certain provisions designed to facilitate receipt of such benefits by
any such persons, including the prepayment of any such benefit.
 
Indemnification Agreements
 
The Company has also entered into Indemnification Agreements pursuant to which
it has agreed to indemnify certain of its directors and officers against
judgments, claims, damages, losses and expenses incurred as a result of the fact
that any director or officer, in his capacity as such, is made or threatened to
be made a party to any suit or proceeding. Such persons will be indemnified to
the fullest extent now or hereafter permitted by the DGCL. The Indemnification
Agreements also provide for the advancement of certain expenses to such
directors and officers in connection with any such suit or proceeding.
 
Insurance
 
The Company has obtained a directors' and officers' liability insurance policy
insuring its directors and officers against losses resulting from wrongful acts
committed by them in their capacities as directors and officers of the company,
including liabilities arising under the Securities Act.
 
                                      II-3
<PAGE>   232
 
ITEM 21. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES.
 
(a) Exhibits
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        EXHIBIT
         NUMBER                              EXHIBIT DESCRIPTION
        -------                              -------------------
<C>                      <S>
          1.1*           -- Purchase Agreement, dated August 13, 1998, by and among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., Chase Securities Inc., Bear,
                            Stearns & Co. Inc., Credit Suisse First Boston
                            Corporation and NationsBank Montgomery Securities LLC
          2.1(1)         -- Agreement and Plan of Reorganization dated May 15, 1996,
                            among Renters Choice, Inc., ColorTyme, Inc., and CT
                            Acquisition Corporation
          2.2(2)         -- Asset Purchase Agreement, dated May 1, 1998, by and among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., Central Rents, Inc., Central Rents
                            Holding, Inc. and Banner Holdings, Inc.
          2.3(3)         -- Letter Agreement, dated as of May 26, 1998, by and among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., Central Rents, Inc., Central Rents
                            Holding, Inc. and Banner Holdings, Inc.
          3.1(4)         -- Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the
                            Company
          3.2(5)         -- Certificate of Amendment to the Amended and Restated
                            Certificate of Incorporation of the Company
          3.3(6)         -- Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Company
          3.4(7)         -- Amendment to the Amended and Restated Bylaws of the
                            Company
          3.5**          -- Certificate of Incorporation of Rent-A-Center, Inc.
          3.6**          -- Articles of Incorporation of ColorTyme, Inc.
          3.7**          -- Bylaws of Rent-A-Center, Inc.
          3.8**          -- Bylaws of ColorTyme, Inc.
          4.1(8)         -- Form of Certificate evidencing Common Stock
          4.2(9)         -- Certificate of Designations, Preferences and Relative
                            Rights and Limitations of Series A Preferred Stock of
                            Renters Choice, Inc.
          4.3(10)        -- Certificate of Designations, Preferences and Relative
                            Rights and Limitations of Series B Preferred Stock of
                            Renters Choice, Inc.
          4.4*           -- Indenture, dated as of August 18, 1998, by and among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., as Issuer, ColorTyme, Inc. and
                            Rent-A-Center, Inc., as Subsidiary Guarantors, and IBJ
                            Schroder Bank & Trust Company, as Trustee
          4.5**          -- Form of Certificate evidencing Series A Preferred Stock
          5.1**          -- Opinion of Winstead Sechrest & Minick P.C. regarding
                            legality of the securities offered.
         10.1(11)        -- Amended and Restated 1994 Renters Choice, Inc. Long-Term
                            Incentive Plan
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-4
<PAGE>   233
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        EXHIBIT
         NUMBER                              EXHIBIT DESCRIPTION
        -------                              -------------------
<C>                      <S>
         10.2(12)        -- Revolving Credit Agreement dated as of November 27, 1996
                            between Comerica Bank, as agent, Renters Choice, Inc. and
                            certain other lenders
         10.3(13)        -- Portfolio Acquisition Agreement dated May 15, 1996, by
                            and among Renters Choice, Inc., ColorTyme Financial
                            Services, Inc., and STI Credit Corporation
         10.4(14)        -- Employment Agreement, dated March 28, 1997, by and
                            between Renters Choice, Inc. and Danny Z. Wilbanks
         10.5(15)        -- Stock Option Agreement, dated April 1, 1997, by and
                            between Renters Choice, Inc. and Danny Z. Wilbanks
         10.6(16)        -- Credit Agreement, dated August 5, 1998, among Renters
                            Choice, Inc., Comerica Bank, as Documentation Agent,
                            NationsBank N.A., as Syndication Agent, and The Chase
                            Manhattan Bank, as Administrative Agent, and certain
                            other lenders
         10.7(17)        -- Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated August 5, 1998,
                            made by Renters Choice, Inc., and certain of its
                            Subsidiaries in favor of the Chase Manhattan Bank, as
                            Administrative Agent
         10.8(18)        -- $175,000,000 Senior Subordinated Credit Agreement, dated
                            as of August 5, 1998, among Renters Choice, Inc., certain
                            other lenders and the Chase Manhattan Bank
         10.9(19)        -- Stockholders Agreement, dated as of August 5, 1998, by
                            and among Apollo Investment Fund IV, L.P., Apollo
                            Overseas Partners IV, L.P., J. Ernest Talley, Mark E.
                            Speese, Renters Choice, Inc., and certain other persons
         10.10(20)       -- Registration Rights Agreement, dated August 5, 1998, by
                            and between Renters Choice, Inc., Apollo Investment Fund
                            IV, L.P., and Apollo Overseas Partners IV, L.P., related
                            to the Series A Convertible Preferred Stock
         10.11(21)       -- Registration Rights Agreement, dated August 5, 1998, by
                            and between Renters Choice, Inc., Apollo Investment Fund
                            IV, L.P., and Apollo Overseas Partners IV, L.P., related
                            to the Series B Convertible Preferred Stock
         10.12(22)       -- Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of June 16, 1998,
                            among Renters Choice, Inc., Thorn International BV and
                            Thorn plc
         10.13(23)       -- Stock Purchase Agreement, dated August 5, 1998, among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., Apollo Investment Fund IV, L.P. and
                            Apollo Overseas Partners IV, L.P.
         10.14*          -- Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement, dated August
                            18, 1998, by and among Renters Choice, Inc. and Chase
                            Securities Inc., Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc., NationsBank
                            Montgomery Securities LLC and Credit Suisse First Boston
                            Corporation
         21.1*           -- Subsidiaries of Registrant
         23.1*           -- Consent of Grant Thornton LLP
         23.2*           -- Consent of Ernst & Young LLP
         23.3*           -- Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-5
<PAGE>   234
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        EXHIBIT
         NUMBER                              EXHIBIT DESCRIPTION
        -------                              -------------------
<C>                      <S>
         23.4*           -- Consent of Winstead Sechrest & Minick P.C. (included as
                            part of its opinion filed as Exhibits 5.1 and 8.1)
         24.1*           -- Power of Attorney (included on signature page of this
                            S-4)
         25.1**          -- Statement of eligibility of IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust
                            Company to act as Trustee
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
  *  Filed herewith.
 
 **  To be filed by amendment.
 
 (1) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the registrant's Current
     Report on Form 8-K dated May 15, 1996
 
 (2) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the registrant's Current
     Report on Form 8-K dated May 28, 1998
 
 (3) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.2 to the registrant's Current
     Report on Form 8-K dated May 15, 1996
 
 (4) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the registrant's Annual
     Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994
 
 (5) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 1996
 
 (6) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.4 to the registrant's Annual
     Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994
 
 (7) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.3 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
 (8) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the registrant's
     Registration Statement on Form S-1 (File No. 33-86504)
 
 (9) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(10) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(11) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to the registrant's
     Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333- 53471)
 
(12) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the registrant's Annual
     Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996
 
(13) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the registrant's
     Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 15, 1996
 
(14) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 1997
 
(15) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 1997
 
                                      II-6
<PAGE>   235
 
(16) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(17) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(18) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(19) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(20) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.22 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(21) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(22) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.9 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(23) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.10 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
                                      II-7
<PAGE>   236
 
ITEM 22. UNDERTAKINGS.
 
(a) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that insofar as indemnification
for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Act")
may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the
Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant
has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission
such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is,
therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim of indemnification against
such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred
or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the
successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being
registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter
has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate
jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public
policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of
such issue.
 
(b) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes:
 
     (1) To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being made, a
     post-effective amendment to this registration statement:
 
        (i) To include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of the
        Securities Act of 1933;
 
        (ii) To reflect in the prospectus any facts or events arising after the
        effective date of the registration statement (or the most recent
        post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the
        aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information set forth
        in the registration statement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any
        increase or decrease in volume of securities offered (if the total
        dollar value of securities offered would not exceed that which was
        registered) and any deviation from the low or high end of the estimated
        maximum offering range may be reflected in the form of prospectus filed
        with the SEC pursuant to Rule 424(b) if, in the aggregate, the changes
        in volume and price represent no more than 20 percent change in the
        maximum aggregate offering price set forth in the "Calculation of
        Registration Fee" table in the effective registration statement;
 
        (iii) To include any material information with respect to the plan of
        distribution not previously disclosed in the registration statement or
        any material change to such information in the registration statement;
 
     provided, however, that paragraphs (a)(1)(i) and (a)(1)(ii) do not apply if
     the registration statement is on Form S-3, Form S-8 or Form F-3, and the
     information required to be included in a post-effective amendment by those
     paragraphs is contained in periodic reports filed with or furnished to the
     SEC by the registrant pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities
     Exchange Act of 1934 that are incorporated by reference in the registration
     statement.
 
     (2) That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities
     Act of 1933, each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new
     registration
 
                                      II-8
<PAGE>   237
 
     statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of
     such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide
     offering thereof.
     
     (3) To remove from registration by means of a post-effective amendment any
     of the securities being registered which remain unsold at the termination
     of the offering.
 
     (4) If the registrant is a foreign private issuer, to file a post-effective
     amendment to the registration statement to include any financial statements
     required by Rule 3-19 of this chapter at the start of any delayed offering
     or throughout a continuous offering. Financial statements and information
     otherwise required by Section 10(a)(3) of the Act need not be furnished,
     provided, that the registrant includes in the prospectus, by means of a
     post-effective amendment, financial statements required pursuant to this
     paragraph (a)(4) and other information necessary to ensure that all other
     information in the prospectus is at least as current as the date of those
     financial statements. Notwithstanding the foregoing, with respect to
     registration statements on Form F-3, a post-effective amendment need not be
     filed to include financial statements and information required by Section
     10(a)(3) of the Act or Rule 3-19 of this chapter if such financial
     statements and information are contained in periodic reports filed with or
     furnished to the SEC by the registrant pursuant to Section 13 or Section
     15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 that are incorporated by
     reference on the Form F-3.
 
(c) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to supply by means of a
post-effective amendment all information concerning a transaction, and the
company being acquired involved therein, that was not the subject of and
included in the registration statement when it became effective.
 
(d) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to file an application for the
purpose of determining the eligibility of the trustee to act under subsection
(a) of Section 310 of the Trust Indenture Act in accordance with the rules and
regulations prescribed by the SEC under Section 305(b)(2) of the Act.
 
(e) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that, for purposes of
determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each filing of the
registrant's annual report pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 (and, where applicable, each filing of an employee benefit
plan's annual report pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934) that is incorporated by reference in the registration statement shall be
deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered
therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be
the initial bona fide offering thereof.
 
                                      II-9
<PAGE>   238
 
                                   SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant
certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets all the
requirements for filing on Form S-4 and has duly caused this Registration
Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly
authorized, in the City of Dallas, State of Texas, on October 16, 1998.
 
                                          RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
 
                                          By:      /s/ J. ERNEST TALLEY
                                             -----------------------------------
 
                                                      J. Ernest Talley
                                                    Chairman of the Board
                                                 and Chief Executive Officer
 
                               POWER OF ATTORNEY
 
We the undersigned directors and officers of Renters Choice, Inc., do hereby
constitute and appoint J. Ernest Talley and Mark E. Speese, and each and either
of them, our true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, to do any and all
acts and things in our names and on our behalf in our capacities as directors
and officers and to execute any and all instruments for us and in our name in
the capacities indicated below, which said attorneys and agents, or either of
them, may deem necessary or advisable to enable said Corporation to comply with
the Securities Act of 1933 and any rules, regulations and requirements of the
Securities and Exchange Commission, in connection with this registration
statement, or any registration statement for this offering that is to be
effective upon filing pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of 1933,
including specifically, but without limitation, power and authority to sign for
us or any of us in our names in the capacities indicated below, any and all
amendments (including post-effective amendments) hereto; and we do hereby ratify
and confirm all that said attorneys and agents, or any of them, shall do or
cause to be done by virtue thereof.
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration
Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the
dates indicated.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                SIGNATURE                             TITLE                  DATE
                ---------                             -----                  ----
<C>                                         <S>                        <C>
 
           /s/ J. ERNEST TALLEY             Chairman of the Board and  October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------  Chief Executive Officer
             J. Ernest Talley               (Principal Executive
                                            Officer)
 
            /s/ MARK E. SPEESE              President, Chief           October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------  Operating Officer and
              Mark E. Speese                Director
 
          /s/ DANNY Z. WILBANKS             Senior Vice President --   October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------  Finance and Chief
            Danny Z. Wilbanks               Financial Officer
                                            (Principal Financial and
                                            Accounting Officer)
 
            /s/ J. V. LENTELL               Director                   October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------
               J.V. Lentell
 
          /s/ JOSEPH V. MARINER             Director                   October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------
            Joseph V. Mariner
 
           /s/ REX W. THOMPSON              Director                   October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------
             Rex W. Thompson
 
           /s/ LAURENCE M. BERG             Director                   October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------
             Laurence M. Berg
 
           /s/ PETER P. COPSES              Director                   October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------
             Peter P. Copses
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-10
<PAGE>   239
 
SUBSIDIARY GUARANTORS:
 
                                   SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant
certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets all the
requirements for filing on Form S-4 and has duly caused this Registration
Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly
authorized, in the City of Dallas, State of Texas, on October 16, 1998.
 
                                          RENT-A-CENTER, INC.
 
                                          By:      /s/ J. ERNEST TALLEY
                                             -----------------------------------
                                                      J. Ernest Talley
                                                          President
 
                               POWER OF ATTORNEY
 
We the undersigned directors and officers of Rent-A-Center, Inc., do hereby
constitute and appoint J. Ernest Talley and Mark E. Speese, and each and either
of them, our true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, to do any and all
acts and things in our names and on our behalf in our capacities as directors
and officers and to execute any and all instruments for us and in our name in
the capacities indicated below, which said attorneys and agents, or either of
them, may deem necessary or advisable to enable said Corporation to comply with
the Securities Act of 1933 and any rules, regulations and requirements of the
Securities and Exchange Commission, in connection with this registration
statement, or any registration statement for this offering that is to be
effective upon filing pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of 1933,
including specifically, but without limitation, power and authority to sign for
us or any of us in our names in the capacities indicated below, any and all
amendments (including post-effective amendments) hereto; and we do hereby ratify
and confirm all that said attorneys and agents, or any of them, shall do or
cause to be done by virtue thereof.
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration
Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the
dates indicated.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                SIGNATURE                             TITLE                  DATE
                ---------                             -----                  ----
<C>                                         <S>                        <C>
 
           /s/ J. ERNEST TALLEY             President (Principal       October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------  Executive Officer) and
             J. Ernest Talley               Director
 
            /s/ MARK E. SPEESE              Vice President and         October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------  Director
              Mark E. Speese
 
          /s/ DANNY Z. WILBANKS             Vice President,            October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------  Secretary, Treasurer
            Danny Z. Wilbanks               (Principal Financial and
                                            Accounting Officer) and
                                            Director
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-11
<PAGE>   240
 
                                   SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant
certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets all the
requirements for filing on Form S-4 and has duly caused this Registration
Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly
authorized, in the City of Dallas, State of Texas, on October 16, 1998.
 
                                          COLORTYME, INC.
 
                                          By:       /s/ MARK E. SPEESE
                                             -----------------------------------
                                                       Mark E. Speese
                                                       Vice President
 
                               POWER OF ATTORNEY
 
We the undersigned directors and officers of ColorTyme, Inc., do hereby
constitute and appoint J. Ernest Talley and Mark E. Speese, and each and either
of them, our true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, to do any and all
acts and things in our names and on our behalf in our capacities as directors
and officers and to execute any and all instruments for us and in our name in
the capacities indicated below, which said attorneys and agents, or either of
them, may deem necessary or advisable to enable said Corporation to comply with
the Securities Act of 1933 and any rules, regulations and requirements of the
Securities and Exchange Commission, in connection with this registration
statement, or any registration statement for this offering that is to be
effective upon filing pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of 1933,
including specifically, but without limitation, power and authority to sign for
us or any of us in our names in the capacities indicated below, any and all
amendments (including post-effective amendments) hereto; and we do hereby ratify
and confirm all that said attorneys and agents, or any of them, shall do or
cause to be done by virtue thereof.
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration
Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the
dates indicated.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                SIGNATURE                             TITLE                  DATE
                ---------                             -----                  ----
<C>                                         <S>                        <C>
 
          /s/ MITCHELL E. FADEL             President and Chief        October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------  Executive Officer
            Mitchell E. Fadel               (Principal Executive
                                            Officer)
 
           /s/ J. ERNEST TALLEY             Director                   October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------
             J. Ernest Talley
 
            /s/ MARK E. SPEESE              Vice President and         October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------  Director
              Mark E. Speese
 
          /s/ DANNY Z. WILBANKS             Secretary (Principal       October 16, 1998
- ------------------------------------------  Financial and Accounting
            Danny Z. Wilbanks               Officer)
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-12
<PAGE>   241
 
                                 EXHIBIT INDEX
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        EXHIBIT
         NUMBER                              EXHIBIT DESCRIPTION
        -------                              -------------------
<C>                      <S>
          1.1*           -- Purchase Agreement, dated August 13, 1998, by and among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., Chase Securities Inc., Bear,
                            Stearns & Co. Inc., Credit Suisse First Boston
                            Corporation and NationsBank Montgomery Securities LLC
          2.1(1)         -- Agreement and Plan of Reorganization dated May 15, 1996,
                            among Renters Choice, Inc., ColorTyme, Inc., and CT
                            Acquisition Corporation
          2.2(2)         -- Asset Purchase Agreement, dated May 1, 1998, by and among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., Central Rents, Inc., Central Rents
                            Holding, Inc. and Banner Holdings, Inc.
          2.3(3)         -- Letter Agreement, dated as of May 26, 1998, by and among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., Central Rents, Inc., Central Rents
                            Holding, Inc. and Banner Holdings, Inc.
          3.1(4)         -- Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the
                            Company
          3.2(5)         -- Certificate of Amendment to the Amended and Restated
                            Certificate of Incorporation of the Company
          3.3(6)         -- Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Company
          3.4(7)         -- Amendment to the Amended and Restated Bylaws of the
                            Company
          3.5**          -- Certificate of Incorporation of Rent-A-Center, Inc.
          3.6**          -- Articles of Incorporation of ColorTyme, Inc.
          3.7**          -- Bylaws of Rent-A-Center, Inc.
          3.8**          -- Bylaws of ColorTyme, Inc.
          4.1(8)         -- Form of Certificate evidencing Common Stock
          4.2(9)         -- Certificate of Designations, Preferences and Relative
                            Rights and Limitations of Series A Preferred Stock of
                            Renters Choice, Inc.
          4.3(10)        -- Certificate of Designations, Preferences and Relative
                            Rights and Limitations of Series B Preferred Stock of
                            Renters Choice, Inc.
          4.4*           -- Indenture, dated as of August 18, 1998, by and among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., as Issuer, ColorTyme, Inc. and
                            Rent-A-Center, Inc., as Subsidiary Guarantors, and IBJ
                            Schroder Bank & Trust Company, as Trustee
          4.5**          -- Form of Certificate evidencing Series A Preferred Stock
          5.1**          -- Opinion of Winstead Sechrest & Minick P.C. regarding
                            legality of the securities offered.
         10.1(11)        -- Amended and Restated 1994 Renters Choice, Inc. Long-Term
                            Incentive Plan
         10.2(12)        -- Revolving Credit Agreement dated as of November 27, 1996
                            between Comerica Bank, as agent, Renters Choice, Inc. and
                            certain other lenders
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   242
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        EXHIBIT
         NUMBER                              EXHIBIT DESCRIPTION
        -------                              -------------------
<C>                      <S>
         10.3(13)        -- Portfolio Acquisition Agreement dated May 15, 1996, by
                            and among Renters Choice, Inc., ColorTyme Financial
                            Services, Inc., and STI Credit Corporation
         10.4(14)        -- Employment Agreement, dated March 28, 1997, by and
                            between Renters Choice, Inc. and Danny Z. Wilbanks
         10.5(15)        -- Stock Option Agreement, dated April 1, 1997, by and
                            between Renters Choice, Inc. and Danny Z. Wilbanks
         10.6(16)        -- Credit Agreement, dated August 5, 1998, among Renters
                            Choice, Inc., Comerica Bank, as Documentation Agent,
                            NationsBank N.A., as Syndication Agent, and The Chase
                            Manhattan Bank, as Administrative Agent, and certain
                            other lenders
         10.7(17)        -- Guarantee and Collateral Agreement, dated August 5, 1998,
                            made by Renters Choice, Inc., and certain of its
                            Subsidiaries in favor of the Chase Manhattan Bank, as
                            Administrative Agent
         10.8(18)        -- $175,000,000 Senior Subordinated Credit Agreement, dated
                            as of August 5, 1998, among Renters Choice, Inc., certain
                            other lenders and the Chase Manhattan Bank
         10.9(19)        -- Stockholders Agreement, dated as of August 5, 1998, by
                            and among Apollo Investment Fund IV, L.P., Apollo
                            Overseas Partners IV, L.P., J. Ernest Talley, Mark E.
                            Speese, Renters Choice, Inc., and certain other persons
         10.10(20)       -- Registration Rights Agreement, dated August 5, 1998, by
                            and between Renters Choice, Inc., Apollo Investment Fund
                            IV, L.P., and Apollo Overseas Partners IV, L.P., related
                            to the Series A Convertible Preferred Stock
         10.11(21)       -- Registration Rights Agreement, dated August 5, 1998, by
                            and between Renters Choice, Inc., Apollo Investment Fund
                            IV, L.P., and Apollo Overseas Partners IV, L.P., related
                            to the Series B Convertible Preferred Stock
         10.12(22)       -- Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of June 16, 1998,
                            among Renters Choice, Inc., Thorn International BV and
                            Thorn plc
         10.13(23)       -- Stock Purchase Agreement, dated August 5, 1998, among
                            Renters Choice, Inc., Apollo Investment Fund IV, L.P. and
                            Apollo Overseas Partners IV, L.P.
         10.14*          -- Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement, dated August
                            18, 1998, by and among Renters Choice, Inc. and Chase
                            Securities Inc., Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc., NationsBank
                            Montgomery Securities LLC and Credit Suisse First Boston
                            Corporation
         21.1*           -- Subsidiaries of Registrant
         23.1*           -- Consent of Grant Thornton LLP
         23.2*           -- Consent of Ernst & Young LLP
         23.3*           -- Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP
         23.4*           -- Consent of Winstead Sechrest & Minick P.C. (included as
                            part of its opinion filed as Exhibits 5.1 and 8.1)
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   243
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        EXHIBIT
         NUMBER                              EXHIBIT DESCRIPTION
        -------                              -------------------
<C>                      <S>
         24.1*           -- Power of Attorney (included on signature page of this
                            S-4)
         25.1**          -- Statement of eligibility of IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust
                            Company to act as Trustee
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------
 
  *  Filed herewith.
 
 **  To be filed by amendment.
 
 (1) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the registrant's Current
     Report on Form 8-K dated May 15, 1996
 
 (2) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the registrant's Current
     Report on Form 8-K dated May 28, 1998
 
 (3) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.2 to the registrant's Current
     Report on Form 8-K dated May 15, 1996
 
 (4) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the registrant's Annual
     Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994
 
 (5) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 1996
 
 (6) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.4 to the registrant's Annual
     Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1994
 
 (7) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.3 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
 (8) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the registrant's
     Registration Statement on Form S-1 (File No. 33-86504)
 
 (9) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(10) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(11) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to the registrant's
     Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333- 53471)
 
(12) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the registrant's Annual
     Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996
 
(13) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the registrant's
     Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 15, 1996
 
(14) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 1997
 
(15) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 1997
 
(16) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
<PAGE>   244
 
(17) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(18) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(19) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(20) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.22 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(21) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(22) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.9 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998
 
(23) Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.10 to the registrant's
     Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1998

<PAGE>   1

                                                                     EXHIBIT 1.1

                              RENTERS CHOICE, INC.


                                  $175,000,000

                    11.00% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008

                               PURCHASE AGREEMENT

                                                                 August 13, 1998

CHASE SECURITIES INC.
BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.
CREDIT SUISSE FIRST BOSTON CORPORATION
NATIONSBANC MONTGOMERY SECURITIES LLC
c/o Chase Securities Inc.
270 Park Avenue, 4th floor
New York, New York  10017


Ladies and Gentlemen:

                  RENTERS CHOICE, INC. a Delaware corporation ("RCI" or the
"Company"), proposes to issue and sell $175,000,000 aggregate principal amount
of its 11.00% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Notes"). The Company's
obligations under the Notes will be irrevocably and unconditionally guaranteed
(each, a "Subsidiary Guarantee") by Rent-A-Center, Inc. (formerly known as Thorn
Americas, Inc., "Rent-A-Center"), and ColorTyme, Inc. ("ColorTyme", and together
with Rent-A-Center, the "Subsidiary Guarantors"). The Notes and the Subsidiary
Guarantees are collectively referred to as the "Securities". The Securities will
be issued pursuant to an Indenture to be dated as of August __, 1998 (the
"Indenture") among the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and IBJ Schroder Bank
& Trust Company, as trustee (the "Trustee"). The Company hereby confirms its
agreement with Chase Securities Inc. ("CSI"), Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. ("Bear
Stearns"), Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation ("CSFB") and NationsBanc
Montgomery Securities LLC (NationsBanc, and together with CSI, Bear Stearns and
CSFB, the "Initial Purchasers") concerning the purchase of the Securities from
the Company by the Initial Purchasers.

                  The Securities will be offered and sold to the Initial
Purchasers without being registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended
(the "Securities Act"), in reliance upon an exemption therefrom. The Company has
prepared a preliminary offering memorandum dated July 24, 1998 (the "Preliminary
Offering Memorandum") and will prepare an offering memorandum dated the date
hereof (the "Offering Memorandum") setting forth information concerning the
Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and the Securities. Copies of the Preliminary
Offering Memorandum have been, and copies of the Offering Memorandum will be,
delivered by the Company to the Initial Purchasers pursuant to the terms of this
agreement (this "Agreement"). Any references herein to the Preliminary Offering
Memorandum and the Offering Memorandum shall be deemed to include all amendments
and supplements thereto, unless otherwise noted. The Company hereby confirms
that it has authorized the use of the Preliminary Offering Memorandum and the
Offering Memorandum in connection with the offering and resale of the Securities
by the Initial Purchasers in accordance with Section 2.

                  Holders of the Securities (including the Initial Purchasers
and their direct and indirect transferees) will be entitled to the benefits of
an Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement, substantially in the form
attached hereto as Annex A (the "Registration Rights Agreement"), pursuant to
which the Company will agree to file with the Securities and Exchange Commission
(the


<PAGE>   2




                                                                               2

"Commission") (i) a registration statement under the Securities Act (the
"Exchange Offer Registration Statement") registering an issue of senior
subordinated notes of the Company (the "Exchange Securities") which are
identical in all material respects to the Securities (except that the Exchange
Securities will not contain terms with respect to transfer restrictions or
additional interest upon certain failures to comply with the Registration Rights
Agreement) and (ii) under certain circumstances, a shelf registration statement
pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act (the "Shelf Registration
Statement").

                  The Company will use the net proceeds from the Offering to
repay approximately $175 million of indebtedness of the Company represented by
the Senior Subordinated Facility. On August 5, 1998, the Company acquired
Rent-A-Center (the "Acquisition"). Proceeds from the Senior Credit Facilities,
the Senior Subordinated Facility and the Equity Investment funded the
Acquisition. Concurrently with the Offering, the Company will repurchase
approximately $25 million of its common stock.

                  Capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the
meanings given to such terms in the Offering Memorandum. As used in this
Agreement, unless the context otherwise requires: the "Company" refers to RCI
and its subsidiaries, and the related business and operations thereof, prior to
the Acquisition and to RCI and its subsidiaries (including Rent-A-Center), and
the related business and operations thereof (including the Rent-A-Center
operations), after the Acquisition.

                  1.  Representations, Warranties and Agreements of the Company.
The Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors represent and warrant to the several
Initial Purchasers on and as of the date hereof and the Closing Date (as defined
in Section 3 and after giving effect to the Acquisition) that:

                  (a) Each of the Preliminary Offering Memorandum and the
         Offering Memorandum, as of its respective date, did not, and on the
         Closing Date the Offering Memorandum will not, contain any untrue
         statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required
         to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements
         therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made,
         not misleading; provided that no representation or warranty is made as
         to information contained in or omitted from the Preliminary Offering
         Memorandum or the Offering Memorandum in reliance upon and in
         conformity with written information relating to the Initial Purchasers
         furnished to the Company by or on behalf of any Initial Purchaser
         specifically for use therein (collectively, the "Initial Purchasers'
         Information").

                  (b) Each of the Preliminary Offering Memorandum and the
         Offering Memorandum, as of its respective date, contains all of the
         information that, if requested by a prospective purchaser of the
         Securities, would be required to be provided to such prospective
         purchaser pursuant to Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Act.

                  (c) Assuming the accuracy of the representations and
         warranties of the Initial Purchasers contained in Section 2 and their
         compliance with the agreements set forth therein, it is not necessary,
         in connection with the issuance and sale of the Securities to the
         Initial Purchasers and the offer, resale and delivery of the Securities
         by the Initial Purchasers in the manner contemplated by this Agreement
         and the Offering Memorandum, to register the Securities under the
         Securities Act or to qualify the Indenture under the Trust Indenture
         Act of 1939, as amended (the "Trust Indenture Act").

                  (d) The Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and each of their
         respective subsidiaries have been duly incorporated and are validly
         existing as corporations in good standing under the laws of their
         respective jurisdictions of incorporation, are duly qualified to do
         business and are in good standing as foreign corporations in each
         jurisdiction in which their respective ownership or lease of property
         or the conduct of their respective businesses requires such
         qualification, and have all power and authority necessary to own or
         hold their 



<PAGE>   3

                                                                               3



         respective properties and to conduct the businesses in which they are
         engaged, except where the failure to so qualify or have such power or
         authority would not, singularly or in the aggregate, have a material
         adverse effect on the condition (financial or otherwise), results of
         operations, business or prospects of the Company, the Subsidiary
         Guarantors and their respective subsidiaries taken as a whole (a
         "Material Adverse Effect").

                  (e) The Company will, on the Closing Date, have capitalization
         as set forth in the Offering Memorandum under the heading
         "Capitalization"; and all of the outstanding shares of capital stock of
         the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors have been duly and validly
         authorized and issued and are fully paid and non-assessable. All of the
         outstanding shares of capital stock of each subsidiary of the Company
         have been duly and validly authorized and issued, are fully paid and
         non-assessable and are owned directly or indirectly by the Company and
         the Subsidiary Guarantors, respectively, free and clear of any lien,
         charge, encumbrance, security interest, restriction upon voting or
         transfer or any other claim of any third party, except as otherwise
         disclosed in the Offering Memorandum.

                  (f) Each of the Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor has full
         right, power and authority to execute and deliver this Agreement, the
         Indenture, the Registration Rights Agreement, the Securities and the
         Subsidiary Guarantees (collectively, the "Transaction Documents") to
         which it is a party and to perform its obligations hereunder and
         thereunder; and all corporate action required to be taken for the due
         and proper authorization, execution and delivery of each of the
         Transaction Documents to which it is a party and the consummation of
         the transactions contemplated thereby have been duly and validly taken.

                  (g) This Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and
         delivered by the Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor party hereto and
         constitutes a valid and binding agreement of the Company and each
         Subsidiary Guarantor party hereto.

                  (h) The Registration Rights Agreement has been duly authorized
         by the Company and, when duly executed and delivered in accordance with
         its terms by each of the parties thereto, will constitute a valid and
         binding agreement of the Company enforceable against the Company in
         accordance with its terms, except to the extent that such
         enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency,
         fraudulent conveyance, reorganization, moratorium and other similar
         laws affecting creditors' rights generally and by general equitable
         principles (whether considered in a proceeding in equity or at law).

                  (i) The Indenture has been duly authorized by the Company and
         the Subsidiary Guarantors and, when duly executed and delivered in
         accordance with its terms by each of the parties thereto, will
         constitute a valid and binding agreement of the Company and each
         Subsidiary Guarantor enforceable against the Company and each
         Subsidiary Guarantor in accordance with its terms, except to the extent
         that such enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy,
         insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization, moratorium and other
         similar laws affecting creditors' rights generally and by general
         equitable principles (whether considered in a proceeding in equity or
         at law). On the Closing Date, the Indenture will conform in all
         material respects to the requirements of the Trust Indenture Act and
         the rules and regulations of the Commission applicable to an indenture
         which is qualified thereunder.

                  (j) The Securities and the Exchange Securities have been duly
         authorized by the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors and, when duly
         executed, authenticated, issued and delivered as provided in the
         Indenture and paid for as provided herein, will be duly and validly
         issued and outstanding and will constitute valid and binding
         obligations of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors entitled to
         the benefits of the Indenture and enforceable against the Company and
         the Subsidiary Guarantors in accordance with their terms, except to the
         extent that such enforceability may be limited by applicable
         bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization,
         moratorium and other similar laws


<PAGE>   4

                                                                               4




         affecting creditors' rights generally and by general equitable
         principles (whether considered in a proceeding in equity or at law).

                  (k) Each Transaction Document conforms in all material
         respects to the description thereof contained in the Offering
         Memorandum.

                  (l) The execution, delivery and performance by the Company and
         each Subsidiary Guarantor of each of the Transaction Documents to which
         it is a party, the issuance, authentication, sale and delivery of the
         Securities and compliance by the Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor
         with the terms thereof and the consummation of the transactions
         contemplated by the Transaction Documents to which it is a party will
         not conflict with or result in a breach or violation of any of the
         terms or provisions of, or constitute a default under, or result in the
         creation or imposition of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any
         property or assets of the Company or the Subsidiary Guarantors pursuant
         to, any material indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement or
         other material agreement or instrument to which the Company or any
         Subsidiary Guarantor is a party or by which the Company or any
         Subsidiary Guarantor is bound or to which any of the property or assets
         of the Company or any of Subsidiary Guarantor is subject, nor will such
         actions result in any violation of the provisions of the charter or
         by-laws of the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor or any statute or
         any judgment, order, decree, rule or regulation of any court or
         arbitrator or governmental agency or body having jurisdiction over the
         Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor or any of their properties or
         assets; and no consent, approval, authorization or order of, or filing
         or registration with, any such court or arbitrator or governmental
         agency or body under any such statute, judgment, order, decree, rule or
         regulation is required for the execution, delivery and performance by
         the Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor of each of the Transaction
         Documents to which it is a party, the issuance, authentication, sale
         and delivery of the Securities and compliance by the Company and each
         Subsidiary Guarantor with the terms thereof and the consummation of the
         transactions contemplated by the Transaction Documents to which it is a
         party, except for such consents, approvals, authorizations, filings,
         registrations or qualifications (i) which shall have been obtained or
         made prior to the Closing Date, (ii) as may be required to be obtained
         or made under the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws
         as provided in the Registration Rights Agreement and (iii) which shall
         not adversely affect the ability of the Company and each Subsidiary
         Guarantor to consummate the transactions contemplated by the
         Transaction Documents.

                  (m) (i) Grant Thornton LLP are independent certified public
         accountants with respect to the Company and its subsidiaries, (ii)
         Arthur Andersen LLP are independent certified public accountants with
         respect to Central Rents, Inc. ("Central Rents") and (iii) Ernst &
         Young LLP are independent public accountants with respect to Thorn
         Americas, Inc., each within the meaning of Rule 101 of the Code of
         Professional Conduct of the American Institute of Certified Public
         Accountants ("AICPA") and its interpretations and rulings thereunder.
         The historical financial statements (including the related notes)
         contained in the Offering Memorandum comply in all material respects
         with the requirements applicable to a registration statement on Form
         S-1 under the Securities Act; such financial statements have been
         prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles
         consistently applied throughout the periods covered thereby and fairly
         present the financial position of the entities purported to be covered
         thereby at the respective dates indicated and the results of their
         operations and their cash flows for the respective periods indicated;
         and the financial information contained in the Offering Memorandum
         under the headings "Summary--Summary Unaudited Pro Forma Combined
         Statement of Operations", "Summary--Summary Historical Financial Data",
         "Capitalization", "Selected Historical Financial Data", "Management's
         Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
         Operations" and Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Financial Information", is
         derived from the accounting records of the Company, Rent-A-Center and
         their respective subsidiaries, as the case may be, and such sections of
         the Offering Memorandum fairly present the information purported



<PAGE>   5

                                                                               5

         to be shown thereby in all material respects. The pro forma financial
         information contained in the Offering Memorandum has been prepared on a
         basis consistent with the historical financial statements contained in
         the Offering Memorandum (except for the pro forma adjustments specified
         therein), includes all material adjustments to the historical financial
         information required by Rule 11-02 of Regulation S-X under the
         Securities Act and the Exchange Act to reflect the transactions
         described in the Offering Memorandum, gives effect to assumptions made
         on a reasonable basis and fairly presents the historical and proposed
         transactions contemplated by the Offering Memorandum and the
         Transaction Documents in all material respects. The other historical
         financial and statistical information and data included in the Offering
         Memorandum are, in all material respects, fairly presented.

                  (n) Except as otherwise stated in the Offering Memorandum,
         there are no legal or governmental proceedings pending to which the
         Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor is a party or of which any property
         or assets of the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor is the subject
         which, singularly or in the aggregate, if determined adversely to the
         Company or any of its subsidiaries, could reasonably be expected to
         have a Material Adverse Effect; and to the best knowledge of the
         Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor, no such proceedings are
         threatened or contemplated by governmental authorities or threatened by
         others.

                  (o) No action has been taken and no statute, rule, regulation
         or order has been enacted, adopted or issued by any governmental agency
         or body which prevents the issuance of the Securities or suspends the
         sale of the Securities in any jurisdiction; no injunction, restraining
         order or order of any nature by any federal or state court of competent
         jurisdiction has been issued with respect to the Company or any
         Subsidiary Guarantor which would prevent or suspend the issuance or
         sale of the Securities or the use of the Offering Memorandum in any
         jurisdiction; no action, suit or proceeding is pending against or, to
         the knowledge of the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor after
         reasonable due inquiry, threatened against or affecting the Company or
         any Subsidiary Guarantor before any court or arbitrator or any
         governmental agency, body or official, domestic or foreign, which could
         reasonably be expected to interfere with or adversely affect the
         issuance of the Securities or in any manner draw into question the
         validity or enforceability of any of the Transaction Documents or any
         action taken or to be taken pursuant thereto; and the Company and each
         Subsidiary Guarantor have complied with any and all requests by any
         securities authority in any jurisdiction for additional information to
         be included in the Preliminary Offering Memorandum and the Offering
         Memorandum.

                  (p) Neither the Company nor any Subsidiary Guarantor is (i) in
         violation of its charter or by-laws, (ii) in default in any material
         respect, and no event has occurred which, with notice or lapse of time
         or both, would constitute such a default, in the due performance or
         observance of any term, covenant or condition contained in any material
         indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement or other material
         agreement or instrument to which it is a party or by which it is bound
         or to which any of its property or assets is subject or (iii) in
         violation in any material respect of any material law, ordinance,
         governmental rule, regulation or court decree to which it or its
         property or assets may be subject.

                  (q) The Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors possess all
         material licenses, certificates, authorizations and permits issued by,
         and have made all declarations and filings with, the appropriate
         federal, state or foreign regulatory agencies or bodies which are
         necessary or desirable for the ownership of their respective properties
         or the conduct of their respective businesses as described in the
         Offering Memorandum, except where the failure to possess or make the
         same would not, singularly or in the aggregate, have a Material Adverse
         Effect, and neither the Company nor any Subsidiary Guarantor has
         received notification of any revocation or modification of any such
         license, certificate, authorization or permit or has any reason to
         believe that any such license, certificate, authorization or permit
         will not be renewed in the ordinary course.



<PAGE>   6

                                                                               6


                  (r) The Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors have filed all
         federal, state, local and foreign income and franchise tax returns
         required to be filed through the date hereof and have paid all taxes
         due thereon, except such returns, which individually or in the
         aggregate, do not involve material amounts or where the failure to file
         such returns by the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors, as the case
         may be, would not, individually or in the aggregate, materially
         adversely affect the business, operations or prospects of such entity,
         and no tax deficiency has been determined adversely to the Company or
         any Subsidiary Guarantor, as the case may be, which has had (nor does
         the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor have any knowledge of any tax
         deficiency which, if determined adversely to the Company or any
         Subsidiary Guarantor, as the case may be, could reasonably be expected
         to have) a Material Adverse Effect, except to the extent that the
         validity thereof is being contested in good faith pursuant to
         appropriate proceedings.

                  (s) Neither the Company nor any Subsidiary Guarantor is (i) an
         "investment company" or a company "controlled by" an investment company
         within the meaning of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended
         (the "Investment Company Act"), and the rules and regulations of the
         Commission thereunder or (ii) a "holding company" or a "subsidiary
         company" of a holding company or an "affiliate" thereof within the
         meaning of the Public Utility Holding Company Act of 1935, as amended.

                  (t) The Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors maintain a
         system of internal accounting controls sufficient to provide reasonable
         assurance that (i) transactions are executed in accordance with
         management's general or specific authorizations; (ii) transactions are
         recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in
         conformity with generally accepted accounting principles and to
         maintain asset accountability; (iii) access to assets is permitted only
         in accordance with management's general or specific authorization; and
         (iv) the recorded accountability for assets is compared with the
         existing assets at reasonable intervals and appropriate action is taken
         with respect to any differences.

                  (u) The Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors maintain
         insurance of the types and in the amounts generally deemed adequate for
         their businesses and consistent with insurance coverage maintained by
         similar companies and businesses, all of which insurance is in full
         force and effect.

                  (v) The Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors own or possess
         adequate rights to use all material patents, patent applications,
         trademarks, service marks, trade names, trademark registrations,
         service mark registrations, copyrights, licenses and know-how
         (including trade secrets and other unpatented and/or unpatentable
         proprietary or confidential information, systems or procedures)
         necessary for the conduct of their respective businesses; and the
         Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors have not received any notice of
         any claim of conflict with, any such rights of others, except for such
         notices of conflicts, which, if individually or in the aggregate
         determined adversely to the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor, as the
         case may be, would not have a Material Adverse Effect.

                  (w) The Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors have good and
         marketable title to, or have valid rights to lease or otherwise use,
         all items of real and personal property which are material to the
         business of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors, in each case
         free and clear of all liens, encumbrances, claims and defects and
         imperfections of title except such as (i) do not materially interfere
         with the use made and proposed to be made of such property by the
         Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors or (ii) could not reasonably be
         expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

                  (x) No strike or work stoppages by the employees of the
         Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor exists or, to the Company's or any
         Subsidiary Guarantor's knowledge after reasonable due inquiry, is
         contemplated or threatened.


<PAGE>   7


                                                                               7

                  (y) No "prohibited transaction" (as defined in Section 406 of
         the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended,
         including the regulations and published interpretations thereunder
         ("ERISA"), or Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
         amended from time to time (the "Code")) or "accumulated funding
         deficiency" (as defined in Section 302 of ERISA) or any of the events
         set forth in Section 4043(b) of ERISA (other than events with respect
         to which the 30-day notice requirement under Section 4043 of ERISA has
         been waived) has occurred with respect to any employee benefit plan of
         the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor which could reasonably be
         expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; each such employee benefit
         plan is in compliance in all material respects with applicable law,
         including ERISA and the Code; the Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor
         have not incurred and do not expect to incur liability under Title IV
         of ERISA with respect to the termination of, or withdrawal from, any
         pension plan for which the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor would
         have any liability; and each such pension plan that is intended to be
         qualified under Section 401(a) of the Code is so qualified in all
         material respects and nothing has occurred, whether by action or by
         failure to act, which could reasonably be expected to cause the loss of
         such qualification.

                  (z) There has been no storage, generation, transportation,
         handling, treatment, disposal, discharge, emission or other release of
         any kind of toxic or other wastes or other hazardous substances by, due
         to or caused by the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor upon any of the
         property now or, to the knowledge of the Company or any Subsidiary
         Guarantor, as the case may be, previously owned or leased by the
         Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor, in violation of any statute or any
         ordinance, rule, regulation, order, judgment, decree or permit or which
         would, under any statute or any ordinance, rule (including rule of
         common law), regulation, order, judgment, decree or permit, give rise
         to any liability, except for any violation or liability which could not
         reasonably be expected to have, singularly or in the aggregate with all
         such violations and liabilities, a Material Adverse Effect; and there
         has been no disposal, discharge, emission or other release of any kind
         onto such property or into the environment surrounding such property of
         any toxic or other wastes or other hazardous substances with respect to
         which the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor has knowledge, except for
         any such disposal, discharge, emission or other release of any kind
         which could not reasonably be expected to have, singularly or in the
         aggregate with all such discharges and other releases, a Material
         Adverse Effect.

                  (aa) Neither the Company nor any Subsidiary Guarantor nor, to
         the Company's or any Subsidiary Guarantor's knowledge after reasonable
         due inquiry, any employee or agent of the Company, or any Subsidiary
         Guarantor or has intentionally made any payment of funds of the Company
         or any Subsidiary Guarantor, as the case may be, or used, received or
         retained any funds in violation of the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of
         1977.

                  (bb) On and immediately after the Closing Date, the Company
         and each Subsidiary Guarantor (after giving effect to the issuance of
         the Securities and to the other transactions related thereto as
         described in the Offering Memorandum) will be Solvent. As used in this
         paragraph, the term "Solvent" means, with respect to a particular date,
         that on such date (i) the present fair market value (or present fair
         saleable value) of the assets of the Company and of each Subsidiary
         Guarantor is not less than the total amount required to pay the
         probable liabilities of the Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor on its
         total existing debts and liabilities (including contingent liabilities)
         as they become absolute and matured, (ii) each of the Company and the
         Subsidiary Guarantors is able to realize upon its assets and pay its
         debts and other liabilities, contingent obligations and commitments as
         they mature and become due in the normal course of business, (iii)
         assuming the sale of the Securities as contemplated by this Agreement
         and the Offering Memorandum, each of the Company and the Subsidiary
         Guarantors is not incurring debts or liabilities beyond its ability to
         pay as such debts and liabilities mature and (iv) the Company and each
         Subsidiary Guarantor is not engaged in any business or transaction, and
         is not about to engage in any business or transaction, for which its
         property would constitute unreasonably small capital after giving


<PAGE>   8


                                                                               8


         due consideration to the prevailing practice in the industry in which
         the Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor is engaged. In computing the
         amount of such contingent liabilities at any time, it is intended that
         such liabilities will be computed at the amount that, in the light of
         all the facts and circumstances existing at such time, represents the
         amount that can reasonably be expected to become an actual or matured
         liability.

                  (cc) Neither the Company nor any Subsidiary Guarantor owns any
         "margin securities" as that term is defined in Regulations G and U of
         the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the "Federal
         Reserve Board"), and none of the proceeds of the sale of the Securities
         will be used, directly or indirectly, for the purpose of purchasing or
         carrying any margin security, for the purpose of reducing or retiring
         any indebtedness which was originally incurred to purchase or carry any
         margin security or for any other purpose which might cause any of the
         Securities to be considered a "purpose credit" within the meanings of
         Regulation G, T, U or X of the Federal Reserve Board.

                  (dd) Except as contemplated by this Agreement, neither the
         Company nor any Subsidiary Guarantor is a party to any contract,
         agreement or understanding with any person that would give rise to a
         valid claim against the Company, any Subsidiary Guarantor or the
         Initial Purchasers for a brokerage commission, finder's fee or like
         payment in connection with the offering and sale of the Securities.

                  (ee) The Securities (i) will not, when issued, be of the same
         class as securities listed on a national securities exchange registered
         under Section 6 of the Exchange Act or quoted in an automated
         inter-dealer quotation system; provided, that securities that are
         convertible or exchangeable into securities so listed or quoted at the
         time of issuance and that had an effective conversion premium of less
         than 10%, shall be treated as securities of the class into which they
         are convertible or exchangeable; and that warrants that may be
         exercised for securities so listed or quoted at the time of issuance,
         or that had an effective exercise premium of less than 10%, shall be
         treated as securities of the class to be issued upon exercise; and
         provided further that the Commission may from time to time, taking into
         account then-existing market practices, designate additional securities
         and classes of securities that will not be deemed of the same class as
         securities listed on a national securities exchange or quoted in a U.S.
         automated inter-dealer quotation system, and (ii) are not securities of
         an open-end investment company, unit investment trust or face-amount
         certificate company that is or is required to be registered under
         Section 8 of the Investment Company Act.

                  (ff) Assuming the accuracy of the representations and
         warranties of the Initial Purchasers set forth in Section 2 hereof,
         none of the Company, any of the Subsidiary Guarantors, any of their
         respective affiliates or any person acting on its or their behalf has
         engaged or will engage in any directed selling efforts (as such term is
         defined in Regulation S under the Securities Act ("Regulation S")), and
         all such persons have complied and will comply with the offering
         restrictions requirement of Regulation S to the extent applicable.

                  (gg) Assuming the accuracy of the representations and
         warranties of the Initial Purchasers set forth in Section 2 hereof,
         neither the Company nor any of the Subsidiary Guarantors nor any of
         their affiliates has, directly or through any agent, sold, offered for
         sale, solicited offers to buy or otherwise negotiated in respect of,
         any security (as such term is defined in the Securities Act) which is
         or will be integrated with the sale of the Securities in a manner that
         would require registration of the Securities under the Securities Act.

                  (hh) Assuming the accuracy of the representations and
         warranties of the Initial Purchasers set forth in Section 2 hereof,
         none of the Company, any of the Subsidiary Guarantors, or any of their
         respective affiliates or any other person acting on its or their behalf
         has engaged, in connection with the offering of the Securities, in any
         form of general solicitation or general advertising within the meaning
         of Rule 502(c) under the Securities Act.



<PAGE>   9


                                                                               9




                  (ii) Assuming the accuracy of the representations and
         warranties of the Initial Purchasers set forth in Section 2 hereof, the
         Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor has not taken and will not take,
         directly or indirectly, any action prohibited by Regulation M under the
         Exchange Act in connection with the offering of the Securities.

                  (jj) No forward-looking statement (within the meaning of
         Section 27A of the Securities Act and Section 21E of the Exchange Act)
         contained in the Preliminary Offering Memorandum or the Offering
         Memorandum has been made or reaffirmed without, in light of the
         circumstances under which such statements were made, a reasonable basis
         or has been disclosed other than in good faith.

                  (kk) None of the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor does
         business with the government of Cuba or with any person or affiliate
         located in Cuba within the meaning of Florida Statutes Section 517.075.

                  (ll) Since the date as of which information is given in the
         Offering Memorandum, except as otherwise stated therein, (i) there has
         been no material adverse change or any development involving a
         prospective material adverse change in the condition, financial or
         otherwise, or in the earnings, business affairs, management or business
         prospects of the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor, whether or not
         arising in the ordinary course of business, (ii) the Company and the
         Subsidiary Guarantor have not incurred any material liability or
         obligation, direct or contingent, other than in the ordinary course of
         business, (iii) the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors have not
         entered into any material transaction other than in the ordinary course
         of business and (iv) there has not been any change in the capital stock
         or long-term debt of the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor, or any
         dividend or distribution of any kind declared, paid or made by the
         Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor on any class of its capital stock.

                  2. Purchase and Resale of the Securities. (a) On the basis of
the representations, warranties and agreements contained herein, and subject to
the terms and conditions set forth herein, the Company agrees to issue and sell
to each of the Initial Purchasers, severally and not jointly, and each of the
Initial Purchasers, severally and not jointly, agrees to purchase from the
Company, the principal amount of Securities set forth opposite the name of such
Initial Purchaser on Schedule 1 hereto at a purchase price equal to 97.25% of
the principal amount thereof. The Company shall not be obligated to deliver any
of the Securities except upon payment for all of the Securities to be purchased
as provided herein.

                  (b) The Initial Purchasers have advised the Company that they
propose to offer the Securities for resale upon the terms and subject to the
conditions set forth herein and in the Offering Memorandum. Each Initial
Purchaser, severally and not jointly, represents, warrants and agrees that (i)
it is purchasing the Securities pursuant to a private sale exempt from
registration under the Securities Act, (ii) it has not solicited offers for, or
offered or sold, and will not solicit offers for, or offer or sell, the
Securities by means of any form of general solicitation or general advertising
within the meaning of Rule 502(c) of Regulation D under the Securities Act
("Regulation D") or in any manner involving a public offering within the meaning
of Section 4(2) of the Securities Act and (iii) it has solicited and will
solicit offers for the Securities only from, and has offered or sold and will
offer, sell or deliver the Securities, as part of their initial offering, only
(A) within the United States to persons whom it reasonably believes to be
qualified institutional buyers ("Qualified Institutional Buyers"), as defined in
Rule 144A under the Securities Act ("Rule 144A"), or if any such person is
buying for one or more institutional accounts for which such person is acting as
fiduciary or agent, only when such person has represented to it that each such
account is a Qualified Institutional Buyer to whom notice has been given that
such sale or delivery is being made in reliance on Rule 144A and in each case,
in transactions in accordance with Rule 144A and (B) outside the United States
to persons other than U.S. persons in reliance on Regulation S under the
Securities Act ("Regulation S").



<PAGE>   10


                                                                              10




                  (c) In connection with the offer and sale of Securities in
reliance on Regulation S, each Initial Purchaser, severally and not jointly,
represents, warrants and agrees that:

                  (i) the Securities have not been registered under the
         Securities Act and may not be offered or sold within the United States
         or to, or for the account or benefit of, U.S. persons except pursuant
         to an exemption from, or in transactions not subject to, the
         registration requirements of the Securities Act;

                  (ii) such Initial Purchaser has offered and sold the
         Securities, and will offer and sell the Securities, (A) as part of
         their distribution at any time and (B) otherwise until 40 days after
         the later of the commencement of the offering of the Securities and the
         Closing Date, only in accordance with Regulation S or Rule 144A or any
         other available exemption from registration under the Securities Act;

                  (iii) neither of such Initial Purchaser nor any of its
         affiliates nor any other person acting on its or their behalf has
         engaged or will engage in any directed selling efforts with respect to
         the Securities, and all such persons have complied and will comply with
         the offering restrictions requirement of Regulation S;

                  (iv) at or prior to the confirmation of sale of any Securities
         sold in reliance on Regulation S, such Initial Purchaser will have sent
         to each distributor, dealer or other person receiving a selling
         concession, fee or other remuneration that purchases Securities from it
         during the restricted period a confirmation or notice to substantially
         the following effect:

                  "The Securities covered hereby have not been registered under
                  the U.S. Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities
                  Act"), and may not be offered or sold within the United States
                  or to, or for the account or benefit of, U.S. persons (i) as
                  part of their distribution at any time or (ii) otherwise until
                  40 days after the later of the commencement of the offering of
                  the Securities and the date of original issuance of the
                  Securities, except in accordance with Regulation S or Rule
                  144A or any other available exemption from registration under
                  the Securities Act. Terms used above have the meanings given
                  to them by Regulation S."; and

                  (v) such Initial Purchaser has not and will not enter into any
         contractual arrangement with any distributor with respect to the
         distribution of the Securities, except with its affiliates or with the
         prior written consent of the Company.

Terms used in this Section 2(c) have the meanings given to them by Regulation S.

                  (d) Each Initial Purchaser, severally and not jointly,
represents, warrants and agrees that (i) such Initial Purchaser has not offered
or sold and prior to the date six months after the Closing Date will not offer
or sell any Securities to persons in the United Kingdom except to persons whose
ordinary activities involve them in acquiring, holding, managing or disposing of
investments (as principal or agent) for the purposes of their businesses or
otherwise in circumstances which have not resulted and will not result in an
offer to the public in the United Kingdom within the meaning of the Public
Offers of Securities Regulations 1995; (ii) such Initial Purchaser has complied
and will comply with all applicable provisions of the Financial Services Act
1986 and the Public Offers of Securities Regulations 1995 with respect to
anything done by it in relation to the Securities in, from or otherwise
involving the United Kingdom; and (iii) such Initial Purchaser has only issued
or passed on and will only issue or pass on in the United Kingdom any document
received by it in connection with the issue of the Securities to a person who is
of a kind described in Article 11(3) of the Financial Services Act 1986
(Investment Advertisements) (Exemptions) Order 1996 or is a person to whom such
document may otherwise lawfully be issued or passed on.

                  (e) Each Initial Purchaser, severally and not jointly, agrees
that, prior to or simultaneously with the confirmation of sale by such Initial
Purchaser to any purchaser of any of the


<PAGE>   11

                                                                              11


Securities purchased by such Initial Purchaser from the Company pursuant hereto,
such Initial Purchaser shall furnish to that purchaser a copy of the Offering
Memorandum (and any amendment or supplement thereto that the Company shall have
furnished to such Initial Purchaser prior to the date of such confirmation of
sale). In addition to the foregoing, each Initial Purchaser acknowledges and
agrees that the Company and, for purposes of the opinions to be delivered to the
Initial Purchasers pursuant to Sections 5(d) and (e), counsel for the Company
and for the Initial Purchasers, respectively, may rely upon the accuracy of the
representations and warranties of the Initial Purchasers and their compliance
with their agreements contained in this Section 2, and each Initial Purchaser
hereby consents to such reliance.

                  (f) The Company acknowledges and agrees that the Initial
Purchasers may sell Securities to any affiliate of an Initial Purchaser and that
any such affiliate may sell Securities purchased by such affiliate to an Initial
Purchaser.

                  3. Delivery of and Payment for the Securities. (a) Delivery of
and payment for the Securities shall be made at the offices of Simpson Thacher &
Bartlett, New York, New York, or at such other place as shall be agreed upon by
the Initial Purchasers and the Company, at 9:30 A.M., New York City time, on
August 18, 1998, or at such other time or date, not later than seven full
business days thereafter, as shall be agreed upon by the Initial Purchasers and
the Company (such date and time of payment and delivery being referred to herein
as the "Closing Date").

                  (b) On the Closing Date, payment of the purchase price for the
Securities shall be made to the Company by wire or book-entry transfer of
same-day funds to such account or accounts as the Company shall specify prior to
the Closing Date or by such other means as the parties hereto shall agree prior
to the Closing Date against delivery to the Initial Purchasers of the
certificates evidencing the Securities. Time shall be of the essence, and
delivery at the time and place specified pursuant to this Agreement is a further
condition of the obligations of the Initial Purchasers hereunder. Upon delivery,
the Securities shall be in global form, registered in such names and in such
denominations as CSI on behalf of the Initial Purchasers shall have requested in
writing not less than two full business days prior to the Closing Date. The
Company agrees to make one or more global certificates evidencing the Securities
available for inspection by CSI on behalf of the Initial Purchasers in New York,
New York at least 24 hours prior to the Closing Date.


                  4. Further Agreements of the Company and the Subsidiary
Guarantors. The Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors agree with each of the
Initial Purchasers:

                  (a) to advise the Initial Purchasers promptly and, if
         requested, confirm such advice in writing, of the happening of any
         event which makes any statement of a material fact made in the Offering
         Memorandum untrue or which requires the making of any additions to or
         changes in the Offering Memorandum (as amended or supplemented from
         time to time) in order to make the statements therein, in the light of
         the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading; to advise
         the Initial Purchasers promptly of any order preventing or suspending
         the use of the Offering Memorandum, of any suspension of the
         qualification of the Securities for offering or sale in any
         jurisdiction and of the initiation or threatening of any proceeding for
         any such purpose; and to use its best efforts to prevent the issuance
         of any such order preventing or suspending the use of the Offering
         Memorandum or suspending any such qualification and, if any such
         suspension is issued, to obtain the lifting thereof at the earliest
         possible time;

                  (b) to furnish promptly to each of the Initial Purchasers and
         counsel for the Initial Purchasers, without charge, as many copies of
         the Offering Memorandum (and any amendments or supplements thereto) as
         may be reasonably requested;

                  (c) prior to making any amendment or supplement to the
         Offering Memorandum, to furnish a copy thereof to each of the Initial
         Purchasers and counsel for the Initial Purchasers


<PAGE>   12


                                                                              12



         and not to effect any such amendment or supplement to which the Initial
         Purchasers shall reasonably object by notice to the Company after a
         reasonable period to review;

                  (d) if, at any time prior to completion of the resale of the
         Securities by the Initial Purchasers, any event shall occur or
         condition exist as a result of which it is necessary, in the opinion of
         counsel for the Initial Purchasers or counsel for the Company, to amend
         or supplement the Offering Memorandum in order that the Offering
         Memorandum will not include an untrue statement of a material fact or
         omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements
         therein, in the light of the circumstances existing at the time it is
         delivered to a purchaser, not misleading, or if it is necessary to
         amend or supplement the Offering Memorandum to comply with applicable
         law, to promptly prepare such amendment or supplement as may be
         necessary to correct such untrue statement or omission or so that the
         Offering Memorandum, as so amended or supplemented, will comply with
         applicable law;

                  (e) for so long as the Securities are outstanding and are
         "restricted securities" within the meaning of Rule 144(a)(3) under the
         Securities Act, to furnish to holders of the Securities and prospective
         purchasers of the Securities designated by such holders, upon request
         of such holders or such prospective purchasers, the information
         required to be delivered pursuant to Rule 144A(d)(4) under the
         Securities Act, unless the Company is then subject to and in compliance
         with Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act (the foregoing agreement
         being for the benefit of the holders from time to time of the
         Securities and prospective purchasers of the Securities designated by
         such holders);

                  (f) for a three-year period ending on the third anniversary of
         the Closing Date, to furnish to the Initial Purchasers copies of any
         annual reports, quarterly reports and current reports filed by the
         Company with the Commission on Forms 10-K, 10-Q and 8-K, or such other
         similar forms as may be designated by the Commission, and such other
         documents, reports and information as shall be furnished by the Company
         to the Trustee or to the holders of the Securities pursuant to the
         Indenture or the Exchange Act or any rule or regulation of the
         Commission thereunder;

                  (g) to promptly take from time to time such actions as the
         Initial Purchasers may reasonably request to qualify the Securities for
         offering and sale under the securities or Blue Sky laws of such
         jurisdictions in the United States as the Initial Purchasers may
         reasonably designate and to continue such qualifications in effect for
         so long as required for the resale of the Securities; and to arrange
         for the determination of the eligibility for investment of the
         Securities under the laws of such jurisdictions as the Initial
         Purchasers may reasonably request; provided that the Company and its
         subsidiaries will not be required to qualify generally to do business
         in any jurisdiction where it is not then so qualified or to take any
         action which would subject it to general service of process or to
         taxation in any such jurisdiction where it is not then so subject;

                  (h) to assist the Initial Purchasers in arranging for the
         Securities to be designated Private Offerings, Resales and Trading
         through Automated Linkages ("PORTAL") Market securities in accordance
         with the rules and regulations adopted by the National Association of
         Securities Dealers, Inc. ("NASD") relating to trading in the PORTAL
         Market and for the Securities to be eligible for clearance and
         settlement through The Depository Trust Company ("DTC");

                  (i) not to, and to cause its affiliates not to, sell, offer
         for sale or solicit offers to buy or otherwise negotiate in respect of
         any security (as such term is defined in the Securities Act) which
         could be integrated with the sale of the Securities in a manner which
         would require registration of the Securities under the Securities Act;



<PAGE>   13


                                                                              13


                  (j) except following the effectiveness of the Exchange Offer
         Registration Statement or the Shelf Registration Statement, as the case
         may be, not to, and to cause its affiliates not to, and not to
         authorize or knowingly permit any person acting on their behalf to,
         solicit any offer to buy or offer to sell the Securities by means of
         any form of general solicitation or general advertising within the
         meaning of Regulation D or in any manner involving a public offering
         within the meaning of Section 4(2) of the Securities Act; and not to
         offer, sell, contract to sell or otherwise dispose of, directly or
         indirectly, any securities under circumstances where such offer, sale,
         contract or disposition would cause the exemption afforded by Section
         4(2) of the Securities Act to cease to be applicable to the offering
         and sale of the Securities as contemplated by this Agreement and the
         Offering Memorandum;

                  (k) from the date hereof and until the earlier of (i) 180 days
         after the date of the Offering Memorandum or (ii) the consummation of
         the Exchange Offer, not to offer for sale, sell, contract to sell or
         otherwise dispose of, directly or indirectly, or file a registration
         statement for, or announce any offer, sale, contract for sale of or
         other disposition of any debt securities issued or guaranteed by the
         Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor (other than the Securities) without
         the prior written consent of the Initial Purchasers;

                  (l) during the period from the Closing Date until two years
         after the Closing Date, without the prior written consent of the
         Initial Purchasers, not to, and not permit any of its affiliates (as
         defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act) to, resell any of the
         Securities that have been reacquired by them, except for Securities
         purchased by the Company or any of its affiliates and resold in a
         transaction registered under the Securities Act;

                  (m) not to, for so long as the Securities are outstanding, be
         or become, or be or become owned by, an open-end investment company,
         unit investment trust or face-amount certificate company that is or is
         required to be registered under Section 8 of the Investment Company
         Act, and to not be or become, or be or become owned by, a closed-end
         investment company required to be registered, but not registered
         thereunder;

                  (n) in connection with the offering of the Securities, until
         CSI on behalf of the Initial Purchasers shall have notified the Company
         of the completion of the resale of the Securities, not to, and to cause
         its affiliated purchasers (as defined in Regulation M under the
         Exchange Act) not to, either alone or with one or more other persons,
         bid for or purchase, for any account in which it or any of its
         affiliated purchasers has a beneficial interest, any Securities, or
         attempt to induce any person to purchase any Securities; and not to,
         and to cause its affiliated purchasers not to, make bids or purchase
         for the purpose of creating actual, or apparent, active trading in or
         of raising the price of the Securities;

                  (o) to furnish to each of the Initial Purchasers on the date
         hereof a copy of the independent accountants' report included in the
         Offering Memorandum signed by the accountants rendering such report;

                  (p) to do and perform all things required to be done and
         performed by it under this Agreement that are within its control prior
         to or after the Closing Date, and to use its reasonable best efforts to
         satisfy all conditions precedent on its part to the delivery of the
         Securities;

                  (q) prior to the Closing Date, not to issue any press release
         or other communication directly or indirectly or hold any press
         conference with respect to the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor, its
         condition, financial or otherwise, or earnings, business affairs or
         business prospects (except for routine oral marketing communications in
         the ordinary course of business and consistent with the past practices
         of the Company and of which the Initial Purchasers are notified),
         without prior consultation with the Initial Purchasers, unless in the
         judgment of the Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor and their
         respective counsel, and

<PAGE>   14


                                                                              14




         after notification to the Initial Purchasers, such press release or
         communication is required by law; and

                  (r) to apply the net proceeds from the sale of the Securities
         as set forth in the Offering Memorandum under the heading "Use of
         Proceeds".

                  5. Conditions of Initial Purchasers' Obligations. The
respective obligations of the several Initial Purchasers hereunder are subject
to the accuracy, on and as of the date hereof and the Closing Date, of the
representations and warranties of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors
contained herein, to the accuracy of the statements of the Company, and the
Subsidiary Guarantors and their respective officers made in any certificates
delivered pursuant hereto, to the performance by the Company and the Subsidiary
Guarantors of their respective obligations hereunder, and to each of the
following additional terms and conditions:

                  (a) The Offering Memorandum (and any amendments or supplements
         thereto) shall have been printed and copies distributed to the Initial
         Purchasers as promptly as practicable on or following the date of this
         Agreement or at such other date and time as to which the Initial
         Purchasers may agree; and no stop order suspending the sale of the
         Securities in any jurisdiction shall have been issued and no proceeding
         for that purpose shall have been commenced or shall be pending or
         threatened.

                  (b) None of the Initial Purchasers shall have discovered and
         disclosed to the Company on or prior to the Closing Date that the
         Offering Memorandum or any amendment or supplement thereto contains an
         untrue statement of a fact which, in the written advice of counsel for
         the Initial Purchasers, is material or omits to state any fact which,
         in the written advice of such counsel (a copy of which shall be
         supplied to the Company), is material and is required to be stated
         therein or is necessary to make the statements therein not misleading.

                  (c) All corporate proceedings and other matters required for
         due authorization and validity of each of the Transaction Documents and
         the transactions contemplated thereby and the Offering Memorandum shall
         be satisfactory in all material respects to the Initial Purchasers, and
         the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors shall have furnished to the
         Initial Purchasers copies of such documents and information that they
         or their counsel may reasonably request to enable them to pass upon
         such matters.

                  (d) (i) Winstead Sechrest & Minick P.C. shall have furnished
         to the Initial Purchasers their written opinion, as counsel to the
         Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors and (ii) Arnold & Porter shall
         have furnished to the Initial Purchasers their written opinion, as New
         York counsel to the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors, in each
         case, addressed to the Initial Purchasers and dated the Closing Date,
         in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Initial
         Purchasers, substantially to the effect set forth in Annex B hereto.

                  (e) The Initial Purchasers shall have received from Simpson
         Thacher & Bartlett, counsel for the Initial Purchasers, such opinion or
         opinions, dated the Closing Date, with respect to such matters as the
         Initial Purchasers may reasonably require, and the Company and the
         Subsidiary Guarantors shall have furnished to such counsel such
         documents and information as they request for the purpose of enabling
         them to pass upon such matters.

                  (f) The Company shall have furnished to the Initial Purchasers
         letters (the "Initial Letters") of Grant Thornton LLP and Ernst & Young
         LLP, addressed to the Initial Purchasers and dated the date hereof, in
         form and substance satisfactory to the Initial Purchasers.

                  (g) The Company shall have furnished to the Initial Purchasers
         letters (the "Bring-Down Letters") of Grant Thornton LLP and Ernst &
         Young LLP, addressed to the Initial Purchasers and dated the Closing
         Date (i) confirming that they are independent public accountants with
         respect to the Company and its subsidiaries and Rent-A-Center and its



<PAGE>   15


                                                                              15



         subsidiaries, respectively, within the meaning of Rule 101 of the Code
         of Professional Conduct of the AICPA and its interpretations and
         rulings thereunder, (ii) stating, as of the date of the Bring-Down
         Letter (or, with respect to matters involving changes or developments
         since the respective dates as of which specified financial information
         is given in the Offering Memorandum, as of a date not more than three
         business days prior to the date of the Bring-Down Letter), that the
         conclusions and findings of such accountants with respect to the
         financial information and other matters covered by their Initial
         Letters are accurate and (iii) confirming in all material respects the
         conclusions and findings set forth in their Initial Letters.

                  (h) The Company and each of the Subsidiary Guarantors shall
         have furnished to the Initial Purchasers a certificate, dated the
         Closing Date, of their respective chief executive officers and chief
         financial officers or such other persons who possess similar authority
         or perform similar functions, solely in their capacity as officers and
         not in their individual capacity, stating that (A) such persons have
         examined the Offering Memorandum, (B) in their opinion, the Offering
         Memorandum, as of its date, did not include any untrue statement of a
         material fact and did not omit to state a material fact required to be
         stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein, in
         the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not
         misleading, and since the date of the Offering Memorandum, no event has
         occurred which should have been set forth in a supplement or amendment
         to the Offering Memorandum so that the Offering Memorandum (as so
         amended or supplemented) would not include any untrue statement of a
         material fact and would not omit to state a material fact required to
         be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein,
         in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not
         misleading and (C) to such officer's knowledge after reasonable due
         inquiry, as of the Closing Date, the representations and warranties of
         the Company and each of the Subsidiary Guarantors, as the case may be,
         in this Agreement are true and correct, the Company and each of the
         Subsidiary Guarantors, as the case may be, has complied with all
         agreements and satisfied all conditions on its part to be performed or
         satisfied hereunder on or prior to the Closing Date in all material
         respects, and subsequent to the date of the most recent financial
         statements contained in the Offering Memorandum, there has been no
         material adverse change in the financial position or results of
         operations of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors taken as a
         whole, or any change, or any development including a prospective
         change, in or affecting the condition (financial or otherwise), results
         of operations, business or prospects of the Company and the Subsidiary
         Guarantors taken as a whole that would, or could reasonably be expected
         to, result in a Material Adverse Effect, except as set forth in the
         Offering Memorandum. Such persons may also state that (i) they
         participated in the preparation of the Offering Memorandum, and (ii)
         they are generally familiar with the operations and business of the
         respective corporations of which they were officers or directors, have
         made such inquiries as they deemed appropriate in connection with
         making this certificate and have conferred amongst themselves in its
         preparation.

                  (i) The Initial Purchasers shall have received a counterpart
         of the Registration Rights Agreement which shall have been executed and
         delivered by a duly authorized officer of the Company.

                  (j) The Indenture shall have been duly executed and delivered
         by the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and the Trustee, and the
         Securities shall have been duly executed and delivered by the Company,
         the Subsidiary Guarantors and duly authenticated by the Trustee.

                  (k) The Securities shall have been approved by the NASD for
         trading in the PORTAL Market.

                  (l) If any event shall have occurred that requires the Company
         under Section 4(d) to prepare an amendment or supplement to the
         Offering Memorandum, such amendment or


<PAGE>   16

                                                                              16



         supplement shall have been prepared, the Initial Purchasers shall have
         been given a reasonable opportunity to comment thereon, and copies
         thereof shall have been delivered to the Initial Purchasers reasonably
         in advance of the Closing Date.

                  (m) There shall not have occurred any invalidation of Rule
         144A under the Securities Act by any court or any withdrawal or
         proposed withdrawal of any rule or regulation under the Securities Act
         or the Exchange Act by the Commission or any amendment or proposed
         amendment thereof by the Commission which, in the case of a proposed
         withdrawal, in the written advice of counsel to the Initial Purchasers,
         a copy of which will be delivered to the Company, is reasonably likely
         to occur and would materially impair the ability of the Initial
         Purchasers to purchase, hold or effect resales of the Securities as
         contemplated hereby.

                  (n) Except as otherwise disclosed in the Offering Memorandum
         (exclusive of any amendment or supplement thereto), subsequent to the
         execution and delivery of this Agreement or, if earlier, the dates as
         of which information is given in the Offering Memorandum (exclusive of
         any amendment or supplement thereto), there shall not have been any
         change in the capital stock or long-term debt or any change, or any
         development involving a prospective change, in or affecting the
         condition (financial or otherwise), results of operations, business or
         prospects of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors taken as a whole
         (including Rent-A-Center prior to the consummation of the Acquisition),
         the effect of which, in any such case described above, is, in the
         judgment of the Initial Purchasers, so material and adverse as to make
         it impracticable or inadvisable to proceed with the sale or delivery of
         the Securities on the terms and in the manner contemplated by this
         Agreement and the Offering Memorandum, which change or development
         shall be specified in writing by the Initial Purchasers to the Company
         (exclusive of any amendment or supplement thereto).

                  (o) No action shall have been taken and no statute, rule,
         regulation or order shall have been enacted, adopted or issued by any
         governmental agency or body which would, as of the Closing Date,
         prevent the issuance or sale of the Securities; and no injunction,
         restraining order or order of any other nature by any federal or state
         court of competent jurisdiction shall have been issued as of the
         Closing Date which would prevent the issuance or sale of the
         Securities.

                  (p) Subsequent to the execution and delivery of this Agreement
         (i) no downgrading shall have occurred in the rating accorded the
         Securities or any of the Company's or any Subsidiary Guarantor's other
         debt securities or preferred stock by any "nationally recognized
         statistical rating organization", as such term is defined by the
         Commission for purposes of Rule 436(g)(2) of the rules and regulations
         of the Commission under the Securities Act and (ii) no such
         organization shall have publicly announced that it has under
         surveillance or review (other than an announcement with positive
         implications of a possible upgrading), its rating of the Securities or
         any of the Company's or any Subsidiary Guarantor's other debt
         securities or preferred stock.

                  (q) Subsequent to the execution and delivery of this Agreement
         there shall not have occurred any of the following: (i) trading in
         securities generally on the New York Stock Exchange or the
         over-the-counter market shall have been suspended or limited, or
         minimum prices shall have been established on any such exchange or
         market by the Commission, by any such exchange or by any other
         regulatory body or governmental authority having jurisdiction, or
         trading in any securities of the Company on any exchange or in the
         over-the-counter market shall have been suspended or (ii) any
         moratorium on commercial banking activities shall have been declared by
         federal or New York state authorities or (iii) an outbreak or
         escalation of hostilities or a declaration by the United States of a
         national emergency or war shall have occurred or (iv) a material
         adverse change in general economic, political or financial conditions
         (or in the effect of international conditions on the financial markets
         in the United States) shall have occurred, the effect of which, in the
         case of this clause (iv), is, in the judgment of the Initial
         Purchasers, so material and adverse as to

<PAGE>   17


                                                                              17




         make it impracticable or inadvisable to proceed with the sale or the
         delivery of the Securities on the terms and in the manner contemplated
         by this Agreement and in the Offering Memorandum (exclusive of any
         amendment or supplement thereto).

                  (r) The Initial Purchasers shall have received (i) copies of
         the documentation evidencing the Acquisition (the "Acquisition
         Documents"), and the documentation evidencing the Senior Credit
         Facilities (the "Bank Documents"), in each case certified by the
         secretary of the Company as being true, complete and correct and (ii)
         evidence, reasonably satisfactory to them, that (A) the Acquisition
         shall have been consummated in accordance with the terms of the
         Acquisition Documents (and without waiver or amendment of any material
         condition contained therein) (B) the initial funding shall have
         occurred or is occurring under the Bank Documents and the Company shall
         have received at least $720.0 million in gross cash proceeds therefrom
         and (C) the Company shall have issued the Convertible Preferred Stock
         and the gross proceeds therefrom shall be at least $250 million.

                  All opinions, letters, evidence and certificates mentioned
above or elsewhere in this Agreement shall be deemed to be in compliance with
the provisions hereof only if they are in form and substance reasonably
satisfactory to counsel for the Initial Purchasers.

                  6. Termination. The obligations of the Initial Purchasers
hereunder may be terminated by the Initial Purchasers, in their absolute
discretion, by notice given to and received by the Company prior to delivery of
and payment for the Securities if, prior to that time, any of the events
described in Section 5(m), (n), (o), (p) or (q) shall have occurred and be
continuing.

                  7. Defaulting Initial Purchasers. (a) If, on the Closing Date,
any Initial Purchaser defaults in the performance of its obligations under this
Agreement, the non-defaulting Initial Purchasers may make arrangements for the
purchase of the Securities which such defaulting Initial Purchaser agreed but
failed to purchase by other persons satisfactory to the Company and the
non-defaulting Initial Purchasers, but if no such arrangements are made within
48 hours after such default, this Agreement shall terminate without liability on
the part of the non-defaulting Initial Purchasers or the Company, except that
the Company will continue to be liable for the payment of expenses to the extent
set forth in Sections 8 and 12 and except that the provisions of Sections 9 and
10 shall not terminate and shall remain in effect. As used in this Agreement,
the term "Initial Purchasers" includes, for all purposes of this Agreement
unless the context otherwise requires, any party not listed in Schedule 1 hereto
that, pursuant to this Section 7, purchases Securities which a defaulting
Initial Purchaser agreed but failed to purchase.

                  (b) Nothing contained herein shall relieve a defaulting
Initial Purchaser of any liability it may have to the Company or any
non-defaulting Initial Purchaser for damages caused by its default. If other
persons are obligated or agree to purchase the Securities of a defaulting
Initial Purchaser, either the non-defaulting Initial Purchasers or the Company
may postpone the Closing Date for up to seven full business days in order to
effect any changes that in the opinion of counsel for the Company or counsel for
the Initial Purchasers may be necessary in the Offering Memorandum or in any
other document or arrangement, and the Company agrees to promptly prepare any
amendment or supplement to the Offering Memorandum that effects any such
changes.

                  8. Reimbursement of Initial Purchasers' Expenses. If (a) this
Agreement shall have been terminated pursuant to Section 6 or 7, (b) the Company
shall fail to tender the Securities for delivery to the Initial Purchasers for
any reason or (c) the Initial Purchasers shall decline to purchase the
Securities for any reason permitted under this Agreement, the Company shall
reimburse the Initial Purchasers for such out-of-pocket expenses (including
reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel) as shall have been reasonably
incurred by the Initial Purchasers in connection with this Agreement and the
proposed purchase and resale of the Securities. If this Agreement is terminated
pursuant to Section 7 by reason of the default of one or more of the Initial
Purchasers, the Company shall not be obligated to reimburse any defaulting
Initial Purchaser on account of such expenses.


<PAGE>   18


                                                                              18




                  9. Indemnification. (a) The Company and the Subsidiary
Guarantors shall indemnify and hold harmless each Initial Purchaser, its
affiliates, their respective officers, directors, employees, representatives and
agents, and each person, if any, who controls any Initial Purchaser within the
meaning of the Securities Act or the Exchange Act (collectively referred to for
purposes of this Section 9(a) and Section 10 as an Initial Purchaser), from and
against any loss, claim, damage or liability, joint or several, or any action in
respect thereof (including, without limitation, any loss, claim, damage,
liability or action relating to purchases and sales of the Securities), to which
that Initial Purchaser may become subject, whether commenced or threatened,
under the Securities Act, the Exchange Act, any other federal or state statutory
law or regulation, at common law or otherwise, solely insofar as such loss,
claim, damage, liability or action arises out of, or is based upon, (i) any
untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in the
Preliminary Offering Memorandum or the Offering Memorandum or in any amendment
or supplement thereto or in any information provided by the Company pursuant to
Section 4(e) or (ii) the omission or alleged omission to state therein a
material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the
statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were
made, not misleading, and shall reimburse each Initial Purchaser promptly upon
demand for any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by that Initial
Purchaser in connection with investigating or defending or preparing to defend
against or appearing as a third party witness in connection with any such loss,
claim, damage, liability or action as such expenses are incurred; provided,
however, that the Company shall not be liable in any such case to the extent
that any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action arises out of, or is
based upon, an untrue statement or alleged untrue statement in or omission or
alleged omission from any of such documents in reliance upon and in conformity
with any Initial Purchasers' Information furnished by such Initial Purchaser;
and provided, further, that with respect to any such untrue statement in or
omission from the Preliminary Offering Memorandum, the indemnity agreement
contained in this Section 9(a) shall not inure to the benefit of any such
Initial Purchaser to the extent that the sale to the person asserting any such
loss, claim, damage, liability or action was an initial resale by such Initial
Purchaser and any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action of or with
respect to such Initial Purchaser results from the fact that both (A) to the
extent required by applicable law, a copy of the Offering Memorandum was not
sent or given to such person at or prior to the written confirmation of the sale
of such Securities to such person and (B) the untrue statement in or omission
from the Preliminary Offering Memorandum was corrected in the Offering
Memorandum unless such failure to deliver the Offering Memorandum was a result
of non-compliance by the Company with Section 4(b).

                  (b) Each Initial Purchaser, severally and not jointly, shall
indemnify and hold harmless the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors, their
respective officers, directors, employees, representatives and agents, and each
person, if any, who controls the Company within the meaning of the Securities
Act or the Exchange Act (collectively referred to for purposes of this Section
9(b) and Section 10 as the Company), from and against any loss, claim, damage or
liability, joint or several, or any action in respect thereof, to which the
Company may become subject, whether commenced or threatened, under the
Securities Act, the Exchange Act, any other federal or state statutory law or
regulation, at common law or otherwise, solely insofar as such loss, claim,
damage, liability or action arises out of, or is based upon, (i) any untrue
statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in the
Preliminary Offering Memorandum or the Offering Memorandum or in any amendment
or supplement thereto or (ii) the omission or alleged omission to state therein
a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the
statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were
made, not misleading, but in each case only to the extent that the untrue
statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission was made
in reliance upon and in conformity with any Initial Purchasers' Information
furnished by such Initial Purchaser, and shall reimburse the Company for any
legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by the Company in connection with
investigating or defending or preparing to defend against or appearing as a
third party witness in connection with any such loss, claim, damage, liability
or action as such expenses are incurred.

                  (c) Promptly after receipt by an indemnified party under this
Section 9 of notice of any claim or the commencement of any action, the
indemnified party shall, if a claim in respect


<PAGE>   19


                                                                              19



thereof is to be made against the indemnifying party pursuant to Section 9(a) or
9(b), notify the indemnifying party in writing of the claim or the commencement
of that action; provided, however, that the failure to notify the indemnifying
party shall not relieve it from any liability which it may have under this
Section 9 except to the extent that it has been materially prejudiced (through
the forfeiture of substantive rights or defenses) by such failure; and,
provided, further, that the failure to notify the indemnifying party shall not
relieve it from any liability which it may have to an indemnified party
otherwise than under this Section 9. If any such claim or action shall be
brought against an indemnified party, and it shall notify the indemnifying party
thereof, the indemnifying party shall be entitled to participate therein and, to
the extent that it wishes, jointly with any other similarly notified
indemnifying party, to assume the defense thereof with counsel reasonably
satisfactory to the indemnified party. After notice from the indemnifying party
to the indemnified party of its election to assume the defense of such claim or
action, the indemnifying party shall not be liable to the indemnified party
under this Section 9 for any legal or other expenses subsequently incurred by
the indemnified party in connection with the defense thereof other than
reasonable costs of investigation; provided, however, that an indemnified party
shall have the right to employ its own counsel in any such action, but the fees,
expenses and other charges of such counsel for the indemnified party will be at
the expense of such indemnified party unless (i) the employment of counsel by
the indemnified party has been authorized in writing by the indemnifying party,
(ii) the indemnified party has reasonably concluded (based upon written advice
of counsel to the indemnified party, a copy of which shall be provided to the
indemnifying party) that there may be legal defenses available to it or other
indemnified parties that are different from or in addition to those available to
the indemnifying party, (iii) a conflict or potential conflict exists (based
upon written advice of counsel to the indemnified party, a copy of which shall
be provided to the indemnifying party) between the indemnified party and the
indemnifying party (in which case the indemnifying party will not have the right
to direct the defense of such action on behalf of the indemnified party) or (iv)
the indemnifying party has not in fact employed counsel reasonably satisfactory
to the indemnified party to assume the defense of such action within a
reasonable time after receiving notice of the commencement of the action, in
each of which cases the reasonable fees, disbursements and other charges of
counsel will be at the expense of the indemnifying party or parties. It is
understood that the indemnifying party or parties shall not, in connection with
any proceeding or related proceedings in the same jurisdiction, be liable for
the reasonable fees, disbursements and other charges of more than one separate
firm of attorneys (in addition to any local counsel) at any one time for all
such indemnified party or parties. Each indemnified party, as a condition of the
indemnity agreements contained in Sections 9(a) and 9(b), shall use all
reasonable efforts to cooperate with the indemnifying party in the defense of
any such action or claim. No indemnifying party shall be liable for any
settlement of any such action effected without its written consent (which
consent shall not be unreasonably withheld), but if settled with its written
consent or if there be a final judgment for the plaintiff in any such action,
the indemnifying party agrees to indemnify and hold harmless any indemnified
party from and against any loss or liability by reason of such settlement or
judgment. No indemnifying party shall, without the prior written consent of the
indemnified party (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld), effect any
settlement of any pending or threatened proceeding in respect of which any
indemnified party is or could have been a party and indemnity could have been
sought hereunder by such indemnified party unless such settlement includes an
unconditional release of such indemnified party from all liability on claims
that are the subject matter of such proceeding.

                  The obligations of the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and
the Initial Purchasers in this Section 9 and in Section 10 are in addition to
any other liability that the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors or the Initial
Purchasers, as the case may be, may otherwise have, including in respect of any
breaches of representations, warranties and agreements made herein by any such
party.

                  10. Contribution. If the indemnification provided for in
Section 9 is unavailable or insufficient to hold harmless an indemnified party
under Section 9(a) or 9(b), then each indemnifying party shall, in lieu of
indemnifying such indemnified party, contribute to the amount paid or payable by
such indemnified party as a result of such loss, claim, damage or liability, or
action in respect thereof, (i) in such proportion as shall be appropriate to
reflect the relative benefits received by the


<PAGE>   20

                                                                              20



Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors on the one hand and the Initial Purchasers
on the other from the offering of the Securities or (ii) if the allocation
provided by clause (i) above is not permitted by applicable law, in such
proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits referred
to in clause (i) above but also the relative fault of the Company and the
Subsidiary Guarantors on the one hand and the Initial Purchasers on the other
with respect to the statements or omissions that resulted in such loss, claim,
damage or liability, or action in respect thereof, as well as any other relevant
equitable considerations. The relative benefits received by the Company and the
Subsidiary Guarantors on the one hand and the Initial Purchasers on the other
with respect to such offering shall be deemed to be in the same proportion as
the total net proceeds from the offering of the Securities purchased under this
Agreement (before deducting expenses) received by or on behalf of the Company
and the Subsidiary Guarantors, on the one hand, and the total discounts and
commissions received by the Initial Purchasers with respect to the Securities
purchased under this Agreement, on the other, bear to the total gross proceeds
from the sale of the Securities under this Agreement, in each case as set forth
in the table on the cover page of the Offering Memorandum. The relative fault
shall be determined by reference to, among other things, whether the untrue or
alleged untrue statement of a material fact or the omission or alleged omission
to state a material fact relates to the Company or information supplied by the
Company or the Subsidiary Guarantors on the one hand or to any Initial
Purchasers' Information on the other, the intent of the parties and their
relative knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent
such untrue statement or omission. The Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and
the Initial Purchasers agree that it would not be just and equitable if
contributions pursuant to this Section 10 were to be determined by pro rata
allocation (even if the Initial Purchasers were treated as one entity for such
purpose) or by any other method of allocation that does not take into account
the equitable considerations referred to herein. The amount paid or payable by
an indemnified party as a result of the loss, claim, damage or liability, or
action in respect thereof, referred to above in this Section 10 shall be deemed
to include, for purposes of this Section 10, any legal or other expenses
reasonably incurred by such indemnified party in connection with investigating
or defending or preparing to defend any such action or claim. Notwithstanding
the provisions of this Section 10, no Initial Purchaser shall be required to
contribute any amount in excess of the amount by which the total discounts and
commissions received by such Initial Purchaser with respect to the Securities
purchased by it under this Agreement exceeds the amount of any damages which
such Initial Purchaser has otherwise paid or become liable to pay by reason of
any untrue or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission. No
person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section
12(f) of the Securities Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any person
who was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation. The Initial Purchasers'
obligations to contribute as provided in this Section 10 are several in
proportion to their respective purchase obligations and not joint.

                  11. Persons Entitled to Benefit of Agreement. This Agreement
shall inure to the benefit of and be binding upon the Initial Purchasers, the
Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and their respective successors. This
Agreement and the terms and provisions hereof are for the sole benefit of only
those persons, except as provided in Sections 9 and 10 with respect to
affiliates, officers, directors, employees, representatives, agents and
controlling persons of the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and the Initial
Purchasers and in Section 4(e) with respect to holders and prospective
purchasers of the Securities. Nothing in this Agreement is intended or shall be
construed to give any person, other than the persons referred to in this Section
11, any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim under or in respect of this
Agreement or any provision contained herein.

                  12. Expenses. Each of the Company and the Subsidiary
Guarantors agrees with the Initial Purchasers to pay (a) the costs incident to
the authorization, issuance, sale, preparation and delivery of the Securities
and any taxes payable in that connection; (b) the costs incident to the
preparation, printing and distribution of the Preliminary Offering Memorandum,
the Offering Memorandum and any amendments or supplements thereto; (c) the costs
of reproducing and distributing each of the Transaction Documents; (d) the costs
incident to the preparation, printing and delivery of the certificates
evidencing the Securities, including stamp duties and transfer taxes, if any,
payable upon issuance of the Securities; (e) the fees and expenses of the
Company's counsel


<PAGE>   21

                                                                              21



(including, without limitation, the fees and expenses of counsel to the Company
prior to completion of the Acquisition) and their independent accountants; (f)
the fees and expenses of qualifying the Securities under the securities laws of
the several jurisdictions as provided in Section 4(g) and of preparing, printing
and distributing Blue Sky Memoranda (including related fees and expenses of
counsel for the Initial Purchasers); (g) any fees charged by rating agencies for
rating the Securities; (h) the fees and expenses of the Trustee and any paying
agent (including related fees and expenses of any counsel to such parties); (i)
all expenses and application fees incurred in connection with the application
for the inclusion of the Securities on the PORTAL Market and the approval of the
Securities for book-entry transfer by DTC; and (j) all other costs and expenses
incident to the performance of the obligations of the Company under this
Agreement which are not otherwise specifically provided for in this Section 12;
provided, however, that except as provided in this Section 12 and Section 8, the
Initial Purchasers shall pay their own costs and expenses.

                  13. Survival. The respective indemnities, rights of
contribution, representations, warranties and agreements of the Company and the
Initial Purchasers contained in this Agreement or made by or on behalf of the
Company or the Initial Purchasers pursuant to this Agreement or any certificate
delivered pursuant hereto shall survive the delivery of and payment for the
Securities and shall remain in full force and effect, regardless of any
termination or cancellation of this Agreement or any investigation made by or on
behalf of any of them or any of their respective affiliates, officers,
directors, employees, representatives, agents or controlling persons, until such
time as the applicable statute of limitations has expired.

                  14. Notices, etc.. All statements, requests, notices and
agreements hereunder shall be in writing, and:

                  (a) if to the Initial Purchasers, shall be delivered or sent
         by mail or telecopy transmission to Chase Securities Inc., 270 Park
         Avenue, New York, New York 10017, Attention: Jeffrey Blumin (telecopier
         no.: (212) 270-0994); or

                  (b) if to the Company, or the Subsidiary Guarantors shall be
         delivered or sent by mail or telecopy transmission to the address of
         the Company set forth in the Offering Memorandum, Attention: Danny
         Wilbanks (telecopier no.: (972) 385-1625).

provided that any notice to an Initial Purchaser pursuant to Section 9(c) shall
also be delivered or sent by mail to such Initial Purchaser at its address set
forth on the signature page hereof. Any such statements, requests, notices or
agreements shall take effect at the time of receipt thereof. The Company shall
be entitled to act and rely upon any request, consent, notice or agreement given
or made on behalf of the Initial Purchasers by CSI.


                  15. Definition of Terms. For purposes of this Agreement, (a)
the term "business day" means any day on which the New York Stock Exchange, Inc.
is open for trading, (b) the term "subsidiary" has the meaning set forth in Rule
405 under the Securities Act, and (c) except where otherwise expressly provided,
the term "affiliate" has the meaning set forth in Rule 405 under the Securities
Act.

                  16. Initial Purchasers' Information. The parties hereto
acknowledge and agree that, for all purposes of this Agreement, the Initial
Purchasers' Information consists solely of the following information in the
Preliminary Offering Memorandum and the Offering Memorandum: (i) the last
paragraph on the front cover page concerning the terms of the offering by the
Initial Purchasers; (ii) the first paragraph on page (i); and (iii) the
information contained in the first sentence of the third paragraph, the second
sentence of the fourth paragraph, the fifth paragraph, the seventh paragraph,
the second sentence of the ninth paragraph, the twelfth paragraph and the
thirteenth paragraph under the heading "Plan of Distribution".

                  17. Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND
CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

<PAGE>   22


                                                                              22





                  18. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in one or
more counterparts (which may include counterparts delivered by telecopier) and,
if executed in more than one counterpart, the executed counterparts shall each
be deemed to be an original, but all such counterparts shall together constitute
one and the same instrument.

                  19. Amendments. No amendment or waiver of any provision of
this Agreement, nor any consent or approval to any departure therefrom, shall in
any event be effective unless the same shall be in writing and signed by the
parties hereto.

                  20. Headings. The headings herein are inserted for convenience
of reference only and are not intended to be part of, or to affect the meaning
or interpretation of, this Agreement.




<PAGE>   23






                  If the foregoing is in accordance with your understanding of
our agreement, kindly sign and return to us a counterpart hereof, whereupon this
instrument will become a binding agreement among the parties hereto in
accordance with its terms.

                               Very truly yours,

                               RENTERS CHOICE, INC.


                               By
                                 ----------------------------------  
                                 Name:
                                 Title:


                               COLORTYME, INC.


                               By
                                 ----------------------------------  
                                 Name:
                                 Title:


                               RENT-A-CENTER, INC.


                               By
                                 ----------------------------------  
                                 Name:
                                 Title:

Accepted:

CHASE SECURITIES INC.


By
  -----------------------------------   
        Authorized Signatory


Address for notices pursuant to Section 9(c):
1 Chase Plaza, 25th floor
New York, New York 10081
Attention:  Legal Department



BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.



By
  -----------------------------------   
        Authorized Signatory


Address for notices pursuant to Section 9(c):
245 Park Avenue
New York, New York 10167
Attention:  Legal Department



<PAGE>   24








NATIONSBANC MONTGOMERY SECURITIES LLC


By
  -----------------------------------   
        Authorized Signatory


Address for notices pursuant to Section 9(c):
901 Main Street, 66th Floor
Dallas, Texas 75202
Attention:  Stuart B. Gleichenhaus



CREDIT SUISSE FIRST BOSTON CORPORATION



By
  -----------------------------------   
        Authorized Signatory


Address for notices pursuant to Section 9(c):
Eleven Madison Avenue, 24th Floor
New York, New York  10010
Attention:  Investment Banking Department/Transactions Advisory Group




<PAGE>   25



                                                                      SCHEDULE 1


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                              Principal Amount of Securities
Initial Purchasers                            to be Purchased
- ------------------                            ------------------------------
<S>                                           <C>                  
Chase Securities Inc.                         $   78,750,000
Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc.                      $   43,750,000
NationsBanc Montgomery Securities LLC         $   35,000,000
Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation        $   17,500,000
                                              -------------- 
                  Total                       $  175,000,000
                                              ==============  
</TABLE>





<PAGE>   26

                                                                         ANNEX A


              [FORM OF EXCHANGE AND REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT]



<PAGE>   27



                                                                         ANNEX B


                  [Form of Opinion of Counsel for the Company]


                  Winstead Sechrest & Minick P.C. shall have furnished to the
Initial Purchasers their written opinion, as counsel to the Company, and the
Subsidiary Guarantors addressed to the Initial Purchasers and dated the Closing
Date, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Initial Purchasers,
substantially to the effect set forth below:

                  (i) the Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor has been duly
         incorporated and is validly existing as a corporation in good standing
         under the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation, is duly qualified
         to do business and is in good standing as a foreign corporation in each
         jurisdiction in which its ownership or lease of property or the conduct
         of its businesses requires such qualification, and has all power and
         authority necessary to own or hold its properties and to conduct the
         businesses in which it is engaged (except where the failure to so
         qualify or have such power or authority would not, singularly or in the
         aggregate, have a Material Adverse Effect);

                  (ii) the Company has an authorized capitalization as set forth
         in the Offering Memorandum, and all of the outstanding shares of
         capital stock of the Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor have been
         duly and validly authorized and issued and are fully paid and
         non-assessable; and the capital stock of the Company conforms in all
         material respects to the description thereof contained in the Offering
         Memorandum;

                  (iii) the descriptions in the Offering Memorandum of statutes,
         legal and governmental proceedings and contracts and other documents
         are accurate in all material respects; the statements in the Offering
         Memorandum under the heading "Certain United States Federal Income Tax
         Consequences," to the extent that they constitute summaries of matters
         of law or regulation or legal conclusions, have been reviewed by such
         counsel and fairly summarize the matters described therein in all
         material respects; and such counsel does not have actual knowledge of
         any current or pending legal or governmental actions, suits or
         proceedings which would be required to be described in the Offering
         Memorandum if the Offering Memorandum were a prospectus included in a
         registration statement on Form S-1 which are not described as so
         required;

                  (iv) the Indenture conforms in all material respects with the
         requirements of the Trust Indenture Act and the rules and regulations
         of the Commission applicable to an indenture which is qualified
         thereunder;

                  (v) the Company and each Subsidiary Guarantor has full right,
         power and authority to execute and deliver each of the Transaction
         Documents and to perform its obligations thereunder; and all corporate
         action required to be taken for the due and proper authorization,
         execution and delivery of each of the Transaction Documents and the
         consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby have been duly
         and validly taken;

                  (vi) the Registration Rights Agreement has been duly
         authorized, executed and delivered by the Company and constitutes a
         valid and legally binding agreement of the Company enforceable against
         the Company in accordance with its terms, except to the extent that
         such enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy,
         insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization, moratorium and other
         similar laws affecting creditors' rights generally and by general
         equitable principles (whether considered in a proceeding in equity or
         at law) and except to the extent that the indemnification provisions
         thereof may be unenforceable;

                  (vii) the Purchase Agreement has been duly authorized,
         executed and delivered by the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors and
         constitutes a valid and legally binding agreement of the Company and
         the Subsidiary Guarantors in accordance with its terms, except to the
         extent that such enforceability may be limited by applicable
         bankruptcy,


<PAGE>   28

                                                                               2

         insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization, moratorium or other
         similar laws affecting creditors' rights generally and by general
         equitable principles (whether considered in a proceeding in equity or
         at law) and except to the extent that the indemnification provisions
         thereof may be unenforceable;

                  (viii) the Indenture has been duly authorized, executed and
         delivered by the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors and, assuming
         due authorization, execution and delivery thereof by the Trustee,
         constitutes a valid and legally binding agreement of the Company and
         the Subsidiary Guarantors enforceable against the Company and the
         Subsidiary Guarantors in accordance with its terms, except to the
         extent that such enforceability may be limited by applicable
         bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization,
         moratorium and other similar laws affecting creditors' rights generally
         and by general equitable principles (whether considered in a proceeding
         in equity or at law);

                  (ix) the Securities have been duly authorized and issued by
         the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors and, assuming due
         authentication thereof by the Trustee and upon payment and delivery in
         accordance with the Purchase Agreement, will constitute valid and
         legally binding obligations of the Company and the Subsidiary
         Guarantors entitled to the benefits of the Indenture and enforceable
         against the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors in accordance with
         their terms, except to the extent that such enforceability may be
         limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance,
         reorganization, moratorium and other similar laws affecting creditors'
         rights generally and by general equitable principles (whether
         considered in a proceeding in equity or at law);

                  (x) the Bank Documents have been duly authorized, executed and
         delivered by the Company and constitutes a valid and legally binding
         agreement of the Company enforceable against the Company in accordance
         with its terms, except to the extent that such enforceability may be
         limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance,
         reorganization, moratorium and other similar laws affecting creditors'
         rights generally and by general equitable principles (whether
         considered in a proceeding in equity or at law);

                  (xi) the Acquisition was consummated in accordance with (A)
         the terms of the Acquisition Documents and (B) applicable law;

                  (xii) each Transaction Document conforms in all material
         respects to the description thereof contained in the Offering
         Memorandum;

                  (xiii) the execution, delivery and performance by the Company
         and the Subsidiary Guarantors of each of the Transaction Documents to
         which it is a party, the issuance, authentication, sale and delivery of
         the Securities and compliance by the Company with the terms thereof and
         the consummation of the transactions contemplated by the Transaction
         Documents will not conflict with or result in a breach or violation of
         any of the terms or provisions of, or constitute a default under, or
         result in the creation or imposition of any lien, charge or encumbrance
         upon any property or assets of the Company or any of its subsidiaries
         pursuant to, any material indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan
         agreement or other material agreement or instrument to which the
         Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party or by which the Company
         or any of its subsidiaries is bound or to which any of the property or
         assets of the Company or any of its subsidiaries is subject, nor will
         such actions result in any violation of the provisions of the charter
         or by-laws of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any statute or
         any judgment, order, decree, rule or regulation of any court or
         arbitrator or governmental agency or body having jurisdiction over the
         Company or any of its subsidiaries or any of their properties or
         assets; and no consent, approval, authorization or order of, or filing
         or registration with, any such court or arbitrator or governmental
         agency or body under any such statute, judgment, order, decree, rule or
         regulation is required for the execution, delivery and performance by
         the Company of each of the Transaction Documents, the issuance,
         authentication, sale and delivery of the Securities and compliance by
         the Company with the terms thereof and the consummation of the
         transactions contemplated by


<PAGE>   29


                                                                               3

         the Transaction Documents, except for such consents, approvals,
         authorizations, filings, registrations or qualifications (i) which have
         been obtained or made prior to the Closing Date and (ii) as may be
         required to be obtained or made under the Securities Act and applicable
         state securities laws as provided in the Registration Rights Agreement;

                  (xiv) to the best knowledge of such counsel, other than those
         disclosed in the Offering Memorandum there are no pending actions or
         suits or judicial, arbitral, rule-making, administrative or other
         proceedings to which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a party
         or of which any property or assets of the Company or any of its
         subsidiaries is the subject which (A) singularly or in the aggregate,
         if determined adversely to the Company or any of its subsidiaries,
         could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect or (B)
         questions the validity or enforceability of any of the Transaction
         Documents or any action taken or to be taken pursuant thereto; and to
         the best knowledge of such counsel, no such proceedings are threatened
         or contemplated by governmental authorities or threatened by others;

                  (xv) neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries is (A) an
         "investment company" or a company "controlled by" an investment company
         within the meaning of the Investment Company Act and the rules and
         regulations of the Commission thereunder, without taking account of any
         exemption under the Investment Company Act arising out of the number of
         holders of the Company's securities or (B) a "holding company" or a
         "subsidiary company" of a holding company or an "affiliate" thereof
         within the meaning of the Public Utility Holding Company Act of 1935,
         as amended;

                  (xvi) neither the consummation of the transactions
         contemplated by this Agreement nor the sale, issuance, execution or
         delivery of the Securities will violate Regulation G, T, U or X of the
         Federal Reserve Board; and

                  (xvii) assuming the accuracy of the representations,
         warranties and agreements of the Company of the Subsidiary Guarantors
         and of the Initial Purchasers contained in the Purchase Agreement, no
         registration of the Securities under the Securities Act or
         qualification of the Indenture under the Trust Indenture Act is
         required in connection with the issuance and sale of the Securities by
         the Company and the offer, resale and delivery of the Securities by the
         Initial Purchasers in the manner contemplated by the Purchase Agreement
         and the Offering.

                  Such counsel shall also state that they have participated in
conferences with representatives of the Company, representatives of its
independent accountants and counsel and representatives of the Initial
Purchasers and their counsel at which conferences the contents of the
Preliminary Offering Memorandum and the Offering Memorandum and any amendment
and supplement thereto and related matters were discussed and, although such
counsel assumes no responsibility for the accuracy, completeness or fairness of
the Offering Memorandum or any amendment or supplement thereto (except as
expressly provided above), nothing has come to the attention of such counsel to
cause such counsel to believe that the Offering Memorandum or any amendment or
supplement thereto (other than the financial statements and other financial and
statistical information contained therein, as to which such counsel need express
no belief), as of the date thereof and as of the Closing Date, contained or
contains any untrue statement of a material fact or omitted or omits to state a
material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the
circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

                  In rendering such opinion, such counsel may rely as to matters
of fact, to the extent such counsel deems proper, on certificates of responsible
officers of the Company and public officials which are furnished to the Initial
Purchasers.




<PAGE>   1
                                                                     Exhibit 4.4


            INDENTURE, dated as of August 18, 1998, among RENTERS CHOICE, INC.,
a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), having its principal office at 13800
Montfort Drive, Suite 300, Dallas, Texas 75240, COLORTYME, INC., a Texas
corporation ("ColorTyme"), having its principal office at 1231 Greenway Drive,
Irving, Texas, RENT-A-CENTER,INC. (formerly known as Thorn Americas, Inc.), a
Delaware corporation ("RAC", and together with ColorTyme, the "Subsidiary
Guarantors") having its principal office at 8200 East Thorn, Wichita, Kansas
67226, and IBJ SCHRODER BANK & TRUST COMPANY, a New York banking corporation,
as trustee (the "Trustee"), having its Corporate Trust Office at 1 State
Street, New York, New York  10004.

                            RECITALS OF THE COMPANY

                 The Company has duly authorized the creation of and issuance
of (i) the Company's 11% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Initial
Notes"), (ii) if and when issued in exchange for the Initial Notes as provided
in the Registration Rights Agreement (as defined herein), the Company's 11%
Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Exchange Notes"), and (iii) if and
when issued pursuant to a private exchange for Initial Notes, the Company's 11%
Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Private Exchange Notes", and together
with the Initial Notes and the Exchange Notes, the "Notes"), of substantially
the tenor and amount hereinafter set forth, and to provide therefor the Company
and each Subsidiary Guarantor has duly authorized the execution and delivery of
this Indenture.

                 Upon the issuance of the Exchange Notes or the Private
Exchange Notes, if any, or the effectiveness of the Shelf Registration
Statement (as defined herein), this Indenture will be subject to, and shall be
governed by, the provisions of the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended,
that are required or deemed to be part of and to govern indentures qualified
thereunder.

                 All things necessary have been done to make the Notes, when
executed and duly issued by the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors and
authenticated and delivered hereunder by the Trustee or the Authenticating
Agent, the valid obligations of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors and
to make this Indenture a valid agreement of the Company and the Subsidiary
Guarantors in accordance with their and its terms.

                 NOW, THEREFORE, THIS INDENTURE WITNESSETH:

                 For and in consideration of the premises and the purchase of
the Notes by the Holders thereof, it is mutually covenanted and agreed, for the
equal and proportionate benefit of all Holders of the Notes, as follows:


      ARTICLE ONE.  DEFINITIONS AND OTHER PROVISIONS OF GENERAL APPLICATION
100.

                 SECTION 101.  Definitions.

                 For all purposes of this Indenture, except as otherwise
expressly provided or unless the context otherwise requires:

                 (a)      the terms defined in this Article have the meanings
         assigned to them in this Article, and words in the singular include
         the plural as well as the singular, and words in the plural include
         the singular as well as the plural;

                 (b)      all other terms used herein which are defined in the
         Trust Indenture Act, either directly or by reference therein, or
         defined by Commission rule and not otherwise defined herein have the
         meanings assigned to them therein, and the terms "cash transaction"
         and "self-
<PAGE>   2
                                                                               2

         liquidating paper", as used in TIA Section 311, shall have the
         meanings assigned to them in the rules of the Commission adopted under
         the Trust Indenture Act;

                 (c)      all accounting terms not otherwise defined herein
         have the meanings assigned to them in accordance with GAAP (as defined
         herein);

                 (d)      the words "herein," "hereof" and "hereunder" and
         other words of similar import refer to this Indenture as a whole and
         not to any particular Article, Section or other subdivision;

                 (e)      the word "or" is not exclusive; and

                 (f)      provisions of this Indenture apply to successive
         events and transactions.

                 Certain terms, used principally in Articles Two, Ten, Twelve
and Thirteen, are defined in those Articles.

                 "Acquisition" means the acquisition of RAC by the Company.

                 "Additional Assets" means (i) any property or assets (other
than Indebtedness and Capital Stock) to be used by the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary in a Related Business; (ii) the Capital Stock of a Person that
becomes a Restricted Subsidiary as a result of the acquisition of such Capital
Stock by the Company or another Restricted Subsidiary; (iii) Capital Stock of
any Person that at such time is a Restricted Subsidiary, acquired from a third
party; provided, however, that, in the case of clauses (ii) and (iii), such
Restricted Subsidiary is primarily engaged in a Related Business; or (iv)
Capital Stock or Indebtedness of any Person which is primarily engaged in a
Related Business; provided, however, for purposes of the covenant described
under Section 1017, the aggregate amount of Net Available Cash permitted to be
invested pursuant to this clause (iv) shall not exceed at any one time
outstanding 5% of Consolidated Tangible Assets.

                 "Affiliate" of any specified Person means any other Person,
directly or indirectly, controlling or controlled by or under direct or
indirect common control with such specified Person. For the purposes of this
definition, "control" when used with respect to any Person means the power to
direct the management and policies of such Person, directly or indirectly,
whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise;
and the terms "controlling" and "controlled" have meanings correlative to the
foregoing.  Chase and its Affiliates shall not be deemed an Affiliate of the
Company.

                 "Apollo" means Apollo Management IV, L.P., and its Affiliates
or any entity controlled thereby or any of the partners thereof.

                 "Asset Disposition" means any sale, lease, transfer or other
disposition of shares of Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary (other than
directors' qualifying shares), property or other assets (each referred to for
the purposes of this definition as a "disposition") by the Company or any of
its Restricted Subsidiaries (including any disposition by means of a merger,
consolidation or similar transaction) other than (i) a disposition by a
Restricted Subsidiary to the Company or by the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary to a Restricted Subsidiary, (ii) a disposition of inventory,
equipment, obsolete assets or surplus personal property in the ordinary course
of business, (iii) the sale of Temporary Cash Investments or Cash Equivalents
in the ordinary course or business, (iv) a transaction or a series of related
transactions in which either (x) the fair market value of the assets disposed
of, in the aggregate, does not exceed 2.5% of the Consolidated Tangible Assets
of the Company or (y) the EBITDA related to such assets does not, in the
aggregate, exceed 2.5% of the Company's EBITDA, (v) the sale or discount (with
or without recourse, and on commercially reasonable terms) of accounts
receivable or notes receivable arising in the ordinary course of business, or
the conversion or exchange of accounts receivable for notes receivable, (vi)
the licensing of intellectual property in the ordinary course of business,
(vii) an RTO Facility Swap, (viii) for purposes of the covenant contained in
Section 1017 only, a disposition subject to the covenant contained in Section
1009 or (ix) a disposition of property or assets that is governed by the
provisions of Article 8.


<PAGE>   3
                                                                               3


                 "Attributable Debt" in respect of a Sale/Leaseback Transaction
means, as of the time of determination, the present value (discounted at the
interest rate assumed in making calculations in accordance with FAS 13) of the
total obligations of the lessee for rental payments during the remaining term
of the lease included in such Sale/Leaseback Transaction (including any period
for which such lease has been extended).

                 "Average Life" means, as of the date of determination, with
respect to any Indebtedness or Preferred Stock, the quotient obtained by
dividing (i) the sum of the products of the numbers of years from the date of
determination to the dates of each successive scheduled principal payment of
such Indebtedness or redemption or similar payment with respect to such
Indebtedness or Preferred Stock multiplied by the amount of such payment by
(ii) the sum of all such payments.

                 "Bank Indebtedness" means any and all amounts, whether
outstanding on the Issue Date or thereafter Incurred, payable under or in
respect of the Senior Credit Facility, including, without limitation,
principal, premium (if any), interest (including interest accruing on or after
the filing of any petition in bankruptcy or for reorganization relating to the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary whether or not a claim for postfiling
interest is allowed in such proceedings), fees, charges, expenses,
reimbursement obligations, guarantees, other monetary obligations of any nature
and all other amounts payable thereunder or in respect thereof.

                 "Board of Directors" means the Board of Directors of the
Company or any committee thereof duly authorized to act on behalf of such
Board.

                 "Board Resolution" means a copy of a resolution, certified by
the appropriate officer of the Company to have been duly adopted by the Board
of Directors and to be in full force and effect on the date of such
certification, and delivered to the Trustee.

                 "Business Day" means a day other than a Saturday, Sunday or
other day on which commercial banking institutions are authorized or required
by law to close in New York City.

                 "Capital Stock" of any Person means any and all shares,
interests, rights to purchase, warrants, options, participations or other
equivalents of or interests in (however designated) equity of such Person,
including any Preferred Stock, but excluding any debt securities convertible
into such equity.

                 "Capitalized Lease Obligation" means an obligation that is
required to be classified and accounted for as a capitalized lease for
financial reporting purposes in accordance with GAAP, and the amount of
Indebtedness represented by such obligation shall be the capitalized amount of
such obligation determined in accordance with GAAP; and the Stated Maturity
thereof shall be the date of the last payment of rent or any other amount due
under such lease.

                 "Cash Equivalents" means any of the following:  (i) securities
issued or fully guaranteed or insured by the United States Government or any
agency or instrumentality thereof, (ii) time deposits, certificates of deposit
or bankers' acceptances of (A) any lender under the Senior Credit Agreement or
(B) any commercial bank having capital and surplus in excess of $500,000,000
and the commercial paper of the holding company of which is rated at least A-2
or the equivalent thereof by S&P or at least P-2 or the equivalent thereof by
Moody's (or if at such time neither is issuing ratings, then a comparable
rating of another nationally recognized rating agency), (iii) commercial paper
rated at least A-1 or the equivalent thereof by S&P or at least P-1 or the
equivalent thereof by Moody's (or if at such time neither is issuing ratings,
then a comparable rating of another nationally recognized rating agency), (iv)
investments in money market funds complying with the risk limiting conditions
of Rule 2a-7 or any successor rule of the SEC under the Investment Company Act,
(v) repurchase obligations of any lender under the Senior Credit Agreement or
any commercial bank satisfying the requirements of clause (ii) of this
definition, having a term of not more than 30 days, with respect to securities
issued or fully guaranteed or insured by the United States Government, (vi)
securities with maturities of one year or less from the date of acquisition,
issued or fully guaranteed by any state, commonwealth or territory of


<PAGE>   4
                                                                               4


the United States, by any political subdivision or taxing authority of such
state, commonwealth or territory or by any foreign government, the securities
of which state, commonwealth, territory, political subdivision, taxing
authority or foreign government, as the case may be, are rated at least A by
S&P or A by Moody's, and (vii) securities with maturities of six months or less
from the date of acquisition backed ny standby letters of credit issued by any
lender under the Senior Credit Agreement or any commercial bank satisfying the
requirements of clause (ii) of this definition.

                 "Central Acquisition" means the Company's acquisition of
substantially all of the assets of Central Rents, Inc.

                 "Change of Control" means (i) any "Person" (as such term is
used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Exchange Act), other than one or more
Permitted Holders, is or becomes the beneficial owner (as defined in Rules
13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act except that a Person shall be deemed to
have "beneficial ownership" of all shares that any such Person has the right to
acquire within one year) directly or indirectly, of more than 50% of the Voting
Stock of the Company or a Successor Company (as defined below) (including,
without limitation, through a merger or consolidation or purchase of Voting
Stock of the Company); provided that, the Permitted Holders do not have the
right or ability by voting power, contract or otherwise to elect or designate
for election a majority of the Board of Directors; provided further that, the
transfer of 100% of the voting stock of the Company to a Person that has an
ownership structure identical to that of the Company prior to such transfer,
such that the Company becomes a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of such Person, shall
not be treated as a Change of Control for purposes of this Indenture; (ii)
during any period of two consecutive years, individuals who at the beginning of
such period constituted the Board of Directors (together with any new directors
whose election by such Board of Directors or whose nomination for election by
the shareholders of the Company was approved by a vote of a majority of the
directors of the Company then still in office who were either directors at the
beginning of such period or whose election or nomination for election was
previously so approved) cease for any reason to constitute a majority of the
Board of Directors then in office; (iii) the sale, lease, transfer, conveyance
or other disposition (other than by way of merger or consolidation), in one or
a series of related transactions, of all or substantially all of the assets of
the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries taken as a whole to any Person or
group of related Persons (a "Group") (as such term is used in Sections 13(d)
and 14(d) of the Exchange Act) other than a Permitted Holder; or (iv) the
adoption of a plan relating to the liquidation or dissolution of the Company.

                 "Chase" means The Chase Manhattan Bank.

                 "Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

                 "Company" means Renters Choice, Inc. after giving effect to
the Acquisition.

                 "Company Request" or "Company Order" means a written request
or order signed in the name of the Company by an Officer of the Company with
actual authority to bind the Company on such matters, and delivered to the
Trustee.

                 "Consolidated Coverage Ratio" as of any date of determination
means the ratio of (i) the aggregate amount of EBITDA of the Company and its
Restricted Subsidiaries for the period of the most recent four consecutive
fiscal quarters ending prior to the date of such determination for which
consolidated financial statements of the Company are available to (ii)
Consolidated Interest Expense for such four fiscal quarters (in each of clause
(i) and (ii), determined, for each fiscal quarter (or portion thereof) of the
four fiscal quarters ending prior to the Issue Date, on a pro forma basis to
give effect to the Central Acquisition and the Transactions (including the
anticipated disposition of any non-rent-to-own businesses under contract for
sale or held for sale following the Issue Date) as if they had occurred at the
beginning of such four-quarter period); provided, however, that:  (1) if the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary (x) has Incurred any Indebtedness since
the beginning of such period that remains outstanding on such date of
determination or if the transaction giving rise to the need to calculate the
Consolidated Coverage Ratio is an Incurrence of Indebtedness, EBITDA and
Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated after giving
effect on a pro forma basis to such

<PAGE>   5
                                                                               5


Indebtedness as if such Indebtedness had been Incurred on the first day of such
period (except that in making such computation, the amount of Indebtedness
under any revolving credit facility outstanding on the date of such calculation
shall be computed based on (A) the average daily balance of such Indebtedness
during such four fiscal quarters or such shorter period for which such facility
was outstanding or (B) if such facility was created after the end of such four
fiscal quarters, the average daily balance of such Indebtedness during the
period from the date of creation of such facility to the date of such
calculation) and the discharge of any other Indebtedness repaid, repurchased,
defeased or otherwise discharged with the proceeds of such new Indebtedness as
if such discharge had occurred on the first day of such period, or (y) has
repaid, repurchased, defeased or otherwise discharged any Indebtedness since
the beginning of the period that is no longer outstanding on such date of
determination, or if the transaction giving rise to the need to calculate the
Consolidated Coverage Ratio involves a discharge of Indebtedness (in each case
other than Indebtedness Incurred under any revolving credit facility unless
such Indebtedness has been permanently repaid), EBITDA and Consolidated
Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated after giving effect on a
pro forma basis to such discharge of such Indebtedness, including with the
proceeds of such new Indebtedness, as if such discharge had occurred on the
first day of such period; (2) if since the beginning of such period the Company
or any Restricted Subsidiary shall have made any Asset Disposition of any
company or any business or any group of assets, the EBITDA for such period
shall be reduced by an amount equal to the EBITDA (if positive) directly
attributable to the assets that are the subject of such Asset Disposition for
such period or increased by an amount equal to the EBITDA (if negative)
directly attributable thereto for such period and Consolidated Interest Expense
for such period shall be reduced by an amount equal to the Consolidated
Interest Expense directly attributable to any Indebtedness of the Company or
any Restricted Subsidiary repaid, repurchased, defeased or otherwise discharged
with respect to the Company and its continuing Restricted Subsidiaries in
connection with such Asset Disposition for such period (and, if the Capital
Stock of any Restricted Subsidiary is sold, the Consolidated Interest Expense
for such period directly attributable to the Indebtedness of such Restricted
Subsidiary to the extent the Company and its continuing Restricted Subsidiaries
are no longer liable for such Indebtedness after such sale); (3) if since the
beginning of such period the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary (by merger or
otherwise) shall have made an Investment in any Person that thereby becomes a
Restricted Subsidiary, or otherwise acquired any company or any business or any
group of assets, including any such acquisition of assets occurring in
connection with a transaction causing a calculation to be made hereunder,
EBITDA and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated
after giving pro forma effect thereto (including the Incurrence of any
Indebtedness and including the pro forma expenses and cost reductions
calculated on a basis consistent with Regulation S-X of the Securities Act) as
if such Investment or acquisition occurred on the first day of such period; and
(4) if since the beginning of such period any Person (that subsequently became
a Restricted Subsidiary or was merged with or into the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary since the beginning of such period) shall have made any
Asset Disposition or any Investment or acquisition of assets that would have
required an adjustment pursuant to clause (2) or (3) above if made by the
Company or a Restricted Subsidiary during such period, EBITDA and Consolidated
Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated after giving pro forma
effect thereto as if such Asset Disposition, Investment or acquisition of
assets occurred on the first day of such period.

                 For purposes of this definition, whenever pro forma effect is
to be given to an Asset Disposition, Investment or acquisition of assets, or
any transaction governed by the provisions of Article 8, or the amount of
income or earnings relating thereto and the amount of Consolidated Interest
Expense associated with any Indebtedness Incurred or repaid, repurchased,
defeased or otherwise discharged in connection therewith, the pro forma
calculations in respect thereof shall be as determined in good faith by a
responsible financial or accounting officer of the Company, based on reasonable
assumptions. If any Indebtedness bears a floating rate of interest and is being
given pro forma effect, the interest expense on such Indebtedness shall be
calculated at a fixed rate as if the rate in effect on the date of
determination had been the applicable rate for the entire period (taking into
account any Interest Rate Agreement applicable to such Indebtedness if such
Interest Rate Agreement has a remaining term as at the date of determination in
excess of 12 months). If any Indebtedness bears, at the option of the Company
or a Restricted Subsidiary, a fixed or floating rate of interest and is being
given pro forma effect, the interest expense on such Indebtedness shall be
computed by applying, at the option of the

<PAGE>   6
                                                                               6


Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, either a fixed or floating rate. If any
Indebtedness which is being given pro forma effect was Incurred under a
revolving credit facility, the interest expense on such Indebtedness shall be
computed based upon the average daily balance of such Indebtedness during the
applicable period.

                 "Consolidated Interest Expense" means, as to any Person, for
any period, the total consolidated interest expense of such Person and its
Subsidiaries determined in accordance with GAAP, minus, to the extent included
in such interest expense, amortization or write-off of financing costs, plus,
to the extent incurred by such Person and its Subsidiaries in such period but
not included in such interest expense, without duplication, (i) interest
expense attributable to Capitalized Lease Obligations and the interest
component of rent expense associated with Attributable Debt in respect of the
relevant lease giving rise thereto, determined as if such lease were a
capitalized lease, in accordance with GAAP, (ii) amortization of debt discount,
(iii) interest in respect of indebtedness of any other Person that has been
Guaranteed by such Person or any Subsidiary, but only to the extent that such
interest is actually paid by such Person or any Restricted Subsidiary, (iv)
non-cash interest expense, (v) net costs associated with Hedging Obligations,
(vi) the product of (A) mandatory Preferred Stock cash dividends in respect of
all Preferred Stock of Subsidiaries of such Person and Disqualified Stock of
such Person held by Persons other than such Person or a Subsidiary multiplied
by (B) a fraction, the numerator of which is one and the denominator of which
is one minus the then current combined Federal, state and local statutory tax
rate of such Person, expressed as a decimal, in each case, determined on a
consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP; and (vii) the cash contributions to
any employee stock ownership plan or similar trust to the extent such
contributions are used by such plan or trust to pay interest to any Person
(other than the referent Person or any Subsidiary thereof) in connection with
Indebtedness Incurred by such plan or trust; provided, however, that as to the
Company, there shall be excluded therefrom any such interest expense of any
Unrestricted Subsidiary to the extent the related Indebtedness is not
Guaranteed or paid by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary. For purposes of
the foregoing, gross interest expense shall be determined after giving effect
to any net payments made or received by such Person and its Subsidiaries with
respect to Interest Rate Agreements.

                 "Consolidated Net Income" means, as to any Person, for any
period, the consolidated net income (loss) of such Person and its Subsidiaries
before preferred stock dividends, determined in accordance with GAAP; provided,
however, that there shall not be included in such Consolidated Net Income:  (i)
any net income (loss) of any Person if such Person is not (as to the Company) a
Restricted Subsidiary and (as to any other Person) an unconsolidated Person,
except that (A) subject to the limitations contained in clause (iv) below, the
referent Person's equity in the net income of any such Person for such period
shall be included in such Consolidated Net Income up to the aggregate amount of
cash actually distributed by such Person during such period to the referent
Person or a Subsidiary as a dividend or other distribution (subject, in the
case of a dividend or other distribution to a Subsidiary, to the limitations
contained in clause (iii) below) and (B) the net loss of such Person shall be
included to the extent of the aggregate Investment of the referent Person or
any of its Subsidiaries in such Person; (ii) any net income (loss) of any
Person acquired in a pooling of interests transaction for any period prior to
the date of such acquisition; (iii) any net income (loss) of any Restricted
Subsidiary (as to the Company) or of any Subsidiary (as to any other Person) if
such Subsidiary is subject to restrictions, directly or indirectly, on the
payment of dividends or the making of distributions by such Subsidiary,
directly or indirectly, to the Company, except that (A) subject to the
limitations contained in (iv) below, such Person's equity in the net income of
any such Subsidiary for such period shall be included in Consolidated Net
Income up to the aggregate amount of cash that could have been distributed by
such Subsidiary during such period to such Person or another Subsidiary as a
dividend (subject, in the case of a dividend that could have been made to
another Restricted Subsidiary, to the limitation contained in this clause) and
(B) the net loss of such Subsidiary shall be included in determining
Consolidated Net Income; (iv) any charges for costs and expenses associated
with the Transactions; (v) any extraordinary gain or loss and (vi) the
cumulative effect of a change in accounting principles.

                 "Consolidated Tangible Assets" means, as of any date of
determination, the total assets, less goodwill and other intangibles (other
than patents, trademarks, copyrights, licenses and other

<PAGE>   7
                                                                               7


intellectual property), shown on the balance sheet of the Company and its
Restricted Subsidiaries as of the most recent date for which such a balance
sheet is available, determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP
less all write-ups (other than write-ups in connection with acquisitions)
subsequent to the date of this Indenture in the book value of any asset (except
any such intangible assets) owned by the Company or any of its Restricted
Subsidiaries.

                 "Consolidation" means the consolidation of the accounts of
each of the Restricted Subsidiaries with those of the Company in accordance
with GAAP; provided, however, that "Consolidation" will not include
consolidation of the accounts of any Unrestricted Subsidiary, but the interest
of the Company in any Unrestricted Subsidiary will be accounted for as an
Investment. The term "Consolidated" has a correlative meaning.

                 "Convertible Preferred Stock" means (i) the convertible
preferred stock of the Company issued to Apollo, resulting in gross proceeds to
the Company of $250 million, and (ii) the convertible preferred stock of the
Company which will be issued to an Affiliate of Bear, Stearns & Co.
concurrently with the issuance of the Notes, resulting in gross proceeds to the
Company of $10 million.

                 "Currency Agreement" means in respect of a Person any foreign
exchange contract, currency swap agreement or other similar agreement or
arrangement (including derivative agreements or arrangements) as to which such
Person is a party or a beneficiary.

                 "Default" means any event or condition that is, or after
notice or passage of time or both would be, an Event of Default.

                 "Depositary" means The Depository Trust Company, its nominees
and their respective successors and assigns, or such other depository
institution hereinafter appointed by the Company.

                 "Designated Senior Indebtedness" means (i) the Bank
Indebtedness and (ii) any other Senior Indebtedness which, at the date of
determination, has an aggregate principal amount of, or under which, at the
date of determination, the holders thereof are committed to lend up to, at
least $25.0 million and is specifically designated by the Company in the
instrument evidencing or governing such Senior Indebtedness as "Designated
Senior Indebtedness" for purposes of this Indenture.

                 "Disqualified Stock" means, with respect to any Person, any
Capital Stock (other than the Convertible Preferred Stock) that by its terms
(or by the terms of any security into which it is convertible or for which it
is exchangeable or exercisable) or upon the happening of any event (i) matures
or is mandatorily redeemable pursuant to a sinking fund obligation or
otherwise, (ii) is convertible or exchangeable for Indebtedness or Disqualified
Stock or (iii) is redeemable at the option of the holder thereof, in whole or
in part, in the case of clauses (i), (ii) and (iii), on or prior to the 91st
day after the Stated Maturity of the Notes.

                 "EBITDA" means, as to any Person, for any period, the
Consolidated Net Income for such period, plus the following to the extent
included in calculating such Consolidated Net Income:  (i) income tax expense,
(ii) Consolidated Interest Expense, (iii) depreciation expense (other than
depreciation expense relating to rental merchandise), (iv) amortization
expense, and (v) other non-cash charges or non-cash losses, and minus any gain
(but not loss) realized upon the sale or other disposition of any asset of the
Company or its Restricted Subsidiaries (including pursuant to any
Sale/Leaseback Transaction) that is not sold or otherwise disposed of in the
ordinary course of business.

                 "Equity Offering" means a primary public or private offering
or sale of common stock of the Company, the proceeds of which shall be at least
$25.0 million.

                 "Exchange Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended.

                 "GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles in the
United States of America as in effect on the Issue Date (for purposes of the
definitions of the terms "Consolidated Coverage
<PAGE>   8
                                                                               8


Ratio," "Consolidated Interest Expense," "Consolidated Net Income" and
"EBITDA," all defined terms in this Indenture to the extent used in or relating
to any of the foregoing definitions, and all ratios and computations based on
any of the foregoing definitions) and as in effect from time to time (for all
other purposes of this Indenture), including those set forth in the opinions
and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board of the American Institute
of Certified Public Accountants and statements and pronouncements of the
Financial Accounting Standards Board or in such other statements by such other
entity as approved by a significant segment of the accounting profession. All
ratios and computations based on GAAP contained in this Indenture shall be
computed in conformity with GAAP.

                 "Guarantee" means any obligation, contingent or otherwise, of
any Person directly or indirectly guaranteeing any Indebtedness or other
nonfinancial obligation of any other Person, including any such obligation,
direct or indirect, contingent or otherwise, of such Person (i) to purchase or
pay (or advance or supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such
Indebtedness or such other obligation of such other Person (whether arising by
virtue of partnership arrangements, or by agreement to keep-well, to purchase
assets, goods, securities or services, to take-or-pay, or to maintain financial
statement conditions or otherwise) or (ii) entered into for purposes of
assuring in any other manner the obligee of such Indebtedness or other
obligation of the payment thereof or to protect such obligee against loss in
respect thereof (in whole or in part); provided, however, that the term
"Guarantee" shall not include endorsements for collection, or deposits made, in
the ordinary course of business. The term "Guarantee" used as a verb has a
corresponding meaning.

                 "Guarantor Senior Indebtedness" means, with respect to a
Subsidiary Guarantor, the following obligations, whether outstanding on the
date of this Indenture or thereafter Incurred, without duplication:  (i) any
Guarantee of the Senior Credit Facility by such Subsidiary Guarantor and all
other Guarantees by such Subsidiary Guarantor of Senior Indebtedness of the
Company or Guarantor Indebtedness for any other Subsidiary Guarantor; and (ii)
all obligations consisting of the principal of and premium, if any, and accrued
and unpaid interest (including interest accruing on or after the filing of any
petition in bankruptcy or for reorganization relating to the Subsidiary
Guarantor regardless of whether post filing interest is allowed in such
proceeding) on, and fees and other amounts owing in respect of, all other
Indebtedness of the Subsidiary Guarantor, unless, in the instrument creating or
evidencing the same or pursuant to which the same is outstanding, it is
expressly provided that the obligations in respect of such Indebtedness are not
senior in right of payment to the obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor
under the Subsidiary Guarantee; provided, however, that Guarantor Senior
Indebtedness will not include (1) any obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor
to another Subsidiary Guarantor or any other Affiliate of the Subsidiary
Guarantor or any such Affiliate's Subsidiaries, (2) any liability for Federal,
state, local, foreign or other taxes owed or owing by such Subsidiary
Guarantor, (3) any accounts payable or other liability to trade creditors
arising in the ordinary course of business (including Guarantees thereof or
instruments evidencing such liabilities) or other current liabilities (other
than current liabilities which constitute Bank Indebtedness or the current
portion of any long-term Indebtedness which would constitute Senior
Indebtedness but for the operation of this clause (3), (4) any Indebtedness,
Guarantee or obligation of such Subsidiary Guarantor that is expressly
subordinate or junior to any other Indebtedness, Guarantee or obligation of
such Subsidiary Guarantor, including any Guarantor Senior Subordinated
Indebtedness and Guarantor Subordinated Obligations of such Subsidiary
Guarantor, (5) Indebtedness which is represented by redeemable Capital Stock or
(6) that portion of any Indebtedness that is Incurred in violation of this
Indenture.  If any Designated Senior Indebtedness is disallowed, avoided or
subordinated pursuant to the provisions of Section 548 of Title 11 of the
United States Code or any applicable state fraudulent conveyance law, such
Designated Senior Indebtedness nevertheless will constitute Senior
Indebtedness.

                 "Guarantor Senior Subordinated Indebtedness" means with
respect to a Subsidiary Guarantor, the obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor
under the Subsidiary Guarantee and any other Indebtedness of such Subsidiary
Guarantor (whether outstanding on the Issue Date or thereafter Incurred) that
specifically provides that such Indebtedness is to rank pari passu in right of
payment with the obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor under the Subsidiary
Guarantee and is not expressly subordinated by its terms in right of payment to
any Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor which is not Guarantor Senior
Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor.

<PAGE>   9
                                                                               9


                 "Guarantor Subordinated Obligation" means, with respect to a
Subsidiary Guarantor, any Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor (whether
outstanding on the Issue Date or thereafter Incurred) which is expressly
subordinated in right of payment to the obligations of such Subsidiary
Guarantor under its Subsidiary Guarantee pursuant to a written agreement.

                 "Hedging Obligations" of any Person means the obligations of
such Person pursuant to any Interest Rate Agreement or Currency Agreement.

                 "Holder" or "Noteholder" means the Person in whose name a Note
is registered in the Register.

                 "Incur" means issue, assume, enter into any Guarantee of,
incur or otherwise become liable for; provided, however, that any Indebtedness
or Capital Stock of a Person existing at the time such Person becomes a
Subsidiary (whether by merger, consolidation, acquisition or otherwise) shall
be deemed to be Incurred by such Subsidiary at the time it becomes a
Subsidiary. Any Indebtedness issued at a discount (including Indebtedness on
which interest is payable through the issuance of additional Indebtedness)
shall be deemed incurred at the time of original issuance of the Indebtedness
at the initial accreted amount thereof.

                 "Indebtedness" means, with respect to any Person on any date
of determination (without duplication):  (i) the principal of indebtedness of
such Person for borrowed money, (ii) the principal of obligations of such
Person evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes or other similar instruments,
(iii) all reimbursement obligations of such Person, including reimbursement
obligations in respect of letters of credit or other similar instruments (the
amount of such obligations being equal at any time to the aggregate then
undrawn and unexpired amount of such letters of credit or other instruments
plus the aggregate amount of drawings thereunder that have not then been
reimbursed), (iv) all obligations of such Person to pay the deferred and unpaid
purchase price of property or services (except Trade Payables), which purchase
price is due more than one year after the date of placing such property in
final service or taking final delivery and title thereto or the completion of
such services, (v) all Capitalized Lease Obligations and Attributable Debt of
such Person, (vi) the redemption, repayment or other repurchase amount of such
Person with respect to any Disqualified Stock or (if such Person is a
Subsidiary of the Company) any Preferred Stock of such Subsidiary, but
excluding, in each case, any accrued dividends (the amount of such obligation
to be equal at any time to the maximum fixed involuntary redemption, repayment
or repurchase price for such Capital Stock, or if such Capital Stock has no
fixed price, to the involuntary redemption, repayment or repurchase price
therefor calculated in accordance with the terms thereof as if then redeemed,
repaid or repurchased, and if such price is based upon or measured by the fair
market value of such Capital Stock, such fair market value shall be as
determined in good faith by the Board of Directors or the board of directors of
the issuer of such Capital Stock), (vii) all Indebtedness of other Persons
secured by a Lien on any asset of such Person, whether or not such Indebtedness
is assumed by such Person; provided, however, that the amount of Indebtedness
of such Person shall be the lesser of (A) the fair market value of such asset
at such date of determination and (B) the amount of such Indebtedness of such
other Persons, (viii) all Indebtedness of other Persons to the extent
Guaranteed by such Person, and (ix) to the extent not otherwise included in
this definition, net Hedging Obligations of such Person (such obligations to be
equal at any time to the termination value of such agreement or arrangement
giving rise to such Hedging Obligation that would be payable by such Person at
such time).

                 The amount of Indebtedness of any Person at any date shall be
determined as set forth above or otherwise provided in this Indenture, or
otherwise in accordance with GAAP.

                 "Indenture" means this Indenture as amended or supplemented
from time to time.

                 "Interest Rate Agreement" means with respect to any Person any
interest rate protection agreement, interest rate future agreement, interest
rate option agreement, interest rate swap agreement, interest rate cap
agreement, interest rate collar agreement, interest rate hedge agreement or
other similar agreement or arrangement (including derivative agreement or
arrangements) as to which such

<PAGE>   10
                                                                              10


Person is party or a beneficiary; provided, however, any such agreements
entered into in connection with the Notes shall not be included.

                 "Investment" in any Person by any other Person means any
direct or indirect advance, loan or other extension of credit (other than to
customers, directors, officers or employees of any Person in the ordinary
course of business) or capital contribution to (by means of any transfer of
cash or other property to others or any payment for property or services for
the account or use of others), or any purchase or acquisition of Capital Stock,
Indebtedness or other similar instruments issued by, such Person. If the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary of the Company sells or otherwise disposes
of any Capital Stock of any direct or indirect Restricted Subsidiary of the
Company such that, after giving effect to any such sale or disposition, such
entity is no longer a Subsidiary of the Company, the Company shall be deemed to
have made an Investment on the date of any such sale or disposition equal to
the fair market value of the Capital Stock of such Subsidiary not sold or
disposed of.

                 "Issue Date" means the date on which the Initial Notes are
originally issued.

                 "Lien" means any mortgage, pledge, security interest,
encumbrance, lien or charge of any kind (including any conditional sale or
other title retention agreement or lease in the nature thereof).

                 "Moody's" means Moody's Investors Service, Inc. and its
successors.

                 "Net Available Cash" from an Asset Disposition means cash
payments received (including any cash payments received by way of deferred
payment of principal pursuant to a note or installment receivable or otherwise,
but only as and when received, but excluding any other consideration received
in the form of assumption by the acquiring person of Indebtedness or other
obligations relating to the properties or assets that are the subject of such
Asset Disposition or received in any other noncash form) therefrom, in each
case net of (i) all legal, title and recording tax expenses, commissions and
other fees and expenses incurred (including, without limitation, fees and
expenses of legal counsel, accountants and financial advisors), and all
Federal, state, provincial, foreign and local taxes required to be paid or
accrued as a liability under GAAP, as a consequence of such Asset Disposition,
(ii) all payments made on any Indebtedness that is secured by any assets
subject to such Asset Disposition, in accordance with the terms of any Lien
upon such assets, or that must by its terms, or in order to obtain a necessary
consent to such Asset Disposition, or by applicable law be repaid out of the
proceeds from such Asset Disposition, (iii) all distributions and other
payments required to be made to minority interest holders in Subsidiaries or
joint ventures as a result of such Asset Disposition or to any other Person
(other than the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary) owning a beneficial
interest in the assets disposed of in such Asset Disposition and (iv)
appropriate amounts to be provided by the seller as a reserve, in accordance
with GAAP, against any liabilities associated with the assets disposed of in
such Asset Disposition and retained by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
after such Asset Disposition.

                 "Net Cash Proceeds" means, with respect to any issuance or
sale of any securities of the Company or any Subsidiary by the Company or any
Subsidiary, or any capital contribution, the cash proceeds of such issuance,
sale or contribution net of attorneys' fees, accountants' fees, underwriters'
or placement agents' fees, discounts or commissions and brokerage, consultant
and other fees and expenses actually incurred in connection with such issuance,
sale or contribution and net of taxes paid or payable as a result thereof.

                 "Non-Recourse Debt" means Indebtedness (i) as to which neither
the Company nor any Restricted Subsidiary (A) provides any Guarantee or credit
support of any kind (including any undertaking, Guarantee, indemnity, agreement
or instrument that would constitute Indebtedness) or (B) is directly or
indirectly liable (as a guarantor or otherwise) and (ii) no default with
respect to which (including any rights that the holders thereof may have to
take enforcement action against an Unrestricted Subsidiary) would permit (upon
notice, lapse of time or both) any holder of any other Indebtedness of the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary to declare a default under such other
Indebtedness or cause the payment thereof to be accelerated or payable prior to
its stated maturity.

<PAGE>   11
                                                                              11


                 "Offering Memorandum" means the Offering Memorandum dated
August 13, 1998 relating to the Initial Notes.

                 "Officer" means the Chief Executive Officer, President, Chief
Financial Officer, any Vice President, Controller, Secretary or Treasurer of
the Company.

                 "Officers' Certificate" means a certificate signed by two
Officers.

                 "Opinion of Counsel" means a written opinion from legal
counsel who is acceptable to the Trustee. The counsel may be an employee of or
counsel to the Company or the Trustee.

                 "Permitted Holders" Apollo, J. Ernest Talley and Mark E.
Speese, their respective Affiliates and successors or assigns and any Person
acting in the capacity of an underwriter in connection with a public or private
offering of the Company's Capital Stock.

                 "Permitted Investment" means an Investment by the Company or
any Restricted Subsidiary in any of the following:

                     (i)  a Restricted Subsidiary, the Company or a Person that
         will, upon the making of such Investment, become a Restricted
         Subsidiary;

                    (ii)  another Person if as a result of such Investment such
         other Person is merged or consolidated with or into, or transfers or
         conveys all or substantially all its assets to, the Company or a
         Restricted Subsidiary;

                   (iii)  Temporary Cash Investments or Cash Equivalents;

                    (iv)  receivables owing to the Company or any Restricted
         Subsidiary, if created or acquired in the ordinary course of business
         and payable or dischargeable in accordance with customary trade terms;
         provided, however, that such trade terms may include such
         concessionary trade terms as the Company or any such Restricted
         Subsidiary deems reasonable under the circumstances;

                     (v)  securities or other Investments received as
         consideration in connection with RTO Facility Swaps or in sales or
         other dispositions of property or assets made in compliance with the
         covenant contained in Section 1017;

                    (vi)  securities or other Investments received in
         settlement of debts created in the ordinary course of business and
         owing to the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary, or as a result of
         foreclosure, perfection or enforcement of any Lien, or in satisfaction
         of judgments, including in connection with any bankruptcy proceeding
         or other reorganization of another Person;

                   (vii)  Investments in existence or made pursuant to legally
         binding written commitments in existence on the Issue Date;

                  (viii)  Currency Agreements, Interest Rate Agreements and
         related Hedging Obligations, which obligations are Incurred in
         compliance with the covenant contained in Section 1010;

                    (ix)  pledges or deposits (A) with respect to leases or
         utilities provided to third parties in the ordinary course of business
         or (B) otherwise described in the definition of "Permitted Liens";

                     (x)  Investment in a Related Business in an amount not to
         exceed $10 million in the aggregate; and
<PAGE>   12
                                                                              12


                    (xi)  other Investments in an aggregate amount not to
         exceed the sum of $10 million and the aggregate non-cash net proceeds
         received by the Company from the issue or sale of its Capital Stock
         (other than Disqualified Stock) subsequent to the Issue Date (other
         than non-cash proceeds from an issuance or sale of such Capital Stock
         to a Subsidiary of the Company or an employee stock ownership plan or
         similar trust); provided, however, that the value of such non-cash net
         proceeds shall be as conclusively determined by the Board of Directors
         in good faith, except that in the event the value of any non-cash net
         proceeds shall be $25 million or more, the value shall be as
         determined in writing by an independent investment banking firm of
         nationally recognized standing.

                 "Permitted Liens" means:  (i) Liens for taxes, assessments or
other governmental charges not yet delinquent or the nonpayment of which in the
aggregate would not be reasonably expected to have a material adverse effect on
the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries, or that are being contested in
good faith and by appropriate proceedings if adequate reserves with respect
thereto are maintained on the books of the Company or such Subsidiary, as the
case may be, in accordance with GAAP; (ii) carriers', warehousemen's,
mechanics', landlords', materialmen's, repairmen's or other like Liens arising
in the ordinary course of business in respect of obligations that are not
overdue for a period of more than 60 days or that are bonded or that are being
contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings; (iii) pledges, deposits
or Liens in connection with workers' compensation, unemployment insurance and
other social security legislation and/or similar legislation or other
insurance-related obligations (including without limitation, pledges or
deposits securing liability to insurance carriers under insurance or
self-insurance arrangements); (iv) pledges, deposits or Liens to secure the
performance of bids, tenders, trade, government or other contracts (other than
for borrowed money), obligations for or under or in respect of utilities,
leases, licenses, statutory obligations, surety, judgment and appeal bonds,
performance bonds and other obligations of a like nature incurred in the
ordinary course of business; (v) easements (including reciprocal easement
agreements), rights-of-way, building, zoning and similar restrictions, utility
agreements, covenants, reservations, restrictions, encroachments, changes, and
other similar encumbrances or title defects incurred, or leases or subleases
granted to others, in the ordinary course of business, which do not in the
aggregate materially interfere with the ordinary conduct of the business of the
Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole; (vi) Liens existing on, or
provided for under written arrangements existing on, the Issue Date, or (in the
case of any such Liens securing Indebtedness of the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries existing or arising under written arrangements existing on the
Issue Date) securing any Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of such
Indebtedness so long as the Lien securing such Refinancing Indebtedness is
limited to all or part of the same property or assets (plus improvements,
accessions, proceeds or dividends or distributions in respect thereof) that
secured (or under such written arrangements could secure) the original
Indebtedness; (vii) Liens securing Hedging Obligations Incurred in compliance
with the covenant contained in Section 1010; (viii) Liens arising out of
judgments, decrees, orders or awards in respect of which the Company shall in
good faith be prosecuting an appeal or proceedings for review which appeal or
proceedings shall not have been finally terminated, or the period within which
such appeal or proceedings may be initiated shall not have expired; (ix) Liens
securing (A) Indebtedness Incurred in compliance with clause (i), (ii) or (v)
of the second paragraph of Section 1010 or clause (iv) thereof (other than
Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred in respect of Indebtedness described in the
first paragraph thereof) or (B) Bank Indebtedness; (x) Liens on properties or
assets of the Company securing Senior Indebtedness; (xi) Liens existing on
property or assets of a Person at the time such Person becomes a Subsidiary of
the Company (or at the time the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary acquires
such property or assets); provided, however, that such Liens are not created in
connection with, or in contemplation of, such other Person becoming such a
Subsidiary (or such acquisition of such property or assets), and that such
Liens are limited to all or part of the same property or assets (plus
improvements, accessions, proceeds or dividends or distributions in respect
thereof) that secured (or, under the written arrangements under which such
Liens arose, could secure) the obligations to which such Liens relate, (xii)
Liens on Capital Stock of an Unrestricted Subsidiary that secure Indebtedness
or other obligations of such Unrestricted Subsidiary; (xiii) Liens securing the
Notes; and (xiv) Liens securing Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred in respect of
any Indebtedness secured by, or securing any refinancing, refunding, extension,
renewal or replacement (in whole or in part) of any other obligation secured
by, any other Permitted Liens, provided that any such new Lien is limited to
all or part

<PAGE>   13
                                                                              13


of the same property or assets (plus improvements, accessions, proceeds or
dividends or distributions in respect thereof) that secured (or, under the
written arrangements under which the original Lien arose, could secure) the
obligations to which such Liens relate.

                 "Person" means any individual, corporation, partnership, joint
venture, association, joint-stock company, limited liability company, trust,
unincorporated organization, government or any agency or political subdivision
thereof or any other entity.

                 "Preferred Stock", as applied to the Capital Stock of any
corporation, means Capital Stock of any class or classes (however designated)
that is preferred as to the payment of dividends, or as to the distribution of
assets upon any voluntary or involuntary liquidation or dissolution of such
corporation, over shares of Capital Stock of any other class of such
corporation.

                 "Purchase Money Obligations" means any Indebtedness of the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary Incurred to finance the acquisition,
construction or capital improvement of any property or business (including
Indebtedness Incurred within 90 days following such acquisition or
construction), including Indebtedness of a Person existing at the time such
Person becomes a Restricted Subsidiary or assumed by the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary in connection with the acquisition of assets from such
Person; provided, however, that any Lien on such Indebtedness shall not extend
to any property other than the property so acquired or constructed.

                 "RAC" means Rent-A-Center, Inc.

                 "Refinancing Indebtedness" means Indebtedness that is Incurred
to refund, refinance, replace, renew, repay or extend (including pursuant to
any defeasance or discharge mechanism) (collectively, "refinances" and
"refinanced" shall have a correlative meaning) any Indebtedness existing on the
date of this Indenture or Incurred in compliance with this Indenture (including
Indebtedness of the Company that refinances Indebtedness of any Restricted
Subsidiary (to the extent permitted in this Indenture) and Indebtedness of any
Restricted Subsidiary that refinances Indebtedness of another Restricted
Subsidiary) including Indebtedness that refinances Refinancing Indebtedness;
provided, however, that (i) the Refinancing Indebtedness has a Stated Maturity
no earlier than the Stated Maturity of the Indebtedness being refinanced, (ii)
the Refinancing Indebtedness has an Average Life at the time such Refinancing
Indebtedness is Incurred that is equal to or greater than the Average Life of
the Indebtedness being refinanced and (iii) such Refinancing Indebtedness is
Incurred in an aggregate principal amount (or if issued with original issue
discount, an aggregate issue price) that is equal to or less than the aggregate
principal amount (or if issued with original issue discount, the aggregate
accreted value) then outstanding of the Indebtedness being refinanced, plus
fees, underwriting discounts, premiums and other costs and expenses incurred in
connection with such Refinancing Indebtedness; provided further, however, that
Refinancing Indebtedness shall not include (x) Indebtedness of a Restricted
Subsidiary that refinances Indebtedness of the Company or (y) Indebtedness of
the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary that refinances Indebtedness of an
Unrestricted Subsidiary.

                 "Registration Rights Agreement" means the Registration Rights
Agreement dated as of August 18, 1997 among the Company, Chase Securities Inc.,
Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc., NationsBanc Montgomery Securities LLC and Credit
Suisse First Boston Corporation.

                 "Regular Record Date" means, with respect to any Interest
Payment Date, the February 1 or August 1 (whether or not a Business Day), as
the case may be, next preceding such Interest Payment Date.

                 "Related Business" means those businesses, other than the car
rental business, in which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is engaged on
the date of this Indenture or that are reasonably related or incidental
thereto.

<PAGE>   14
                                                                              14


                 "Representative" means the trustee, agent or representative
(if any) of an issue of Senior Indebtedness.

                 "Restricted Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary of the Company
other than an Unrestricted Subsidiary.

                 "Revolving Credit Facility" means the revolving credit
facility under the Senior Credit Facility (which may include any swing line or
letter of credit facility or subfacility thereunder).

                 "RTO Facility" means any facility through which the Company or
any of its Restricted Subsidiaries conducts the business of renting merchandise
to its customers and any facility through which a franchisee of the Company or
any of its Subsidiaries conducts the business of renting merchandise to
customers.

                 "RTO Facility Swap" means an exchange of assets (including
Capital Stock of a Subsidiary or the Company) of substantially equivalent fair
market value, as conclusively determined in good faith by the Board of
Directors, by the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary for one or more RTO
Facilities or for cash, Capital Stock, Indebtedness or other securities of any
Person owning or operating one or more RTO Facilities and primarily engaged in
a Related Business; provided, however, that any Net Cash Proceeds received by
the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary in connection with any such
transaction must be applied in accordance with Section 1017.

                 "Sale/Leaseback Transaction" means an arrangement relating to
property now owned or hereafter acquired by the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary whereby the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary transfers such
property to a Person and the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary leases it
from such Person, other than leases (i) between the Company and a Restricted
Subsidiary or (ii) required to be classified and accounted for as capitalized
leases for financial reporting purposes in accordance with GAAP.

                 "SEC" means the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                 "Secured Indebtedness" means any Indebtedness of the Company
secured by a Lien.

                 "Securities Act" means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

                 "Senior Credit Agreement" means the credit agreement dated as
of August 5, 1998, among the Company, the banks and other financial
institutions party thereto from time to time, the documentation agent,
NationsBank, N.A. as syndication agent and Chase, as administrative agent, as
such agreement may be assumed by any successor in interest, and as such
agreement may be amended, supplemented, waived or otherwise modified from time
to time, or refunded, refinanced, restructured, replaced, renewed, repaid,
increased or extended from time to time (whether in whole or in part, whether
with the original agent and lenders or other agents and lenders or otherwise,
and whether provided under the original Senior Credit Agreement or otherwise).

                 "Senior Credit Facility" means the collective reference to the
Senior Credit Agreement, any Loan Documents (as defined therein), any notes and
letters of credit issued pursuant thereto and any guarantee and collateral
agreement, patent and trademark security agreement, mortgages, letter of credit
applications and other security agreements and collateral documents, and other
instruments and documents, executed and delivered pursuant to or in connection
with any of the foregoing, in each case as the same may be amended,
supplemented, waived or otherwise modified from time to time, or refunded,
refinanced, restructured, replaced, renewed, repaid, increased or extended from
time to time (whether in whole or in part, whether with the original agent and
lenders or other agents and lenders or otherwise, and whether provided under
the original Senior Credit Agreement or otherwise). Without limiting the
generality of the foregoing, the term "Senior Credit Facility" shall include
any agreement (i) changing the maturity of any Indebtedness Incurred thereunder
or contemplated thereby, (ii) adding Subsidiaries of the Company as additional
borrowers or guarantors thereunder, (iii) increasing the

<PAGE>   15
                                                                              15


amount of Indebtedness Incurred thereunder or available to be borrowed
thereunder or (iv) otherwise altering the terms and conditions thereof.

                 "Senior Indebtedness" means the following obligations, whether
outstanding on the date of this Indenture or thereafter issued, without
duplication:  (i) all obligations consisting of Bank Indebtedness; and (ii) all
obligations consisting of the principal of and premium, if any, and accrued and
unpaid interest (including interest accruing on or after the filing of any
petition in bankruptcy or for reorganization relating to the Company regardless
of whether postfiling interest is allowed in such proceeding) on, and fees and
other amounts owing in respect of, all other Indebtedness of the Company,
unless, in the instrument creating or evidencing the same or pursuant to which
the same is outstanding, it is provided that the obligations in respect of such
Indebtedness are not superior in right of payment to the Notes; provided,
however, that Senior Indebtedness shall not include (A) any obligation of the
Company to any Subsidiary or any other Affiliate of the Company, or any such
Affiliate's Subsidiaries, (B) any liability for Federal, state, foreign, local
or other taxes owed or owing by the Company, (C) any accounts payable or other
liability to trade creditors arising in the ordinary course of business
(including Guarantees thereof or instruments evidencing such liabilities) or
other current liabilities (other than current liabilities which constitute Bank
Indebtedness or the current portion of any long-term Indebtedness which would
constitute Senior Indebtedness but for the operation of this clause (C)), (D)
any Indebtedness, Guarantee or obligation of the Company that is expressly
subordinate or junior to any other Indebtedness, Guarantee or obligation of the
Company, (E) Indebtedness which is represented by redeemable Capital Stock or
(F) that portion of any Indebtedness that is Incurred in violation of this
Indenture. If any Designated Senior Indebtedness is disallowed, avoided or
subordinated pursuant to the provisions of Section 548 of Title 11 of the
United States Code or any applicable state fraudulent conveyance law, such
Designated Senior Indebtedness nevertheless will constitute Senior
Indebtedness.

                 "Senior Subordinated Indebtedness" means the Notes and any
other Indebtedness of the Company that (i) specifically provides that such
Indebtedness is to rank pari passu with the Notes or is otherwise entitled
Senior Subordinated Indebtedness and (ii) is not subordinated by its terms to
any Indebtedness or other obligation of the Company that is not Senior
Indebtedness.

                 "Shelf Registration Statement" has the meaning ascribed
thereto in the Registration Rights Agreement.

                 "Significant Subsidiary" means (i) each Subsidiary that for
the most recent fiscal year of such Subsidiary had consolidated revenues
greater than $10.0 million or as at the end of such fiscal year had assets or
liabilities greater than $10.0 million and (ii) any group of Subsidiaries that,
taken together, would constitute a Significant Subsidiary.

                 "S&P" means Standard & Poor's Ratings Service, a division of
The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. and its successors.

                 "Stated Maturity" means, with respect to any security, the
date specified in such security as the fixed date on which the payment of
principal of such security is due and payable, including pursuant to any
mandatory redemption provision (but excluding any provision providing for the
repurchase of such security at the option of the holder thereof upon the
happening of any contingency beyond the control of the issuer unless such
contingency has occurred).

                 "Subordinated Obligation" means any Indebtedness of the
Company (whether outstanding on the date of this Indenture or thereafter
Incurred) which is subordinate or junior in right of payment to the Notes
pursuant to a written agreement.

                 "Subsidiary" of any Person means any corporation, association,
partnership or other business entity of which more than 50% of the total voting
power of shares of Capital Stock or other interests (including partnership
interests) entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency)

<PAGE>   16
                                                                              16


to vote in the election of directors, managers or trustees thereof is at the
time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by (i) such Person or (ii)
one or more Subsidiaries of such Person.

                 "Subsidiary Guarantee" means, individually, any Guarantee of
payment of the Notes by a Subsidiary Guarantor pursuant to the terms of this
Indenture, and, collectively, all such Guarantees.  Each such Subsidiary
Guarantee will be in the form prescribed in this Indenture.

                 "Subsidiary Guarantor" means (i) each Subsidiary of the
Company in existence on the Issue Date and (ii) any Restricted Subsidiary
created or acquired by the Company after the Issue Date.

                 "Successor Company" shall have the meaning assigned thereto in
Section 801.

                 "Temporary Cash Investments" means any of the following:  (i)
any investment in direct obligations (x) of the United States of America or any
agency thereof or obligations Guaranteed by the United States of America or any
agency thereof or (y) of any foreign country recognized by the United States of
America rated at least "A" by S&P or "A-1" by Moody's, (ii) investments in time
deposit accounts, certificates of deposit and money market deposits maturing
within 180 days of the date of acquisition thereof issued by a bank or trust
company that is organized under the laws of the United States of America, any
state thereof or any foreign country recognized by the United States of America
having capital and surplus aggregating in excess of $250 million (or the
foreign currency equivalent thereof), and whose long-term debt is rated "A" by
S&P or "A-1" by Moody's, (iii) repurchase obligations with a term of not more
than 180 days for underlying securities of the types described in clause (i) or
(ii) above entered into with a bank meeting the qualifications described in
clause (ii) above, (iv) Investments in commercial paper, maturing not more than
180 days after the date of acquisition, issued by a corporation (other than an
Affiliate of the Company) organized and in existence under the laws of the
United States of America or any foreign country recognized by the United States
of America with a rating at the time as of which any Investment therein is made
of "P-1" (or higher) according to Moody's or "A-1" (or higher) according to
S&P, (v) Investments in securities with maturities of six months or less from
the date of acquisition issued or fully guaranteed by any state, commonwealth
or territory of the United States of America, or by any political subdivision
or taxing authority thereof, and rated at least "A" by S&P or "A" by Moody's,
(vi) any money market deposit accounts issued or offered by a domestic
commercial bank or a commercial bank organized and located in a country
recognized by the United States of America, in each case, having capital and
surplus in excess of $250 million (or the foreign currency equivalent thereof),
or investments in money market funds complying with the risk limiting
conditions of Rule 2a-7 (or any short-term successor rule) of the SEC, under
the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, and (vii) similar short-term
investments approved by the Board of Directors in the ordinary course of
business.

                 "Term Loan Facility" means the term loan facilities provided
under the Senior Credit Facility.

                 "TIA" means the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 (15 U.S.C. Sections
77aaa-77bbbb) as in effect on the date of this Indenture.

                 "Trade Payables" means, with respect to any Person, any
accounts payable or any Indebtedness or monetary obligation to trade creditors
created, assumed or Guaranteed by such Person arising in the ordinary course of
business in connection with the acquisition of goods or services.

                 "Transactions," means collectively the Acquisition, the
offering of the Initial Notes, the initial borrowings under the Senior Credit
Facility, and all other transactions relating to the Acquisition or the
financing thereof (including the issuance of the Convertible Preferred Stock).

                 "Transfer Restricted Notes" means Notes that bear or are
required to bear the legend set forth in Section 202 hereof.

                 "Trustee" means the party named as such in this Indenture
until a successor replaces it and, thereafter, means the successor.

<PAGE>   17
                                                                              17


                 "Trust Officer" means the Chairman of the Board, the President
or any other officer or assistant officer of the Trustee assigned by the
Trustee to administer its corporate trust matters.

                 "Unrestricted Subsidiary" means (i) any Subsidiary of the
Company that at the time of determination shall be designated an Unrestricted
Subsidiary by the Board of Directors in the manner provided below and (ii) any
Subsidiary of an Unrestricted Subsidiary. The Board of Directors may designate
any Subsidiary of the Company (including any newly acquired or newly formed
Subsidiary of the Company) to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary unless such
Subsidiary or any of its Subsidiaries owns any Capital Stock or Indebtedness
of, or owns or holds any Lien on any property of, the Company or any other
Subsidiary of the Company that is not a Subsidiary of the Subsidiary to be so
designated; provided, however, that either (A) the Subsidiary to be so
designated has total consolidated assets of $10,000 or less or (B) if such
Subsidiary has consolidated assets greater than $10,000, then such designation
would be permitted under Section 1009.  The Board of Directors may designate
any Unrestricted Subsidiary to be a Restricted Subsidiary; provided, however,
that immediately after giving effect to such designation, (x) the Company could
Incur at least $1.00 of additional Indebtedness under the first paragraph in
the covenant contained in Section 1010 and (y) no Default or Event of Default
shall have occurred and be continuing. Any such designation by the Board of
Directors shall be evidenced to the Trustee by promptly filing with the Trustee
a copy of the resolution of the Company's Board of Directors giving effect to
such designation and an Officers' Certificate certifying that such designation
complied with the foregoing provisions.

                 "U.S. Government Obligations" means direct obligations (or
certificates representing an ownership interest in such obligations) of the
United States of America (including any agency or instrumentality thereof) for
the payment of which the full faith and credit of the United States of America
is pledged and which are not callable or redeemable at the issuer's option.

                 "Voting Stock" of an entity means all classes of Capital Stock
of such entity then outstanding and normally entitled to vote in the election
of directors or all interests in such entity with the ability to control the
management or actions of such entity.

                 "Wholly Owned Subsidiary" means a Restricted Subsidiary of the
Company, all of the Capital Stock of which (other than directors' qualifying
shares) is owned by the Company or another Wholly Owned Subsidiary.

                 SECTION 102.  Compliance Certificates and Opinions.

                 Upon any application or request by the Company or any
Subsidiary Guarantor to the Trustee to take any action under any provision of
this Indenture, the Company and such Subsidiary Guarantor, as the case may be,
shall furnish to the Trustee an Officers' Certificate in form and substance
reasonably acceptable to the Trustee stating that all conditions precedent, if
any, provided for in this Indenture (including any covenant compliance with
which constitutes a condition precedent) relating to the proposed action have
been complied with and an Opinion of Counsel stating that in the opinion of
such counsel all such conditions precedent, if any, have been complied with,
except that in the case of any such application or request as to which the
furnishing of such documents is specifically required by any provision of this
Indenture relating to such particular application or request, no additional
certificate or opinion need be furnished.

                 Each certificate or opinion with respect to compliance with a
condition or covenant provided for in this Indenture (including certificates
provided pursuant to Section 1018(a)) shall include:

                 (1)      a statement that each individual signing such
         certificate or opinion has read such covenant or condition and the
         definitions herein relating thereto;

                 (2)      a brief statement as to the nature and scope of the
         examination or investigation upon which the statements or opinions
         contained in such certificate or opinion are based;

<PAGE>   18
                                                                              18


                 (3)      a statement that, in the opinion of each such
         individual or such firm, he or it has made such examination or
         investigation as is necessary to enable him or it to express an
         informed opinion as to whether or not such covenant or condition has
         been complied with; and

                 (4)      a statement as to whether, in the opinion of each
         such individual, such condition or covenant has been complied with.

                 SECTION 103.  Form of Documents Delivered to Trustee.

                 In any case where several matters are required to be certified
by, or covered by an opinion of, any specified Person, it is not necessary that
all such matters be certified by, or covered by the opinion of, only one such
Person, or that they be so certified or covered by only one document, but one
such Person may certify or give an opinion with respect to some matters and one
or more other such Persons as to other matters, and any such Person may certify
or give an opinion as to such matters in one or several documents.

                 Any certificate or opinion of an officer of the Company, any
Guarantor or other obligor on the Notes may be based, insofar as it relates to
legal matters, upon a certificate or opinion of, or representations by,
counsel, unless such officer knows, or in the exercise of reasonable care
should know, that the certificate or opinion or representations with respect to
the matters upon which his certificate or opinion is based are erroneous.  Any
such certificate or Opinion of Counsel may be based, insofar as it relates to
factual matters, upon a certificate or opinion of, or representations by, an
officer or officers of the Company, any Guarantor or other obligor on the Notes
stating that the information with respect to such factual matters is in the
possession of the Company, any Guarantor or other obligor on the Notes unless
such counsel knows, or in the exercise of reasonable care should know, that the
certificate or opinion or representations with respect to such matters are
erroneous.

                 Where any Person is required to make, give or execute two or
more applications, requests, consents, certificates, statements, opinions or
other instruments under this Indenture, they may, but need not, be consolidated
and form one instrument.

                 SECTION 104.  Acts of Holders.

                 (a)      Any request, demand, authorization, direction,
notice, consent, waiver or other action provided by this Indenture to be given
or taken by Holders may be embodied in and evidenced by one or more instruments
of substantially similar tenor signed by such Holders in person or by agents
duly appointed in writing; and, except as herein otherwise expressly provided,
such action shall become effective when such instrument or instruments are
delivered to the Trustee and, where it is hereby expressly required, to the
Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors, as the case may be.  Such instrument or
instruments (and the action embodied therein and evidenced thereby) are herein
sometimes referred to as the "Act" of the Holders signing such instrument or
instruments.  Proof of execution of any such instrument or of a writing
appointing any such agent shall be sufficient for any purpose of this Indenture
and conclusive in favor of the Trustee, the Company and the Subsidiary
Guarantors, if made in the manner provided in this Section 104.

                 (b)      The fact and date of the execution by any Person of
any such instrument or writing may be proved by the affidavit of a witness of
such execution or by a certificate of a notary public or other officer
authorized by law to take acknowledgments of deeds, certifying that the
individual signing such instrument or writing acknowledged to him the execution
thereof.  Where such execution is by a signer acting in a capacity other than
his individual capacity, such certificate or affidavit shall also constitute
sufficient proof of authority.  The fact and date of the execution of any such
instrument or writing, or the authority of the Person executing the same, may
also be proved in any other manner that the Trustee deems sufficient.

                 (c)      The principal amount and serial numbers of Notes held
by any Person, and the date of holding the same, shall be proved by the Note
Register.

<PAGE>   19
                                                                              19


                 (d)      If the Company shall solicit from the Holders any
request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other
Act, the Company may, at its option, by or pursuant to a Board Resolution, fix
in advance a record date for the determination of Holders entitled to give such
request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other
Act, but the Company shall have no obligation to do so.  Notwithstanding TIA
Section 316(c), such record date shall be the record date specified in or
pursuant to such Board Resolution, which shall be a date not earlier than the
date 30 days prior to the first solicitation of Holders generally in connection
therewith and not later than the date such solicitation is completed.  If such
a record date is fixed, such request, demand, authorization, direction, notice,
consent, waiver or other Act may be given before or after such record date, but
only the Holders of record at the close of business on such record date shall
be deemed to be Holders for the purposes of determining whether Holders of the
requisite proportion of Outstanding Notes have authorized or agreed or
consented to such request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent,
waiver or other Act, and for that purpose the Outstanding Notes shall be
computed as of such record date; provided that no such authorization, agreement
or consent by the Holders on such record date shall be deemed effective unless
it shall become effective pursuant to the provisions of this Indenture not
later than six months after the record date.

                 (e)      Any request, demand, authorization, direction,
notice, consent, waiver or other Act of the Holder of any Note shall bind every
future Holder of the same Note and the Holder of every Note issued upon the
registration of transfer thereof or in exchange therefor or in lieu thereof
(including in accordance with Section 310) in respect of anything done, omitted
or suffered to be done by the Trustee, any Paying Agent or the Company or any
Guarantor in reliance thereon, whether or not notation of such action is made
upon such Note.

                 SECTION 105.  Notices, Etc., to Trustee, the Company and any
Guarantor.

                 Any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice,
consent, waiver or Act of Holders or other document provided or permitted by
this Indenture to be made upon, given or furnished to, or filed with,

                 (1)      the Trustee by any Holder or by the Company or any
         Subsidiary Guarantor shall be sufficient for every purpose hereunder
         if made, given, furnished or delivered in writing and mailed,
         first-class postage prepaid, or delivered by recognized overnight
         courier, to or with the Trustee and received at its Corporate Trust
         Office, Attention: Corporate Trust Administration.

                 (2)      the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor by the
         Trustee or by any Holder shall be sufficient for every purpose
         hereunder (unless otherwise herein expressly provided) if made, given,
         furnished or delivered, in writing, or mailed, first-class postage
         prepaid, or delivered by recognized overnight courier, to the Company
         or such Subsidiary Guarantor addressed to it and received at the
         address of its principal office specified in the first paragraph of
         this Indenture, or at any other address previously furnished in
         writing to the Trustee by the Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor.

                 SECTION 106.  Notice to Holders; Waiver.

                 Where this Indenture provides for notice of any event to
Holders by the Company, any Subsidiary Guarantor or the Trustee, such notice
shall be sufficiently given (unless otherwise herein expressly provided) if in
writing and mailed, first-class postage prepaid, to each Holder affected by
such event, at his address as it appears in the Note Register, not later than
the latest date, and not earlier than the earliest date, prescribed for the
giving of such notice.  Neither the failure to mail such notice, nor any defect
in any notice so mailed, to any particular Holder shall affect the sufficiency
of such notice with respect to other Holders.  Any notice mailed to a Holder in
the manner herein prescribed shall be conclusively deemed to have been received
by such Holder, whether or not such Holder actually receives such notice.
Where this Indenture provides for notice in any manner, such notice may be
waived in writing by the Person entitled to receive such notice, either before
or after the event, and such waiver shall be the equivalent of such notice.
Waivers of notice by Holders shall be filed with the

<PAGE>   20
                                                                              20


Trustee, but such filing shall not be a condition precedent to the validity of
any action taken in reliance upon such waiver.

                 In case by reason of the suspension of or irregularities in
regular mail service or by reason of any other cause, it shall be impracticable
to mail notice of any event to Holders when such notice is required to be given
pursuant to any provision of this Indenture, then any manner of giving such
notice as shall be satisfactory to the Trustee shall be deemed to be a
sufficient giving of such notice for every purpose hereunder.

                 If the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor mails any notice or
communication to any Holder, it shall mail a copy to the Trustee at the same
time.

                 SECTION 107.  Effect of Headings and Table of Contents.

                 The Article and Section headings herein and the Table of
Contents are for convenience only and shall not affect the construction hereof.

                 SECTION 108.  Successors and Assigns.

                 All covenants and agreements in this Indenture by the Company
and each Subsidiary Guarantor shall bind its successors and assigns, whether so
expressed or not.

                 SECTION 109.  Separability Clause.

                 In case any provision in this Indenture or in the Notes shall
be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability
of the remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired
thereby.

                 SECTION 110.  Benefits of Indenture.

                 Nothing in this Indenture or in the Notes, express or implied,
shall give to any Person, (other than the parties hereto, any agent and their
successors hereunder and each of the Holders and, with respect to any
provisions hereof relating to the subordination of the Notes or the rights of
holders of Senior Indebtedness, the holders of Senior Indebtedness) any benefit
or any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim under this Indenture.

                 SECTION 111.  Governing Law.

                 THIS INDENTURE AND THE NOTES SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND
CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK EXCLUDING (TO
THE GREATEST EXTENT PERMISSIBLE BY LAW) ANY RULE OF LAW THAT WOULD CAUSE THE
APPLICATION OF THE LAWS OF ANY JURISDICTION OTHER THAN THE STATE OF NEW YORK.
UPON THE ISSUANCE OF THE EXCHANGE NOTES OR THE EFFECTIVENESS OF THE SHELF
REGISTRATION STATEMENT, THIS INDENTURE SHALL BE SUBJECT TO THE PROVISIONS OF
THE TRUST INDENTURE ACT THAT ARE REQUIRED TO BE PART OF THIS INDENTURE AND
SHALL, TO THE EXTENT APPLICABLE, BE GOVERNED BY SUCH PROVISIONS.  EACH OF THE
PARTIES HERETO AGREES TO SUBMIT TO THE JURISDICTION OF THE COURTS OF THE STATE
OF NEW YORK AND THE U.S. FEDERAL COURTS, IN EACH CASE SITTING IN THE BOROUGH OF
MANHATTAN, AND WAIVES ANY OBJECTION AS TO VENUE OR FORUM NON CONVENIENS.

                 SECTION 112.  Legal Holidays.

                 In any case where any interest payment date, any date
established for payment of Defaulted Interest pursuant to Section 311 or
redemption date or Stated Maturity of any Note shall not be a Business Day,
then (notwithstanding any other provision of this Indenture or of the Notes)
payment of principal (or premium, if any) or interest need not be made on such
date, but may be made on the

<PAGE>   21
                                                                              21


next succeeding Business Day with the same force and effect as if made on the
interest payment date or date established for payment of Defaulted Interest
pursuant to Section 311, Redemption Date, or at the Stated Maturity or
Maturity; provided that no interest shall accrue for the period from and after
such interest payment date, redemption date or date established for payment of
Defaulted Interest pursuant to Section 311, Stated Maturity or Maturity, as the
case may be, to the next succeeding Business Day.

                 SECTION 113.  No Personal Liability of Directors, Officers,
Employees, Stockholders or Incorporators.

                 No director, officer, employee, incorporator or stockholders,
as such, of the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor shall have any liability
for any obligations of the Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor under the
Notes, this Indenture or any Subsidiary Guarantee or for any claim based on, in
respect of, or by reason of, such obligations or their creations.  Each Holder
by accepting a Note waives and releases all such liability.  Such waiver and
release are part of the consideration for the issuance of the Notes.

                 SECTION 114.  Counterparts.

                 This Indenture may be executed in any number of counterparts,
each of which shall be original; but such counterparts shall together
constitute but one and the same instrument.

                 SECTION 115.  Communications by Holders with Other Holders.

                 Holders may communicate pursuant to TIA Section 312(b) with
other Holders with respect to their rights under this Indenture or the Notes.
The Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors, the Trustee, the Note Registrar and
anyone else shall have the protection of TIA Section 312(c).


                            ARTICLE TWO.  NOTE FORMS
200.

                 SECTION 201.  Forms Generally.

                 The Notes and the Trustee's certificate of authentication
shall be in substantially the forms set forth in this Article, with such
appropriate insertions, omissions, substitutions and other variations as are
required or permitted by this Indenture, and may have such letters, numbers or
other marks of identification and such legends or endorsements placed thereon
as may be required to comply with applicable laws or the rules of any
securities exchange or as may, consistently herewith, be determined by the
officers executing such Notes, as evidenced by their execution of the Notes.
Any portion of the text of any Note may be set forth on the reverse thereof,
with an appropriate reference thereto on the face of the Note.  Each Note shall
be dated the date of its authentication.

                 Initial Notes offered and sold to the qualified institutional
buyers (as defined in Rule 144A under the Securities Act) in the United States
of America ("Rule 144A Note") will be issued on the Issue Date in the form of a
permanent global Note substantially in the form set forth in Section 203 (a
"Rule 144A Global Note") deposited with the Trustee, as custodian for the
Depositary, duly executed by the Company and authenticated by the Trustee as
hereinafter provided. The Rule 144A Global Note may be represented by more than
one certificate, if so required by the Depositary's rules regarding the maximum
principal amount to be represented by a single certificate.  The aggregate
principal amount of the Rule 144A Global Note may from time to time be
increased or decreased by adjustments made on the records of the Trustee, as
custodian for the Depositary or its nominee, as hereinafter provided.

                 Initial Notes offered and sold outside the United States of
America ("Regulation S Note") in reliance on Regulation S shall be issued in
the form of a permanent global Note substantially in the form set forth in
Section 203 (a "Regulation S Global Note").  The Regulation S Global Note will
be deposited with the Trustee, as custodian for the Depositary, duly executed
by the Company and authenticated by the Trustee as hereinafter provided.  The
Regulation S Global Note may be represented

<PAGE>   22
                                                                              22


by more than one certificate, if so required by the Depositary's rules
regarding the maximum principal amount to be represented by a single
certificate.  The aggregate principal amount of the Regulation S Global Note
may from time to time be increased or decreased by adjustments made on the
records of the Trustee, as custodian for the Depositary or its nominee, as
hereinafter provided.

                 Initial Notes offered and sold to institutional "accredited
investors" (as defined in Rule 501(a)(1), (2), (3) and (7) under the Securities
Act) in the United States of America ("Institutional Accredited Investor Note")
will be issued in the form of a permanent global Note substantially in the form
set forth in Section 203 (a "Institutional Accredited Investor Global Note")
deposited with the Trustee, as custodian for the Depositary, duly executed by
the Company and authenticated by the Trustee as hereinafter provided. The
Institutional Accredited Investor Global Note may be represented by more than
one certificate, if so required by the Depositary's rules regarding the maximum
principal amount to be represented by a single certificate.  The aggregate
principal amount of the Institutional Accredited Investor Global Note may from
time to time be increased or decreased by adjustments made on the records of
the Trustee, as custodian for the Depositary or its nominee, as hereinafter
provided.

                 The Rule 144A Global Note, the Regulation S Global Note and
the Institutional Accredited Investor Global Note are sometimes collectively
herein referred to as the "Global Notes."

                 The definitive Notes shall be printed, lithographed or
engraved on steel-engraved borders or may be produced in any other manner, all
as determined by the officers of the Company executing such Notes, as evidenced
by their execution of such Notes.

                 SECTION 202.  Restrictive Legends.

                 Unless and until (i) an Initial Note is sold under an
effective Registration Statement or (ii) an Initial Note is exchanged for an
Exchange Note in connection with an effective Registration Statement, in each
case pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, the Rule 144A Global Note
and the Institutional Accredited Investor Global Note shall bear the following
legend (the "Private Placement Legend") on the face thereof:

                 THIS SECURITY HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT
         OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE "SECURITIES ACT"), OR ANY STATE SECURITIES
         LAWS.  NEITHER THIS SECURITY NOR ANY INTEREST OR PARTICIPATION HEREIN
         MAY BE REOFFERED, SOLD, ASSIGNED, TRANSFERRED, PLEDGED, ENCUMBERED OR
         OTHERWISE DISPOSED OF IN THE ABSENCE OF SUCH REGISTRATION OR UNLESS
         SUCH TRANSACTION IS EXEMPT FROM, OR NOT SUBJECT TO, SUCH REGISTRATION.

                 THE HOLDER OF THIS SECURITY BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF AGREES TO
         OFFER, SELL OR OTHERWISE TRANSFER SUCH SECURITY, PRIOR TO THE DATE
         (THE "RESALE RESTRICTION TERMINATION DATE") WHICH IS TWO YEARS AFTER
         THE LATER OF THE ORIGINAL ISSUE DATE HEREOF AND THE LAST DATE ON WHICH
         THE COMPANY OR ANY AFFILIATE OF THE COMPANY WAS THE OWNER OF THIS
         SECURITY (OR ANY PREDECESSOR OF SUCH SECURITY), ONLY (A) TO THE
         COMPANY, (B) PURSUANT TO A REGISTRATION STATEMENT THAT HAS BEEN
         DECLARED EFFECTIVE UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (C) FOR SO LONG AS THE
         SECURITIES ARE ELIGIBLE FOR RESALE PURSUANT TO RULE 144A UNDER THE
         SECURITIES ACT, TO A PERSON IT REASONABLY BELIEVES IS A "QUALIFIED
         INSTITUTIONAL BUYER" AS DEFINED IN RULE 144A THAT PURCHASES FOR ITS
         OWN ACCOUNT OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER TO
         WHOM NOTICE IS GIVEN THAT THE TRANSFER IS BEING MADE IN RELIANCE ON
         RULE 144A, (D) PURSUANT TO OFFERS AND SALES THAT OCCUR OUTSIDE THE
         UNITED STATES WITHIN THE MEANING OF REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES
         ACT, (E) TO AN INSTITUTIONAL ACCREDITED INVESTOR WITHIN THE MEANING OF
         SECTION 501(A)(1), (2), (3) OR (7) UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT THAT IS
         ACQUIRING THE SECURITY FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT, OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF SUCH
         AN INSTITUTIONAL ACCREDITED INVESTOR, IN EACH CASE IN A
<PAGE>   23
                                                                              23


         TRANSACTION INVOLVING A MINIMUM PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF $250,000 OF SUCH
         SECURITIES, FOR INVESTMENT PURPOSES AND NOT WITH A VIEW TO OR FOR
         OFFER OR SALE IN CONNECTION WITH ANY DISTRIBUTION IN VIOLATION OF THE
         SECURITIES ACT, OR (F) PURSUANT TO ANOTHER AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM
         THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT, SUBJECT TO THE
         COMPANY'S AND THE TRUSTEE'S RIGHT PRIOR TO ANY SUCH OFFER, SALE OR
         TRANSFER PURSUANT TO CLAUSE (D), (E) OR (F) ABOVE TO REQUIRE THE
         DELIVERY OF AN OPINION OF COUNSEL, CERTIFICATION AND/OR OTHER
         INFORMATION SATISFACTORY TO EACH OF THEM, AND IN THE CASE OF THE
         FOREGOING CLAUSE (E), A CERTIFICATE OF TRANSFER IN THE FORM APPEARING
         ON THE OTHER SIDE OF THIS SECURITY IS COMPLETED AND DELIVERED BY THE
         TRANSFEROR TO THE COMPANY AND THE TRUSTEE.  THIS LEGEND WILL BE
         REMOVED UPON THE REQUEST OF THE HOLDER AFTER THE RESALE RESTRICTION
         TERMINATION DATE.

                 The Regulation S Global Note shall bear the following legend
on the face thereof:

                 THIS SECURITY HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE U.S.
         SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE "SECURITIES ACT"), AND,
         ACCORDINGLY, MAY NOT BE OFFERED OR SOLD WITHIN THE UNITED STATES OR TO
         OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OR BENEFIT OF, U.S. PERSONS EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN
         THE FOLLOWING SENTENCE.  BY ITS ACQUISITION HEREOF, THE HOLDER (1)
         REPRESENTS THAT IT IS NOT A U.S. PERSON AND IS ACQUIRING THIS SECURITY
         IN AN OFFSHORE TRANSACTION, (2) BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF AGREES TO
         OFFER, SELL OR OTHERWISE TRANSFER SUCH SECURITY, PRIOR TO THE DATE
         (THE "RESALE RESTRICTION TERMINATION DATE") WHICH IS TWO YEARS AFTER
         THE LATER OF THE ORIGINAL ISSUE DATE HEREOF AND THE LAST DATE ON WHICH
         THE COMPANY OR ANY AFFILIATE OF THE COMPANY WAS THE OWNER OF THIS
         SECURITY (OR ANY PREDECESSOR OF SUCH SECURITY), ONLY (A) TO THE
         COMPANY, (B) PURSUANT TO A REGISTRATION STATEMENT THAT HAS BEEN
         DECLARED EFFECTIVE UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (C) FOR SO LONG AS THE
         SECURITIES ARE ELIGIBLE FOR RESALE PURSUANT TO RULE 144A UNDER THE
         SECURITIES ACT, TO A PERSON IT REASONABLY BELIEVES IS A "QUALIFIED
         INSTITUTIONAL BUYER" AS DEFINED IN RULE 144A THAT PURCHASES FOR ITS
         OWN ACCOUNT OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER TO
         WHOM NOTICE IS GIVEN THAT THE TRANSFER IS BEING MADE IN RELIANCE ON
         RULE 144A, (D) PURSUANT TO OFFERS AND SALES THAT OCCUR OUTSIDE THE
         UNITED STATES WITHIN THE MEANING OF REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES
         ACT, (E) TO AN INSTITUTIONAL ACCREDITED INVESTOR WITHIN THE MEANING OF
         SECTION 501(A)(1), (2), (3) OR (7) UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT THAT IS
         ACQUIRING THE SECURITY FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT, OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF SUCH
         AN INSTITUTIONAL ACCREDITED INVESTOR, IN EACH CASE IN A TRANSACTION
         INVOLVING A MINIMUM PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF $250,000 OF SUCH SECURITIES,
         FOR INVESTMENT PURPOSES AND NOT WITH A VIEW TO OR FOR OFFER OR SALE IN
         CONNECTION WITH ANY DISTRIBUTION IN VIOLATION OF THE SECURITIES ACT,
         OR (F) PURSUANT TO ANOTHER AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM THE REGISTRATION
         REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT, SUBJECT TO THE COMPANY'S AND THE
         TRUSTEE'S RIGHT PRIOR TO ANY SUCH OFFER, SALE OR TRANSFER PURSUANT TO
         CLAUSE (D), (E) OR (F) ABOVE TO REQUIRE THE DELIVERY OF AN OPINION OF
         COUNSEL, CERTIFICATION AND/OR OTHER INFORMATION SATISFACTORY TO EACH
         OF THEM, AND IN THE CASE OF THE FOREGOING CLAUSE (E), A CERTIFICATE OF
         TRANSFER IN THE FORM APPEARING ON THE OTHER SIDE OF THIS SECURITY IS
         COMPLETED AND DELIVERED BY THE TRANSFEROR TO THE COMPANY AND THE
         TRUSTEE.  THIS LEGEND WILL BE REMOVED AFTER 40 CONSECUTIVE DAYS
         BEGINNING ON AND INCLUDING THE LATER OF (A) THE DAY ON WHICH THE
         SECURITIES ARE OFFERED TO PERSONS OTHER THAN DISTRIBUTORS (AS DEFINED
         IN REGULATION S) AND (B) THE DATE OF THE CLOSING OF THE ORIGINAL
         OFFERING.  AS USED HEREIN, THE TERMS "OFFSHORE

<PAGE>   24
                                                                              24



         TRANSACTION", "UNITED STATES" AND "U.S. PERSON" HAVE THE MEANINGS
         GIVEN TO THEM BY REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT.

                 The Global Notes, whether or not an Initial Note, shall also
bear the following legend on the face thereof:

         UNLESS THIS CERTIFICATE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE
         OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY ("DTC")  TO THE COMPANY OR ITS AGENT
         FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY CERTIFICATE
         ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR SUCH OTHER
         REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE
         OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT HEREON IS MADE TO CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER
         ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DTC),
         ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR
         TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL SINCE THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE &
         CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.

         TRANSFERS OF THIS GLOBAL SECURITY SHALL BE LIMITED TO TRANSFERS IN
         WHOLE, BUT NOT IN PART, TO NOMINEES OF CEDE & CO. OR TO A SUCCESSOR
         THEREOF OR SUCH SUCCESSOR'S NOMINEE AND TRANSFERS OF PORTIONS OF THIS
         GLOBAL SECURITY SHALL BE LIMITED TO TRANSFERS MADE IN ACCORDANCE WITH
         THE RESTRICTIONS SET FORTH IN SECTIONS 306 AND 307 OF THE INDENTURE.

                 SECTION 203.  Form of Initial Note.

No. [___]                                     Principal Amount $[______________]

                                                          CUSIP NO. ____________

                     11% Senior Subordinated Note due 2008


                 Renters Choice, Inc., a Delaware corporation promises to pay
to Cede & Co., or registered assigns, the principal sum of [__________________]
Dollars on August 15, 2008.

                 Interest Payment Dates:  February 15 and August 15.

                 Record Dates:  February 1 and August 1.

                 Additional provisions of this Note are set forth on the other
side of this Note.


Dated:  August 18, 1998                    RENTERS CHOICE, INC.


                                                   By:                        
                                                      ------------------------
                                                       Title:


                                                   By:                        
                                                      ------------------------
                                                       Title:

<PAGE>   25
                                                                              25


TRUSTEE'S CERTIFICATE OF
  AUTHENTICATION

IBJ SCHRODER BANK & TRUST COMPANY,
as Trustee, certifies
that this is one of the
Notes referred to
in the Indenture.


By                               
   ------------------------------
    Authorized Signatory                                    August 18, 1998

<PAGE>   26
                                                                              26



               [FORM OF REVERSE SIDE OF SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTE]

                     11% Senior Subordinated Note due 2008


1.       Interest

                 Renters Choice, Inc., a Delaware corporation (such
corporation, and its successors and assigns under the Indenture hereinafter
referred to, being herein called the "Company") promises to pay interest on the
principal amount of this Note at the rate per annum shown above.

                 The Company will pay interest semiannually in cash and in
arrears to Holders of record at the close of business on the February 1 and
August 1 immediately preceding the interest payment date on February 15 and
August 15 of each year, commencing February 15, 1999.  Interest on the Notes
will accrue from the most recent date to which interest has been paid on the
Notes or, if no interest has been paid, from August 18, 1998.  The Company
shall pay interest on overdue principal or premium, if any (plus interest on
such interest to the extent lawful), at the rate borne by the Notes to the
extent lawful.  Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year of
twelve 30-day months.

2.       Method of Payment

                 By at least 10:00 a.m. (New York City time) on the date on
which any principal of or interest on the Notes is due and payable, the Company
shall irrevocably deposit with the Trustee or the Paying Agent money sufficient
to pay such principal, premium, if any, and/or interest.  The Company will pay
interest (except defaulted interest) to the Persons who are registered Holders
of Notes at the close of business on the February 1 or August 1 next preceding
the interest payment date even if the Notes are cancelled, repurchased or
redeemed after the record date and on or before the interest payment date.
Holders must surrender Notes to a Paying Agent to collect principal payments.
The Company will pay principal and interest in money of the United States that
at the time of payment is legal tender for payment of public and private debts.
However, the Company may pay interest by check payable in such money.  It may
mail an interest check to a Holder's registered address.

3.       Trustee, Paying Agent and Registrar

                 Initially, IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust Company, a New York
banking corporation (the "Trustee"), will act as Trustee, Paying Agent and
Registrar.  The Company may appoint and change any Paying Agent, Registrar or
co-registrar without notice to any Noteholder.  The Company or any of its
domestically incorporated Wholly Owned Subsidiaries may act as Paying Agent,
Registrar or co-registrar.

4.       Indenture

                 The Company issued the Notes under an Indenture dated as of
August 18, 1998 (as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time in
accordance with the terms thereof, the "Indenture"), among the Company, the
Subsidiary Guarantors and the Trustee.  The terms of the Notes include those
stated in the Indenture and those made part of the Indenture by reference to the
Trust Indenture Act of 1939 (15 U.S.C. Sections 77aaa-77bbbb) as in effect on
the date of the Indenture (the "Act").  Capitalized terms used herein and not
defined herein have the meanings ascribed thereto in the Indenture. The Notes
are subject to all such terms, and Noteholders are referred to the Indenture and
the Act for a statement of those terms.

                 The Notes are general unsecured senior subordinated
obligations of the Company limited to $175 million aggregate principal amount
(subject to Section 310 of the Indenture).  This Note is one of the Initial
Notes referred to in the Indenture.  The Notes include the Initial Notes and
any Exchange Notes issued in exchange for the Initial Notes pursuant to the
Indenture and the Registration Rights Agreement. The Initial Notes and the
Exchange Notes are treated as a single class of securities under
<PAGE>   27
                                                                              27



the Indenture.  The Indenture imposes certain limitations on the Incurrence of
Indebtedness by the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries, the payment of
dividends on, and the purchase or redemption of, Capital Stock of the Company
and its Restricted Subsidiaries, certain purchases or redemptions of
Subordinated Indebtedness, the sale or transfer of assets and Capital Stock of
Restricted Subsidiaries, investments of the Company and its Restricted
Subsidiaries and transactions with Affiliates.  In addition, the Indenture
limits the ability of the Company and its Subsidiaries to restrict
distributions and dividends from Restricted Subsidiaries.

5.       Optional Redemption

                 The Senior Subordinated Notes will be redeemable, at the
Company's option, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time on and
after August 15, 2003 and prior to maturity, upon not less than 30 nor more
than 90 days' prior notice mailed by first-class mail to each Holder's
registered address, at the following redemption prices (expressed as a
percentage of principal amount), plus accrued interest, if any, to the
redemption date (subject to the right of Holders of record on the relevant
record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date), if
redeemed during the 12-month period commencing on August 15 of the years set
forth below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
         Year                              Redemption Price
         ----                              ----------------
         <S>                                  <C>
         2003 . . . . . . . . . . . . .       105.500%
         2004 . . . . . . . . . . . . .       103.667%
         2005 . . . . . . . . . . . . .       101.833%
         2006 and thereafter. . . . . .       100.000%
</TABLE>

                 In addition, at any time and from time to time prior to August
15, 2001, the Company may redeem in the aggregate up to 33.33% of the original
aggregate principal amount of the Notes with the proceeds of one or more Equity
Offerings by the Company at a redemption price (expressed as a percentage of
principal amount thereof) of 111% plus accrued interest, if any, to the
redemption date (subject to the right of Holders of record on the relevant
record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date);
provided, however, that at least 66.67% of the original aggregate principal
amount of the Notes must remain outstanding after each such redemption and that
any such redemption occurs within 90 days following the closing of any such
Equity Offering.

6.       Notice of Redemption

                 Notice of redemption will be mailed at least 30 days but not
more than 90 days before the redemption date to each Holder of Notes to be
redeemed at his registered address.  Notes in denominations of principal amount
larger than $1,000 may be redeemed in part but only in whole multiples of
$1,000.  If money sufficient to pay the redemption price of and accrued and
unpaid interest on all Notes (or portions thereof) to be redeemed on the
redemption date is deposited with the Paying Agent on or before the redemption
date and certain other conditions are satisfied, on and after such date
interest ceases to accrue on such Notes (or such portions thereof) called for
redemption.

7.       Put Provisions

                 Upon a Change of Control, any Holder of Notes will have the
right to cause the Company to repurchase all or any part of the Notes of such
Holder at a repurchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof plus
accrued and unpaid interest to the date of repurchase as provided in, and
subject to the terms of, the Indenture.

8.       Subordination and Ranking

                 The Notes are subordinated to Senior Indebtedness, as defined
in the Indenture.  To the extent provided in the Indenture, Senior Indebtedness
must be paid before the Notes may be paid.  The Company agrees, and each
Noteholder by accepting a Note agrees, to the subordination provisions

<PAGE>   28
                                                                              28


contained in the Indenture and authorizes the Trustee to give them effect and
appoints the Trustee as attorney-in-fact for such purpose.  The Notes will in
all respects rank pari passu with all other Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of
the Company.

9.       Denominations; Transfer; Exchange

                 The Notes are in registered form without coupons in
denominations of principal amount of $1,000 and whole multiples of $1,000.  A
Holder may transfer or exchange Notes in accordance with the Indenture.  The
Registrar may require a Holder, among other things, to furnish appropriate
endorsements or transfer documents and to pay any taxes and fees required by
law or permitted by the Indenture.  The Registrar need not register the
transfer of or exchange of (i) any Note selected for redemption (except, in the
case of a Note to be redeemed in part, the portion of the Note not to be
redeemed) for a period beginning 15 days before a selection of Notes to be
redeemed and ending on the date of such selection or (ii) any Notes for a
period beginning 15 days before an interest payment date and ending on such
interest payment date.

10.      Persons Deemed Owners

                 The registered holder of this Note may be treated as the owner
of it for all purposes.

11.      Unclaimed Money

                 If money for the payment of principal or interest remains
unclaimed for two years, the Trustee or Paying Agent shall pay the money back
to the Company at its request unless an abandoned property law designates
another Person.  After any such payment, Holders entitled to the money must
look only to the Company and not to the Trustee for payment.

12.      Defeasance

                 Subject to certain conditions set forth in the Indenture, the
Company at any time may terminate some or all of its obligations under the
Notes and the Indenture if the Company deposits with the Trustee money or U.S.
Government Obligations for the payment of principal and interest on the Notes
to redemption or maturity, as the case may be.

13.      Amendment, Waiver

                 Subject to certain exceptions set forth in the Indenture, (i)
the Indenture or the Notes may be amended with the written consent of the
Holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes and
(ii) any default or noncompliance with any provision may be waived with the
written consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the
outstanding Notes.  Subject to certain exceptions set forth in the Indenture,
without the consent of any Noteholder, the Company and the Trustee may amend
the Indenture or the Notes to cure any ambiguity, omission, defect or
inconsistency, or to comply with Article 5 of the Indenture, or to provide for
uncertificated Notes in addition to or in place of certificated Notes, or to
add guarantees with respect to the Notes or to secure the Notes, or to add
additional covenants or surrender rights and powers conferred on the Company,
or to comply with any request of the SEC in connection with qualifying the
Indenture under the Act, or to make any change that does not adversely affect
the rights of any Noteholder, or to provide for the issuance of Exchange Notes.
However, no amendment may be made to the subordination provisions of the
Indenture that adversely affects the rights of any holder of Senior
Indebtedness then outstanding unless the holders of such Senior Indebtedness
(or any group or representative thereof authorized to give a consent) consent
to such change.

14.      Defaults and Remedies

                 Under the Indenture, Events of Default include (i) a default
in any payment of interest on any Note when due (whether or not such payment is
prohibited by Article 13 of the Indenture), continued for 30 days, (ii) a
default in the payment of principal of any Note when due at its Stated
Maturity, upon

<PAGE>   29
                                                                              29


optional redemption, upon required repurchase, upon declaration or otherwise,
whether or not such payment is prohibited by Article 13 of the Indenture, (iii)
the failure by the Company to comply with its obligations under Section 801 of
the Indenture, (iv) the failure by the Company to comply for 30 days after
written notice with any of its obligations under Section 1016 of the Indenture
or Sections 1003, 1009, 1010, 1011, 1012, 1013, 1014, 1015, 1017, 1019 or 1020
of the Indenture (in each case, other than a failure to purchase Notes when
required under Sections 1016 or 1017 of the Indenture), (v) the failure by the
Company to comply for 60 days after notice with its other agreements contained
in the Notes or the Indenture, (vi) the failure by the Company or any
Significant Subsidiary to pay any Indebtedness within any applicable grace
period after final maturity or the acceleration of any such Indebtedness by the
holders thereof because of a default if the total amount of such Indebtedness
unpaid or accelerated exceeds $25.0 million, (vii) certain events of
bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of the Company or a Significant
Subsidiary, (viii) the rendering of any judgment or decree for the payment of
money in an amount (net of any insurance or indemnity payments actually
received in respect thereof prior to or within 90 days from the entry thereof,
or to be received in respect thereof in the event any appeal thereof shall be
unsuccessful) in excess of $25.0 million against the Company or a Significant
Subsidiary that is not discharged, bonded or insured by a third Person if (A)
an enforcement proceeding thereon is commenced or (B) such judgment or decree
remains outstanding for a period of 90 days following such judgment or decree
and is not discharged, waived or stayed or (ix) the failure of any Subsidiary
Guarantee of the Notes by a Subsidiary Guarantor made pursuant to Section 1020
of the Indenture to be in full force and effect (except as contemplated by the
terms thereof or of the Indenture) or the denial or disaffirmation in writing
by any such Subsidiary Guarantor of its obligations under the Indenture or its
Subsidiary Guarantee if such Default continues for 10 days.  If an Event of
Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee or the Holders of at least a
majority in principal amount of the outstanding applicable Notes may declare
all such Notes to be due and payable immediately.  Certain events of bankruptcy
or insolvency are Events of Default which will result in the Notes being due
and payable immediately upon the occurrence of such Events of Default.

                 Noteholders may not enforce the Indenture or the Notes except
as provided in the Indenture.  The Trustee may refuse to enforce the Indenture
or the Notes unless it receives indemnity or security reasonably satisfactory
to it.  Subject to certain limitations, Holders of a majority in principal
amount of the Notes may direct the Trustee in its exercise of any trust or
power.  The Trustee may withhold from Noteholders notice of any continuing
Default or Event of Default (except a Default or Event of Default in payment of
principal or interest) if it determines that withholding notice is in their
interest.

15.      Trustee Dealings with the Company

                 Subject to certain limitations set forth in the Indenture, the
Trustee under the Indenture, in its individual or any other capacity, may
become the owner or pledgee of Notes and may otherwise deal with and collect
obligations owed to it by the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors or their
affiliates and may otherwise deal with the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors
or their affiliates with the same rights it would have if it were not Trustee.

16.      No Recourse Against Others

                 A director, officer, employee or stockholder, as such, of the
Company or the Subsidiary Guarantors shall not have any liability for any
obligations of the Company or the Subsidiary Guarantors under the Notes, the
Subsidiary Guarantees or the Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of
or by reason of such obligations or their creation.  By accepting a Note, each
Noteholder waives and releases all such liability.  The waiver and release are
part of the consideration for the issue of the Notes.

17.      Authentication

                 This Note shall not be valid until an authorized signatory of
the Trustee (or an authenticating agent acting on its behalf) manually signs
the certificate of authentication on the other side of this Note.
<PAGE>   30
                                                                              30


18.      Registration Rights

                 The Holder of this Note is entitled to the benefits of the
Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of August 18, 1998 (the "Registration
Rights Agreement"), between the Company and the Initial Purchasers named
therein.  In the event that either (i) an Exchange Offer Registration Statement
is not filed with the Commission on or prior to 60 days after the Issue Date,
(ii) an Exchange Offer Registration Statement is not declared effective within
150 days after the Issue Date, (iii) the Exchange Offer is not consummated on
or prior to 180 days after the Issue Date in respect of tendered Notes and a
Shelf Registration Statement has not been declared effective or (iv) a Shelf
Registration Statement is filed and declared effective within 150 days after
the Issue Date but shall thereafter cease to be effective (at any time that the
Company is obligated to maintain the effectiveness thereof) without being
succeeded within 45 days by an additional Registration Statement filed and
declared effective (each such event referred to in clauses (i), (ii), (iii) and
(iv), a "Registration Default"), the Company will pay liquidated damages to
each holder of Transfer Restricted Securities (as defined in the Registration
Rights Agreement), during the period of one or more such Registration Defaults,
in an amount equal to $0.192 per week per $1,000 principal amount of the Notes
constituting Transfer Restricted Securities held by such holder until the
applicable Registration Statement is filed or declared effective, the Exchange
Offer is consummated or the Shelf Registration Statement again becomes
effective, as the case may be, provided that, except in certain limited
circumstances, the Company's obligation to pay liquidated damages will
terminate upon consummation of the Exchange Offer.  All accrued liquidated
damages shall be paid to holders in the same manner as interest payments on the
Notes on semi-annual payment dates which correspond to interest payment dates
for the Notes.  Following the cure of all Registration Defaults, the accrual of
liquidated damages will cease.

19.      Abbreviations

                 Customary abbreviations may be used in the name of a
Noteholder or an assignee, such as TEN COM (=tenants in common), TEN ENT
(=tenants by the entirety), JT TEN (=joint tenants with rights of survivorship
and not as tenants in common), CUST (=custodian) and U/G/M/A (=Uniform Gift to
Minors Act).

20.      CUSIP Numbers

                 Pursuant to a recommendation promulgated by the Committee on
Uniform Security Identification Procedures, the Company has caused CUSIP
numbers to be printed on the Notes and has directed the Trustee to use CUSIP
numbers in notices of redemption as a convenience to Noteholders.  No
representation is made as to the accuracy of such numbers either as printed on
the Notes or as contained in any notice of redemption and reliance may be
placed only on the other identification numbers placed thereon.

21.      Governing Law

                 THIS NOTE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE
WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK EXCLUDING (TO THE GREATEST EXTENT
PERMISSIBLE BY LAW) ANY RULE OF LAW THAT WOULD CAUSE THE APPLICATION OF THE
LAWS OF ANY JURISDICTION OTHER THAN THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

                 The Company will furnish to any Noteholder upon written
request and without charge to the Noteholder a copy of the Indenture.  Requests
may be made to:

                                  Renters Choice, Inc.
                                  13800 Montfort Drive
                                  Suite 300
                                  Dallas, Texas  75240

                                  Attention of Danny Z. Wilbanks

<PAGE>   31
                                                                              31



                              SUBSIDIARY GUARANTEE

1.       Guarantee

                 The Subsidiary Guarantor, jointly and severally with each
other Subsidiary Guarantor, as a primary obligor and not merely as a surety,
irrevocably and unconditionally Guarantees on an unsecured senior subordinated
basis the performance and punctual payment when due, whether at Stated
Maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, all obligations of the Company under
the Indenture and the Notes, whether for payment of principal of or interest on
the Notes, expenses, indemnification or otherwise all in accordance with the
terms set forth in Article XIV of the Indenture. The Subsidiary Guarantor also
agrees to pay any and all costs and expenses (including reasonably attorney's
fees and expenses) incurred by the Trustee or any Holders in enforcing any
rights under this Subsidiary Guarantee, indemnification or otherwise.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee shall not be valid or obligatory for
any purpose until the certificate of authentication on the Note upon which this
Subsidiary Guarantee is noted shall have been executed by the Trustee under the
Indenture by the manual signature of one of its authorized officers.

                 The obligations of the Subsidiary Guarantor shall be limited
to the extent set forth in Article XIV of the Indenture.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee shall be governed by and construed
in accordance with the laws of the State of New York without regard to the
principles of conflicts of law to the extent that the application of the law of
another jurisdiction would be required thereby.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee is subject to release upon the terms
set forth in the Indenture.


                                  COLORTYME, INC.


                                  By:                                     
                                      ------------------------------------
                                      Name:
                                      Title:

<PAGE>   32
                                                                              32



                              SUBSIDIARY GUARANTEE


1.       Guarantee

                 The Subsidiary Guarantor, jointly and severally with each
other Subsidiary Guarantor, as a primary obligor and not merely as a surety,
irrevocably and unconditionally Guarantees on an unsecured senior subordinated
basis the performance and punctual payment when due, whether at Stated
Maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, all obligations of the Company under
the Indenture and the Notes, whether for payment of principal of or interest on
the Notes, expenses, indemnification or otherwise all in accordance with the
terms set forth in Article XIV of the Indenture. The Subsidiary Guarantor also
agrees to pay any and all costs and expenses (including reasonably attorney's
fees and expenses) incurred by the Trustee or any Holders in enforcing any
rights under this Subsidiary Guarantee, indemnification or otherwise.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee shall not be valid or obligatory for
any purpose until the certificate of authentication on the Note upon which this
Subsidiary Guarantee is noted shall have been executed by the Trustee under the
Indenture by the manual signature of one of its authorized officers.

                 The obligations of the Subsidiary Guarantor shall be limited
to the extent set forth in Article XIV of the Indenture.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee shall be governed by and construed
in accordance with the laws of the State of New York without regard to the
principles of conflicts of law to the extent that the application of the law of
another jurisdiction would be required thereby.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee is subject to release upon the terms
set forth in the Indenture.


                                           RENT-A-CENTER, INC.


                                           By:                                
                                              --------------------------------
                                              Name:
                                              Title:
<PAGE>   33
                                                                              33



                                ASSIGNMENT FORM

                 To assign this Note, fill in the form below:

                 I or we assign and transfer this Note to

             (Print or type assignee's name, address and zip code)

                 (Insert assignee's soc. sec. or tax I.D. No.)

         and irrevocably appoint agent to transfer this Note on the books of
         the Company.  The agent may substitute another to act for him.

________________________________________________________________________________

Date:____________________                  Your Signature:______________________

Signature Guarantee:____________________________________________________________
                                  (Signature must be guaranteed)

________________________________________________________________________________
Sign exactly as your name appears on the other side of this Note.

The signature(s) should be guaranteed by an eligible guarantor institution
(banks, stockbrokers, savings and loan associations and credit unions with
membership in the Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program ("STAMP") or
such other signature guarantee medallion program as may be approved by the Note
Registrar in addition to or substitution for, STAMP), pursuant to S.E.C. Rule
17Ad-15.

In connection with any transfer or exchange of any of the Notes evidenced by
this certificate occurring prior to the date that is two years after the later
of the date of original issuance of such Notes and the last date, if any, on
which such Notes were owned by the Company or any Affiliate of the Company, the
undersigned confirms that such Notes are being:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
CHECK ONE BOX BELOW:
        <S>              <C>
         1 [ ]            acquired for the undersigned's own account, without
                          transfer; or

         2 [ ]            transferred to the Company; or

         3 [ ]            transferred pursuant to and in compliance with Rule
                          144A under the Securities Act of 1933; or

         4 [ ]            transferred pursuant to an effective registration
                          statement under the Securities Act; or

         5 [ ]            transferred pursuant to and in compliance with
                          Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933; or


         6 [ ]            transferred to an institutional "accredited investor"
                          (as defined in Rule 501(a)(1), (2), (3) or (7) under
                          the Securities Act of 1933), that has furnished to the
                          Trustee a signed letter containing certain
                          representations and agreements (the form of which
                          letter appears as Exhibit E to the Indenture); or

         7 [ ]            transferred pursuant to another available exemption
                          from the registration requirements of the Securities
                          Act of 1933.
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   34
                                                                              34



Unless one of the boxes is checked, the Trustee may refuse to register any of
the Notes evidenced by this certificate in the name of any person other than
the registered holder thereof; provided, however, that if box (5), (6) or (7)
is checked, the Trustee or the Company may require, prior to registering any
such transfer of the Notes, in their sole discretion, such legal opinions,
certifications and other information as the Trustee or the Company may
reasonably request to confirm that such transfer is being made pursuant to an
exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the registration
requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, such as the exemption provided by
Rule 144 under such Act.


                                  ______________________________
                                           Signature
Signature Guarantee:

___________________________________    _________________________________
   (Signature must be guaranteed)                  Signature


____________________________________________________________

The signature(s) should be guaranteed by an eligible guarantor institution
(banks, stockbrokers, savings and loan associations and credit unions) with
membership in the Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program ("STAMP") or
such other signature guarantee medallion program as may be approved by the Note
Registrar in addition to or substitution for STAMP, pursuant to S.E.C. Rule
17Ad-15.
<PAGE>   35
                                                                              35



                        (TO BE ATTACHED TO GLOBAL NOTES)

               SCHEDULE OF INCREASES OR DECREASES IN GLOBAL NOTE


                 The following increases or decreases in this Global Note have
been made:


<TABLE>
<S>            <C>                     <C>                     <C>                      <C>
                                                               Principal Amount of      Signature of
               Amount of decrease in   Amount of increase in   this Global Note         authorized signatory
 Date of       Principal Amount of     Principal Amount of     following such           of Trustee or Notes
 Exchange      this Global Note        this Global Note        decrease or increase     Custodian
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   36
                                                                              36



OPTION OF HOLDER TO ELECT PURCHASE

                 If you want to elect to have this Note purchased by the
Company pursuant to Section 1016 or 1017 of the Indenture, check the box:

                                     [ ]

                 If you want to elect to have only part of this Note purchased
by the Company pursuant to Section 1016 or 1017 of the Indenture, state the
amount in principal amount (must be integral multiple of $1,000):  $


Date:                     Your Signature                                       
      ----------                          -------------------------------------
                                           (Sign exactly as your name appears on
                                            the other side of the Note)


Signature Guarantee:                                          
                     -----------------------------------------
                          (Signature must be guaranteed)

The signature(s) should be guaranteed by an eligible guarantor institution
(banks, stockbrokers, savings and loan associations and credit unions) with
membership in the Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program ("STAMP") or
such other signature guarantee medallion program as may be approved by the Note
Registrar in addition to or substitution for STAMP, pursuant to S.E.C. Rule
17Ad-15.

<PAGE>   37
                                                                              37



                    [THE FOLLOWING PROVISION TO BE INCLUDED
                           ON ALL 144A CERTIFICATES]


                 In connection with any transfer of this Note occurring prior
to the date that is the earlier of the date of an effective Registration
Statement (as defined in the Registration Rights Agreement dated as of August
18, 1998) or August 18, 2000, the undersigned confirms that without utilizing
any general solicitation or general advertising that:

                                  [Check One]

[ ] (a)  this Note is being transferred in compliance with the exemption from
         registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, provided by
         Rule 144A thereunder.

                                       or

[ ] (b)  this Note is being transferred other than in accordance with (a) above
         and documents are being furnished that comply with the conditions of
         transfer set forth in this Note and the Indenture.

If neither of the foregoing boxes is checked, the Trustee or other Registrar
shall not be obligated to register this Note in the name of any Person other
than the Holder hereof unless and until the conditions to any such transfer of
registration set forth herein and in Section 307 of the Indenture shall have
been satisfied.

Date:                       
       -----------------------

- --------------------------------------------------
                                  NOTICE:  The signature  must correspond with
                                           the name as written upon the face of
                                           the within-mentioned instrument in
                                           every particular, without alteration
                                           or any change whatsoever.

Signature Guarantee:  
                    -------------------------------------------

TO BE COMPLETED BY PURCHASER IF (a) ABOVE IS CHECKED.

                 The undersigned represents and warrants that it is purchasing
this Note for its own account or an account with respect to which it exercises
sole investment discretion and that it and any such account is a "qualified
institutional buyer" within the meaning of Rule 144A under the Securities Act
of 1933, as amended, and is aware that the sale to it is being made in reliance
on Rule 144A and acknowledges that it has received such information regarding
the Company as the undersigned has requested pursuant to Rule 144A or has
determined not to request such information and that it is aware that the
transferor is relying upon the undersigned's foregoing representations in order
to claim the exemption from registration provided by Rule 144A.




Date:                                                                      
      -----------------   -------------------------------------------------
                          NOTICE:  To be executed by an executive officer.

<PAGE>   38
                                                                              38



                      SECTION 204.  Form of Exchange Note.



No. [   ]                                     Principal Amount $[             ]
     ---                                                         -------------
    
                                                          CUSIP NO.
                                                                   -----------

                     11% Senior Subordinated Note due 2008


                 Renters Choice, Inc., a Delaware corporation promises to pay
to Cede & Co., or registered assigns, the principal sum of [                ]
Dollars on August 15, 2008.                                 ----------------

                 Interest Payment Dates:  February 15 and August 15.

                    Record Dates:  February 1 and August 1.

                 Additional provisions of this Note are set forth on the other
side of this Note.


Dated:  August 18, 1998                    RENTERS CHOICE, INC.


                                                   By:                          
                                                      --------------------------
                                                       (Title)


                                                   By:                          
                                                      --------------------------
                                                       (Title)


TRUSTEE'S CERTIFICATE OF
  AUTHENTICATION

IBJ SCHRODER BANK & TRUST COMPANY,
as Trustee, certifies
that this is one of the
Notes referred to
in the Indenture.


By                             
    ---------------------------
    Authorized Signatory
         August 18, 1998

<PAGE>   39
                                                                              39



               [FORM OF REVERSE SIDE OF SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTE]

                     11% Senior Subordinated Note due 2008


1.       Interest

                 Renters Choice, Inc., a Delaware corporation (such
corporation, and its successors and assigns under the Indenture hereinafter
referred to, being herein called the "Company") promises to pay interest on the
principal amount of this Note at the rate per annum shown above.

                 The Company will pay interest semiannually in cash and in
arrears to Holders of record at the close of business on the February 1 and
August 1 immediately preceding the interest payment date on February 15 and
August 15 of each year, commencing February 15, 1999.  Interest on the Notes
will accrue from the most recent date to which interest has been paid on the
Notes or, if no interest has been paid, from August 18, 1998.  The Company
shall pay interest on overdue principal or premium, if any (plus interest on
such interest to the extent lawful), at the rate borne by the Notes to the
extent lawful.  Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year of
twelve 30-day months.

2.       Method of Payment

                 By at least 10:00 a.m. (New York City time) on the date on
which any principal of or interest on the Notes is due and payable, the Company
shall irrevocably deposit with the Trustee or the Paying Agent money sufficient
to pay such principal, premium, if any, and/or interest.  The Company will pay
interest (except defaulted interest) to the Persons who are registered Holders
of Notes at the close of business on the February 1 or August 1 next preceding
the interest payment date even if the Notes are cancelled, repurchased or
redeemed after the record date and on or before the interest payment date.
Holders must surrender Notes to a Paying Agent to collect principal payments.
The Company will pay principal and interest in money of the United States that
at the time of payment is legal tender for payment of public and private debts.
However, the Company may pay interest by check payable in such money.  It may
mail an interest check to a Holder's registered address.

3.       Trustee, Paying Agent and Registrar

                 Initially, IBJ Schroder Bank & Trust Company, a New York
banking corporation (the "Trustee"), will act as Trustee, Paying Agent and
Registrar.  The Company may appoint and change any Paying Agent, Registrar or
co-registrar without notice to any Noteholder.  The Company or any of its
domestically incorporated Wholly Owned Subsidiaries may act as Paying Agent,
Registrar or co-registrar.

4.       Indenture

                 The Company issued the Notes under an Indenture dated as of
August 18, 1998 (as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time in
accordance with the terms thereof, the "Indenture"), among the Company, the
Subsidiary Guarantors and the Trustee.  The terms of the Notes include those
stated in the Indenture and those made part of the Indenture by reference to
the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 (15 U.S.C. Sections 77aaa-77bbbb) as in
effect on the date of the Indenture (the "Act").  Capitalized terms used herein
and not defined herein have the meanings ascribed thereto in the Indenture.
The Notes are subject to all such terms, and Noteholders are referred to the
Indenture and the Act for a statement of those terms.

                 The Notes are general unsecured senior subordinated
obligations of the Company limited to $175 million aggregate principal amount
(subject to Section 310 of the Indenture).  This Note is one of the Exchange
Notes referred to in the Indenture.  The Notes include the Initial Notes and
any Exchange Notes issued in exchange for the Initial Notes pursuant to the
Indenture and the Registration Rights Agreement.  The Initial Notes and the
Exchange Notes are treated as a single class of securities

<PAGE>   40
                                                                              40


under the Indenture.  The Indenture imposes certain limitations on the
Incurrence of Indebtedness by the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries, the
payment of dividends on, and the purchase or redemption of, Capital Stock of
the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries, certain purchases or redemptions
of Subordinated Indebtedness, the sale or transfer of assets and Capital Stock
of Restricted Subsidiaries, investments of the Company and its Restricted
Subsidiaries and transactions with Affiliates.  In addition, the Indenture
limits the ability of the Company and its Subsidiaries to restrict
distributions and dividends from Restricted Subsidiaries.

5.       Optional Redemption

                 The Senior Subordinated Notes will be redeemable, at the
Company's option, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time on and
after August 15, 2003 and prior to maturity, upon not less than 30 nor more
than 90 days' prior notice mailed by first-class mail to each Holder's
registered address, at the following redemption prices (expressed as a
percentage of principal amount), plus accrued interest, if any, to the
redemption date (subject to the right of Holders of record on the relevant
record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date), if
redeemed during the 12-month period commencing on August 15 of the years set
forth below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
         Year                              Redemption Price
         ----                              ----------------
         <S>                                       <C>
         2003 . . . . . . . . . . . .              105.500%
         2004 . . . . . . . . . . . .              103.667%
         2005 . . . . . . . . . . . .              101.833%
         2006 and thereafter. . . . .              100.000%
</TABLE>

                 In addition, at any time and from time to time prior to August
15, 2001, the Company may redeem in the aggregate up to 33.33% of the original
aggregate principal amount of the Notes with the proceeds of one or more Equity
Offerings by the Company at a redemption price (expressed as a percentage of
principal amount thereof) of 111% plus accrued interest, if any, to the
redemption date (subject to the right of Holders of record on the relevant
record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date);
provided, however, that at least 66.67% of the original aggregate principal
amount of the Notes must remain outstanding after each such redemption and that
any such redemption occurs within 90 days following the closing of any such
Equity Offering.

6.       Notice of Redemption

                 Notice of redemption will be mailed at least 30 days but not
more than 90 days before the redemption date to each Holder of Notes to be
redeemed at his registered address.  Notes in denominations of principal amount
larger than $1,000 may be redeemed in part but only in whole multiples of
$1,000.  If money sufficient to pay the redemption price of and accrued and
unpaid interest on all Notes (or portions thereof) to be redeemed on the
redemption date is deposited with the Paying Agent on or before the redemption
date and certain other conditions are satisfied, on and after such date
interest ceases to accrue on such Notes (or such portions thereof) called for
redemption.

7.       Put Provisions

                 Upon a Change of Control, any Holder of Notes will have the
right to cause the Company to repurchase all or any part of the Notes of such
Holder at a repurchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof plus
accrued and unpaid interest to the date of repurchase as provided in, and
subject to the terms of, the Indenture.

8.       Subordination and Ranking

                 The Notes are subordinated to Senior Indebtedness, as defined
in the Indenture.  To the extent provided in the Indenture, Senior Indebtedness
must be paid before the Notes may be paid.  The Company agrees, and each
Noteholder by accepting a Note agrees, to the subordination provisions

<PAGE>   41
                                                                              41


contained in the Indenture and authorizes the Trustee to give them effect and
appoints the Trustee as attorney-in-fact for such purpose.  The Notes will in
all respects rank pari passu with all other Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of
the Company.

9.       Denominations; Transfer; Exchange

                 The Notes are in registered form without coupons in
denominations of principal amount of $1,000 and whole multiples of $1,000.  A
Holder may transfer or exchange Notes in accordance with the Indenture.  The
Registrar may require a Holder, among other things, to furnish appropriate
endorsements or transfer documents and to pay any taxes and fees required by
law or permitted by the Indenture.  The Registrar need not register the
transfer of or exchange of (i) any Note selected for redemption (except, in the
case of a Note to be redeemed in part, the portion of the Note not to be
redeemed) for a period beginning 15 days before a selection of Notes to be
redeemed and ending on the date of such selection or (ii) any Notes for a
period beginning 15 days before an interest payment date and ending on such
interest payment date.

10.      Persons Deemed Owners

                 The registered holder of this Note may be treated as the owner
of it for all purposes.

11.      Unclaimed Money

                 If money for the payment of principal or interest remains
unclaimed for two years, the Trustee or Paying Agent shall pay the money back
to the Company at its request unless an abandoned property law designates
another Person.  After any such payment, Holders entitled to the money must
look only to the Company and not to the Trustee for payment.

12.      Defeasance

                 Subject to certain conditions set forth in the Indenture, the
Company at any time may terminate some or all of its obligations under the
Notes and the Indenture if the Company deposits with the Trustee money or U.S.
Government Obligations for the payment of principal and interest on the Notes
to redemption or maturity, as the case may be.

13.      Amendment, Waiver

                 Subject to certain exceptions set forth in the Indenture, (i)
the Indenture or the Notes may be amended with the written consent of the
Holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes and
(ii) any default or noncompliance with any provision may be waived with the
written consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the
outstanding Notes.  Subject to certain exceptions set forth in the Indenture,
without the consent of any Noteholder, the Company and the Trustee may amend
the Indenture or the Notes to cure any ambiguity, omission, defect or
inconsistency, or to comply with Article 5 of the Indenture, or to provide for
uncertificated Notes in addition to or in place of certificated Notes, or to
add guarantees with respect to the Notes or to secure the Notes, or to add
additional covenants or surrender rights and powers conferred on the Company,
or to comply with any request of the SEC in connection with qualifying the
Indenture under the Act, or to make any change that does not adversely affect
the rights of any Noteholder, or to provide for the issuance of Exchange Notes.
However, no amendment may be made to the subordination provisions of the
Indenture that adversely affects the rights of any holder of Senior
Indebtedness then outstanding unless the holders of such Senior Indebtedness
(or any group or representative thereof authorized to give a consent) consent
to such change.

14.      Defaults and Remedies

                 Under the Indenture, Events of Default include (i) a default
in any payment of interest on any Note when due (whether or not such payment is
prohibited by Article 13 of the Indenture), continued for 30 days, (ii) a
default in the payment of principal of any Note when due at its Stated
Maturity, upon
<PAGE>   42
                                                                              42


optional redemption, upon required repurchase, upon declaration or otherwise,
whether or not such payment is prohibited by Article 13 of the Indenture, (iii)
the failure by the Company to comply with its obligations under Section 801 of
the Indenture, (iv) the failure by the Company to comply for 30 days after
written notice with any of its obligations under Section 1016 of the Indenture
or Sections 1003, 1009, 1010, 1011, 1012, 1013, 1014, 1015, 1017, 1019 or 1020
of the Indenture (in each case, other than a failure to purchase Notes when
required under Sections 1016 or 1017 of the Indenture), (v) the failure by the
Company to comply for 60 days after notice with its other agreements contained
in the Notes or the Indenture, (vi) the failure by the Company or any
Significant Subsidiary to pay any Indebtedness within any applicable grace
period after final maturity or the acceleration of any such Indebtedness by the
holders thereof because of a default if the total amount of such Indebtedness
unpaid or accelerated exceeds $25.0 million, (vii) certain events of
bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of the Company or a Significant
Subsidiary, (viii) the rendering of any judgment or decree for the payment of
money in an amount (net of any insurance or indemnity payments actually
received in respect thereof prior to or within 90 days from the entry thereof,
or to be received in respect thereof in the event any appeal thereof shall be
unsuccessful) in excess of $25.0 million against the Company or a Significant
Subsidiary that is not discharged, bonded or insured by a third Person if (A)
an enforcement proceeding thereon is commenced or (B) such judgment or decree
remains outstanding for a period of 90 days following such judgment or decree
and is not discharged, waived or stayed or (ix) the failure of any Subsidiary
Guarantee of the Notes by a Subsidiary Guarantor made pursuant to Section 1020
of the Indenture to be in full force and effect (except as contemplated by the
terms thereof or of the Indenture) or the denial or disaffirmation in writing
by any such Subsidiary Guarantor of its obligations under the Indenture or its
Subsidiary Guarantee if such Default continues for 10 days.  If an Event of
Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee or the Holders of at least a
majority in principal amount of the outstanding applicable Notes may declare
all such Notes to be due and payable immediately.  Certain events of bankruptcy
or insolvency are Events of Default which will result in the Notes being due
and payable immediately upon the occurrence of such Events of Default.

                 Noteholders may not enforce the Indenture or the Notes except
as provided in the Indenture.  The Trustee may refuse to enforce the Indenture
or the Notes unless it receives indemnity or security reasonably satisfactory
to it.  Subject to certain limitations, Holders of a majority in principal
amount of the Notes may direct the Trustee in its exercise of any trust or
power.  The Trustee may withhold from Noteholders notice of any continuing
Default or Event of Default (except a Default or Event of Default in payment of
principal or interest) if it determines that withholding notice is in their
interest.

15.      Trustee Dealings with the Company

                 Subject to certain limitations set forth in the Indenture, the
Trustee under the Indenture, in its individual or any other capacity, may
become the owner or pledgee of Notes and may otherwise deal with and collect
obligations owed to it by the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors or their
affiliates and may otherwise deal with the Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors
or their affiliates with the same rights it would have if it were not Trustee.

16.      No Recourse Against Others

                 A director, officer, employee or stockholder, as such, of the
Company or the Subsidiary Guarantors shall not have any liability for any
obligations of the Company or the Subsidiary Guarantors under the Notes, the
Subsidiary Guarantees or the Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of
or by reason of such obligations or their creation.  By accepting a Note, each
Noteholder waives and releases all such liability.  The waiver and release are
part of the consideration for the issue of the Notes.

17.      Authentication

                 This Note shall not be valid until an authorized signatory of
the Trustee (or an authenticating agent acting on its behalf) manually signs
the certificate of authentication on the other side of this Note.

<PAGE>   43
                                                                              43
 

18.      Abbreviations

                 Customary abbreviations may be used in the name of a
Noteholder or an assignee, such as TEN COM (=tenants in common), TEN ENT
(=tenants by the entirety), JT TEN (=joint tenants with rights of survivorship
and not as tenants in common), CUST (=custodian) and U/G/M/A (=Uniform Gift to
Minors Act).

19.      CUSIP Numbers

                 Pursuant to a recommendation promulgated by the Committee on
Uniform Security Identification Procedures, the Company has caused CUSIP
numbers to be printed on the Notes and has directed the Trustee to use CUSIP
numbers in notices of redemption as a convenience to Noteholders.  No
representation is made as to the accuracy of such numbers either as printed on
the Notes or as contained in any notice of redemption and reliance may be
placed only on the other identification numbers placed thereon.

20.      Governing Law

                 THIS NOTE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE
WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK EXCLUDING (TO THE GREATEST EXTENT
PERMISSIBLE BY LAW) ANY RULE OF LAW THAT WOULD CAUSE THE APPLICATION OF THE
LAWS OF ANY JURISDICTION OTHER THAN THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

                 The Company will furnish to any Noteholder upon written
request and without charge to the Noteholder a copy of the Indenture.  Requests
may be made to:

                                  Renters Choice, Inc.
                                  13800 Montfort Drive
                                  Suite 300
                                  Dallas, Texas  75240

                                  Attention of Danny Z. Wilbanks

<PAGE>   44
                                                                              44


                              SUBSIDIARY GUARANTEE

1.       Guarantee

                 The Subsidiary Guarantor, jointly and severally with each
other Subsidiary Guarantor, as a primary obligor and not merely as a surety,
irrevocably and unconditionally Guarantees on an unsecured senior subordinated
basis the performance and punctual payment when due, whether at Stated
Maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, all obligations of the Company under
the Indenture and the Notes, whether for payment of principal of or interest on
the Notes, expenses, indemnification or otherwise all in accordance with the
terms set forth in Article XIV of the Indenture. The Subsidiary Guarantor also
agrees to pay any and all costs and expenses (including reasonably attorney's
fees and expenses) incurred by the Trustee or any Holders in enforcing any
rights under this Subsidiary Guarantee, indemnification or otherwise.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee shall not be valid or obligatory for
any purpose until the certificate of authentication on the Note upon which this
Subsidiary Guarantee is noted shall have been executed by the Trustee under the
Indenture by the manual signature of one of its authorized officers.

                 The obligations of the Subsidiary Guarantor shall be limited
to the extent set forth in Article XIV of the Indenture.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee shall be governed by and construed
in accordance with the laws of the State of New York without regard to the
principles of conflicts of law to the extent that the application of the law of
another jurisdiction would be required thereby.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee is subject to release upon the terms
set forth in the Indenture.


                                  COLORTYME, INC.


                                  By:                                  
                                      ---------------------------------
                                      Name:
                                      Title:
<PAGE>   45
                                                                              45


                              SUBSIDIARY GUARANTEE


1.       Guarantee

                 The Subsidiary Guarantor, jointly and severally with each
other Subsidiary Guarantor, as a primary obligor and not merely as a surety,
irrevocably and unconditionally Guarantees on an unsecured senior subordinated
basis the performance and punctual payment when due, whether at Stated
Maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, all obligations of the Company under
the Indenture and the Notes, whether for payment of principal of or interest on
the Notes, expenses, indemnification or otherwise all in accordance with the
terms set forth in Article XIV of the Indenture. The Subsidiary Guarantor also
agrees to pay any and all costs and expenses (including reasonably attorney's
fees and expenses) incurred by the Trustee or any Holders in enforcing any
rights under this Subsidiary Guarantee, indemnification or otherwise.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee shall not be valid or obligatory for
any purpose until the certificate of authentication on the Note upon which this
Subsidiary Guarantee is noted shall have been executed by the Trustee under the
Indenture by the manual signature of one of its authorized officers.

                 The obligations of the Subsidiary Guarantor shall be limited
to the extent set forth in Article XIV of the Indenture.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee shall be governed by and construed
in accordance with the laws of the State of New York without regard to the
principles of conflicts of law to the extent that the application of the law of
another jurisdiction would be required thereby.

                 This Subsidiary Guarantee is subject to release upon the terms
set forth in the Indenture.


                                  RENT-A-CENTER, INC.


                                  By:                                  
                                      ---------------------------------
                                      Name:
                                      Title:

<PAGE>   46
                                                                              46


                                ASSIGNMENT FORM

                 To assign this Note, fill in the form below:

                 I or we assign and transfer this Note to

             (Print or type assignee's name, address and zip code)

                 (Insert assignee's soc. sec. or tax I.D. No.)

         and irrevocably appoint agent to transfer this Note on the books of
         the Company.  The agent may substitute another to act for him.

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Date:                                Your Signature:
     -------------------                            ---------------------------

Signature Guarantee:
                    ---------------------------------------
                          (Signature must be guaranteed)

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sign exactly as your name appears on the other side of this Note.

The signature(s) should be guaranteed by an eligible guarantor institution
(banks, stockbrokers, savings and loan associations and credit unions with
membership in the Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program ("STAMP") or
such other signature guarantee medallion program as may be approved by the Note
Registrar in addition to or substitution for, STAMP), pursuant to S.E.C. Rule
17Ad-15.

In connection with any transfer or exchange of any of the Notes evidenced by
this certificate occurring prior to the date that is two years after the later
of the date of original issuance of such Notes and the last date, if any, on
which such Notes were owned by the Company or any Affiliate of the Company, the
undersigned confirms that such Notes are being:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
CHECK ONE BOX BELOW:
        <S>              <C>
         1 [ ]            acquired for the undersigned's own account, without
                          transfer; or

         2 [ ]            transferred to the Company; or

         3 [ ]            transferred pursuant to and in compliance with Rule
                          144A under the Securities Act of 1933; or

         4 [ ]            transferred pursuant to an effective registration
                          statement under the Securities Act; or

         5 [ ]            transferred pursuant to and in compliance with
                          Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933; or


         6 [ ]            transferred to an institutional "accredited investor"
                          (as defined in Rule 501(a)(1), (2), (3) or (7) under
                          the Securities Act of 1933), that has furnished to the
                          Trustee a signed letter containing certain
                          representations and agreements (the form of which
                          letter appears as Exhibit E to the Indenture); or

         7 [ ]            transferred pursuant to another available exemption
                          from the registration requirements of the Securities
                          Act of 1933.
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   47
                                                                              47



Unless one of the boxes is checked, the Trustee may refuse to register any of
the Notes evidenced by this certificate in the name of any person other than
the registered holder thereof; provided, however, that if box (5), (6) or (7)
is checked, the Trustee or the Company may require, prior to registering any
such transfer of the Notes, in their sole discretion, such legal opinions,
certifications and other information as the Trustee or the Company may
reasonably request to confirm that such transfer is being made pursuant to an
exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the registration
requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, such as the exemption provided by
Rule 144 under such Act.


                                  ----------------------------
                                           Signature
Signature Guarantee:

- --------------------------------------   -------------------------------
(Signature must be guaranteed)                     Signature


- -------------------------------------------------------------
The signature(s) should be guaranteed by an eligible guarantor institution
(banks, stockbrokers, savings and loan associations and credit unions) with
membership in the Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program ("STAMP") or
such other signature guarantee medallion program as may be approved by the Note
Registrar in addition to or substitution for STAMP, pursuant to S.E.C. Rule
17Ad-15.
<PAGE>   48
                                                                              48


                        [TO BE ATTACHED TO GLOBAL NOTES]

               SCHEDULE OF INCREASES OR DECREASES IN GLOBAL NOTE


                 The following increases or decreases in this Global Note have
been made:


<TABLE>
<S>            <C>                     <C>                     <C>                      <C>
                                                               Principal Amount of      Signature of
               Amount of decrease in   Amount of increase in   this Global Note         authorized signatory
 Date of       Principal Amount of     Principal Amount of     following such           of Trustee or Notes
 Exchange      this Global Note        this Global Note        decrease or increase     Custodian
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   49
                                                                              49



OPTION OF HOLDER TO ELECT PURCHASE

                 If you want to elect to have this Note purchased by the
Company pursuant to Section 1016 or 1017 of the Indenture, check the box: [ ]



                 If you want to elect to have only part of this Note purchased
by the Company pursuant to Section 1016 or 1017 of the Indenture, state the
amount in principal amount (must be integral multiple of $1,000):  $


Date:                     Your Signature                                       
     ----------                           --------------------------------------
                                           (Sign exactly as your name appears on
                                            the other side of the Note)


Signature Guarantee:                                       
                     --------------------------------------   
                         (Signature must be guaranteed)

The signature(s) should be guaranteed by an eligible guarantor institution
(banks, stockbrokers, savings and loan associations and credit unions) with
membership in the Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program ("STAMP") or
such other signature guarantee medallion program as may be approved by the Note
Registrar in addition to or substitution for STAMP, pursuant to S.E.C. Rule
17Ad-15.
<PAGE>   50
                                                                              50



                 SECTION 205.  Form of Trustee's Certificate of Authentication.

                 The Trustee's certificate of authentication shall be in
substantially the following form:

                    TRUSTEE'S CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION.


                 This is one of the Notes referred to in the within-mentioned
Indenture.


                                  IBJ SCHRODER BANK & TRUST
                                    COMPANY, as Trustee


                                  By                             
                                     ----------------------------
                                     Authorized Signatory

Dated:  August 18, 1998



                           ARTICLE THREE.  THE NOTES
300.

                 SECTION 301.  Title and Terms.

                 The aggregate principal amount of Notes which may be
authenticated and delivered under this Indenture is limited to $175 million,
except for Notes authenticated and delivered upon registration of transfer of,
or in exchange for, or in lieu of, other Notes pursuant to Section 304, 305,
306, 307, 310, 906, 1016, 1017 or 1108 or pursuant to an Exchange Offer.

                 The Notes shall be known and designated as the "11% Senior
Subordinated Notes due 2008" of the Company.  The Stated Maturity of the Notes
shall be August 15, 2008, and they shall bear interest at the rate of 11% per
annum from August 18, 1998, or from the most recent interest payment date to
which interest has been paid or duly provided for, payable semiannually in cash
and in arrears to the Person in whose name the Note (or any predecessor Note)
is registered at the close of business on the February 1 and August 1
immediately preceding the interest payment date on February 15 and August 15 of
each year, commencing February 15, 1999.  Interest will be computed on the
basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve 30-day months, until the principal
thereof is paid or duly provided for.  Interest on any overdue principal,
interest (to the extent lawful) or premium, if any, shall be payable on demand.

                 The principal of (and premium, if any) and interest on the
Notes shall be payable at the office or agency of the Company maintained for
such purpose in The City of New York, or at such other office or agency of the
Company as may be maintained for such purpose; provided, however, that, at the
option of the Company, interest may be paid by check mailed to addresses of the
Persons entitled thereto as such addresses shall appear on the Note Register.

                 Holders shall have the right to require the Company to
purchase their Notes, in whole or in part, in the event of a Change of Control
pursuant to Section 1016.

                 The Notes shall be subject to repurchase by the Company
pursuant to an Asset Disposition as provided in Section 1017.

                 The Notes shall be redeemable as provided in Article Eleven
and in the Notes.

<PAGE>   51
                                                                              51



                 The Indebtedness evidenced by the Notes shall be subordinated
in right of payment to Senior Indebtedness as provided in Article Thirteen.

                 SECTION 302.  Denominations.

                 The Notes shall be issuable only in fully registered form,
without coupons, and only in denominations of $1,000 and any integral multiple
thereof.

                 SECTION 303.  Execution, Authentication, Delivery and Dating.

                 The Notes shall be executed on behalf of the Company by two
Officers, of which at least one Officer shall be the President or the Chief
Financial Officer of the Company.  The signature of any Officer on the Notes
may be manual or facsimile signatures of the present or any future such
authorized officer and may be imprinted or otherwise reproduced on the Notes.

                 Notes bearing the manual or facsimile signatures of
individuals who were at any time the proper officers of the Company shall bind
the Company, notwithstanding that such individuals or any of them have ceased
to hold such offices prior to the authentication and delivery of such Notes or
did not hold such offices at the date of such Notes.

                 At any time and from time to time after the execution and
delivery of this Indenture, the Company may deliver Initial Notes executed by
the Company to the Trustee for authentication, together with a Company Order
for the authentication and delivery of such Notes, and the Trustee in
accordance with such Company Order shall authenticate and deliver such Initial
Notes directing the Trustee to authenticate the Notes and certifying that all
conditions precedent to the issuance of Notes contained herein have been fully
complied with, and the Trustee in accordance with such Company Order shall
authenticate and deliver such Initial Notes.  On Company Order, the Trustee
shall authenticate for original issue Exchange Notes in an aggregate principal
amount not to exceed $175,000,000; provided that such Exchange Notes shall be
issuable only upon the valid surrender for cancellation of Initial Notes of a
like aggregate principal amount in accordance with an Exchange Offer pursuant
to the Registration Rights Agreement.  In each case, the Trustee shall be
entitled to receive an Officers' Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel of the
Company that it may reasonably request in connection with such authentication
of Notes.  Such order shall specify the amount of Notes to be authenticated and
the date on which the original issue of Initial Notes or Exchange Notes is to
be authenticated.

                 Each Note shall be dated the date of its authentication.

                 No Note shall be entitled to any benefit under this Indenture
or be valid or obligatory for any purpose unless there appears on such Note a
certificate of authentication substantially in the form provided for herein
duly executed by the Trustee by manual signature of an authorized signatory,
and such certificate upon any Note shall be conclusive evidence, and the only
evidence, that such Note has been duly authenticated and delivered hereunder
and is entitled to the benefits of this Indenture.

                 In case the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor, pursuant to
Article Eight, shall be consolidated or merged with or into any other Person or
shall convey, transfer, lease or otherwise dispose of its properties and assets
substantially as an entirety to any Person, and the successor Person resulting
from such consolidation, or surviving such merger, or into which the Company or
such Subsidiary Guarantor shall have been merged, or the Person which shall
have received a conveyance, transfer, lease or other disposition as aforesaid,
shall have executed an indenture supplemental hereto with the Trustee pursuant
to Article Eight, any of the Notes authenticated or delivered prior to such
consolidation, merger, conveyance, transfer, lease or other disposition may,
from time to time, at the request of the successor Person, be exchanged for
other Notes executed in the name of the successor Person with such changes in
phraseology and form as may be appropriate, but otherwise in substance of like
tenor as the Notes surrendered for such exchange and of like principal amount;
and the Trustee, upon Company Request of the successor Person, shall
authenticate and deliver Notes as specified in such request for the purpose of
such exchange.  If Notes shall at any time be authenticated and

<PAGE>   52
                                                                              52


delivered in any new name of a successor Person pursuant to this Section 303 in
exchange or substitution for or upon registration of transfer of any Notes,
such successor Person, at the option of the Holders but without expense to
them, shall provide for the exchange of all Notes at the time Outstanding for
Notes authenticated and delivered in such new name.

                 The Trustee may appoint an authenticating agent acceptable to
the Company to authenticate Notes on behalf of the Trustee.  Unless limited by
the terms of such appointment, an authenticating agent may authenticate Notes
whenever the Trustee may do so.  Each reference in this Indenture to
authentication by the Trustee includes authentication by such agent.  An
authenticating agent has the same rights as any Note Registrar or Paying Agent
to deal with the Company and its Affiliates.

                 SECTION 304.  Temporary Notes.

                 Pending the preparation of definitive Notes, the Company may
execute, and upon Company Order the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver,
temporary Notes which are printed, lithographed, typewritten, mimeographed or
otherwise produced, in any authorized denomination.  Temporary Notes shall be
substantially of the tenor of the definitive Notes in lieu of which they are
issued and with such appropriate insertions, omissions, substitutions and other
variations as the officers executing such Notes may determine, as conclusively
evidenced by their execution of such Notes.

                 If temporary Notes are issued, the Company will cause
definitive Notes to be prepared without unreasonable delay.  After the
preparation of definitive Notes, the temporary Notes shall be exchangeable for
definitive Notes upon surrender of the temporary Notes at the office or agency
of the Company designated for such purpose pursuant to Section 1002, without
charge to the Holder.  Upon surrender for cancellation of any one or more
temporary Notes, the Company shall execute and the Trustee shall authenticate
and deliver in exchange therefor a like principal amount of definitive Notes of
authorized denominations.  Until so exchanged, the temporary Notes shall in all
respects be entitled to the same benefits under this Indenture as definitive
Notes.

                 SECTION 305.  Registration, Registration of Transfer and
Exchange.

                 The Company shall cause to be kept at the Corporate Trust
Office of the Trustee a register (the register maintained in such office and in
any other office or agency designated pursuant to Section 1002 being herein
sometimes referred to as the "Note Register") in which, subject to such
reasonable regulations as it may prescribe, the Company shall provide for the
registration of Notes and of transfers of Notes.  The Note Register shall be in
written form or any other form capable of being converted into written form
within a reasonable time.  At all reasonable times, the Note Register shall be
open to inspection by the Trustee.  The Trustee is hereby initially appointed
as security registrar (the Trustee in such capacity, together with any
successor of the Trustee in such capacity, the "Note Registrar") for the
purpose of registering Notes and transfers of Notes as herein provided.

                 Upon surrender for registration of transfer of any Note at the
office or agency of the Company designated pursuant to Section 1002, the
Company shall execute, and the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver, in the
name of the designated transferee or transferees, one or more new Notes of any
authorized denomination or denominations of a like aggregate principal amount.

                 Furthermore, any Holder of a Global Note shall, by acceptance
of such Global Note, agree that transfers of beneficial interest in such Global
Note may be effected only through a book-entry system maintained by the Holder
of such Global Note (or its agent), and that ownership of a beneficial interest
in the Note shall be required to be reflected in a book entry.

                 At the option of the Holder, Notes may be exchanged for other
Notes of any authorized denomination and of a like aggregate principal amount,
upon surrender of the Notes to be exchanged at such office or agency.  Whenever
any Notes are so surrendered for exchange (including an exchange of Initial
Notes for Exchange Notes), the Company shall execute, and the Trustee shall
authenticate and


<PAGE>   53
                                                                             53


deliver, the Notes which the Holder making the exchange is entitled to receive;
provided that no exchange of Initial Notes for Exchange Notes shall occur until
an Exchange Offer Registration Statement shall have been declared effective by
the Commission, the Trustee shall have received an Officers' Certificate
confirming that the Exchange Offer Registration Statement has been declared
effective by the Commission and the Initial Notes to be exchanged for the
Exchange Notes shall be cancelled by the Trustee.

                 All Notes issued upon any registration of transfer or exchange
of Notes shall be the valid obligations of the Company, evidencing the same
debt, and entitled to the same benefits under this Indenture, as the Notes
surrendered upon such registration of transfer or exchange.

                 Every Note presented or surrendered for registration of
transfer or for exchange shall (if so required by the Company or the Note
Registrar) be duly endorsed, or be accompanied by a written instrument of
transfer, in form satisfactory to the Company and the Note Registrar, duly
executed by the Holder thereof or his attorney duly authorized in writing.

                 No service charge shall be made for any registration of
transfer or exchange or redemption of Notes, but the Company may require
payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that
may be imposed in connection with any registration of transfer or exchange of
Notes, other than exchanges pursuant to Section 304, 906, 1016, 1017 or 1108,
not involving any transfer.

                 The Register shall be in written form in the English language
or in any other form including computerized records, capable of being converted
into such form within a reasonable time.

                 SECTION 306.  Book-Entry Provisions for Global Notes.

                 (a)      Each Global Note initially shall (i) be registered in
the name of the Depositary for such global Note or the nominee of such
Depositary, (ii) be delivered to the Trustee as custodian for such Depositary
and (iii) bear legends as set forth in Section 202.

                 Members of, or participants in, the Depositary ("Agent
Members") shall have no rights under this Indenture with respect to any Global
Note held on their behalf by the Depositary, or the Trustee as its custodian,
or under the Global Note, and the Depositary may be treated by the Company, the
Trustee and any agent of the Company or the Trustee as the absolute owner of
such Global Note for all purposes whatsoever.  Notwithstanding the foregoing,
nothing herein shall prevent the Company, the Trustee or any agent of the
Company or the Trustee from giving effect to any written certification, proxy
or other authorization furnished by the Depositary or shall impair, as between
the Depositary and its Agent Members, the operation of customary practices
governing the exercise of the rights of a Holder of any Note.

                 (b)      Transfers of a Global Note shall be limited to
transfers of such Global Note in whole, but not in part, to the Depositary, its
successors or their respective nominees.  Interests of beneficial owners in a
Global Note may be transferred in accordance with the rules and procedures of
the Depositary and the provisions of Section 307.  If required to do so
pursuant to any applicable law or regulation, beneficial owners may obtain
Notes in definitive form ("Physical Notes") in exchange for their beneficial
interests in a Global Note upon written request in accordance with the
Depositary's and the Registrar's procedures.  In addition, Physical Notes shall
be transferred to all beneficial owners in exchange for their beneficial
interests in a Global Note if (i) the Depositary notifies the Company that it
is unwilling or unable to continue as Depositary for such Global Note or the
Depositary ceases to be a clearing agency registered under the Exchange Act, at
a time when the Depositary is required to be so registered in order to act as
Depositary, and in each case a successor depositary is not appointed by the
Company within 90 days of such notice, (ii) the Company executes and delivers
to the Trustee and Note Registrar an Officers' Certificate stating that such
Global Note shall be so exchangeable or (iii) an Event of Default has occurred
and is continuing and the Note Registrar has received a request from the
Depositary.

<PAGE>   54
                                                                              54


                 (c)      In connection with any transfer of a portion of the
beneficial interest in a Global Note pursuant to subsection (b) of this Section
to beneficial owners who are required to hold Physical Notes, the Note
Registrar shall reflect on its books and records the date and a decrease in the
principal amount of such Global Note in an amount equal to the principal amount
of the beneficial interest in the Global Note to be transferred, and the
Company shall execute, and the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver, one or
more Physical Notes of like tenor and amount.

                 (d)      In connection with the transfer of an entire Global
Note to beneficial owners pursuant to subsection (b) of this Section, such
Global Note shall be deemed to be surrendered to the Trustee for cancellation,
and the Company shall execute, and the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver,
to each beneficial owner identified by the Depositary in exchange for its
beneficial interest in such Global Note, an equal aggregate principal amount of
Physical Notes of authorized denominations.

                 (e)      Any Physical Note delivered in exchange for an
interest in a Global Note pursuant to subsection (c) or subsection (d) of this
Section shall, except as otherwise provided by paragraph (a)(i)(x) and
paragraph (f) of Section 307, bear the applicable legend regarding transfer
restrictions applicable to the Physical Note set forth in Section 202.

                 (f)      The registered holder of a Global Note may grant
proxies and otherwise authorize any person, including Agent Members and persons
that may hold interests through Agent Members, to take any action which a
Holder is entitled to take under this Indenture or the Notes.

                 SECTION 307.  Special Transfer Provisions.

                 (a)      The following provisions shall apply with respect to
any proposed transfer of a Rule 144A Note or an Institutional Accredited
Investor Note prior to the expiration of the Resale Restriction Termination
Date (as defined in Section 202 hereof):

                    (i)   a transfer of a Rule 144A Note or an Institutional
         Accredited Investor Note or a beneficial interest therein to a QIB
         shall be made upon the representation of the transferee that it is
         purchasing the Note for its own account or an account with respect to
         which it exercises sole investment discretion and that it and any such
         account is a "qualified institutional buyer" within the meaning of
         Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and is aware
         that the sale to it is being made in reliance on Rule 144A and
         acknowledges that it has received such information regarding the
         Company as the undersigned has requested pursuant to Rule 144A or has
         determined not to request such information and that it is aware that
         the transferor is relying upon its foregoing representations in order
         to claim the exemption from registration provided by Rule 144A;

                    (ii)  a transfer of a Rule 144A Note or an Institutional
         Accredited Investor Note or a beneficial interest therein to an
         institutional accredited investor shall be made upon receipt by the
         Trustee or its agent of a certificate substantially in the form set
         forth in Section 308 hereof from the proposed transferee and, if
         requested by the Company or the Trustee, the delivery of an opinion of
         counsel, certification and/or other information satisfactory to each
         of them; and

                   (iii)  a transfer of a Rule 144A Note or an Institutional
         Accredited Investor Note or a beneficial interest therein to a
         Non-U.S. Person shall be made upon receipt by the Trustee or its
         agent of a certificate substantially in the form set forth in Section
         309 hereof from the proposed transferee and, if requested by the
         Company or the Trustee, the delivery of an opinion of counsel,
         certification and/or other information satisfactory to each of them.

                 (b)      The following provisions shall apply with respect to
any proposed transfer of a Regulation S Note prior to the expiration of the
Restricted Period:

                    (i)   a transfer of a Regulation S Note or a beneficial
         interest therein to a QIB shall be made upon the representation of the
         transferee that it is purchasing the Note for its own

<PAGE>   55
                                                                              55


         account or an account with respect to which it exercises sole
         investment discretion and that it and any such account is a "qualified
         institutional buyer" within the meaning of Rule 144A under the
         Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and is aware that the sale to it
         is being made in reliance on Rule 144A and acknowledges that it has
         received such information regarding the Company as the undersigned has
         requested pursuant to Rule 144A or has determined not to request such
         information and that it is aware that the transferor is relying upon
         its foregoing representations in order to claim the exemption from
         registration provided by Rule 144A;

                    (ii)  a transfer of a Regulation S Note or a beneficial
         interest therein to an institutional accredited investor shall be made
         upon receipt by the Trustee or its agent of a certificate
         substantially in the form set forth in Section 308 hereof from the
         proposed transferee and, if requested by the Company or the Trustee,
         the delivery of an opinion of counsel, certification and/or other
         information satisfactory to each of them; and

                   (iii)  a transfer of a Regulation S Note or a beneficial
         interest therein to a Non-U.S. Person shall be made upon, if requested
         by the Company or the Trustee, receipt by the Trustee or its agent of
         an opinion of counsel, certification and/or other information
         satisfactory to each of them.

                 After the expiration of the Restricted Period, interests in
the Regulation S Note may be transferred without requiring certification set
forth in Section 308 or any additional certification.

                 (c)      Private Placement Legend.  Upon the transfer,
exchange or replacement of Notes not bearing the Private Placement Legend, the
Note Registrar shall deliver Notes that do not bear the Private Placement
Legend.  Upon the transfer, exchange or replacement of Notes bearing the
Private Placement Legend, the Note Registrar shall deliver only Notes that bear
the Private Placement Legend unless there is delivered to the Note Registrar an
Opinion of Counsel reasonably satisfactory to the Company and the Trustee to
the effect that neither such legend nor the related restrictions on transfer
are required in order to maintain compliance with the provisions of the
Securities Act.

                 (d)      General.  By its acceptance of any Note bearing the
Private Placement Legend, each Holder of such a Note acknowledges the
restrictions on transfer of such Note set forth in this Indenture and in the
Private Placement Legend and agrees that it will transfer such Note only as
provided in this Indenture.

                 (e)      The Company shall deliver to the Trustee an Officers'
Certificate setting forth the dates on which the Restricted Period terminates
(the "Resale Restriction Termination Date").

                 The Note Registrar shall retain copies of all letters, notices
and other written communications received pursuant to Section 306 or this
Section 307.  The Company shall have the right to inspect and make copies of
all such letters, notices or other written communications at any reasonable
time upon the giving of reasonable written notice to the Note Registrar.

                 (f)      No Obligation of the Trustee:  (i)  The Trustee shall
have no responsibility or obligation to any beneficial owner of a Global Note,
a member of, or a participant in the Depository or other Person with respect to
any ownership interest in the Notes, with respect to the accuracy of the
records of the Depository or its nominee or of any participant or member
thereof or with respect to the delivery to any participant, member, beneficial
owner or other Person (other than the Depository) of any notice (including any
notice of redemption) or the payment of any amount, under or with respect to
such Notes.  All notices and communications to be given to the Holders and all
payments to be made to Holders under the Notes shall be given or made only to
the registered Holders (which shall be the Depository or its nominee in the
case of a Global Note).  The rights of beneficial owners in any Global Note in
global form shall be exercised only through the Depository subject to the
applicable rules and procedures of the Depository.  The Trustee may rely and
shall be fully protected and indemnified pursuant to Section 607 in relying
upon information furnished by the Depository with respect to any beneficial
owners, its members and participants.
<PAGE>   56
                                                                              56


                 (ii)  The Trustee shall have no obligation or duty to monitor,
determine or inquire as to compliance with any restrictions on transfer imposed
under this Indenture or under applicable law with respect to any transfer of
any interest in any Note (including without limitation any transfers between or
among Depository participants, members or beneficial owners in any Global Note)
other than to require delivery of such certificates and other documentation of
evidence as are expressly required by, and to do so if and when expressly
required by, the terms of this Indenture, and to examine the same to determine
substantial compliance as to form with the express requirements hereof.

                 SECTION 308.  Form of Certificate to Be Delivered in
Connection with Transfers to Institutional Accredited Investors.

                                  [date]


         RENTERS CHOICE, INC.
         IBJ SCHRODER BANK & TRUST COMPANY, as Trustee
         1 State Street
         New York, New York  10004
         Attention:  Corporate Trust Department

Ladies and Gentlemen:

                 This certificate is delivered to request a transfer of $______
principal amount of the 11% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Notes") of
Renters Choice, Inc. (the "Company").

                 Upon transfer, the Notes would be registered in the name of
the new beneficial owner as follows:

                 Name:
                 Address:
                 Taxpayer ID Number:

                 The undersigned represents and warrants to you that:

                 (1)      We are an institutional "accredited investor" (as
defined in Rules 501(a)(1), (2), (3) and (7) under the Securities Act of 1933,
as amended (the "Securities Act")), purchasing for our own account or for the
account of an institutional "accredited investor" at least $250,000 principal
amount of the Notes, and we are acquiring the Notes not with a view to, or for
offer or sale in connection with, any distribution in violation of the
Securities Act.  We have such knowledge and experience in financial and
business matters as to be capable of evaluating the merits and risks of our
investment in the Notes and invest in or purchase securities similar to the
Notes in the normal course of our business.  We and any accounts for which we
are acting are each able to bear the economic risk of our or its investment.

<PAGE>   57
                                                                              57



                 (2)      We understand that the Notes have not been registered
under the Securities Act and, unless so registered, may not be sold except as
permitted in the following sentence.  We agree on our own behalf and on behalf
of any investor account for which we are purchasing Notes to offer, sell or
otherwise transfer such Notes prior to the date which is two years after the
later of the date of original issue and the last date on which the Company or
any affiliate of the Company was the owner of such Notes (or any predecessor
thereto) (the "Resale Restriction Termination Date") only (a) to the Company,
(b) pursuant to a registration statement which has been declared effective
under the Securities Act, (c) in a transaction complying with the requirements
of Rule 144A under the Securities Act, to a person we reasonably believe is a
qualified institutional buyer under Rule 144A (a "QIB") that purchases for its
own account or for the account of a QIB and to whom notice is given that the
transfer is being made in reliance on Rule 144A, (d) pursuant to offers and
sales that occur outside the United States within the meaning of Regulation S
under the Securities Act, (e) to an institutional "accredited investor" within
the meaning of Rule 501(a)(1), (2), (3) or (7) under the Securities Act that is
purchasing for its own account or for the account of such an institutional
"accredited investor", in each case in a minimum principal amount of Notes of
$250,000 or (f) pursuant to any other available exemption from the registration
requirements of the Securities Act, subject in each of the foregoing cases to
any requirement of law that the disposition of our property or the property of
such investor account or accounts be at all times within our or their control
and in compliance with any applicable state securities laws.  The foregoing
restrictions on resale will not apply subsequent to the Resale Restriction
Termination Date.  If any resale or other transfer of the Notes is proposed to
be made pursuant to clause (e) above prior to the Resale Restriction
Termination Date, the transferor shall deliver a letter from the transferee
substantially in the form of this letter to the Company and the Trustee, which
shall provide, among other things, that the transferee is an institutional
"accredited investor" within the meaning of Rule 501(a)(1), (2), (3) or (7)
under the Securities Act and that it is acquiring such Notes for investment
purposes and not for distribution in violation of the Securities Act.  Each
purchaser acknowledges that the Company and the Trustee reserve the right prior
to any offer, sale or other transfer prior to the Resale Termination Date of
the Notes pursuant to clauses (d), (e) or (f) above to require the delivery of
an opinion of counsel, certifications and/or other information satisfactory to
the Company and the Trustee.


                                  TRANSFEREE:

                                  BY:


Upon transfer the Notes would be registered in the name of the new beneficial
owner as follows:

<TABLE>
                        <S>                                         <C>                                     <C>
                                                                                                            Taxpayer ID
                        Name                                        Address                                   Number:
                        ----                                        -------                                   ------ 
</TABLE>


Very truly yours,

[Name of Transferor]


                                                                              
By:                                                                           
   -------------------------------         ----------------------------------
   Name:                                   Signature Medallion Guaranteed
   Title:

                 SECTION 309.  Form of Certificate to Be Delivered in
Connection with Transfers Pursuant to Regulation S.
<PAGE>   58
                                                                              58



                                  [date]

IBJ SCHRODER BANK & TRUST COMPANY, as Trustee
1 State Street
New York, New York  10004
Attention:  Corporate Trust Department

                 Re:      RENTERS CHOICE, INC. (the "Company") 11% Senior
                          Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Notes")

Ladies and Gentlemen:

                 In connection with our proposed sale of $________ aggregate
principal amount of the Notes, we confirm that such sale has been effected
pursuant to and in accordance with Regulation S under the United States
Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"), and, accordingly, we
represent that:

                 (a)      the offer of the Notes was not made to a person in
         the United States;

                 (b)      either (i) at the time the buy order was originated,
         the transferee was outside the United States or we and any person
         acting on our behalf reasonably believed that the transferee was
         outside the United States or (ii) the transaction was executed in, on
         or through the facilities of a designated off-shore securities market
         and neither we nor any person acting on our behalf knows that the
         transaction has been pre-arranged with a buyer in the United States;

                 (c)      no directed selling efforts have been made in the
         United States in contravention of the requirements of Rule 903(b) or
         Rule 904(b) of Regulation S, as applicable; and

                 (d)      the transaction is not part of a plan or scheme to
         evade the registration requirements of the Securities Act.

                 In addition, if the sale is made during a restricted period
and the provisions of Rule 903(c)(3) or Rule 904(c)(1) of Regulation S are
applicable thereto, we confirm that such sale has been made in accordance with
the applicable provisions of Rule 903(c)(3) or Rule 904(c)(1), as the case may
be.

                 You and the Company are entitled to rely upon this letter and
are irrevocably authorized to produce this letter or a copy hereof to any
interested party in any administrative or legal proceedings or official inquiry
with respect to the matters covered hereby.  Terms used in this certificate
have the meanings set forth in Regulation S.

         Very truly yours,

         [Name of Transferor]


         By:
            --------------------           ------------------------------
            Authorized Signature           Signature Medallion Guaranteed


<PAGE>   59
                                                                              59


                 SECTION 310.  Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost and Stolen Notes.

                 If (i) any mutilated Note is surrendered to the Trustee, or
(ii) the Company and the Trustee receive evidence to their satisfaction of the
destruction, loss or theft of any Note, and there is delivered to the Company,
each Subsidiary Guarantor and the Trustee such security or indemnity, in each
case, as may be required by them to save each of them harmless, then, in the
absence of notice to the Company any Subsidiary Guarantor or the Trustee that
such Note has been acquired by a bona fide purchaser, the Company shall execute
and upon Company Order the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver, in exchange
for any such mutilated Note or in lieu of any such destroyed, lost or stolen
Note, a new Note of like tenor and principal amount, bearing a number not
contemporaneously outstanding.

                 In case any such mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Note has
become or is about to become due and payable, the Company in its discretion
may, instead of issuing a new Note, pay such Note.

                 Upon the issuance of any new Note under this Section, the
Company may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other
governmental charge that may be imposed in relation thereto and any other
expenses (including the fees and expenses of the Trustee) in connection
therewith.

                 Every new Note issued pursuant to this Section in lieu of any
mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Note shall constitute an original
additional contractual obligation of the Company, any Guarantor and any other
obligor upon the Notes, whether or not the mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen
Note shall be at any time enforceable by anyone, and shall be entitled to all
benefits of this Indenture equally and proportionately with any and all other
Notes duly issued hereunder.

                 The provisions of this Section are exclusive and shall
preclude (to the extent lawful) all other rights and remedies with respect to
the replacement or payment of mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes.

                 SECTION 311.  Payment of Interest; Interest Rights Preserved.

                 Interest on any Note which is payable, and is punctually paid
or duly provided for, on any interest payment date shall be paid to the Person
in whose name such Note (or one or more predecessor Notes) is registered at the
close of business on the Regular Record Date for such interest at the office or
agency of the Company maintained for such purpose pursuant to Section 1002;
provided, however, that each installment of interest may at the Company's
option be paid by (i) mailing a check for such interest, payable to or upon the
written order of the Person entitled thereto pursuant to Section 312, to the
address of such Person as it appears in the Note Register or (ii) wire transfer
to an account located in the United States maintained by the payee.

                 Any interest on any Note which is payable, but is not paid
when the same becomes due and payable and such nonpayment continues for a
period of 30 days shall forthwith cease to be payable to the Holder on the
Regular Record Date by virtue of having been such Holder, and such defaulted
interest and (to the extent lawful) interest on such defaulted interest at the
rate borne by the Notes (such defaulted interest and interest thereon herein
collectively called "Defaulted Interest") shall be paid by the Company, at its
election in each case, as provided in clause (a) or (b) below:

                 (a)      The Company may elect to make payment of any
         Defaulted Interest to the Persons in whose names the Notes (or their
         respective predecessor Notes) are registered at the close of business
         on a Special Record Date for the payment of such Defaulted Interest,
         which shall be fixed in the following manner.  The Company shall
         notify the Trustee in writing of the amount of Defaulted Interest
         proposed to be paid on each Note and the date (not less than 30 days
         after such notice) of the proposed payment (the "Special Interest
         Payment Date"), and at the same time the Company shall deposit with
         the Trustee an amount of money equal to the aggregate amount proposed
         to be paid in respect of such Defaulted Interest or shall make


<PAGE>   60
                                                                              60


         arrangements satisfactory to the Trustee for such deposit prior to the
         date of the proposed payment, such money when deposited to be held in
         trust for the benefit of the Persons entitled to such Defaulted
         Interest as in this clause provided.  Thereupon the Trustee shall fix
         a record date (the "Special Record Date") for the payment of such
         Defaulted Interest which shall be not more than 15 days and not less
         than 10 days prior to the Special Interest Payment Date and not less
         than 10 days after the receipt by the Trustee of the notice of the
         proposed payment.  The Trustee shall promptly notify the Company of
         such Special Record Date, and in the name and at the expense of the
         Company, shall cause notice of the proposed payment of such Defaulted
         Interest and the Special Record Date and Special Interest Payment Date
         therefor to be given in the manner provided for in Section 106, not
         less than 10 days prior to such Special Record Date.  Notice of the
         proposed payment of such Defaulted Interest and the Special Record
         Date and Special Interest Payment Date therefor having been so given,
         such Defaulted Interest shall be paid on the Special Interest Payment
         Date to the Persons in whose names the Notes (or their respective
         predecessor Notes) are registered at the close of business on such
         Special Record Date and shall no longer be payable pursuant to the
         following clause (b).

                 (b)      The Company may make payment of any Defaulted
         Interest in any other lawful manner not inconsistent with the
         requirements of any securities exchange on which the Notes may be
         listed, and upon such notice as may be required by such exchange, if,
         after notice given by the Company to the Trustee of the proposed
         payment pursuant to this clause, such manner of payment shall be
         deemed practicable by the Trustee.

                 Subject to the foregoing provisions of this Section, each Note
delivered under this Indenture upon registration of transfer of or in exchange
for or in lieu of any other Note shall carry the rights to interest accrued and
unpaid, and to accrue, which were carried by such other Note.

                 SECTION 312.  Persons Deemed Owners.

                 Prior to the due presentment of a Note for registration of
transfer, the Company, the Trustee and any agent of the Company, any Subsidiary
Guarantor or the Trustee may treat the Person in whose name such Note is
registered as the owner of such Note for the purpose of receiving payment of
principal of (and premium, if any) and (subject to Sections 305 and 311)
interest on such Note and for all other purposes whatsoever, whether or not
such Note be overdue, and none of the Company, any Subsidiary Guarantor, the
Trustee nor any agent of the Company, any Subsidiary Guarantor or the Trustee
shall be affected by notice to the contrary.

                 SECTION 313.  Cancellation.

                 All Notes surrendered for payment, redemption, registration of
transfer or exchange shall, if surrendered to any Person other than the
Trustee, be delivered to the Trustee and shall be promptly cancelled by it.  If
the Company shall acquire any of the Notes other than as set forth in the
preceding sentence, the acquisition shall not operate as a redemption or
satisfaction of the Indebtedness represented by such Notes unless and until the
same are surrendered to the Trustee for cancellation pursuant to this Section
313.  No Notes shall be authenticated in lieu of or in exchange for any Notes
cancelled as provided in this Section, except as expressly permitted by this
Indenture.  All cancelled Notes held by the Trustee shall be destroyed by the
Trustee and the Trustee shall send a certificate of such destruction to the
Company.

                 SECTION 314.  Computation of Interest.

                 Interest on the Notes shall be computed on the basis of a
360-day year of twelve 30-day months.

<PAGE>   61
                                                                              61


                 SECTION 315.  CUSIP Numbers.

                 The Company in issuing Notes may use "CUSIP" numbers (if then
generally in use) in addition to serial numbers; if so, the Trustee shall use
such "CUSIP" numbers in addition to serial numbers in notices of redemption and
repurchase as a convenience to Holders; provided that any such notice may state
that no representation is made as to the correctness of such CUSIP numbers,
either as printed on the Notes or as contained in any notice of a redemption or
repurchase and that reliance may be placed only on the serial or other
identification numbers printed on the Notes, and any such redemption or
repurchase shall not be affected by any defect in or omission of such CUSIP
numbers.  The Company will promptly notify the Trustee of any change in the
CUSIP numbers.


                   ARTICLE FOUR.  SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE
400.

                 SECTION 401.  Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture.

                 This Indenture shall upon Company Request cease to be of
further effect (except as to surviving rights of registration of transfer or
exchange of Notes expressly provided for herein or pursuant hereto) and the
Trustee, at the expense of the Company, shall execute proper instruments
acknowledging satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture when

                 (i)      either

                          (A)     all Notes theretofore authenticated and
                 delivered (other than (1) Notes which have been lost, stolen
                 or destroyed and which have been replaced or paid as provided
                 in Section 310 and (2) Notes for whose payment money has
                 theretofore been deposited in trust with the Trustee or any
                 Paying Agent or segregated and held in trust by the Company
                 and thereafter repaid to the Company or discharged from such
                 trust, as provided in Section 1003) have been delivered to the
                 Trustee for cancellation; or

                          (B)     all Notes not theretofore delivered to the
                 Trustee for cancellation

                                  (1)      have become due and payable by
                          reason of the making of a notice of redemption or
                          otherwise; or

                                  (2)      will become due and payable at their
                          Stated Maturity within one year; or

                                  (3)      are to be called for redemption
                          within one year under arrangements satisfactory to
                          the Trustee for the giving of notice of redemption by
                          the Trustee in the name, and at the expense, of the
                          Company,

                 and the Company in the case of (1), (2) or (3) above, has
                 irrevocably deposited or caused to be deposited with the
                 Trustee as trust funds in trust for such purpose an amount in
                 cash or Government Obligations sufficient to pay and discharge
                 the entire indebtedness on such Notes not theretofore
                 delivered to the Trustee for cancellation, for principal of
                 (and premium, if any) and interest to the date of such deposit
                 (in the case of Notes which have become due and payable) or to
                 the Stated Maturity or Redemption Date, as the case may be;

                 (ii)     no Default or Event of Default with respect to this
         Indenture or the Notes shall have occurred and be continuing on the
         date of such deposit or shall occur as a result of such deposit and
         such deposit will not result in a breach or violation of, or
         constitute a default under, any other instrument or agreement to which
         the Company or any Guarantor of the Notes is a party or by which it is
         bound;

<PAGE>   62
                                                                              62


                 (iii)    the Company or any Guarantor has paid or caused to be
         paid all sums payable hereunder by the Company or any Guarantor in
         connection with all the Notes including all fees and expenses of the
         Trustee;

                 (iv)     the Company has delivered irrevocable instructions to
         the Trustee to apply the deposited money toward the payment of such
         Notes at maturity or the Redemption Date, as the case may be; and

                 (v)      the Company has delivered to the Trustee an Officers'
         Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that all
         conditions precedent herein provided for relating to the satisfaction
         and discharge of this Indenture and the termination of the Company's
         obligation hereunder have been satisfied.

                 Notwithstanding the satisfaction and discharge of this
Indenture, the obligations of the Company to the Trustee under Section 607 and,
if money shall have been deposited with the Trustee pursuant to subclause (B)
of clause (i) of this Section, the obligations of the Trustee under Section 402
and the last paragraph of Section 1003 shall survive any such satisfaction and
discharge.

                 SECTION 402.  Application of Trust Money.

                 Subject to the provisions of the last paragraph of Section
1003, all money deposited with the Trustee pursuant to Section 401 shall be
held in trust and applied by it, in accordance with the provisions of the Notes
and this Indenture, to the payment, either directly or through any Paying Agent
(including the Company acting as its own Paying Agent) as the Trustee may
determine, to the Persons entitled thereto, of the principal (and premium, if
any) and interest for whose payment such money has been deposited with the
Trustee; but such money need not be segregated from other funds except to the
extent required by law.

                 If the Trustee or Paying Agent is unable to apply any money or
Government Obligations in accordance with Section 401 by reason of any legal
proceeding or by reason of any order or judgment of any court or governmental
authority enjoining, restraining or otherwise prohibiting such application, the
Company's and any Guarantor's obligations under this Indenture and the Notes
shall be revived and reinstated as though no deposit had occurred pursuant to
Section 401; provided that if the Company has made any payment of principal of,
premium, if any, or interest on any Notes because of the reinstatement of its
obligations, the Company shall be subrogated to the rights of the Holders of
such Notes to receive such payment from the money or U.S. Government
Obligations held by the Trustee or Paying Agent.


                            ARTICLE FIVE.  REMEDIES
500.

                 SECTION 501.  Events of Default.

                 "Event of Default," wherever used herein, means any one of the
following events (whatever the reason for such Event of Default and whether it
shall be occasioned by the provisions of Article 13 or be voluntary or
involuntary or be effected by operation of law or pursuant to any judgment,
decree or order of any court or any order, rule or regulation of any
administrative or governmental body):

                    (i)   default in any payment of interest on any Note when
         the same becomes due and such default continues for a period of 30
         days whether or not such payment shall be prohibited by Article
         Thirteen;

                    (ii)  default in the payment of the principal of any Note
         when the same becomes due at its Stated Maturity, upon optional
         redemption, upon required repurchase, upon declaration or otherwise,
         whether or not such payment shall be prohibited by Article Thirteen;

<PAGE>   63
                                                                              63


                   (iii)  the Company fails to comply with Section 801;

                    (iv)  the Company fails to comply with Section 1003, 1009,
         1010, 1011, 1012, 1013, 1014, 1015, 1016, 1017, 1019, 1020 or 1022
         (other than a failure to purchase Notes when required under Section
         1016 or 1017) and such failure continues for 30 days after the notice
         specified below;

                    (v)   the Company fails to comply with any of its
         agreements in the Notes or this Indenture (other than those referred
         to in (i), (ii), (iii) or (iv) above) and such failure continues for
         60 days after the notice specified below;

                    (vi)  Indebtedness of the Company or any Significant
         Subsidiary is not paid within any applicable grace period after final
         maturity or the acceleration by the holders thereof because of a
         default and the total amount of such Indebtedness unpaid or
         accelerated exceeds $25 million;

                   (vii)  the Company or any Significant Subsidiary pursuant to
         or within the meaning of any Bankruptcy Law:

                          (A)  commences a voluntary case;

                          (B)  consents to the entry of an order for relief
                 against it in an involuntary case;

                          (C)  consents to the appointment of a custodian of it
                 or for any substantial part of its property;

                          (D)  makes a general assignment for the benefit of
                 its creditors;

         or takes any comparable action under any foreign laws relating to
         insolvency; or

                 (viii)   a court of competent jurisdiction enters an order or
         decree under any Bankruptcy Law that:

                          (A)  is for relief against the Company or any
                 Significant Subsidiary in an involuntary case;

                          (B)  appoints a custodian of the Company or any
                 Significant Subsidiary or for any substantial part of its
                 property; or

                          (C)  orders the winding up or liquidation of the
                 Company or any Significant Subsidiary;

         or any similar relief is granted under any foreign laws and the order
         or decree remains unstayed and in effect for 90 days;

                    (ix)  any judgment or decree for the payment of money in
         excess of $25 million (net of any insurance or indemnity payments
         actually received in respect thereof prior to or within 90 days from
         the entry thereof, or to be received in respect thereof in the event
         any appeal thereof shall be unsuccessful) is rendered against the
         Company or any Significant Subsidiary that is not discharged, or
         bonded or insured by a third Person and either (A) an enforcement
         proceeding has been commenced upon such judgment or decree or (B) such
         judgment or decree remains outstanding for a period of 90 days
         following the entry of such judgment or decree and is not discharged,
         waived or stayed; or

                 (x) the failure of any Guarantee of the Notes by a Subsidiary
         Guarantor to be in full force and effect (except as contemplated by
         the terms thereof or of this Indenture) or the denial or

<PAGE>   64
                                                                              64


         disaffirmation in writing by any such Subsidiary Guarantor of its
         obligations under this Indenture or any such Guarantee of the Notes if
         such Default continues for 10 days.

                 The foregoing will constitute Events of Default whatever the
reason for any such Event of Default and whether it is voluntary or involuntary
or is effected by operation of law or pursuant to any judgment, decree or order
of any court or any order, rule or regulation of any administrative or
governmental body.

                 A Default under clause (iv) or (v) above shall not constitute
an Event of Default until the Trustee or the Holders of at least 25% in
principal amount of the outstanding Notes notify the Company of the Default and
the Company does not cure such Default within the time specified in clause (iv)
or (v), as the case may be, after receipt of such notice.  Such notice must
specify the Default, demand that it be remedied and state that such notice is a
"Notice of Default".

                 The Company shall deliver to the Trustee, within 30 days after
the occurrence thereof, written notice in the form of an Officers' Certificate
of any event which with the giving of notice or the lapse of time would become
an Event of Default under clause (iv), (v) or (viii) above, its status and what
action the Company is taking or proposes to take with respect thereto.

                 If a Default occurs and is continuing and is known to the
Trustee, the Trustee must mail to each Holder notice of the Default within 90
days after it occurs. Except in the case of a Default in the payment of
principal of, premium, if any, or interest on any Note, the Trustee may
withhold such notice if and so long as a committee of its Trust Officers in
good faith determines that withholding notice is in the interests of the
Holders. In addition, the Company is required to deliver to the Trustee, within
120 days after the end of each fiscal year, a certificate indicating whether
the signers thereof know of any Default that occurred during the previous year.

                 SECTION 502.  Acceleration of Maturity; Rescission and
Annulment.

                 If an Event of Default (other than by reason of an Event of
Default specified in Section 501(vii) or 501(viii)) occurs and is continuing,
the Trustee by written notice to the Company, or the Holders of at least a
majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes, by written notice to the
Company and the Trustee, may declare the principal (and premium, if any) and
accrued and unpaid interest on all such then outstanding Notes to be due and
payable immediately.  Upon the effectiveness of such declaration, such
principal (and premium, if any) and interest will be due and payable
immediately.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the case of an Event of Default
specified in Section 501(vii) or 501(viii) occurs and is continuing, then the
principal amount of, and interest on, all the Notes shall ipso facto become and
be immediately due and payable without any declaration or other act on the part
of the Trustee or any Holder.

                 The Holders of a majority in principal amount of the
outstanding Notes by notice to the Trustee may rescind an acceleration and its
consequences if the rescission would not conflict with any judgment or decree
and if all existing Events of Default have been cured or waived except
nonpayment of principal or interest that has become due solely because of
acceleration.  The Trustee may rely upon such notice of rescission without any
independent investigation as to the satisfaction of the conditions in the
preceding sentence.  No such rescission shall affect any subsequent Default or
impair any right consequent thereto.

                 SECTION 503.  Collection of Indebtedness and Suits for
Enforcement by Trustee.

                 If an Event of Default specified in Section 501(i) or 501(ii)
occurs and is continuing, the Trustee, in its own name as trustee of an express
trust, may institute a judicial proceeding for the collection of the sums so
due and unpaid, may prosecute such proceeding to judgment or final decree and
may enforce the same against the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor (in
accordance with the applicable Subsidiary Guarantee) and collect the moneys
adjudged or decreed to be payable in the
<PAGE>   65
                                                                              65


manner provided by law out of the property of the Company or any Subsidiary
Guarantor, wherever situated.

                 If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee
may in its discretion proceed to protect and enforce its rights and the rights
of the Holders under this Indenture or any Guarantee of the Notes by such
appropriate judicial proceedings as the Trustee shall deem most effectual to
protect and enforce any such rights, including, seeking recourse against any
Subsidiary Guarantor pursuant to the terms of any Subsidiary Guarantee, whether
for the specific enforcement of any covenant or agreement in this Indenture or
in aid of the exercise of any power granted herein, or to enforce any other
proper remedy including, without limitation, seeking recourse against any
Subsidiary Guarantor pursuant to the terms of its Subsidiary Guarantee, or to
enforce any other proper remedy, subject however to Section 513.  No recovery
of any such judgment upon any property of the Company or any Subsidiary
Guarantor shall affect or impair any rights, powers or remedies of the Trustee
or the Holders.

                 SECTION 504.  Trustee May File Proofs of Claim.

                 In case of the pendency of any receivership, insolvency,
liquidation, bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, adjustment, composition
or other judicial proceeding relative to the Company or any other obligor,
including any Subsidiary Guarantor, upon the Notes or the property of the
Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors or of such other obligor or their creditors,
the Trustee (irrespective of whether the principal of the Notes shall then be
due and payable as therein expressed or by declaration or otherwise and
irrespective of whether the Trustee shall have made any demand on the Company
for the payment of overdue principal, premium, if any, or interest) shall be
entitled and empowered, by intervention in such proceeding or otherwise,

                 (i)      to file proofs of claim for the whole amount of
         principal (and premium, if any) and interest owing and unpaid in
         respect of the Notes, to take such other actions (including
         participating as a member, voting or otherwise, of any official
         committee of creditors appointed in such matter) and to file such
         other papers or documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to
         have the claims of the Trustee (including any claim for the reasonable
         compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its
         agents and counsel) and of the Holders allowed in such judicial
         proceeding, and

                 (ii)     to collect and receive any moneys or other property
         payable or deliverable on any such claims and to distribute the same;

and any custodian in any such judicial proceeding is hereby authorized by each
Holder to make such payments to the Trustee and, in the event that the Trustee
shall consent to the making of such payments directly to the Holders, to pay
the Trustee any amount due it for the reasonable compensation, expenses,
disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any
other amounts due the Trustee under Section 607.

                 Nothing herein contained shall be deemed to authorize the
Trustee to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Holder
any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting
the Notes or the rights of any Holder thereof, or to authorize the Trustee to
vote in respect of the claim of any Holder in any such proceeding; provided,
however, that the Trustee may, on behalf of such Holders, vote for the election
of a trustee in bankruptcy or other similar official.

                 SECTION 505.  Trustee May Enforce Claims Without Possession of
Notes.

                 All rights of action and claims under this Indenture, the
Notes or the Subsidiary Guarantees may be prosecuted and enforced by the
Trustee without the possession of any of the Notes or the production thereof in
any proceeding relating thereto, and any such proceeding instituted by the
Trustee shall be brought in its own name and as trustee of an express trust,
and any recovery of judgment shall, after provision for the payment of the
reasonable compensation, expenses,

<PAGE>   66
                                                                              66


disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, be for the
ratable benefit of the Holders of the Notes in respect of which such judgment
has been recovered.

                 SECTION 506.  Application of Money Collected.

                 Subject to Article Thirteen, any money collected by the
Trustee pursuant to this Article shall be applied in the following order, at
the date or dates fixed by the Trustee and, in case of the distribution of such
money on account of principal (or premium, if any) or interest, upon
presentation of the Notes and the notation thereon of the payment if only
partially paid and upon surrender thereof if fully paid:

                 FIRST:  To the payment of all amounts due the Trustee under
         Section 607;

                 SECOND:  To holders of Senior Indebtedness to the extent
         required by Article Thirteen;

                 THIRD:  To the payment of the amounts then due and unpaid for
         principal of (and premium, if any) and interest on the Notes in
         respect of which or for the benefit of which such money has been
         collected, ratably, without preference or priority of any kind,
         according to the amounts due and payable on such Notes for principal
         (and premium, if any) and interest, respectively; and

                 FOURTH:  The balance, if any, to the Person or Persons
         entitled thereto, including the Company or any other obligor on the
         Notes, as their interests may appear or as a court of competent
         jurisdiction may direct, provided that all sums due and owing to the
         Holders and the Trustee have been paid in full as required by this
         Indenture.

                 SECTION 507.  Limitation on Suits.

                 No Holder of any Notes shall have any right to institute any
proceeding, judicial or otherwise, with respect to this Indenture, or for the
appointment of a receiver or trustee, or for any other remedy hereunder, unless

                       (i)  the Holder gives to the Trustee written notice
         stating that an Event of Default is continuing;

                      (ii)  the Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of
         the outstanding Notes make a written request to the Trustee to pursue
         the remedy;

                     (iii)  such Holder or Holders offer to the Trustee
         security or indemnity against any loss, liability or expense as may be
         reasonably requested by the Trustee;

                      (iv)  the Trustee does not comply with the request within
         60 days after receipt of the request and the offer of security or
         indemnity; and

                       (v)  the Holders of a majority in principal amount of
         the outstanding Notes do not give the Trustee a direction inconsistent
         with the request during such 60-day period.

it being understood and intended that no one or more Holders shall have any
right in any manner whatever by virtue of, or by availing of, any provision of
this Indenture, any Note or any Subsidiary Guarantee to affect, disturb or
prejudice the rights of any other Holders, or to obtain or to seek to obtain
priority or preference over any other Holders or to enforce any right under
this Indenture, any Note or any Subsidiary Guarantee Notes, except in the
manner herein provided and for the equal and ratable benefit of all the
Holders.


<PAGE>   67
                                                                              67



                 SECTION 508.  Unconditional Right of Holders to Receive
Principal, Premium and Interest.

                 Notwithstanding any other provision in this Indenture (other
than Article XIII), the Holder of any Note shall have the right, which is
absolute and unconditional, to receive payment, as provided herein (including,
if applicable, Article Eleven) and in such Note of the principal of (and
premium, if any) and (subject to Section 311) interest on such Note on the
respective Stated Maturities expressed in such Note (or, in the case of
redemption or repurchase, on the Redemption Date or repurchase) and to
institute suit for the enforcement of any such payment, and such rights shall
not be impaired without the consent of such Holder.

                 SECTION 509.  Restoration of Rights and Remedies.

                 If the Trustee or any Holder has instituted any proceeding to
enforce any right or remedy under this Indenture or any Guarantee of the Notes
and such proceeding has been discontinued or abandoned for any reason, or has
been determined adversely to the Trustee or to such Holder, then and in every
such case, subject to any determination in such proceeding, the Company, any
Subsidiary Guarantor, any other obligor on the Notes, the Trustee and the
Holders shall be restored severally and respectively to their former positions
hereunder, and thereafter all rights and remedies of the Trustee and the
Holders shall continue as though no such proceeding had been instituted.

                 SECTION 510.  Rights and Remedies Cumulative.

                 Except as otherwise provided with respect to the replacement
or payment of mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes in the last paragraph
of Section 310, no right or remedy herein conferred upon or reserved to the
Trustee or to the Holders is intended to be exclusive of any other right or
remedy, and every right and remedy shall, to the extent permitted by law, be
cumulative and in addition to every other right and remedy given hereunder or
now or hereafter existing at law or in equity or otherwise.  The assertion or
employment of any right or remedy hereunder, or otherwise, shall not prevent
the concurrent assertion or employment of any other appropriate right or
remedy.

                 SECTION 511.  Delay or Omission Not Waiver.

                 No delay or omission of the Trustee or of any Holder to
exercise any right or remedy accruing upon any Event of Default shall impair
any such right or remedy or constitute a waiver of any such Event of Default or
an acquiescence therein.  Every right and remedy given by this Article or by
law to the Trustee or to the Holders may be exercised from time to time, and as
often as may be deemed expedient, by the Trustee or by the Holders, as the case
may be.

                 SECTION 512.  Control by Holders.

                 The Holders of not less than a majority in principal amount of
the Outstanding Notes shall have the right to direct the time, method and place
of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee, or
exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee, provided that

                    (i)   such direction shall not be in conflict with any rule
         of law or with this Indenture or any Subsidiary Guarantee,

                    (ii)  the Trustee need not take any action which might
         involve it in personal liability or be unduly prejudicial to the
         Holders not consenting, it being understood that (subject to Section
         601) the Trustee shall have no duty to ascertain whether or not such
         actions or forbearance are unduly prejudicial to such Holders; and

                   (iii)  subject to the provisions of Section 315 of the Trust
         Indenture Act, the Trustee may take any other action deemed proper by
         the Trustee which is not inconsistent with such direction.

<PAGE>   68
                                                                              68


                 Prior to taking any action hereunder, the Trustee shall be
entitled to indemnification satisfactory to it in its sole discretion against
all losses and expenses caused by taking or not taking such action.

                 SECTION 513.  Waiver of Past Defaults.

                 Subject to Sections 508 and 902, the Holders of a majority in
aggregate principal amount of the Outstanding Notes (including consents
obtained in connection with a tender offer or exchange offer for the Notes) may
on behalf of the Holders of all the Notes, by written notice to the Trustee,
waive any existing Default or Event of Default and its consequences under this
Indenture or any Subsidiary Guarantee except a continuing Default or Event of
Default in the payment of interest on, premium, if any, or the principal of,
any such Note held by a non-consenting Holder, or in respect of a covenant or a
provision which cannot be amended or modified without the consent of all
Holders.

                 In the event that any Event of Default specified in Section
501(vi) shall have occurred and be continuing, such Event of Default and all
consequences thereof (including without limitation any acceleration or
resulting payment default) shall be annulled, waived and rescinded,
automatically and without any action by the Trustee or the Holders of the
Notes, if within 30 days after such Event of Default arose (i) the Indebtedness
that is the basis for such Event of Default has been discharged, or (ii) the
holders thereof have rescinded or waived the acceleration, notice or action (as
the case may be) giving rise to such Event of Default, or (iii) if the Default
that is the basis for such Event of Default has been cured.

                 Upon any such waiver, such Default shall cease to exist, and
any Event of Default arising therefrom shall be deemed to have been cured, for
every purpose of this Indenture; but no such waiver shall extend to any
subsequent or other Default or Event of Default or impair any right consequent
thereon.

                 SECTION 514.  Waiver of Stay or Extension Laws.

                 The Company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and any other obligors
upon the Notes, covenants (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) that it
will not at any time insist upon, or plead, or in any manner whatsoever claim
or take the benefit or advantage of, any stay or extension law wherever
enacted, now or at any time hereafter in force, which would prohibit or forgive
the Company, any Subsidiary Guarantor or any such obligor from paying all or
any portion of the principal of, premium, if any, or interest on the Notes
contemplated herein or in the Notes or which may affect the covenants or the
performance of this Indenture; and each of the Company, any Subsidiary
Guarantor and any such obligor (to the extent that it may lawfully do so)
hereby expressly waives all benefit or advantage of any such law and covenants
that it will not hinder, delay or impede the execution of any power herein
granted to the Trustee, but will suffer and permit the execution of every such
power as though no such law had been enacted.

                 SECTION 515.  Undertaking for Costs.

                 All parties to this Indenture agree, and each Holder of any
Note by his acceptance thereof shall be deemed to have agreed, that any court
may in its discretion require, in any suit for the enforcement of any right or
remedy under this Indenture, or in any suit against the Trustee for any action
taken, suffered or omitted by it as Trustee, the filing by any party litigant
in such suit of an undertaking to pay the costs of such suit, and that such
court may in its discretion assess reasonable costs, including reasonable
attorneys' fees and expenses, against any party litigant in such suit, having
due regard to the merits and good faith of the claims or defenses made by such
party litigant; but the provisions of this Section shall not apply to any suit
instituted by the Trustee, to any suit instituted by any Holder, or group of
Holders, holding in the aggregate more than 10% in principal amount of the
Outstanding Notes, or to any suit instituted by any Holder for the enforcement
of the payment of the principal of (or premium, if any) or interest on any Note
on or after the respective Stated Maturities expressed in such Note (or, in the
case of redemption, on or after the Redemption Date).
<PAGE>   69
                                                                              69



                           ARTICLE SIX.  THE TRUSTEE
600.

                 SECTION 601.  Certain Duties and Responsibilities.

                 (a)      Except during the continuance of a Default or an
                          Event of Default,

                    (i)   the Trustee undertakes to perform such duties and
         only such duties as are specifically set forth in this Indenture, and
         the Trustee should not be liable except for the performance of such
         duties as specifically set forth in the Indenture and no others; and
         no implied covenants or obligations shall be read into this Indenture
         against the Trustee; and

                    (ii)  in the absence of bad faith or willful misconduct on
         its part, the Trustee may conclusively rely, as to the truth of the
         statements and the correctness of the opinions expressed therein, upon
         certificates or opinions furnished to the Trustee and conforming to
         the requirements of this Indenture; but in the case of any such
         certificates or opinions, the Trustee shall be under a duty to examine
         the same to determine whether or not they conform to the requirements
         of this Indenture, but not to verify the contents thereof.

                 (b)      In case a Default or an Event of Default has occurred
and is continuing of which a Trust Officer of the Trustee has actual knowledge
or of which written notice of such Default or Event of Default shall have been
given to the Trustee by the Company, any other obligor of the Notes or by any
Holder, the Trustee shall exercise such of the rights and powers vested in it
by this Indenture, and use the same degree of care and skill in their exercise,
as a prudent man would exercise or use under the circumstances in the conduct
of his own affairs.

                 (c)      No provision of this Indenture shall be construed to
relieve the Trustee from liability for its own negligent action, its own
negligent failure to act, or its own willful misconduct, except that

                    (i)   this paragraph (c) shall not be construed to limit
         the effect of paragraph (a) of this Section;

                    (ii)  the Trustee shall not be liable for any error of
         judgment made in good faith by a Trust Officer, unless it shall be
         proved that the Trustee was negligent in ascertaining the pertinent
         facts; and

                   (iii)  the Trustee shall not be liable with respect to any
         action taken or omitted to be taken by it in good faith in accordance
         with the direction of the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal
         amount of the Outstanding Notes relating to the time, method and place
         of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee,
         or exercising any trust or power conferred upon the Trustee, under
         this Indenture.

                 (d)      Whether or not therein expressly so provided, every
provision of this Indenture relating to the conduct or affecting the liability
of or affording protection to the Trustee shall be subject to the provisions of
this Section and to the TIA.

                 SECTION 602.  Notice of Defaults.

                 Within 90 days after the occurrence of any Default hereunder,
the Trustee shall transmit in the manner and to the extent provided in TIA
Section 313(c), notice of such Default hereunder actually known to a Trust
Officer of the Trustee, unless such Default shall have been cured or waived;
provided, however, that, except in the case of a Default in the payment of the
principal of (or premium, if any) or interest on any Note, the Trustee shall be
protected in withholding such notice if and so long as the board of directors,
the executive committee or a trust committee of directors and/or Trust Officers
of the Trustee in good faith determine that the withholding of such notice is
in the interest of the Holders; and

<PAGE>   70
                                                                              70



provided further that in the case of any Default of the character specified in
Section 501(iii) no such notice to Holders shall be given until at least 30
days after the occurrence thereof.  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary
expressed in this Indenture, the Trustee shall not be deemed to have knowledge
of any Default or Event of Default hereunder unless and until the Trustee shall
have received written notice thereof from the Company at its principal
Corporate Trust Office as specified in Section 105, except in the case of an
Event of Default under Sections 501(i) or 501(ii) (provided that the Trustee is
the Paying Agent).

                 SECTION 603.  Certain Rights of Trustee.

                 (a)      If an Event of Default has occurred and is
continuing, the Trustee shall exercise such of the rights and powers vested in
it by this Indenture and use the same degree of care and skill in their
exercise as a prudent person would exercise or use under the circumstances in
the conduct of his own affairs.

                 (b)      Subject to the provisions of TIA Sections 315(a)
through 315(d):

                    (i)   the Trustee may conclusively rely and shall be
         protected in acting or refraining from acting upon (whether in its
         original or facsimile form) any resolution, certificate, statement,
         instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, direction, consent,
         order, bond, debenture, note, other evidence of indebtedness or other
         paper or document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed
         or presented by the proper party or parties and the Trustee need not
         investigate any fact or matter stated in the documents;

                    (ii)  any request or direction of the Company mentioned
         herein shall be sufficiently evidenced by a Company Request or Company
         Order and any resolution of the Board of Directors may be sufficiently
         evidenced by a Board Resolution;

                   (iii)  whenever in the administration of this Indenture the
         Trustee shall deem it desirable that a matter be proved or established
         prior to taking, suffering or omitting any action hereunder, the
         Trustee (unless other evidence be herein specifically prescribed) may,
         in the absence of bad faith or willful misconduct on its part, request
         and rely upon an Officers' Certificate or an Opinion of Counsel and
         shall not liable for any action it takes or omits to take in good
         faith reliance on such Officers' Certificate or Opinion of Counsel;

                    (iv)  the Trustee may consult with counsel of its selection
         and any advice of such counsel or any Opinion of Counsel shall be full
         and complete authorization and protection in respect of any action
         taken, suffered or omitted by it hereunder in good faith and in
         reliance thereon;

                     (v)  the Trustee shall be under no obligation to exercise
         any of the rights or powers vested in it by this Indenture at the
         request or direction of any of the Holders pursuant to this Indenture,
         unless such Holders shall have offered to the Trustee security or
         indemnity reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee against the costs,
         expenses, losses and liabilities which might be incurred by it in
         compliance with such request or direction;

                    (vi)  the Trustee shall not be bound to make any
         investigation into the facts or matters stated in any resolution,
         certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request,
         direction, consent, order, bond, debenture, note, other evidence of
         indebtedness or other paper or document, but the Trustee, in its
         discretion, may make such further inquiry or investigation into such
         facts or matters as it may see fit, and, if the Trustee shall
         determine to make such further inquiry or investigation, it shall be
         entitled to examine the books, records and premises of the Company,
         personally or by agent or attorney;

                   (vii)  the Trustee may execute any of the trusts or powers
         hereunder or perform any duties hereunder either directly or by or
         through agents or attorneys and the Trustee shall not


<PAGE>   71

                                                                              71



         be responsible for any misconduct or negligence on the part of any
         agent or attorney appointed with due care by it hereunder; and

                 (viii)   the Trustee shall not be liable for any action taken,
         suffered or omitted by it in good faith and reasonably believed by it
         to be authorized or within the discretion or rights or powers
         conferred upon it by this Indenture; provided, however, that the
         Trustee's conduct does not constitute willful misconduct or
         negligence.

                 (c)      The Trustee shall not be required to expend or risk
its own funds or otherwise incur any financial liability in the performance of
any of its duties hereunder, or in the exercise of any of its rights or powers
if it shall have reasonable grounds for believing that repayment of such funds
or adequate indemnity against such risk or liability is not reasonably assured
to it.

                 SECTION 604.  Trustee Not Responsible for Recitals or Issuance
of Notes.

                 The recitals contained herein and in the Notes, except for the
Trustee's certificates of authentication, shall be taken as the statements of
the Company, and the Trustee assumes no responsibility for their correctness
and it shall not be responsible for the Company's use of the proceeds from the
Notes.  The Trustee makes no representations as to the validity or sufficiency
of this Indenture or of the Notes, except that the Trustee represents that it
is duly authorized to execute and deliver this Indenture, authenticate the
Notes and perform its obligations hereunder and that the statements made by it
in a Statement of Eligibility on Form T-1 supplied to the Company are true and
accurate, subject to the qualifications set forth therein.  The Trustee shall
not be accountable for the use or application by the Company of the proceeds of
the Notes.

                 SECTION 605.  May Hold Notes.

                 The Trustee, any Paying Agent, any Note Registrar, any
Authenticating Agent or any other agent of the Company or of the Trustee, in
its individual or any other capacity, may become the owner or pledgee of Notes
and, subject to TIA Sections 310(b) and 311, may otherwise deal with the
Company with the same rights it would have if it were not Trustee, Paying
Agent, Note Registrar, Authenticating Agent or such other agent.

                 SECTION 606.  Money Held in Trust.

                 All moneys received by the Trustee shall, until used or
applied as herein provided, be held in trust hereunder for the purposes for
which they were received, but need not be segregated from other funds except to
the extent required by law.  The Trustee shall be under no liability for
interest on any money received by it hereunder except as otherwise agreed in
writing with the Company.

                 SECTION 607.  Compensation and Reimbursement.

                 The Company agrees:

                 (i)      to pay to the Trustee from time to time such
         compensation as shall be agreed to in writing between the Company and
         the Trustee for all services rendered by it hereunder (which
         compensation shall not be limited by any provision of law in regard to
         the compensation of a trustee of an express trust);

                 (ii)     except as otherwise expressly provided herein, to
         reimburse the Trustee upon its request for all reasonable expenses,
         disbursements and advances incurred or made by the Trustee in
         accordance with any provision of this Indenture (including the
         reasonable compensation and the expenses and disbursements of its
         agents, consultants and counsel and costs and expenses of collection),
         except any such expense, disbursement or advance as may be
         attributable to its negligence or bad faith; and

<PAGE>   72
                                                                              72



                 (iii)    to indemnify each of the Trustee or any predecessor
         Trustee (and their respective directors, officers, stockholders,
         employees and agents) for, and to hold them harmless against, any and
         all loss, damage, claim, liability or expense, including taxes (other
         than taxes based on the income of the Trustee) incurred without gross
         negligence, willful misconduct or bad faith on their part, arising out
         of or in connection with the acceptance or administration of this
         trust, including the costs and expenses of defending themselves
         against any claim or liability in connection with the exercise or
         performance of any of the Trustee's powers or duties hereunder.

                 The obligations of the Company under this Section to
compensate the Trustee, to pay or reimburse the Trustee for expenses,
disbursements and advances and to indemnify and hold harmless the Trustee shall
constitute additional indebtedness hereunder and shall survive the satisfaction
and discharge of this Indenture.  As security for the performance of such
obligations of the Company, the Trustee shall have a lien prior to the Holders
of the Notes upon all property and funds held or collected by the Trustee as
such, except funds held in trust for the payment of principal of (and premium,
if any) or interest on particular Notes.

                 When the Trustee incurs expenses or renders services in
connection with an Event of Default specified in Section 501(vii) or (viii),
the expenses (including the reasonable charges and expenses of its counsel) of
and the compensation for such services are intended to constitute expenses of
administration under any applicable Federal or state bankruptcy, insolvency or
other similar law.

                 The provisions of this Section shall survive the termination
of this Indenture.

                 SECTION 608.  Corporate Trustee Required; Eligibility.

                 There shall be at all times a Trustee hereunder which shall be
eligible to act as Trustee under TIA Section 310(a)(1), and which shall have an
office in The City of New York and shall have a combined capital and surplus of
at least $50,000,000.  If the Trustee does not have an office in The City of
New York, the Trustee may appoint an agent in The City of New York reasonably
acceptable to the Company to conduct any activities which the Trustee may be
required under this Indenture to conduct in The City of New York.  If such
corporation publishes reports of condition at least annually, pursuant to law
or to the requirements of Federal, state, territorial or District of Columbia
supervising or examining authority, then for the purposes of this Section 608,
the combined capital and surplus of such corporation shall be deemed to be its
combined capital and surplus as set forth in its most recent report of
condition so published.  If at any time the Trustee shall cease to be eligible
in accordance with the provisions of this Section 608, it shall resign
immediately in the manner and with the effect hereinafter specified in this
Article.

                 SECTION 609.  Resignation and Removal; Appointment of
Successor.

                 (a)      No resignation or removal of the Trustee and no
appointment of a successor Trustee pursuant to this Article shall become
effective until the acceptance of appointment by the successor Trustee in
accordance with the applicable requirements of this Section.

                 (b)      The Trustee may resign at any time by giving written
notice thereof to the Company.  Upon receiving such notice of resignation, the
Company shall promptly appoint a successor trustee by written instrument
executed by authority of the Board of Directors, a copy of which shall be
delivered to the resigning Trustee and a copy to the successor trustee.  If an
instrument of acceptance required by this Section shall not have been delivered
to the Trustee within 30 days after the giving of such notice of resignation,
the resigning Trustee may petition, at the expense of the Company, any court of
competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor Trustee.

                 (c)      The Trustee may be removed at any time by Act of the
Holders of not less than a majority in principal amount of the Outstanding
Notes, delivered to the Trustee and to the Company.  The Trustee so removed
may, at the expense of the Company, petition any court of competent

<PAGE>   73
                                                                              73



jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor Trustee if no successor Trustee
is appointed within 30 days of such removal.

                 (d)      If at any time:

                    (i)   the Trustee shall fail to comply with the provisions
         of TIA Section 310(b) after written request therefor by the Company or
         by any Holder who has been a bona fide Holder of a Note for at least
         six months, or

                    (ii)  the Trustee shall cease to be eligible under Section
         608 and shall fail to resign after written request therefor by the
         Company or by any Holder who has been a bona fide Holder of a Note for
         at least six months, or

                   (iii)  the Trustee shall become incapable of acting or shall
         be adjudged a bankrupt or insolvent or a custodian of the Trustee or
         of its property shall be appointed or any public officer shall take
         charge or control of the Trustee or of its property or affairs for the
         purpose of rehabilitation, conservation or liquidation,

then, in any such case, (A) the Company, by a Board Resolution, may remove the
Trustee, or (B) subject to TIA Section 315(e), any Holder who has been a bona
fide Holder of a Note for at least six months may, on behalf of himself and all
others similarly situated, petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the
removal of the Trustee and the appointment of a successor Trustee.

                 (e)      If the Trustee shall resign, be removed or become
incapable of acting, or if a vacancy shall occur in the office of Trustee for
any cause, the Company, by a Board Resolution, shall promptly appoint a
successor Trustee.  If, within one year after such resignation, removal or
incapability, or the occurrence of such vacancy, a successor Trustee shall be
appointed by Act of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the
Outstanding Notes delivered to the Company and the retiring Trustee, the
successor Trustee so appointed shall, forthwith upon its acceptance of such
appointment, become the successor Trustee and supersede the successor Trustee
appointed by the Company.  If no successor Trustee shall have been so appointed
by the Company or the Holders and accepted appointment in the manner
hereinafter provided, any Holder who has been a bona fide Holder of a Note for
at least six months may, at the expense of the Company on behalf of himself and
all others similarly situated, petition any court of competent jurisdiction for
the appointment of a successor Trustee.

                 (f)      The Company shall give notice of each resignation and
each removal of the Trustee and each appointment of a successor Trustee to the
Holders of Notes in the manner provided for in Section 106.  Each notice shall
include the name of the successor Trustee and the address of its Corporate
Trust Office.

                 SECTION 610.  Acceptance of Appointment by Successor.

                 Every successor Trustee appointed hereunder shall execute,
acknowledge and deliver to the Company and to the retiring Trustee an
instrument accepting such appointment, and thereupon the resignation or removal
of the retiring Trustee shall become effective and such successor Trustee,
without any further act, deed or conveyance, shall become vested with all the
rights, powers, trusts and duties of the retiring Trustee; but, on request of
the Company or the successor Trustee, such retiring Trustee shall, upon payment
of its charges, execute and deliver an instrument transferring to such
successor Trustee all the rights, powers and trusts of the retiring Trustee and
shall duly assign, transfer and deliver to such successor Trustee all property
and money held by such retiring Trustee hereunder.  Notwithstanding the
replacement of the Trustee pursuant to this Section 610, the Company's
obligations under Section 607 shall continue for the benefit of the retiring
Trustee with regard to expenses and liabilities incurred by it and compensation
earned by it prior to such replacement or otherwise under the Indenture.  Upon
request of any such successor Trustee, the Company shall execute any and all
instruments for more fully and certainly vesting in and confirming to such
successor Trustee all such rights, powers and trusts.


<PAGE>   74
                                                                              74


                 No successor Trustee shall accept its appointment unless at
the time of such acceptance such successor Trustee shall be qualified and
eligible under this Article.

                 SECTION 611.  Merger, Conversion, Consolidation or Succession
to Business.

                 Any corporation into which the Trustee may be merged or
converted or with which it may be consolidated, or any corporation resulting
from any merger, conversion or consolidation to which the Trustee shall be a
party, or any corporation succeeding to all or substantially all of the
corporate trust business of the Trustee, shall be the successor of the Trustee
hereunder, provided such corporation shall be otherwise qualified and eligible
under this Article, without the execution or filing of any paper or any further
act on the part of any of the parties hereto.  In case any Notes shall have
been authenticated, but not delivered, by the Trustee then in office, any
successor by merger, conversion or consolidation to such authenticating Trustee
may adopt such authentication and deliver the Notes so authenticated with the
same effect as if such successor Trustee had itself authenticated such Notes.
In case at that time any of the Notes shall not have been authenticated, any
successor Trustee may authenticate such Notes either in the name of any
predecessor hereunder or in the name of the successor Trustee.  In all such
cases such certificates shall have the full force and effect which this
Indenture provides for the certificate of authentication of the Trustee shall
have; provided, however, that the right to adopt the certificate of
authentication of any predecessor Trustee or to authenticate Notes in the name
of any predecessor Trustee shall apply only to its successor or successors by
merger, conversion or consolidation.

                 SECTION 612.  Trustee's Application for Instructions from the
Company.

                 Any application by the Trustee for written instructions from
the Company may, at the option of the Trustee, set forth in writing any action
proposed to be taken or omitted by the Trustee under this Indenture and the
date on and/or after which such action shall be taken or such omission shall be
effective. Subject to Section 610, the Trustee shall not be liable for any
action taken by, or omission of, the Trustee in accordance with a proposal
included in such application on or after the date specified in such application
(which date shall not be less than three Business Days after the date any
officer of the Company actually receives such application, unless any such
officer shall have consented in writing to any earlier date) unless prior to
taking any such action (or the effective date in the case of an omission), the
Trustee shall have received written instructions in response to such
application specifying the action to be taken or omitted.


        ARTICLE SEVEN.  HOLDERS LISTS AND REPORTS BY TRUSTEE AND COMPANY
700.

                 SECTION 701.  Company to Furnish Trustee Names and Addresses.

                 The Company will furnish or cause to be furnished to the
Trustee

                 (a)      semiannually, not more than 10 days after each
Regular Record Date, a list, in such form as the Trustee may reasonably
require, of the names and addresses of the Holders as of such Regular Record
Date; and

                 (b)      at such other times as the Trustee may reasonably
request in writing, within 30 days after receipt by the Company of any such
request, a list of similar form and content to that in Subsection (a) hereof as
of a date not more than 15 days prior to the time such list is furnished;

provided, however, that if and so long as the Trustee shall be the Note
Registrar, no such list need be furnished.

                 SECTION 702.  Disclosure of Names and Addresses of Holders.

                 Every Holder of Notes, by receiving and holding the same,
agrees with the Company and the Trustee that none of the Company or the Trustee
or any agent of either of them shall be held

<PAGE>   75
                                                                              75



accountable by reason of the disclosure of any such information as to the names
and addresses of the Holders in accordance with TIA Section 312, regardless of
the source from which such information was derived, and that the Trustee shall
not be held accountable by reason of mailing any material pursuant to a request
made under TIA Section 312(b).

                 SECTION 703.  Reports by Trustee.

                 Within 60 days after May 15 of each year commencing with the
first May 15 after the first issuance of Notes, the Trustee shall transmit to
the Holders, in the manner and to the extent provided in TIA Section 313(c), a
brief report dated as of such May 15 if required by TIA Section 313(a).
Delivery of such reports, information and documents to the Trustee is for
informational purposes only and the Trustee's receipt of such shall not
constitute constructive notice of any information contained therein or
determinable from information contained therein, including the Company's
compliance with any of its covenants hereunder (as to which the Trustee is
entitled to conclusively rely exclusively on Officers' Certificates).

                 The Trustee also shall comply with TIA Section 313(b).  A
copy of each report at the time of its mailing to Holders shall be filed by the
Trustee with the Commission and each stock exchange (if any) on which the Notes
are listed.  The Company agrees to notify promptly the Trustee whenever the
Notes become listed on any stock exchange and of any delisting thereof.

                 SECTION 704.  Notice of Defaults.

                 The Company is required to deliver to the Trustee, within 30
days after the occurrence thereof, written notice of any event which would
constitute certain Defaults, their status and what action the Company is taking
or proposes to take in respect thereof.

                    ARTICLE EIGHT.  MERGER AND CONSOLIDATION
800.

                 SECTION 801.  Company May Consolidate, Etc., Only on Certain
Terms.

                 The Company will not in a single transaction or series of
related transactions consolidate with or merge with or into, or convey,
transfer or lease all or substantially all its assets to any Person, unless:

                    (i)   the resulting, surviving or transferee Person (the
         "Successor Company") shall be a Person organized and existing under
         the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or the
         District of Columbia and the Successor Company (if not the Company)
         shall expressly assume, by supplemental indenture, executed and
         delivered to the Trustee, in form satisfactory to the Trustee, all the
         obligations of the Company under the Notes and hereunder;

                    (ii)  immediately after giving effect to such transaction
         (and treating any Indebtedness that becomes an obligation of the
         Successor Company or any Subsidiary of the Successor Company as a
         result of such transaction as having been incurred by the Successor
         Company or such Restricted Subsidiary at the time of such
         transaction), no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and
         be continuing;

                   (iii)  immediately before and after giving effect to such
         transaction, the Company or the Successor Company if the Company is
         not the continuing obligor under this Indenture would at the time of
         such transaction or series of transactions, after giving pro forma
         effect to such transaction as if such transaction had occurred on the
         first day of the four quarter period ending on or immediately prior to
         the date of such transaction, be able to Incur at least $1.00 of
         Indebtedness pursuant to clause (a) of Section 1010; and

                    (iv)  the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee (A)
         an Officers' Certificate, stating that (1) such Officers are not aware
         of any Default or Event of Default that shall have

<PAGE>   76
                                                                              76


         happened and be continuing and (2) such consolidation, merger or
         transfer and such supplemental indenture comply with this Indenture;
         provided that no Officers' Certificate will be required as to matters
         described in clause (A)(1) of this clause (iv) for a consolidation,
         merger or transfer described in the last paragraph of this Section
         801, and (B) an Opinion of Counsel, stating that such consolidation,
         merger or transfer and such supplemental indenture comply with this
         Indenture, both in the form required by this Indenture; provided that
         (1) in giving such opinion such counsel may rely on such Officers'
         Certificate as to any matters of fact (including without limitation as
         to compliance with the foregoing clauses (ii) and (iii)), and (2) no
         Opinion of Counsel will be required for a consolidation, merger or
         transfer described in the last paragraph of this Section 801.

                 Notwithstanding the foregoing clauses (ii) and (iii), (x) any
Restricted Subsidiary may consolidate with, merge into or transfer all or part
of its properties and assets to the Company and (y) the Company may merge with
an Affiliate incorporated solely for the purpose of reincorporating the Company
in another jurisdiction to realize tax or other benefits.

                 SECTION 802.  Successor Substituted.

                 Upon any consolidation of the Company with or merger of the
Company with or into any other corporation or any conveyance, transfer, lease
or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company
to any Person in accordance with Section 801, the Successor Company will
succeed to, and be substituted for, and may exercise every right and power of,
the Company hereunder and thereafter the predecessor Company shall be released
from all obligations and covenants hereunder, but, in the case of conveyance,
transfer or lease of all or substantially all its assets, the predecessor
Company will not be released from the obligation to pay the principal of and
interest on the Notes.


             ARTICLE NINE.  SUPPLEMENTS AND AMENDMENTS TO INDENTURE
900.

                 SECTION 901.  Supplemental Indentures Without Consent of
Holders.

                 Without the consent of any Holders, the Company, the
Subsidiary Guarantors, and the Trustee, at any time and from time to time, may
enter into one or more indentures supplemental hereto, in form satisfactory to
the Trustee, for any of the following purposes:

                     (i)  to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency; or

                    (ii)  to provide for uncertificated Notes in addition to or
         in place of certificated Notes (provided that the uncertificated Notes
         are issued in registered form for purposes of Section 163(f) of the
         Code, or in a manner such that the uncertificated Notes are described
         in Section 163(f)(2)(B) of the Code); or

                   (iii)  to add Guarantees with respect to the Notes
         (including those of Subsidiary Guarantors); or

                    (iv)  to provide for the assumption by a successor
         corporation, partnership, trust or limited liability company of the
         obligations of the Company hereunder; or

                     (v)  to secure the Notes; or

                    (vi)  to confirm and evidence the release and discharge of
         any Guarantee of the Notes or Lien with respect to or securing the
         Notes when such release and discharge is permitted by and provided for
         hereunder; or


<PAGE>   77
                                                                              77



                   (vii)  to provide that any Indebtedness that becomes or will
         become an obligation of the Successor Company pursuant to a
         transaction governed by Section 801 (and that is not a Subordinated
         Obligation) is Senior Subordinated Indebtedness for purposes of this
         Indenture; or

                  (viii)  to add to the covenants of the Company for the
         benefit of the Holders or to surrender any right or power conferred
         upon the Company; or

                    (ix)  to make any other change that does not adversely
         affect the rights of any Holder; or

                     (x)  to comply with any requirement of the Commission in
         connection with the qualification of this Indenture under the Trust
         Indenture Act.

                 However, no amendment may be made to the subordination
provisions of the Indenture that adversely affects the rights of any holder of
Senior Indebtedness then outstanding unless the holders of such Senior
Indebtedness (or any group or representative thereof authorized to give a
consent) consent to such change.

                 SECTION 902.  Supplemental Indentures with Consent of Holders.

                 With the consent of the Holders of at least a majority in
principal amount of the Outstanding Notes (including consents obtained in
connection with a tender offer or exchange offer for the Notes), the Company,
the Subsidiary Guarantors, and the Trustee may enter into an indenture or
indentures supplemental hereto for the purpose of adding any provisions to or
changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of this Indenture
or of modifying in any manner the rights of the Holders under this Indenture;
provided, however, that no such supplemental indenture shall, without the
consent of the Holder of each Outstanding Note affected thereby (with respect
to any Notes held by a nonconsenting Holder of the Notes):

                     (i)  reduce the amount of Notes whose Holders must consent
         to an amendment; or

                    (ii)  reduce the stated rate of or extend the stated time
         for payment of interest on any Note; or

                   (iii)  reduce the principal of or extend the Stated Maturity
         of any Note; or

                    (iv)  reduce the premium payable upon the redemption or
         repurchase of any Note or change the time at which any Note may be
         redeemed as described in Section 1101; or

                     (v)  make any Note payable in money other than that stated
         in the Note; or

                    (vi)  impair the right of any Holder to receive payment of
         principal of and interest on such Holder's Notes on or after the due
         dates therefor or to institute suit for the enforcement of any payment
         on or with respect to such Holder's Notes; or

                   (vii)  make any change in the amendment provisions which
         require each Holder's consent or in the waiver provisions; or

                  (viii)   make any change to the subordination provisions of
         this Indenture that adversely affects the rights of any Holder.

<PAGE>   78
                                                                              78


                 The consent of the Holders is not necessary under this
Indenture to approve the particular form of any proposed supplemental
indenture.  It is sufficient if such consent approves the substance of the
proposed supplemental indenture.

                 SECTION 903.  Execution of Supplemental Indentures.

                 The Trustee may, but shall not be obligated to, enter into any
such supplemental indenture which affects the Trustee's own rights, duties or
immunities, as determined by the Trustee in its sole discretion under this
Indenture or otherwise.  In signing or refusing to sign any supplemental
indenture permitted by this Article or the modifications thereby of the trusts
created by this Indenture, the Trustee shall be entitled to receive, and shall
be fully protected in relying upon, an Officers' Certificate and an Opinion of
Counsel stating that the execution of such supplemental indenture is authorized
or permitted by this Indenture.

                 SECTION 904.  Effect of Supplemental Indentures.

                 Upon the execution of any supplemental indenture under this
Article, this Indenture shall be modified in accordance therewith, and such
supplemental indenture shall form a part of this Indenture for all purposes;
and every Holder of Notes theretofore or thereafter authenticated and delivered
hereunder shall be bound thereby (except as provided in Section 902).

                 SECTION 905.  Conformity with Trust Indenture Act.

                 Every supplemental indenture executed pursuant to the Article
shall conform to the requirements of the Trust Indenture Act as then in effect.

                 SECTION 906.  Reference in Notes to Supplemental Indentures.

                 Notes authenticated and delivered after the execution of any
supplemental indenture pursuant to this Article may, and shall if required by
the Trustee, bear a notation in form approved by the Trustee as to any matter
provided for in such supplemental indenture.  If the Company or the Trustee
shall so determine, new Notes so modified as to conform to any such
supplemental indenture may be prepared and executed by the Company, and the
Subsidiary Guarantors and the Company shall issue and the Trustee shall
authenticate a new Note that reflects the changed terms, the cost and expense
of which will be borne by the Company in exchange for Outstanding Notes.

                 SECTION 907.  Notice of Supplemental Indentures.

                 Promptly after the execution by the Company, the Subsidiary
Guarantors and the Trustee of any supplemental indenture pursuant to the
provisions of Section 902, the Company shall give notice thereof to the Holders
of each Outstanding Note affected, in the manner provided for in Section 106,
setting forth in general terms the substance of such supplemental indenture.
The failure to give such notice to all the Holders, or any defect therein, will
not impair or affect the validity of the supplemental indenture.

                  SECTION 908.  Effect on Senior Indebtedness.

                 No supplemental indenture shall adversely affect the rights of
any holders of Senior Indebtedness under Article Thirteen unless the requisite
holders of each issue of Senior Indebtedness affected thereby shall have
consented to such supplemental indenture.


<PAGE>   79
                                                                              79



                            ARTICLE TEN.  COVENANTS
1000.

                 SECTION 1001.  Payment of Principal, Premium, if any, and
Interest.

                 The Company covenants and agrees for the benefit of the
Holders that it will duly and punctually pay the principal of (and premium, if
any) and interest on the Notes in accordance with the terms of the Notes and
this Indenture.

                 SECTION 1002.  Maintenance of Office or Agency.

                 The Company will maintain in The City of New York, an office
or agency where the Notes may be presented or surrendered for payment, where,
if applicable, the Notes may be surrendered for registration of transfer or
exchange and where notices and demands to or upon the Company in respect of the
Notes and this Indenture may be served.  The Corporate Trust Office of the
Trustee shall be such office or agency of the Company, unless the Company shall
designate and maintain some other office or agency for one or more of such
purposes.  The Company will give prompt written notice to the Trustee of any
change in the location of any such office or agency.  If at any time the
Company shall fail to maintain any such required office or agency or shall fail
to furnish the Trustee with the address thereof, such presentations,
surrenders, notices and demands may be made or served at the Corporate Trust
Office of the Trustee, and the Company hereby appoints the Trustee as its agent
to receive all such presentations, surrenders, notices and demands.

                 The Company may also from time to time designate one or more
other offices or agencies (in or outside of The City of New York) where the
Notes may be presented or surrendered for any or all such purposes and may from
time to time rescind any such designation; provided, however, that no such
designation or rescission shall in any manner relieve the Company of its
obligation to maintain an office or agency in The City of New York for such
purposes.  The Company will give prompt written notice to the Trustee of any
such designation or rescission and any change in the location of any such other
office or agency.

                 SECTION 1003.  Money for Note Payments to Be Held in Trust.

                 If the Company shall at any time act as its own Paying Agent,
it will, on or before each due date of the principal of (or premium, if any) or
interest on any of the Notes, segregate and hold in trust for the benefit of
the Persons entitled thereto a sum sufficient to pay the principal of (or
premium, if any) or interest so becoming due until such sums shall be paid to
such Persons or otherwise disposed of as herein provided and will promptly
notify the Trustee of its action or failure to so act.

                 Whenever the Company shall have one or more Paying Agents for
the Notes, it will, on or before each due date of the principal of (or premium,
if any) or interest on any Notes, deposit with a Paying Agent a sum in same day
funds (or New York Clearing House funds if such deposit is made prior to the
date on which such deposit is required to be made) that shall be available to
the Trustee by 11:00 a.m. Eastern Standard Time on such due date sufficient to
pay the principal (and premium, if any) or interest so becoming due, such sum
to be held in trust for the benefit of the Persons entitled to such principal,
premium or interest, and (unless such Paying Agent is the Trustee) the Company
will promptly notify the Trustee of such action or any failure to so act.

                 The Company will cause each Paying Agent (other than the
Trustee) to execute and deliver to the Trustee an instrument in which such
Paying Agent shall agree with the Trustee, subject to the provisions of this
Section, that such Paying Agent will:

                    (i)   hold all sums held by it for the payment of the
         principal of (and premium, if any) or interest on Notes in trust for
         the benefit of the Persons entitled thereto until such sums shall be
         paid to such Persons or otherwise disposed of as herein provided;


<PAGE>   80
                                                                              80



                    (ii)  give the Trustee notice of any default by the Company
         (or any other obligor upon the Notes) in the making of any payment of
         principal (and premium, if any) or interest; and

                   (iii)  at any time during the continuance of any such
         default, upon the written request of the Trustee, forthwith pay to the
         Trustee all sums so held in trust by such Paying Agent.

                 The Company may at any time, for the purpose of obtaining the
satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture or for any other purpose, pay, or
by Company Order direct any Paying Agent to pay, to the Trustee all sums held
in trust by the Company or such Paying Agent, such sums to be held by the
Trustee upon the same trusts as those upon which such sums were held by the
Company or such Paying Agent; and, upon such payment by any Paying Agent to the
Trustee, such Paying Agent shall be released from all further liability with
respect to such sums.

                 Any money deposited with the Trustee or any Paying Agent, or
then held by the Company, in trust for the payment of the principal of (or
premium, if any) or interest on any Note and remaining unclaimed for two years
after such principal, premium or interest has become due and payable shall be
paid to the Company on Company Request, or (if then held by the Company) shall
be discharged from such trust; and the Holder of such Note shall thereafter, as
an unsecured general creditor, look only to the Company for payment thereof,
and all liability of the Trustee or such Paying Agent with respect to such
trust money, and all liability of the Company as trustee thereof, shall
thereupon cease; provided, however, that the Trustee or such Paying Agent,
before being required to make any such repayment to the Company, may at the
expense of the Company cause to be published once, in a leading daily newspaper
(if practicable, The Wall Street Journal (Eastern Edition)) printed in the
English language and of general circulation in New York City, notice that such
money remains unclaimed and that, after a date specified therein, which shall
not be less than 30 days from the date of such publication, any unclaimed
balance of such money then remaining will be repaid to the Company.

                 SECTION 1004.  Corporate Existence.

                 Subject to Article Eight, the Company will do or cause to be
done all things necessary to preserve and keep in full force and effect the
corporate existence and that of each Restricted Subsidiary and the corporate
rights (charter and statutory) licenses and franchises of the Company and each
Restricted Subsidiary; provided, however, that the Company shall not be
required to preserve any such existence (except the Company) right, license or
franchise if the Board of Directors of the Company shall determine that the
preservation thereof is no longer desirable in the conduct of the business of
the Company and each of its Restricted Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, and that
the loss thereof is not, and will not be, disadvantageous in any material
respect to the Holders.

                 SECTION 1005.  Payment of Taxes and Other Claims.

                 The Company will pay or discharge or cause to be paid or
discharged, before the same shall become delinquent, (i) all material taxes,
assessments and governmental charges levied or imposed upon the Company or any
Subsidiary or upon the income, profits or property of the Company or any
Subsidiary and (ii) all lawful claims for labor, materials and supplies, which,
if unpaid, might by law become a material liability or lien upon the property
of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary; provided, however, that the
Company shall not be required to pay or discharge or cause to be paid or
discharged any such tax, assessment, charge or claim whose amount,
applicability or validity is being contested in good faith by appropriate
proceedings and for which appropriate reserves, if necessary (in the good faith
judgment of management of the Company) are being maintained in accordance with
GAAP.
<PAGE>   81
                                                                              81


                 SECTION 1006.  Maintenance of Properties.

                 The Company will cause all material properties owned by the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary or used or held for use in the conduct of
its business or the business of any Restricted Subsidiary to be maintained and
kept in normal condition, repair and working order and will cause to be made
all necessary repairs, renewals, replacements, betterments and improvements
thereof, all as in the judgment of the Company may be necessary so that the
business carried on in connection therewith may be properly conducted at all
times; provided, however, that nothing in this Section shall prevent the
Company or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries from discontinuing the
maintenance of any of such properties if such discontinuance is, in the
judgment of the Company, desirable in the conduct of its business or the
business of any Restricted Subsidiary and not adverse in any material respect
to the Holders.

                 SECTION 1007.  Insurance.

                 To the extent available at commercially reasonable rates, the
Company will maintain, and will cause its Restricted Subsidiaries to maintain,
insurance with responsible carriers against such risks and in such amounts, and
with such deductibles, retentions, self-insured amounts and co-insurance
provisions, as are customarily carried by similar businesses, of similar size
in their country of organization, including professional and general liability,
property and casualty loss, workers' compensation and interruption of business
insurance.  In the event the Company determines that insurance satisfying the
first sentence of this Section 1007 is not available at commercially available
rates, it shall provide an Officers' Certificate to such effect to the Trustee
and the Trustee may conclusively rely on the determinations set forth therein.

                 SECTION 1008.  Compliance with Laws.

                 The Company shall comply, and shall cause each of its
Restricted Subsidiaries to comply, with all applicable statutes, rules,
regulations, orders and restrictions of the United States of America, all
states and municipalities thereof, and of any governmental regulatory
authority, in respect of the conduct of their respective businesses and the
ownership of their respective properties, except for such noncompliances as
would not in the aggregate have a material adverse effect on the financial
condition or results of operations of the Company and its Restricted
Subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

                 SECTION 1009.  Limitation on Restricted Payments.

                 (a)      The Company shall not, and shall not permit any
Restricted Subsidiary, directly or indirectly, to (i) declare or pay any
dividend or make any distribution on or in respect of its Capital Stock
(including any payment to its stockholders in connection with any merger or
consolidation involving the Company) except (A) dividends or distributions
payable solely in its Capital Stock (other than Disqualified Stock) and (B)
dividends or distributions payable to the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
(and, if such Restricted Subsidiary is not a Wholly Owned Subsidiary, to its
other shareholders on no more than a pro rata basis, measured by value), (ii)
purchase, redeem, retire or otherwise acquire for value any Capital Stock of
the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary held by Persons other than the Company
or another Restricted Subsidiary, (iii) purchase, repurchase, redeem, defease
or otherwise acquire or retire for value, prior to scheduled maturity,
scheduled repayment or scheduled sinking fund payment, any Subordinated
Obligations (other than the purchase, repurchase, redemption or other
acquisition of Subordinated Obligations in anticipation of satisfying a sinking
fund obligation, principal installment or final maturity, in each case due
within one year of the date of acquisition) or (iv) make any Investment (other
than a Permitted Investment) in any Person (any such dividend, distribution,
purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance, other acquisition, retirement or
Investment being herein referred to as a "Restricted Payment") if at the time
the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary makes such Restricted Payment:  (A) a
Default shall have occurred and be continuing (or would result therefrom); (B)
the Company could not incur at least an additional $1.00 of Indebtedness under
paragraph (a) of the covenant contained in Section 1010; or (C) the aggregate
amount of such Restricted Payment and all other Restricted Payments (the amount
so expended, if other

<PAGE>   82
                                                                              82


than in cash, to be determined in good faith by the Company's Board of
Directors, whose determination shall be conclusive and evidenced by a
resolution of the Company's Board of Directors) declared or made subsequent to
the date of this Indenture would exceed the sum of:  (1) 50% of the
Consolidated Net Income accrued during the period (treated as one accounting
period) from the end of the most recent fiscal quarter ending prior to the
Issue Date to the end of the most recent fiscal quarter ending prior to the
date of such Restricted Payment for which consolidated financial statements of
the Company are available (or, in case such Consolidated Net Income shall be a
deficit, minus 100% of such deficit); (2) the aggregate Net Cash Proceeds
received by the Company from the issuance or sale of its Capital Stock (other
than Disqualified Stock) subsequent to the Issue Date (other than an issuance
or sale to a Restricted Subsidiary of the Company); provided that in the event
such issuance or sale is to an employee stock ownership plan or other trust
established by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries for the benefit of their
employees, to the extent the purchase by such plan or trust is financed by
Indebtedness of such plan or trust and for which the Company is liable as a
guarantor or otherwise, such aggregate amount of Net Cash Proceeds shall be
limited to the aggregate amount of principal payments made by such plan or
trust with respect to such Indebtedness); and (3) in the case of the
disposition or repayment of any Investment constituting a Restricted Payment
(without duplication of any amount deducted in calculating the amount of
Investments at any time outstanding included in the amount of Restricted
Payments), an amount equal to the lesser of (x) the return of capital or
similar repayment with respect to such Investment and (y) the initial amount of
such Investment, in either case, less the cost of the disposition of such
Investment.

                 (b)      The provisions of the foregoing paragraph (a) will
not prohibit:  (i) any purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance, retirement
or other acquisition of Capital Stock of the Company or Subordinated
Obligations made by exchange (including any such exchange pursuant to the
exercise of a conversion right or privilege in connection with which cash is
paid in lieu of the issuance of fractional shares) for, or out of the proceeds
of the substantially concurrent sale of, Capital Stock of the Company (other
than Disqualified Stock and other than Capital Stock issued or sold to a
Subsidiary or an employee stock ownership plan or other trust established by
the Company or any of its Subsidiaries); provided, however, that (A) such
purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance, retirement or other acquisition
shall be excluded in subsequent calculations of the amount of Restricted
Payments and (B) the Net Cash Proceeds or reduction of Indebtedness from such
sale shall be excluded in calculations under clauses (B) and (C) of the
previous paragraph; (ii) any purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance,
retirement or other acquisition of Subordinated Obligations made by exchange
for, or out of the proceeds of the substantially concurrent sale of,
Subordinated Obligations of the Company that is permitted to be Incurred
pursuant to the covenant contained in Section 1010; provided, however, that
such purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance, retirement or other
acquisition shall be excluded in subsequent calculations of the amount of
Restricted Payments; (iii) any purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance,
retirement or other acquisition of Subordinated Obligations from Net Available
Cash to the extent permitted by the covenant contained in Section 1017;
provided, however, that such purchase, redemption, repurchase, defeasance,
retirement or other acquisition shall be excluded in subsequent calculations of
the amount of Restricted Payments; (iv) dividends paid within 60 days after the
date of declaration thereof if at such date of declaration such dividend would
have complied with paragraph (a); provided, however, that such dividend shall
be included in subsequent calculations of the amount of Restricted Payments;
(v) any purchase or redemption of any shares of Capital Stock of the Company
from employees of the Company and its Subsidiaries pursuant to the repurchase
provisions under employee stock option or stock purchase agreements or other
agreements to compensate management employees in an aggregate amount after the
date of this Indenture not in excess of $2.5 million in any fiscal year, plus
any unused amounts under this clause (v) from prior fiscal years; provided,
however, that such purchases or redemptions shall be excluded in subsequent
calculations of the amount of Restricted Payments; or (vi) the repurchase of
the Company's common stock in an aggregate amount not to exceed the amount by
which the proceeds from the issuance of the Convertible Preferred Stock exceeds
$235 million; provided, however, the aggregate amount of repurchases pursuant
to this clause (vi) shall not exceed $25 million.

                 (c)      Not later than the date of making any Restricted
Payment, the Company shall deliver to the Trustee an Officers' Certificate
stating that such Restricted Payment is permitted and

<PAGE>   83
                                                                              83


setting forth the basis upon which the calculations required by this Section
1009 were computed, which calculations may be based upon the Company's latest
available financial statements.  The Trustee shall have no duty to recompute or
recalculate or verify the accuracy of the information set forth in such
Officers' Certificate.

                 (d)      The Company will not permit any Unrestricted
Subsidiary to become a Restricted Subsidiary except pursuant to the second to
last sentence of the definition of "Unrestricted Subsidiary."

                 SECTION 1010.  Limitation on Indebtedness.

                 (a)      The Company shall not, and shall not permit any
Restricted Subsidiary to, Incur any Indebtedness; provided, however, that the
Company and any Restricted Subsidiary which is a Subsidiary Guarantor may Incur
Indebtedness if on the date of the Incurrence of such Indebtedness the
Consolidated Coverage Ratio would be greater than (i) 2.25 to 1.00, if such
Indebtedness is Incurred on or prior to the second anniversary of the Issue
Date and (ii) 2.50 to 1.00 if such Indebtedness is Incurred thereafter.

                 (b)      Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraph (a), the
Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries may Incur the following Indebtedness:
(i) Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to the Senior Credit Facility (or any
refinancing thereof) in a maximum principal amount not to exceed $962.25
million; (ii) the Subsidiary Guarantees and Guarantees of Indebtedness incurred
pursuant to paragraph (a) or clause (i) of this paragraph (b); (iii)
Indebtedness (A) of the Company to any Restricted Subsidiary and (B) of any
Wholly Owned Subsidiary to the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary; provided,
however, that any subsequent issuance or transfer of any Capital Stock or any
other event that results in any such Wholly Owned Subsidiary ceasing to be a
Wholly Owned Subsidiary or any other subsequent transfer of any such
Indebtedness (except to the Company or a Wholly Owned Subsidiary) will be
deemed, in each case, an Incurrence of Indebtedness by the Company or such
Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be, in the amount that remains
outstanding following such issuance or transfer of such securities; (iv)
Indebtedness represented by the Notes, any Indebtedness (other than the
Indebtedness described in clauses (i), (ii) or (iii) above) outstanding on the
date of this Indenture and any Refinancing Indebtedness Incurred in respect of
any Indebtedness described in this clause (iv) or the previous paragraph; (v)
Indebtedness of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary in the form of
Capitalized Lease Obligations, Purchase Money Obligations or Attributable Debt,
and any Refinancing Indebtedness with respect thereto, in an aggregate amount
not in excess of 2.5% of Consolidated Tangible Assets at any one time
outstanding; (vi) Indebtedness under Hedging Obligations; provided, however,
that such Hedging Obligations are entered into for bona fide hedging purposes
of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary and are in the ordinary course of
business or are required by the Senior Credit Facility; (vii) Indebtedness
evidenced by letters of credit assumed in the Transactions or issued in the
ordinary course of business of the Company to secure workers' compensation and
other insurance coverages; (viii) Guarantees of the Company in respect of
Indebtedness of franchisees not to exceed $50 million at any one time
outstanding; and (ix) Indebtedness (which may comprise Bank Indebtedness) in an
aggregate principal amount at any one time outstanding not in excess of $25.0
million.

                 (c)      Notwithstanding the foregoing, neither the Company
nor any Restricted Subsidiary shall Incur any Indebtedness pursuant to the
foregoing paragraph that permits Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of
Indebtedness constituting Subordinated Obligations if the proceeds of such
Refinancing Indebtedness are used, directly or indirectly, to Refinance such
Subordinated Obligations, unless such Refinancing Indebtedness will be
subordinated to the Notes at least to the same extent as such Subordinated
Obligations.  No Subsidiary Guarantor will Incur any Indebtedness pursuant to
the foregoing paragraph that permits Refinancing Indebtedness in respect of
Indebtedness constituting Guarantor Subordinated Obligations if the proceeds of
such Refinancing Indebtedness are used, directly or indirectly, to Refinance
such Guarantor Subordinated Obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor unless
such Refinancing Indebtedness will be subordinated to the obligations of such
Subsidiary Guarantor under its Subsidiary Guarantee to at least the same extent
as such Guarantor Subordinated Obligations.

<PAGE>   84
                                                                              84



                 (d)      For purposes of determining compliance with, and the
outstanding principal amount of any particular Indebtedness Incurred pursuant
to and in compliance with, this covenant, (i) in the event that Indebtedness
meets the criteria of more than one of the types of Indebtedness described in
paragraph (b) of this Section, the Company, in its sole discretion, shall
classify such item of Indebtedness and only be required to include the amount
and type of such Indebtedness in one of such clauses; and (ii) the amount of
Indebtedness issued at a price that is less than the principal amount thereof
shall be equal to the amount of the liability in respect thereof determined in
accordance with GAAP.

                 (e)      The Company will not permit any Unrestricted
Subsidiary to Incur any Indebtedness other than Non-Recourse Debt; provided,
however, if any such Indebtedness ceases to be Non-Recourse Debt, such event
shall be deemed to constitute an incurrence of Indebtedness by the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary.

                 SECTION 1011.  Limitation on Layering.

                 The Company shall not incur any Indebtedness that is expressly
subordinate in right of payment to any Senior Indebtedness unless such
Indebtedness is Senior Subordinated Indebtedness or is contractually
subordinated in right of payment to Senior Subordinated Indebtedness. No
Subsidiary Guarantor will incur any Indebtedness that is expressly subordinate
in right of payment to any Guarantor Senior Indebtedness of such Subsidiary
Guarantor unless such Indebtedness is Guarantor Senior Subordinated
Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor or is contractually subordinated in
right of payment to Guarantor Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of such
Subsidiary Guarantor.  Unsecured Indebtedness is not deemed to be subordinate
or junior to Secured Indebtedness merely because it is unsecured, and
Indebtedness that is not guaranteed by a particular Person is not deemed to be
subordinate or junior to Indebtedness that is so guaranteed merely because it
is not so guaranteed.

                 SECTION 1012.  Limitation on Affiliate Transactions.

                 (a)      The Company will not, and will not permit any
Restricted Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, enter into or conduct any
transaction or series of transactions (including the purchase, sale, lease or
exchange of any property or the rendering of any service with any Affiliate of
the Company (an "Affiliate Transaction") on terms (i) that taken as a whole are
less favorable to the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may
be, than those that could be obtained at the time of such transaction in arm's-
length dealings with a Person who is not such an Affiliate and (ii) that, in
the event such Affiliate Transaction involves an aggregate amount in excess of
$10.0 million, are not in writing and have not been approved by a majority of
the members of the Board of Directors having no material personal financial
interest in such Affiliate Transaction or, in the event there are no such
members, as to which the Company has not obtained a Fairness Opinion (as
hereinafter defined).  In addition, any transaction involving aggregate
payments or other transfers by the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries in
excess of $20.0 million will also require an opinion (a "Fairness Opinion")
from an independent investment banking firm or appraiser, as appropriate, of
national prominence, to the effect that the terms of such transaction are fair
to the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be, from a
financial point of view.

                 (b)  The provisions of the foregoing paragraph (a) shall not
prohibit (i) any Restricted Payment permitted by Section 1009, or any Permitted
Investment, (ii) the performance of the Company's or Restricted Subsidiary's
obligations under any employment contract, collective bargaining agreement,
agreement for the provision of services, employee benefit plan, related trust
agreement or any other similar arrangement heretofore or hereafter entered into
in the ordinary course of business, (iii) payment of compensation, performance
of indemnification or contribution obligations, or any issuance, grant or award
of stock, options or other securities, to employees, officers or directors in
the ordinary course of business, (iv) any transaction between the Company and a
Restricted Subsidiary or between Restricted Subsidiaries, (v) the Transactions
and the incurrence and payment of all fees and expenses payable in connection
therewith as described in or contemplated by the Offering Memorandum, (vi) any
other transaction arising out of agreements in existence on the Issue Date and
(vii) transactions with suppliers

<PAGE>   85
                                                                              85



or other purchasers or sellers of goods or services, in each case in the
ordinary course of business and on terms no less favorable to the Company or
the Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be, than those that could be
obtained at such time in arm's-length dealings with a Person which is not an
Affiliate.

                 SECTION 1013.  Limitation on Restrictions on Distributions
from Restricted Subsidiaries.

                 The Company will not, and will not permit any Restricted
Subsidiary to, create or otherwise cause or permit to exist or become effective
any consensual encumbrance or restriction on the ability of any Restricted
Subsidiary to (i) pay dividends or make any other distributions on its Capital
Stock or pay any Indebtedness or other obligations owed to the Company, (ii)
make any loans or advances to the Company or (iii) transfer any of its property
or assets to the Company, except (A) any encumbrance or restriction pursuant to
an agreement in effect at or entered into on the date of this Indenture
(including, without limitation, the Senior Credit Facility); (B) any
encumbrance or restriction with respect to a Restricted Subsidiary (1) pursuant
to an agreement relating to any Indebtedness Incurred by a Restricted
Subsidiary prior to the date on which such Restricted Subsidiary was acquired
by the Company, or of another Person that is assumed by the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary in connection with the acquisition of assets from, or
merger or consolidation with, such Person (other than Indebtedness Incurred as
consideration in, or to provide all or any portion of the funds or credit
support utilized to consummate, the transaction or series of related
transactions pursuant to which such Restricted Subsidiary became a Restricted
Subsidiary or was acquired by the Company, or such acquisition of assets,
merger or consolidation) and outstanding on the date of such acquisition,
merger or consolidation or (2) pursuant to any agreement (not relating to any
Indebtedness) in existence when a Person becomes a Subsidiary of the Company or
when such agreement is acquired by the Company or any Subsidiary thereof, that
is not created in contemplation of such Person becoming such a Subsidiary or
such acquisition (for purposes of this clause (B), if another Person is the
Successor Company, any Subsidiary or agreement thereof shall be deemed acquired
or assumed, as the case may be, by the Company when such Person becomes the
Successor Company); (C) any encumbrance or restriction with respect to a
Restricted Subsidiary pursuant to an agreement (a "Refinancing Agreement")
effecting a refinancing of Indebtedness Incurred pursuant to, or that otherwise
extends, renews, refinances or replaces, an agreement referred to in clause (A)
or (B) of this covenant or this clause (C) or contained in any amendment to an
agreement referred to in clause (A) or (B) of this covenant or this clause (C)
(an "Initial Agreement") or contained in any amendment to an Initial Agreement;
provided, however, that the encumbrances and restrictions contained in any such
Refinancing Agreement or amendment are no less favorable to the Holders of the
Notes taken as a whole than encumbrances and restrictions contained in the
Initial Agreement or Agreements to which such Refinancing Agreement or
amendment relates; (D) any encumbrance or restriction (1) that restricts in a
customary manner the subletting, assignment or transfer of any property or
asset that is subject to a lease, license or similar contract, or the
assignment or transfer of any lease, license or other contract, (2) by virtue
of any transfer of, agreement to transfer, option or right with respect to, or
Lien on, any property or assets of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary not
otherwise prohibited by this Indenture, (3) contained in mortgages, pledges or
other security agreements securing Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary to
the extent such encumbrance or restrictions restrict the transfer of the
property subject to such mortgages, pledges or other security agreements or (4)
pursuant to customary provisions restricting dispositions of real property
interests set forth in any reciprocal easement agreements of the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary; (E) any restriction with respect to a Restricted
Subsidiary (or any of its property or assets) imposed pursuant to an agreement
entered into for the direct or indirect sale or disposition of all or
substantially all the Capital Stock or assets of such Restricted Subsidiary (or
the property or assets that are subject to such restriction) pending the
closing of such sale or disposition; and (F) any encumbrance or restriction on
the transfer of property or assets required by any regulatory authority having
jurisdiction over the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary or any of their
businesses.

                 SECTION 1014.  Limitation on Sale or Issuance of Preferred
Stock of Restricted Subsidiaries.

<PAGE>   86
                                                                              86



                 The Company shall not sell any shares of Preferred Stock of a
Restricted Subsidiary, and shall not permit any Restricted Subsidiary, directly
or indirectly, to issue or sell any shares of its Preferred Stock to any Person
(other than to the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary).

                 SECTION 1015.  Limitation on Liens.

                 The Company shall not, and shall not permit any Restricted
Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, create or permit to exist any Lien
(other than Permitted Liens) on any of its property or assets (including
Capital Stock), whether owned on the date of this Indenture or thereafter
acquired, securing any Indebtedness that is not Senior Indebtedness (the
"Initial Lien"), unless contemporaneously therewith effective provision is made
to secure the obligations due under this Indenture and the Notes or, in respect
of Liens on any Restricted Subsidiary's property or assets, equally and ratably
with such obligation for so long as such obligation is secured by such Initial
Lien.  Any such Lien thereby created in favor of the Notes will be
automatically and unconditionally released and discharged upon (i) the release
and discharge of the Initial Lien to which it relates, or (ii) any sale,
exchange or transfer to any Person not an Affiliate of the Company of the
property or assets secured by such Initial Lien, or of all of the Capital Stock
held by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary in, or all or substantially
all the assets of, any Restricted Subsidiary creating such Lien.

                 SECTION 1016.  Change of Control.

                 (a)      Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, each
Holder will have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or any part
of such Holder's Notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the
principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date
of repurchase (subject to the right of Holders of record on the relevant record
date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date) (the
"Change of Control Offer"); provided, however, that notwithstanding the
occurrence of a Change of Control, the Company shall not be obligated to
purchase the Notes pursuant to this covenant in the event that it has exercised
its right to redeem all of the Notes pursuant to Section 1101.

                 (b)      Within 30 days following any Change of Control (or at
the Company's option, prior to such Change of Control but after the public
announcement thereof), unless the Company has mailed a redemption notice in
connection with such Change of Control as described in Section 1105, the
Company shall mail a notice to each holder with a copy to the Trustee stating:

                     (i)  that a Change of Control has occurred or will occur
         and that such Holder has (or upon such occurrence will have) the right
         to require the Company to purchase such Holder's Notes at a purchase
         price in cash equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof, plus
         accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of purchase (subject
         to the right of Holders of record on a record date to receive interest
         on the relevant interest payment date);

                    (ii)  the circumstances and relevant facts and financial
         information regarding such Change of Control;

                   (iii)  the date of purchase (which shall be no earlier than
         30 days nor later than 90 days from the date such notice is mailed);

                    (iv)  the instructions determined by the Company,
         consistent with this covenant, that a Holder must follow in order to
         have its Notes purchased; and

                     (v)  that, if such offer is made prior to such Change of
         Control, payment is conditioned on the occurrence of such Change of
         Control.

                 (c)      The Company will comply, to the extent applicable,
with the requirements of Section 14(e) of the Exchange Act and any other
securities laws or regulations in connection with the

<PAGE>   87
                                                                              87



repurchase of Notes pursuant to this covenant. To the extent that the
provisions of any securities laws or regulations conflict with provisions of
this Indenture, the Company will comply with the applicable securities laws and
regulations and shall not be deemed to have breached its obligations described
in this Indenture by virtue thereof.

                 SECTION 1017.  Limitation on Sales of Assets.

                 (a)      The Company will not, and will not permit any
Restricted Subsidiary to, make any Asset Disposition unless the Company or such
Restricted Subsidiary receives consideration (including by way of relief from,
or by any other Person assuming sole responsibility for, any liabilities,
contingent or otherwise) at the time of such Asset Disposition at least equal
to the fair market value of the shares and assets subject to such Asset
Disposition of such fair market value shall be determined in good faith by the
Board of Directors, whose determination shall be conclusive (including as to
the value of all non-cash consideration), (ii) at least 75% of the
consideration therefor (excluding, in the case of an Asset Disposition of
assets, any consideration by way of relief from, or by any other person
assuming responsibility for, any liabilities, contingent or otherwise, which
are not Indebtedness) received by the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary is
in the form of cash and (iii) an amount equal to 100% of the Net Available Cash
from such Asset Disposition is applied by the Company (or such Restricted
Subsidiary, as the case may be) (A) first, to the extent the Company elects (or
is required by the terms of any Senior Indebtedness or Indebtedness (other than
Preferred Stock) of a Restricted Subsidiary), to prepay, repay or purchase
Senior Indebtedness or such Indebtedness of a Restricted Subsidiary (in each
case other than Indebtedness owed to the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary of
the Company) within 365 days after the date of such Asset Disposition; (B)
second, to the extent of the balance of Net Available Cash after application in
accordance with clause (A), to the extent the Company or such Restricted
Subsidiary elects, to reinvest in Additional Assets (including by means of an
Investment in Additional Assets by a Restricted Subsidiary with Net Available
Cash received by the Company or another Restricted Subsidiary) within 365 days
from the date of such Asset Disposition or, if such reinvestment in Additional
Assets is a project authorized by the Board of Directors that will take longer
than 365 days to complete, the period of time necessary to complete such
project; (C) third, to the extent of the balance of such Net Available Cash
after application in accordance with clauses (A) and (B) (such balance, the
"Excess Proceeds"), to make an offer to purchase Notes at a price in cash equal
to 100% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if
any, to the purchase date, and (to the extent required by the terms thereof)
any other Senior Subordinated Indebtedness pursuant and subject to the
conditions of the agreements governing such other Indebtedness at a purchase
price of 100% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest
to the purchase date and (D) fourth, to the extent of the balance of such
Excess Proceeds after application in accordance with clauses (A), (B) and (C)
above, to fund (to the extent consistent with any other applicable provision of
this Indenture) any general corporate purpose (including the repayment of
Subordinated Obligations); provided, however, that in connection with any
prepayment, repayment or purchase of Indebtedness pursuant to clause (A) or (C)
above, the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary will retire such Indebtedness
and will cause the related loan commitment (if any) to be permanently reduced
in an amount equal to the principal amount so prepaid, repaid or purchased.
Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this covenant, the Company and the
Restricted Subsidiaries shall not be required to apply any Net Available Cash
in accordance with this covenant except to the extent that the aggregate Net
Available Cash from all Asset Dispositions that is not applied in accordance
with this covenant exceeds $10.0 million.

                 To the extent that the aggregate principal amount of the Notes
and other Senior Subordinated Indebtedness tendered pursuant to an offer to
purchase made in accordance with clause (C) above exceeds the amount of Excess
Proceeds, the Trustee shall select the Notes and Senior Subordinated
Indebtedness to be purchased on a pro rata basis, based on the aggregate
principal amount thereof surrendered in such offer to purchase.  Upon
completion of such offer to purchase, the amount of Excess Proceeds shall be
reset to zero.

                 For the purposes of this covenant, the following are deemed to
be cash:  (v) Cash Equivalents, (w) the assumption of Indebtedness of the
Company (other than Disqualified Stock of the

<PAGE>   88
                                                                              88



Company) or any Restricted Subsidiary and the release of the Company or such
Restricted Subsidiary from all liability on such Indebtedness in connection
with such Asset Disposition, (x) Indebtedness of any Restricted Subsidiary that
is no longer a Restricted Subsidiary as a result of such Asset Disposition, to
the extent that the Company and each other Restricted Subsidiary is released
from any Guarantee (or is the beneficiary of any indemnity with respect thereto
which is secured by any letter of credit or cash equivalents) of such
Indebtedness in connection with such Asset Disposition, (y) securities received
by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary from the transferee that are
promptly converted by the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary into cash, and
(z) consideration consisting of Indebtedness of the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary.

                 (b)      The Company will comply, to the extent applicable,
with the requirements of Section 14(e) of the Exchange Act and any other
securities laws or regulations in connection with the repurchase of Notes
pursuant to this covenant.  To the extent that the provisions of any securities
laws or regulations conflict with provisions of this covenant, the Company will
comply with the applicable securities laws and regulations and will not be
deemed to have breached its obligations under this covenant by virtue thereof.

                 SECTION 1018.  Statement by Officers as to Default.

                 (a)      The Company will deliver to the Trustee, within 120
days after the end of each fiscal year, an Officers' Certificate stating that a
review of the activities of the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries during
the preceding fiscal year has been made under the supervision of the signing
officers with a view to determining whether it has kept, observed, performed
and fulfilled, and has caused each of its Restricted Subsidiaries to keep,
observe, perform and fulfill its obligations under this Indenture and further
stating, as to each such officer signing such certificate, that, to the best of
his or her knowledge, the Company during such preceding fiscal year has kept,
observed, performed and fulfilled, and has caused each of its Restricted
Subsidiaries to keep, observe, perform and fulfill, each and every such
covenant contained in this Indenture and no Default or Event of Default
occurred during such year and at the date of such certificate there is no
Default or Event of Default which has occurred and is continuing or, if such
signers do know of such Default or Event of Default, the certificate shall
describe its status, with particularity and that, to the best of his or her
knowledge, no event has occurred and remains by reason of which payments on the
account of the principal of or interest, if any, on the Notes is prohibited or
if such event has occurred, a description of the event and what action each is
taking or proposes to take with respect thereto.  The Officers' Certificate
shall also notify the Trustee should the Company elect to change the manner in
which it fixes its fiscal year end.  For purposes of this Section 1018(a), such
compliance shall be determined without regard to any period of grace or
requirement of notice under this Indenture.

                 (b)      When any Default has occurred and is continuing under
this Indenture, or if the trustee for or the holder of any other evidence of
Indebtedness of the Company or any Significant Subsidiary gives any notice or
takes any other action with respect to a claimed default (other than with
respect to Indebtedness in the principal amount of less than $20 million), the
Company shall deliver to the Trustee by registered or certified mail or
facsimile transmission an Officers' Certificate specifying such event, notice
or other action within five Business Days of its occurrence.

                 SECTION 1019.  Reporting Requirements.

                 As long as any of the Notes is outstanding, the Company will
file with the Commission (unless the Commission will not accept such a filing)
the annual reports, quarterly reports and other documents required to be filed
with the Commission pursuant to Sections 13 and 15 of the Exchange Act, whether
or not the Company is then obligated to file reports pursuant to such sections.
The Company will be required to file with the Trustee and provide to each
holder of Notes within 15 days after filing with the Commission (or if any such
filing is not required under the Exchange Act, 15 days after the Company would
have been required to make such filing) copies of such reports and documents.

<PAGE>   89
                                                                              89



                 SECTION 1020.  Future Subsidiary Guarantors.

                 After the Issue Date, the Company will cause each Restricted
Subsidiary created or acquired by the Company to execute and deliver to the
Trustee a Subsidiary Guarantee pursuant to which such Restricted Subsidiary
will unconditionally Guarantee, on a joint and several basis, the full and
prompt payment of the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes
on a senior unsecured basis.  Such Guarantee shall be in the form of a
supplemental indenture to this Indenture in accordance with Section 901.

                 SECTION 1021.  Designation of Unrestricted Subsidiaries.

                 The Board of Directors of the Company may designate any
Restricted Subsidiary to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary if such designation
would not cause a default.  For purposes of making such determination, all
outstanding Investments by the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries (except
to the extent repaid in cash) in the Subsidiary so designated will be deemed to
be Restricted Payments at the time of such designation and will reduce the
amount available for Restricted Payments under clause (C) of paragraph (a) of
Section 1009.  All such outstanding Investments will be deemed to constitute
Investments in an amount equal to the greater of the fair market value or the
book value of such Subsidiary at the time of such designation.  Such
designation will only be permitted if such Restricted Payment would be
permitted at such time and if such Restricted Subsidiary otherwise meets the
definition of an Unrestricted Subsidiary.

                 SECTION 1022.  Limitation on Sale/Leaseback Transactions.

                 The Company will not, and will not permit any Restricted
Subsidiary to, enter into any Sale/Leaseback Transaction with respect to any
property unless: (i) the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary would be
entitled to Incur Indebtedness in an amount equal to the Attributable Debt with
respect to such Sale/Leaseback Transaction pursuant to Section 1010; (ii) the
net proceeds received by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary in connection
with such Sale/Leaseback Transaction are at least equal to the fair value (as
determined by the Board of Directors) of such property; and (iii) the transfer
of such property is permitted by, and the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary
applies the proceeds of such transaction in compliance with, the covenant
described under Section 1017.


                      ARTICLE ELEVEN.  REDEMPTION OF NOTES
1100.

                 SECTION 1101.  Optional Redemption.

                 The Notes will be redeemable at the Company's option, in whole
or in part, at any time and from time to time on and after August 15, 2003 and
prior to maturity, upon not less than 30 nor more than 90 days' prior notice
mailed by first-class mail to each Holder's registered address, at the
following redemption prices (expressed as a percentage of principal amount),
plus accrued interest, if any, to the redemption date (subject to the right of
Holders of record on the relevant record date to receive interest due on the
relevant interest payment date), if redeemed during the 12-month period
commencing on August 15 of the years set forth below:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   REDEMPTION 
         PERIOD                                      PRICE
         ------                                    ---------- 
         <S>                                       <C>
         2003 . . . . . . . . . . . .              100.000%
         2004 . . . . . . . . . . . .              103.667%
         2005 . . . . . . . . . . . .              101.833%
         2006 and thereafter. . . . .              100.000%
</TABLE>


<PAGE>   90
                                                                              90



                 In addition, at any time and from time to time prior to August
15, 2001, the Company may redeem in the aggregate up to 33.33% of the original
aggregate principal amount of the Notes with the proceeds of one or more Equity
Offerings by the Company at a redemption price (expressed as a percentage of
principal amount thereof) of 111% plus accrued interest, if any, to the
redemption date (subject to the right of Holders of record on the relevant
record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date);
provided, however, that at least 66.67% of the original aggregate principal
amount of the Notes must remain outstanding after each such redemption and that
any such redemption occurs within 90 days following the closing of any such
Equity Offering.

                 SECTION 1102.  Applicability of Article.

                 Redemption of Notes at the election of the Company or
otherwise, as permitted or required by any provision of this Indenture, shall
be made in accordance with such provision and this Article.

                 SECTION 1103.  Election to Redeem; Notice to Trustee.

                 The election of the Company to redeem any Notes pursuant to
Section 1101 shall be evidenced by a Board Resolution.  In case of any
redemption at the election of the Company, the Company shall, at least 90 days
prior to the Redemption Date fixed by the Company (unless a shorter notice
shall be satisfactory to the Trustee), notify the Trustee in writing of such
Redemption Date, the specific provision of the Indenture pursuant to which such
redemption is being made, the Redemption Price and the principal amount of
Notes to be redeemed and shall deliver to the Trustee such documentation and
records as shall enable the Trustee to select the Notes to be redeemed pursuant
to Section 1104.

                 SECTION 1104.  Selection by Trustee of Notes to Be Redeemed.

                 If less than all the Notes are to be redeemed at any time
pursuant to an optional redemption, the particular Notes to be redeemed shall
be selected at least 30 but not more than 90 days prior to the Redemption Date
by the Trustee, from the Outstanding Notes not previously called for
redemption, in compliance with the requirements of the principal securities
exchange, if any, on which such Notes are listed, or, if such Notes are not so
listed, on a pro rata basis, by lot or by such other method as the Trustee
shall deem fair and appropriate (and in such manner as complies with applicable
legal requirements) and which may provide for the selection for redemption of
portions of the principal of the Notes; provided, however, that no Notes of a
principal amount of $1,000 or less shall be redeemed in part.

                 The Trustee shall promptly notify the Company in writing of
the Notes selected for redemption and, in the case of any Notes selected for
partial redemption, the principal amount thereof to be redeemed.

                 For all purposes of this Indenture, unless the context
otherwise requires, all provisions relating to redemption of Notes shall
relate, in the case of any Note redeemed or to be redeemed only in part, to the
portion of the principal amount of such Note which has been or is to be
redeemed.

                 SECTION 1105.  Notice of Redemption.

                 Notice of redemption shall be given in the manner provided for
in Section 106 not less than 30 nor more than 90 days prior to the Redemption
Date, to each Holder of Notes to be redeemed.  The Trustee shall give notice of
redemption in the Company's name and at the Company's expense; provided,
however, that the Company shall deliver to the Trustee, at least 45 days prior
to the Redemption Date, an Officers' Certificate requesting that the Trustee
give such notice and setting forth the information to be stated in such notice
as provided in the following items.

                 All notices of redemption shall state:

<PAGE>   91
                                                                              91


                     (i)  the Redemption Date,

                    (ii)  the Redemption Price and the amount of accrued
         interest to the Redemption Date payable as provided in Section 1107,
         if any,

                   (iii)  if less than all Outstanding Notes are to be
         redeemed, the identification of the particular Notes (or portion
         thereof) to be redeemed, as well as the aggregate principal amount of
         Notes to be redeemed and the aggregate principal amount of Notes to be
         Outstanding after such partial redemption,

                    (iv)  in case any Note is to be redeemed in part only, the
         notice which relates to such Note shall state that on and after the
         Redemption Date, upon surrender of such Note, the holder will receive,
         without charge, a new Note or Notes of authorized denominations for
         the principal amount thereof remaining unredeemed,

                     (v)  that on the Redemption Date the Redemption Price (and
         accrued interest, if any, to the Redemption Date payable as provided
         in Section 1107) will become due and payable upon each such Note, or
         the portion thereof, to be redeemed, and, unless the Company defaults
         in making the redemption payment, that interest on Notes called for
         redemption (or the portion thereof) will cease to accrue on and after
         said date,

                    (vi)  the place or places where such Notes are to be
         surrendered for payment of the Redemption Price and accrued interest,
         if any,

                   (vii)  the name and address of the Paying Agent,

                  (viii)  that Notes called for redemption must be surrendered
         to the Paying Agent to collect the Redemption Price,

                    (ix)  the CUSIP number, and that no representation is made
         as to the accuracy or correctness of the CUSIP number, if any, listed
         in such notice or printed on the Notes, and

                     (x)  the paragraph of the Notes or Section of the
         Indenture pursuant to which the Notes are to be redeemed.

                 SECTION 1106.  Deposit of Redemption Price.

                 Prior to any Redemption Date, the Company shall deposit with
the Trustee or with a Paying Agent (or, if the Company is acting as its own
Paying Agent, segregate and hold in trust as provided in Section 1003) an
amount of money sufficient to pay the Redemption Price of, and accrued interest
on, all the Notes which are to be redeemed on that date.

                 SECTION 1107.  Notes Payable on Redemption Date.

                 Notice of redemption having been given as aforesaid, the Notes
so to be redeemed shall, on the Redemption Date, become due and payable at the
Redemption Price therein specified (together with accrued interest, if any, to
the Redemption Date), and from and after such date (unless the Company shall
default in the payment of the Redemption Price and accrued interest) such Notes
shall cease to bear interest.  Upon surrender of any such Note for redemption
in accordance with said notice, such Note shall be paid by the Company at the
Redemption Price, together with accrued interest, if any, to the Redemption
Date; provided, however, that installments of interest whose Stated Maturity is
on or prior to the Redemption Date shall be payable to the Holders of such
Notes, or one or more Predecessor Notes, registered as such at the close of
business on the relevant Regular Record Date or Special Record Date, as the
case may be, according to their terms and the provisions of Section 311.

<PAGE>   92
                                                                              92



                 If any Note called for redemption shall not be so paid upon
surrender thereof for redemption, the principal (and premium, if any) shall,
until paid, bear interest from the Redemption Date at the rate borne by the
Notes.

                 SECTION 1108.  Notes Redeemed in Part.

                 Any Note which is to be redeemed only in part (pursuant to the
provisions of this Article) shall be surrendered at the office or agency of the
Company maintained for such purpose pursuant to Section 1002 (with, if the
Company or the Trustee so requires, due endorsement by, or a written instrument
of transfer in form satisfactory to the Company and the Trustee duly executed
by, the Holder thereof or such Holder's attorney duly authorized in writing),
and the Company shall execute, and the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver
to the Holder of such Note at the expense of the Company, a new Note or Notes,
of any authorized denomination as requested by such Holder, in an aggregate
principal amount equal to and in exchange for the unredeemed portion of the
principal of the Note so surrendered, provided, that each such new Note will be
in a principal amount of $1,000 or integral multiple thereof.


           ARTICLE TWELVE.  LEGAL DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE
1200.

                 SECTION 1201.  Company's Option to Effect Legal Defeasance or
Covenant Defeasance.

                 The Company may, at its option, at any time, with respect to
the Notes, elect to have either Section 1202 or Section 1203 be applied to all
Outstanding Notes upon compliance with the conditions set forth in this Article
Twelve.

                 SECTION 1202.  Legal Defeasance and Discharge.

                 Upon the Company's exercise under Section 1201 of the option
applicable to this Section 1202, the Company and any Subsidiary Guarantor shall
be deemed to have been discharged from its obligations with respect to all
Outstanding Notes on the date the conditions set forth in Section 1204 are
satisfied (hereinafter, "Legal Defeasance").  For this purpose, such Legal
Defeasance means that the Company and any such Subsidiary Guarantor shall be
deemed to have paid and discharged the entire Indebtedness represented by the
Outstanding Notes, which shall thereafter be deemed to be "Outstanding" only
for the purposes of Section 1205 and the other Sections of this Indenture
referred to in (i) and (ii) below, and to have satisfied all its other
obligations under such Notes and this Indenture insofar as such Notes are
concerned (and the Trustee, at the expense of the Company, shall execute proper
instruments acknowledging the same), except for the following which shall
survive until otherwise terminated or discharged hereunder:  (i) the rights of
Holders of Outstanding Notes to receive, solely from the trust fund described
in Section 1204 and as more fully set forth in such Section, payments in
respect of the principal of (and premium, if any, on) and interest on such
Notes when such payments are due, (ii) the Company's obligations with respect
to such Notes under Sections 304, 305, 310, 1002 and 1003, (iii) the rights,
powers, trusts, duties and immunities of the Trustee hereunder, and the
Company's obligations in connection therewith and (iv) this Article Twelve.

                 If the Company exercises its Legal Defeasance Option, payment
of the Notes may not be accelerated because of an Event of Default.

                 Subject to compliance with this Article Twelve, the Company
may exercise its option under this Section 1202 notwithstanding the prior
exercise of its option under Section 1203 with respect to the Notes.

                 SECTION 1203.  Covenant Defeasance.

                 Upon the Company's exercise under Section 1201 of the option
applicable to this Section 1203, the Company may terminate (i) its obligations
under any covenant contained in

<PAGE>   93
                                                                              93



Sections 1004 through 1022, (ii) the operation of Section 501(vi), Section
501(vii) (with respect only to Significant Subsidiaries), Section 501(viii)
(with respect only to Significant Subsidiaries) and Section 501(ix) and (iii)
the limitations contained in Sections 801(a)(iii) and (iv) with respect to the
Outstanding Notes on and after the date the conditions set forth below are
satisfied (hereinafter, "Covenant Defeasance"), and the Notes shall thereafter
be deemed not to be "Outstanding" for the purposes of any direction, waiver,
consent or declaration or Act of Holders (and the consequences of any thereof)
in connection with such covenants, but shall continue to be deemed
"Outstanding" for all other purposes hereunder (it being understood that such
Notes will not be outstanding for accounting purposes).  If the Company
exercises its covenant defeasance option, payment of the Notes may not be
accelerated because of an Event of Default specified under Section 501(iv),
(vi), (vii) (with respect only to Significant Subsidiaries), (viii) (with
respect only to Significant Subsidiaries) and (ix) or because of the failure of
the Company to comply with Sections 801(a)(iii) and (iv).  For this purpose,
such Covenant Defeasance means that, with respect to the Outstanding Notes, the
Company may omit to comply with and shall have no liability in respect of any
term, condition or limitation set forth in any such covenant, whether directly
or indirectly, by reason of any reference elsewhere herein to any such covenant
or by reason of any reference in any such covenant to any other provision
herein or in any other document and such omission to comply shall not
constitute a Default or an Event of Default under Section 501(iv), but, except
as specified above, the remainder of this Indenture and such Notes shall be
unaffected thereby.

                 SECTION 1204.  Conditions to Legal Defeasance or Covenant
Defeasance.

                 The following shall be the conditions to application of either
Section 1202 or Section 1203 to the Outstanding Notes:

                    (i)   The Company shall irrevocably have deposited or
         caused to be deposited with the Trustee (or another trustee satisfying
         the requirements of this Indenture who shall agree to comply with the
         provisions of this Article Twelve applicable to it) as trust funds,
         money or U.S. Government Obligations, in such amounts as will be
         sufficient, in the opinion of a nationally recognized firm of
         independent public accountants selected by the Company, to pay the
         principal of, premium, if any, and interest due on the Outstanding
         Notes on the Stated Maturity or on the applicable Redemption Date as
         the case may be, of such principal, premium, if any, or interest on
         the Outstanding Notes;

                    (ii)  in the case of Legal Defeasance, the Company shall
         have delivered to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel in the United
         States reasonably acceptable to the Trustee (which opinion may be
         subject to customary assumptions and exclusions) confirming that (A)
         the Company has received from, or there has been published by, the
         United States Internal Revenue Service a ruling or (B) since the Issue
         Date, there has been a change in the applicable U.S. Federal income
         tax law, in either case to the effect that, and based thereon such
         Opinion of Counsel in the United States (which opinion may be subject
         to customary assumptions and exclusions) shall confirm that, the
         Holders of the Outstanding Notes will not recognize income, gain or
         loss for U.S. Federal income tax purposes as a result of such Legal
         Defeasance and will be subject to U.S. Federal income tax on the same
         amounts, in the same manner and at the same times  as would have been
         the case if such Legal Defeasance had not occurred;

                   (iii)  in the case of Covenant Defeasance, the Company shall
         have delivered to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel in the United
         States reasonably acceptable to the Trustee confirming that, subject
         to customary assumptions and exclusions, the Holders of the
         Outstanding Notes will not recognize income, gain or loss for U.S.
         Federal income tax purposes as a result of such Covenant Defeasance
         and will be subject to such tax on the same amounts, in the same
         manner and at the same times as would have been the case if such
         Covenant Defeasance had not occurred;

                    (iv)  no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred
         and be continuing on the date of such deposit or insofar as Events of
         Default from bankruptcy or insolvency events are concerned, at any
         time in the period ending on the 123rd day after the date of deposit;

<PAGE>   94
                                                                              94


                     (v)  such Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance shall
         not result in a breach or violation of, or constitute a default under,
         any material agreement or instrument (other than this Indenture) to
         which the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor is a party or by which
         the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor is bound;

                    (vi)  the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee an
         Opinion of Counsel to the effect that, as of the date of such opinion
         and subject to customary assumptions and exclusions following the
         deposit, the trust funds will not be subject to the effect of any
         applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or similar laws
         affecting  creditors' rights generally under any applicable U.S.
         Federal or state law, and that the Trustee has a perfected security
         interest in such trust funds for the ratable benefit of the Holders;

                   (vii)  the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee an
         Officers' Certificate stating that the deposit was not made by the
         Company with the intent of defeating, hindering, delaying or
         defrauding any creditors of the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor or
         others;

                  (viii)  the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee an
         Officers' Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel in the United States
         (which Opinion of Counsel may be subject to customary assumptions and
         exclusions) each stating that all conditions precedent provided for or
         relating to the Legal Defeasance or the Covenant Defeasance, as the
         case may be, have been complied with; and

                    (ix)  the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee the
         opinion of a nationally recognized firm of independent public
         accountants stating the matters set forth in paragraph (i) above.

                 SECTION 1205.  Deposited Money and Government Obligations to
Be Held in Trust; Other Miscellaneous Provisions.

                 Subject to the provisions of the last paragraph of Section
1003, all money and Government Obligations (including the proceeds thereof)
deposited with the Trustee (or other qualifying trustee, collectively for
purposes of this Section 1205, the "Trustee") pursuant to Section 1204 in
respect of the Outstanding Notes shall be held in trust and applied by the
Trustee, in accordance with the provisions of such Notes and this Indenture, to
the payment, either directly or through any Paying Agent (including the Company
acting as its own Paying Agent) as the Trustee may determine, to the Holders of
such Notes of all sums due and to become due thereon in respect of principal
(and premium, if any) and interest, but such money need not be segregated from
other funds except to the extent required by law.  Money and U.S. Government
Obligations so held in trust are not subject to Article Thirteen.

                 The Company shall pay and indemnify the Trustee against any
tax, fee or other charge imposed on or assessed against the U.S. Government
Obligations deposited pursuant to Section 1204 or the principal and interest
received in respect thereof.

                 Anything in this Article Twelve to the contrary
notwithstanding, the Trustee shall deliver or pay to the Company from time to
time upon Company request any money or U.S. Government Obligations held by it
as provided in Section 1204 which, in the opinion of a nationally recognized
firm of independent public accountants expressed in a written certification
thereof delivered to the Trustee, are in excess of the amount thereof which
would then be required to be deposited to effect an equivalent legal defeasance
or covenant defeasance, as applicable, in accordance with this Article.

                 SECTION 1206.  Reinstatement.

                 If the Trustee or any Paying Agent is unable to apply any
money or Government Obligations in accordance with Section 1205 by reason of
any legal proceeding or by any reason of any order or judgment of any court or
governmental authority enjoining, restraining or otherwise prohibiting such
application, then the Company's obligations under this Indenture and the Notes
shall be revived

<PAGE>   95
                                                                              95



and reinstated as though no deposit had occurred pursuant to Section 1202 or
1203, as the case may be, until such time as the Trustee or Paying Agent is
permitted to apply all such money in accordance with Section 1205; provided,
however, that if the Company makes any payment of principal of (or premium, if
any) or interest on any Note following the reinstatement of its obligations,
the Company shall be subrogated to the rights of the Holders of such Notes to
receive such payment from the money and U.S. Government Obligations held by the
Trustee or Paying Agent.

                   ARTICLE THIRTEEN.  SUBORDINATION OF NOTES
1300.

                 SECTION 1301.  Notes Subordinate to Senior Indebtedness.

                 The Company covenants and agrees, and each Holder of a Note,
by his acceptance thereof, likewise covenants and agrees, for the benefit of
the holders, from time to time, of Senior Indebtedness that, to the extent and
in the manner hereinafter set forth in this Article, the Indebtedness
represented by the Notes and the payment of the principal of (and premium, if
any) and interest on each and all of the Notes and all other Subordinated
Obligations are hereby expressly made subordinate and subject in right of
payment as provided in this Article to the prior payment in full in cash or
Cash Equivalents of all Senior Indebtedness, whether outstanding on the Issue
Date or thereafter incurred, created, assumed or, except as set forth in
Section 1014, guaranteed.  The Notes will in all respects rank pari passu with
all other Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of the Company.

                 SECTION 1302.  Payment over of Proceeds upon Dissolution, Etc.

                 Upon any payment or distribution of the assets of the Company
upon a total or partial liquidation or dissolution or reorganization or
bankruptcy of or similar proceeding relating to the Company or its property:

                    (i)   the holders of Senior Indebtedness will be entitled
         to receive payment in full in cash or Cash Equivalents of the Senior
         Indebtedness (including interest after, or which would accrue but for,
         the commencement of any proceeding at the rate specified in the
         applicable Senior Indebtedness, whether or not a claim for such
         interest would be allowed in a proceeding) before the holders of the
         Notes are entitled to receive any payment, and

                    (ii)  until the Senior Indebtedness is paid in full in cash
         or Cash Equivalents, any payment or distribution to which holders of
         the Notes would be entitled but for the subordination provisions of
         this Indenture will be made to holders of the Senior Indebtedness as
         their interests may appear (except that holders of Notes may receive
         securities that are subordinated at least to the same extent as the
         Notes to the Senior Indebtedness and any securities issued in exchange
         for any Senior Indebtedness).

                 SECTION 1303.  Suspension of Payment When Senior Indebtedness
in Default.

                 (a)      The Company may not pay principal of, premium, if
any, or interest on, the Notes or make any deposit pursuant to the provisions
described under "Defeasance" and may not otherwise purchase or retire any Notes
(collectively, "pay the Notes") if:

                    (i)   any Senior Indebtedness is not paid when due in cash
         or Cash Equivalents; or

                    (ii)  any other default on Senior Indebtedness occurs and
         the maturity of such Senior Indebtedness is accelerated in accordance
         with its terms unless, in either case, the default has been cured or
         waived and any such acceleration has been rescinded or such Senior
         Indebtedness has been paid in full in cash or Cash Equivalents;

provided, however, the Company may pay the Notes without regard to the
foregoing if the Company and the Trustee receive written notice approving such
payment from the Representative of the Senior

<PAGE>   96
                                                                              96



Indebtedness with respect to which either of the events set forth in clause (i)
or (ii) above has occurred and is continuing.

                 (b)      During the continuance of any default (other than a
default described in clause (a) (i) or (a) (ii) above) with respect to any
Designated Senior Indebtedness pursuant to which the maturity thereof may be
accelerated immediately without further notice (except such notice as may be
required to effect such acceleration) or the expiration of any applicable grace
periods, the Company may not pay the Notes for a period (a "Payment Blockage
Period") commencing upon the receipt by the Trustee (with a copy to the
Company) of written notice (a "Blockage Notice") of such default from the
Representative of the holders of such Designated Senior Indebtedness specifying
an election to effect a Payment Blockage Period and ending 179 days thereafter
(or earlier if such Payment Blockage Period is terminated (i) by written notice
to the Trustee and the Company from the Person or Persons who gave such
Blockage Notice, (ii) because the default giving rise to such Blockage Notice
is no longer continuing or (iii) because such Designated Senior Indebtedness
has been repaid in full (or such payment has been duly provided for in a manner
acceptable to the holders of such Designated Senior Indebtedness).
Notwithstanding the provisions described in the immediately preceding sentence
(but subject to Section 1303(a)), unless the holders of such Designated Senior
Indebtedness or the Representative of such holders have accelerated the
maturity of such Designated Senior Indebtedness, the Company may resume
payments on the Notes after the end of such Payment Blockage Period. Not more
than one Blockage Notice may be given in any consecutive 360-day period,
irrespective of the number of defaults with respect to Designated Senior
Indebtedness during such period.  However, if any Blockage Notice within such
360-day period is given by or on behalf of any holders of Designated Senior
Indebtedness other than Bank Indebtedness, a Representative of Bank
Indebtedness may give one additional Blockage Notice within such period.  In no
event, however, may the total number of days during which any Payment Blockage
Period or Periods is in effect exceed 179 days in the aggregate during any 360
consecutive day period.

                 SECTION 1304.  Acceleration of Notes.

                 If payment of the Notes is accelerated because of an Event of
Default, the Company or the Trustee shall promptly notify the holders of the
Designated Senior Indebtedness or the Representative of such holders of the
acceleration. The Company may not pay the Notes until five Business Days after
such holders or the Representative of the Designated Senior Indebtedness
receive notice of such acceleration and, thereafter, may pay the Notes only if
the subordination provisions of this Indenture otherwise permit payment at that
time.

                 SECTION 1305.  When Distribution Must Be Paid Over.

                 If a distribution is made to Holders of the Notes that, due to
the provisions of this Article Thirteen, should not have been made to them,
such Holders are required to hold it in trust for the Holders of Senior
Indebtedness and pay it over to them as their interests may appear.

                 With respect to the holders of Senior Indebtedness, the
Trustee undertakes to perform only such obligations on the part of the Trustee
as are specifically set forth in this Article Thirteen, and no implied
covenants or obligations with respect to the holders of Senior Indebtedness
shall be read into this Indenture against the Trustee.  The Trustee shall not
be deemed to owe any fiduciary duty to the holders of Senior Indebtedness, and
shall not be liable to any such holders if the Trustee shall pay over or
distribute to or on behalf of Holders or the Company or any other Person money
or assets to which any holders of Senior Indebtedness shall be entitled by
virtue of this Article Thirteen, except if such payment is made as a result of
the willful misconduct or gross negligence of the Trustee.

                 SECTION 1306.  Notice by Company.

                 The Company shall promptly notify the Trustee and the Paying
Agent of any facts known to the Company that would cause a payment of any
Obligations with respect to the Notes that violate

<PAGE>   97
                                                                              97



this Article, but failure to give such notice shall not affect the
subordination of the Notes to the Senior Indebtedness as provided in this
Article Thirteen.

                 SECTION 1307.  Payment Permitted If No Default.

                 Nothing contained in this Article or elsewhere in this
Indenture or in any of the Notes shall prevent the Company, at any time except
during the pendency of any case, proceeding, dissolution, liquidation or other
winding up, assignment for the benefit of creditors or other marshalling of
assets and liabilities of the Company referred to in Section 1302 or under the
conditions described in Section 1303, from making payments at any time of
principal of (and premium, if any, on) or interest on the Notes.

                 SECTION 1308.  Subrogation to Rights of Holders of Senior
Indebtedness.

                 Subject to the payment in full of all Senior Indebtedness in
cash or Cash Equivalents, the Holders shall be subrogated (equally and ratably
with the holders of all pari passu Indebtedness of the Company) to the rights
of the holders of such Senior Indebtedness to receive payments and
distributions of cash, property and securities applicable to the Senior
Indebtedness until the Subordinated Obligations shall be paid in full.  For
purposes of such subrogation, no payments or distributions to the holders of
Senior Indebtedness of any cash, property or securities to which the Holders of
the Notes or the Trustee would be entitled except for the provisions of this
Article, and no payments pursuant to the provisions of this Article to the
holders of Senior Indebtedness by Holders of the Notes or on their behalf or by
the Trustee, shall, as among the Company, its creditors other than holders of
Senior Indebtedness, and the Holders of the Notes, be deemed to be a payment or
distribution by the Company to or on account of the Senior Indebtedness; it
being understood that the provisions of this Article are intended solely for
the purpose of determining the relative rights of the Holders of the Notes, on
the one hand, and the holders of Senior Indebtedness, on the other hand.

                 SECTION 1309.  Provisions Solely to Define Relative Rights.

                 The provisions of this Article are and are intended solely for
the purpose of defining the relative rights of the Holders on the one hand and
the holders of Senior Indebtedness on the other hand.  Nothing contained in
this Article or elsewhere in this Indenture or in the Notes is intended to or
shall (a) impair, as between the Company and the Holders, the obligation of the
Company, which is absolute and unconditional, to pay to the Holders the
principal of (and premium, if any) and interest on the Notes as and when the
same shall become due and payable in accordance with their terms; (b) affect
the relative rights against the Company of the Holders and creditors of the
Company other than their rights in relation to holders of Senior Indebtedness;
or (c) prevent the Trustee or any Holder from exercising all remedies otherwise
permitted by applicable law upon default under this Indenture, subject to the
rights, if any, under this Article of the holders of Senior Indebtedness.  If
the Company fails because of this Article to pay principal (or premium, if any)
or interest on a Note on the due date, the failure is still a Default or Event
of Default.

                 SECTION 1310.  Trustee to Effectuate Subordination.

                 Each Holder of a Note by his acceptance thereof authorizes and
directs the Trustee on such Holder's behalf to take such action as may be
necessary or appropriate to effectuate the subordination provided in this
Article and appoints the Trustee his attorney-in-fact for any and all such
purposes.  If the Trustee does not file a proper proof of claim or proof of
debt in the form required in any proceeding referred to in Section 504 hereof
at least 30 days before the expiration of the time to file such claim, the
agent bank under the Senior Credit Facility (if such facility is still
outstanding) is hereby authorized to file an appropriate claim for and on
behalf of the Holders of the Notes.

                 SECTION 1311.  Subordination May Not Be Impaired by Company.

                 No right of any present or future holder of any Senior
Indebtedness to enforce subordination as herein provided shall at any time in
any way be prejudiced or impaired by any act or

<PAGE>   98
                                                                              98



failure to act on the part of the Company or by any act or failure to act, in
good faith, by any such holder, or by any non-compliance by the Company with
the terms, provisions and covenants of this Indenture, regardless of any
knowledge thereof any such holder may have or be otherwise charged with.

                 SECTION 1312.  Distribution or Notice to Representative.

                 Whenever a distribution is to be made or a notice given to
holders of Senior Indebtedness, the distribution may be made and the notice
given to their Representative.

                 Upon any payment or distribution of assets of the Company
referred to in this Article Thirteen, the Trustee and the Holders shall be
entitled to rely upon any order or decree made by any court of competent
jurisdiction or upon any certificate of such Representative or of the
liquidating trustee or agent or other Person making any distribution to the
Trustee or to the Holders for the purpose of ascertaining the Persons entitled
to participate in such distribution, the holders of the Senior Indebtedness and
other Indebtedness of the Company, the amount thereof or payable thereon, the
amount or amounts paid or distributed thereon and all other acts pertinent
thereto or to this Article Thirteen.

                 SECTION 1313.  Notice to Trustee.

                 (a)      The Company shall give prompt written notice to the
Trustee of any fact known to the Company which would prohibit the making of any
payment to or by the Trustee in respect of the Notes.  Notwithstanding the
provisions of this Article or any other provision of this Indenture, the
Trustee shall not be charged with knowledge of the existence of any facts which
would prohibit the making of any payment to or by the Trustee in respect of the
Notes, unless and until the Trustee shall have received written notice thereof
from the Company, agent bank under the Senior Credit Facility or a holder of
Senior Indebtedness or from any trustee, fiduciary or agent therefor; and,
prior to the receipt of any such written notice, the Trustee, subject to TIA
Sections 315(a) through 315(d), shall be entitled in all respects to assume
that no such facts exist; provided, however, that, if the Trustee shall not
have received the notice provided for in this Section at least three Business
Days prior to the date upon which by the terms hereof any money may become
payable for any purpose (including, without limitation, the payment of the
principal of (and premium, if any) or interest on any Note), then, anything
herein contained to the contrary notwithstanding, the Trustee shall have full
power and authority to receive such money and to apply the same to the purpose
for which such money was received and shall not be affected by any notice to
the contrary which may be received by it within three Business Days prior to
such date.

                 (b)      Subject to TIA Sections 315(a) through 315(d), the
Trustee shall be entitled to rely on the delivery to it of a written notice by
a Person representing himself to be a holder of Senior Indebtedness (or a
trustee, fiduciary or agent therefor) to establish that such notice has been
given by a holder of Senior Indebtedness (or a trustee, fiduciary or agent
therefor).  In the event that the Trustee determines in good faith that further
evidence is required with respect to the right of any Person as a holder of
Senior Indebtedness to participate in any payment or distribution pursuant to
this Article, the Trustee may request such Person to furnish evidence to the
reasonable satisfaction of the Trustee as to the amount of Senior Indebtedness
held by such Person, the extent to which such Person is entitled to participate
in such payment or distribution and any other facts pertinent to the rights of
such Person under this Article and, if such evidence is not furnished, the
Trustee may defer any payment to such Person pending judicial determination as
to the right of such Person to receive such payment.

                 SECTION 1314.  Reliance on Judicial Order or Certificate of
Liquidating Agent.

                 Upon any payment or distribution of assets of the Company
referred to in this Article, the Trustee, subject to TIA Sections 315(a)
through 315(d), and the Holders of the Notes shall be entitled to rely upon any
order or decree entered by any court of competent jurisdiction in which such
insolvency, bankruptcy, receivership, liquidation, reorganization, dissolution,
winding up or similar case or proceeding is pending, or a certificate of the
trustee in bankruptcy, receiver, liquidating trustee,

<PAGE>   99
                                                                              99


custodian, assignee for the benefit of creditors, agent or other Person making
such payment or distribution, delivered to the Trustee or to the Holders of
Notes, for the purpose of ascertaining the Persons entitled to participate in
such payment or distribution, the holders of Senior Indebtedness and other
indebtedness of the Company, the amount thereof or payable thereon, the amount
or amounts paid or distributed thereon and all other facts pertinent thereto or
to this Article; provided that such court, trustee, receiver, custodian,
assignee, agent or other Person has been apprised of, or the order, decree or
certificate makes reference to, the provisions of this Article.

                 SECTION 1315.  Rights of Trustee as a Holder of Senior
Indebtedness; Preservation of Trustee's Rights.

                 The Trustee in its individual capacity shall be entitled to
all the rights set forth in this Article with respect to any Senior
Indebtedness which may at any time be held by it, to the same extent as any
other holder of Senior Indebtedness, and nothing in this Indenture shall
deprive the Trustee of any of its rights as such holder.  Nothing in this
Article shall apply to claims of, or payments to, the Trustee under or pursuant
to Section 607.

                 SECTION 1316.  Article Applicable to Paying Agents.

                 In case at any time any Paying Agent other than the Trustee
shall have been appointed by the Company and be then acting hereunder, the term
"Trustee" as used in this Article shall in such case (unless the context
otherwise requires) be construed as extending to and including such Paying
Agent within its meaning as fully for all intents and purposes as if such
Paying Agent were named in this Article in addition to or in place of the
Trustee; provided, however, that Section 1315 shall not apply to the Company or
any Affiliate of the Company if it or such Affiliate acts as Paying Agent.

                 SECTION 1317.  No Suspension of Remedies.

                 Nothing contained in this Article shall limit the right of the
Trustee or the Holders of Notes to take any action to accelerate the maturity
of the Notes pursuant to Article Five or to pursue any rights or remedies
hereunder or under applicable law, except as provided in Article Five.

                 SECTION 1318.  Modification of Terms of Senior Indebtedness.

                 Any renewal or extension of the time of payment of any Senior
Indebtedness or the exercise by the holders of Senior Indebtedness of any of
their rights under any instrument creating or evidencing Senior Indebtedness,
including, without limitation, the waiver of default thereunder, may be made or
done all without notice to or assent from the Holders or the Trustee.

                 No compromise, alteration, amendment, modification, extension,
renewal or other change of, or waiver, consent or other action in respect of,
any liability or obligation under or in respect of, or of any of the terms,
covenants or conditions of any indenture or other instrument under which any
Senior Indebtedness is outstanding or of such Senior Indebtedness, whether or
not such release is in accordance with the provisions of any applicable
document, shall in any way alter or affect any of the provisions of this
Article Thirteen or of the Notes relating to the subordination thereof.

                 SECTION 1319.  Trust Moneys Not Subordinated.

                 Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary,
payments from cash or the proceeds of U.S. Government Obligations held in trust
under Article Twelve hereof by the Trustee (or other qualifying trustee) and
which were deposited in accordance with the terms of Article Twelve hereof and
not in violation of Section 1303 hereof for the payment of principal of (and
premium, if any) and interest on the Notes shall not be subordinated to the
prior payment of any Senior Indebtedness or subject to the restrictions set
forth in this Article Thirteen, and none of the Holders shall be obligated to
pay over any such amount to the Company or any holder of Senior Indebtedness or
any other creditor of the Company.

<PAGE>   100
                                                                             100



                 This Indenture may be signed in any number of counterparts
each of which so executed shall be deemed to be an original, but all such
counterparts shall together constitute but one and the same Indenture.


                    ARTICLE FOURTEEN.  SUBSIDIARY GUARANTEES
1400.

                 SECTION 1401.  Subsidiary Guarantees.

                 (a)  Each Subsidiary Guarantor hereby unconditionally and
irrevocably guarantees, jointly and severally, to each Holder and to the
Trustee and its successors and assigns on an unsecured senior subordinated
basis (i) the full and punctual payment of principal of, premium, if any, and
interest on the Notes when due, whether at maturity, by acceleration, by
redemption, by required repurchase or otherwise, and all other monetary
obligations of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors under this Indenture
and the Notes and (ii) the full and punctual performance within applicable
grace periods of all other obligations of the Company and the Subsidiary
Guarantors under this Indenture and the Notes (all the foregoing being
hereinafter collectively called the "Guaranteed Obligations").  Each Subsidiary
Guarantor agrees that the Guaranteed Obligations may be extended or renewed, in
whole or in part, without further notice or further assent from such Subsidiary
Guarantor and that such Subsidiary Guarantor will remain bound under this
Article XIV notwithstanding any extension or renewal of any Guaranteed
Obligation.

                 (b)  Each Subsidiary Guarantor waives presentation to, demand
of, payment from and protest to the Company of any of the Guaranteed
Obligations and also waives notice of protest for nonpayment.  Each Subsidiary
Guarantor waives notice of any default under the Notes or the Guaranteed
Obligations.  The Guaranteed Obligations of each Subsidiary Guarantor hereunder
shall not be affected by (a) the failure of any Holder or the Trustee to assert
any claim or demand or to enforce any right or remedy against the Company or
any other Person under this Indenture, the Notes or any other agent or
otherwise; (b) any extension or renewal of any thereof; (c) any rescission,
waiver, amendment or modification of any of the terms or provisions of this
Indenture, the Notes or any other agreement; (d) the release of any security
held by any Holder or the Trustee for the Guaranteed Obligations or any of
them; (e) the failure of any Holder or the Trustee to exercise any right or
remedy against any other guarantor of the Guaranteed Obligations; (f) subject
to Section 1405, any change in the ownership of such Subsidiary Guarantor; or
(g) any other circumstance which might otherwise constitute a legal or
equitable discharge or defense of a guarantor.

                 (c)  Each Subsidiary Guarantor further agrees that its
Subsidiary Guarantee herein constitutes a guarantee of payment, performance and
compliance when due (and not a guarantee of collection) and waives any right to
require that any resort be had by any Holder or the Trustee to any security
held for payment of the Guaranteed Obligations.

                 (d)  Except as expressly set forth in Sections 1402, 1404,
1202 and 1203, the obligations of each Subsidiary Guarantor hereunder shall not
be subject to any reduction, limitation, impairment or termination for any
reason, including any claim of waiver, release, surrender, alteration or
compromise, and shall not be subject to any defense of setoff, counterclaim,
recoupment or termination whatsoever or by reason of the invalidity, illegality
or unenforceability of the Guaranteed Obligations or otherwise.  Without
limiting the generality of the foregoing, the obligations of each Subsidiary
Guarantor herein shall not be discharged or impaired or otherwise affected by
the failure of any Holder or the Trustee to assert any claim or demand or to
enforce any remedy under this Indenture, the Notes or any other agreement, by
any waiver or modification of any thereof, by any default, failure or delay,
willful or otherwise, in the performance of the obligations, or by any other
act or thing or omission or delay to do any other act or thing which may or
might in any manner or to any extent vary the risk of such guarantor or would
otherwise operate as a discharge of such Subsidiary Guarantor as a matter of
law or equity.

                 (e)  Each Subsidiary Guarantor further agrees that its
Subsidiary Guarantee herein shall continue to be effective or be reinstated, as
the case may be, if at any time payment, or any part thereof,

<PAGE>   101
                                                                             101



of principal of or interest on any Guaranteed Obligation is rescinded or must
otherwise be restored by any Holder or the Trustee upon the bankruptcy or
reorganization of the Company or otherwise.

                 (f)  In furtherance of the foregoing and not in limitation of
any other right which any Holder or the Trustee has at law or in equity against
any Subsidiary Guarantor by virtue hereof, upon the failure of the Company to
pay the principal of or interest on any Guaranteed Obligation when and as the
same shall become due, whether at maturity, by acceleration, by redemption or
otherwise, or to perform or comply with any other Guaranteed Obligation, each
Subsidiary Guarantor hereby promises to and will, upon receipt of written
demand by the Trustee, forthwith pay, or cause to be paid, in cash, to the
Holders or the Trustee an amount equal to the sum of (i) the unpaid amount of
such Guaranteed Obligations, (ii) accrued and unpaid interest on such
Guaranteed Obligations (but only to the extent not prohibited by law) and (iii)
all other monetary Guaranteed Obligations of the Company or the Subsidiary
Guarantors to the Holders and the Trustee.

                 (g)  Each Subsidiary Guarantor agrees that, as between it, on
the one hand, and the Holders and the Trustee, on the other hand, (x) the
maturity of the Guaranteed Obligations guaranteed hereby may be accelerated as
provided in Article VIII for the purposes of such Guarantee herein,
notwithstanding any stay, injunction or other prohibition preventing such
acceleration in respect of the Guaranteed Obligations guaranteed hereby, and
(y) in the event of any declaration of acceleration of such Guaranteed
Obligations as provided in Article V, such Guaranteed Obligations (whether or
not due and payable) shall forthwith become due and payable by such Subsidiary
Guarantor for the purposes of this Section 1401.

                 (h)  Each Subsidiary Guarantor also agrees to pay any and all
costs and expenses (including attorneys' fees and disbursements) incurred by
the Trustee or any Holder in enforcing or obtaining advice of counsel in
respect of any rights with respect to or collecting such Subsidiary Guarantor
under this Subsidiary Guarantee under this Section 1401.

                 SECTION 1402.  Limitation on Liability.

                 Each Subsidiary Guarantor agrees that the Guaranteed
Obligations may at any time and from time to time exceed the amount of the
liability of such Subsidiary Guarantor hereunder without impairing this
Subsidiary Guarantee or affecting the rights and remedies of the Agent or any
Lender hereunder; provided, however, that any term or provision of this
Indenture to the contrary notwithstanding, the maximum aggregate amount of the
Guaranteed Obligations guaranteed hereunder by any Subsidiary Guarantor shall
not exceed the maximum amount that can be guaranteed hereby without rendering
this Indenture, as it relates to such Subsidiary Guarantor, void or voidable
under applicable law relating to fraudulent conveyance or fraudulent transfer
or similar laws affecting the rights of creditors generally.

                 SECTION 1403.  No Waiver.

                 Neither a failure nor a delay on the part of either the
Trustee or the Holders in exercising any right, power or privilege under this
Article XIV shall operate as a waiver thereof, or shall a single or partial
exercise thereof preclude any other or further exercise of any right, power or
privilege.  The rights, remedies and benefits of the Trustee and the Holders
herein expressly specified are cumulative and not exclusive of any other
rights, remedies or benefits which either may have under this Article XIV at
law, in equity, by statute or otherwise.

                 SECTION 1404.  Modification.

                 No modification, amendment or waiver of any provision of this
Article XIV, nor the consent to any departure by any Subsidiary Guarantor
therefrom, shall in any event be effective unless the same shall be in writing
and signed by the Trustee, and then such waiver or consent shall be effective
only in the specific instance and for the purposes for which given.  No notice
to or demand on any Subsidiary Guarantor in any case shall entitle such
Subsidiary Guarantor to any other or further notice or demand in the same,
similar or other circumstance.

<PAGE>   102
                                                                             102



                 SECTION 1405.  Release of Subsidiary Guarantor.

                 Upon the occurrence of a sale or other disposition (including
by way of consolidation or merger) of a Subsidiary Guarantor or the sale or
disposition of all or substantially all the assets of such Subsidiary Guarantor
(in each case other than to the Company or an Affiliate of the Company)
pursuant to and in accordance with the terms and provisions of this Indenture,
such Subsidiary Guarantor shall be deemed released from all obligations under
this Article XIV without any further action required on the part of the Trustee
or any Holder; provided, however, that any such release will occur only to the
extent that all obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor under the Senior
Credit Facility and all of its Guarantees of, and under all of its pledges of
assets or other security interests which secure, any other Indebtedness of the
Company will also terminate concurrently with such release.  At the request of
the Company and upon receipt of an Officers' Certificate, the Trustee shall
execute and deliver an appropriate instrument evidencing such release.


<PAGE>   103


                 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this
Indenture to be duly executed as of the day and year first above written.

                                  RENTERS CHOICE, INC.


                                  By                            
                                     ---------------------------
                                     Name:
                                     Title:


                                  COLORTYME, INC., as a Subsidiary Guarantor


                                  By                            
                                     ---------------------------
                                     Name:
                                     Title:


                                  RENT-A-CENTER, INC., as a Subsidiary Guarantor


                                  By                            
                                     ---------------------------
                                     Name:
                                     Title:


                                  IBJ SCHRODER BANK & TRUST COMPANY,
                                    as Trustee


                                  By                            
                                     ---------------------------
                                     Name:
                                     Title:


<PAGE>   104
                                                                  EXECUTION COPY


===============================================================================





                             RENTERS CHOICE, INC.,

                                   as Issuer

                                COLORTYME, INC.
                                      and
                              RENT-A-CENTER, INC.,

                            as Subsidiary Guarantors

                                      and

                       IBJ SCHRODER BANK & TRUST COMPANY,

                                   as Trustee



                              ____________________

                                   INDENTURE

                          Dated as of August 18, 1998

                             _____________________




                     11% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008




===============================================================================

<PAGE>   105
               RECONCILIATION AND TIE BETWEEN TRUST INDENTURE ACT
             OF 1939 AND INDENTURE, DATED AS OF NOVEMBER 4, 1997*/




<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
TRUST INDENTURE
  ACT SECTION                                   INDENTURE SECTION
<S>                                                  <C>
Section  310(a)(1)    . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    608
         (a)(2)       . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    608
         (b)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    609
Section  312(a)       . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    701
         (c)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    702
Section  313(a)       . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    703
         (c)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    703
Section  314(a)(4)    . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    1018(a)
         (c)(1)       . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    102
         (c)(2)       . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    102
         (e)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    102
Section  315(a)       . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    601(a)
         (b)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    602
         (c)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    601(b)
         (d)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    601(c), 603
316(a)(last sentence) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     
         101 ("Outstanding")                         
         (a)(1)(A)    . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    502, 512
         (a)(1)(B)    . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    513
         (b)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    508
         (c)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    104(d)
Section  317(a)(1)    . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    503
         (a)(2)       . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    504
         (b)          . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    1003
Section  318(a)       . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    111
</TABLE>



__________________________________

*/Note:  This reconciliation and tie shall not, for any purpose, be deemed to
         be a part of the Indenture.

<PAGE>   106
 
                              TABLE OF CONTENTS,/


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            Page
                                                                            ----
     <S>                                                                    <C>
     ARTICLE ONE.  DEFINITIONS AND OTHER PROVISIONS OF GENERAL APPLICATION     1
        SECTION 101.  Definitions   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    1
        SECTION 102.  Compliance Certificates and Opinions  . . . . . . . .   18
        SECTION 103.  Form of Documents Delivered to Trustee  . . . . . . .   18
        SECTION 104.  Acts of Holders   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   19
        SECTION 105.  Notices, Etc., to Trustee, the Company and any 
                      Guarantor   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   20
        SECTION 106.  Notice to Holders; Waiver   . . . . . . . . . . . . .   20
        SECTION 107.  Effect of Headings and Table of Contents  . . . . . .   20
        SECTION 108.  Successors and Assigns  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   20
        SECTION 109.  Separability Clause   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   21
        SECTION 110.  Benefits of Indenture   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   21
        SECTION 111.  Governing Law   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   21
        SECTION 112.  Legal Holidays  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   21
        SECTION 113.  No Personal Liability of Directors, Officers, 
                      Employees, Stockholders or Incorporators  . . . . . .   21
        SECTION 114.  Counterparts  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   22
        SECTION 115.  Communications by Holders with Other Holders  . . . .   22

                           ARTICLE TWO.  NOTE FORMS . . . . . . . . . . . .   22
        SECTION 201.  Forms Generally   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   22
        SECTION 202.  Restrictive Legends   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   23
        SECTION 203.  Form of Initial Note  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   25
        SECTION 204.  Form of Exchange Note   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   40
        SECTION 205.  Form of Trustee's Certificate of Authentication   . .   52

                           ARTICLE THREE.  THE NOTES  . . . . . . . . . . .   52
        SECTION 301.  Title and Terms   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   52
        SECTION 302.  Denominations   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   53
        SECTION 303.  Execution, Authentication, Delivery and Dating  . . .   53
        SECTION 304.  Temporary Notes   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   54
        SECTION 305.  Registration, Registration of Transfer and Exchange     54
        SECTION 306.  Book-Entry Provisions for Global Notes  . . . . . . .   55
        SECTION 307.  Special Transfer Provisions   . . . . . . . . . . . .   56
        SECTION 308.  Form of Certificate to Be Delivered in Connection
                      with Transfers to Institutional Accredited 
                      Investors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   58
        SECTION 309.  Form of Certificate to Be Delivered in Connection 
                      with Transfers Pursuant to Regulation S . . . . . . .   60
        SECTION 310.  Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost and Stolen Notes   . . . .   61
        SECTION 311.  Payment of Interest; Interest Rights Preserved  . . .   61
        SECTION 312.  Persons Deemed Owners   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   62
        SECTION 313.  Cancellation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   62
        SECTION 314.  Computation of Interest   . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   62
        SECTION 315.  CUSIP Numbers   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   63

                   ARTICLE FOUR.  SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE  . . . . . . .   63
        SECTION 401.  Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture   . . . . . .   63
        SECTION 402.  Application of Trust Money  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
</TABLE>

- ----------------------------------

,/       Note:   This table of contents shall not, for any purpose, be deemed
                 to be a part of the Indenture.

<PAGE>   107

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            Page
                                                                            ----
       <S>                                                                  <C>
                            ARTICLE FIVE.  REMEDIES   . . . . . . . . . . .   64
        SECTION 501.  Events of Default   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   64
        SECTION 502.  Acceleration of Maturity; Rescission and Annulment. .   66
        SECTION 503.  Collection of Indebtedness and Suits for Enforcement 
                      by Trustee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   67
        SECTION 504.  Trustee May File Proofs of Claim  . . . . . . . . . .   67
        SECTION 505.  Trustee May Enforce Claims Without Possession of 
                      Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   68
        SECTION 506.  Application of Money Collected  . . . . . . . . . . .   68
        SECTION 507.  Limitation on Suits   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   68
        SECTION 508.  Unconditional Right of Holders to Receive Principal,
                      Premium and Interest  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   69
        SECTION 509.  Restoration of Rights and Remedies  . . . . . . . . .   69
        SECTION 510.  Rights and Remedies Cumulative  . . . . . . . . . . .   69
        SECTION 511.  Delay or Omission Not Waiver  . . . . . . . . . . . .   69
        SECTION 512.  Control by Holders  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   69
        SECTION 513.  Waiver of Past Defaults   . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   70
        SECTION 514.  Waiver of Stay or Extension Laws  . . . . . . . . . .   70
        SECTION 515.  Undertaking for Costs   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   70

                           ARTICLE SIX.  THE TRUSTEE  . . . . . . . . . . .   71
        SECTION 601.  Certain Duties and Responsibilities   . . . . . . . .   71
        SECTION 602.  Notice of Defaults  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   72
        SECTION 603.  Certain Rights of Trustee   . . . . . . . . . . . . .   72
        SECTION 604.  Trustee Not Responsible for Recitals or Issuance of 
                      Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   73
        SECTION 605.  May Hold Notes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   73
        SECTION 606.  Money Held in Trust   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   73
        SECTION 607.  Compensation and Reimbursement  . . . . . . . . . . .   74
        SECTION 608.  Corporate Trustee Required; Eligibility   . . . . . .   74
        SECTION 609.  Resignation and Removal; Appointment of Successor . .   75
        SECTION 610.  Acceptance of Appointment by Successor  . . . . . . .   76
        SECTION 611.  Merger, Conversion, Consolidation or Succession to
                      Business  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   76
        SECTION 612.  Trustee's Application for Instructions from the 
                      Company . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   76

       ARTICLE SEVEN.  HOLDERS LISTS AND REPORTS BY TRUSTEE AND COMPANY . .   77
        SECTION 701.  Company to Furnish Trustee Names and Addresses  . . .   77
        SECTION 702.  Disclosure of Names and Addresses of Holders  . . . .   77
        SECTION 703.  Reports by Trustee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   77
        SECTION 704.  Notice of Defaults  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   77

                   ARTICLE EIGHT.  MERGER AND CONSOLIDATION . . . . . . . .   77
        SECTION 801.  Company May Consolidate, Etc., Only on Certain 
                      Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   77
        SECTION 802.  Successor Substituted   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   78

            ARTICLE NINE.  SUPPLEMENTS AND AMENDMENTS TO INDENTURE  . . . .   79
        SECTION 901.  Supplemental Indentures Without Consent of Holders. .   79
        SECTION 902.  Supplemental Indentures with Consent of Holders   . .   79
        SECTION 903.  Execution of Supplemental Indentures  . . . . . . . .   80
        SECTION 904.  Effect of Supplemental Indentures   . . . . . . . . .   80
        SECTION 905.  Conformity with Trust Indenture Act   . . . . . . . .   80
        SECTION 906.  Reference in Notes to Supplemental Indentures   . . .   81
        SECTION 907.  Notice of Supplemental Indentures   . . . . . . . . .   81
        SECTION 908.  Effect on Senior Indebtedness   . . . . . . . . . . .   81

                            ARTICLE TEN.  COVENANTS . . . . . . . . . . . .   81
        SECTION 1001.  Payment of Principal, Premium, if any, and 
                       Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   81
        SECTION 1002.  Maintenance of Office or Agency. . . . . . . . . . .   81
        SECTION 1003.  Money for Note Payments to Be Held in Trust. . . . .   82
</TABLE>


                                     ii
<PAGE>   108

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            Page
                                                                            ----
         <S>                                                                 <C>
         SECTION 1004.  Corporate Existence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   83
         SECTION 1005.  Payment of Taxes and Other Claims . . . . . . . . .   83
         SECTION 1006.  Maintenance of Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . .   83
         SECTION 1007.  Insurance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   83
         SECTION 1008.  Compliance with Laws. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   83
         SECTION 1009.  Limitation on Restricted Payments . . . . . . . . .   84
         SECTION 1010.  Limitation on Indebtedness  . . . . . . . . . . . .   85
         SECTION 1011.  Limitation on Layering  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   86
         SECTION 1012.  Limitation on Affiliate Transactions  . . . . . . .   87
         SECTION 1013.  Limitation on Restrictions on Distributions from
                        Restricted Subsidiaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   87
         SECTION 1014.  Limitation on Sale or Issuance of Preferred Stock 
                        of Restricted Subsidiaries  . . . . . . . . . . . .   88
         SECTION 1015.  Limitation on Liens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   88
         SECTION 1016.  Change of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   88
         SECTION 1017.  Limitation on Sales of Assets . . . . . . . . . . .   89
         SECTION 1018.  Statement by Officers as to Default . . . . . . . .   90
         SECTION 1019.  Reporting Requirements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   91
         SECTION 1020.  Future Subsidiary Guarantors  . . . . . . . . . . .   91
         SECTION 1021.  Designation of Unrestricted Subsidiaries  . . . . .   91
         SECTION 1022.  Limitation on Sale/Leaseback Transactions . . . . .   91

                      ARTICLE ELEVEN.  REDEMPTION OF NOTES  . . . . . . . .   92
         SECTION 1101.  Optional Redemption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   92
         SECTION 1102.  Applicability of Article  . . . . . . . . . . . . .   92
         SECTION 1103.  Election to Redeem; Notice to Trustee . . . . . . .   92
         SECTION 1104.  Selection by Trustee of Notes to Be Redeemed  . . .   93
         SECTION 1105.  Notice of Redemption  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   93
         SECTION 1106.  Deposit of Redemption Price . . . . . . . . . . . .   94
         SECTION 1107.  Notes Payable on Redemption Date  . . . . . . . . .   94
         SECTION 1108.  Notes Redeemed in Part  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   94

            ARTICLE TWELVE.  LEGAL DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE . . .   95
         SECTION 1201.  Company's Option to Effect Legal Defeasance or 
                        Covenant Defeasance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   95
         SECTION 1202.  Legal Defeasance and Discharge  . . . . . . . . . .   95
         SECTION 1203.  Covenant Defeasance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   95
         SECTION 1204.  Conditions to Legal Defeasance or Covenant 
                        Defeasance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   97 
         SECTION 1205.  Deposited Money and Government Obligations to Be 
                        Held in Trust; Other Miscellaneous Provisions . . .   97
         SECTION 1206.  Reinstatement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   97

                    ARTICLE THIRTEEN.  SUBORDINATION OF NOTES . . . . . . .   98
         SECTION 1301.  Notes Subordinate to Senior Indebtedness  . . . . .   98
         SECTION 1302.  Payment over of Proceeds upon Dissolution, Etc. . .   98
         SECTION 1303.  Suspension of Payment When Senior Indebtedness in
                        Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   98
         SECTION 1304.  Acceleration of Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   99
         SECTION 1305.  When Distribution Must Be Paid Over . . . . . . . .   99
         SECTION 1306.  Notice by Company . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   99
         SECTION 1307.  Payment Permitted If No Default . . . . . . . . . .  100
         SECTION 1308.  Subrogation to Rights of Holders of Senior 
                        Indebtedness. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  100
         SECTION 1309.  Provisions Solely to Define Relative Rights . . . .  100
         SECTION 1310.  Trustee to Effectuate Subordination . . . . . . . .  100
         SECTION 1311.  Subordination May Not Be Impaired by Company  . . .  100
         SECTION 1312.  Distribution or Notice to Representative  . . . . .  101
         SECTION 1313.  Notice to Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  101
</TABLE>


                                     iii

<PAGE>   109
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            Page
                                                                            ----
         <S>                                                                <C>
         SECTION 1314.  Reliance on Judicial Order or Certificate of 
                        Liquidating Agent  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   101
         SECTION 1315.  Rights of Trustee as a Holder of Senior 
                        Indebtedness; Preservation of Trustee's Rights . .   102
         SECTION 1316.  Article Applicable to Paying Agents . . . . . . . .  102
         SECTION 1317.  No Suspension of Remedies . . . . . . . . . . . . .  102
         SECTION 1318.  Modification of Terms of Senior Indebtedness  . . .  102
         SECTION 1319.  Trust Moneys Not Subordinated . . . . . . . . . . .  102

                    ARTICLE FOURTEEN.  SUBSIDIARY GUARANTEES  . . . . . . .  103
         SECTION 1401.  Subsidiary Guarantees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  103
         SECTION 1402.  Limitation on Liability . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  104
         SECTION 1403.  No Waiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  104
         SECTION 1404.  Modification  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  104
         SECTION 1405.  Release of Subsidiary Guarantor . . . . . . . . . .  105
</TABLE>

                                     iv



<PAGE>   1
                                                                EXHIBIT 10.14


                              RENTERS CHOICE, INC.

                                  $175,000,000

                     11% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008



                   EXCHANGE AND REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT

                                                                 August 18, 1998

CHASE SECURITIES INC.
BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.
NATIONSBANC MONTGOMERY SECURITIES LLC
CREDIT SUISSE FIRST BOSTON CORPORATION
c/o Chase Securities Inc.
270 Park Avenue, 4th floor
New York, New York  10017


Ladies and Gentlemen:

         RENTERS CHOICE, INC., a Delaware corporation (after giving effect to
the Acquisition, the "Company"), proposes to issue and sell to Chase Securities
Inc. ("CSI"), Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. ("Bear, Stearns"), NationsBanc Montgomery
Securities LLC ("NationsBanc") and Credit Suisse First Boston Corporation
("CSFB," and together with CSI, Bear, Stearns and NationsBanc, the "Initial
Purchasers"), upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in a
purchase agreement dated August 14, 1998 (the "Purchase Agreement"),
$175,000,000 aggregate principal amount of its __% Senior Subordinated Notes due
2008 (the "Notes"). Capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the
meanings given to such terms in the Purchase Agreement.

         As an inducement to the Initial Purchasers to enter into the Purchase
Agreement and in satisfaction of a condition to the obligations of the Initial
Purchasers thereunder, the Company agrees with the Initial Purchasers, for the
benefit of the holders (including the Initial Purchasers) of the Notes, the
Exchange Notes (as defined herein) and the Private Exchange Notes (as defined
herein) (collectively, the "Holders"), as follows:

         1. Registered Exchange Offer. The Company shall (i) use its
commercially reasonable efforts to prepare and, not later than 60 days following
the date of original issuance of the Notes (the "Issue Date"), to file with the
Commission a registration statement (the "Exchange Offer Registration
Statement") on an appropriate form under the Securities Act with respect to a
proposed offer to the Holders of the Notes (the "Registered Exchange Offer") to
issue and deliver to such Holders, in exchange for the Notes, a like aggregate
principal amount of debt securities of the Company (the "Exchange Notes") that
are identical in all material respects to the Notes (except that the Exchange
Notes will not contain terms with respect to transfer restrictions or additional
interest upon certain failures to comply with this Agreement), (ii) use its
commercially reasonable efforts to cause the Exchange Offer Registration
Statement to become effective under the Securities Act no later than 150 days
after the Issue Date and the Registered Exchange Offer to be consummated no
later than 180 days after the Issue Date and (iii) keep the Exchange Offer
Registration Statement effective for not less than 30 days (or longer, if
required by applicable law) after the date on which notice of the Registered
Exchange Offer is mailed to the Holders (such period being called the "Exchange
Offer Registration Period"). The Exchange Notes will be issued under the
Indenture or


<PAGE>   2


                                                                               2





an indenture (the "Exchange Notes Indenture") between the Company, the
Subsidiary Guarantors and the Trustee or such other bank or trust company that
is reasonably satisfactory to the Initial Purchasers, as trustee (the "Exchange
Notes Trustee"), such indenture to be identical in all material respects to the
Indenture, except for the transfer restrictions relating to the Notes (as
described above).

         Upon the effectiveness of the Exchange Offer Registration Statement,
the Company shall promptly commence the Registered Exchange Offer, it being the
objective of such Registered Exchange Offer to enable each Holder electing to
exchange Notes for Exchange Notes (assuming that such Holder (a) is not an
affiliate of the Company or an Exchanging Dealer (as defined herein) not
complying with the requirements of the next sentence, (b) is not an Initial
Purchaser holding Notes that have, or that are reasonably likely to have, the
status of an unsold allotment in an initial distribution, (c) acquires the
Exchange Notes in the ordinary course of such Holder's business and (d) has no
arrangements or understandings with any person to participate in the
distribution of the Exchange Notes) and to trade such Exchange Notes from and
after their receipt without any limitations or restrictions under the Securities
Act and without material restrictions under the securities laws of the several
states of the United States. The Company, the Initial Purchasers and each
Exchanging Dealer acknowledge that, pursuant to current interpretations by the
Commission's staff of Section 5 of the Securities Act, each Holder that is a
broker-dealer electing to exchange Notes, acquired for its own account as a
result of market-making activities or other trading activities, for Exchange
Notes (an "Exchanging Dealer"), is required to deliver a prospectus containing
substantially the information set forth in Annex A hereto on the cover, in Annex
B hereto in the "Exchange Offer Procedures" section and the "Purpose of the
Exchange Offer" section and in Annex C hereto in the "Plan of Distribution"
section of such prospectus in connection with a sale of any such Exchange Notes
received by such Exchanging Dealer pursuant to the Registered Exchange Offer.

         If, prior to the consummation of the Registered Exchange Offer, any
Holder holds any Notes acquired by it that have, or that are reasonably likely
to be determined to have, the status of an unsold allotment in an initial
distribution, or any Holder is not entitled to participate in the Registered
Exchange Offer, the Company shall, upon the request of any such Holder,
simultaneously with the delivery of the Exchange Notes in the Registered
Exchange Offer, issue and deliver to any such Holder, in exchange for the Notes
held by such Holder (the "Private Exchange"), a like aggregate principal amount
of debt securities of the Company (the "Private Exchange Notes") that are
identical in all material respects to the Exchange Notes, except for the
transfer restrictions relating to such Private Exchange Notes. The Private
Exchange Notes will be issued under the same indenture as the Exchange Notes,
and the Company shall use its commercially reasonable efforts to cause the
Private Exchange Notes to bear the same CUSIP numbers as the Exchange Notes.

         In connection with the Registered Exchange Offer, the Company shall:

         (a) mail to each Holder a copy of the prospectus forming part of the
    Exchange Offer Registration Statement, together with an appropriate letter
    of transmittal and related documents;

         (b) keep the Registered Exchange Offer open for not less than 30 days
    (or longer, if required by applicable law) after the date on which notice of
    the Registered Exchange Offer is first mailed to the Holders;

         (c) utilize the services of a depositary for the Registered Exchange
    Offer with an address in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York;

         (d) permit Holders to withdraw tendered Notes at any time prior to 5:00
    p.m., New York City time, on the last business day on which the Registered
    Exchange Offer shall remain open; and



<PAGE>   3


                                                                               3






         (e) otherwise comply in all respects with all laws that are applicable
    to the Registered Exchange Offer.

         As soon as practicable after the close of the Registered Exchange Offer
and any Private Exchange, as the case may be, the Company shall:

         (a) accept for exchange all Notes tendered and not validly withdrawn
    pursuant to the Registered Exchange Offer and the Private Exchange;

         (b) deliver to the Trustee for cancellation all Notes so accepted for
    exchange; and

         (c) cause the Trustee or the Exchange Notes Trustee, as the case may
    be, promptly to authenticate and deliver to each Holder, Exchange Notes or
    Private Exchange Notes, as the case may be, equal in principal amount to the
    Notes of such Holder so accepted for exchange.

         The Company shall use its commercially reasonable efforts to keep the
Exchange Offer Registration Statement effective and to amend and supplement the
prospectus contained therein in order to permit such prospectus to be used by
all persons subject to the prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities
Act for such period of time as such persons must comply with such requirements
in order to resell the Exchange Notes; provided that (i) in the case where such
prospectus and any amendment or supplement thereto must be delivered by an
Exchanging Dealer, such period shall be the lesser of 180 days after the
commencement of the Exchange Offer and the date on which all Exchanging Dealers
have sold all Exchange Notes held by them and (ii) the Company shall make such
prospectus and any amendment or supplement thereto available to any
broker-dealer for use in connection with any resale of any Exchange Notes for a
period of 180 days after the consummation of the Registered Exchange Offer.

         The Indenture or the Exchange Notes Indenture, as the case may be,
shall provide that the Notes, the Exchange Notes and the Private Exchange Notes
shall vote and consent together on all matters as one class and that none of the
Notes, the Exchange Notes or the Private Exchange Notes will have the right to
vote or consent as a separate class on any matter.

         Interest on each Exchange Note and Private Exchange Note issued
pursuant to the Registered Exchange Offer and in the Private Exchange will
accrue from the last interest payment date on which interest was paid on the
Notes surrendered in exchange therefor or, if no interest has been paid on the
Notes, from the Issue Date.

         Each Holder participating in the Registered Exchange Offer shall be
required to represent to the Company that at the time of the consummation of the
Registered Exchange Offer (i) any Exchange Notes received by such Holder will be
acquired in the ordinary course of business, (ii) such Holder will have no
arrangements or understandings with any person to participate in the
distribution of the Notes or the Exchange Notes within the meaning of the
Securities Act and (iii) such Holder is not an affiliate of the Company or, if
it is such an affiliate, such Holder will comply with the registration and
prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act to the extent applicable.

         Notwithstanding any other provisions hereof, the Company will ensure
that (i) any Exchange Offer Registration Statement and any amendment thereto and
any prospectus forming part thereof and any supplement thereto complies as to
form in all material respects with the Securities Act and the rules and
regulations of the Commission thereunder, (ii) any Exchange Offer Registration
Statement and any amendment thereto does not, when it becomes effective, contain
an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required
to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein, in the light
of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading and (iii) any
prospectus forming part of any Exchange Offer Registration Statement, and any
supplement to such prospectus, does not, as of the consummation of the


<PAGE>   4


                                                                               4






Registered Exchange Offer, include an untrue statement of a material fact or
omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein,
in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

         2. Shelf Registration. If (i) because of any change in law or
applicable interpretations thereof by the Commission's staff the Company is not
permitted to effect the Registered Exchange Offer as contemplated by Section 1
hereof, or (ii) any Securities validly tendered pursuant to the Registered
Exchange Offer are not exchanged for Exchange Notes within 180 days after the
Issue Date, or (iii) any Initial Purchaser so requests with respect to Notes or
Private Exchange Notes not eligible to be exchanged for Exchange Notes in the
Registered Exchange Offer and held by it following the consummation of the
Registered Exchange Offer, or (iv) any applicable law or interpretations do not
permit any Holder to participate in the Registered Exchange Offer, or (v) any
Holder that participates in the Registered Exchange Offer does not receive
freely transferable Exchange Notes in exchange for tendered Notes, or (vi) the
Company so elects, then the following provisions shall apply:

         (a) The Company shall use its commercially reasonable efforts to file
as promptly as practicable (but in no event more than 60 days after so required
or requested pursuant to this Section 2) with the Commission, and thereafter
shall use its commercially reasonable efforts to cause to be declared effective,
a shelf registration statement on an appropriate form under the Securities Act
relating to the offer and sale of the Transfer Restricted Notes (as defined
below) by the Holders thereof from time to time in accordance with the methods
of distribution set forth in such registration statement (hereafter, a "Shelf
Registration Statement" and, together with any Exchange Offer Registration
Statement, a "Registration Statement").

         (b) The Company shall use its commercially reasonable efforts to keep
the Shelf Registration Statement continuously effective in order to permit the
prospectus forming part thereof to be used by Holders of Transfer Restricted
Securities for a period ending on the earlier of (i) two years from the Issue
Date or such shorter period that will terminate when all the Transfer Restricted
Securities covered by the Shelf Registration Statement have been sold pursuant
thereto and (ii) the date on which the Notes become eligible for resale without
volume restrictions pursuant to Rule 144(k) under the Securities Act (in any
such case, such period being called the "Shelf Registration Period"). The
Company shall be deemed not to have used its commercially reasonable efforts to
keep the Shelf Registration Statement effective during the requisite period if
it voluntarily takes any action that would result in Holders of Transfer
Restricted Notes covered thereby not being able to offer and sell such Transfer
Restricted Notes during that period, unless such action is required by
applicable law.

         (c) Notwithstanding any other provisions hereof, the Company will
ensure that (i) any Shelf Registration Statement and any amendment thereto and
any prospectus forming part thereof and any supplement thereto complies as to
form in all material respects with the Securities Act and the rules and
regulations of the Commission thereunder, (ii) any Shelf Registration Statement
and any amendment thereto (in either case, other than with respect to
information included therein in reliance upon or in conformity with written
information furnished to the Company by or on behalf of any Holder specifically
for use therein (the "Holders' Information")) does not contain an untrue
statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be
stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the
circumstances under which they were made, not misleading and (iii) any
prospectus forming part of any Shelf Registration Statement, and any supplement
to such prospectus (in either case, other than with respect to Holders'
Information), does not include an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to
state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the
light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

         3. Liquidated Damages. (a) The parties hereto agree that the Holders of
Transfer Restricted Securities will suffer damages if the Company fails to
fulfill its obligations under Section 1 or Section 2, as applicable, and that it
would not be feasible to ascertain the extent of such damages.



<PAGE>   5


                                                                               5





Accordingly, if (i) the applicable Registration Statement is not filed with the
Commission on or prior to 60 days after the Issue Date, (ii) the Exchange Offer
Registration Statement or the Shelf Registration Statement, as the case may be,
is not declared effective within 150 days after the Issue Date (or in the case
of a Shelf Registration Statement required to be filed in response to a change
in law or the applicable interpretations of Commission's staff, if later, within
45 days after publication of the change in law or interpretation), (iii) the
Registered Exchange Offer is not consummated on or prior to 180 days after the
Issue Date, or (iv) the Shelf Registration Statement is filed and declared
effective within 150 days after the Issue Date (or in the case of a Shelf
Registration Statement required to be filed in response to a change in law or
the applicable interpretations of Commission's staff, if later, within 45 days
after publication of the change in law or interpretation) but shall thereafter
cease to be effective (at any time that the Company is obligated to maintain the
effectiveness thereof) without being succeeded within 45 days by an additional
Registration Statement filed and declared effective (each such event referred to
in clauses (i) through (iv), a "Registration Default"), the Company will be
obligated to pay liquidated damages to each Holder of Transfer Restricted Notes,
during the period of one or more such Registration Defaults, in an amount equal
to $ 0.192 per week per $1,000 principal amount of Transfer Restricted Notes
held by such Holder until (i) the applicable Registration Statement is filed,
(ii) the Exchange Offer Registration Statement is declared effective and the
Registered Exchange Offer is consummated, (iii) the Shelf Registration Statement
is declared effective or (iv) the Shelf Registration Statement again becomes
effective, as the case may be. Following the cure of all Registration Defaults,
the accrual of liquidated damages will cease. As used herein, the term "Transfer
Restricted Notes" means (i) each Note until the date on which such Security has
been exchanged for a freely transferable Exchange Note in the Registered
Exchange Offer, (ii) each Note or Private Exchange Note until the date on which
it has been effectively registered under the Securities Act and disposed of in
accordance with the Shelf Registration Statement or (iii) each Note or Private
Exchange Note until the date on which it is distributed to the public pursuant
to Rule 144 under the Securities Act or is saleable pursuant to Rule 144(k)
under the Securities Act. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this
Section 3(a), the Company shall not be required to pay liquidated damages to a
Holder of Transfer Restricted Notes if such Holder failed to comply with its
obligations to make the representations set forth in the second to last
paragraph of Section 1 or failed to provide the information required to be
provided by it, if any, pursuant to Section 4(n).

         (b) The Company shall notify the Trustee and the Paying Agent (as
defined in the Indenture) immediately upon the happening of each and every
Registration Default. The Company shall pay the liquidated damages due on the
Transfer Restricted Notes by depositing with the Paying Agent (which may not be
the Company for these purposes), in trust, for the benefit of the Holders
thereof, prior to 10:00 a.m., New York City time, on the next interest payment
date specified by the Indenture and the Notes, sums sufficient to pay the
liquidated damages then due. The liquidated damages due shall be payable
semi-annually on dates which correspond to interest payment dates specified by
the Indenture and the Notes to the record holder entitled to receive the
interest payment to be made on such date. Each obligation to pay liquidated
damages shall be deemed to accrue from and including the date of the applicable
Registration Default.

         (c) The parties hereto agree that the liquidated damages provided for
in this Section 3 constitute a reasonable estimate of and are intended to
constitute the sole damages that will be suffered by Holders of Transfer
Restricted Notes by reason of the failure of (i) the Shelf Registration
Statement or the Exchange Offer Registration Statement to be filed, (ii) the
Shelf Registration Statement to remain effective or (iii) the Exchange Offer
Registration Statement to be declared effective and the Registered Exchange
Offer to be consummated, in each case to the extent required by this Agreement.

         4. Registration Procedures. In connection with any Registration
Statement, the following provisions shall apply:

         (a) The Company shall (i) furnish to each Initial Purchaser, prior to
the filing thereof with the Commission, a copy of the Registration Statement and
each amendment thereof


<PAGE>   6


                                                                               6





and each supplement, if any, to the prospectus included therein and shall use
its commercially reasonable efforts to reflect in each such document, when so
filed with the Commission, such comments as any Initial Purchaser may reasonably
propose; (ii) include the information set forth in Annex A hereto on the cover,
in Annex B hereto in the "Exchange Offer Procedures" section and the "Purpose of
the Exchange Offer" section and in Annex C hereto in the "Plan of Distribution"
section of the prospectus forming a part of the Exchange Offer Registration
Statement, and include the information set forth in Annex D hereto in the Letter
of Transmittal delivered pursuant to the Registered Exchange Offer; and (iii) if
requested by any Initial Purchaser, include the information required by Items
507 or 508 of Regulation S-K, as applicable, in the prospectus forming a part of
the Exchange Offer Registration Statement.

         (b) The Company shall advise each Initial Purchaser, each Exchanging
Dealer and each of the Holders (if applicable) and, if requested by any such
person, confirm such advice in writing (which advice pursuant to clauses
(ii)-(v) hereof shall be accompanied by an instruction to suspend the use of the
prospectus until the requisite changes have been made):

         (i) when any Registration Statement and any amendment thereto has been
    filed with the Commission and when such Registration Statement or any
    post-effective amendment thereto has become effective;

         (ii) of any request by the Commission for amendments or supplements to
    any Registration Statement or the prospectus included therein or for
    additional information;

         (iii) of the issuance by the Commission of any stop order suspending
    the effectiveness of any Registration Statement or the initiation of any
    proceedings for that purpose;

         (iv) of the receipt by the Company of any notification with respect to
    the suspension of the qualification of the Notes, the Exchange Notes or the
    Private Exchange Notes for sale in any jurisdiction or the initiation or
    threatening of any proceeding for such purpose; and

         (v) of the happening of any event that requires the making of any
    changes in any Registration Statement or the prospectus included therein in
    order that the statements therein are not misleading and do not omit to
    state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the
    statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were
    made, not misleading.

         (c) The Company will use its commercially reasonable efforts to obtain
the withdrawal at the earliest possible time of any order suspending the
effectiveness of any Registration Statement.

         (d) The Company will furnish to each Holder of Transfer Restricted
Notes included within the coverage of any Shelf Registration Statement, without
charge, at least one conformed copy of such Shelf Registration Statement and any
post-effective amendment thereto, including financial statements and schedules
and, if any such Holder so requests in writing, all exhibits thereto (including
those, if any, incorporated by reference).

         (e) The Company will, during the Shelf Registration Period, promptly
deliver to each Holder of Transfer Restricted Notes included within the coverage
of any Shelf Registration Statement, without charge, as many copies of the
prospectus (including each preliminary prospectus) included in such Shelf
Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement thereto as such Holder
may reasonably request; and the Company consents to the use of such prospectus
or any amendment or supplement thereto by each of the selling Holders of
Transfer Restricted Notes in connection with the offer and sale of the Transfer
Restricted Notes covered by such prospectus or any amendment or supplement
thereto.



<PAGE>   7


                                                                               7






         (f) The Company will furnish to each Initial Purchaser and each
Exchanging Dealer, and to any other Holder who so requests, without charge, at
least one conformed copy of the Exchange Offer Registration Statement and any
post-effective amendment thereto, including financial statements and schedules
and, if any Initial Purchaser or Exchanging Dealer or any such Holder so
requests in writing, all exhibits thereto (including those, if any, incorporated
by reference).

         (g) The Company will, during the Exchange Offer Registration Period or
the Shelf Registration Period, as applicable, promptly deliver to each Initial
Purchaser, each Exchanging Dealer and such other persons that are required to
deliver a prospectus following the Registered Exchange Offer, without charge, as
many copies of the final prospectus included in the Exchange Offer Registration
Statement or the Shelf Registration Statement and any amendment or supplement
thereto as such Initial Purchaser, Exchanging Dealer or other persons may
reasonably request; and the Company consents to the use of such prospectus or
any amendment or supplement thereto by any such Initial Purchaser, Exchanging
Dealer or other persons, as applicable, as aforesaid.

         (h) Prior to the effective date of any Registration Statement, the
Company will use its commercially reasonable efforts to register or qualify, or
cooperate with the Holders of Notes, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes
included therein and their respective counsel in connection with the
registration or qualification of, such Notes, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange
Notes for offer and sale under the securities or blue sky laws of such
jurisdictions as any such Holder reasonably requests in writing and do any and
all other acts or things necessary or advisable to enable the offer and sale in
such jurisdictions of the Notes, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes
covered by such Registration Statement; provided that the Company will not be
required to qualify generally to do business in any jurisdiction where it is not
then so qualified or to take any action which would subject it to general
service of process or to taxation in any such jurisdiction where it is not then
so subject.

         (i) The Company will cooperate with the Holders of Notes, Exchange
Notes or Private Exchange Notes to facilitate the timely preparation and
delivery of certificates representing Notes, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange
Notes to be sold pursuant to any Registration Statement free of any restrictive
legends and in such denominations and registered in such names as the Holders
thereof may request in writing prior to sales of Notes, Exchange Notes or
Private Exchange Notes pursuant to such Registration Statement.

         (j) If any event contemplated by Section 4(b)(ii) through (v) occurs
during the period for which the Company is required to maintain an effective
Registration Statement, the Company will use its commercially reasonable efforts
to promptly prepare and file with the Commission a post-effective amendment to
the Registration Statement or a supplement to the related prospectus or file any
other required document so that, as thereafter delivered to purchasers of the
Notes, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes from a Holder, the prospectus
will not include an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of
the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

         (k) Not later than the effective date of the applicable Registration
Statement, the Company will provide CUSIP numbers for the Notes, the Exchange
Notes and the Private Exchange Notes, as the case may be, and provide the
applicable trustee with printed certificates for the Notes, the Exchange Notes
or the Private Exchange Notes, as the case may be, in a form eligible for
deposit with The Depository Trust Company.

         (l) The Company will comply with all applicable rules and regulations
of the Commission and will make generally available to its security holders as
soon as practicable after the effective date of the applicable Registration
Statement an earning statement satisfying the provisions of Section 11(a) of the
Securities Act; provided that in no event shall such earning statement be
delivered later than 45 days after the end of a 12-month period (or 90 days, if
such period is a fiscal year) beginning with the first month of the Company's
first fiscal quarter commencing after the


<PAGE>   8


                                                                               8





effective date of the applicable Registration Statement, which statement shall
cover such 12-month period.

         (m) The Company will cause the Indenture or the Exchange Notes
Indenture, as the case may be, to be qualified under the Trust Indenture Act as
required by applicable law in a timely manner.

         (n) The Company may require each Holder of Transfer Restricted Notes to
be registered pursuant to any Shelf Registration Statement to furnish to the
Company such information concerning the Holder and the distribution of such
Transfer Restricted Notes as the Company may from time to time reasonably
require for inclusion in such Shelf Registration Statement, and the Company may
exclude from such registration the Transfer Restricted Notes of any Holder that
fails to furnish such information within a reasonable time after receiving such
request.

         (o) In the case of a Shelf Registration Statement, each Holder of
Transfer Restricted Notes to be registered pursuant thereto agrees by
acquisition of such Transfer Restricted Notes that, upon receipt of any notice
from the Company pursuant to Section 4(b)(ii) through (v), such Holder will
discontinue disposition of such Transfer Restricted Notes until such Holder's
receipt of copies of the supplemental or amended prospectus contemplated by
Section 4(j) or until advised in writing (the "Advice") by the Company that the
use of the applicable prospectus may be resumed. If the Company shall give any
notice under Section 4(b)(ii) through (v) during the period that the Company is
required to maintain an effective Registration Statement (the "Effectiveness
Period"), such Effectiveness Period shall be extended by the number of days
during such period from and including the date of the giving of such notice to
and including the date when each seller of Transfer Restricted Securities
covered by such Registration Statement shall have received (x) the copies of the
supplemental or amended prospectus contemplated by Section 4(j) (if an amended
or supplemental prospectus is required) or (y) the Advice (if no amended or
supplemental prospectus is required).

         (p) In the case of a Shelf Registration Statement, the Company shall
enter into such customary agreements (including, if requested, an underwriting
agreement in customary form) and take all such other action, if any, as Holders
of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Notes, Exchange Notes and
Private Exchange Notes being sold or the managing underwriters (if any) shall
reasonably request in order to facilitate any disposition of Notes, Exchange
Notes or Private Exchange Notes pursuant to such Shelf Registration Statement.

         (q) In the case of a Shelf Registration Statement, the Company shall
(i) make reasonably available for inspection by a representative of, and Special
Counsel (as defined below) acting for, Holders of a majority in aggregate
principal amount of the Notes, Exchange Notes and Private Exchange Notes being
sold and any underwriter participating in any disposition of Notes, Exchange
Notes or Private Exchange Notes pursuant to such Shelf Registration Statement,
all relevant financial and other records, pertinent corporate documents and
properties of the Company and its subsidiaries and (ii) use its commercially
reasonable efforts to have its officers, directors, employees, accountants and
counsel supply all relevant information reasonably requested by such
representative, Special Counsel or any such underwriter (an "Inspector") in
connection with such Shelf Registration Statement.

         (r) In the case of a Shelf Registration Statement, the Company shall,
if requested by Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the
Notes, Exchange Notes and Private Exchange Notes being sold, their Special
Counsel or the managing underwriters (if any) in connection with such Shelf
Registration Statement, use its commercially reasonable efforts to cause (i) its
counsel to deliver an opinion relating to the Shelf Registration Statement and
the Notes, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes, as applicable, in customary
form, (ii) its officers to execute and deliver all customary documents and
certificates requested by Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of
the Notes, Exchange Notes and Private Exchange Notes being sold, their Special
Counsel or the managing underwriters (if any) and (iii) its independent public


<PAGE>   9


                                                                               9





accountants to provide a comfort letter or letters in customary form, subject to
receipt of appropriate documentation as contemplated, and only if permitted, by
Statement of Auditing Standards No. 72.

         5. Registration Expenses. Except as provided in Section 9 hereof, the
Company will bear all expenses incurred in connection with the performance of
its obligations under Sections 1, 2, 3 and 4, and the Company will reimburse the
Initial Purchasers and the Holders for the reasonable fees and disbursements of
one firm of attorneys (in addition to any local counsel) chosen by the Holders
of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Notes, the Exchange Notes and
the Private Exchange Notes to be sold pursuant to each Registration Statement
(the "Special Counsel") acting for the Initial Purchasers or Holders in
connection therewith.

         6. Indemnification. (a) In the event of a Shelf Registration Statement
or in connection with any prospectus delivery pursuant to an Exchange Offer
Registration Statement by an Initial Purchaser or Exchanging Dealer, as
applicable, the Company shall indemnify and hold harmless each Holder
(including, without limitation, any such Initial Purchaser or Exchanging
Dealer), its affiliates, their respective officers, directors, employees,
representatives and agents, and each person, if any, who controls such Holder
within the meaning of the Securities Act or the Exchange Act (collectively
referred to for purposes of this Section 6 and Section 7 as a Holder) from and
against any loss, claim, damage or liability, joint or several, or any action in
respect thereof (including, without limitation, any loss, claim, damage,
liability or action relating to purchases and sales of Notes, Exchange Notes or
Private Exchange Notes), to which that Holder may become subject, whether
commenced or threatened, under the Securities Act, the Exchange Act, any other
federal or state statutory law or regulation, at common law or otherwise,
insofar as such loss, claim, damage, liability or action arises out of, or is
based upon, (i) any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material
fact contained in any such Registration Statement or any prospectus forming part
thereof or in any amendment or supplement thereto or (ii) the omission or
alleged omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein
or necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the
circumstances under which they were made, not misleading, and shall reimburse
each Holder promptly upon demand for any reasonable legal or other expenses
reasonably incurred by that Holder in connection with investigating or defending
or preparing to defend against or appearing as a third party witness in
connection with any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action as such
expenses are incurred; provided, however, that the Company shall not be liable
in any such case to the extent that any such loss, claim, damage, liability or
action arises out of, or is based upon, an untrue statement or alleged untrue
statement in or omission or alleged omission from any of such documents in
reliance upon and in conformity with any Holders' Information; and provided,
further, that with respect to any such untrue statement in or omission from any
related preliminary prospectus, the indemnity agreement contained in this
Section 6(a) shall not inure to the benefit of any Holder from whom the person
asserting any such loss, claim, damage, liability or action received Notes,
Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes to the extent that such loss, claim,
damage, liability or action of or with respect to such Holder results from the
fact that both (A) a copy of the final prospectus was not sent or given to such
person at or prior to the written confirmation of the sale of such Notes,
Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes to such person and (B) the untrue
statement in or omission from the related preliminary prospectus was corrected
in the final prospectus unless such failure to deliver the final prospectus was
a result of non-compliance by the Company with Section 4(d), 4(e), 4(f) or 4(g).

         (b) In the event of a Shelf Registration Statement, each Holder shall
indemnify and hold harmless the Company, its affiliates, their respective
officers, directors, employees, representatives and agents, and each person, if
any, who controls the Company within the meaning of the Securities Act or the
Exchange Act (collectively referred to for purposes of this Section 6(b) and
Section 7 as the Company), from and against any loss, claim, damage or
liability, joint or several, or any action in respect thereof, to which the
Company may become subject, whether commenced or threatened, under the
Securities Act, the Exchange Act, any other federal or state statutory law or
regulation, at common law or otherwise, insofar as such loss, claim, damage,
liability or action arises out of, or is based upon, (i) any untrue statement or
alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any such Registration
Statement or any prospectus forming part thereof or


<PAGE>   10


                                                                              10





in any amendment or supplement thereto or (ii) the omission or alleged omission
to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in
order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under
which they were made, not misleading, but in each case only to the extent that
the untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission
was made in reliance upon and in conformity with any Holders' Information
furnished to the Company by such Holder, and shall reimburse the Company for any
legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by the Company in connection with
investigating or defending or preparing to defend against or appearing as a
third-party witness in connection with any such loss, claim, damage, liability
or action as such expenses are incurred; provided, however, that no such Holder
shall be liable for any indemnity claims hereunder in excess of the amount of
net proceeds received by such Holder from the sale of Notes, Exchange Notes or
Private Exchange Notes pursuant to such Shelf Registration Statement.

         (c) Promptly after receipt by an indemnified party under this Section 6
of notice of any claim or the commencement of any action, the indemnified party
shall, if a claim in respect thereof is to be made against the indemnifying
party pursuant to Section 6(a) or 6(b), notify the indemnifying party in writing
of the claim or the commencement of that action; provided, however, that the
failure to notify the indemnifying party shall not relieve the indemnifying
party from any liability which it may have under this Section 6 except to the
extent that it has been materially prejudiced (through the forfeiture of
substantive rights or defenses) by such failure; and provided, further, that the
failure to notify the indemnifying party shall not relieve it from any liability
which it may have to an indemnified party otherwise than under this Section 6.
If any such claim or action shall be brought against an indemnified party, and
it shall notify the indemnifying party thereof, the indemnifying party shall be
entitled to participate therein and, to the extent that it wishes, jointly with
any other similarly notified indemnifying party, to assume the defense thereof
with counsel reasonably satisfactory to the indemnified party. After notice from
the indemnifying party to the indemnified party of its election to assume the
defense of such claim or action, the indemnifying party shall not be liable to
the indemnified party under this Section 6 for any legal or other expenses
subsequently incurred by the indemnified party in connection with the defense
thereof other than the reasonable costs of investigation; provided, however,
that an indemnified party shall have the right to employ its own counsel in any
such action, but the fees, expenses and other charges of such counsel for the
indemnified party will be at the expense of such indemnified party unless (1)
the employment of counsel by the indemnified party has been authorized in
writing by the indemnifying party, (2) the indemnified party has reasonably
concluded (based upon written advice of counsel to the indemnified party, a copy
of which has been provided to the indemnifying party) that there may be legal
defenses available to it or other indemnified parties that are different from or
in addition to those available to the indemnifying party, (3) a conflict or
potential conflict exists (based upon written advice of counsel to the
indemnified party, a copy of which has been provided to the indemnifying party)
between the indemnified party and the indemnifying party (in which case the
indemnifying party will not have the right to direct the defense of such action
on behalf of the indemnified party) or (4) the indemnifying party has not in
fact employed counsel reasonably satisfactory to the indemnified party to assume
the defense of such action within a reasonable time after receiving notice of
the commencement of the action, in each of which cases the reasonable fees,
disbursements and other charges of counsel will be at the expense of the
indemnifying party or parties. It is understood that the indemnifying party or
parties shall not, in connection with any proceeding or related proceedings in
the same jurisdiction, be liable for the reasonable fees, disbursements and
other charges of more than one separate firm of attorneys (in addition to any
local counsel) at any one time for all such indemnified party or parties. Each
indemnified party, as a condition of the indemnity agreements contained in
Sections 6(a) and 6(b), shall use all reasonable efforts to cooperate with the
indemnifying party in the defense of any such action or claim. No indemnifying
party shall be liable for any settlement of any such action effected without its
written consent (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld), but if
settled with its written consent or if there be a final judgment for the
plaintiff in any such action, the indemnifying party agrees to indemnify and
hold harmless any indemnified party from and against any loss or liability by
reason of such settlement or judgment. No indemnifying party shall, without the
prior written consent of the indemnified party (which consent shall not be
unreasonably withheld), effect any settlement of any


<PAGE>   11


                                                                              11





pending or threatened proceeding in respect of which any indemnified party is or
could have been a party and indemnity could have been sought hereunder by such
indemnified party, unless such settlement includes an unconditional release of
such indemnified party from all liability on claims that are the subject matter
of such proceeding.

         7. Contribution. If the indemnification provided for in Section 6 is
unavailable or insufficient to hold harmless an indemnified party under Section
6(a) or 6(b), then each indemnifying party shall, in lieu of indemnifying such
indemnified party, contribute to the amount paid or payable by such indemnified
party as a result of such loss, claim, damage or liability, or action in respect
thereof, (i) in such proportion as shall be appropriate to reflect the relative
benefits received by the Company from the offering and sale of the Securities,
on the one hand, and a Holder with respect to the sale by such Holder of
Securities, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes, on the other, or (ii) if
the allocation provided by clause (i) above is not permitted by applicable law,
in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits
referred to in clause (i) above but also the relative fault of the Company on
the one hand and such Holder on the other with respect to the statements or
omissions that resulted in such loss, claim, damage or liability, or action in
respect thereof, as well as any other relevant equitable considerations. The
relative benefits received by the Company on the one hand and a Holder on the
other with respect to such offering and such sale shall be deemed to be in the
same proportion as the total net proceeds from the offering of the Notes (before
deducting expenses) received by or on behalf of the Company as set forth in the
table on the cover of the Offering Memorandum, on the one hand, bear to the
total proceeds received by such Holder with respect to its sale of Notes,
Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes, on the other. The relative fault shall
be determined by reference to, among other things, whether the untrue or alleged
untrue statement of a material fact or the omission or alleged omission to state
a material fact relates to the Company or information supplied by the Company on
the one hand or to any Holders' Information supplied by such Holder on the
other, the intent of the parties and their relative knowledge, access to
information and opportunity to correct or prevent such untrue statement or
omission. The parties hereto agree that it would not be just and equitable if
contributions pursuant to this Section 7 were to be determined by pro rata
allocation or by any other method of allocation that does not take into account
the equitable considerations referred to herein. The amount paid or payable by
an indemnified party as a result of the loss, claim, damage or liability, or
action in respect thereof, referred to above in this Section 7 shall be deemed
to include, for purposes of this Section 7, any reasonable legal or other
expenses reasonably incurred by such indemnified party in connection with
investigating or defending or preparing to defend any such action or claim.
Notwithstanding the provisions of this Section 7, an indemnifying party that is
a Holder of Notes, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes shall not be
required to contribute any amount in excess of the amount by which the total
price at which the Notes, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes sold by such
indemnifying party to any purchaser exceeds the amount of any damages which such
indemnifying party has otherwise paid or become liable to pay by reason of any
untrue or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission. No person
guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of
the Notes Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any person who was not
guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation.

         8. Rules 144 and 144A. The Company shall use its commercially
reasonable efforts to file the reports required to be filed by it under the
Securities Act and the Exchange Act in a timely manner and, if at any time the
Company is not required to file such reports, it will, upon the written request
of any Holder of Transfer Restricted Notes, make publicly available other
information so long as necessary to permit sales of such Holder's securities
pursuant to Rules 144 and 144A. The Company covenants that it will take such
further action as any Holder of Transfer Restricted Notes may reasonably
request, all to the extent required from time to time to enable such Holder to
sell Transfer Restricted Notes without registration under the Securities Act
within the limitation of the exemptions provided by Rules 144 and 144A
(including, without limitation, the requirements of Rule 144A(d)(4)). Upon the
written request of any Holder of Transfer Restricted Notes, the Company shall
deliver to such Holder a written statement as to whether it has complied with
such requirements. Notwithstanding the foregoing, nothing in this Section 8
shall be deemed to require the Company to register any of its securities
pursuant to the Exchange Act.



<PAGE>   12


                                                                              12






         9. Underwritten Registrations. If any of the Transfer Restricted Notes
covered by any Shelf Registration Statement are to be sold in an underwritten
offering, the investment banker or investment bankers and manager or managers
that will administer the offering will be selected by the Holders of a majority
in aggregate principal amount of such Transfer Restricted Notes included in such
offering, subject to the consent of the Company (which shall not be unreasonably
withheld or delayed), and such Holders shall be responsible for all underwriting
commissions and discounts in connection therewith.

         No person may participate in any underwritten registration hereunder
unless such person (i) agrees to sell such person's Transfer Restricted Notes on
the basis reasonably provided in any underwriting arrangements approved by the
persons entitled hereunder to approve such arrangements and (ii) completes and
executes all questionnaires, powers of attorney, indemnities, underwriting
agreements and other documents reasonably required under the terms of such
underwriting arrangements.

         10. Miscellaneous. (a) Amendments and Waivers. The provisions of this
Agreement may not be amended, modified or supplemented, and waivers or consents
to departures from the provisions hereof may not be given, unless the Company
has obtained the written consent of Holders of a majority in aggregate principal
amount of the Notes, the Exchange Notes and the Private Exchange Notes, taken as
a single class. Notwithstanding the foregoing, a waiver or consent to depart
from the provisions hereof with respect to a matter that relates exclusively to
the rights of Holders whose Notes, Exchange Notes or Private Exchange Notes are
being sold pursuant to a Registration Statement and that does not directly or
indirectly affect the rights of other Holders may be given by Holders of a
majority in aggregate principal amount of the Notes, the Exchange Notes and the
Private Exchange Securities being sold by such Holders pursuant to such
Registration Statement.

         (b) Notices. All notices and other communications provided for or
permitted hereunder shall be made in writing by hand delivery, first-class mail,
telecopier or air courier guaranteeing next-day delivery:

         (1) if to a Holder, at the most current address given by such Holder to
    the Company in accordance with the provisions of this Section 10(b), which
    address initially is, with respect to each Holder, the address of such
    Holder maintained by the Registrar under the Indenture, with a copy in like
    manner to the Initial Purchasers;

         (2) if to an Initial Purchaser, initially at its address set forth in
    the Purchase Agreement; and

         (3) if to the Company, initially at the address of the Company set
    forth in the Purchase Agreement.

         All such notices and communications shall be deemed to have been duly
given: when delivered by hand, if personally delivered; one business day after
being delivered to a next-day air courier; five business days after being
deposited in the mail; and when receipt is acknowledged by the recipient's
telecopier machine, if sent by telecopier.

         (c) Successors And Assigns. This Agreement shall be binding upon the
Company and its successors and assigns.

         (d) Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of
counterparts (which may be delivered in original form or by telecopier) and by
the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed
shall be deemed to be an original and all of which taken together shall
constitute one and the same agreement.



<PAGE>   13


                                                                              13






         (e) Definition of Terms. For purposes of this Agreement, (a) the term
"business day" means any day on which the New York Stock Exchange, Inc. is open
for trading, (b) the term "subsidiary" has the meaning set forth in Rule 405
under the Securities Act and (c) except where otherwise expressly provided, the
term "affiliate" has the meaning set forth in Rule 405 under the Securities Act.

         (f) Headings. The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of
reference only and shall not limit or otherwise affect the meaning hereof.

         (g) Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in
accordance with the laws of the State of New York.

         (h) Remedies. In the event of a breach by the Company or by any Holder
of any of their obligations under this Agreement, each Holder or the Company, as
the case may be, in addition to being entitled to exercise all rights granted by
law, including recovery of damages (other than the recovery of damages for a
breach by the Company of its obligations under Sections 1 or 2 hereof for which
liquidated damages have been paid pursuant to Section 3 hereof, the sole and
exclusive remedy for any such breach), will be entitled to specific performance
of its rights under this Agreement. The Company and each Holder agree that
monetary damages would not be adequate compensation for any loss incurred by
reason of a breach by it of any of the provisions of this Agreement (other than
a breach by the Company of its obligations under Sections 1 or 2 hereof for
which liquidated damages shall have been paid pursuant to Section 3 hereof) and
hereby further agree that, in the event of any action for specific performance
in respect of such breach, it shall waive the defense that a remedy at law would
be adequate.

         (i) No Inconsistent Agreements. The Company represents, warrants and
agrees that (i) it has not entered into and shall not, on or after the date of
this Agreement, enter into any agreement that is inconsistent with the rights
granted to the Holders in this Agreement or otherwise conflicts with the
provisions hereof, (ii) it has not previously entered into any agreement which
remains in effect granting any registration rights with respect to any of its
debt securities to any person and (iii) without limiting the generality of the
foregoing, without the written consent of the Holders of a majority in aggregate
principal amount of the then outstanding Transfer Restricted Notes, it shall not
grant to any person the right to request the Company to register any debt
securities of the Company under the Securities Act unless the rights so granted
are not in conflict or inconsistent with the provisions of this Agreement.

         (j) No Piggyback on Registrations. Neither the Company nor any of its
security holders (other than the Holders of Transfer Restricted Notes in such
capacity) shall have the right to include any securities of the Company in any
Shelf Registration or Registered Exchange Offer other than Transfer Restricted
Notes.

         (k) Severability. The remedies provided herein are cumulative and not
exclusive of any remedies provided by law. If any term, provision, covenant or
restriction of this Agreement is held by a court of competent jurisdiction to be
invalid, illegal, void or unenforceable, the remainder of the terms, provisions,
covenants and restrictions set forth herein shall remain in full force and
effect and shall in no way be affected, impaired or invalidated, and the parties
hereto shall use their commercially reasonable efforts to find and employ an
alternative means to achieve the same or substantially the same result as that
contemplated by such term, provision, covenant or restriction. It is hereby
stipulated and declared to be the intention of the parties that they would have
executed the remaining terms, provisions, covenants and restrictions without
including any of such that may be hereafter declared invalid, illegal, void or
unenforceable.



<PAGE>   14


                                                                              14






         Please confirm that the foregoing correctly sets forth the agreement
among the Company and the Initial Purchasers.

                                        Very truly yours,

                                        RENTERS CHOICE, INC.


                                        By
                                          --------------------------------------
                                        Name:
                                        Title:


Accepted:

CHASE SECURITIES INC.


By
  ------------------------------------
        Authorized Signatory


BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.


By
  ------------------------------------
        Authorized Signatory


NATIONSBANC MONTGOMERY
  SECURITIES LLC


By
  ------------------------------------
        Authorized Signatory


CREDIT SUISSE FIRST BOSTON CORPORATION


By
  ------------------------------------
        Authorized Signatory




<PAGE>   15










                                                             ANNEX A
                                                             TO THE REGISTRATION
                                                             RIGHTS AGREEMENT


         Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account
pursuant to the Registered Exchange Offer must acknowledge that it will deliver
a prospectus in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. The Letter of
Transmittal states that by so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, a
broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within the
meaning of the Securities Act. This Prospectus, as it may be amended or
supplemented from time to time, may be used by a broker-dealer in connection
with resales of Exchange Notes received in exchange for Notes where such Notes
were acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or
other trading activities. The Company has agreed that, for a period of 90 days
after the consummation of the Exchange Offer (as defined herein), it will use
its commercially reasonable efforts to make this Prospectus available to any
broker-dealer for use in connection with any such resale. See "Plan of
Distribution."



<PAGE>   16









                                                             ANNEX B
                                                             TO THE REGISTRATION
                                                             RIGHTS AGREEMENT


         Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account in
exchange for Notes, where such Notes were acquired by such broker-dealer as a
result of market-making activities or other trading activities, must acknowledge
that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of such Exchange
Notes. See "Plan of Distribution."




<PAGE>   17









                                                             ANNEX C
                                                             TO THE REGISTRATION
                                                             RIGHTS AGREEMENT

                              PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION


         Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account
pursuant to the Registered Exchange Offer must acknowledge that it will deliver
a prospectus in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. This
Prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may be used
by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of Exchange Notes received in
exchange for Notes where such Notes were acquired as a result of market-making
activities or other trading activities. The Company has agreed that, for a
period of 180 days after the consummation of the Exchange Offer, it will use its
commercially reasonable efforts to make this prospectus, as amended or
supplemented, available to any broker-dealer for use in connection with any such
resale. In addition, until _______________, 199_, all dealers effecting
transactions in the Exchange Notes may be required to deliver a prospectus.

         The Company will not receive any proceeds from any sale of Exchange
Notes by broker-dealers. Exchange Notes received by broker-dealers for their own
account pursuant to the Registered Exchange Offer may be sold from time to time
in one or more transactions in the over-the-counter market, in negotiated
transactions, through the writing of options on the Exchange Notes or a
combination of such methods of resale, at market prices prevailing at the time
of resale, at prices related to such prevailing market prices or at negotiated
prices. Any such resale may be made directly to purchasers or to or through
brokers or dealers who may receive compensation in the form of commissions or
concessions from any such broker-dealer or the purchasers of any such Exchange
Notes. Any broker-dealer that resells Exchange Notes that were received by it
for its own account pursuant to the Registered Exchange Offer and any broker or
dealer that participates in a distribution of such Exchange Notes may be deemed
to be an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act and any profit
on any such resale of Exchange Notes and any commission or concessions received
by any such persons may be deemed to be underwriting compensation under the
Securities Act. The Letter of Transmittal states that, by acknowledging that it
will deliver and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed
to admit that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act.

         For a period of 90 days after the consummation of the Exchange Offer,
the Company will promptly send additional copies of this Prospectus and any
amendment or supplement to this Prospectus to any broker-dealer that requests
such documents in the Letter of Transmittal. The Company has agreed to pay all
expenses incident to the Registered Exchange Offer (including the expenses of
one counsel for the Holders of the Notes) other than commissions or concessions
of any broker-dealers and will indemnify the Holders of the Securities
(including any broker-dealers) against certain liabilities, including
liabilities under the Securities Act.




<PAGE>   18








                                                             ANNEX D
                                                             TO THE REGISTRATION
                                                             RIGHTS AGREEMENT



         [  ]     CHECK HERE IF YOU ARE A BROKER-DEALER AND WISH TO RECEIVE 10
                  ADDITIONAL COPIES OF THE PROSPECTUS AND 10 COPIES OF ANY
                  AMENDMENTS OR SUPPLEMENTS THERETO.

                  Name:
                       ----------------------------------------------------
                  Address:
                          -------------------------------------------------

                          -------------------------------------------------


If the undersigned is not a broker-dealer, the undersigned represents that it is
not engaged in, and does not intend to engage in, a distribution of Exchange
Notes. If the undersigned is a broker-dealer that will receive Exchange Notes
for its own account in exchange for Notes that were acquired as a result of
market-making activities or other trading activities, it acknowledges that it
will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes;
however, by so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, the undersigned
will not be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of
the Securities Act.



<PAGE>   1
                                                                    Exhibit 21.1


                           Subsidiaries of Registrant

                         Rent-A-Center, Inc. - Delaware

                            Color Tyme, Inc. - Texas

<PAGE>   1
 
                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.1
 
              CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT CERTIFIED PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
We have issued our report dated February 12, 1998, accompanying the consolidated
financial statements of Renters Choice, Inc. and Subsidiaries contained in the
Registration Statement on Form S-4 and Prospectus. We consent to the use of the
aforementioned report in this Registration Statement on Form S-4 and Prospectus,
and to the use of our name as it appears under the caption "Experts".
 
GRANT THORNTON LLP
 
Dallas, Texas
October 15, 1998

<PAGE>   1
 
                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.2
 
                        CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS
 
We consent to the reference to our firm under the caption "Experts" and to the
use of our report dated April 24, 1998 (except for Note 14, as to which the date
is June 25, 1998), with respect to the consolidated financial statements of
THORN Americas, Inc. and subsidiaries included in the Registration Statement
(Form S-4) and related Prospectus of Renters Choice, Inc. for the registration
of $175,000,000, 11% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008.
 
                                                ERNST & YOUNG LLP
 
Wichita, Kansas
October 13, 1998

<PAGE>   1
 
                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.3
 
                   CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
As independent public accountants, we hereby consent to the use of our report
dated March 19, 1998 included in this Form S-4 Registration Statement of Renters
Choice, Inc., Rent-A-Center, Inc. and ColorTyme, Inc. and to all references to
our Firm included in this registration statement.
 
                                                ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
 
Los Angeles, California
October 13, 1998


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission